UNITED STATES DEPARTMENT OF THE INTERIOR Water and Power Resources Service Denver, Colorado 1980 Transmission Line Design Manual bY Holland H. Farr A guide for the investigation, development, and design of power transmission A Water Resources Technical lines. Publication As the Nation’s principal conservation agency, the Department of the Interior has responsibility for most of our nationally owned public lands and natural resources. This includes fostering the wisest use of our land and water resources, protecting our fish and wildlife, preserving the environmental and cultural values of our national parks and historical places, and providing for the enjoyment of life through outdoor recreation. The Department assessesour energy and mineral resources and works to assure that their development is in the best interests of all our people. The Department also has a major responsibility for American Indian reservation communities and for people who live in Island Territories under U.S. administration. On November 6, 1979, the Bureau of Reclamation was renamed the Water and Power Resources Service in the U.S. Department of the Interior. The new name more closely identifies the agency with its principal functions - supplying water and power. The text of this publication was prepared prior to adoption of the new name; all references to the Bureau of Reclamation or any derivative thereof are to be considered synonymous with the Water and Power Resources Service. SI METRIC UNITED STATES GOVERNMENT DENVER: PRINTING OFFICE 1980 For sale by the Superintendent of Documents, U.S. Government Printing Office, Washington DC 20402, and the Water and Power Resources Service, Engineering and Research Center, Attn D-922, P 0 Box 25007, Denver Federal Center, Denver CO 80225, Stock Number 024-003-00135-O PREFACE The purpose followed in the of the line Interior. design, such of this manual is to outline design of power transmission Numerous are included aspects protection, spotting. of the National problems with as selection clearance structure design patterns, Safety when the sixth some 16 000 circuit to properly distribute made other codes edition are made of NESC as required. lightning charts, of the are so noted; sparce by and Interpretations Some and concerning guying construction. considered voltages engineers of transmission insulation, and to he Department is presented was current, while of lines having power, Bureau procedures U.S. tensions, limitation to wood-pole the aspects Information sags and structure are limited and on specific applications. of NESC. of the Bureau, miles this of Reclamation, been conductors, and for, Bureau conductor examples most examples use the 1977 edition The transmission line network encompasses In addition, have of their Code requirements by the of construction, design developed which galloping Structure various lines explanations of type Electrical were studies, the some up to and including have also designed example however, standards, 500 kilovolts. and built some 300 substations and switchyards. This total transmission system represents an installed transformer capacity of approximately 22 million kilovolt amperes. In many areas, a Bureau line is the only source of electricity and, if an outage occurs, an area may be completely without power. The vast land area covered by Bureau lines offers almost every conceivable type large percentage of lines are in remote areas-maintenance Therefore, the line designs shown in this manual are more ordinarily be considered. The Bureau of Reclamation recognized the need for this of climatic condition, and complete be readily the manual available engineers designing new This manual contains manual and consequently initiated so that the design expertise gained through years of practical to other organizations as well as being a technical guide lines and maintaining the engineering tools many years of transmission line reference and guide for Bureau design by the Bureau. designers. In keeping metric units have been shown throughout the There are occasional references to proprietary not be construed in any processes of manufacturers other facilities. that have proven its of Energy in transmission to have the experience for Bureau to be successful over The manual is not a textbook, but a useful with the Metric Conversion Act of 1975, SI manual in addition to U.S. customary materials or products in this publication. way as an endorsement, as we cannot or the services of commercial firms units. These must endorse proprietary products for advertising, publicity, sales, or or purposes. The author, as an electrical contributions Area the remaining and concepts a is both difficult and time consuming. conservative than designs which might preparation. With the advent of the Western Area Power Administration, Department October of 1977, many of the electrical power features of the Bureau, including most lines, were transferred to the jurisdiction of Energy. However, it was deemed prudent Bureau would because Power Mr. Holland H. Farr, has more than 30 years of transmission line design experience engineer with the Bureau of Reclamation. He gratefully.acknowledges the many to this manual by the personnel of both the Bureau of Reclamation and the Western Administration. Special recognition to H. J. Kientz for suggestions, and consultation; R. D. Mohr who provided the technical Bureau of Reclamation, U.S. Department is given to F. F. Priest his computer treatment continuity. This of the Interior, Cdlorado. . .. 111 for his encouragement, of the concepts; and manual was prepared and Engineering and Research published Center, to by the Denver, ABBREVIATIONS ACSR aluminum conductor, AIEE Alcoa American Institute Aluminum AND SYMBOLS steel of Electrical Company ANSI American National ,4WG American Wire BIL basic impulse Standards insulation level International extra IEEE Institute K conductor loading LP low (distance MS1 NBS maximum National Bureau NESC National Electrical OGW SAS overhead ground sum of adjacent UHV USBR ultra high voltage U.S. Bureau of Reclamation gigapascal GPa Hz kcmil hertz thousand kPa kV*A kilopascal kilovolt kWh MPa kilowatt N/m N*m Institute Gage EHV point Engineers of America CIGRE high reinforced Conference on Large Electric Systems voltage of Electrical and Electronic Engineers constant between low sag increase of Standards Safety wire spans circular mils ampere hour megapascal newtons per meter newton meter iv Code points in adjacent spans) CONTENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preface :\bbrc\ ialions and CHAPTER syn~hols I. BASIC Field data Safety Cost 6 7 8 9 10 CHAPTER ..................................... of type Single wood-pole (b) H-frame, (c) (d) Single-circuit Double-circuit (e) Structures (f) Transpositions structures ................... 4 steel structures steel structures .................... ................... s ................... long-span construction ..................... and effective spans ............................. Selection of conductors ................................ Stress-strain curves The parabola and the catenary ........................ Design instructions Transmission data II. CONDUCTOR srnnmary tension calculations 19 20 21 9 10 14 21 form 23 ................... 2s ................................ charts Preparation ........................................ of sag template Inclined spans using Coppcrwcld sag calculating 29 32 .......................... 38 SO .................................... ............................... conductors Galloping Broken conductors Insulator effect III. 7 SAGS AND TENSIONS Sag and Spans 7 ................................ line 12 CHAPTER 6 6 Special ruling, ion 18 6 .................. special conditions .............................. informat 16 17 .4 structures wood-pole for 4 ....................... ..................... of construction (a) General 1S 2 .................................... 11 13 14 1 2 ...................................... estimates (g) Normal, with iv DATA codes Selection 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... III 56 ................................ on sag and concentrated tension in short spans ........... ........................ loads 77 99 INSULATION, LIGHTNING PROTECTION, AND CLEARANCE PATTERNS Insulation coordination Lightning Conductor protection clearance ............................. ............................... ......................... patterns V 103 106 111 TRANSMISSION vi CHAPTER 22 LINE DESIGN MANUAL IV. STRUCTURE LIMITATION GUYING CHARTS AND 127 127 General ........................................ .............................. Components of charts ............................... Preparation of charts 23 24 CHAPTER 25 V. ADDITIONAL Stresses Structure 26 in wood-pole spotting 266 266 required .................... ........................... (c) Determining ........................... 26% (d) (e) Insulator General ........................... .......................... 268 273 Kight-of-way Armor Corona uplift sideswing instructions and building clearance sag data (a) Sag tables (b) Sag and Transmission 274 282 284 ...................... ................................. 292 ................................. 292 292 300 insulator line 266 ..................... rods and vibration dampers ........................................ Stringing Bibliography 213 ........................ structures ................................. Data and equipment Process of spotting 28 31 DATA (a) (b) 27 29 30 127 offset equations data for inclined spans ........ ........................... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 APPENDIXES A. A method for computing transmission spans adjacent to a broken conductor B. Useful C. Conductor Index figures and and tables overhead line sags and .................. tensions 307 ............................ ground wire data tables in ............ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..~.... 339 441 479 CONTENTS 1 Conductor for and USHR Mathematical transpositions calculation form (metric) tension calculation form (U.S. Stress-strain furnished by tension parabolic and and and and curve catenary showing length line data of standard 13 I-I Typical sag template 15 Sag and tension origin 16 template Sag and form for (metric) form for on example on construction calcldation span tension Sag on inclined span-parameter of cxampk % method problem on 22 parameter Conductor 23 Conductor 24 problem Overhead 25 example Overhead 26 IIalf-sag sag Zmethod sag and (U.S. customary) tension calculation galloping sag and conductors 24 33 ...... 34 sag 36 problem on sag .............. 38 .............. ................ 39 44 using 47 span using .................. form (metric) ellipses on for calculation on for ,49 example ................ galloping example form 52 example ........... on galloping conductors (U.S. customary) ground wire sag and tension calculation form for .......... problem on galloping conductors (metric) ground wire sag and tension calculation form for problem tension form problem an inclined span ........................ 21 example 18 36 method method parameter %method (metric) Results of example problem on an inclirled on 18 ...................... span-equivalent span-average problem 15 16 17 22 inclined Sag on inclined Restllts as ................... form tension .......................... on I4 problems ............ curves (U.S. customary) percentage relationship between summary sag and 12 used example problems .................. customary) Sag of values ......................... ......................... calculation form for example ................................. (metric) tension calculation form for example (U.S. 11 .... .................................. Transmission Explanation template .......... customary) for an ACSR, 26/7 conductor ................. Association curves calculation 7 ........................ equations equations catenary tension span illustrating calculations calculation and parabolic Catenary curves and creep curves the Almninum Sag and Sag and creep tension 9 19 20 3 tension and criteria .................. sag and curve curve 18 design sag and Parabolic Catenary 17 for ratenary Standard 7 8 12 wire ......................... Standard in sag and 10 ground lines solution Stress-strain 6 overhead transmission vii conductors problem on for (U.S. galloping customary) conductors 53 54 .... ... 54 55 . .. VIII TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Page b'igrrw Profile 28 Sag and problem tension calculation form for ................................. (metric) broken conductor 29 Sag and tension broken conductor 30 31 of spans used for broken calculation form Curves for broken Sag template for 33 Conditions condition for problem problem conductor 60 61 tension for equilibrium before ...................................... (U.S. to broken and after 68 sohltion of unbalanced condition (metric) Graphical solution of unbalanced condition (U.S. 36 Nomenclature 37 tension Sag and 39 40 tension (U.S. customary) calculation Spans Graphical rnethod 43 conductor Reduction required of angle with structure concentrated height (metric) tension effect for insulator effect problem problem (U.S. 94 ........................ determining additional 100 length of .......... for concentrated load problem of protection against lightning patterns according tension the three types to of voltage 112 clearance pattern problem calculation form for ................................. clearance pattern problem form 113 for side view 114 of structure at conductor 121 ...................................... structure 49 Clearance pattern for a 30s ...................................... tangent structure so conductor Clearance pattern angle for 101 110 for pattern for a 30s tangent ...................................... Clearance conductor effect 90 insulator Clearance conductor 51 problem for 47 conductor problem 85 form calculation (U.S. customary) Assrmled dimensions 18 effect ....................................... Sag and elevation insulator .................................. 16 76 on sag and 78 insulator loads for Superimposed clearance stresses ............................................. Sag and for 75 ... 81 Tension-temperature curve for customary) ..................................... 42 4.5 form effect .......... customary) ................................. 41 44 determining insulator .............................. spans Tension-temperature curve for (metric) ....................................... Sag and 67 unbalanced Graphical 38 66 ..... conductor 35 (metric) ....... customary) due 34 in short tension calculation ....................................... 6.5 ............. (metric) problem reduced for 57 ........................... problem (U.S. customary) Curves for broken conductor 32 conductor .......... 27 a 30A with single 122 with duplex 123 structure with single 124 ...................................... pattern for a 30A angle ....................................... structure with duplex 125 CONTENTS 52 Condnctor sag and problem 53 on steel Condnctor iX tension calcnlation form for example strnctnre limitation chart (metric) tension calcnlation form for example structure limitation chart (U.S. sag and . . . . . . . . . 13s . . . 136 54 Center phase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . of a steel structure limitation chart (metric) . . . . . . . . . 137 5s angle Example 56 Example limitation chart . . 148 57 Conductor problem sag and tension on wood-structnre calculation limitation form chart for example (metric) . . . . . . . . . IS0 58 Conductor sag and tension on wood-structure calculation limitation form chart for example (U.S. customary) 59 Type HS Type HSB problem on steel of a steel problem 60 61 for type structure wood-pole 3OS steel structure (U.S. no line customary) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . wind force ground wire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . sag and tension calculation form for 158 example problem on wood-structure . . 160 Overhead grourld wire example problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . sketch of one pole of a type FIS wood-pole 161 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 wood-pole structure sketch of wood pole sag and limitation tension chart calculation on wood-structure chart 65 66 Single-line 67 structure with X-brace Force triangle showing 68 Force 69 limitation chart (U.S. Force triangle showing 70 Type 3A 71 Type 3AB 72 Type 3TA 73 HalfHalf- and and full-sag full-sag ellipses ellipses for for type type HS wood-pole HSB wood-pole Half- and full-sag ellipses for type 3AC structure sketch limitation chart triangle angle of top portion HS for (U.S. wood-pole . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . angle of bias lines for wood-structure 163 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 (metric) showing of a type (metric) form limitation customary) Single-line angle of bias for wood-strncture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . conductor force due to line 168 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 177 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 wood-pole customary) resnltant lines structure wood-pole structure wood-pole structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . wood-pole . . . . . . . . . 189 structure . . . . 191 193 F&sag ellipses for type 3TA 4267-mm (14-ft) pole spacing wood-pole structure, tangent, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Half-sag wood-pole 4267-mm Full-sag angle, ellipses for (14-ft) ellipses 11 278-mm type pole for 3TA spacing type (37-ft) 3TA pole structure, spacing structure, 187 tangent, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . wood-pole 180 structure structure 76 78 151 154 1ss compute Overhead strncture 147 157 63 74 75 with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 wood-pole customary) strnctnre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . showing values needed to Type 3AC Single-line 64 V-string 90° 194 line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 TRANSMISSION X LINE DESIGN MANUAL FigUIV 79 Page Half-sag ellipses angle, 80 81 Full-sag angle, ellipses 4267-mm Full-sag ellipses angle, 8230-mm 82 Half-sag ellipses angle, 4267-mm 83 Half-sag ellipses 84 angle, Full-sag 85 86 87 angle, Half-sag angle, 88 for 11 278-mm type (37-ft) for type (14-ft) for type (27-ft) for type (14-ft) for 3TA wood-pole structure, spacing .................. pole 3TA pole 90 O line 196 wood-pole structure, spacing .................... 60’ 3TA wood-pole 60° line pole spacing structure, 60° line .................... structure, 60° line 3TA pole line 197 structure, 198 .................... wood-pole spacing wood-pole 199 type 3TA 8230-mm ellipses (27-ft) for type pole 3TA spacing .................... wood-pole structure, 45 o line angle, Half-sag 6096-mm ellipses (20-ft) for type pole 3TA spacing .................... wood-pole structure, 45 o line angle, 6096-mm (20-ft) Full-sag ellipses pole spacing type 3TA wood-pole 4572-mm ellipses (IS-ft) for type pole 3TA spacing .................... wood-pole structure, 4572-mm (15-ft) pole spacing for 200 201 .................... structure, 202 30 O line 203 30° .................... limitation chart ...... chart (metric) ........ chart (U.S. customary) 89 Instructive Example example of a wood-structure of a wood-structure limitation 90 Example of a wood-structure 91 Additional 92 93 Example Example 94 95 Standard guying arrangement for type 3TA structure 29-m type HS 230-kV structure with class 2 Douglas 96 95-ft 97 (one X-brace) 29-m type HSB 98 poles (one X-brace) Free body diagram 99 Free data chart required limitation for the line wood-structure customary) (one chart chart crosstie body HS structures structures class example of pole 2) (one X-brace) .................................... Free body diagram of pole above plane 102 Free customary customary example of pole 2 Douglas fir 2 Douglas 209 211 poles fir 219 of inflection and to the example between 221 planes 101 diagram ......... fir poleg .......................... between with (U.S. class ............................... of pole above plane example 2) ..................................... 95-ft type HSB 230-kV structure body ....... 217 with 100 crosstie (metric) (U.S. 214 with ................................... 230-kV structure diagram 207 210 ................................... 230-kV structure (metric 206 . . 208 wood-pole wood-pole ..................................... X-brace) type for for 205 limitation ......................................... guying guying 204 of inflection (metric 223 class 2 Douglas fir poles 232 of inflection and to the 2) .................... planes of inflection 2) ., ............................. 234 (U.S. 235 CONTENTS 29-m type poles 104 105 HSB (two 230-kV 3) 107 (two X-braces) Free body diagram type crosstie HSR (U.S. 230-kV fir 243 customary 109 customary example Typical sag template 110 Typical plan and 111 superimposed Typical plan and diagram profile 114 Average and Sag and insulator example 3) between bundles poles (II) snow of inflection (U.S. 2.59 spotting conductor sag template 269 showing use of sag template 271 284 fair 287 weather with different ................................ form .................. voltages free running stringing 120 insulator offset Profile of spans 121 sag correction ................................... Stationing equation for common survey, assumption 122 Stationing equation 123 survey, Station assumption designations calculation form sheaves insulator operations offset and ............... for problem ............... on problem on ......... sag correction Sag and example (metric) for and sag correction for example problem example (U.S. customary) on insulator offset 293 297 298 line common point on a transmission No. 2 ........................... when station back is greater than line 1 Station back designations point ........................... 301 for when station ......................................... 297 and on a transmission No. ... 288 290 293 sag 301 station ahead ......................................... 124 267 ...... structures .......................... 119 tension 2S7 .................... with loss under for different when using and to the waves in a conductor (A) fair weather, (B) rainfall, calculation offset and ............... required for calculating data during stringing tension of inflection planes drawing of corona Corona loss curves Conductor tensions Dimensions correction fir .............................. Schematic of vibration Corona loss curves for conductor 1 Douglas 255 plane ................................... profile drawing 113 valrles class 3) .............................. (plastic) used for uplift hoarfrost, with above of pole in determining (C) 247 structure of pole Free body 24.5 .................................. 108 118 1 Douglas ..................................... 95-ft 116 117 class body diagram of pole above plane of inflection and to the crosstie (metric example 3) .......................... Free body diagram of pole between planes of inflection (metric 106 115 with .............................. Free example 112 structure X-braces) xi 302 ahead is greater than stat&n 302 TRANSMISSION xii NESC Functions P curve conductor P curve conductor 6 H curve conductor 7 11 curve conductor .................. loading constants (K) ......................... sag template of % ................................... 27 37 41 for computations for example problem ................................ (metric) computations example problem .......................... customary) (U.S. computations for computations (U.S. example problem .......................... customary) No. l-broken I he computations for example ................................ for No. 2-unbalanced example problem .......................... No. 2-unbalanced 11 P curve full-load computations condition 13 H curve computations 14 full-load II curve condition computations no-load conditiou 15 H 16 no-load Insulation conditiou selection 17 Insulatiou selection 18 Insulation Minimum curve (grade computations 69 No. 2-unbhanced example problem .......................... No. 2-unbalanced for example problem .......................... (metric) No. 2-unbalanced problem No. .................... 2-unbalanced No. 2-unbalanced problem No. .................... 2-unbalanced customary) H 69 problem for 12 64 problem 10 (U.S. 63 for condition (U.S. customary) P curve computations for example ................................ condition (metric) condition 63 l-broken 9 computations l-broken No. computations (metric) curve No. ................................ Line data condition data l-broken problem (metric) example No. 62 for 8 I9 MANUAL conductor Calculations 5 LINE DESIGN for example 70 70 71 (U.S. customary) for example problem ........................... (metric) for example 72 73 74 107 (U.S. customary) for 34s kV ........................ ........................ for 230 kV 108 20 Conductor clearance surface-wood-pole to pole ground wire or crossarm ....................... construction 21 Angular of suspension 22 USBK Minimurn 23 109 ........................ selection for 115 kV factors of safety for wood-pole construction R) ....................................... limitations wood-pole structures factors of safety for ...................................... California Conductor clearance surface-wood-pole insulator swing for 129 129 standard 129 .......................... wood-pole construction to pole ground wire or crossarm .............. construction in California in 131 131 . .. CONTENTS 21- Stttntttary of loads lertgths 2s 26 and Stttntttary lengths Stttnrttary of loads and Sttrntnary Minimum NESC 29 Mirtirttttrtt NESC irt structure low-point of loads lengths 28 tttetnbers distartces and in slrrtctttre for for 242 3) . . . . . . . . . . 254 spatt light, clearartce rttedittrn, and to buildings-USBR heavy loading . . . 266 startdard for . . . . . . . . . . . 275 cxatttple horizontal clearance to buildings-USBR and heavy loading (rttetric) light, tnedittrn, horizontal standard (U.S. 2) span various customary 231 . . . various exarttple tttetnbers (U.S. span 2) . . . . . . . . . . for various span cttstorttary exatnple (metric. distartces various exarttple rnerttbers distartces low-point for (rttctric of loads iii structure rttetttbers artd low-point distartcrs (U.S. lengths 27 itt structure low-point x111 crtstorttary) 3) for . . . . 275 30 Right-of-way values-NESC light . . . . . . . . . . . , 276 31 32 Right-of-way Right-of-way values-NESC values-NE%: light loading (U.S. crtstotttary) . . . . , rnedittrn loadirtg (metric.) . . . . . . . . . 277 278 33 Right-of-way values-NESC ntedirtrtt . . . 279 34 35 Right-of-way Right-of-way values-NESC values-NE%: heavy heavy (metric) . . . . . . . . . . . (U.S. rttstotnary) . . . . 280 36 Data frottt correctiott 37 Data 1% I problettt (metric) front correction example example (U.S. loading (metric) loading loadirtg loading ott insulator (U.S. offset cuslorttary) and . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . problettt crtstornary) 281 sag 299 on insulator offset artd sag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340 341 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342 township showing sectiort rtttrttbering lartd section showing corner and l/l6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-2 Typical Typical 13-3 Azirttitth H-4 I~eveloprttertt of forttirtla for rnaxirnttrrt rtiorttertt of resistance ort wood poles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343 13-s Grottnd 344 chart resistivity in the Urtited States desigrtatiotts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TRANSMISSION xiv LINE DESIGN TABLES IN MANUAL APPENDIXES Pa&? Table B-l Maximum ground B-2 moment line-USBR of resistance standard for pole circumferences ......................... at moment of resistance for pole circumferences .......................... at Maximum ground line-ANSI standard B-3 B-4 Pole circumferences for Douglas fir Pole circumferences for western red B-5 Permanent set values for Alumoweld B-6 Permanent set values for steel B-7 Flashover characteristics B-9 Flashover Relative B-10 Barometric B-l 1 B-13 B-14 Pressure Permanent c-2 (metric) Permanent (U.S. c-3 c-4 c-5 Conductor Conductor Conductor C-6 Conductor medium, medium, pine 385 ............... strand .................... strand of suspension insulator 351 419 420 strings and air 424 Conductor sag-tension C-l southern yellow ................ cedar .......................... values of air gaps ............... air density and barometric pressure .................... pressure versus elevation B-12 Equivalent Selected and 423 Mass per unit species used B-15 348 ... ........................................ gaps.. B-8 345 volume and relative mass .............................. for poles temperature computations area due set, and and and and and and 427 to wind and for final normal 428 velocity data for standard electrical ........................ conversions set, creep, and initial ....................................... customary) of wood coefficients of expansion ........................... on a projected metric SI-metric density 426 426 ........... 429 ...... conductors 431 moduhts values 442 creep, and initial and ................................. final overhead overhead overhead .......... data (metric) data (U.S. customary) values for NESC light, .................... heavy loading overhead heavy ground ground ground loading wire wire wire (metric) ground (U.S. 430 wire values customary) modulus for values NESC ............. 452 462 .... 466 470 light, 474 (<Chapter I BASIC DATA 1. Field necessary Data.-Before to gather construction, establishment design certain requirements preliminary for a transmission information prior line can be formulated, to establishing and the desired conductor and overhead ground wire of the voltage on major transmission lines, the number the sizes and and type it is voltage, type of types. Usually, of lines required the in a given area, and the type of construction to be used depends on a comprehensive system study. This study would include the size and location of generators and loads, and the possibility of using existing transmission facilities. After a system study has established the required voltages and the end points of the transmission and lines, to prepare a. Operating b. Average the following designs: voltage and peak information is required of the line. loads to be transmitted over the to establish line, or the the peak details load of construction and estimated load factor. c. per Value in mills per kilowatt hour of the month or year of capacity to be served. d. A summary of local climatic (1) Maximum and minimum (2) (3) e. and muskeg. A map showing substations. g. The The length velocities with of ice expected general route navigation from a., b., and is used mainly specifications clearance c., is used to establish prepare h. Whether i. Date delivery of power is required. Delivery points for Government-furnished i material required k. Key map, 1. Drill logs line and of the To the will and a summary designs, the sheets, of footing and line, for, to determine the required following the value special 1 river most and lake economic and per kilowatt and drawings. for tower and agents, intermediate crossings. conductor size. The requirements is required: forces: the crossing corrosive structural information or Governrnent steel or other of terminal additional materials, conditions alkali mechanical by contract and sand, locations requirements the be constructed at each point. plan and profile and and without ice. on the conductors. smoke or fog atmospheres. that is, the presence of rock, of, and information other information for the line. the to be transmitted, conditions including: temperatures. (4) Presence of corrosive A summary of soil conditions, swamps, f. Maximmn wind Radial thickness energy proportion lines or special of each steel item structures. of TRANSMISSION 2 2. Safety National Codes.-The Standards NESC Institute), supply and communication where it is not certain safety rules not provide The from code specifies structures, circuits, which the However, design when also be taken those into Loading the latest by than Many states states recognize lines in California been those and prescribed NESC code also be based line, may general area. cover state the force for of railroads, weather the The rules important to the public. supporting thoroughfares, geographic or heavy loading and climatic the use of heavier that construct and general areas in which more and conductors the medium, We of NESC. for crossings local indicate of the those open important lines. specifies on light, of electric it is very work loadings requirements conditions to line (American over of these intended design The shall for the have as the should so noted. in a code One climbing general special standard be designed area rules in which regarding for transmission in accordance California Public It is imperative have clearances areas loading in conditions. conditions lines the line electrical should conditions and is being than designed. construction; distribution Utilities Commission however, circuits. Rules for Overhead Electric with 3. used Cost by to make the most Transmission Line Construction, [ 11.’ line, construction. They costs making types of construction on past and also are also system A final Engineers the line, is prepared cost in brackets general Preliminary of various when certain latest refer to items state at least a minimum allowable and that often types to determine used one Ensure of cost are the to compare of line that to assure is too that code and NESC all applicable design overlooked, all structures in which estimates used data in the and Bibliography. made, the amount of funds of construction the economy This on current are to determine the construction. are to be determined. bid be taken applicable that cost For and example, feasibility is especially Cost Estimate, based on the cost for each construction specification. and of the should estimates types studies editions Care have factors will be met. is the the safe proper climbing codes. Estimates.-Two estimate. transmission the lines. important factors of safety, for linemen on structures. prescribed engineers’ that of transmission been of the most clearance ’ Numbers maintenance are ANSI are constructed by fencing, transmission transmission that municipalities for all designs based lines by maintenance of the example problems in this manual were developed using the Sixth Edition of NESC [2]; most of the problems use the current 1977 Edition [3]. Problems using the old Sixth Edition be used compare special lines for General Order No. 95 of the have rather to the circuits. as local NESC issued and conditions and conductor and overhead ground wire tensions shall be in accordance with edition of NESC with exceptions as shown on figure 1 or by specific heavier loading conditions Some however, and a particular account prescribed Code), installation public and of construction, communication designing the transmission construction but grades of transmission Safety for the general of safety requirements, and MANUAL unless the regulations with NESC constructed are more stringent than standpoint clearances, strength power from specifications, the rules overhead in the in accordance line is being detailed requirements them be observed Electrical safety Because to isolate our transmission lines particular transmission do (National contains lines. possible LINE DESIGN prices a preliminary economic to be requested these comparisons would at voltages as quoted a final voltages and of 230 kV of a budget routes, of all items involved Both the preliminary of materials in the on alternate of different true and feasibility to be used alternate and in the construction and final estimates by for and manufacturers. above. of are CHAPTER CONDUCTOR AN0 OGW FOR “SGN FULL LO.9 Fii LCunductor I CATENARY DESIGN TNAUSYISSION LINES CONDUCTOR NO LOAD and overhead From Dwg. 40-D-5169. I-BASIC ground I NO LOAD I 1 wire’catenary DATA CRITERIA O”ER”El0 FULL LOAD I GROUND WIRE NO LOAD I “9 design criteria for USBR transmission lines. 104-D-1046. TRANSMISSION 4 4. Selection of Type a transmission line, to be used, desired or necessary in the according to structures in a transmission and methods structures. function: lines, special are given All 40-D- original structures. to design conductor heights Brief data for specific are on file are supplied Since the structure Design These special such transmission Bureau’s Denver units associated with on the basic types wood-pole as standard three classes of the hardware, drawings All standard for general design limitation and are given 104-D- office, and reproducible various field offices. of structures of materials into structures, design on are to be used for all transmission designs. and loading conditions for transmission and types are varied to maintain efficient discussions availability 80 to 90 percent as sag templates, lines in the the type are divided Usually, drawings structural drawings, of conductors and Standard and established ratings. to be used size and line (3) tension. class. of construction line, of construction, tangent require type of the in a transmission and designed voltage conditions developed drawings been for various numbers. are usually drawings and where (2) angle, the voltage costs used are of the have lines the lengths, structures line of installation except span The MANUAL en selecting to consider (1) tangent, use on transmission tables, of Construction.-Wh it is necessary to be used LINE DESIGN charts, or project prints drawings and sag numbers. of applicable lines are often different, span lengths and economical use of the standard are presented in the following paragraphs. (a) Single Wood-Pole Structures .-The Bureau usually uses single wood-pole structures for voltages from 2.3 through 46 kV. In addition, where right-of-way is severely restricted, it is sometimes necessary to use single wood-pole construction for 69- and 115-kV 1ines. For lines up to and including 69 kV, two conductors, types of single-pole structures are designated flattop and are used conductors triangular are supported by a single crossarm and are arranged in the same horizontal plane. In the type, the middle conductor is supported at the top of the pole and the two outside conductors are supported by a crossarm below both single-pole and H-frame construction. construction is used; however, crossarm are used. For 115-kV types of single-pole, which, with reference In the flattop type triangular. the For top of the pole. Pin-type insulators 69-kV lines, a type of single-pole suspension insulators with two lines, a single wishbone-type single-circuit structures and tangent, single crossarm small line angle, double to the arrangement of the of construction, the three their conductors structure nomenclature suspended is used. The are used triangular from the common, = = suspension, suspension, SA SAT = = vertical conductor attachment suspension, medium line angle (up to 600), tension, large line angle (60 ’ to 90 ’ ), vertical conductor attachment ST STR = = tension, medium line angle (0’ to 60 O), vertical suspension, transposition structure crossarm H-Frame tangent be used 230-kV structure which has a double-plank crossarm. Occasionally, for lower voltages where long spans cannot be avoided; lines. The use of X-braces between the poles is standard the use of longer Wood-Pole Structures .-The conductor (b) voltages 69 through spans 161 kV. and heavier The Bureau usually H-frame designation conductors, upper basic are: SS SD from in and to support attachment uses H-frame, wood-pole structures for originates from the appearance of the this type of construction must however, it is sometimes used for on H-frame structures to permit the structures under transverse loading. The use of wood poles longer than 27 m (90 ft) is not recommended, except for very special cases, because they are not economical and are difficult to obtain. For normal wood-pole construction, it is preferred that the majority of poles on lines with overhead ground wires should not exceed 19.8 m CHAPTER (65 ft) in length; and on lines 18.3 m (60 ft). Although we normally arise (other than without and to permit the substation. The basic to obtain reduced types HS 3AC 3A and high (c) 161 kV. Steel clearance for on conductors = two-pole, suspension, = three-pole, suspension, = three-pole, suspension, = three-pole, tension, and H-frame are also many were transmission line types: (1) tangent, years used: steel used for structures an SAL-type climatic loading. In 1975, the the voltage; system steel designate the voltages under long spans loadings. is used special type to their system Medium D = Double Heavy Transposition a 2 indicates 230 kV. of the number and The = Suspension X = Heavier suspension with ST = Heavier suspension type, A = phase dead-ended Angle (insulators in suspension) T = Tension Y D = = Tension with large line Dead end with variable R = Transposition small to for second is now specific digit such used is a design as crossings spans The first designator designers to immediately letters are added to the letters designed as a basic into in three line. For identifying structure loadings. above for light designation digit for indicates for a particular identify two-digit the basic number to structure: S with angle suspension, voltages approach in which = = Circuit all and are designed function in the = voltage spans are: for for H TR a two-digit approach conditions are required, by a nomenclature system permits the steel structure for any given line. The following function construction M and For angle Tension Angle a specific towers. angle line T = A = for situations crossarm Light was changed, exceed angle line a single-circuit, to use steel nomenclature = was not occasional in the L designed This used their double-plank medium designated wires Suspension = for example, series of towers. set of structures were structure a set of structures ground and line 0 ’ to 90 ’ lower it is necessary should 183 m (600 ft) of a substation; therefore, to permit large line angles, where required, overhead small of poles up to 161 kV, structures are usually of the self-supporting (2) an gl e, and (3) dead end, according S Thus, all lines where tangent, Steel Structures .- Normally, 5 the majority construction over navigable streams where high clearance and substations and switchyards, and for extra-heavy Steel general wires, for crossings) for structures DATA to guy any structure within are used in these locations tensions Single-Circuit ground structures of structures 3AB 3TA overhead use wood-pole example, it is our policy not self-supporting steel structures I-BASIC line small line no line angle (0’ angle angle to 5 “) (O’to 5O) capability, capability angle (5’ to 30 “) capability line angle capability capability outside phases in suspension, center 6 TRANSMISSION Thus, a type 30s structure The limitations in the conductors would of a given and LINE DESIGN be a 345kV suspension set of structures overhead ground wires, MANUAL structure will depend and the with upon a design conductor loading area designation size, where of zero. maximum the structures may be used tension are to be used. Double-Circuit (d) Steel Structures necessary to place two cost of two lines along are arranged expected, vertically the on one conductors loading are expected, contact between may (e) of the steel structure. be located the conductors. directly to offset Contact In areas above the center can be caused structures right-of-way, structures, where one another; conductor lines for Special which Conditions and however, by galloping ice loading are where and the conductors snow possibility or uneven .-Sp ecial conditions frequently arise in the use of special structures. Special structures the not ice of any snow and to use steel Transpositions .- To maintain structures to obtain balanced sufficient conditions phases of a transmission line, at least one terminals. However, it has been determined designing of are required a higher voltage line, (2) a branch and (4) long spans, such as those require higher than normal structures to maintain navigational conductors. Where navigational clearances over rivers or lakes necessary clearances are required, height. of reactance and capacitance on the line of uniform configuration three transposition barrel should be placed between major that for less than 161 km (100 mi) between terminals, the unbalance is not sufficient to affect the operation of the transmission line or the protective barrel, as used by the Bureau of Reclamation, refers to a section of a three-phase The term transmission it is For example, if the three conductors are located directly above one one of the lower conductors may drop its ice and spring up into the steel structures are constructed in the same general types as the necessitate for a river or lake crossing, or wider spacings between (f) snow to minimize where: (1) a lower voltage line is carried on the same structure below line takes off from a main line, (3) switches are required in a line, it is usually where or if it is desired to reduce the the conductors for each circuit structures. Structures transmission side it is desirable ice loading on the conductors. another and covered with ice, conductor above. Double-circuit single-circuit .-Double-circuit transmission lines on a restricted the same route. On double-circuit that is divided length by two transpositions arranged so that each one-third the length of the section. Specific instructions the design instructions for each transmission line. into conductor regarding three parts of approximately occupies each transpositions relays. power equal phase position for should be given in The distances between conductors in a transposition must be studied to determine if adequate minimum electrical clearances will be obtained in a given case. If possible, it is helpful to set up model of the transposition. A model will give good results and will also present the whole problem in perspective. A problem thorough analysis. A model must be made to scale. area in a transposition eliminates the possibility A large to hold the dowels in the desired an inexpensive way of duplicating conductors, between conductors Another method that may sheet of plywood may be difficult to locate of selecting the wrong area. for a base, dowels to support correctly The model, the without a of course, conductors, locations, and adequate string to represent the conductors various questionable line situations ‘such as clearances and structures, or between conductors and guys. be used geometry to the problem. This method made and the problem areas determined. transposition problems. to determine should The be used formulas these clearances is by applying a screws provide between descriptive after an analysis of the whole system derived on figure 2 may be applied has been to many CHAPTER I-BASIC DATA Dv v -=- First v= kS$=kD, dD* dk =-2D,*+2k(Dv D” -=S Solution S kS SHkS derivative 7 of D* with ‘+ respect to k: DH2) of differential equation: 2 ti=(S-kS@ =D,(I-k) DH D2=DH2-2D,* (h2)* D,* + D,* D= ~kDv)2+[DH(I-k)]2 D*= + OH2 -2kD,‘+k*D,* Dv2+DH4 D”* D*= D,* k2(Dv2+ For structures at different ,/(Span)'+ (difference 13). where rough Special Long-Span terrain, it is often solution Construction .-To necessary 5. Normal, span lengths Ruling, and Effective obtainable by using take to use spans consideration. To obtain the required spacing may be used on single wood-pole structures, structures. For steel construction, the structures the -2DH4+DH4 + D,.,’ conductors e on crossarm) is the slope angle. in elevation)* Figure S.-Mathematical (g) +D,*) elevations: spacing) (-Ices Span D,= V v D,*) Remains the same (spacing between D,= (Vertical 2 (D D,*)~ (Dv *+ D,‘) D* = D,2 -2kDH2+ D, (D,*+ OH2 (Dv2+DH2)-2DH4+DH4 D*= k* D,* + (D, - kD,)* D2=k2Dy2 + for transpositions. advantage longer 104-D-1047. of topographic than are normal conditions for- the in areas voltage under between conductors for long spans, longer crossarms and greater pole spacing may be used on H-frame can be designed for any required conductor spacing. Spans.-Th e normal span is used to determine and compare different structure heights. The normal span may be defined of 8 TRANSMISSION as the maximum level span ground. seldom can The level, attainable with usefulness and the be calculated a given of the actual spans the following from LINE DESIGN structure normal will span vary MANUAL height and a given is limited because considerably from conductor the the clearance transmission normal above line span. The profile normal is span formula: Normal span in meters (feet) = where: P = height of conductor L = conductor clearance C = ruling D = conductor ruling The changes spans the span, sag for used and preparing n spans having and lengths length template, ruling which level span be defined in temperature span for above the ground, normal span is to be calculated, m (ft) m (ft) m (ft) span may of varying support as that span will most loading, between as a basis the C, m (ft) dead ends. nearly agree tables. The the with common the in the average sags and ruling span dead tension definition the conductor L 1, L 2, Ls... L, between of lengths in which A more for calculating stringing length for ends tension is that tensions, any may conductor, under in a series the ruling constructing section from is the of transmission be calculated of span the sag line following equation: L,3 Ruling span = To use this is used as a basis structures the equation, lengths the structure the line entire exceptionally rough tensions due to variations in sections In isolated the ruling a structure. If the point of the the conductor. the other, support supports conductor In this the low that spans, is made used for point portion the case, with the of the of the the middle span conductor conductor by the should usually and short spans cannot be avoided a longer or shorter a change ruling spans tensions of the end should for of be used. because same sections canyons with because occurs by the between each to the the conductor of a span and be closer between vary of be selected span span do not result strength the amounts of different which are dead-ended which is supported by elevation, the span. portion span ruling the so that span can be estimated in ruling or over actual is equal will line span at each of the is limited span before a transmission the ruling crossings to the length ruling be estimated for ruling where as river conductor effective span Unbalanced equal must structures the One different such span because Therefore, long point to designate is at the case, is the at the and loading. long span span is the term low this of line in temperature end, then When be dead-ended spans. Effecthe will profile. must where However, ruling maximum are located. sections +...L, be known. the The + .. . Ln3 +L, to locate requirements. structures for certain must practice as possible. the +L, sag template, good clearance before L, locations the It is always except conductor horizontal than calculating and conductor accuracy at each structure are as uniform sufficient ruling for are located. span The the i- L,3 + L,3 are at the structure actual span. to the lower structure will support If one support and same the one-half support and low each point. is higher structure In effect, of CHAPTER considering the the equivalent low point conductor load of a level of the span conductor. To determine on one equal This the total spans; 6. Selection to consider voltage for minimum depends of the it without has assumed no-load conditions. the sag and initially. When values, ru 1’m g s p an, the initial (8.5 ft), and Bureau, for strength (3954 to 3700 The use of either point the short that shorter structures by The electrical the conductor with conductor losses studies to twice it is necessary on the line, corona conductor cost, and is determined of designs type or design amount of conductor before instructions. of corona loss; Corona loss surface. of 13 832 economical The The wind, and mm (9.53 N (3110 lb) a t mimts enough and using short spans or very the tension sag with small For enough some small are required. structures can standard height. The on a line be supported structures Section may 15 describes considerations. conductivity to a temperature of the conductor that would must cause be high annealing enough to carry and consequent N no ice and no wind. structures to structure is 17 580 the sag to increase conductor that N/m the immediate structures. of the are of 4.3782 and the size conductor permissible in addition tall cost the ultimate conditions lb), cause mm by of the loading 18 ’ C with high were be 2594 N (7500 sag of the increases to use a larger maximum the they as determined will excessively will a constant ft), assume on a 213.4-m percent heavy of 33 362 in the conductor usually considerations NESC tension is 2906 without either condition, loading less than no wind is 33-l/3 factor be high that more load no wind spans limiting the initial it will conductor no ice and loading for maximum being 24/7 to after under is unloaded, tension conditions transverse to a full must The maximum strength as specified the ice loads conditions ultimate ACSR, and urlder conductor and no load. (4-lb/ft2) wind, wind no-load of the the the strength specified (0 OF) with lb). initial, to carry kcmil), loading the creep spans. and percent (477 heavy structures longer line, conductivity, by the permissible When N (4429 or tall conductor of power system under 18 ‘C no ice and sag is so great spans galloping galloping 0.19-kPa long from greater mm2 40 “F) installation, it becomes limited the NESC conductor for a transmission electrical by ice and sag being a 242 19 700 use of reasonably size conductors, the a tension structure structure. of the ultimate stretched. be ft) with of the is loaded the conductor after (12.14 the (3) 33-l/3 sag at minus (0 ’ F) with years strength to permit sag, and under ice, loading 18 ‘C Ten mm will radial After lb). strength 40 OC (minus (l/2-in) lb/ft). sag at minus the tension conductor at minus 13-mm (0.30 the this is equal be sufficient (1) 50 p ercent with (700-ft) must ultimate if we string to consider given any of the for preparation sea level, is permanently example, it is necessary below. the conductor conductor tension For its final selected designers conductor of the the conductor. above exceeding: and for vahte determined and structure span. the sum of the adjacent side is usually altitude of 46 kV one-half to one-half of the conductor, line the effective supports is equal the conductor is usually structure between the spans on either in the each distance to be transmitted, used line voltage, (2) 25 percent conditions, final materials strength upon conductor load strength of conductor voltages mechanical conditions, line, the is called effective spans only, length selecting to the transmission on the for be imposed adjacent of the a transmission diameter is negligible The of the of the is assigned which of the points mechanical availability The The voltage interference, the the line sum low 9 by any one structure, supported of Conductors.-When the and radio and or the to twice supported The DATA structure span length effective between in length conductor on each side of a structure. distance of the hypothetical the spans the side I-BASIC the load reduction without in the heating strength to on be TRANSMISSION 10 of the conductor voltage drop which, in the line use of reactors, transmitted over conductor between the line in greater be limited to about synchronous Usually, size than available results and the line. value transmission must capacitors, a larger various in turn, LINE DESIGN sag and reduced of power to control to limit heating in the conductor and the will result. such that types of conductors minimum above this the and voltage annual cost as well as determining fixed (reactive volt line is sufficient drop. A balance charges on Comparison the most the ground. The can be controlled vars losses in a transmission is required of losses clearances * however, 10 percent, condensers the value MANUAL must to justify must the by the amperes) be obtained investment be made economical in the between the size of any one type of conductor. Since 1945, has proved 1945, that copper (aluminum conductor, economical than other were that copper prices aluminum 90 percent ACSR more such conductors are now of distribution It is occasionally being steel several such conductor specified conductor, as copper was more for nearly because of its lower or Copperweld-copper. economical all new than ACSR. transmission lines, price, Prior Records and to show for about lines. necessary to consider the availability it may be necessary to complete the transmission economical conductor. Once the route and length of a transmission conductor type and size selected to carry safely power, reinforced) conductors, mechanical considerations line of the different in a short or distribution and economically remain which may time types of conductors without regard because to the most line have been determined, and a the system voltage, current, and influence the choice of conductor and will definitely influence the installation methods. The designer must consider such factors as structure and ground clearances. Thus, the heights and locations, span lengths, conductor sags and tensions, designer must have detailed knowledge of conductor sag and tension as a function of span length, temperature, and weight loading. Most of this information is supplied by conductor manufacturers in the form of tables and graphs; however, the designer will usually have to prepare additional aids such as forms, charts, diagrams, and templates, that are related to a specific installation. Figures 3 and .4 show a standard form that USBR designers use for conductor calculations. This form is a Pa. [6]. Figure 3 shows metric variation of a form designed by the Copperweld Steel Co. of Glassport, calculations calculations 12, chapter 7. for the conductor previously mentioned, for the same conductor. A detailed description II. and figure 4 shows the U.S. customary of this calculation form is given in section Stress-Strain calculations Curves.-Most of the mechanical properties required are determined by tensile testing. Wires used in the manufacture conductors are tested in full section. The loads stresses based on an area of the original section: determined in a tension for sag and tension of transmission line test are reported as unit Load Stress = Area Elongation elongation is measured is then determined as the increase in length of a gage-marked as (Final Length) - (Original Length) (Original Length) length on a test specimen. The CHAPTER DCm-578 I-BASIC 11 DATA (3-78) :“I’N’:“L’ SAGCALCULATIONS LOADING j T5!cp-\ LMST~ESSED LENGTH i /3InIn Ice 0. 9/~~kP=Wl~(W”‘)~-/8.0, Permanent No Ice. Set 6 creep NO Wmd ---.a--InIn 0.d!.#vsakPa Permanent (W’) 1 -18 1 -1 15.5 12 __ 49 lo. 0. 0.000 15 999 O.RUfl 0,949 (w-y (W’) mm 1.3 kPa WwJ (W”‘) Permanent set 6 creep - 5 I 110 ,6o6!o.uoo I 096 16 2594 i ! 114 /fJ , OO/ I/. ouu ! mm ICO Set S Crew 91) ,a/ I O”$ I m O,/Ull u.u/-? 62: 1 I : I 2.906 , I I /9/j I I I /7 590 P.5 I I 13 833 -, k&d I I I m /Q/ I 003 /aY oofw , Qg d n, /383 &/J/7 34 -7700 / I / /9// I I I I I / 49 , I 1 I I I SPANLENGTH(S) m I 1 j-18 1 I I 1 49 1 I I I I I I I I I I I SPANLENGTH(S) I I I m I I I I 15.5 32 40 .- I L SPANLENGTH(S) , I I , m / 1 , I I I I I -18 -1 I I 15.5 32 j I I I 49 I/J I I j I , 700 &&j /. 115.5 *I kPa Wind (W”‘) Set 6 Crew NO Wind (WY I!?.? 462 .3 L I I 999 _ ! NO Ice. NO Wind (W’) NO Ice. ! 5,P45 I 4 I 1 1 -1.9 -1 Permanent lo.nK7 I I mm,ca Permanent 0.0971 4693 SPANLENGTWS)H(S) set 6 Creep NO Wind L TENSION,N 1 /Q/ 15.5 -18 -t NO Ice, m5- SW,N 99 I 0 (W’) kPa Wl”d 0./7-5210.02, I I Ice Permanent 7 1 m 3L SPANLENGTH(S) 2’3. 32 49 Nmm /o/ j I NO Wmd 999 /o/ ~U.OQU 393 SAG,mm SIG FLCTOR Y I ’ 1 -18 -1 NO Ice. 499 I ice , Wind cw”%-/g Set ?!6 SPANLENGTH(S)213. 1 Figure 3.4tandard I sag and tension calculation fornl (tnetric). TRANSMISSION 12 DC-576 LINE DESIGN MANUAL (S-76) ;;L;FL CONDUCTOR ~77h’d -.. I Code Name Weight Breakutg Diameter Load &&!6 Tensat inch Initial.-&OF Final, Computed &%,&!&?-lb -1/oF Loaded, *F *OF by - No Wind X //300 lb Area 2 % ti lb Temp. 18 % &$&lb (AI d Coeff. Modulus. in2 of Linear (E) Final 0.000 o/&~ (W’) No Ice. NO Wind (WY per “F SPAN LENGTH(S) Ice. Wind(W”‘) 6 creep InitialAE FEET 0 30 No Ice. No Wind (W’) 60 90 -Inch Pemlanent SPAN LENGTH(S) Ice. Ib/ft2 Wind(W”‘1 set h creep FEET 0 30 NO Ice. No Wind (W’) 60 90 120 Figure 4.-Standard sag and tension calculation FinaljD. lnltial Exp.: (W’) No Wind set _25- Date Ice. -Inch -Ib/ft2 Permanent Factors: /7alb Limltatlons: Final. No LOADING h/ecrv - Rated No Ice. .h?dR 24 SAGCALCULATIONS form (U.S. customary). AE ‘/ u 53x g,epLx 4 L 106 lb/in2 106 lb/in2 24 :i CHAPTER I-BASIC DATA 13 Stress-strain curves are prepared from the data obtained from these tests. As the test specimen is slowly loaded, readings of elongation are made so that the initial curve may be plotted. As the specimen is unloaded, elongation readings are again taken so that the fin& curve may be plotted. A typical, stress-strain curve for a wire has a straight line segment, which in the deformation is proportional to the applied load. The unit stress (load divided by original area) is proportional to the unit strain (deformation divided by original gage length). The numerical value of this ratio (stress/strain), usually expressed in gigapascals (pounds per square inch), is the modulus of elasticity. For an ACSR conductor, there is no straight line segment on the initial curve, so a straight line average of the portion of the curve under use is used for determination of the modulus of elasticity. The final curve is always a straight line and has the same slope regardless of the maximum load applied, provided the yield strength is not exceeded. The slope of this line is the final modulus of the conductor. Other characteristics of the test specimen may be determined from the stress-strain test. The proportionul limitis the stress value at which the deformation ceases to be proportional to the applied load. The maximum stress which can be applied without causing permanent deformation upon release of the load is the elastic limit. The yield strength is the stress at which the deformation ceases to be proportional to the applied load by a specified percent of elongation (usually 0.2 percent). Ultimate tensile strength is the maximum tensile stress which a material is capable of sustaining. Tensile strength is calculated from the maximum load during a tension test which is carried to rupture with the original cross-sectional area of the specimen. All metals have lower ultimate strength values when subjected to a fluctuating stress. The amount of decrease will depend upon the range of the fluctuating stress and the number of repetitions. Alcoa (Aluminum Co. of America) states [7] that research and experience in transmission line design indicates that if the limits of variation in tensile stress are approximately 10 percent, the maximum value of the fluctuating stress necessary to produce fracture will be approximately 70 percent of the ultimate strength. This stress is referred to as the working limit. Creep is the plastic deformation that occurs in metal at stresses below its yield strength. Metal that is stressed below the yield point will normally return to its original shape and size when unloaded because of its elasticity. However, if the metal is held under stress for a long period of time, permanent deformation will occur. This deformation is in addition to the expected increase in length resulting from the stress-strain characteristics of the metal. Figure 5 shows a stress-strain curve that illustrates the origin of values used in conductor sag and tension calculations for transmission lines. An explanation of figure 5 is: l ADFG represents the initial loading curve plotted from test data taken during the loading of a specimen in a stress-strain test. l The average slope of curve AF has been extended and labeled “Average slope of initial from zero to full load.” The slope of this line is used for the initial modulus in calculations. The value in this example is 40 GPa (5.8 x lo6 lb/in2). l CGis the final loading curve plotted from test data during the unloading on the test specimen. The slope of this line is the final modulus. l The conductor represented by the curves is to have a maximum stress of 69-MPa (10 000 lb/in2) under full load conditions. l BFis drawn parallel to the final curve CG and between the points for full load and zero load. l AB is the permanent elongation and is called the permanent set l The lo-year creep line is drawn from previously computed values. The creep value DEis read horizontally between a point on the initial curve and a point on the creep curve at the same stress value. TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 14 - 30 000 200 175 2s 000 150 I 20000 / N .-E 125 2 5 2 - IS 000 100 / 68 e: c” cn -Full 10000 v; c I v) 75 SO I 5 000 D 0 A/ i b es -Creep - 0.4 0.5 0 0.6 -c c Permanent Set UNIT Fii S.-Stress-strain 104-D-1048. STRAIN, and creep curves illustrating percent origin elongation of values used in sag and tension calculations. DE represents the creep value over a lo-year period. We assume that the average tension over a period of 10 years will he at 15.5 ’ C (60 o F) un d er no load conditions. limits conductor stress to 18 percent of the ultimate strength at these conditions. values used for our calculations reflect all of these conditions. Figure 6 shows stress-strain and creep curves for an ACSR, 26/7 (26 aluminum strands strands) conductor as furnished by the Aluminum Association. l conductor The USBR The creep and 7 steel 8. The Parabola and the Catenary.-Two curves, the parabola and the catenary, are generally used in the calculations for conductor sags on transmission lines. The parabola, an approximate curve, is often used because it simplifies the calculations. When a wire or cable is assumed to conform to the curve of the parabola, the mass of the wire or cable is.assumed to he uniformly distributed along its horizontal projection (the horizontal span length). For the parabolic solution, it is safe to assume that the sag will vary as the square of the span length for spans that are at least double the length of the ruling span. CHAPTER I-BASIC DATA 15 35 000 [I 225 30 000 I75 25 000 N .E 20 000 2 vi z (r E-I 15 000 IO 000 // H 5 000 25 U.E UNIT Figure 6.-Stress-strain 104-D-1049. 0.3 STRAIN, and creep curves for an ACSR, 0.4 0.45 percent 2617 conductor as furnished by the Aluminum Association. The second curve to be considered is the catenary. Any perfectly flexible material of uniform mass will hang in the shape of a catenary when suspended between two supports. Although commercially available wires and cables are not truly flexible, they will, in very short spans, conform closer to a catenary since than they is assumed The to any other will similar catenary and in long is easily understood parabolic of an imaginary Figures 7 and equations the curve long, 8 show the the arc the the of the short or the be appreciable that For reasonably catenary becomes conductors curve. conductor more be considered the mass as truly of the flexible conductor conductor. span parabola. in heavy even may catenary, with no unusually However, loading areas pronounced in an inclined the sag will between a with-comparatively if the spans span large difference is actually low are inclined. a small This portion span. the Figures following can realizing a level, the difference level spans, along for either This by for each. for distributed using spans. In longer of a catenary obtained when tensions needed shape to be uniformly sag calculations be very curve. sag in the parabolic 9 and example and 10 show problems. catenary the metric curves, respectively, and U.S. customary and also the commonly sag and tension used calculations TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Parabola Directrix X2 Y=40 w= Force per unit length L = p + $$ = Length of cable H = 2aw = w& = Horizontal '= w(3p2+8s2) 6p of cable and load = Vertical tension tension T=.z m = Maximum S,= $ = Sag at any point S= g = Maximum tension sag Figure 7.-Parabolic curve and equations. 104-D-1050. CHAPTER I-BASIC 17 DATA Catenary y= w = Force 4 ) = a cash (e++e+ per unit length L = a (e’-e’) =2a v=y(e x o -%*)= of cable and load sinh + = Length H = aw= T -SW= Horizontal $ of cable tension aw sinh + = Vertical tens ‘ion T = yw = aw cash $- = H cash $= Maximum S= y-a = a(cosh a= S 8 -I) = Maximum tension sag = Length of cable whose mass is equal to horizontal tension = Parameter of catenary Figure 8.-Catenary curve and equations. 104-D-1051. TRANSMISSION 18 DCm-576 MANUAL (3-78) M ;;;;LL CONDUCTOR f/D3 Code LINE DESIGN 2 mm k)psn "% SAGCALCULATIONS LOADIHG~ Linear Name Rated SreJklng Strength DLsme,er aB Tension L~m,tat,ons Force Dead /3 mm Factor. Load Force mm Ice O./m hPa N/m 915-7 /5-; 18. Wand Resultant Area (rV’) (w,‘)a (W’“) Cc&f. ad-51 N/m Total b/j2 N/m 34. Modulus. 0.000 of Linear NO Wind O.OOQL/65 0.000~ Final #d.?ztm ln~tlal Final 0 /~perOc 56. GPa I/do GPa AE34 75-T -369 N AE dL 939 318 N (W’) Figure 9.-Sag and tension DC-576 (El Exp.. lnttaal NO Ice. Set O.OOOJb Creep (A)&..&--rnd Temp. Permanent N/m calculation form for example problems on parabolic and catenary curves (metric). (3.78) ;;;f' CONDUCTORI+' Code Name 2 Rated kfm TensIon Load /. A 500 31 Final. + iz~“. AF 0 %fO 2 OF 50 E by - LOADING WeIghI Ice &lb 33f Z!&.?F Factors Dead lb Llmltatlons Loaded, Fmal. fl Inch In,t,al.-°F Computed d SAGCALCULATIONS I LOADING ~-"J/ Welght Breaking Dmmeter / 26 lb lb Area 5.70 lb Temo. “1 7 % 6 (AI 1. 2, Ib/ft opt/s Iblft Creep 0.00dL lb! It Total 0.000 7 -0. (W”‘) 2. a&?% Coeff. o.??o 4-09f7 o.000 UNSTRESSED LENGTH\ Figure lO.-Sag and tension calculation 2 o/D form for example problems (E) Final/o*76 In,t,al$. Exp: per OF 5; Set 0.0003 SAC FACTOR on parabolic ? 6 3 5 8-- 8 f’2 Ib/ft Modulus. 12 of Linear Permanent O’o ~-lb Date jT\;“” Wtnd Resultant: c00 (W’) (W”) SAG, ft and catenary /Z6 x 106 lb/l9 * 106 lb/ln2 Final AE 7 lb lnltlal AE &$tt lb SW,lb 1 TENSIONsIb curves (U.S. customary). CHAPTER Example Z.-Parabolic Assume: 366-m ‘C DATA 19 (metric) ruling span 403-mme, ACSR, 44 482-N maximum NESC 15.5 curve I-BASIC heavy 26/7 conductor tension (13 -mm loading sag at no load = 14 556 ice, 0.19-kPa wind plus constant at minus mm sagRS Sag, _ VW2 (Span, I2 where: sag in ruling span, sagRS = Sag, RS Span, = sag in any other = ruling span = span length mm given m of any other Sag,= (sa&S 1200-ft 795 NESC (Span1 j2, 104m2 SagI = K Gwn1)2, mm 100 200 300 400 500 600 700 800 900 1000 1 4 9 16 25 36 49 64 81 100 1, (U.S. 1 087 4 346 9780 17 386 27 166 39 119 53 245 69 544 88 017 108 663 customary) span ACSR, maximum heavy 60 o F sag at no load = K (Span, I2 m ruling kcmil, ) (Span 1I2 m 1.0866 x 10w4m-’ curve 10 OOO-lb span, 14 556 span Assume: given L= = (366)2 K =(Rs)2 Z.-Parabolic mm WI2 sagRS Example span, length, loading = 47.69 26/7 conductor tension (l/2ft in ice, 4-lb/fts wind plus constant at 0 OF) 18 ’ C) TRANSMISSION 20 LINE DESIGN MANUAL SaRS -= (RSY sa& (Span, 1’ where: S%RS = sag in ruling Sag, = sag in any = ruling span = span length RS Span 1 span, ft other given span, length, ft of any other given 47.69 sagRS - K=(RS)Z 105fi2 200 400 600 800 1000 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 3000 Assume: 366-m 44 482-N maximum 15.5 ‘C 15.5 o C tension sag at no load figure H = aw = a = H/w 0.4 1.6 1.32 5.30 11.92 21.20 33.12 41.69 64.91 84.78 107.30 132.41 160.29 190.76 223.88 259.65 298.06 2 10.0 14.4 19.6 25.6 32.4 40.0 48.4 57.6 67.6 78.4 90.0 span ACSR, heavy ft (metric) 403-mm2, NESC From ruling 10-5ft-1 S481= K (Spanl)“, (Span1j2 I ft curve ft =3.3118x =(1200)2 Spanl, 3.-Catenary span, (SagRs1 (Span 1I2 = K (Span, >2 WI2 Sag, = Example ft 26/7 conductor tension (13- mm loading = at no load 14 556 = ice, 0.19-kPa wind at minus mm 18 638 N 8: T= SW = 18 638, - (14.556) 18 405/15.9657 = 1152.7839 (15.9657) m = 18 405 N 18 “C) CHAPTER x =p/2 Example = 1/2span, 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 0.043 313 0.086146 0.130 120 0.173 493 0.216 866 0.260240 0.303 613 0.346986 0.390 359 0.433133 curve 795 ruling kcmil, 10 OOO-lb NESC ACSR, heavy loading = at no load = 9. Design the Regional by the Denver may and office 4-lb/ft2 4190 curve curves .-A = (1.0940) 3782.29 at 0 “F) = 4137.83 lb ft Sag=a(c;hz- z.- 1 cosha showing 0.000 349 531 0.001 398 367 0.003 147 243 0.005 597738 0.008 750 491 0.012 608 78 1 0.017 174 947 0.022452 180 0.028 444 171 0.035 155 107 0.042589680 0.050753087 0.059 651 036 0.069 289745 0.079 675 954 the percentage useful proportion seven the technical further of the regions. design in chapter work Design of each between a clearance design l), 1.322 5.289 11.904 21.172 33.097 47.690 64.961 84.921 107.584 132.967 161.087 191.963 225.618 262.074 301.358 relationship in determining are discussed of the Bureau’s to cover wind lb - (47.69) x a Instructions 1 084 4 340 9113 17 393 21215 39257 53542 70096 88952 110 144 ft be particularly catenary Directors in ice, 0.026439 0.052 878 0.079 317 0.105 756 0.132 195 0.158 634 0.185 073 0.211 512 0.237 951 0.264 390 0.290829 0.317 268 0.343707 0.370 146 0.396585 11 is a catenary Parabolic 0.000940156 0.003 764194 0.008 411558 0.015 087 698 0.023607738 0.034053 971 0.046445 57 1 0.06080607 1 0.077 162 490 0.095 546 05 1 conductor (l/Z- 47.69 100 200 300 400 500 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 1500 relationship - 1), mm tension x = p/2 = l/2 span, ft Figure Sag =a(cosh; 1 customary) 26/‘7 H = aw = T- SW = 4190 a = H/w = 4137.83/1.0940 This 21 span maximum 60 OF sag at no load 60 OF tension (U.S. DATA coshz- a 1200-ft Assume: X m 4.-Catenary I-BASIC at any point span length, in a span. II. on transmission instructions transmission sag and lines are issued line is delegated to these and include directors the following: to TRANSMISSION I”” 0, lb LINE DESIGN MANUAL 30 2'0 40 5’0 PERCENT Figure Il.-Catenary a. Design curve showing percentage relationship 70 $0 SPAN 80 90 100 LENGTH between sag and span length. 104-D-1052. data. (1) Length of line (2) Voltage of line (3) Number (4) Type (5) Ruling (6) Insulators: (7) Conductors and (8) Maximum tension (9) Final of circuits of structures span number, tension size, overhead under at 15.5 and type ground loaded OC (60 wires: number, size, and type conditions for conductors and “F) with no wind for conductors overhead ground wit -es and overhead groul nd wires (10) For steel towers, ground wires the horizontal and vertical spacing between conductors and overhe, ad CHAPTER (11) For (12) Final steel towers, sag at overhead the 15.5 conductor OC (60 ground (14) wires The annual isoceraunic level This number is calculated clearance at 15.5 the Design c. d. Minimum Drawings loading e. Number 49 23 to tower steel with OC (120OF) ’ F) between the conductors and the probable number either per 100 kilometers for coefficent for the and of power outages or per 100 miles “per-lOO-miles” conductors vahle overhead ground due to lighting. of transmission is 1.6 times locations of transpositions. all pertinent data concerning the line Initial entries on the summary form charts, so that should a compact, ready be made when the steel tower are obtained, filled out. notebook, records-if along they sheets for other lines, for easy reference. summary sheet is simple in layout, easy normally required, with summary are kept. The has room for any and by the time The completed reference is available. design work is assigned. entries should be made as data the form should be completely source. the than those given in a. of structures to be used. clearance A Transmission Line Data Summary Transmission Line Data Summary Form.on figure 12, should be prepared for each transmission line designed. This form should information and conditions. f. Design data drawings including sag templates, structure limitation diagrams, and conductor height tables for wood-pole structures. 10. shown no load value. clearances, other and characteristics and o C (60 mmlerical “per-IOO-kilometers” b. and DATA wires Midspan length; clearances “F) (13) line I-BASIC additional data that the transmission form should might form, as contain Additional line is put into service, be placed in a looseleaf Nothing is better than good to fill out, contains all data be useful, and is an excellent 24 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN TRANSMISSION LINE Region: Project: Name of Line: Length: Elevation, min.-max.: NESC loading: Type of km MANUAL DATA SUMMARY Specifications Voltage: In service: Data by: kPa wind, lb/ft* wind, contractor: mi zone, mm ice, in ice, construction: Insulators Size: -. Strength: Number per mmx in x l-Ql( N ( in) Conductor at 15.5 lb) No. +K(O.-), +K(O.-), and overhead ground wire to ground clearance "C (60 "F) mm ft Overhead ground wire _ - Name : size: Type: Stranding: Ultimate strength: Tension limitations 50% us at -"C( OF) initial 33-l/3% US at -"C(eoF) initial 25% US at -"C(OF) final 18% US at 15.5 "Cf 60 "F) final 15% US at 15.5 "C( 60 OF; final Diameter: Area : Temp. coeff. of linear expansion: Modulus of elasticity Final: Initial: NESC Force (weight) per unit length Bare: Iced: Wind: Resultant (with constant): Ellipse resultant: Ruling span: sacs OC OF string: Conductor Conductor at at mm* -- kcmil mm ml* mm dia. in dia. lb N lb lb lb lb lb N N N lb lb lb N lb in in in* -p&C __ perOF 2 pergc ----Tn* per"F GPa GPa lb/in* lb/in2 GPa GPa lb/in2 lb/in2 N/m N/m N/m N/m N/m m lblft lb/ft lb/ft lb/ft lb/ft lb/ft lb/ft lb/ft lb/ft lb[ft ft N/m N/m N/m N/Ill N/IO In OF) final: OF) final: nun Em mm mm mm ft ft ft ft ft mm mm mn mm mm OF) final: OF) final: N N N N N lb lb lb lb lb ft - Full load: Cold curve: Ellipse: 15.5 "C (60 49 'C (120 Tensions Full load: Cold curve: Ellipse: 15.5 “C (60 49 'C (120 ___ -OC ( OF) Key map: Plan-profile drawings: sag template: Stringing sag tables Cond"&r; Overhead ground wire: Structure Figure 12.-Transmission line data summary Limitation form. Chart: 104-D-1053. ft ft ft ft ft lb lb lb lb lb <<Chapter CONDUCTOR 11. General conductor under line design. This Information.-The SAGS AND TENSIONS determination of sags and various conditions of temperature and loading determination enables design elements, such to be established and permits the use of sag templates, criteria are in use as a basis for making sag and tension parabolic curve. If a uniform, perfectly flexible and inelastic stringing calculations: length corresponding tensions is of basic importance as the most economical tables, and other (1) the catenary of material, such for aids. Two general curve, and (2) the as a chain points of support. The tension at any horizontal component which is uniform point in the throughout component which varies along along its length. The vertical This means that the total tension of the tension at the low point the If it is assumed that points of support, curve of the and parabola) increasingly as the span the mass of the cable is uniformly instead of along the cable itself, cable is that of the are almost identical greater length ratios greater as the sag increases. increases. the value of this less than 0.05, and should than 0.20, the catenary encountered introduced stringing (100 error where in practice will in sag and the conductor. tension ft) of span length for spans greater a portion of a curve distributed the resultant parabola. The results of the two when the sag is small; however, Within a limited range of values method may be used for calculations. to spans cable will consist of two the length of the cable, Since of the ratio Generally, ratio longer or cable, be the method may present 0.05. The used for difficulty. a sag-to-span computations have not components: (1) a and (2) a vertical along a horizontal line mathematical equation between for the methods of calculation (catenary the difference in results becomes larger sags, the catenary of less than be greater difference catenary method method ratios between Fortunately, ratio should hangs the mass minimum be at the in the cable will also vary of the cable is zero. of sag to span, either the the use of the parabolic is less than involve spans increases or the parabolic should be limited can also be used 0.05 and 0.20. For most transmission 0.20. than The the error tolerance for ratios lines inherent or allowed in In general, the error allowed in stringing is 12 mm (0.04 ft) per 30.5 m for spans up to and inchtding 366 m (1200 ft), and 152 mm (0.5 ft) maximum than 366 m. The curve assumed by the cable in a steep inclined span is actually for a very large level span, so calculations for steep inclined spans, even though the spans may be short, should be made using the catenary method. Computed sags should to 3 mm (if in feet, to two decimal places) regardless of the method used. Sag and tension data can be divided into three categories according to the physical state conductor, of time with any in transmission span length, in still air between two fixed supports, it will take the form of a catenary. For the catenary, of the conductor is assumed to be uniformly distributed along the arc of the conductor. The tension in the cable will be at the lowest point of the arc, and the maximum tension will the curve. component II reference to its past and present degree 25 of stressing, and the length be accurate of the the TRANSMISSION conductor has been (2) final loading (1) a small this under stress. condition, and The initial percentage condition preparing These LINE DESIGN three (3) final categories loading MANUAL are referred condition to as: (1) initial with loading condition applies to conductors which of the stress value selected as the maximum are used as stringing sag templates, which data are used for unstressed to determine have not operating condition, been stressed beyond stress. Sags based on conductors, uplift to determine maximum stress conditions. applies to conductors (2) Th e f ina 11 oa d in g condition loading creep. forces and as basic on structures. data for Tensions are used selected as the maximum for only a short time. sag and tension, and maximum stress (3) The final operating stress, Sags and tensions stringing data for conditions. 1oa d’ m g condition but based where on this creep the have stressed has been to the value under this are used to determine conductors. applies been conductor condition prestressed with which Tensions to conductors are used which stress the full-load to determine have been in place for several years. Creep values are generally based on a lo-year period, since about 95 percent of the creep has been removed from the conductor over this length of time. Sags based on this loading condition are used for preparing sag templates that can be used for spotting structures on plan-profile Sag and conditions, drawings. Corresponding tensions are used in broken conductor tension values for a given span length and conductor will vary according that is, the sag for the final loading condition with creep will be greater calculations. to the loading than the sag for the final loading condition, and the sag for the final loading condition will be greater than for the initial loading condition. The difference in the sag between final loading with creep final loading conditions is obviously due to creep. The value of this creep is dependent magnitude of the average in the sag between final permanent To compute tension and the length of time and initial loading conditions set is dependent upon the magnitude sags and tensions based on initial for the conductor Likewise, the final set must of the loading maximum conditions, under study must be determined and modulus of elasticity must be determined tensions based on either the To relate initial conditions, permanent the tension has been is due to permanent final loading condition final conditions, and be determined. To determine used in formulas involving the and used in order to compute values, the The loading permanent curve and approximating elongation the at zero set may the loading conditions unloading initial stress Whenever electrical subjected to the effects be taken line. loading between as the difference In the curve, the case where the initial 1 Numbers as the in brackets the permanent modulus line at zero stress initial set and modulus modulus may the may and recommendations for conductor tensions requirements California Rules for Overhead Line Construction refer to items in the Bibliography. [l].t and be taken as loading curve between the is the slope of the unloading be taken unloading between the initial is represented as the by a line difference are set forth in line. conductors or overhead ground wires are strung above ground, of wind, temperature, and ice, all of which add load to the wires, rules have been adopted as the basic standard code the Bureau of Reclamation serves, except California. is published in elongation modulus. sags and condition with creep. creep, values of creep initial the slope of a straight line which most closely approximates the initial point of maximum stress and the point of zero stress. The final modulus line. applied. The difference set. The value of the stress attained by the conductor. the initial modulus of elasticity or the final loading final conditions with these the sag and the on the in NESC. by all of the 17 Western has established its own they are Standard These NESC States that code, which CHAPTER The the standard loading NESC[S]. length NESC loading districts of the According of the horizontal load conductor (ice determined per unit covered from conditions Uniied to NESC, components total and Henry, which on the general loading load on a conductor shall load per unit (ice covered length due a horizontal to specified), length wind to which resultant apply map be the resultant where in general in section loading specified) to 25 of per unit and the pressure on the projected area of the has been added a constant that can be 1. Radial thickness of ice, mm (in) Horizontal wind pressure, kPa (lb/ft* ) Temperature, OC (OF) Constant K to be added to the resultant of all conductors, N/m (lb/ft) State Medium, as shown vertical Table 1.-NESC The are Light, States the 27 SAGS AND TENSIONS of the where table II-CONDUCTOR of California specifies conductor loading constants (K) Heavy Loading Medium Light 13 (0.5) 6 (0.25) 0 (0) 0.191 52 (4) - 18 (0) 0.191 52 (4) - 9.4 (+ 15) 0.430 92 (9) - 1 (+30) 4.3782 (0.30) 2.9 188 (0.20) 0.7297 (0.05) heavy loading conditions of 13-mm (0.5-in) radial thickness of ice and 0.29 kPa (6 lb/ft2) of wind pressure on the projected area of cylindrical surfaces at minus 18 ‘C (0 “F) for all parts of the State where the elevation exceeds 914 m (3000 ft) above sea level. Unlike the NESC, the California code does not require the addition of conductor loading constants. California light loading conditions of no ice and 0.38-kPa (8-lb/ft2) wind pressure on the projected area of cylindrical where the elevation above snow are likely to occur surfaces at minus 4 ’ C (25 OF) are specified sea level is 914 m or less. However, our experience at elevations below 914 m in northern California; for all areas has shown therefore, of the State that ice and some Bureau lines in this part of the State are designed for NESC medium loading conditions. This loading is more practical for the expected weather conditions and exceeds the requirements of the California code. In Montana and Wyoming, NESC medium loading is specified for most of the area covering these States. However, extremely low temperatures so we have revised, for Bureau use, these 1 in section Both the strung of the 2. NESC and California been encountered areas to NESC recommend that conductors in these states during the winter heavy loading as shown on figure and overhead ground wires be at tensions such that the final unloaded tension at 15.5 ’ C (60 ’ F) will not exceed 25 percent ultimate strength, and the initial unloaded tension at 15.5 “C will not exceed 35 percent of the ultimate strength. The NESC ultimate strength under maximum percent For codes have loading of the ultimate ACSR conductors, permits tensions assumed loading. strength under the Aluminum maximum Company under The load that California do not exceed 60 percent of the code limits maximum load to 50 assumed loading. of America recommends that the tension shall not exceed 50 percent unloaded tension shall of the ultimate strength under maximum loading conditions; and that the final not exceed 25 percent of the ultimate strength at minus 18 ’ C (0 OF) in NESC and loading California heavy districts, at minus 9.4 ‘C (15 ’ F) in NESC medium loading districts, 2% TRANSMISSION and at minus 1 ’ C (30 those recommended vibration. Several years ’ F) in NESC by the light codes ago, we installed and steel LINE DESIGN loading result districts. with some of the overhead conductors, 25 percent of the ultimate strength at the following temperatures: ground so we now of both These in considerably tensions at a final breaks for high-strength clamps. Vibration in one problems unloaded ground from of 25 percent occurred final overhead less than conductor tension to vibration a maximum steel to the unloaded due suspension design are substantially less damage wires of the ultimate strength at 15.5 ’ C (60 OF). N umerous more wires of the seven-wire strand at the supporting occurred MANUAL wires or also tension of and conductors Temperature OC (OFI District NESC heavy loading NESC medium loading NESC light loading -40 (- 40) -29 (- 20) -18 (0) When extra-high-strength steel is used for overhead ground wires, we design for a maximum final unloaded tension of 20 percent of the ultimate strength at the temperatures shown above for the different loading districts. Bureau design criteria for conductors and overhead ground wires should be in accordance with the data shown on figure 1; note that there are four limiting conditions shown. Although the ice and wind loadings prescribed by the codes are generally applicable for determining the loading conditions to be used in the design of a transmission line, specific climatic and weather conditions should be studied for each transmission and South Dakota transmission lines, 38 mm (1.5 in) of ice on the conductors, was considered as it did not seem simultaneously. Certain limitations regarding in various local safety codes. applicable authorities. of spans, References are given inclined level to various to some be exceeded, except a general discussion for which sag and methods (symmetrical) (asymmetrical) or group of lines. For example, on our North allowable sags, tensions, and span lengths are set forth in NESC These codes or regulations should be reviewed to determine limitations which should not In the following paragraphs, and special span combinations, in such spans. A perfectly line the crossarms were designed to support a vertical load due to but no extra wind load for the excess ice above 13 mm (0.5 in) probable that heavy icing and high winds would occur span degree. simple treatment by either the parabolic for computing sags and tensions in level which by written permission from the proper is given concerning the various types tension data are likely to be required. are in general is infrequently However, found the level and the use for computing in practice span problem since lends sags and almost itself tensions all spans are to comparatively or catenary relations. Numerous methods have been derived spans, the majority of which are-based on catenary relations in the form of dimensionless ratios. Four of these methods Reference [6] offers the greatest facility in most problems are described in references [4, 5, 6, 71. and is discussed further in the following section. be made the Before method, using and then any care method, should a careful study be given to the should application of the to determine method As might be expected, the computation of sags and tensions for inclined their asymmetry. Most inclined spans are supported by suspension or pin-type the within limitations these of limits. spans is complicated insulators at both by ends, CHAPTER or by suspension A few or pin-type inclined spans can be designed purposes, without correction. catenary solving can curves each insulators may the For be used span extremely to theoretical sag condition for at both or correcting ruling the data determination work from requirements the spans, hillside of support proper at the level over railroad, special clearances to ground treatment. discussed waterway, such and line, be used applies conductor condition and the and sag curves to obstructions. which 14. to a broken under this communication structure may support to provide A method in section end. span as extending as the upper be made For usually calculations, other of inclined spans. spans elevation should at the type for symmetrical tensions in spans adjacent of assuring compliance highway, insulators suspended on symmetrical same span, conductor the computed steep points of sags and standpoint Usually, based spans dead-ended at both ends also require special is given as reference [S]. Inclined spans are further The design by dead-end-type ends. sag template as an individual determining SAGS AND TENSIONS at one end and be dead-ended by modifying spotting II-CONDUCTOR then which Inclined to this case is important in with clearance powerline crossings; and from the standpoint of determining the unbalanced loads on the structures. The computation of sags and tensions under this condition is quite involved, due mainly to the many variables introduced. A method which applies directly to this problem is given as reference [8]. In addition to this published solution, an unpublished that offers as appendix a margin A, and method of facility an example was devised by Mr. over other methods. problem using this G. R. Wiszneauckas, former Bureau This method has been included method is shown in section 16. engineer, in this manual In a series of suspension spans, where relatively short spans occur adjacent to a relatively long span, it is desirable to determine the changes in sags and tensions which would result from temperature and loading changes and produce dangerous loads values. The consequently, nature most this problem with in section 16. Problems substation from unbalanced on the structures; of this problem of the methods slight relating for to spans with An example concentrated approach In some cases, such changes clearances may be reduced is very similar handling the modification. or switchyard loadings. in others, spans to that of the broken conductor problem loads broken conductor problem; problem can be applied to on unbalanced are relatively or unbalances will below the required few conditions and is presented are confined mainly to taps or tie-down arrangements in which problems are complicated by the elastic effects No published method is known which adequately are used. Such of the tie-down in addition to the dead load applied. treats this problem; however, a method was devised by facility, the Bureau Another dead-ended in references handled 12. that by one of the Sag and Calculating Engineers’ published handles this problem with methods Tension Tables [4] were Society in book given Calculations first made of Western form by the in reference 18. [12]. Using Copperweld public by Mr. James Pennsylvania Copperweld in November Steel Co. That then, have been in constant use by engineers designing sags and tensions by Martin’s Tables consist of filling interpolating, tables. see section problem similar to spans with concentrated loads appears in the use of extremely short spans with long insulator strings. This problem may be handled by use of the methods [S, 10, 111. Problems where the concentrated load consists of dead load only can be and computing values. There Sag Calculating Charts.-Martin S. Martin in a paper he presented 1922. In 1931, first edition, and the tables were first several editions since overhead transmission lines. out a calculation form by is a trial-and-error method required ‘s Sag to the Calculations of reading tables, in the use of these 30 TRANSMISSION The “Graphic a series Method of correlated conductor. Graphical superimposing The for Sag-Tension graphs ‘to methods graph Copperweld upon are very graph, and for overhead Tables. The as with Martin’s lines. general procedure Tables. charts for required occasion, sag and but values were [6] are based charts various developed provide and factors of which eliminates using is applied the charts and to a wire, as is done stretches. If the tension of load on a suspended tables should in the wire increases, wire, the elongation a conductor problems the length (stretch) in preparing the calculation using a graphical that time of the catenary curves, these all wire is the between to some two same unstressed force of construction solution. is elastic between in Martin’s charts times the vertical and the trial-and-error most types part of the is strung of sags and as given relationship SF/ T (span length the interpolating be aware when employing of an overhead conditions. to simplify tension is a system characteristics considerable on the functions sag and the require for by Alcoa, tension when using the tables. The range of the charts covers it may be necessary to revert to Martin’s Tables for Designers tension reading solving However, length factors, elongation factors, conductor divided by the tension) the satisfactory Charts The developed Calculations”, determine Sag Calculating tensions LINE DESIGN MANUAL of the methods but, extent. supports, on When the wire of the wire increases. With different amounts and the tension in the wire will change. A temperature change in the wire also changes its length. If the temperature changes while the wire is unstressed (at zero tension) and the wire is free to change its length, the length changes but there is no change in tension. When the wire is suspended in tension and the temperature changes, the change in length the wire. All changes sags and tensions The conductor changeover the metric is affected by both the temperature change and the elastic due to ice, wind, and temperature are taken into consideration in conductors by sag and tension this method calculation period, we have both a metric form to which we have added and item Item (1) (2) (3) (4) (9 (6) (7) (8) (9) Conductor size Conductor code name’ Rated breaking strength’ Diameter,’ mm (in) Radial thickness of ice, mm (in) Wind, kPa (Ib/ft2 ) Loading W’, N/m (lb/ft) W”, N/m (lb/ft) (10) Wind, N/m (lb/ft) (11) W’ (12) Area A, mm2 (in2 > Temperature coefficient of linear expansion (13) “, N/m (lb/ft)l of charts and tables. form is shown on figure a U.S. customary numbers to help 13. characteristics when computing During form for our use. explain the form: Figure the of metric 13 shows Explanation Determined from economic studies From NESC or State codes From NESC or State codes From NESC or State codes Vertical force (weight) of conductor’ Vertical force (weight) of conductor with ice’ (if applicable) Force of wind on conductor and ice’ (if applicable) Resultant force, including applicable constant if NESC loading’ Cross sectional area of conductor’ Change in length of conductor due to temperature change’ CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR Item (14) Final modulus E, GPa (lb/in2 ) (15) Initial modulus E, GPa (lb/in2 ) (16) Final AE, N (lb) (17) Initial AE, N (lb) (18) Span length, m (ft) (19) (20) (21) Thickness of ice, mm (in); and force of wind, kPa (lb/ft2 ) Temperature, OC (OF) Tension, N (lb), initial (22) SW, N (lb) (two decimal places) (23) (24) SW/T (four decimal places) SW/AE (seven decimal places) (25) Unstressed length (six decimal places) Permanent set and creep’ (six decimal places) Unstressed length at -18 OC (0 OF) (six decimal places) (26) (27) (28) - (3 1) Unstressed length (six decimal places) SAGS AND TENSIONS 31 Explanation Slope of final (unloading) curve of stress-strain diagram’ Slope of initial loading curve of stress-strain diagram’ (average slope between maximum loading and point where entire conductor starts to assume loading) Product of conductor area (12) and final modulus ( 14) Product of conductor area (12) and initial modulus (15) Length of span for which computations are to be made For full-load condition For full-load condition Expected or desired tension at full-load conditions (Must not exceed 50 percent of ultimate strength of conductor. May be limited by 33-l /3 percent of ultimate strength of conductor for no-load initial conditions, or 25 percent of conductor ultimate strength for no-load final conditions. At temperatures indicated on fig. 1). Span length (18) times resultant force per unit length of conductor (11) SW (22) divided by full-load tension (21) SW (22) divided by initial AE (17) From Copperweld charts [ 61 at intersection of SW/T (23) and SW/AE (24) values If value of unstressed length is for initial condition, then only a change for temperature, number of degrees change times temperature coefficient of linear expansion (13), need be made. However, if the value for unstressed length is to be for the final-condition, then it will also be necessary to add the permanent set and creep to the value of unstressed length (25) Change in value is equal to the degrees of temperature change times temperature coefficient of linear expansion (13) TRANSMISSION 32 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Item (32) (33) (34) - (38) Explanation SW, N (lb) (two decimal places) SW/AE (seven decimal places) SW/T (four decimal places) (39) - (44) Sag factors (interpolate to five decimal places) (45) - (50) Sags, mm (ft) (two decimal places , if in feet) Tensions, N (lb) (51) - (55) ’ Available from manufacturers’ Span length (18) times unloaded conductor force per unit length of conductor (8) SW (32) divided by final AE (16) From Copperweld charts [ 61 at intersections of unstressed length values (27) - (3 1) and SWlAE(33) From table at back of Copperweld charts book [ 61, sag factor for each value of SW/T (23) and (34) - (38) Span length (18) times sag factors (39) - (44) SW (22) and (32) divided by SW/T (23) and (34) - (38), respectively catalogs or data in appendixes. Figure 13 can be used for any combination of ice, wind, and temperature conditions to find the resulting sags and tensions in a conductor. The procedure is the same for all cases, but one must be sure of the basic data and to keep in mind whether initial or final conditions are being computed. for 13. Preparation a specified loading lengths, profile survey locating sag and conditions catenary 356used span and longer of structures on plan-profile drawings. The data required to prepare a sag template tension values of the conductor at the ruling span length for the temperature and desired. These basic sag values can be computed and extended to corresponding longer in this span lengths by chapter. Whatever The tension values catenary parameters, relations. by 0.635-mm for plotting and also a curve span The the template is made temperature final sag values. loading conditions. to the sag values of the ruling be known in order to expand on a transparent (lo- by 14- by 0.025- in ) size. plan-profile sheets, represents at an assumed minimum curve is plotted or are the loading values either the parabolic or catenary relations, or by any of the method used should be governed by the limitations of that corresponding which must at 49 OC (120 “F) or 54 ‘C (130 “F), maximum sags. The minimum temperature 1 ‘C (30 “F) and minus 51 ‘C (-60 minimum ruling and and the resulting sag values plotted against the corresponding span lengths-a conductor curve results. When this curve is plotted to the same scale as a transmission line plan-profile drawing, it is commonly called a sag template and can be used to facilitate the spotting for shorter and methods shown method. compute If sag values for a conductor at a specified of Sag Template.are expanded to give corresponding values of sag at shorter sheet The template, the conductor from initial Figure 14 shows’a sag template Changing any of these specified of plastic approximately temperature template, curve, if desired, be drawn for any temperature on locality and climatic sag values, prepared conditions and for 254- by made to the same scales that were profile curve at 15.5 O C (60 O F), temperature. A maximum may also be drawn on the curve may OF), depending span are required only to the basic sag values by the the other curves usually taken for checking between conditions. are plotted minus The from a specific conductor under specific would change the shape of the curves, CHAPTER DCm-578 II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS (3-73) !yT:ALL SAG CALCULATIONS (1) CONDUCTOR Rated Breaking Tension Lmear Force Factor: (3) Strength Dfalmlero N L~m~tat~one. _cs, mm ice (W”) (6) kPa Wmd Imtial.~,-?&%--N Resulranr Oc 25 h -N Loaded.v.A% Flnal.15.5’ N o.oal Permanent Set 0.00 Creep 0.00 N/IT Total 0.00 0 1TEMP../ oc UNSTRESSED LENGTH Modulus. (E) FInal (14) (13) lmtlal Exp.: Final AE PdC I 18) (24) j ! 49 mm Ice kPa Wind (W”‘) (25) SAG, mm SW,N ] / I (45) (22) TENSION, N (51) I (29) / (36) (30) 31 I (37) (521 33 SPANLENGTH(S) 50 (53) (54) 55) 32 m I I / -13 -1 15.5 32 49 SPAN LENGTH(S) mm Ice m No Ice. No Wind (W’) No Ice. No Wind (W’) m SPAN LENGTH(S) mm Ice kPa Wind (W”‘) Permanent Set IL Creep No Ice. No Wind (W’) N (21) (33) ( h Creep No Ice. No Wind (w’) GPa N m (39, (23) AE Gpa (15) (16) (17) (26) 15.5 32 ) SAG FACTOR ( f I SPAN LENGTH(S) -1i No Ice. No Wind (W’) ifi (26) N/m lnllial Ice Set (II) (W”‘) N/m N/m Date - kPa Wind (W”‘) j(20) Permanent Set 6 Creep 1 1-13 Permanent (IO) Temp. Coeff. of Linear .-%- LOADING (19) -mm (9) Area (A)(12)m& -N Computed by (8) Dead Load Force (W’) mm Final. (7) LOADING (2) Code Name I I 1 I -13 -1 15.5 32 49 Figure 13.-Explanation of standard sag and tension calculation form. I - --- TRANSMISSION 34 LINE DESIGN MANUAL SAG TEMPLATE 242mm2(477kcmil) ACSR 24/ 7 Ruling Span =213.4m (mft) Maximum Tension 532 472N (7300 lb)=42% ultimote strength NESC Heavy Loading=13-mm($-in)ice,O.lS-kPa(4-lb/ft*) wind + K ot-I8 Scales: Horlzontal 25.4mm -61m (I in = 200 ft) Vertical 25.4mm = 12.2m( I in =40 ft) I 12.2m 1 (4011) 305 244 (1000) (800) . \ I \ le.3 (600) they would the minimum h 122 (400) Figure and and I 0 meters 14.-Typical I 61 122 .._- construction. requirements this specific job. The 15.5 no-load” curve are plotted I 104-D-1054. ’ C (60 OF) “final no-load” curve in the center of the template, and The 15.5 ’ C final no-load curve the plastic material between these two curves should be cut away. is used for plotting the conductor location on plan and profile drawings because this is the temperature which are identical to the 15.5 ‘C curve, used as a basis for NESC clearances. Clearance curves, are drawn below the 15.5 ‘C final no-load curve. The amount of clearance is determined from the following no longer be good for temperature “initial sag template I OC(O OF) of NESC: Assume line voltage Plus 5 percent overvoltage 115 kV 5.75 120.75 kV Maximum line voltage 120.75 69.7 kV Line to ground = n Assume 2 13.4-m (700-ft) ruling span. Clearance from NESC, 1977 edition, Rule 232: CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS 232.A. Basic clearance Table 232-l) Basic clearance for 50-kV, 53.3-m span, in heavy loading area where equipment ating height is less than 4.3 m (14 ft) . . . . 232.B. Additional clearances 232.B. 1. Voltages exceeding 50 kV 232.B.l .a. Plus 10.2 mm (0.4 in) for each kilovolt 10.2 (69.7 - 50) = 201 mm % (69.7 - 50) (175-ft) oper. . . . . . Clearance 6706 mm (22.0 ft) above 50 kV ft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = 0.66 35 201 mm (0.66 ft) 18mm (0.06 ft) 232.B.l .b. Additional clearance calculated in 232.B. 1.a. shall be increased 3 percent for each 304.8 m (1000 ft) over 1005.8-m (3300-ft) elevation. Assume an elevation of 1920.2 m (6300 ft): 1920;ii ioo5a8 (0.03) (201) = 18 mm 630;o;;300 (0.03) (0.66) = 0.06 ft . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232.B.2. Sag increase 232.B.2.c. Span is longer than 53.3 m (175 ft). Assume line operates below 49 OC (120 OF). Calculate clearances in 232.B.2.c.( 1) and (3), use smaller clearance of the two. 232.B.2.c.( 1) Clearance specified in table 232-l shall be increased 0.03 m (0.1 ft) for each 3.05 m (10 ft) over 53.3 m (175 ft). 213j4i553e3 (0.03) = 1.57 m 7o01; 175 (0.1) = 5.25 ft 232.B.2.c.(3) Limits Assume difference in final sag at 15.5 OC (60 and49 OC(120OF),nowind= 1.2m(4ft) Total clearance required by NESC . . . . . . 6706+201+18+1219=8144mm 22 + 0.66 + 0.06 + 4 = 26.72 ft Plus, for width of profile line on drawing and in plotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Total ground clearance on sag template . . . For lines in California, a 54 ’ C (130 ’ F) final and for locating the structures instead of the 15.5 be in accordance The sag template calculation sheets, with reference 1219 mm 8144 mm (4.0 ft) (26.72 ft) small errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8754 610 mm mm (2.0 ft) (28.72 ft) no-load ’ C (60 curve should be used for the sag template ’ F) final no-load curve. Clearances should [l]. shown on figure 14 was made figures 15 and 16: 15.5 ‘C (60 “F), final, Minus 40 ‘C (-40 OF) OF), no wind, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . no-load initial, sag for 213.4-m no-load sag for from the (700-ft) 213.4-m data ruling ruling indicated on the span span = = 4874 2243 sag and mm mm tension (15.99 (7.36 ft) ft) 36 TRANSMISSION DCm-576 LINE DESIGN MANUAL (3-73) ;llNT;;' SAGCALCULATIONS LOADlUG Linear Force Dead 13 Factor Load Force 8. (W’) a=kPa W,“da. Area (A,~ammi! Temp. Coeff. 0.000 No Wind Set 0.004 ,“: 27 I 3450 Nlm MOduIus. 01 Linear (E) Final Exp.: p. d03 GPa In,tml_5-j,mGPa 0 ~J.&$.fLyl/wrQC Final AE /? gm lnttlal AE 15 2.31 N 252 N 15.-Sag and tension calculation form for example problem on sag template (metric). (3-78) krm;/ CONDUCTOR g,?? Code Permanent (W’) Figure DC-570 N/m Rdd Resultant (W”‘) NO Ice. f6ff? mm Ice (N”) $-/!fL v7 hdb? LOADING -kJ+-- F/!&k Name Rated Diameter Weight Load =;7 Breakmg /7. Tenston 280 lb Final. Final. Computed Ice lb ‘AL d % 673.4 -zT % e$!&?& lb Area OF 50 % 9Lofl lb Temp. -f&L+ 18 % &.2&m lb LOADING 0.000 Date ! “o”“‘t lmd UNSTRESSED LENGTH (Al 0 /o B- D No Wand Inch D. (W”‘) 87L .I, 7 Ltnear o.oo~r/48-~ )b/ft Total O.OOC&?&2.- Modulus. (E) Final/O,53 lnrtral Exp.: per OF v Set O.OOCX-&2creep lb/0 in2 of Permanent Ib/ft SAG FACTOR ; SAG,R Final AE lnltial AE ( x 10s 8./7,?/ 1/ x SW,Ib I 16.-Sag and tension calculation :E j TENSION, lb %+-FEET SPAN LENGTI form for example problem on sag template lb/ln2 106 )b/in2 1/ & (W’) Ice. Figure lblft p-f.7 1. a. Cc&f. SPAti LENGTk NO Ice. (W’) .e (W”) Resultant: lb zz&?F by ___ Weight + JIk,,. Llmttatmns. In,lial,-&F Factors Dead Inch Loaded. SAGCAL,CULATIONS (U.S. customary). CHAPTER Using the relationship from II-CONDUCTOR section SAGS AND TENSIONS 37 8, sag, sagRS -= UW2 C$an, j2 where, SagRs = sag in ruling span, mm (in) Sag, = sag in any other given span, mm (in) = ruling span length, m (ft) span i = span length of any other given span, m (ft) RS 4.874 m sagRS For 15.5 OC final: (RS)Z = sagRS 60 OF final: (RS)~ = For - 40 = 1 0707 x 10S4m-’ 15.99 ft = 3.2633 x 10-5ft-’ (700 ft)2 sagRS = -40 OF initial: (RS)~ Assume values for span lengths sags as shown in table 2. 7.36 ft = 1.502x (700 ft)2 (x), square these Span length (Span length) 2 horizontally, m ft m2 60.96 121.92 243.84 365.76 487.68 609.60 200 400 800 1200 1600 2000 3 716.12 14 864.49 59 457.95 133 780.38 237 831.78 371612.16 same and scales 25.4 as those mm = multiply by the 15.5 ‘C (60 OF) Sag 0.4 x 1.6 x 6.4 x 14.4 x :i:::::i5 used 105 lo5 lo5 10: on the m or m mm 0.398 1.592 6.366 14.324 25.464 39.788 398 1592 6 366 14 324 25 464 39788 plan-profile 1 in = template for the span lengths shown in table sag template to permit its use on an entire extremely steep span where a special catenary Kvalues to obtain the -40 OC (-40 OF) Sag K,X2 ft2 12.2 and =K, for sag template x2 x 10-5ft-1 (x2), Table 2.-Calculations the =K, 2.243 m = (213.36 m)2 = 4.9272 x 10-5m-1 =K, VW2 Using =K 1 ’ sas,S initial: OC (213.36 m)2 K22 m mm ft 0.183 0.732 2.930 6.592 11.718 18.310 183 732 2 930 6 592 11 718 18310 0.60 2.40 9.61 21.63 38.45 60.08 ft 1.31 5.22 20.89 46.99 83.54 130.53 sheets 40 ft vertically), (25.4 mm plot = the 61 m or 1 in = sag values on 2. The curves should be expanded far enough transmission line, with the possible exception curve should be used. 200 the ft sag on the of an 38 TRANSMISSION Draw must the but a vertical be kept line at the center perfectly vertical of the when the LINE DESIGN MANUAL template (zero template span is being Clearance (conductor to earth) curves should be located 15.5 OC (60 o F) final sag curve. The clearance curves will be offset vertically ,411 curves should maximum conductor be noted on the 14. inclined inclined spans spans it by the values at the will of clearance for a reference for laying specified Spans.-In to some may may practice, degree. get rather be classified end; and (2) inclined spans falling in the first category require located This distances to the final line line. below sag curve required. The conductor horizontal and size and type, vertical scales the ruling span, used should also nearly every span of a transmission layout be used to ahnost is inclined supported by at the other purposes sags and span. Some vertical, inclined computed spans for or spotting purposes, the ruling span sag template based on without correction. Inclined spans dead-ended at both ends layout or spotting A series of spans for stringing The method used for calculating somewhat on the steepness of the level spans insulators which are dead-ended at both ends. Problems concerning usually can be handled by modifying or correcting data special treatment, even for on extremely steep inclines. insulator offset calculations (sec. 30(b), ch. V). line As might be suspected, the computations for sags and tensions for complex, depending upon the degree of their asymmetry. In general, into two categories for design purposes: (1) inclined spans supported spans. For structure spans usually may spans, from extremes. line. a transmission NESC be identical by suspension or pin-type insulators at both ends of the span, and inclined suspension or pin-type insulators at one end of the span and by dead-end type symmetrical symmetrical out template. Inclined (asymmetrical) from be identified on the sag template. tension, NESC loading, and the length) used while purposes, if they are fairly long spans and are located on extremely steep inclines may require in order tensions to get each for successive a dead-ended, span properly inclined span sagged depends methods of calculation are good for all dead-ended other methods apply to particular areas between these For a dead-ended span of normal length and a relatively span with the same horizontal distance between supports on figure 17, the sag D(for this case) is measured vertically small incline, the calculations for a level may be used. Using the notation shown and is the vertical distance between the straight is tangent line joining the supports Figure and a parallel 17.-Sag on inclined line which span-equivalent to the span method. conductor’s curvature. CHAPTER If the span is long, or if there II-CONDUCTOR is a relatively SAGS AND TENSIONS large difference in elevation 39 of the end supports, some correction should be made in the calculations. Calculations based on the catenary are preferred over those based on the parabola because the conductor conforms to a catenary curve when suspended between supports-the of a cateriary as the The by using equivalent level span. is then spans Another sag value. Thus, span, of the an qrrirulfw/ span the calculated as can the greater horizontal level span. span in the usual This be used as the slope equivalent span equals manner. shown difference between error between method, alt bough plus field the and = may an average 2SI-S. between The where w is the conductor linear force factor per unit length. Figure Tl + T2 2T, - wH 2 = 2 18.~Sag on inclined span-average tension this method. gives can be results limitations. the slope sag span and the D for the equivalent less than in the span 18: portion 11 to be the same However, field be used with tension comparable an approximation, wilhin T, - T, = wH Tav= the in assuming supports. difference (SLS) method IIWS on figure is some distance in the S’ + This up to 20 percent. gives good results, 11ie notation the the sag, there same ordinarily is taken with an incline method, which Using the In computing span are as accurate span for a parabola. sag for a level minimized which steeper and and I percent error has a corrected TRANSMISSION 40 T,,. Use ;2lcoa, and or other A method Zare and included sags calculation. Since for calculated various sag by sags and tensions was developed staff. For [S]. A b rte’ f version a sample tensions the for calculating of any incline, as table and Correct of Reclamation see reference procedure, methods. intended to spans Bureau formulas, L t to calculate acceptable originally is applicable of the length LINE DESIGN MANUAL by Mr. a full discussion of this the method method conditions the in steeply using Copperweld, relationship SL ,/L. D = inclined spans, but which D. 0. Ehrenburg while he was a member of his method, including derivations follows is based showing nonmenclature, on a parameter 2, the of formulas, functions of 3. Nomenclature and units Metric U.S. customary T, = Te = w = h = V = w’ = S = S, = a = b = c = a’ = b’ = A = E = a = d = 2 = tension at upper support effective (average) tension of conductor linear force factor of conductor per unit length wind load per unit length of conductor ice load per unit length of conductor (w + v)~ + h2 = resultant force per unit length of conductor actual length of conductor unstressed length of conductor horizontal spacing of supports vertical spacing of supports straight line distance between supports spacing of supports in plane of w’, at right angles to vector w’ spacing of supports in plane of w’, in direction of vector w’ area of conductor cross section modulus of elasticity of conductor coefficient of linear expansion sag of conductor parameter Necessary given data: Loading conditions (ice, Size, type, and stranding Linear Linear force force factor factor per per wind, and temperature) of conductor unit unit length length of bare of iced conductor conductor Force on conductor due to wind Resultant force on conductor Cross-sectional area Modulus of elasticity Temperature Maximum Horizontal Vertical of conductor of conductor coefficient of linear tension in conductor spacing spacing of supports of supports expansion for conductor N N N/m N/m N/m N/m (lb) (lb) Wft) Wft) Wft) m m m m m m m mm2 GPa w> (ft) (ft) (ft) (ft) WI (ft) mm WI (lb/W (in2 ) (lb/in2 ) CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS Table 3.-Functions Z f0 0.010 ,020 .030 .040 .oso 0.000 016 ,000 066 .ooo 150 .OOO266 .OOO416 67 6 0 7 7 .060 .070 .080 .OOO600 1 ,000 8169 .OOl 067 .OOl 351 ,001 668 .llO .120 .130 .140 .150 .002 ,002 ,002 .003 .003 .160 .170 ,180 .190 .200 41 of Z coth Z l/Z 23 100.003 50.007 33.343 25.013 20.017 100.000 50 .ooo 33.333 3 25.000 0 20.000 0 0.000 001 ,000 008 .OOO027 ,000 064 .OOO125 0.000 000 .OOO000 .OOO000 .OOO002 .OOO006 01 16 81 56 25 24 16.687 14.309 12.527 11.141 10.0333 16.666 14.285 12.500 11.111 10.000 7 7 0 1 0 ,000 216 .ooo 343 .OOO512 .ooo 729 .OOl 000 .OOO012 .OOO024 .OOO040 .OOO065 .ooo 100 96 01 96 61 0 018 402 819 270 754 9.1275 8.3733 7.7356 7.1895 6.7166 9.090 8.333 7.692 7.142 6.666 9 3 3 9 7 .OOl 331 .OOl 728 ,002 197 .002 744 .003 375 .OOO146 .OOO207 ,000 285 .OOO 384 ,000 506 4 4 6 2 3 .004 .004 .005 ,006 .006 272 824 409 028 680 6.3032 5.9389 5.6154 5.3263 5.0665 6.250 5.882 5.555 5.263 5 .ooo 0 4 6 2 0 .004 .004 .005 .006 .008 096 913 832 859 000 ,000 655 4 .OOO835 2 ,001 050 ,001 303 .OOl 600 .205 .210 .215 ,220 .225 ,007 .007 .007 .008 .008 019 366 722 086 459 4.9462 4.8317 4.7226 4.6186 4.5192 4.878 4.761 4.651 4.545 4.444 05 90 16 45 44 ,008 .009 .009 ,010 .Oll 615 261 938 648 39 .OOl 766 .OOl 945 ,002 137 .002 343 .002 563 .230 .235 .240 ,245 .008 .009 .009 .OlO .OlO 840 230 628 034 449 4.4242 4.3334 4.2464 4.1630 4.0830 4.347 4.255 4.166 4.081 4.000 83 32 67 63 00 ,012 ,012 .013 ,014 .015 17 98 82 71 63 .002 .003 ilO3 .003 .003 798 050 318 603 906 .255 .OlO .Oll ,011 .012 .012 873 305 745 194 652 4.0062 3.9324 3.8615 3.7933 3.7276 3.921 3.846 3.773 3.703 3.636 57 15 58 70 36 .016 ,017 ,018 .019 .020 58 58 61 68 80 .004 ,004 .004 ,005 ,005 228 570 932 314 719 .280 .285 ,290 .295 .013 .013 .014 .014 .015 118 592 076 567 068 3.6643 3.6033 3.5444 3.4876 3.4327 3.571 3.508 3.448 3.389 3.333 43 77 28 83 33 .021 .023 .024 .025 .027 95 15 39 67 00 .006 .006 .007 .007 .008 147 598 073 573 100 .305 .310 ,315 .320 .325 ,015 .016 .016 .017 .017 576 094 620 154 697 3.3797 3.3285 3.2789 3.2309 3.1845 3.278 3.225 3.174 3.125 3.076 69 81 60 00 92 .028 .029 .031 .032 .034 37 79 26 77 33 .008 .009 ,009 .OlO .Oll 654 235 846 49 16 .018 .018 .019 .019 .020 249 809 378 956 542 3.1395 3.0959 3.0536 3.0126 2.9729 3.030 2.985 2.941 2.898 2.857 30 07 18 55 14 .035 .037 ,039 ,041 .042 94 60 30 06 88 .Oll .012 .013 .014 .015 86 59 36 17 01 .265 ,270 .275 TRANSMISSION 42 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table 3 .-Functions z All plan-profile coth Z l/Z 23 24 0.355 .360 .365 ,370 .375 0.021 .021 ,022 ,022 .023 137 740 352 973 602 2.9343 2.8968 2.8603 2.8249 2.7905 2.816 2.777 2.739 2.702 2.666 90 78 73 70 67 0.043 .046 ,048 ,050 ,052 74 66 63 65 73 0.015 .016 .017 .018 .019 88 80 75 74 78 ,380 ,385 ,390 .395 .400 ,024 .024 .025 .026 .026 240 887 543 207 880 2.7570 2.7245 2.6928 2.6620 2.6319 2.631 2.597 2.564 2.531 2.500 58 40 10 65 00 .054 .057 ,059 .061 .064 87 07 32 63 00 .020 .021 .023 .024 .025 85 97 13 34 60 .405 .410 .415 .420 .425 .027 .028 ,028 .029 .030 562 252 95 1 659 376 2.6027 2.5742 2.5464 2.5193 2.4929 2.469 2.439 2.409 2.380 2.352 14 02 64 95 94 .066 ,068 .071 .074 .076 43 92 47 09 77 .026 .028 .029 .031 ,032 90 26 66 12 63 .430 ,435 .440 ,445 .450 .031 ,031 .032 .033 .034 102 856 579 331 092 2.4672 2.4421 2.4175 2.3936 2.3702 2.325 2.298 2.272 2.247 2.222 58 85 73 19 22 .079 .082 .085 .088 .091 51 32 18 12 13 .034 19 .035 81 .037 48 .039 21 .04101 ,455 ,460 ,465 .470 ,475 .034 .035 .036 .037 .038 861 640 427 223 028 2.3474 2.3251 2.3033 2.2821 2.2613 2.197 2.173 2.150 2.127 2.105 80 91 54 66 26 .094 .097 ,100 .103 .107 20 34 5 8 2 .042 .044 .046 ,048 ,050 86 77 75 80 91 .480 ,485 ,490 .495 .500 .038 .039 .040 .041 .042 842 665 497 338 188 2.2409 2.2210 2.2016 2.1826 2.1640 2.083 2.061 2.040 2.020 2.000 33 86 82 20 00 .llO ,114 .117 .121 .125 6 1 6 3 0 ,053 .055 .057 .060 .062 08 33 65 04 50 The loading conditions, other conductor data manufacturers’ f(z) of Z-Continued catalogs. conductor required The horizontal size, and maximum may be obtained and drawings. Procedure steps: 1. Determine c from c2 = a2 + b2 2. Determine b’ from 21’= b(w + v)/W’ 3. Determine a’ from a’ = dn vertical tension are determined by previous studies. from tables shown in appendix C or from spacing of supports can be determined from the CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS 4. Determine coth Z from coth Z = 1 +O.l67t$y (-$) where : A = T,‘(max) - 0.5 w’b’ 0.5 w’c For short spans, 0.5 w’c zJ= A T,‘(max) - 0.5 w’b’ 5. From table 3, determine Z from coth Z found in step 4 6. Determine S, from S, = (S-c) + c where s-c=$f(Z)+Z 24 Find f(Z) from table 3 or from f(Z) = 0.1 67(Z2 + Z4 /20) 7. Determine values for “No-load Chart” a. Assume values for Z (usually two values smaller and three or four values larger than the basic Z value found in step 5) b. Find S-c (from step 6) for each value of Z assumed in step 7.a. c. Determine So (from step 6) for each assumed value of Z d. Determine values for T, and T, by using the assumed values of Z in the formulas: T, = 0.5 w S, coth Z + 0.5 wb, and T, = 0.5 w S,, i 0 + 0.5 w s, e. Determine values for d from d = 0.25 cZ + ““;,;“’ Z3 for assumed values of Z f. Find the slope of the temperature lines from slope equals AE/S, 8. Determine values for “Full-load Chart” a. Find S-c for each value of Z assumed in step 7.a., where smc = (9 f(z) + Cd2 @‘I2 z4 72c3 b. Determine S,, for each assumed value of Z, where S, = (S-c) + c c. Determine horizontal spacing of the temperature lines from (Sol) (5.9, for increments of 5..5 OC from minus 7 to 48 OC, or (Sol) (lo), for increments of 10 OF from 20 to 120 OF. 43 TRANSMISSION 44 LINE DESIGN MANUAL 9. Prepare graph: a. Plot the tensions for the assumed values of 2 against the slack S-c. This will give four curves: T,’ and T,’ for full load, and T, and T, for no load b. Plot sag d against slack S-c on the same graph c. Find the maximum average tension at full-load conditions by drawing a vertical line from the point of maximum tension on the full-load curve T,’ down to the full-load curve T, d. Starting at the maximum average tension point found in step 9.c., draw temperature lines down to the no-load T, curve. The slope of these lines was determined in step 7.e., and their horizontal spacing was found in step 8.b. e. Determine the sag at every 5.5 OC from minus 7 to 48 OC or at every 10 OF from 20 to 120 OF by drawing vertical lines from the points where the temperature lines intersect the no-load T, curve down to the sag curve f. Label all parts of graph Figure 19 shows \ the inclined span used for the following example calculations: support a= m ft) ft) c = 583.69 m (1915 ft) 545.59 (1790 b= 207.26 m (680 h WI w+v INSULATOR STRING. SWING DUE TO WIND FORCE Figure 19.-Sag on inclined span-parameter Zmethod. 104-D-10.55. CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS Example Metric Loading = 6-mm ice, 0.38-kPa wind, at minus 9.4 OC Conductor = 1092 mm’ , ACSR 84/l 9 Bluebird diameter = 45 mm area = 1181 mm* E = 5 1.46 GPa (initial) a = 0.000 020 7 per OC w = 36.6453 N/m h = (45 + 12) (0.38) = 2 1.66 N/m v=9.1314N/m w’ z&36.6453 + 9.1314)2 + (21.66)2 = 50.64 N/m a = 545.59 m b = 207.26 m c = 583.69 m = 18736m = 207.26 a’ = dc’2_02 = d(583.69)2 - (1 87.36)2 = 552.80 m A= T,‘(max) - 0.5 w’b’ = 88 964 - 0.5 (50.64) (187.36) = 5 699 0.5 w’c ’ 0.5(50.64) (583.69) A2 = 32.479 coth 2 = 1 + O.l,,;$r ($)= 1 + 0.167 (5G)2(3+9) 5.699 = 5h729 Z= 0.17822 f(Z) = 0.005 305 (0.005 305) + (545.59j2 (207.2612 (o 178 2214 . 72(583 69)3 = 2.7054 + 0.0009 = 2.7063 S, = (S-c) + c = 2.7063 + 583.69 = 586.40 For “No-Load Table” a = 545.59 0.5 w = 18.3226 c/4 = 145.92 b = 207.26 c = 583.69 w = 36.6453 0.5 wb = 3797.55 a2 lc = 509.98 3a2 - 2b2 = 9 6023 * 144c a2b2 172c3 = 0.8931 b2 /3c2 = 0.0420 45 46 TRANSMISSION 2 s-c 0.16 2.179 585.87 10 735 71462 67 166 23.39 SO 0.5 ws, T, Ti? d 0.17 2.461 586.15 10 740 67 581 63 254 24.85 LINE DESIGN 0.1782 2.706 586.40 10 744 64 747 60 402 26.06 MANUAL 0.18 2.759 586.45 10 74.5 64 135 59 776 26.32 0.19 3.075 586.77 10 751 61061 56 670 27.79 0.20 3.408 587.10 10 757 58 298 53 875 29.26 0.21 3.758 587.45 10 764 55 806 51 352 30.73 AE/S, = 103 640 “Full-Load Table” For a’ = 552.80 b’ = 187.36 0.5 w’ = 25.32 0.5 w’b’ = 4743.96 (u’)~ /c = 523.54 (a’)? (b’)* /72c3 = 0.7492 c = 583.69 w’ = 50.64 Z s-c 1 SO 0.5 ws, T,’ Te’ 0.16 2.237 585.93 14 836 98 258 92 806 0.17 2.526 586.22 14 843 92 895 87 399 AS = &x(5.5) = 586.47(0.000 Results of these from nlinus 9.5 U.S. 0.1782 2.778 586.47 14 849 88 981 83 459 0.18 2.833 586.52 14 851 88 138 82 598 metric calculations to 48 o C. are shown on figure 20 along Loading = l/4-in ice, 8-lb/ft2 wind, at 15 OF Conductor = 2 156 kcmil, ACSR 84/ 19 Bluebird diameter = 1.762 in area = 1.83 10 in2 E = 7 463 320 lb/in2 (initial) a = 0.000 011 5 per OF w = 2.511 lb/ft h = 1.762 + 0.5 (8) (1) = 1.5080 lb/ft 12 v = 0.6257 lb/ft w’ = x/(2.51 1 + 0.6257)2 + (1 .5080)2 = 3.480 lb/ft u= 179oft b = 680 ft c= 1915 ft a’ =,/m 3(~‘)~ - Zb’12 = 1o o7 144c (b’)2 /3c2 = 0.0343 0.19 3.157 586.85 14 859 83 887 78 303 0.203.498 587.19 14 868 80 073 14 442 0.21 3.858 587.55 14 877 76 62.5 70 950 020 7)(5.5) = 0.066 77 Grstoniarv b’=b(y) c/4 = 145.92 =680($$)=612.918ft =&19;5)2 - (612.918)2 = 1814.265 ft with initial sags for temperatures CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS Temp. Sag (“Cl (m) -9.5 24.8 -7.0 25.0 90 000 In { 80 000 Ec zi 5 z 70 000 k 60 000 3 SLACK (S-c), Figure 20.-Results 104-D-1056. of example problem on an inclined meters span using parameter Zmethod (metric). 48 TRANSMISSION A= T, ‘(max) - 0.5 w’b’ LINE DESIGN MANUAL = 20 000 - 0.5(3.480) (612.918) = 5.682 0.5(3.480) (1915) 0.5 w’c A2 = 32.286 ’ coth 2 = 1 +0.167 A3 O( Z= 0.178 75 f(Z) = 0.005 336 = 2 i2 > 1 +0.167 (‘8;;;2565)2 5.682 (0.005 336) + (179o)2 (j&) = 5’6558 (680)2 72(1915)3 (0.178 7514 = 8.9280 + 0.002 99 = 8.93 10 so = (S-c) + c = 8.9310 + 1915 = 1923.93 For “No-Load Table” Z s-c a= 1790 0.5 w = 1.2555 c/4 = 478.75 b = 680 c = 1915 0.5 wb = 853.74 a2/c= 1673.16 3~’ - 2b2 = 31 5. 144c . w = 2.511 a2 b2 /72c3 = 2.93 b2 /3c2 = 0.04203 I so 0.5 w&J Tl Te d 0.16 7.15 1 922.15 2 413.26 16 135 15 099 16.73 0.17 8.10 1923.10 2 414.45 15 193 14 220 81.54 0.1788 8.93 1923.93 2 415.49 14511 14 093 85.781 0.18 9.05 1 924.05 2 415.64 14 419 13 439 86.36 0.19 10.09 1 925.09 2 416.95 13 727 12 740 91.18 0.20 11.18 1926.18 2 418.32 13 106 12 112 96.00 0.21 12.33 1 927.33 2 419.76 12 545 11544 100.83 AE/S, = 7 100 For “Full-Load Table” a’ = 1814.26 b’ = 612.92 c= 1915 w’ = 3.480 Z S-C so 0.5 w’s0 7.1’ Te’ AS= &(lO) 0.16 7.34 1 922.34 3 344.87 22 150 20 924 0.5 w’ = 1.740 0.5 w’b’ = 1066.48 (a’)2/c = 1718.82 (u’)~ (b’>2 /72c3 = 2.45 0.17 8.29 1 923.29 3 346.52 20 941 19 705 0.1788 9.17 1 924.17 3 348.06 20 003 18 758 1 3 19 18 = 1924.17(0.000 011 5) (10) = 0.2213 0.18 9.30 924.30 348.28 868 622 c/4 = 478.75 3(a’>2 - 2(b’12 = 33 o8 144c (b’)3 /3c2 = 0.034 15 0.19 10.36 1 925.36 3 350.13 18 910 17 654 0.20 11.48 1 926.48 3 352.08 18 050 16 783 0.21 12.66 1 927.66 3 354.13 17 273 15 996 CHAPTER Kes~~lts 15 to 120 of these calculations II-CONDUCTOR are shown on figure SAGS AND TENSIONS 21 along with initial 49 sags for temperatures from OF. 22 20 000 I \\ ! T TL \ 000 I 10 000 Temp. (OF) Sag (ft) 70 80 90 loo 110 120 81.2 81.75 82.75 83.7 84.6 85.5 86.4 87.3 88.25 89.2 90. I 91.0 t-- T 16 000 I-- :: El 0 0. c I \Tr !!E 14 000 000 000 000 8 I 0 SLACK Figure 21.-Results of example problem on an inclined I IO 9 (s-c). II ._ IZ .- I3 feet span using parameter Zmethod (U.S. customary). 104-D-1057. 50 TRANSMISSION 15. Galloping Conductors.- LINE DESIGN MANUAL A galloping conductor is a phenomenon usually caused blowing on an iced conductor. relatively light wind of about 48 to 56 km/h (30 to 35 mi/h) may be in the form of either rime or glaze. A few cases of galloping conductors without the of ice have been In 1930, Mr. noted, but A. E. Davison the In by the reaction lifting force. 1932, Mr. instructor at Harvard temperature will melt are extremely of the Hydroelectric of wind J. P. Den formation which, of aerodynamic cases and Hartog, Power Commission School, conductor, An airfoil of about 0 ‘C (32 a portion of the radial and a periodic noted Engineering with the stability. glaze, OF) ice, research presented sun will a theory cross may has published is the result several of the with Westinghouse that sag of the conductor galloping increase) than the articles conductor on the which Electric lift controls and CO. was the result of a glaze and a light and around wind is blowing. the conductor, type The sun and then shade at the bottom of the conductor where takes shape and the possibility of galloping at 0 OC (32 OF), with resultant presented aerodynamic 13 mm (l/2 conductors, This method in) of ices and a wind of 48.3 km/h (30 mi/h) or a wind pressure of 0.096 kPa (2 lb/ft2). This approximates condition under which most cases of galloping have occurred. The path of conductor approximates a loop of elliptical shape. The major axis of the ellipse is slightly larger uses a 6 percent presence capable of causing a certain be formed at a freezing-thawing conductors becomes very real. Based on numerous observations and on several motion pictures of galloping developed an empirical method for determining the conductor oscillation path. on the stabilized Canada of the conductor section easily is shining run down the water will be blown back by the light wind into the it will again freeze. As this process continues, the airfoil of Ontario, twisting engineer has an airfoil cross section when the the water a ice rare. and work on galloping conductors, Mr. Davison suggested that galloping the results of his pioneer subject since that time. produced these by The sag under the loading Davison is based velocity the loading oscillation (the Bureau condition described above, and is inclined from the vertical in a direction by an angle equal to the angle of sideswing. In level a small distance above the normal level of the points opposite the direction of the conductor sideswing spans, the highest point of the full ellipse is only of attachment of the conductor to the insulator string. overhead not As long overlap, as the ellipses galloping will in which the for all conductors not and ground wires of a transmission the conductors to come in contact with each other overhead ground wires. Contact would re’sult in outages and possible damage to the Observations of lines with long spans and heavy conductors indicate that the conductors in two loops cause magnitude of oscillation, or size of ellipse, is approximately line do or with the conductors. may dance half size; that is, the major axis of the ellipse is approximately one-half of the total conductor sag in the span. Application of this method to several existing lines, in regions subject to sleet conditions, has shown that those lines with sufficient ground wires to prevent overlap spacing of the between ellipses, conductors and between had no outages under the conductors and sleet conditions. overhead The lines that showed an overlap of the ellipses had a record of many outages under sleet conditions. There have also been observations where iced conductors have galloped in a manner similar to a skip rope being turned, with the midpoint rising as far above the points of support as it hangs below those points when at rest. This a designer cannot There ellipses. * For NFX: sort of galloping is rare, fortunately, economically be expected to meet. is no definite However, our heavy loading because clearance limits are indicated which length of span where galloping will change from full-sag ellipses to half-sag experience indicates that for our line locations and conditions, we should use area. CHAPTER full-sag ellipses to gallop in spans in two be used. and ground overhead Experience the ends a weak To spot and determine the wires to prevent ground conductors structure and with that spacing required ground wires, and 1. For loading conditions a temperature of minus 1 ‘C for the given span length. a. Figures 22 and conductor, and figures steel, 7-wire overhead the wear of time. all hardware conductors a particular hardware, 24 and ground 25 show wire. b. From the calculations on conditions conducive to galloping, the and between For a 289.5-m (950-ft) s p an, based on the wires, proceed span ordinarily in relatively and length overhead with span for given a given as follows: (2-lb/ft2) wind pressure, and overhead ground wire based on a 213.4-m for a 242 mm2 (477 for a lo-mm a 213.4-m (700-ft) kcmil) (3/8-in) (700-ft) ruling and sags ruling ACSR span. 24/7 high-strength span, and for sag WI 5255 4386 213.4-m conductors check If galloping failure permissible for carefully vibrations, cause maximum mm Conductor Overhead ground wire can the sag calculations these figures, the sags are: very and span of conductors occurred. wind and of 13 mm (l/2 in) of ice,3 0.096-kPa (30 OF), d e t ermine the conductor Assume a 289.5-m (950-ft) 23 show the sag calculations and condition or to determine are likely to 53 percent between to have spot loading ground conductors equal of contact is known in the period the axis reduced. galloping weakened overhead spans, major the probability on the between for longer to examine or excessive contact, In with is greatly where in a short conductors overlap, practice of a line concentrate possibly in length. of galloping, in a conductor overhead given do not 51 SAGS AND TENSIONS size ellipses, it is good part a failure, weather ellipses as a result in any ft) so one-half If these wires, clamps in producing moderate loops, has shown of the has created slow up to 183 m (600 or more the sag, should II-CONDUCTOR (17.24) (14.39) ruling span, the sags are: sag Conductor Overhead ground wire 2. Determine loading conditions 0, the given angle in l., a. Conductor B = tan-l of sideswing, and using heavy loading area. the force (ft> 9675 8075 (31.75) (26.50) conductors triangles 4.4898 N/m 21.186 N/m Or b. Overhead ground wire 13= tan- l 3 For NEST for the mm 3.3079 N/m 11.777 N/m Or and shown overhead on figures = 1 lo 58, ground wires for the 22, 23, 24, and 25. 52 TRANSMISSION DCm-576 LINE DESIGN MANUAL (S-78) Ltnear Force Dead Area Temp. 0.000 NO Ice. No Wind Figure Factory Load Fwce (W’) Creep 0.000 Jag Total O.CO,! 003 (A).arn& C&f. 01 Llnear Exp.: 0 /9peperOC (W’) 22.-Conductor sag and tension calculation form for example problem on galloping conductors (metric). CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR ;;;tL SAGS AND TENSIONS 53 SAGCALCULATIONS LOADING .d- Vv Weight Factors: Dead Weight (W’) + hn. 5i ICY (w”) lb Wind Resultant: 0. L 14% lb/f1 D, L/53 tb,tt lb/l1 e/. (W”‘) ‘F LOADING UNSTRESSED LENGTH Inch Ice. Creep o.ooa*-Total O.ooa I.lb/ft Modulus. (E) Final/D,fl Initial&@/-x FinaIM { ~~~ Initial% 3 &q Area (A) &&.%k in2 Temp. Coolf. of Linear Exp.: 0.004 o/k Permanent set 0.00 per OF SACFlCTOR 1 i! 6 I SPANLENGTH(S) AFEET SAG,H 1 SW,lb x 106 lb/in2 106 lb/i&? -lb /I/ lb 1 TENSION,lb NO Ice. No Wind (W’) Llb/ft2 SPANLENGTH(S) -FEET calculation for example Wind(W”’ No Ice. No Wind (W’) Figure 23.-Conductor customary). 3. Construct at an angle The major to one-half method, sag and tension half-sag of 28 from ellipses the plane as shown form on figure of the conductor 26. when The the problem major 0.096-kPa axis of the ellipse is equal to one-half the sag plus 6 percent, of the major axis. The easiest way to construct the ellipses which is explained in numerous drafting or related texts. on galloping conductors axis ellipse is inclined wind is blowing. of the (24b/fta) (U.S. and the minor axis is equal is by the use of the trammel TRANSMISSION 54 DCm-578 LINE DESIGN - (3-78) ;;;pL' llkili CONDUCTOR,f&mm Code MANUAL ,/d’!‘c %ei: ?-W/b SAG CALCULATIONS LOADIME &a+---- Name Linear Rated Breaking Strength olamerer~22&!5L Tension 18 &o N mm kPa l”~tl~l.-~%,-&-%~N .-a% %a!.2 0/o N 50 -%2o-zoN F,nal.~%. /g O’o g by Dare AL/? Temp. Co&f. o.cm 6. L/L N/C?7 17, 88 L5 Ice. NO Wmd ground FIMI w GPa Inttlalfig*5 0 //pePc Fanal SAG FACTOR ? wire sag and tension 9 AE GPa Lf? 924 AE k SAG,mm : 77 E SW,N : TENSION, N m calculation form for example problem on galloping conductors (3-78) !;,fL /t CONDUCTOR3 f Code 00 Q O.C%.& (W’) Figure 24.-Overhead (metric). DC-576 (E) Exp.. SPAN LENGTH(S) 2 1.3. 36 NO 0.00 N/m lnltial LENGTH1 o.ooo* Total Modulus. of Linear SW E ser creep - /TEMP. ; oc “UftSTRESSEO LOADING N (A)Amm2 Permanent N/m (W”‘) Area N/m (W”)//. W Ind Resultant 25 (W’I m,&?8j ForC2 mm Ice od$&i? Fmal.&C. Computed Factor. Load A Llmltatlons Loaded Force Dead i/i!? .?tee(. 7--w/ re LOADlNG -LM Welghl Name Rated SAGCALCULATIONS Breaking Diameter Load m Factors: Dead /nib Inch Wetght + L”. Ice lb A (W’) m,73 Resultant: Area (A) o.ooo [TEMP.. oF /UNSTRESSED LENGTH LOADING No Ice. NO Wind Gc7fl,iis -lb/@ Permanent Inch /) 5.D79 226 ou creep 0.006-- Ib/ft Total O.OO+ Ib/ft In2 of Linear Permanen~OO~ Ib/ft Modulus. per ?= SAG FACTOR Y B (E) Exp.: 1 Final~x 106 lb/in2 lnttlaf~ox 106 lb/in2 Final AE d! fb lntttal AE tb SAG.11 / 1 TENSION, lb SW,lb (W’) 120 //3 (W’“) Coeff. 453 0. Wind TemD. Iblft 5.967 (W”) lo.999 764 b.am Qq? 51 0. J/L? lo&z. 967 ~9-7 In.o/L WindW”“i3o Figure 25.-Overhead (U.S. customary). 51 m 97 / 2 ,229 I 14f. I I /437 1.3 1 I f/.24 JqQS V. /+f.JP 1 /4/. I 1 S ~6 SPANLENGTH(S).-FEET Ice. Set & creep l,g,dnn o. 994 373 IO, 000 llp7 51 0. /630 1 I ground wire sag and tension calculation form for example problem I 5% , on galloping conductors FAal CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR Type HS Structure 289.5-m (950ft) Span Based on 213.4-m (70%ft) ruling span 3658-mm (12-ft) Pole spacing NESCHeavy Loading Conductor ful I- load tension = 33 362 N (7500 Conductor: 242 mm* Sag Half sag +6% Major axis Minor axis lb) OGWful I- load tension =2l 418 N (4815 lb) Half-sag ellipses SAGS AND TENSIONS OGW: 8= ll”58’ IO-mm (i-in) 2 9f sag +6% Major axis Minor axis (477 mm 9675 4835 290 5128 2564 55 kcmil\fPjCSR. 24/7 (3.35) (15.88) ( 0.95) (16.83) ( 8.42) H.S. Steel Cf_t) mm 8075 4038 242 4250 2125 (26.50) (13.25) ( 0.79) (14.04) ( 7.02) 8 = 15’ 42’ 4023 (13.2 Figure 26.-Half-sag ellipses for example problem on galloping mm ft) _ conductors. 104-D-1058. TRANSMISSION 56 16. Broken conductor Conductors.-The is important condition with crossings; structures. The the of the nature Using given this work requirements and also computation over from of sags and from the the railroad, waterway, of determining tensions under in spans of assuring highway, standpoint of sags and tensions standpoint this to a broken under communication the condition adjacent compliance unbalanced is somewhat this line, loads and on the complex due to variables. a technique in determination in design clearance powerline LINE DESIGN MANUAL by G. R. Wiszneauckas section for a 345-kV shown in appendix transmission line span A, a broken over conductor Interstate Highway problem is No. 25 (Sta. 789 + 95 and 790 + 83) and the Colorado and Southern Railroad crossing (Sta. 795 + 48), both located in Colorado. Figure 27 shows the profile portion of the plan and profile drawing for this example problem. Please note that this figure is predominately in U.S. customary references to this figure, such as stationing, are also in those units. The conductor as 644 mm2 (1272 kcmil), ACSR, 45/7 stranding, with a full-load (NESC heavy) (13 800 lb). Assuming a broken conductor in the span on the at Sta. 797+30, the ruling span for the three remaining spans to be 320.95 m (1053 ft). At 49 OC (120 “F) f’ma 1 conditions, AE d HO HI LJ Ll P s s basic nomenclature used of cross-sectional Product Horizontal displacement of insulator string Initial horizontal tension in conductor Horizontal tension in conductor after a change = = Length Initial = = Final span Horizontal = = of insulator span length length force caused Force Force (weight) (weight) W 8 4 = = Total Angle vertical load, of deflection = Change The resulting values indicated - 2.110 + problem are and modulus of elasticity of the of 4 in span conductor length by Wwhen the insulator string is deflected by an angle 8 string acting W = w l/2 of insulator on insulator string + w2 string length by the curves show the suspension insulator string on the structure string on the structure at Sta. 787 +00 2 110 mm (83 in), and the insulator (37.5 in). This will result in a new span length of 312.789 m (1026.21 ft) 6.92 + 3.13 = 1026.21 ft]. The 24 310-N 0.955 = 312.789 m, or 1030 - at Sta. 797 + 30 will deflect will deflect about 955 mm [313.944 example sag in conductor span length of conductor of insulator of conductor in span in this A. string = w2 area has been assumed tension of 61 385 N is: = = = = = Wl section = General symbol for General symbol for Unit force (weight) W in this therefore, northwest side of the steel structure to a dead-end structure is calculated the tension for this ruling span is 24 310 N (5465 lb), with a corresponding sag of 11 211 mm (36.78 ft). The calculations, tables, nomenclature, and broken conductor curves all in accordance with the broken conductor thesis ‘shown in appendix The units; CHAPTER (5465~lb) the expanded been the tension conductor to make shown figs. 28 and in the the as a dashed adjacent 29) is used adjacent sag curve curve for span. plotting on figure to compute The I.-Broken Highway the calculated on the corresponding sag is 15 736 plan-profile. 27 to indicate the The expected centerline (Sta. 789 +95 and result 790+83) 795 + 48) Ruling span = where S = span length. Metric s, m S3, m3 304.373 341.376 3 13.944 28 198 004 39 783 130 30 942 582 959.693 m 98 923 716 m3 Rulingspan=dz=321. 058m U.S. Customary s, ft s3 ) ft3 998.6 1120 1030 995 805 877 1404928 000 1092727000 3 148.6 ft 3 493 460 877 ft3 Ruling span =dw= sag in this mm sag in the Conductor Calculations centerline (Sta. Span Calculations: 59 SAGS AND TENSIONS span. Example Railroad Ruling (from broken II-CONDUCTOR 1053.34 ft (51.64 ft) crossing of a conductor span which span break with is has in TRANSMISSION DCm-576 LINE DESIGN MANUAL (3-78) f;;LL SAGCALCULATIONS LOADMG Linear VY Force maa -Lz oa Factor, Load Face kPa //. Wtnd (W”‘) (A).zm& Temp. Co&f. TEMP..1 oc UNSTRESSED LENGTH LOADING Lmm O./q/q2 Permanent Wind Set (W”‘) h Creep set Permanent creep N/m T?P9 43 of Ltnear N/m Total Modulus. (I3 Fmal lnltlal 01~perOC SAG FACTOR Final AE lnltial AE SAG,mm ~ 44 3) 1 SW,N Ice. No Wind -mm :/ 800 , 7,/L, / 0 0, g nno No Ice. (W’) ‘5.5 32 I/. j 49 1 454 002 JR/ Ice. kPa Permanenf No Ice. /L5 / 0. ah87 D.03.3 q/E GPa f ?zGPa c//9 009 N 924 827 N 1 TENSI0N.N // 7 17 g97 I I , SPAN LENGTH(S) 350.59 15.5 19 (W’) Ice kPa Wind (W”‘) Set 6 Creep No Win4 &!dtk 46, SPAN LENGTH(S)-m i-/p j / / I 1 300 !o. 000 o&j j/, no/ 3 I/, -18 No / O.OO/ 0.1506 I 1z -mm 0,/q/53 Permanent 3 1 ~0.000 mm Ice No Wind csf/ ’ Ice /3 46 4 0.000 SPAN LENGTH(S)-m l-/g I No 0.004 N/II7 ’ Exp.: v K = r/.37$2 f/ESC N/m I/of?0 ’ ii Ice kPa 92.77 L75z, cw.,ao* 37. ResulIanl #. /977 X~=#524/ mm Ice (W”) Area o.ow J 018 m I I I I 1 I SPANLENGTH(S)-..&!o,?5 o,oD~ 1/J) ;21 0 239-q i 15, I I I I I 1 I ! 1 eon /gin I I 21 (W’) Wind (W”‘) Set 6 Creep No Wind (W’) I i 1 I-18 -1 I I / I I I I I I I I- ; 15.5 I I 73L !6 SN#LI I problem (metric). 32 I 0.3933 49 Figure 28.-Sag and tension calculation w form for broken 31 conductor /5 /L &Jo CHAPTER DC-573 II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS (3-78) ;;;tL CONDUCTOR &&22 Code kr.&gR ‘-r-A i Name Rated Breakrng Load Diameter/*-qf/‘i Tenston Final Computed k No -Inch __ Permanent 100 lb - ~ lb Area lb Temo. % ___ lb 0.000 Date UNSTRESSED LENGTH (A) *&=a,31 fi lb/l1 a SB/L A: 78/T .1, 00 (W”) Wind (W”‘) /, of Linear o// NESC /977 Permanent :,“::: 73 Set 0.000 o.ooo~ZLJ- Total O.Oo/ Modulus. (E) Final ?,.-?s I SAG FACTOR z; / SAG, f! 1 SW, lb 1 FEET / 05;‘i! (W’) SPAN LENGTH(S) Figure FEET I I 29.4ag 1 I I and tension calculation I I form x 106 lb/In2 Exp.: per OF SPAN LENGTH(S) Ice. dA+s creep (W’) Ib/ft2 Wlnd(W”’ Set 6 Creeo /( = a.30 Ib/ft 1n2 Coeff. i! Ice. No Wind Vu J (W*)~/.. Resultanr: ‘yo ____ To”p”j No Wind lb & ___ Weight Ice lb OF 50 &OF ha Factors: Dead +&on. *OF..XI-4c by Inch Ice. .?1/ ‘F&4 LOADING Ice. Weight Llmlratlons: Inltval.- No LOADING Y$‘$ Inch Loaded, Final, SAG CALCULATIONS for broken conductor problem I (U.S. customary). TENSION, lb TRANSMISSION 62 Horizontal Tension Calculate the Then Ho = and w is the linear T- LINE DESIGN MANUAL Calculations: 49 ’ C (120 o F) sag and SW , where Ho is the force factor. tension horizontal on sag calculation T is tension, Metric and Tabulate component P full line (figs. 28 and tension, s is the 29). sag, U.S. Customary H,, = 5465 - (36.78) (1.434) = 5412 lb HO = 24 310 - (11.211) (20.9277) = 24 075 N H the forms Curves: the data of tension for Hand P the acting in the curves (tables conductor. The p=- 4, 5, 6, and Pforce 7). The H force is the 4 W,d i cos 0 and is the horizontal force which resists the movement of an insulator string of length vertical to any angle 8 while a vertical load ?VTis acting. Plot the Hand Pcurves (figs. 30 and 31) from the data in tables 4, 5, 6, and 7. Table 4.-P curve computations for example problem No. 1 -broken conductor (metric) i= 2286 mm $.=7095N d, mm d/i = 500 1000 1250 1500 1650 1800 1950 2050 2150 0.2187 .4314 .5468 .6562 .7218 .I874 .8530 .8968 .9405 cos e d/i cos 0 p, N 0.9758 .8992 .8313 .I546 .6921 .6164 .5219 .4425 .3398 0.2241 .4864 .6531 .8696 1.0429 1.2174 1.6344 2.0267 2.7678 1 589.99 3 451.01 4633.74 6 169.81 7 399.38 9 063.15 11 596.07 14 379.44 19 637.54 Sill6 ’ WT = vertical force at attachment point, which is one-half the insulator force plus force of conductor. 4 WT has been used in this section for clarity; horizontal is it is shown as Win appendix A. i from the CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR 63 SAGS AND TENSIONS Table 5.-P curve computations for example problem No. l-broken conductor (U.S. customary) ‘WT=15951b d, in d/i = sin e 20 40 50 60 65 70 75 80 85 0.2222 .4444 .5555 .6667 .7222 .7778 .8333 .8889 .9444 i=7.5ft=90in cos dli cos e e 0.9750 .8958 .8315 .7453 .6917 .6285 .5528 .4581 .3288 p, lb 0.2279 .4961 .6681 .8945 1.0441 1.2375 1.5074 1.9404 2.8723 363.50 791.28 1065.62 1426.73 1665.34 1973.81 2404.30 3094.94 4581.32 1 W, = vertical weight at attachment point, which is one-half the insulator weight plus weight of conductor. Table 6.-H curve computations for example problem No. I -broken H,, = 24 075 N 1 2 3 WLO HosinhK N 12 13 14 16 18 20 22 24 000 000 000 000 000 000 000 075 L,, = 321 m 3369.803 431 3369.803 431 3369.803 431 3369.803 431 3369.803 431 3369.803 431 3369.803 431 3369.803 431 ' 4 -- HO-H, (2) (3) AE 0.999 .999 .999 .999 .999 .999 .999 1.000 w = 20.9277 N/m 728 751 773 818 863 908 953 000 3368.886 844 3368.964 350 3369.038 486 3369.190 127 3369.341 768 3369.493 409 3369.645 050 3369.803 431 Numbers in parenthesis are column numbers. 5 6 (4) sinh-‘(5) H, 0.280 .259 .240 .210 .187 .168 .153 .139 741 151 646 574 186 475 166 971 0.277 .256 .238 .209 .186 .167 .152 .139 178 335 382 048 110 688 573 518 conductor (metric) AE = 44 419 008 N 7 8 9 IHl w (6) (7) L o‘I (8) 1 m 1146.8054 1242.3725 1337.9397 1529.0739 1720.2081 1911.3424 2102.4766 2300.7784 317.869 227 318.463 555 318.940 742 319.649 841 320.147 930 320.509 184 320.781 162 321 .OOO001 3.130 2.536 2.059 1.350 0.852 .490 .218 .ooo 77 45 26 16 07 82 84 00 TRANSMISSION 64 LINE DESIGN MANUAL 7.-H curve computations for example problem No. l-broken Table H,, =54121b 1 Lo =1053 2 3 HL lb Ho sinh wA 2700 2900 3200 3500 4000 4500 5000 5412 757.452311 151.452311 757.452311 757.452311 757.452311 757.452311 757.452311 757.452311 4 ft conductor (U.S. Customary) w = 1.4340 Ib/ft 5 6 AE = 9 985 800 I 8 10 G9= HO-HI 1- 7 (2) (3) gf 0.999 728 .999148 .999178 .999 809 .999 859 .999909 .999959 1 .ooo 000 751.246284 751.261433 151.284 157 757.307 638 751.345 510 757.383383 151.421256 151.452311 0.280462 .261125 .236651 .216 314 ,189 336 .168 307 .151484 .139958 ZH1 sinh-1 (5) 0.276910 .258245 .234496 .214120 .188223 ,167 522 A50911 .139 505 (6)(7) w =fO 3765.5904 4044.6304 4463.0404 4881.4505 5578.8006 6276.1506 6973.5007 7548.1172 1042.1573 1044.5056 1046.5651 1048.1451 1050.0586 1051.3933 1052.3780 1053.0001 Loft (81, o= Lo in (81, 122.88 101.88 77.16 58.20 35.28 19.32 1.44 0.00 10.24 8.49 6.43 4.85 2.94 1.61 0.62 0.00 Numbers in parenthesis are column numbers. Read the insulator deflections from 2110 mm 955 mm Then, the 313.944 Read the (Sta. 797+30). corresponding new span length for m (1030 ft) - 2.110 horizontal tension line tension, T = SIC = 16640 + crossing ft) 30 and over obstructions in sag and tension 30 and 31: span + is equal 0.955 31) to: m (3.13 in the ft) = 312.789 m (1026.21 ft). conductor at the first suspension point and figures 28 and 29 to compute the lb), of tension in the conductor may now if desired: (1.5.736)(20.9277) difference in sag due to this in a slightly larger sag than clearances corrections on figures Use this value of tension, 16 640 N (3740 49 ‘C (120 “F) sag. Th e h orizontal component to the The results curves (83 in) at Sta. 797+30 (37.5 in) at Sta. 787+00 m (6.92 (figs. be corrected H + the completed = 16969 N, or 3740 + (51.64)(1.434) = 3814 lh. correction is small, and the use of the corrected horizontal would actually exist; therefore, by ignoring the correction, will be slightly greater are seldom made. than those computed. For these tension actual reasons, the CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS 65 Sag curve for broken conductor: Metric K = Sag/Span2 15 736 = L = 1.6062 x 10-4m-’ (3 13)= (Span)‘, span, m m2 x lo4 48 96 144 192 240 288 366 0.2304 0.9216 2.0736 3.6864 5.7600 8.2944 11.2896 Sag = (K) (Spanj2, m 0.370 1.480 3.331 5.921 9.252 13.322 18.133 3000 2500 z 2 aa emaa .-EE.- .= 2000 .‘= EE 0 5000 10000 HORIZONTAL Figure 30.-Curves for broken conductor 15000 FORCE, problem 20000 newtons (metric). 104-D-1060. 25000 TRANSMISSION 66 U.S. LINE DESIGN MANUAL Custontnry K = Sag/Span’ = 51.64 = 4.9056 x lo- 5ft- ’ (1026)= Span, ft (Span)=, ft= x lo5 200 400 600 800 1000 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 0.4 1.6 3.6 6.4 10.0 14.4 19.6 25.6 32.4 40.0 d=83 in sag = (K) (Span)=, ft 1.96 1.85 17.66 31.40 49.06 70.64 96.15 125.58 158.94 196.22 d, ! ti Curve 60' 0 1000 2000 HORIZONTAL Figure 31.-Curves for broken conductor 3000 4000 sooo FORCE, pounds problem (U.S. customary). 104-D-1061. 6000 CHAPTER The sag template figure for the II-CONDUCTOR Span with reduced 67 SAGS AND TENSIONS tension due to the broken conductor is shown on 32. SAG TEMPLATE FOR EXAMPLE PROBLEM NO. I U.S. Highway No. 25 Sta. 789+ 95 and 790+83 Sta. 795 +48 Rai I road Ruling Span = 313 m (1026 ft) Reduced tension at 49 “C (120 OF), no ice, no wind= I6 640 N (3740 lb) 24.0 14.4 E c 9.6 : t47 4.6 0 168 144 120 96 72 46 24 0 24 SPAN, 600 200 400 The broken conductor to the highway of 9754 clearance to the railroad requirements. Example Any 2.-Unbalanced number template 0 curve plotted tension on figure 96 120 144 168 200 400 600 ft due to broken 27 indicates conductor. there would 104-D-1062. be conductor clearances mm (32 ft) at Sta. 789+95 and 7925 mm (26 ft) at Sta. 790+83. would be 14 326 mm (47 ft). These clearances all meet NESC and The State Condition of real or imaginary shown in appendix involved solution for reduced 72 m SPAN, Figure 32.-Sag 48 problems may be studied by use of the broken A. A hypothetical situation has been assumed using the basic broken conductor concept: to illustrate conductor the thesis use of a more 68 TRANSMISSION A transmission and a series situation. All excepted span (4-lb/ft2) line spans, except plus before a bundle (1150-ft) is loaded wind, equilibrium with of 350.5-m have NESC constant and after of two 18 OC kcmil), for this no wind loading unbalanced (1272 assumed no ice and heavy at minus the MANUAL 644 mm2 sp ans has been one, under LINE DESIGN load conditions (0 “F). 45/7 conductors, of an unbalanced at minus 18 ‘C of 13-mm Figure condition ACSR, study (0 OF). (l/2-in) 33 shows load The ice, 0.19-kPa the conditions for exists. INITIAL CONDITIONS (Before unbalance due to ice) L L --c _ d, ~ L, L2 d, Lo _ _ Conditions d2 LO for L4 L3 d3 _ Lo L5 3 d4 Lo _-~- _ L6 3 LO Lo d, Lo _ equilibrium: H, = H,+ P,; H, =H2+P2; H,=H,+P,; H3=H4+P4; H,= 0, =d,-d,; L, = Lo-O,; L, = Lo-2d, 02=d2-d3; L,=L,-0,; %=d3-d,-, L,=L,-0,; 0,=d,-d,; L,=L,-0,; 0,=d,-d,; L,=L,-0,; H,+P,; H,- H,+P, ; etc. 0,=d,-d,; L,=L,-0,; etc. etc. FINAL CONDITIONS (After unbolonce due to ice) Figure 33.-Conditions and for equilibrium before and after unbalanced Conductor data and data for plotting the Pand Hcurves the graphical solution is shown on figures 34 and 35. The 1. procedure Lay out for the graphical the graph axes in span length $ and insulator horizontal force. Allow room and 2. fourth Plot 3. Plot quadrants. the PL 1 curve PL 2 curve 4. Plot the PL1 simplify calculations, +L2 computed. the this solution is: using millimeters (inches) condition. are shown for the deflection a! Use newtons (pounds) on the graph for the development by plotting d versus PI P2 by plotting d versus curve by plotting dversus is taken as the average 104-D-1063. in tables ordinate values table using table 10 or 11. + P2)/2 using table force 15, of change for the abscissa of curves in both using (PI P 8 through values of the first 10 or 11. in the series 10 or 11. To of spans being CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR 69 SAGS AND TENSIONS Table 8. -Line data computations for example problem No. 2unbalanced condition (metric) Two 644 mm’, ACSR, 4517 (duplex conductors) Maximum conductor tension = 61 385 N, initial Twenty 177 928-N insulator units per suspension string -18 ‘C, no load Insulator string vertical force (w,) 1 156.5 N 0.5 WI 578.3N Conductor vertical force, 350.5-m span (w,) w,=o.5 20.9277 N/m (no load) x 2 cond. 43.889 N/m (full load) x 2 cond. wr +w2 Insulator string length (i) Tension (7) final 1 156.5 N 578.3 N 14 670.3 N 30 766.2 N 15 248.6 N 31 344.5 N 3 734 mm 3734mm 30 514 N Conductor vertical force (w) -18 OC, 13-mm ice, 0.19-kPa wind 20.927 7 N/m 57 403 N 43.889 N/m Sag (s), 350.5-m span 10 621 mm 11 865 mm Horizontal 30 292 N 56 882 N 44 419 008 N 44 419 008 N tension (Ho = T - SW) Area times final modulus (4E) Table 9.-Line data computations for example problem No. 2unbalanced condition (U. S. customary) Two 1272 kcmil, ACSR, 4517 (duplex conductors) Maximum conductor tension = 13 800 lb, initial Twenty 40 000-lb insulator units per suspension string 0 OF, no load 0 OF, l/2-in ice, 4-lb/ft2 wind Insulator string weight (wr) 260 lb 260 lb 0.5 w1 130 lb 130 lb Conductor weight, 1150-ft span b3) wT=o.5wr+w2 Insulator string length (i) Tension (7’) final Conductor weight (w) Sag (s), 1150-ft span Horizontal tension (Ho = T - SW) Area times final modulus (.4E) 1.4340 lb/ft (no load) x 2 cond. 3.0073 lb/ft (full load) x 2 cond. 3 298.2 lb 6 916.6 lb 3 428.2 lb 7 046.8 lb 147 in 147 in 6 860 lb 12 904 lb 1.434 lb/ft 34.85 ft 3.007 3 lb/ft 38.93 ft 6 810 lb 12 787 lb 9 985 800 lb 9 985 800 lb 70 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table 1O.-P curve computations for example problem No. 2unbalanced condition (metric) p=- WTd i case WT = 15 248.6 N (no load), 31 344.5 N (full load) d, mm d/i = sin 6 500 1000 1500 2000 2500 3000 3250 3375 3500 3600 3650 3700 3734 0.133 90 .26181 ,401 71 .535 62 .66952 .80343 .870 38 .903 86 .937 33 .964 11 .97750 ,990 89 1 .ooo 00 cos e 0.990 99 .96341 .915 17 .84446 .I4279 .59540 .492 38 .427 83 .34844 .265 50 .21094 .134 61 .ooo 00 i = 3734 mm d/i cos e No load Full load PI P2 2 0.135 12 .217 96 .43866 .634 28 .90136 1.349 40 1.767 70 2.112 66 2.690 08 3.631 30 4.63402 7.357 91 2 060.39 4 238.50 6 688.95 9 671.88 13 744.48 20 576.46 26 954.95 32 215.11 41 019.95 55 372.24 70 662.32 112 197.83 4 235.21 8 712.52 13 749.58 19 881.19 28 252.68 42 296.27 55 407.67 66 220.27 84 319.21 113 821.28 145 251.04 230630.01 3 147.84 6415.52 10 219.29 14 716.51 20 998.62 31436.43 41 181.40 49 217.79 62699.72 84 596.94 107956.91 171414.29 p, +p2 Table 11 .-P curve computations for example problem No. 2unbalanced condition (U. S. customary) p= -WTd i cos 0 WT = 3428.2 lb (no load), 7046.8 lb (full load) d, in 20 40 60 80 100 120 130 135 140 142 144 146 147 d/i = sin e cos e 0.136 05 .272 11 .40816 .54422 .68027 .81633 .88435 .91837 .952 38 .965 99 .97959 .99320 1 .ooo 00 0.990 70 .96227 .91291 .83894 .73296 .57759 .46682 .39572 .30491 .25858 .20101 .116 42 .ooo 00 i= 147 in dli cos 8 No load PI Full load 0.137 33 .28278 .447 10 .64870 .928 11 1.413 34 1.894 41 2.32076 3.123 48 3.735 75 4.873 34 8.531 18 470.79 969.43 1 532.75 2 223.87 3 181.75 4 845.21 6494.42 7 956.03 10 707.91 12 806.90 16 706.78 29 246.59 967.74 1 992.69 3 150.62 4 571.26 6540.21 9 959.52 13 349.53 16 353.93 22010.54 26 325.08 34 341.45 60 117.52 p2 PI +p2 2 719.27 1481.06 2 341.69 3 397.57 4 860.98 7 402.37 9921.97 12 154.98 16359.23 19565.99 25 524.12 44 682.06 Table 12.-H curve computation for example problem No. 2-unbalanced full-load condition (metric) H,=56882N 1 Hl, N L,=350.5 2 3 Ho sinh “2 HO I-- 4 -H, AE WO m AE = 44 419 008 N w = 43.889 N/m 5 6 (4) (2) (3) H, sinh-’ 7 (5) 2Hl W 8 9 (6) (7) G= Lo - (8, m 13500 15 750 18 000 22500 27000 7715.007 734 7 715.007 734 7715.007734 7 715.007'734 7715.007734 0.999 023 .999074 ,999 125 .999226 .999 327 7701.470171 7707.863 637 1708.257 102 7 709.036 318 7 709.815 534 0.570 924 .489 388 .428231 .342624 .285 549 0.543 733 .471700 .416123 .336252 .281804 615.1883 717.7197 820.2511 1025.3139 1230.3766 334.50 338.55 341.33 344.76 346.73 16.00 11.95 9.17 5.74 3.77 31500 36000 40500 45 000 50000 7 715.007734 7715.007 734 7 715.001734 7 715.007 734 7715.007 734 .999 429 .999530 .999 631 .999733 .999845 7710.602465 7711.381680 7 712.160 896 7 712.947 827 7 713.811 908 .244781 .214 205 .190424 .171399 .154276 .242400 .212600 .189 292 .170 571 .153 670 1435.4394 1640.5022 1845.5649 2050.6277 2278.4752 347.95 348.77 349.35 349.78 350.13 2.55 1.73 1.15 0.72 0.37 56882 60000 65 000 70000 75 000 7715.007734 7 715.007734 7715.007734 7715.007 734 7715.007734 1 .ooo 000 1 .ooo 070 1 .OOO183 1.000 295 1.000 408 7715.007734 7715.547 785 7 716.419 580 7717.283661 7 718.155457 .135 .128 .118 .110 .102 632 592 714 247 909 .135 220 .128 240 .118 431 .110025 .I02728 2592.0846 2734.1703 2962.0178 3189.8653 3417.7129 350.5017 350.63 350.81 350.96 351.09 0.0085 -0.13 -0.31 -0.46 -0.59 80000 85 000 90 000 95 000 100 000 7 715.007 734 7715.007 734 7715.007734 7115.007734 7715.007 734 1 .OOO5 20 1.000 633 1 .OOO746 1.000 858 1.000 971 7 719.019 538 7 719.891 334 7720.763130 7721.627 211 7 722.499007 .096488 .090822 .085 786 .081280 .077 225 .096 339 .090 698 .085 681 ,081 191 .077148 3645.5604 3873.4079 4101.2554 4329.1030 4556.9505 351.21 351.31 351.40 351.48 351.56 -0.71 -0.81 -0.90 -0.98 -1.06 105 000 110 000 113764 115 000 120000 7715.007734 7 715.001734 7715.007734 7715.001734 7715.001734 1.001 1.001 1.001 1.001 1.001 1723.363087 7724.234883 7724.890659 7 725.098964 7 725.970760 .073556 .070220 .067902 .067 175 .064 383 .073490 .070162 .067850 .067 125 .064 339 4784.7980 5012.6455 5184.1692 5240.4931 5468.3406 351.63 351.70 351.75 351.77 351.83 -1.13 -1.20 -1.25 -1.27 -1.33 Numbers in parenthesis are column numbers. 083 196 281 308 421 P ; 2 I z i? : 2 n g c, v, $ 0 -I 1 2 5 Table 13.-H curve computations for example problem No. 2-unbalanced H,, = 12 787 lb 1 Hl, lL. 3 WLO H,sinh- HO l-WO 4 5 AE 6 (4) -H1 sinh-’ (2) (3) (5) 1 1 1 1 1 734.472 734.472 734.472 734.472 734.472 747 747 747 747 747 0.999 .999 .999 .999 .999 020 070 120 220 320 1 732.772 1732.859 1 732.946 1733.119 1733.293 964 687 411 858 306 0.577 .495 .433 .346 .288 591 103 237 624 882 7 000 8 000 9 000 10 000 11000 1 1 1 1 1 734.472 734.472 734.472 734.472 734.472 747 747 747 747 747 .999 .999 .999 .999 ,999 420 521 621 721 821 1733.466 1733.641 1733.815 1 733.988 1734.162 753 935 382 829 276 ,247 .216 .192 .173 .157 638 705 646 399 651 .245 174 .215 044 .191474 .172 542 .157 005 12 12 14 15 16 000 787 000 000 000 1 734.472 1 734.472 1734.472 1 734.472 1 734.472 747 747 747 747 747 .999 1 .ooo 1.000 1 .ooo 1.000 921 000 121 222 322 1734.335 724 1 734.472 747 1734.682 618 1734.857 800 1735.031 247 .144 .135 .123 ,115 .108 528 643 906 657 439 .144 ,135 .123 .115 JO8 17 000 18 000 19 000 20 000 21000 1 734.472 1 734.472 1 734.472 1 734.472 1734.472 747 747 747 747 747 1.000 422 1 .OOO522 1 .OOO622 1.000 722 1 .OOO822 1 735.204 1735.378 1735.551 1735.725 1735.898 694 142 589 036 480 .102 .096 .091 .086 .082 071 410 345 786 662 22 23 24 25 25 1 734.472 1734.472 1 734.472 1 734.472 1 734.472 747 747 747 747 747 1.000 1.001 1.001 1.001 1.001 1 736.073 1 736.247 1736.420 1 736.594 1 736.694 665 113 560 007 607 .078 .075 .072 ,069 .067 912 489 351 464 909 923 023 123 223 281 Numbers in parenthesis are column numbers. 7 8 2Hl y (6) (7) - 0.549 .476 .420 .340 .285 5 15 828 715 033 008 10 9 9= Lo ft H1 3 000 3 500 4 000 5 000 6 000 000 000 000 000 574 AE=9985 800 lb w = 3.0073 Ib/ft Lo= 115oft 2 full-load condition f US. customary) @h o= Lo- W, in 1995.145 2 2 327.669 3 2 660.193 5 3 325.241 9 3 990.290 3 1096.36 1109.90 1119.18 1130.69 1137.26 53.64 40.10 30.82 19.31 12.74 643.68 481.20 369.84 231.72 152.88 4 5 5 6 7 8.63 5.88 3.94 2.51 1.42 103.56 70.56 47.28 30.12 17.04 655.338 320.387 985.435 650.483 315.532 7 1 4 8 2 1141.37 1144.12 1146.06 1147.49 1148.58 030 230 591 401 228 7 980.580 8 503.973 9 310.677 9 975.725 10 640.774 6 7 4 7 1 1149.44 1149.9924 1150.72 1151.21 1151.63 0.56 0.01 -0.72 -1.21 -1.63 6.72 0.09 -8.64 -14.52 -19.56 .lOl .096 .091 .086 .082 895 261 218 677 568 11 305.822 11970.870 12 635.919 13 300.967 13 966.016 5 9 3 6 0 1152.01 1152.33 1152.62 1152.89 1153.15 -2.01 -2.33 -2.62 -2.89 -3.15 -24.12 -27.96 -31.44 -34.68 -37.80 .078 .075 .072 ,069 .067 830 417 288 408 857 14 15 15 16 17 4 8 2 6 3 1153.37 1153.59 1153.80 1153.99 1154.11 -3.37 -3.59 -3.80 -3.99 -4.11 -40.44 -43.08 -45.60 -47.88 -49.32 631.064 296.112 961.161 626.209 007.947 ----- Table 14.-H curve computations for example problem No. 2-unbalanced $=LoHo=30292N 1 Hl, N 2H1 W sinh -1 L, = 350.5 m 2 3 WLO HO Ho sinh 2~ l-0 13 500 15 750 18 000 21 000 25 000 3 616.546418 3 616.546478 3616.546418 3 676.546478 3676.546478. 0.999 622 30292 31500 36000 40500 45 000 AE = 44 419 008 N w = 20.9211 N/m 4 5 (2) (3) -(4) -H1 AE no-load condition (metric) 6 sinh-’ I W Hl 0.268 979 .231287 .202803 .174 155 .146 519 9 (6) (7) Lo m @= -2Hl (5) 8 .999881 3 675.156143 3 615.344 241 3 675.528 015 3675.778080 3 676.108 969 0.272 234 .233 355 .204 196 .175037 .147044 3 676.546478 3676.546478 3676.546418 3676.546478 3 676.546478 1 .ooo 000 1 .OOO027 1.000 129 1.000 230 1.000 331 3616.546418 3676.645 745 3671.020752 3671.392084 3677.763415 .121370 .116 719 .102 139 .090 800 .081728 .I21 074 .116 456 .101962 .090 676 .081 637 2 894.919 3 010.364 3 440.416 3 870.468 4 300.520 2 3 3 3 4 49500 54000 58500 60584 63000 3676.546478 3 616.546478 3676.546478 3 616.546418 3 676.546 418 1.000.432 1.000 534 1.000 635 1 .OOO682 1.000 736 3 678.134 746 3678.509754 3 678.881085 3679.053883 3679.252416 .074 306 .068 121 .062887 .060 726 .058 401 .074 ,068 ,062 .060 .058 238 068 846 689 368 4 5 5 5 6 730.572 160.624 590.616 789.838 020.728 4 4 5 3 5 351.19 351.27 351.35 351.38 351.42 67 500 12 000 76 500 81000 85 500 3 616.546 3 676.546 3 676.546 3 676.546 3 676.546 478 478 478 478 478 1.000 1.000 1.001 1.001 1.001 838 939 040 142 243 3 619.621424 3 619.998 755 3 680.310 086 3 680.745 094 3 681.116 425 .054 .051 .048 .045 .043 513 111 109 441 054 .054 486 .05 1 089 .048 090 .045 425 .043 041 6 6 7 7 8 450.780 880.832 310.884 740.936 170.988 5 6 6 7 7 351.48 351.53 351.58 351.63 351.69 -1.03 -1.08 -1.13 -1.19 90 000 3 676.546 3 676.546 3 676.546 3 676.546 3 616.546 3 616.546 478 478 418 478 478 418 1.001 1.001 1.001 1.001 1.001 1.001 344 446 547 648 749 851 3 3 3 3 3 3 .040 .038 .037 .035 .034 .032 905 962 194 581 102 741 .040 .038 .037 .035 .034 .032 8 601.040 9 031.092 9 461.144 9 891.196 10 321.248 10 751.300 7 8 8 8 9 9 351.73 351.78 351.81 351.86 351.90 35 1.94 -1.23 -1.28 -1.31 -1.36 -1.40 -1.44 94 99 103 108 112 500 000 500 000 500 .999673 .999123 .999 791 Numbers in parenthesis are column numbers. 681.487 681.862 682.234 682.605 682.976 683.351 756 764 095 427 758 766 894 952 185 573 095 735 1290.156 1 1505.182 1 1720.208 1 2 006.909 5 2 389.178 0 341.02 348.13 348.86 349.51 350.06 350.4994 (0 3.48 2.37 1.64 0.99 0.44 0.00 350.57 -0.07 350.79 350.96 -0.29 351.08 -0.46 -0.58 -0.69 -0.71 -0.85 -0.88 -0.92 -0.98 Table 1S.-H curve computations for example problem No. 2-unbalanced 2 1 Hl, lb 4 3 WLO HO Hosinh-c l-0 -ff, AE (2) (3) AE = 9 985 800 lb w = 1.434 Ib/ft Lo = 1150 ft H,, = 6810 lb no-load condition (U.S. customary) 5 (4) sinh-’ (5) T 826.248 383 826.303762 826.331866 826.414522 826.491178 0.275 416 .236087 .206583 .165 283 .137750 0.272048 .233947 .205 141 .164540 .137 318 4184.1004 4881.4505 5 578.8005 6973.5007 8368.2008 6 810 I 000 8000 9000 10 000 826.564130 826.564130 826.564130 826.564130 826.564130 1 .ooo 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000 826.564130 826.579835 826.662491 826.145 148 826.821804 .121315 .118083 .103333 .091 861 .082683 A21079 .117 810 .103150 .091732 .082589 11000 12000 13000 13620 14000 826.564130 826.564130 826.564130 826.564130 826.564130 1.000 420 1.000 520 1 .OOO620 1.000 682 1 .OOO720 826.911287 826.993943 827.076600 827.121847 827.159256 .075 174 .068916 .063621 .060729 .059083 15 000 16000 17000 18000 19000 826.564130 826.564130 826.564 130 826.564130 826.564130 1.000 820 1 .OOO920 1.001 020 1.001 121 1.001 221 827.241913 827.324569 827.401225 827.490708 827.573 365 20000 21000 22000 23000 24000 826.564130 826.564130 826.564130 826.564130 826.564130 1.001 1.001 1.001 1.001 1.001 827.656021 827.738618 827.821334 827.903990 827.986647 321 421 521 621 721 Numbers in parenthesis are column numbers. 9 G= Lo - (‘3h ft 0.999 618 .999 685 .999 719 .999819 .999919 000 019 119 219 319 (6) (7) H, 826.564130 826.564130 826.564130 826.564 130 826.564130 3000 3500 4000 5 000 6000 8 I 6 10 f#J= Lo - GO, in 1138.28 1142.00 1144.44 1147.42 1149.10 11.72 8.00 5.56 2.58 0.90 140.64 96.00 66.72 30.96 10.80 9497.9080 9762.9010 11 157.601 1 12 552.301 3 13947.0014 1149.9972 1150.17 1150.91 1151.45 1151.87 0.00 -0.17 -0.91 -1.45 -1.87 0.00 -2.04 -10.92 -17.40 -22.44 .075 103 .068 862 .063578 .060692 .059049 15 341.7015 16736.4017 18 131.1018 18995.8159 19525.8020 1152.21 1152.50 1152.74 1152.89 1152.98 -2.21 -2.50 -2.74 -2.89 -2.98 -26.52 -30.00 -32.88 -34.68 -35.76 ,055 149 .051708 .048671 .045 972 .043556 .055 121 .051685 .048 652 .045 956 .043542 20920.5021 22 315.2022 23709.9024 25 104.602 5 26499.3027 1153.16 1153.36 1153.53 1153.71 1153.83 -3.16 -3.36 -3.53 -3.71 -3.83 -37.92 -40.32 -42.36 -44.52 -45.96 .041383 .039416 .037 628 .035 996 .034499 .041 371 .039406 .037619 .035 988 .034492 27894.002 29288.7029 30683.403 32078.1032 33472.8033 1154.00 1154.15 1154.28 1154.43 1154.54 -4.00 -4.15 -4.28 -4.43 -4.54 -48.00 -49.80 -51.36 -53.16 -54.48 8 1 CHAPTER UJUJ’(P) NOl133133(3 NVdS NI 39NWH3 SAGS AND TENSIONS ONV U’W’(@) H19N31 II-CONDUCTOR ~OlVltlSNI 75 -6( 6000 Figure 35.-Graphical IOOcm solution 12000 14 000 16 000 HORIZONTAL FORCE, pounds of unbalanced condition 18 ooo (U.S. customary). 20 000 104-D-1065. 22000 24000 26000 28000 CHAPTER 5. Plot unloaded 6. curve 2d versus the end of the is necessary II-CONDUCTOR P curve using SAGS AND TENSIONS table 10 or 11. Since span with iced conductors, swing to read the change in horizontal 77 the insulator a like amount toward tension at the insulator strings each other, between at each this curve loaded and spans. Plot H, 1 ( no load) the is not needed 7. Plot the curve also is not for this HLz (full curve load) needed usiug solution, for but curve this table 14 or 15 and normally using solution, is plotted table but HI plotting in the first 12 or 13 and normally in the $ . This for reference. HI plotting is plotted versus quadrant versus first 4 . This quadrant for reference. 8. Plot fourth 9. 2 HI ,1 curve the (for duplex 10. Plot the point by point, 2 HL 2 curve. Ht the conductors). 2HL2 - PL1 + = abscissa Plot quadrant, 2 HL, = duplex conductors). quadrants. In the fourth Plot the 2 HL2 curve (for values of the L2 curve. PL 1 + Plot This 12. values 13. of the H2 curve Plot the Ha = from the ordinate values d2 + PL1 + L2 curve. 15. P10ttheHq.=dg+PLt+L2 is done L2 curve of the basic Add graphically, curve. Add graphically, 17. Plot the Hs = dh + f’~~ + Lo, d5 = ~HL* d6 =2HL1 - H6 curves in a similar manner. d curves converge accuracy for this problem; may continue until two quite rapidly, so that the in the first the Draw a reflection intersection of the deflection at that Insulator spans Effect for of the H 1 = 2 HL 2 - pL 1 + reflected curve with the d6 curve The horizontal adjacent no-load to switchyards is about Sag and and by from quadrant. subtracting the graphically, abscissa values point by point, the abscissa basic 2 HL 1 = d curve. point by point, the ordinate 2 HL1 curve. point by point, point gives the abscissa the by point, ordinate the abscissa the ordinate - Hg, H6 = d5 + d6 curve of the values f’~~ + a satisfactory Lo, and degree as indicated on a final value. figure 16 of the of L 2 curve in the fourth is taken as an acceptable broken quadrant. answer tension in the conductor at the structure between the full-load span is indicated as about 74 800 N (16 800 lb). The insulator structure on first if more accuracy is desired, the plotting of Hand d curves d curves are essentially the same curve. If desired, an however, successive approximation of the d, curve may be computed conductor thesis in appendix A, and then plotted as approach in both Of the pL t + L 2 curve to the abscissa values of the d3 curve. Plot d4= 2HL - Ha curve. Subtract graphically, point by point, Ha curve from :he ordinate values of the basic 2 HL 1 curve. va1ues 16. of the 17. curve of the P L t + ~2 curve to the abscissa values of the dz curve. Subtract graphically, point by point, Plot the d3 = 2HL,- H3 curve. of the H3 curve from the ordinate values of the basic 2 HL, curve. values 14. values problem. and the only Plot the Hz = d+ PL1 + ~~ curve. Add graphically, of the PL 1 + L2 curve to the abscissa vahtes of the Subtract graphically, Plot the d2 = 2HL1 -Hz curve. 11. values The this d . 1090 Tension and substations, on the sag and tension in the conductors. This reduced tensions. Based on the same maximum in accordance with applicable electrical safety mm in (42.8 Short the The to the span string in). Spans insulator .-In strings short, may dead-ended have spans, considerable such effect is especially true when the conductors are strung at tension at full-load conditions (ice and wind loading codes), the tension at no-load conditions (no ice and TRANSMISSION no wind) may the insulators. without The taking A method point actually be as much total the into of calculating is outside the span, as twice sag of conductors insulators the that and calculated insulators will effect in reference equations for transmission The insulators. For shows the two lines. catenaries equilibrium, nomenclature the used Nomenclature The conductor are tangent horizontal also be different inclined spans, method has been is satisfactory the insulator assumes tensions the for determining one catenary, point where in the procedure insulator two effect this conductor 2M = = = sag at center of insulator catenary, below end of insulator sag at center of insulator catenary, below support point, conductor sag, below end of insulator string, mm (ft) inclined length 04 = = = total sag, insulators plus conductor, mm (ft) SV = arc length of one-half the conductor span, unstressed arc length of L, m (ft) SP = = length of insulator string, arc length from insulator A = cross-sectional E = modulus e = = = temperature parameter parameter area of elasticity of span, are not inclined on the catenary be equal. m (ft) m (ft) catenary of conductor, of conductor, coefficient of conductor of the catenary described of the catenary described center mm2 GPa to end mm (ft) m (ft) of insulator (in2) (lb/ft2) by the by the conductor insulator string in short spans. string, mm (ft) string string, low to determine is attached must on sag and tension = a2 conductor method. Dr 02 0s a1 the developed and the insulator the catenaries for where description: = considering the sag calculated for spans which effect is based C L Lu RS without than Another at the in describing Figure 36.-Nomenclature 104-D-1066. methods in steeply [5]. the insulator effect for approximately level spans and by more than 20 percent. This method of calculating catenary. by normal account. insulator is given LINE DESIGN MANUAL m (ft) another to the Figure 36 CHAPTER H = T = tension W = linear force factor (weight Wt = linear force factor of conductor, X = M - Xs = projected Steps horizontal in the component II-CONDUCTOR in conductor, Xs = one-half length procedure the in conductor, N (lb) N (lb) the per unit length) N/m length of insulator of insulator of conductor string, string, N/m (lb/ft) (lb/ft) span, m (ft) m (ft) are: Step I.-Calculate using of tension 79 SAGS AND TENSIONS Lu, following the unstressed arc length of L, for the required loading condition by equations: a, = H/W, , for conductor catenary (1) a, = H/W, for insulator catenary (2) a2 x, x =7> for this equation assume X = (M - KS) (1 .OOOS) Assumption of an appropriate a more accurate value of X. The calculations repeated to obtain calculations increase the accuracy value for X at this point greatly simplifies the calculation of calculated value of Xcould be substituted in equation (3) and a still more accurate value; however, subsequent repetitive very little. SP = a, sinh 3 (4) a2 RSP=RS+SP (5) X2 = a, sinh-’ y (6) x, =x2 - x, (7) X=M- x, (8) L = a, sinh x a1 (9) (10) > 80 TRANSMISSION Step Z.-With LA, a range determine the of tensions temperatures LINE DESIGN (assume H which the for = MANUAL 5”) and corresponding conductor would unstressed have these arc arc lengths lengths: Let: to Lu 0 = = temperature unstressed t1, = temperatures = unstressed tz, . . * t, LlC,, I,112, . . . Lu, at known comluctor at new conductor conditions arc length at known conditions conditions arc lengths at new conditions Lu, = Lu, + Lu,e (tl - t,) (11) Lu, =Luo +Lu,e(t,- to) (11) Lu, = Lu, + Lu,e (tn- to) (11) Step 3.-Plot tension against temperature corresponding to each unstressed arc length loading condition. From this plot, determine the tension at the desired temperatures. (1) through (8). tension, calculate values for X, X I, and X 2 using equations Step &The total sag of the D, =a, (cash: D, =a, (co+ line, insulators plus conductor, is then for each For each determined: - I> (12) l) (13) (14) Dc, =D, +D, -D, mm2 (951. kcmil), (15) Example Assume: 483 (4000 Ih) under NE:SC plus constant at’minus tension insulator strings. ACSR, G/7 conductor with heavy loading of 13-1~111~ (I/2-in) 18 ‘C (0 ’ F). U. SC a 45.72-m maximum tension of ice, 0.19-kI’a (I-lh/ft*) (1 SO-ft) span with 17 793 wind, 1 S-unit N CHAPTER Insulator II-CONDUCTOR string data SAGS AND TENSIONS Length 15 insulator units Anchor shackle Ball-eye fitting Compression dead end 81 Mass m (in) kg 2.1908 0.0813 .0711 .5842 ___ 86.25 3.2 2.8 23.0 ~ 74.84 0.45 .68 10.07 165 1.0 1.5 22.2 2.9274 m 115.25 in 86.04 kg 189.7 lb (lb) w = 86.04 = 29.3912 kg/m = 288.2292 N/m 2.9274 w = (189*7) (12) = 19 75 lb/ft 115.25 ’ Metric Figure DCm-579 37 shows the metric sag and tension calculations. (3-78) ;;c SAGCALCULATIONS LOAOIMG k/e2 vu Lmear Factor, Force Dead _L3_ Load Force mm Ice (W”) O@!,&?.kPa 1-5 -qfl Lgf N/m BD2 N/m Creep 0.00oloo. N/m Total O.OOn Wind/d: Resultant Area (A)&m& Temp. Cc&f. 0.000 (W’) (W”‘)~Jd, Permanent N/m Modulus. of Linear +mm ? 2 Permanent kPa Set ! TYJ..I Ice Wtnd (W”‘) 6 Creep UHSTRESSED LwCTH / Final 1 Ice. NO Wmd (W’) I AE 23 GPa .-7/f */7? SW,N m 543. TENSION, N /5!16B8.@/? I I 773 I I I ! I I 15.5 I 1 49 1 I and tension calculation form for insulator I effect T - W, (sag) = 17 793 - 36.93 1 (0.5432) = 17 772.94 N a1 = E = l7 772*94 = 481 . 2472 m w1 36.931 N N I 32 GPa AE je SAG, mm 1 1 -11 Figure 37.Sag H= klj.rllL m 0.0949~~.0~/ ! -1 No SAC FACTOR ‘; SPAN LENGTH(S)e&$=3. L/g FInal Irntialr/5.c?0 OGkk.pePC 3 (E) Exp: lnitlal LOADING Set O.OOOA problem (mtric). ln~t: TRANSMISSION 82 H 17 772.94=61 a2 =i? = 288.2292 x, = LINE DESIGN MANUAL 6625 m * - RS) (1.0005) = 61.6625(22.86 a,04 a1 SP = a, sinhX1 = 61.6625 - 2.9274)(1.0005)=2 481.2472 5553 m = 2.5560 m sinh ii56f:#5 a2 RSP -RS+SP=2.9274+2.5560= X2 =a, X, =X2 X=M- sinh-1 RSP= a2 - X, =5.4762- 6 1.6625 sinh- 1 ~~~~,5 X, =22.86- L =a1 sinhX 5.4834 m 2.5553 =2.9209 2.9209= 19.9391 = 48 1.2472 sinh 4fi9i4!f32 = 5.4762 m m m = 19.9448 m 4 W, (a, j2 .2/&y Luo=L- ( xa, + sinh % cash f 36.93 1 (48 1.2472)’ = 19 9448 _ = 19.9342 Temperature 2(33 318 479) m = - 18 OC = t, T = 13 345 N Assume H 13 345 a, = - = -=850.6502 15.688 WI H a2 =w 13 345 =288.2292 m = 46.3000 m > 19.9391 + sinh 481.2472 19.9391 'Osh 481.2472 > CHAPTER x1 = a, (M - RS) (l.0005) a1 SP= a, sinh$ II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS = 46.3000 (22.86 - 2.9274) (1.0005) = 1 0855 m 850.6502 = 46.3000 sinh 41$~~~o = 1.0856 m RSP = RS + SP = 2.9274 + 1.0856 = 4.0130 m 4.0130 X2 = a, sinh- ’ -RSP = 46.3000 sinh- 1 46.3000 = 4.0080 m a2 x, =x2 - x, X=M- x, = 4.0080 - 1.0855 = 2.9225 m = 22.86 - 2.9225 = 19.9375 m L =a, sinhE= Lu,=L- 850.6502 sinh 8Fi9QJ;b52= 19.9393 m w12AE (“l I2 _X + sinh _Xco& -x a1 = 19.9393 - a1 15.688 (850.6502)2 2(33318479) a1 19.9375 19.9375 850.6502 ‘Osh 850.6502 = 19.9313 m t, = Lu,Lu,e - Lu, +t, 19.9342 19.9313-(0.000 19.9342 020 7) +(‘18)=-25030c = ’ Assume T= 12 010 Nm H(no load) H 12 010 a, = - = = 765.5533 m Wl 15.688 H 12 010 = 41.6682 m a2 = i? = 288.2292 x1 = a2 (M - RS) (1.0005) = 41.6682 (22.86 - 2.9274) (1 .OOOS) = 1 0855 m 765.5533 a1 83 84 TRANSMISSION SP = a, sinh?= LINE DESIGN MANUAL 41.6682 sinh b;T:852 = 1.0856 m RSP = RS + SP = 2.9274 + 1.0856 = 4.0130 m RSP 4.0130 X, =a, sinh-’ ~ = 41.6682 sinh- ’ 41 .6682 = 4.0068 m a2 X, = X2 - Xl = 4.0068 - 1.0855 = 2.9213 m X = M - X, = 22.86 - 2.9213 = 19.9387 m X L =a, sinh - = 765.5533 sinh 7F59535y3= 19.9410 m a1 W, Lu2 =L - (a, 1’ 2*E x + sinh x cash _x a1 a1 > al 15.688 (765.5533)’ 2 (33 318 479) = 19.9410- 19.9387 +sinh 19.9387 cash 19.9387 765.5533 765.5533 765.5533 > = 19.9338 m t, = Lu, - Lu, +t, Lu,e Similar = 19-9338 - 19*9342 + (- 18) = _ 18.97 OC 19.9342 (0.000 020 7) calculations temperatures were made for five additional assumed Assumed T = H (no load), N The resulting determine line. and the resulting Temperature, OC 10 675 9 341 8 007 6 672 6 227 figure, of the tensions, were: temperatures the tensions t, t, t, t, t, are plotted for the against desired the = - 11.94 = -2.23 = 11.58 = 33.13 = 43.31 assumed temperatures and tensions proceed on figure in finding 38. Using the total this sag CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS 0 rn z W I- -23 -13 -5 0 +5 T EM PERATURE, Figure 38.-Tension-temperature At-18OC.T= H curve for insulator 11 800N 11 800 a, = - =-z752.1673 15.688 wt m H 11 800 a, =~=~~~,~~9~=40.9396 m +I5 +25 +35 “c effect problem (metric). 104-D-1067. +45 TRANSMISSION 86 x 1 LINE DESIGN MANUAL = a, (M - RS) (1.0005) = 40.9396 (22.86 - 2.9274) (1.0005) = 1 0855 m 752.1673 a1 Xl SP = a, sinh a, = ‘40.9396 sinh 40;0983~6= 1.0856 m RSP = RS + SP = 2.9274 + 1.0856 = 4.013 m RSP X, = a, sinh- ’ - 4.013 = 40.9396 sinh- 1 40.9396 = 4.0066 m a2 X, = X2 - X, = 4.0066 - 1.0855 = 2.9211 m X = M - X, = 22.86 - 2.9211 = 19.9389 m D, =a2 (.osh:- 1) =40.9396(cosh4s6- 1) =O.O144m= 14mm D, =a, (coshz- 1) =40.9396(cosh~~~f~6- 1) =O.l962m= 196mm D, =o,(coshc- l) =752.1673(cosh7!~~q368~~3- l) =0.2643m=264mm D, = D, + D, - D, = 264 + 196 - 14 = 446 mm At- 1 OC, T=9220N H 9220 a, = - = = 587.7104 m w, 15.688 H a2 = k= 9220 = 31.9884m 288.2292 x1 = a, (M - RS) (1.0005) = 3 1.9884 (22.86 - 2.9274) (1.0005) = 1 0855 m a1 587.7104 SP = a, sinh 2 = 3 1.9884 bnh 31{yii4 = 1.0857 m CHAPTER RSP=RS+SP=2.9274+ RSP X, = a2 sinh- ’ - a2 II-CONDUCTOR 87 SAGS AND TENSIONS 1.0857=4.0131rn = 3 1.9884 sinh- ’ 34.y1814 = 4.0026 m X, = X, - X, = 4.0026 - 1.0855 = 2.9176 m X = M - X, = 22.86 - 2.9176 = 19.9424 m D, =a,(cosh:- 1) =31.9884 D, =a2 (coshz- 1) = 31.9884(cosh~~~~~4- D, =a1 (cash:- D, =D, +D, (cosh31~~~~~4- 1) =O.O184m= 1) =0.2507m=251 l) =587.7104(cosh:89;~7412~4-1) -D, =338+251 - 18=571 18mm mm =0.3384m=338mm mm At 15.5 OC, T = 7740 N H = ~7740 = 493.3707 m a’ = w, 15.688 H 7740 = 26.8536 m a2 = w = 288.2292 = x 1 a2 (M - RS) (1.0005) = 26.8536 (22.86 - 2.9274) (1 .OOOS)= 1 0855 m 493.3707 al Xl SP=a? sinh - a2 = 26.8536 sinh :ey5y6 = 1.0858 m RSP=RS+SP= 2.9274+ 1.0858=4.0132m RSP X, = a, sinh- ’ - a2 = 26.8536 sinh- l 2:08:3;?6 = 3.9984 m 88 TRANSMISSION X, =X2 X=M - Xl = 3.9984 LINE DESIGN MANUAL - 1.0855 = 2.9129 m - X, = 22.86 - 2.9129 = 19.9471 m D,=a,(cosh$- 1) =26.8536(~osh:6p88;;5~- 1) =O.O219m=22mm D, =a,(cosh$- l) =26.8536(co~h~~~~~~~- l) =0.2982m=298mm D, =a, (,osh~- 1) =493.3707(cosh499;83477d7- D, =D, +D, -D, At32 l) =0.4033m=403mm = 403 + 298 - 22 = 679 mm OC. T=6760N H 6760 = ~ = 430.9026 m a1 = w, 15.688 H a’ =w= x1 = a2 6760 = 23.4536 m 288.2292 (M - RS) (1.0005) = 23.4536 (22.86 - 2.9274) (1 .OOOS)= 1 0855 m 430.9026 a1 SP = a, sinh 2 = 23.4536 sinh 1.0855 = 1.0859 m 23.4536 RSP = RS + SP = 2.9274 + 1.0859 = 4.0133 m X2 =a, sinh-’ !?!f = 23.4536 sinh- ’ ~~~,j3~6 = 3.9940 m a2 X, = X2 - Xl = 3.9940 - 1.0855 = 2.9085 m X=M- X, =22.86- 2.9085 = 19.9515 m CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS D, =a, (yxh$-- l) = 23.4536 (cash $jp)&T;6 - $ = 0.0251 m = 25 mm D, =a2 (c~sh$- 1) = 23.4536 (cash :;:23p6‘ 1) =0.3409m =341 mm D, =a, (cosha$- 1) =430.9026(cosh~~!~~256- l) =0.4620m=462mm D, =D, +D, - D, =462+341- 25=778mm At43 OC, T=6260N H a1 =w 1 6260 = -= 15.688 399.0311 m H 6260 = 21.7188 m az = ii = 288.2292 x, = a,@f - RS) (1.0005) = 21.7188 (22.86 - 2.9274) (1.0005) = 1 0855 m 399.03 11 a1 SP=a, sinh; Xl 1.0855 = 21.7188 sinh 21.7188 = 1.0860 m RSP=RS+SP=2.9274+ 1.0860=4.0134m X, = a, sinh-’ RSP = 2 1.7 188 sinh- l ~~~~~8 = 3.9909 m a2 X, = X2 - X, = 3.9909 - 1.0855 = 2.9054 m X =M - X, = 22.86 - 2.9054 = 19.9546 m D, =a, bosh:- 1) =21.7188 (cosh211f!!f~8- 1) =0.0271 m=27mm 90 TRANSMISSION D, =a, (&$ 1) =21.7188 LINE DESIGN (cosh;;y;;;8- MANUAL 1) =0.3677rn=368rnm D3=al(cosh~-I) =399.0311 (coih;g-f,.,~l -I) =0.4990m=499rnm D, =D, +D, =499+368-27=840mm -D, U. S. Customary Figure DC-576 39 shows the U.S. customary sag and tension computations. (6-76) &,tL SAG CALCULATIONS LOADINGWeight Factws: Dead Welpht (W’) 1, n 750 St.1 0. Initial.- &m°Fd.2d Fenal. -&?.e.?FX Loaded. OF Final. &OF -5e - Computed by - 4 3/7q lb SC,‘&!?&% @&!-lb Resultant: lb 0.000 o// Ib/ft2 Wind(W”‘)/ [ 90 .*n I Figure 39.-Sag H = T - W, H a2 =r=H t 8 I 0 60 1 and tension T>/ 7 Permanent Set 0.009 IbItt Creep Total Ib/ft 2.330 T calculation form Modulus. (E) Final-x initial/,.56x 1 SAGFACTOR 1 SAG,ft FEET I 0.09d9 lLuf&LLn// I I I I 3gg5*53g3 = 202 *3058 19.75 f-t ft 78 I / I I I effect (sag) = 4000 - 2.5306 (1.78) = 3995.5393 lb 3gg5-53g3 = 1578 8901 2.5306 * 106 lb/i,? 106 lb/in2 Final AE .m lnttial AE s 150 for insulator 151 o.oo--O.ooa Ib/ft per “F SPAE;LENGTH(S) tnch Ice. w (W’“) Ib/ft Area (A) ti in2 Temp. Coeff. of Linear Exp.: oF * UNSTRESSED 1TEMP. LENGTH No Ice. No Wind (W’) a,=-= lb Date LOADING .km Kfe Ad.2 o/n problem tb lb 1 SW,Ib 1 TENSION,Ib I.? 7959 I I I (U.S. customary). I JImlo n;d CHAPTER x 1 II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS = a, (M - RS) (1.0005) = 202.3013 (75 - 9.6) (1 .OOOS)= 8 3838 ft 1578.8901 4 Xl= 202.3058 SP=a2 sinhz 8.3838 sinh 202.3058 = 8.3862 ft RSP = RS + SP = 9.6 + 8.3862 = 17.9862 ft X2 = a, sinh- ’ E = 202.3058 sinh- ’ :a’;~~5!8 = 17.9626 ft a2 X, =X2 - Xl = 17.9626 - 8.3838 = 9.5788 ft = 75 - 9.5788 = 65.4212 ft X=M-X, X sinh -= L=a, 1578.8901 sinh l;;;p;;;1 = 65.4399 ft 4 Lu,=L- w, b, 2AE = 65.4399 - I2 --X+sinh&c& a1 i 4 a1 ) 2.5306 ( 1578.8901)2 2 (7 490 285) 65.4212 65.4212 65.4212 1578.8901 + sinh 1578.8901 ‘Osh 1578.8901 = 65.4050 ft Temperature = 0 OF = t, Assume T = 3000 lb w H (no load) H = == 1 1.075 al=w H 3000 = -= a, = w 19.75 x 1 = 2790.6977 ft 151.8987 ft a, (M - RSI (1 .OOOS) _ 15 1.8987 (75 - 9.60) (1 .OOOS) SP=a2 sinh:= Ql 2790.6977 151.8987 sinh 1;.l5;;;7 . = 3.5618 ft = 3.5615 ft 91 ‘12 TRANSMISSION RSP=RStSP=9.6+3.5618= LINE DESIGN MANUAL 13.1618ft x2 RSP = a, sinh-’ = 151.8987 sinh-’ x, =x2 ~~~~91g87= 13.1454 ft a2 - x, = 13.1454 - 3.5615 = 9.5839 ft X =M - X, = 75 - 9.5839 = 65.4161 ft L = a, sinh: 65.4161 = 2790.6977 sinh 2790.6977 = 65.4221 ft wl(al)2 LU, =L - 2AE = 65.4221 x ( c+sinh-f 1 cosht 1.075 (2790.6977)2 2 (7 490 285) - 1 65.4161 65.4161 65.4161 2790.6977 + sinh 2790.6977 ‘Osh 2790.6977 = 65.3959 ft Lu, = Lu, + Lu,e(t, t, = - to) Lu, - Lu, 65.3959 - 65.4050 + o = _ 12.10 OF Lu, e + to = 65.4050 (0.000 011 5) Assume T = 2700 lb = H (no load) H 2700 a, = - = 1075=2511.6279ft WI * H 2700 a, = p = 19.75 = 136.7089 ft x 1 =a,@4 - RS) (1.0005) _ 136.7089 (75 - 9.6) (1.0005) = 3.5615 ft 2511.6279 a1 SP = a, sinh: RSP=RS+SP= = 136.7089 sinh 3.5615 = 3.5619 ft 136.7089 9.6 + 3.5619 = 13.1619 ft CHAPTER X2 =a, sinh-’ @E= II-CONDUCTOR 93 SAGS AND TENSIONS 136.7089 sinh- l 1:; y;899 = 13.1417 ft a2 X, =X2 - X, = 13.1417 - 3.5615 = 9.5802 ft X = M - X, = 75 - 9.5802 = 65.4198 ft L = a, sinh Lu, =L- 5 = 25 11.6279 sinh 65.4198 25 11.6279 F!&&? = 65.4273 ft cash -x a1 1.075 (25 11 .6279)2 2 (7 490 285) = 65.4273 - 65.4198 65.4198 65.4198 2511.6279 + sinh 25 11.6279 ‘Osh 25 11.6279 = 65.4037 ft t, = Lu, - Lu, Lu,e Similar temperatures +t, = 65.4037 - 65.4050 65.4050 (0.000 011 5) = -1*73 OF calculations were: Assumed were made T-- H (no load), lb 2400 2100 1800 1500 1400 At The figure, resulting determine of the line. 0 OF, temperatures the tensions w, 1.075 five additional assumed tensions, = = = = = the resulting 11.30 28.72 53.58 92.53 110.88 are plotted against the assumed tensions for the desired temperatures and proceed 1 ft and Temperature, OF t, t, t, t, t, T = 2645 lb H 2645 = 2460.465 a, = - = - for on figure 40. Using in finding the total this sag 94 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 2600 2400. g 2200 ; 0v) z E 2000 1800. 1600 -20 0 +20 l 40 T EM PERATURE, Figure 40.-Tension-temperature curve for insulator +80 - +60 effect +I00 OF problem (U.S. customary). 104-D-1068. +I20 CHAPTER a2 =-= x H w 2645 -= 19.75 II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS 133.9241 ft - RS) (1.0005) 133.9241 (75 = 9.60) (1.0005) = 3.5615 ft a1 2460.465 1 =a,(M 1 SP=a2 sinh$ = 133.9241 sinh 3.5615 = 3.5619 ft 133.9241 RSP=RS+SP=9.6+3.5619= X2 = a, sinh- 1 Q 13.1619ft = 133.9241 sinh- 1 l:‘; kyll = 13.1408 ft a2 X, =X2 - X, = 13.1408 - 3.5615 = 9.5793 ft X = M - X, = 75 - 9.5793 = 65.4207 ft D,=a,(cosh:- D, =D, l) =133.9241(khll~~~~~)481- +D, 1)=0.6452ft - D, = 0.8698 + 0.6452 - 0.0474 = 1.4676 ft At 30 OF, T = 2075 lb H 2075 a, = - = = 1930.2326 ft w, 1.075 H _ 2075 a2 = w- = 105.0633 ft 19.75 x =a,(M- 1 RS) Ql (1.0005) = 105.0433 (75 - 9.60) (1.0005) = 3 5615 ft 1930.2326 95 TRANSMISSION SP = a, sinh 2 = 105.0633 sinh RSP=RS+SP=9.60+3.5622 RSP X, = a, sinh-’ - LINE DESIGN MANUAL 3.5615 = 3.5622 ft 105.0633 = 13.1622 ft = 105.0633 sinh” 1~~~6~3 = 13.1280 ft a2 X, =X2 - Xl = 13.1280 - 3.5615 = 9.5665 ft X=M- X, =75- 9.5665 =65.4335 ft D, =a,(cosh$ 1) =105.0633(cosh1;;;;;3- l)=O.O604ft D, =a, (ah: - 1) = 105.0633 (cash ll;;;;;;3 - 1) = 0.8213 ft D, =a1 (co&: - 1) = 1930.2326(cash D, =D, 1;;;;;;6- 1) = 1.1092 ft +D, - D, = 1.1092 + 0.8213 - 0.0604 = 1.8701 ft At 60 OF, T = 1733 lb -- H 1733 a, = - =x= Wl . 1612.0930 ft a, = /f=F5=87.7468 x 1- _ a, ft 04 - RS) (1 .OOOS) 87.7468 = (75 9.60) (1 .OOOS) = 3.5615 ft a1 1612.0930 SP = a, sinh: = 87.7468 sinh RSP=RS+SP=9.60+3.5625 3.5615 = 3.5625 ft 87.7468 = 13.1625 ft CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS 13.1625 X, = a, sinh-’ RSP = 87.7468 sinh-’ 87.7468 = 13.1136 ft a2 X, =X2 - X, = 13.1136 - 3.5615 = 9.5521 ft X = M - X, = 75 - 9.5521 = 65.4479 ft D, =a, (cosh$- l) =87.7468(cosh$~~~~8 D, =a2(ysh2- $ =87.7468(cosh~~:~~~~- D, =aI(cosht- - l) =O.O723ft I) =0.9817ft l) =1612.0930(xsh1~~~~~~O- $ =1.3287ft D, = D, +D, -- D, = 1.3287 + 0.9817 - 0.0723 = 2.2381 ft At90°F,T=15131b H a, = - = g$ WI * = 1407.4419 ft H 1513 = = 76.6076 ft a2 =w 19.75 x 1 = Q-2 (M - RS) (l-0005) a1 = 76.6076 (75 - 9.60) (1 .OOOS) = 3 56 15 ft 1407.4419 SP = a, sinh x, = 76.6076 sinh 7iyo1756 = 3.5628 ft a2 RSP=RS+SP=9.60+3.5628 RSP X2 =a2 sinh-’ - = 13.1628ft = 76.6076 sinh- l :i’i$i a2 X, =X2 - X, = 13.0989 - 3.5615’= 9.5374 ft = 13.0989 ft 98 TRANSMISSION X=M- X, =75- 9.5374=65.4626 LINE DESIGN MANUAL ft D, =a, kosh$ 1) =76.6076(cosh;;~;;6- 1) =O.O828ft D, =a+sh$- 1) =76.6076(cosh;~:~;;~- l) D, =a1 (cosh$ D, =D, 1) = 1407.4419 kosh lg4;;;g +D,- = 1.1306ft - 1) =1.5227 ft D, = 1.5227 + 1.1306 - 0.0828 = 2.5705 ft At 110 OF:, T = 1405 lb H a, = - = E Wl . H a2 = w x = 1306.9767 ft 1405 == 71.1392 ft 19.75 =a2(M- = 71.1392 (75 - 9.60) (1.0005) = 3 5615 ft Ra(1.0005) 1 1306.9767 a1 SP =a2 sinhs = 71.1392 sinh ;i5fi12 = 3.5630 ft a2 RSP=RS+SP=9.60+3.5630= X2 =a, sinh- l g 13.163Oft = 71.1392 sinh-’ ~~‘:~~~ = 13.0890 ft a2 X, =X2 - Xl = 13.0890 - 3.5615 = 9.5275 ft X=M- X, =75- D, =a,(cosh~- 9.5275 =65.4725 ft 1) = 71i1392 (cash ~~~1631~2 - 1) = 0.0892 ft CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS 99 D, =a,(cosh$ 1) =71.1392(cosh;;~;~;;-1) = 1.2075ft 65.4725 - 1306.9767 D, 18. =D, - D 1 = 1.6403 +D, Spans With Concentrated infrequent and arrangements in addition figure 3.1 . are used. to the dead are confined Such force to the span 1. 2. string Assume a desired Calculate that will relating or switchyard problems applied. are complicated A method which ft ft to spans spans with concentrated in which loads taps are or tie-down by the elastic effects of the tap or tie-down adequately treats this problem is shown on to this problem than the method shown on figure 41 would be to sag normal sag for a given temperature and then add a calculated length for the force may be determined F. F. Priest: spring tension of the by the at some tie-down, following given see figure procedure 42. The which required was developed temperature. the angle that will be formed by a vertical result from the horizontal tension in the to the tie-down after installation 3. By multiplying the length reflected length of the insulator The difference in the originally = 1.6403 = 2.7586 to substation to compensate additional length of conductor by a former Bureau engineer, - 0.0892 Loads.-Problems mainly Probably a better approach the conductors to the calculated of conductor + 1.2075 1 (0 = tan-’ H/P). of the insulator string string is obtained (i, line and the position of the insulator conductor and the vertical force due by the sine of this = isin 0). angle, the horizontal between the length of the insulator string as it will lay in the near horizontal sagged span and its calculated horizontal reflected length after the tie-down indicates the additional amount of conductor same characteristics as the originally sagged required to give the final span without the tie-down. tied-down span position is made, about the Example Conductor: Span length Force Spring Length Calculate might short the 242 mm2 (477 kcmil), = 45.7 m (150 ft) of hardware on tie-down tension at 15.5 ‘C (60 of insulator sags and string tensions be applicable during span, such as in the insulator effect = ASCR 24/7 = 444.8 N (100 lb) OF) = 889.6 N (200 1829 for the mm conductor, lb) (6 ft) without tie-down, for a range of temperatures that installation. If the insulator force will be appreciable in a comparatively example used here, the original sags should be determined by considering (see sec. 16). LOO TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL P LeveI' Span Inclined Span s = 2PL + wL2 8H CONCENTRATED LOAD AT CENTER OF SPAN H H-TeH t P Level Span Inclined S= Span L, L, (2P + WL) 2LH LOAD AT ANY POINT ON SPAN =Horizontal span length between conductor support points, m (ft) = Horizontal tension in conductor, N (lb) = Sag, from line of supports at concentrated load, m (ft) =Concentrated load, N (lb) = Linear force factor (weight) of conductor, N/m (Ib/ft) ;,L*= Horizontal distance from concentrated load to points of support, m (ft) L H S P Figure 41.Spans with concentrated loads. 104-D-1069. CHAPTER II-CONDUCTOR SAGS AND TENSIONS i = Length of insulator string, mm (ft) length of insulator string, in - Horizontal reflected ni = i-iH, mm (ft) H - Horizontal tension in conductor, N (lb) P - Vertical force added by tie-down (hardware tension) , N (lb) Figure 42.-Graphical method for determining concentrated load problem. 104-D-1070. Assume the following length ‘C (OF) -18 -1 15.5 (0) (30) (60) mm 625 780 917 1039 1149 For 15.5 OC: mm required by previous for calculations: Tension, SW, w N (2.05) (2.56) (3.01) (3.41) (3.77) 3750 3015 2571 2268 2050 (lb) (843) (678) (578) (510) (461) For 60 OF: 2571/1334.4 e = tan-’ 578/300 = tan- l 1.926 70 = tan- ’ 1.926 70 = 62.57O = 62.57O ih = 1829 (ft) + spring of conductor sag and tension values have been obtained Temperature, e = tan-’ additional 101 Sin 8 = 1829 (0.887 57) = 1623.37 mm Ai = 1829 - 1623.37 = 205.63 mm _ ih = 6 sin 8 = 6 (0.887 57) = 5.33 ft Ai = 6 - 5.33 = 0.67 ft = 8 in TRANSMISSION 102 The Ai vahle is the additional Considering 8 constant can be made: for setting Temperature, OC (OFI -18 -1 15.5 32 49 (0) (30) (60) (90) (120) amount of conductor the spring Horizontal N 3750 3015 2571 2269 2050 LINE DESIGN MANUAL tension to be added at other to the span after temperatures, the the initial following tension, (lb) Hardware force, N (lb) Spring tension, N (lb) (843) (678) (578) 444.8 444.8 444.8 444.8 444.8 1501 1120 890 733 620 (510) (461) (100) (100) (100) (100) (100) (337.5) (251.9) (200) (164.7) (139.3) sagging. tabulation <<Chapter INSULATION, 19. Insulation which will Coordination.-Insulation withstand are three LIGHTNING PROTECTION, CLEARANCEPATTERNS the different voltage voltage requirements (1) for the Lightning (2) (3) Switching coordination stresses stresses to which to consider design of high-voltage voltages, voltages, 60~HZ voltages, and called power the AND is the selection system when transmission of an insulation or equipment determining III insulation structure will be subjected. and electrical There clearance lines: frequency operating voltages. The probability of flashover must be controlled so that any system disturbance is minor. Lightning impulse voltages generally have the highest values and the highest rates of voltage rise. The time range for these voltages to crest is about 0.5 to 6 microseconds. Although it is impractical to provide a sufficiently high impulse conductor is struck by an average This is done by locating overhead current structures to earth through for this purpose. insulation strength ground Ievel the steel towers or through This diversion of the current string and air gap insulation values, and by obtaining In a region of average storm intensity of 30 storm on the average of 100 direct must be used on transmission The lightning current the tower footing ground wire will l l Isoceraunic Stroke-current level clearances Number l Span length Midspan clearance Number of insulator If the tower, height footing (number magnitude l l the of tower Tower Tower l to follow a path and along conductor permissible strokes and voltage developed may divert wires provided by coordinating low footing a transmission when a be controlled. the lightning on wood pole the insulator resistance. line will be struck mi) of line per year. Overhead ground wires lightning strokes and shield the conductors. the shield wire, down the tower, and through top of the tower and the connected overhead of the current resistance in the tower footing. and lightning protection design is based primarily the lightning performance of a transmission l l a sufficiently days per year, strokes per 161 km (100 lines to take these direct is expected the lightning flashovers direct strokes and the ground is accomplished resistance to the ground. The entire attain a high voltage, mainly because An evaluation acceptable affecting to withstand lightning stroke, wires to intercept overhead ground on theory line are: of lightning storm and wave shape days wire configurations and experience. to be expected each The for an major factors year) resistance location of overhead ground between units conductors current to midspan stroke to midspan may cause tower wires and (shield overhead is more than flashovers. 103 angles ground twice the to conductors) wires permissible stroke current to TRANSMISSION For transmission flashover rate. or by the lines lightning considerations lightning must not and will impulse could levels, an increase in insulation strength. by the insulation is determined may be dictated 345 kV, control primarily by either switching the probability insulation strength length impulses, tower does surge surfaces so switching not any result design; that have however, made considerations will against is a function The number of surges very low. on simulated towers (extra-high voltage) increase in switching surge does result field effect This dictate in of insulators is due to the electric proximity the factor protection surge At EHV number lightning considerations prime expected. switching been shape. in the This is called the due to a switching tower the surge become in a proportional increase strength. and surge on tests almost a lo-percent in switching of the is based by switching surges of flashover to duplicate example, increase to lightning The be made For proximity Above probably insulation adjustments in a lo-percent line characteristics and the magnitude of the surges be selected to keep the probability of flashover from where withstand kV, rate. be overlooked. of the line insulation insulators used may surge to 345 the line insulation flashover flashover Switching up At 345 kV, LINE DESIGN MANUAL distortion effect the insulation not caused does values not apply at the EHV levels. Wave shapes grouped for for lightning testing and impulses to provide and basic switching data surges for are infinite use in insulation. in number, Wave shape but have been is defined by two impulse and the parameters: (1) The time instant that the (2) The time the impulse crest to crest BIL have have Two a time resulted tail the beginning of the value. as the of the time impulse, interval at which trapped charge The between the system Restriking at the occurs builds Resistors overvoltages insulation. when up at a faster in momentary voltages time reestablishment on the are for of a typical with 50 to 2000 UHV transmission impulse testing the voltage beginning is one-half have BIL. surge of of the of line and in transmission the other there towers switching line is high-speed but opening. Transformers connected to ground high-speed voltage reclosing varies with period, breaker and the may will reclosing characteristics, tests voltages. coordination. reclosing there BIL an increasing These surge insulation to energization, The surges, between has been and equipment. is similar surge shape. of switching lies somewhere developed, insulation wave of 0.5 to 6 microseconds, Coordination of transmission voltage; SO-microsecond microseconds, are of concern no initial the by lightning operation in the switching on a 1.2- coordination with switching the previous energy for is based from and operations of a line from energization. data flashovers. coordinated ranging surge affecting the range is usually switching latter level) is within As EHV of switching The line insulation stress in better types energizing breaker between is defined parameter to crest to crest of outdoor tripout. of the which on the principal withstand. is the on the interval its peak value, instant, impulse time impulse 60-Hz amount the is the reaches to half is the (basic so lightning and voltage and 1.2-microsecond which which value. Time The to crest, One following be energy normally becomes line length, a line trapped dissipate the the same as and the state of switching. lines rate are being than of the deenergized the dielectric arc across and strength the interrupting the recovery voltage of the interrupting contacts across medium. and can the circuit This results produce extreme system. incorporated EHV lines in the closing stroke of a breaker to help reduce switching which, in turn, helps reduce the switching surge requirements for surge line CHAPTER Some causes III-INSULATION, of switching l Normal l High-speed line l Switching capacitor l Load l Out-of-phase l Reinsertion l Circuit l Current Power in the line surge energizing PROTECTION, overvoltages and CLEARANCE PATTERNS 105 are: deenergizing reclosing banks, shunt reactors, and cable circuits rejection switching of series breaker capacitors restriking chopping frequency system overvoltages alters l Voltages l Load Open l LIGHTNING are caused or removes on the the unfaulted rejection end of a long Ferroresonance Although the clearance by condition, phases energized an abnormal such during line condition which exists until a change as: a phase-to-ground (Ferranti fault effect) l necessary for power frequency voltage is much less than for switching or lightning, the clearance envelope is very sensitive to the insulator swing angle created Data on extreme winds during storms and their frequency of occurrence are necessary power frequency electrical insulation clearances. and and surges by the wind. to determine In transmission line design, there are two basic insulations to be considered, the insulator string air. The insulator swing angle depends on the diameter-to-force (weight) ratio of the conductor, the ratio Consideration (2) switching of wind must surge, span to low-point be given to each and (3) p ower span. of the frequency. three of flashover following a circuit breaker operation. of tripouts per 161 km (100 mi) of line per year. of the mean recurrence interval. Bureau insulators types Switching wood-pole designs are based on with the minimum air gap between by a 0.19-kPa wind pressure at 15.5 coordination the conductor wires separation ground and at midspan wires. Insulation included the conductors must See section withstand will be greater 20 for must not than minimum be coordinated impulse, on the probability value of the a wind pressure the impulse insulation angle of the suspension and the air-gap insulator strings sufficient occur before at the structure midspan across so that flashover because flashover occurs angle of 30’) the overhead between the at the structure. of the impedance overhead The of the overhead clearances. the insulator string and the air gap. Factors 0 Crest l Maximum l Strength of air to switching surges in relation to the impulse strength of the insulators, the ratio of critical impulse to switching surge withstand Percent allowance made between withstand voltage and critical flashover of air, or ratio withstand of an insulator string l l withstand or for a sideswing at midspan between in an evaluation Maximum system factor of the insulation operating voltage (1) lightning is based of the impulse insulation and the structure with o C on the conductors, the clearance whichever is greater. For complete coordination, ground wires and the conductor must be made ground stress: performance Lightning performance is measured by the number Power frequency performance is measured in terms of 0.19 kPa (4 lb/ft*) at 15.5 ‘C (60 ’ F). On steel structures, clearance to the structure are coordinated for the sideswing caused of voltage surge are: of wave switching to critical surge overvoltage flashover or of TRANSMISSION 106 l Contaminated l Nonstandard a Maximum this The values the on unfaulted phases factor switching that voltage can vary, of the wave is fi surge varies of switching. is, taking with hut breaker variation in the the surge magnitude values line surges length, for all switching or two switching situations produce highest values. and that barometric pressure. The Bureau surges. Some designers like switching two extra units are and, on 345-kV steel unit and for hot-line because in addition transmission lines not only frustrating, original be included in the If a transmission one for construction, maintenance. examples elevation these satisfactory to use insulation strengths test data surfaces, as the ratio of the impulse strength for value as a ratio between withstand upon value. gap length, wave shape, and A factor of 1.1 is used for examining the air is dependent fault voltage insulation upon the on unfaulted strength for power one extra insulator unit is added to allow two extra units are added: for 230-kV steel a possible defective unit and one for hot-line one extra unit is added as a combination safety unit These extra units have proven to be very valuable calculations to reduce shown initial in section Lightning wrote in the basically costs as insulation coordination is not economical when further of insulation selection limit is governed by for three different the switching surge voltages. impulse limits shown in the tables should be used for design discussed for hot-line maintenance and possible defective line is to operate designers, Westinghouse, and weighting design. The lower of the two elevation extra insulator units previously discussed of the by statistical to the hot-line maintenance safety they afford, they have helped to restrict Bureau to minimal “unexplained” flashovers and outages. Such flashovers and outages are but they are costly to an electrical entity and must be taken into consideration Tables 16, 17, and 18 show tables show that the permissible factors such Such design 1.175 factor for nonstandard sea level. 1.2 for the maximum atmosphere, are used when added, The for to use a 3-sigma wood-pole transmission line construction, defective unit. For 115-kV steel structures, construction, maintenance; for a defective uses surge the state distributions determined from upon the proximity of grounded flashover, but since sigma is a variable depending we have set 17.5 percent as a coordination A factor of 1.5 for contaminated phases, and a safety factor of 1.25 frequency overvoltages. For 115-kV for a possible the and air gaps are described by strength These distributions will vary depending and situations it is probably strings tower. accepted can he described conservative, contaminated atmosphere. An added altitude elevation of the given transmission line above 20. switching To be more the critical configuration, Some characteristics, The is generally of occurrence. humidity, air to the not overvoltage frequency one in the a S-percent by their of insulator on a full-scale and gap crest at the time distribution; etc.) (altitude) voltage operating The maximum system MANUAL of safety maximum limit. (chemicals, density fault Factor l The atmosphere air LINE DESIGN purposes. The units, should tables. problem of lines These values. free, or because then of lack insulation of facts, coordination have is a necessity. chosen to ignore some which results in lines that have many unexplained outages. considered over a period of time._Insulation coordination is 21. Protectioma series In 1930, C. L. Fortescue, a consulting transmission line engineer with of articles on lightning investigations that were published in Electrical Joumm! He advanced the theory strokes of lightning. Previous that high-voltage to that time, transmission transmission lines lines should were be protected designed on from the direct basis of CHAPTER III-INSULATION, LIGHTNING PROTECTION, Table 16.-Insulation selection CLEARANCE PATTERNS 107 for 345 kV Switching surge impulse, positive critical Power frequency, 60-Hz wet a. Overvoltage 1.05 1.05 b. Crest factor 1.414 c. Switching surge 2.5 d. Ratio of critical impulse to switching surge 1.175 e. Ratio of withstand 1.175 1.175 1.1 1.5 1.15 1.25 f. Contaminated to critical flashover voltage atmosphere g. Factor of safety h. Rise due to line faults Total withstand 1.2 multiplying factor (at sea level). Product of (a) through Normal line to neutral, 345/G Total withstand multiplying neutral voltage (h) 2.78 1291 kV 554 kV 1585 kV 690 kV = 199.2 kV factor (at sea level) times normal line to Flashover of 18 insulator units, 146 by 267 mm (5-3/4 by 10-l/2 in), from table B-7 in appendix B Factor for nonstandard 6.48 1585/1291 air density (altitude) namely, that 6901554 = 1.25 2154 m (7068 ft) From table B-10 in appendix B, permissible elevation limit induced-stroke assumption; = 1.23 a charge cloud in the vicinity 2362 m (7750 ft) of the transmission line, with its accompanying gradient of voltage to ground, would bind a charge on the line. The discharge of the cloud to any object other than a transmission line, would release this bound charge, which was then free to travel along the line seeking a path to ground. However, induced voltage gradients appearing on transmission lines during account for the damage to the lines. high-voltage lines. Complete protection nearby lightning discharges have proved to be too low to The direct-stroke theory is now generally accepted for against direct strokes requires a shield to prevent lightning from striking the electrical conductors, together with adequate adequate drainage facilities so that the discharge can drain conductors. The shielding method does not allow the formation to ground. An alternative nonshielding method tubes or ground fault neutralizers, does allow conductors four basic but provides requirements of protection an arc to form a means for quenching for the design of a line Adequate the full clearance effectiveness level used in the must line design. such as protector structure and the the theory be locatd from the line conductor to the tower or ground of the insulating structure can be obtained. (3) Adequate clearances from overhead especially at midspan, to prevent flashover voltage strength of the structures and without affecting the from the line conductor by auxiliary devices, between the ground the arc without interrupting based on the direct-stroke (1) Ground wires with sufficient mechanical the line conductors from direct strokes. (2) so that insulation to ground of an arc ground wires to conductors to the conductors for voltages line are: circuit. to adequately must The shield be maintained must be maintained, up to the protective TRANSMISSION 108 LINE DESIGN Table 17.-Insulation MANUAL selection for 230 kV Switching surge impulse, positive critical Power frequency, 60-Hz wet a. Overvoltage 1.05 1.05 b. Crest factor 1.414 c. Switching surge 2.5 d. Ratio of critical impulse to switching surge 1.175 e. Ratio of withstand to critical flashover voltage 1.175 1.175 f. Contaminated 1.1 1.5 1.2 1.25 atmosphere g. Factor of safety h. Rise due to line faults Total withstand 1.2 multiplying factor (at sea level). Product of (a) through (h) Normal line to neutral, 230/a Total withstand multiplying neutral voltage 6.76 = 132.8 kV factor (at sea level) times normal line to Flashover of 12 insulator units, 146 by 254 mm (S-3/4 by 10 in), from table B-7 in appendix B Factor for nonstandard air density (altitude) 898 kV 369 kV 1105 kV 490 kV 1105/898 From table B-10 in appendix B, permissible elevation limit overhead ground wires are not normally used ground wires are used for a distance of 0.8 km the entire length of line. On lines of 115 kV for the entire length of the line. On transmission (3/8-in), 7-wire, above are used. high-strength lines, 13-mm On lines or for extra so that the long extra saline fogs occur, corrosion resistant overhead extended a straight where spans, heavy galvanized (l/2-in), very 7 -wire, heavy line ice loading, through the overhead maximum angle of 30 o with the vertical. to give a maximum angle of proteetion the angle steel strand radial is used for overhead galvanized steel ice thickness of protection should adequately, ground strand of 25 mm On 230 ground (1 in) or more, the poles the overhead the terrain to maintain kV wires occurs wires where it is desirable to use a more wires. In order to locate the in wood-pole of protection at tangent structures. ground wire and the outside conductor At steel towers, of 20 O. Where be decreased in order wires. overhead steel for the overhead ground sag. In areas near a sea coast, and in other areas having a contaminated atmosphere, material such as Alumoweld for the overhead ground drawn must be obtained. are used on all lines using For standard construction, and higher, overhead ground wires normally are used lines for voltages up to and including 161 kV, lo-mm high-strength the conductors a 30’ cone 3139 m (10 299 ft) on lines of 46 kV or less. On 69.kV lines, overhead (0.5 mi) in each direction from the substations or for it is desirable to use extra-high-strength loads may be carried without excessive ground wires to shield high enough to provide 4901369 = 1.32 = 1.23 2154 m (7068 ft) (4) Tower footing impedances as low as economically justified To meet the first of these requirements, two overhead ground wires H-frame wood-pole construction and generally on all steel tower lines. and 2.78 ground wires lines should be This means that should make a should be located slopes across a transmission line, an angle of less than 30’ for CHAPTER III-INSULATION, LIGHTNING PROTECTION, Table 18.~Insulation CLEARANCE 109 PATTERNS selection for I I5 kV Switching surge impulse, positive critical Power frequency, 60-Hz wet a. Overvoltage 1.05 1.05 b. Crest factor 1.414 c. Switching surge’ 2.8 d. Ratio of critical impulse to switching surge 1.175 e. Ratio of withstand 1.175 1.175 1.1 1.5 1.2 1.25 f. Contaminated to critical flashover voltage atmosphere g. Factor of safety h. Rise due to line faults Total withstand 1.2 multiplying factor (at sea level). Product of (a) through Normal line to neutral, 115/fi= Total withstand multiplying neutral voltage (h) 2.78 503 kV 185 kV 610 kV 255 kV 66.4 kV factor (at sea level) times normal line to Flashover of 6 insulator units, 146 by 254 mm (5-3/4 by 10 in), from table B-7 in appendix B Factor for nonstandard 7.57 610/503 air density (altitude) From table B-10 in appendix B, permissible elevation limit = 1.21 255/185 1946 m (6386 ft) = 1.38 3864 m (12 676 ft) ’ A switching surge value of 2.8 is a more realistic value for 115-kV lines than the 2.5 value used for 230- and 345-kV lines. wood-pole the lines, overhead and ground less than wire earth. If steel towers exceed indicated on figure 43. To maintain between voltages lightning adequate 20 o for steel and the 38.1 m (125 clearance ft) in height, the These and the angles a line angle structure would be between perpendicular or protection and the a line to the should conductors, the through surface of the be reduced air-gap as distance any conductor and the structure should be sufficient to coordinate the impulse flashover of the air gap and the insulation used on the structures, under the conditions at which is likely to occur. Almost all electrical storms occur at temperatures between minus 1 and designs are based air gap between 15.5 OC (60 is measured a sideswing lines. conductor, between 32 OC (30 and 90 OF), and are not insulation suspension tower outside on coordination the conductor likely to occur OF). 0 n wood-pole structures between the conductor and and the insulator air-gap clearance strings caused of 30 O, whichever between the overhead between the ground ground wires and simultaneously of the impulse insulation and the structure with high winds. Therefore, Bureau of the insulators with the minimum pressure of 0.19 kPa (4 lb/fta) at having ground wires running the pole ground wire. On down the pole, steel structures, the clearance the impulse to the structure are coordinated for the sideswing angle by a 0.14kPa wind pressure on the conductors at 15.5 ‘C is greater. wires with value a wind and For complete the conductors the conductors will not coordination, must occur be made before the great flashover clearance enough occurs of the or for at midspan so that flashover at the structure. TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL - (50) 15.2 (70) 21.3 (90) 27.4 (130) 39.6 (110) 33.5 (150) 45.7 TOWER HEIGHT, meters Figure 43.-Reduction Because than of the at the length and of angle of protection impedance structure. of span, an outage shows the span lengths. and of the The the structure probability minimum overhead amount ground of separation footing clearances between voltages have very little tabulation is satisfactory tabulation, the sag in the overhead for voltages 80 percent of the sag of the to the conductor 115 at this separation depends desired structure per year, ground height. at midspan on the a 15-ohm of line wires and the 104-D-1071. must be greater protection footing level, resistance following tabulation conductors for various (15) 4.6 6.1 7.3 9.7 11.3 11.9 13.7 15.5 17.4 (800) wire to structure Midspan spacing, m w (1000) (1150) (1200) (1400) (1600) (1800) from ground mi) overhead (700) relationship the Assuming (600) 183 213 244 305 350 366 427 488 549 according wires, 161 km (100 Span length, m et) Line lightning (feet) required resistance. of 1 or less per midspan against (feet) ( meters 1 (190) 57.9 (170) 5 I.8 (20) (24) (32) (37) (3% (45) (51) (57) required to 500 kV. at 15.5 midspan For ’ C (60 temperature. spans _ clearances, longer ’ F) no load, than should so the those preceding shown be equal in the to about CHAPTER Lightning 60-Hz performance value slightly III-INSULATION, usually less than the 60-Hz less. For based best on the All structures because path pole. under The structures, between through to each desert is fastened protection centerline of the tower I5 the PATTERNS footing, ohms, of resistance, wires the resistance wires should 111 rather the surge surge to the pole surge than the resistance resistance should is measures be estimated, structures, to reinforcing (such as in rocky, one on each 305 mm and (12 a ground down turns grounding bars the brought into each to 18 in) below ground the of the S-pole surface accomplished or in sandy, when a high level of 7.6 m (25 ft) from structure earth 2 the reinforcing terrain at least butt all 2- and welding is used of No. of the pole, the At mountainous are placed wire is usually and at the top the face around staples. counterpoise wires side, to 457 carried impedance together (18 to 24 in) below angles counterpoise structures, spiral grounded on a low be tied of Copperweld continuous be adequately depends should wires, complete On steel stub resistivity line, ground 457 to 610 mm or a double are buried they On wood-pole by means on each pole. two protection wires, five placed The transmission ground wrapped of high ground for lightning to ground. by welding is desired. overhead wires and counterpoise wires values to the overhead pole, footings In areas counterpoise of the up to about 15 ohms, overhead connection the ground lightning The is connected wire a radial having ground are two of the other. areas) lines butt the concrete higher above the impedance an underground is made bars there wire for CLEARANCE data. to reduce ground but of these Where the resistance surge resistances resistances in transmission Copperweld passed on the footing value, available of each structure AWG For footing the effectiveness to ground. PROTECTION, is dependent measured. considerably LIGHTNING and surface. the attached. Figure B-5 in appendix An AIEE B shows ground resistivity values in ohm-meters for the United States. Committee Report published in 1950 [ 131’ was updated and expanded by Clayton and in 1964 [14]. Th e method presented in these reports consists of groups of curves that are based Young on typical span horizontal lengths, insulator to 700 kV. discussed. For studying quantities, that 21. Conductor anticipated Type l Loading area where Minimum conductor Angle of protection l l of towers required Maximum line deflection Ruling span length l Insulation 1 Numbers vertical, at each sum spans in brackets (single the line spacing (against l Maximum adjacent outages Patterns.-Before Longitudinal, ground wires l these The curves footing curves, on wire configurations, cover a voltage resistances use surge transmission for range a desired resistance lines a range I I5 performance values of 345 kV from of as previously and above, it is a designer can design steel towers must afford for a transmission be known: l l using and ground be used. must l When overhead resistances. quantities lightning [15] Clearance data and and footing the curves. reference following conductor of insulator from the suggested the vertical Combinations can be determined line, and or double circuit) is to be constructed lightning) that and transverse loading attachment point of adjacent the ground under wires full-load conditions the for conductors conductors and angle spans, and coordination refer to items in the Bibliography. the maximum distance between low points of the TRANSMISSION 112 It is the the 20; responsibility required data and insulation discussed To in section any insulation and line designer clearance conductor and the considering power frequency) required for the indicted on figure to provide The angle construction all of the of protection of conductor above data. Most of is discussed in section clearance patterns, is 19. adequate structure transmission can be calculated or approximated. coordination, the basis for the maintain between surge, of the LINE DESIGN MANUAL three between structure each the stresses structure should of the three under voltage the condition are, and be sufficient types the to coordinate of voltage at which in general, conductors, each described stress is likely by the air-gap the (lightning gap and the impulse, switching The clearances to govern. three air distance superimposed patterns 44. /////////// /l//// Figure 44Auperimposed clearance voltage stresses. 104-D-1072. patterns 1 Insulator for the three types of Bureau designs for wood-pole structures are based on coordination of the impulse insulation value of the insulators with the minimum air gap between the conductor and structure, and a wind pressure of 0.19 kPa (4 lb/ft2) at 15.5 ‘C (60° F). On steel structures, the impulse insulation of the insulator string and the air-gap clearance to the structure are coordinated suspension insulator strings caused by a 0.19-kPa wind pressure for a sideswing angle of 30 O, whichever is greater. In the normal string, 10 percent is added to the impulse value of the insulator used for clearance to the structure. For the power frequency for the sideswing clearance, the maximum 0.43 to 0.48 kPa (9 to 10 lb/ft2), in the area where the line is to be located, swing of the insulator string. An air gap equivalent to the wet 60-Hz flashover string is used for the clearance envelope. An example Example Assume 644 mm2 problem on constructing the clearance patterns angle wind, (1272 transmission, kcmil), ACSR, line 45/7 follows. with: d u pl ex conductor. The following data usually is used to define the value of the insulator Problem a 345-kV of the at 15.5 “C on the conductors or or vertical position of the insulator string and an equivalent air gap is is also assumed: CHAPTER Maximum Ruling initial III-INSULATION, tension per LIGHTNING PROTECTION, conductor span 18 insulator units per string 146 by 267 mm (5-3/4 by Length per (single 10-l/2 = 53 378 = 350.5 N (12 000 = 3099 mm (122 in) = 3277 mm (129 in) = 1500.8 m (1150 PATTERNS 113 lb) ft) in) string conductor) (duplex conductor) Vertical CLEARANCE force (weight) per string N (337.4 lb) Wind Everyday maximum = 0.19 kPa (4 lb/ft2) Maximum Design for design a minimum = 0.43 kPa (9 lb/ft2) Calculations Sag and tension to be made calculations low-point distance at 15.5 “C are shown L,“ear I TEMP.., / oC UNSTRESSED LENGTH1 LOADING /3mm NO Ice. -mm 0,kPa sr AE to one-third 45 and Force the sum of adjacent 46. I I , ? SAG,mm SAG FACTOR 350.5 SW.N m (W’) Ice Wind (W”‘) Figure 45.-Sag and tension calculation spans. Factor SPANLENGTHW Ice No W\nd equal (60 “F). on figures form for clearance pattern problem (metric). TENSION, N TRANSMISSION 114 LINE DESIGN MANUAL ;;;FL SAGCALCULATIONS L43qpJ CONDUCTOR /'972 Code Name Rated Breaking Dmmeter Load ,!..&& Tension +/Am. Final. -//DF AcF Fml. 6oF Computed by ~ “/.I/ 366 SC R lb Area 50 % 17 lb TemD. - % -lb TEd”p-I /. Wind (A) (W”‘) J!&&!- Coeff. 0.000 tIllSTRESSED LEI(CTH( O// I ,323 Creep O.OOQ&2--- /7: 7817 lb/f: Tolal 0.0009,17 2, 977-3 lblft Modulus, (E) Exp.: z? Final 9.35 lnltial per “F B Set 0.000 lb/f1 in2 of Linear Permanent Ib/ft 5816 1 Final 1 SAC FACTOR / SAG.ft 1 wx AE InltialAE SPAH LENGTH(S) //5D _ lee__ No Wind (w’) (w.‘) Resultant: _25_ Inch Ice. lb lb Date LOADING weight Ice jL 2& Facrors. Dead Llmltarlons: Loaded. No lb 180 L$k.y LOADING h Weight ,?d Inch l”8,~4,+F % ___ ACSR “5 km// 1 ern 4 ; 48 x 106 lb/~+? 103 lb/&? J?Ofl ??/L SW ih 1 :,” TENSION. lb FEET (W’) Figure 46.-Sag and tension calculation form for clearance pattern problem (U.S. customary). Metric A 0.191 52-kPa wind per meter of conductor = A 0.430 92-kPa wind per meter of conductor = (0.430 92) (1000) = 14.722 N/m U. S. Customary A 4-lb/ft’ wind per foot of conductor = A 9-lb/ft2 wind per foot of conductor = The vertical plus one-half load the due to conductor low-point insulator per weight distance equal to one-third the sum of adjacent spans conductor: Metric For duplex conductor line: ‘(350*5) 3 (2) (20 .928) + -1500*8 = 4890.2 + 375.2 = 5265.4 N 4 CHAPTER III-INSULATION, LIGHTNING PROTECTION, CLEARANCE PATTERNS For single conductor line: (350.5) (2) (20 928) + -1500.8 = 4890.2 + 750.4 = 5640.6 N 3 * 2 U. S. Customary For duplex conductor line: (1150) 3 (2) (1 .434) + -337.4 = 1099.4 + 84.3 = 1183.7 lb 4 For single conductor line: (1150)(2) 3 Compute 8 (angle Metric (0.191 of insulator 52-kPa swing) wind, 0’ line for (1 .434)+337.4= 2 the following 1099.4 + 168.7 = 1268.1 lb conditions: angle) Wind = 350.5 (6.542) = 2293 N fj = tan- 1 - 2293 = tan- ’ 0.435 48 = 23O32’, for one conductor of duplex 5265.4 /J = tan- 1 - 2293 = tan- ’ 0.406 52 = 22OO7’, for single conductor 5640.6 U.S. Customary (4-lb/ft2 wind, Wind = 1150(0.4483) 0 = tan-l O” line angle) = 515.55 lb 515.55 = tan- * 0.435 54 = 23O32’, for one conductor of duplex 1183.7 515.55 0 = tan-’ -1268.1 = tan- ’ 0.406 55 = 22OO7’, for single conductor Metric (0.430 92-kPa wind, 0’ line angle) Wind = 350.5 (14.722) = 5 160.06 N ~9= tan-’ 5 160.06 5265.4 = tan- ’ 0.979 99 = 44’25’, for one conductor of duplex 0 = tan- l 5516$)boi = tan- ’ 0.9 14 8 1 ‘= 42O27’, for single conductor 115 TRANSMISSION 116 U.S. Customary (9-lb/ft2 wind, Wind = 1150(1.0088) (j = tan’ l ‘1116~~lf 0 = tan- Metric wind, 5’ line angle) = 1160.12 lb = tan- 1 0.980 08 = 44O25’, for one conductor of duplex l ‘11~~~ 112 = tan- (No 0’ LINE DESIGN MANUAL line l 0.914 85 = 42O27’, for single conductor angle) 2T sin 2S” = 2 (23 916) (0.043 62) = 2086.43 2086.43 5265 4 = tan -l 0.396 25 =21’37’, 0 = tan-’ (j = tan” l 2~~&4~ U.S. Customary (No for one conductor of duplex = tan- l 0.369 90 = 20’ 18’, for single conductor wind, 5 O line angle) 2T sin 2.5’ = 2 (5377) (0.043 62) = 469.09 e = tan- 1 469’09 1183.7 = tan 8 = tan- Metric l ‘s (0.191 = tan- 52-kPa wind, - ’ 0.396 29 = 21037’, for one conductor of duplex l 0.369 91 = 20’ 18’, for single conductor 5’ line angle) 2T sin 2.5’ = 2 (24 985) (0.043 62) = 2179.69 e = tan- l 2179.69 + 2293 = tanl 0.849 45 = 40020’, for one conductor of duplex 5265.4 e = tan- l 2179.69 + 2293 =,tanl 0.792 95 = 38O24’, for single conductor 5640.6 CHAPTER Customary U.S. III-INSULATION, (4-lb/ft2 wind, LIGHTNING 5 O line PROTECTION, CLEARANCE PATTERNS angle) 2T sin 2.5O = 2 (5617) (0.043 62) = 490.03 6 = tan- l 490.03 + 515.55 = tan- 1 0.849 52 = 40020’, for one conductor of duplex 1183.7 e = tan-, 490.03 + 515.55 = tan- 1 0.792 98 = 38”24’, for single conductor 1268.1 Metric (0.430 92-kPa wind, 5’ line angle) 2T sin 2.5O = 2 (28 883) (0.043 62) = 2519.75 e = tan-l 2519.75 + 5160.06 = tan- * 1.4585 = 55O34’, for one conductor of duplex 5265.4 8 = tan- l 2519.75 + 5160.06 = tan- 1 1.36 15 = 53O42’, for single conductor 5640.6 Customary U.S. (9-lb/f@ wind, 5 O line angle) 2T sin 2.5O = 2 (6494) (0.043 62) = 566.54 e = tan-I 566.54+ 1160.12 = tan- 1 1.4587 = 55034’, for one conductor of duplex 1183.7 e = tan- 1 566.54 + 1160.12 = tan-’ 1268.1 Metric (No wind, 15 ’ line 1.3616 = 53O42’, for single conductor angle) 2T sin 7.5O = 2 (23 916) (0.130 53) = 6243.51 e = tmwl 6243.51 5265.4 = tan e = b- - l 1.1858 = 49O5 1’ , for one conductor of duplex i 6243.51 = tan- 1 1.1069 = 47O 54’, for single conductor 5640.6 117 TRANSMISSION 118 Customary U.S. (No wind, 15 O line LINE DESIGN MANUAL angle) 2T sin 7.S” = 2 (5377) (0.130 53) = 1403.72 1403.72 = tan- 1 1.1858 = 4905 1’, for one conductor of duplex 1183.7 8 =tan-’ e = TV- 1 1403.72 = tan- ’ 1.1069 = 47O 54’, for single conductor 1268.1 Metric (0.191 52-kPa 2T sin 79 e = tan-l wind, 15’ line angle) = 2 (24 985) (0.130 53) = 6522.58 6522.58 + 2293 = tan-’ 5265.4 1.6742 = 59OO9’, for one conductor of duplex e = tan- l 6522.58 + 2293 = tan- 1 1.5629 = 57O23’, for single conductor 5640.6 U.S. Customary (4-lb/ft2 wind, 15’ line angle) 2T sin 7.5’ = 2 (5617) (0.130 53) = 1466.37 e =tan-’ 1466.37 + 515.55 = tan’ 1 1.6743 = 59OO9’, for one conductor of duplex 1183.7 8 = tan-’ 1466.37 + 515.55 = tan-l 1268.1 Metric (0.430 92-kPa wind, 15’ line 1.5629 = $7O23’, for single conductor angle) 2T sin 7.5O = 2 (28 883) (0.130 53) = 7540.20 I:=Qn 1 7540.20 + 5 160.06 = tan-’ 5265.4 e = TV- 1 7540.20 + 5160.06 = tan-’ 5640.6 2.4119 = 67O29’, for one conductor of duplex 2.25 16 = 66OO3”, for single conductor CHAPTER III-INSULATION, Customary (9-lb/ft2 U.S. wind, LIGHTNING 15O line PROTECTION, CLEARANCE PATTERNS angle) 2T sin 7.5O = 2 (6494) (0.130 53) = 1695.32 1695.32 + 1160.12 = tan- 1 2.4 123 = 67O29’, for one conductor of duplex 1183.7 0 = tan-’ 1695.32 + 1160.12 = tanl 2.2517 = 66OO3’, for single conductor 1268.1 8 = tan-’ Metric (-0.191 8 = tan- 5%kPa f 2179..69 wind, 5’ - 2293 5265.4 8 = tan-, U.S. Customary line angle) -0.021 52 = -lo 14’, for one conductor of duplex = tan” 2179.69 - 2293 = tan- 1 - 0.020 09 = -1’09”, for single conductor 5640.6 (-4-lb/ft2 wind, 5 ’ line angle) e = tan- 1 490.03 - 515.55 = tm” 1183.7 -0.021 56 = -lo 14’, for one conductor of duplex 8 = tan” 490.03 - 515.55 ztm-1 1268.1 -0.020 12 = -1’09’, for single conductor Metric (-0.430 B = tan-l 9%kPa 2519.75 wind, 5 O line - 5160.06 5265.4 8 = tan-l U.S. Custmmy B = tm-l angle) = tan-l -0.501 44 = -26’38’, 2519.75 - 5160.06 =tm-’ 5640.6 (-9-lb/ft2 wind, 5 O line 566.54- 1160.12= tm-l 1183.7 for one conductor of duplex -0.468 09 = -25OO5 , for single conductor angle) -o . 501 46 = -26O38’, for one conductor of duplex 0 = tan- 1 566’54 - ’ ’ 60*1 2 = tan- l k 0.468 09 = -25OOS’ , for single conductor 1268.1 119 120 TRANSMISSION Metric (-0.191 52-kPa wind, 15’ MANUAL line angle) e = tan- 1 6522.58 - 2293 = tan-’ 5265.4 13= tan-’ LINE DESIGN 0.803 28 = 38O46’, for one conductor of duplex 6522.58 - 2293 = tan- l 0.749 84 = 36O5 l’, for single conductor 5640.6 U.S. Customary (-4-lb/ft2 wind, 15 O line angle) e =tan-’ - 5 15.55 1466.371183.7 = tan- 1 0.803 26 = 38O46’, for one conductor of duplex 8 =tan-’ 1466.37 - 515.55 = tan” 1268.1 Metric (-0.430 92-kPa wind, 0.749 80 = 36O51’, for single conductor 15 o line angle) 8 = tan-’ 7540.20 - 5 160.06 = tan- ’ 0.452 03 = 24O 19’, for one conductor of duplex 5265.4 e = tan- 1 7540.20 - 5 160.06 = tan- 1 0.421 97 = 22O52’, for single conductor 5640.6 U.S. Customary (-9-lb/fts 8 =twl e=ta-l wind, 15 O line angle) 1695.32 - 1160.12 = tan’ 0.452 14 = 24O 19’, for one conductor of duplex 1183.7 1695.32 1160.12 = tan- 1 0.422 05 = 22O52’, for single conductor 1268.1 Determine the critical positive impulse flashover value and the 60-Hz wet flashover value of the insulator string to be used. Determine the lengths of air gaps that are electrically equivalent to the critical positive impulse flashover, equivalent to the impulse flashover plus 10 percent, and equivalent to the 60-Hz wet flashover. These values may be obtained from catalog data or from the tables in appendix B. For example: 1. For 18 insulator units, the critical positive impulse flashover is 1585 kV (table B-7, app. B). 2. 1585 kV plus 10 percent equals 1744 kV. 3. The SO-Hz wet flashover for 18 units is 690 kV (table B-7, app. B). 4. The equivalent air gaps for l., 2., and 3. are 2642,2921, and 2083 mm (104,115, and 82 in), respectively (table B-8, app. B). CHAPTER III-INSULATION, LIGHTNING PROTECTION, CLEARANCE -Bottom of crossarm PATTERNS 121 1524 mm (i-6) Conductor elevation center of tower Conductor elevation at edge of tower, high side of 1:5 ground at Conductor elevation at edge of tower, level span Conductor elevation at edge of tower, low side of 1:5 ground slope NOTES: Conductor = 644 mm2 (1272 kcmil), ACSR, 45/ 7. Sag at 15.5 “C (60 OF)=I3 628 mm (44.71 ft) for a 350.5-m (1150-ft) span. Conductor elevation at edge of, cage: bktriC: 1.219/350.5=0.35% of span = 1.5% of sag =204 mm. U.S. Customary: 4/1150 = 0.35 % of span = 1.5% of sog = 0.67 ft= 8.1 in. Assume ground slope of I in 5 equivalent to 244 mm (0.8 ft=9.6 in) additional sag at edge of tower. On low side of tower, total drop of conductor at edge of tower=448 mm (17.7 in). On high side of tower, assume conductor sag cancels effect of ground slope. Fire 47.-Assumed dimensions for side view of structure at conductor elevation. 104-D-1073. Figure 4’7 shows the assumed dimensions of the sideview of the tower at the conductor elevation. Clearance patterns for two structure types, a tangent structure and an angle structure capable of taking line angles between 5 O and 15 O, have been constructed for two cases: (1) for duplex conductor, and (2) a single conductor. These clearance patterns are shown on figures 48, 49, 50, and 51. The clearance pattern shown on figure 48 has been noted to illustrate the following discussion on construction of the clearance pattern. After selecting a scale, begin constructing the pattern by striking a 180° arc with a radius equal to the length of the insulator string as it hangs normally; the center of the arc represents the attachment point of the insulator string at the tower. By looking at a side view of the tower (fig. 47), it can be seen that the electrical clearance between the conductor and steel will be most critical at the edge of the tower because of the sag in the conductor. To account for this, draw a second arc parallel to the first, but with the radius increased by the amount of the conductor sag at the edge of the tower. These arcs represent the possible locations of the conductor (short radius at the centerline of the tower, and long radius at the edge of the tower) at the end of the insulator string, or the centerline between conductors if duplex conductors are used. Draw radii representing the insulator string as it hangs normally and at its positions with the different wind TRANSMISSION 122 pressures edge and of the strike line tower arcs to form air gaps previously equal to the drawn from t angles, (fig. as applicable. 47) for an envelope the the 0.19-kPa From the 4331 8662 mm (28: 5”) 0.19152-kPa 0.43092-kPa -0.19152-kPa -0.43092-kPa pattern value 1I I is the radii 4331 locations conductor for these of the plus conductor adjusted conductor, the The arc has a radius radius of the of the insulator mm (Id-2;“) ,/Insulator at the locations, arcs are the equivalent 10 percent. air gap equivalent structure wind, wind, wind, wind, wind, w string 0” line 0” -line O” line 0” line 0” line with single conductor. angle angle angle angle angle 104-D-1074. arc impulse Additional clearance for sloping span due to sloping ground = 244 mm (9.6 in) no (d-lb / ft2) (g-lb/ ft2) 64-lb /ft2) (-g-lb/ ft2) for a 30s tangent the these The position impulse tower =204 mm (8.1 in ) Figure BI.-Clearance points. position (Clearance for upslope a 00 b 1 22’07’. C = 42”27’, b’=-22”07’, C’ =-42’27’, showing From ‘?wind” mm (I 41-2;‘) MANUAL points “no-wind” insulator w w the conditions. the conductor of the (4-lb/f@) Locate applicable around determined. air gap equivalent LINE DESIGN CHAPTER III-INSULATION, LIGHTNING flashover value, and the arc radius of the 60-Hz wet flashover value from the 0.43-kPa of the insulator corresponding values, No part wind of a steel and line structure angle is allowed are shown to encroach PROTECTION, CLEARANCE PATTERNS (9-lb/ft2) wind position is the air gap equivalent string. The angles of insulator swing, with their on figures upon 48,49,50, a clearance and 51 for ready pattern envelope. 9398 mm (30’~101’) 4699 mm (I 5: 5”) \457 cl 4699 mm ( I 5: 5”) mm (18 in) Spacing of duplex conductor 0” b 123’32’: O.i9152-kPa (4-lb/ft*) c = 44’25’. 0.43092-kPa (g-lb /ft*) b’=-23°32’,-0.19152 -kPa (-4-lb/ft*) C’ =-44°25’,-0.43092-kPa (-Wb/ft*) Figure 49Alearance pattern for a 30s tangent 123 structure no wind, wind, wind, wind, wind, with duplex 0” 0” 0” 0” 0” line line line line line conductor. angle angle angle angle angle 104-D-1075. reference. 124 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 8992 mm (291-6”) l-2 3099 mm (122 in) -0.4x92-kPa a =-25’05’, b =-oIO o9’,-O.I9152-kPa C = 20” I8’, d = 22” 52’, -0.43092--kPa e = 36’51’, -0.19152 -kPa f = 38’24’, 0.19152-kPa g = 47”54’, h = 53’42’, o.43092-kPa i = 57O 23’, 0.19152-kPa j= 66OO3’, 0.43092-kPa Fire SO.-Clearance pattern (-g-lb /ft2) wind, 5” line (-4-lb / ft2) wind, 5” line no wind, 5” line (-g-lb / ft2) wind, 15” line (-4-lb /ft2) wind, 15” line (4-lb /ft2) wind, 5” line no wind,-l5O line (g-lb / ft2) wind, 5” line (4-lb / ft2) wind, 15” line (g-lb / ft2) wind, 15” line for a 30A angle structure with single conductor. angle angle angle angle angle angle angle angle angle angle 104-D-1076. CHAPTER III-INSULATION, 9652 * c LIGHTNING 3874 mm (12:8;) 1168 PROTECTION, CLEARANCE mm ( 31L8”) C! C 5778 mm (18Lll~) mm (46 in)+ L74fR 3277 mm (129 in) a =-26’38’,-0.43092-kPa (-g-lb / ft*) b =-01” ~4’,-0.~9~52 -kPa (-&lb/ ft*) c = d= e= f = 9= h= i= j = wind, wind, no wind, 21” 36’. 24” I&-0.43092-kPa (-9-lb/ft*) wind, 38” 46’, -0.19152 -kPa (-+lb/ft*) wind, 40020’, 0.19152-kPa (+lb/ft*) wind, 49O5l’, no wind, 55O34, 0.43092-kPa (g-lb / f t*) wind, 5g”W, 0.19152-kPa (+lb/ft*) wind, 67’29’. 0.43092-kPa (g-lb/ft*) wind, Figure Sl.-Clearance pattern for a 30A angle structure 125 PATTERNS with duplex line 5O line 5” line 15” line 15” line 5” line 15” line 5” line 15” line 15’ line 5” conductor. angle angle angle angle angle angle angle angle angle angle 104-D-1077. <Chapter STRUCTURE 22. General.-For constructed for construction wood-pole is also main transmission loading line conditions, AND GUYING under consideration, specific size and CHARTS a structure type limitation of conductor, to be used. The chart is used to determine the type of structure construction that is required at any’ given location in the transmission constructed 23. each the LIMITATION to determine Components the nutnber of Charts.-The of guys structure to be used limitation and IV with the guying and is type of for either steel or line. A guying chart wood-pole chart chart the structures. consists of the following items: l A suspension-type structure limitation chart that determines required for a given location. The chart also determines points) which must be provided by the conductor to limit for a particular location are outside the limits of any necessary to use a dead-end-type is dependent on the magnitude between conductor low points at the structure. l A guy chart magnitude that determines of the line angle self-supporting steel structures references to guys are omitted. l A summary of guying A table summarizing l Notes l covering the structure. The type of suspension the number of angle and the lengths of are to be used for materials, and of structure required guys required the adjacent a transmission the structure the amount of mass (between low insulator sideswing. If the conditions suspension-type structure, it will be of the line angle, lengths of the adjacent in the adjacent spans, and the required data for tension structures. the structure types, their span construction the type limits, conditions and at any location actual spans, distance conductor clearances (dependent upon the actual spans). When line, the their allowable on which guy the chart and line chart all angles. is based. 24. Preparation of Charts.-A structure limitation chart for steel towers and a structure limitation and guying chart for H-frame, wood-pole transmission lines are developed in this section. The following numbered paragraphs (1 through 7) describe the procedures for preparing these charts. Paragraph In order established: 1. to establish a basis for preparing For steel structures, the permissible a. structure is determined from the clearance clearance pattern depends on the these sideswing pattern size and’ type charts, following standards have been of each insulator string on a suspension-type established for the design of the towers. The of conductor 127 the and loading conditions for which the 128 TRANSMISSION transmission shall The and line for determining and the following the strength minimum strings (suspension) 2.5 strings (tension) 3.0 spans, the maximum angle are established these structure distance limits factors Insulator to fit in California, for important MANUAL Insulator deflection are designed b. Except voltages and Calculations conditions sum of adjacent maximum towers designed. on full-load maximum the steel line is being be based LINE DESIGN between as required for of insulator strings of safety: low points the of adjacent transmission line spans, and the requirements. the design of all wood-pole lines of lower voltages shall transmission be in accordance lines for 69-kV and higher with grade B construction as shown in the latest edition of NESC. Loading conditions and conductor and overhead ground wire tensions shall also be in accordance with the latest edition of the code, except as modified by figure 1 or by specific heavier loading conditions than those prescribed for the general area for which a line is being designed. The recommended conductor ultimate used on transmission maximum design tensions (full-load tensions based on 33-l/3 percent of the ’ C (0 ’ F) under initial conditions) for typical conductors strength at minus 18 lines with H-frame, wood-pole structures are shown in the following tabulation: ACSR, 2417 conductors mm2 RCW 242 282 306 322 403 Maximum full-load conductor Maximum N (477) E) 33362 35 585 31810 40034 44482 (636) (795) tension allowble on standard exceed 44 482 N (10 000 lb). Strength calculations for determining permissible guying, and requirements for double insulator strings USBR tensions (lb) (7 500) (8000) (8 500) (9 000) (10 000) H-frame, wood-pole structures should not in paragraph 2 and the minimum Selection of the proper type condition of 0.19-kPa (4-lb/ft2) factors of safety of suspension wind pressure zones. The three axes of the structure limitation of this loading condition. Table 20 shows the span lengths, distance between low shall be based on the full-load conditions shown in table 19. structure for any location shall be based on a loading on the bare conductor at 15.5 o C (60 o F) in all loading chart shall be calibrated minimum clearance from to correspond the conductor ground wire or to the surface of the crossarm; these clearances shall be maintained condition above. If a pole ground wire is not be maintained to the centerline types of structures are shown different types of wood points, shown to the values to the pole under the loading used, the clearances specified to the pole ground wire in table 20 shall of the. poles. The limits for permissible insulator swing on the different for, the various voltage classes in table 21. Drawings of some of the structures are shown later in this section. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS Table lg.-Minimum factors of safety for wood-pole construction’ (grade B) At full load Wood poles Crossarms Guys (line) Guys (transverse) Insulator strings (suspension) Insulator strings (tension) Insulator pins (bending) Conductor At 15.5 OC (60 OF), no wind 35.5 35.5 z 22:o 2.61 ‘2.5 i-8 2:o 4.0 r Factors of safety are based on ultimate strengths of the different materials to whith they are applicable. USBR standard. 3 Based on 8.96-MPa (1300-lb/in*) fiber stress for fii, or 6.89-MPa (lOOO-lb/in*) fiber stress for western red cedar. Table 20.-Conductor clearance to pole ground wire or crossarm surface-wood-pole construction Conductor Type of construction, kV Pole ground wire’ mm (in) 660 1092 1245 1524 1803 69 115 138 161 230 (26) (43) (49) (60) (71) clearance Crossarm surface’ mm (in) 508 889 991 1245 1473 (20) (35) (39) (49) (58) t USBR standard. Table 21 .-Angukzr limitations of suspension insulator swing for standard USBR wood-pole structures Structure type HS HSB 3A El 3AD’ 69 kV *54 max. *54 max. 30 min. -30 12 min. to +70 -30 to +70 115 kV 36 max. 36 max. 36 min. -16 24 min. to +70 -16 to +70 AnguIar limitation, 138 kV 40 max. 40 max. 39 min. -28 27 min. to +70 -28 to +70 degrees 161 kV 38 max. 38 max. 45 min. 35 min. -16 to +63 -16 to +63 230 kV 42 max. 42 max. 41 mill. 38 min. -17 to +60 -17 to +60 ’ Structure types 3AC and 3AD should not be used where either a type 3A or 3AB wiIl satisfy the req$rements of the proposed structure:location. Extreme care should be exercised inchecking for uplift. 129 TRANSMISSION 130 The following conductor minimum positions clearance on wood-pole LINE DESIGN MANUAL between conductor and guy wire shall be maintained at all construction: Typeofconsmction kV C1&?llWlCe’ mm w 69 115 138 161 230 965 1397 1524 1676 1956 (38) (55) (60) (66) (77) 1 USBR standard. In areas where conductors and length of a single span conductors and overhead (600 ft), full-sag ellipses should ground should one-half-sag be used. ellipses may overhead ground wires be limited to prevent wires due to galloping be- used to determine are subject to ice loading, contact between conductors conductors. For span lengths the required clearances. For the maximum or between up to‘183 m longer spans, c. In California, the design of wood-pole transmission lines shall be in accordance with grade B construction as shown in General Order No. 95 of the California Public Utilities Commission [l],’ except that grade A construction is required for crossings over railroads and major communication lines. Loading conditions with General Order and conductor No. 95, except The recommended conductor ultimate maximum design tensions (full-load tensions based on 33-l/3 percent of the strength at minus 18 o C (0 ’ F) under initial conditions) for typical conductors lines in California with H-frame, wood-pole structures are shown in the following used on transmission tabulation: and overhead ground as modified by figure ACSR, 2417 conductors Maximum full-load mm2 W-1 242 282 306 322 403 (4771 (556.5) conductor Maximum N 33 35 37 40 44 (605) (636) (795) tension on standard should not exceed 44 482 N (10 000 lb). Strength calculations for determining permissible guying, and requirements for double insulator strings in paragraph ’ Numbers 2 and in brackets the minimum factors of safety refer to items in the Bibliography. wire 1. tensions allowble 362 585 810 034 482 USBR shall also be in accordance tensions (lb) (7 (8 (8 (9 (10 500) 000) 500) 000) 000) H-frame-type structures in California span lengths, distance between low shall be based on the full-load conditions shown in table 22. points, shown CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 131 Table 22.-Minimum factors of safety for wood-pole construction in California’ Grade A Wood poles Crossarms Guys, except in light loading rural areas Guys in light loading rural areas Insulator strings (suspension) Insulator strings (tension) Insulator pins (bending) Conductor Grade B 2t:: 24.0 3.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 1.5 22.5 23.0 23.0 2.0 23:o Ei 2.0 ’ Factors of safety are based on ultimate strengths of the different to Thich they are applicable. USBR standard. Selection at 15.5 ‘C of the proper (60 OF) with type of suspension a 0.19-kPa (4-lb/ft2) crossarm; these for any location shall he based on conditions wind pressure in all loading areas. The three axes of shall be calibrated to correspond to the values at the above conditions. clearance from the conductor to the pole ground wire or to the surface the structure limitation chart Table 23 shows the minimum of the structure materials clearances shall be maintained under the above loading condition. Table 23.-Conductor clearance to pole ground wire or crossarm surface-wood-pole construction in cizlifornia Conductor Pole ground wire’ mm (in) Type of construction, kV 69 115 138 161 230 (26) 660 1092 1245 1524 1803 (43) (49) (60) (71) clearance Crossarm surfacer mm (in) (20) 508 889 991 1245 1473 (35) (39) (49) (58) r USBR standard. If a pole ground be maintained The limits The conductor wire is not used, the clearances specified to the centerline of the poles. for permissible insulator swing in California following minimum clearance between conductor to the pole are the and same guy positions: T&e of construction kV Clearance ’ mm (in) 69 965 (38) 115 138 161 230 1524 1397 1676 1956 035) s USBR standard. si; (77) wire ground wire as shown shall in table in table be maintained 23 shall 21. at all TRANSMISSION 132 In areas of California maximum length conductors (600 ft), where of a single and overhead full-sag ellipses one-half-sag ellipses Paragraph may span conductors should LINE DESIGN and overhead be limited ground wires due should be used ground to prevent to galloping to determine MANUAL wires contact are subject between conductors. the For required to ice loading, conductors span lengths clearance. For the or between up to longer 183 m spans, be used. 2. Full-load conditions are as follows: National Electrical Safety Code or California General Order No. 95 Loading for calculations of strength of structures and their components Light loading districts’ : 0.43-kPa (9-lb/ft2) wind pressure, no ice, plus constant, at -1 OC (30 OF) 0.57~kPa (1 2-lb/ft2 ) wind pressure, no ice’ Medium loading districts’ : 0.19-kPa (4-lb/ft2 ) wind pressure, 6-mm (l/4+1) ice, plus constant, at -9.5 OC (15 OF) 0.38-kPa (8-lb/ft2 ) wind pressure, 6-mm ( l/4&) ice’ Heavy loading districts’ : 0.19-kPa (4lb/ft2 ) wind pressure, 13-mm ( l/2+) ice, plus constant, at - 18 OC (0 OF) 0.38~kPa (S-lb/ft2 ) wind pressure, 13-mm (l/2+1) ice’ California light loading: 0.3 8-kPa ( 8-lb/ft2 ) wind pressure, no ice, at -4 OC (25 OF) 0.38~kPa (8-lb/ft2 ) wind pressure, no ice California heavy 0.29-kPa (6-lb/ft2 pressure, 13-mm ice, at - 18 OC (0 0.29-kPa (6-lb/ft2 ) wind pressure, 13-mm ( l/2&) ice loading: ) wind ( l/2-in) OF) ’ Extreme wind loading as shown on NESC figure 250-2 in reference [ 31 should be u;ed if resultant loading is greater. Pa ragrap h 3. The data transmission patterns. The required for construction of a structure line are discussed at the beginning clearance patterns themselves limitation of section are important chart for the design of a steel structure 21, which covers conductor clearance because they indicate the maximum design CHAPTER swing of the suspension limitation lines on the previously discussed maximum sum that shows Example Assume conductor. insulator strings low-point portion are basically of adjacent the procedure Problem for (steel a 345-kV Assume obtaining conditions. The extreme data are also assumed: initial heavy) made 30s = tangent, 30X = tangent 30A 30T 30D = = = angle, tangent tangent for each chart. steel structure for with a 644-mm2 swing The angles balance low-point An become of the distance example and problem limitation force wind pressure data the follows chart. = per extreme per unit length N/m (1.8867 here for 45/7 wind duplex pressure. for the conductor lb/ft) for NESC example purposes. The (weight) of steel transmission V-string = 63 165 N (14 200 lb) 350.5 m (1150 ft) = 3556 mm = 1628 N (366 = = 0.19 0.48 string by per 10-l/2 in) string design suspension, ACSR, (16~lb/ftz) was assumed maximum types (1272-kcmil), a 0.77-kPa because the resultant force which is less than 27.5345 Design for a minimum sum of adjacent spans. are usually the maximum on the data is in an area with 267 mm (5-3/4 per string Maximum of the different the these chart. full-load tension per conductor Ruling span 20 insulator units Drawings although are drawn line location not be a factor (1.285 lb/ft), Vertical Wind Everyday data, of structures; limitation 133 CHARTS construction) the line 146 by Length structure the AND GUYING types of the limitations transmission Maximum (NESC LIMITATION on the various tabled spans This wind pressure will would be 18.746 N/m full-load following IV-STRUCTURE low-point distance structures line. Steel on center to 5 O line angle, suspension line angle, suspension 5 to 15’ to 5’ line angle, tension to 30’ line angle, dead end equal are not shown tower phase kPa kPa (140 in) lb) (4 lb/ft2) (10 lh/fts) to one-third the in this manual designations and types because are: new designs TRANSMISSION 134 Tabular steel tower data LINE DESIGN MANUAL follows: Metric Tower type Line angle capability Ruling span (m) Maximum single span (m) Minimum line angle Maximum line angle Maximum sum of adjacent spans (m) Minimum line angle Maximum line angle Maximum low point distance (m) Conductor, minimum line angle Conductor, maximum line angle OGW, minimum line angle OCW, maximum line angle Maximum uplift (N) Conductor, minimum line angle Conductor, maximum line angle OGW, minimum line angle OGW, maximum line angle Body heights (m) Leg extension range (m), at 0.762-m intervals 30s 30x 30A 30T 30D O0 350.5 00-50 350.5 so-150 350.5 00-50 350.5 00-300 350.5 396 396 487.5 396 487.5 396 548.5 487.5 640 792.5 792.5 975.5 792.5 975.5 792.5 1097 975.5 1280 731.5 731.5 853.5 853.5 975.5 792.5 1036.5 853.5 975.5 792.5 1036.5 853.5 19.8 and 25.9 1.524 19.8 and 25.9 1.524 19.8 and 25.9 1.524 10x lo:607 10x 1280 1280 1524 1524 305 213.5 396 254 16.8 and 22.9 1.524 lo::7 1371.5 1463 305 396 16.8 and 22.9 1.524 lo::7 U. S. Customary Tower type Line angle capability Ruling span (ft) Maximum single span (ft) Minimum line angle Maximum line angle Maximum sum of adjacent spans (ft) Minimum line angle Maximum line angle Maximum low point distance (ft) Conductor, minimum line angle Conductor, maximum line anae OCW, minimum line angle OCW, maximum line angle Maximum uplift (lb) Conductor, minimum line angle Conductor, maximum line angle OGW, minimum line angle OGW, maximum line angle Body heights 0% Leg extension range (ft), at 2.5-ft intervals 30A 30T 30s 30x 00 1150 00-50 1150 so-150 1150 00-50 1150 00-300 1150 1300 1300 1600 1300 1600 1300 1800 1600 2100 2600 2600 3200 2600 3200 2600 3600 3200 4200 2400 2400 2800 2800 3200 2600 3400 2800 3200 2600 3400 2800 4200 4200 5000 5000 65 and 85 5 65 and 85 5 65 and 85 5 :5” ii ;: 1000 700 1300 833 55 and 75 5 :z 30D 4500 4800 1000 1300 55 and 75 5 ii CHAPTER Calculations IV-STRUCTURE for the strength LIMITATION requirements AND GUYING of insulator strings CHARTS for the various 135 types of steel towers are as follows: Type 30.5, 0 o Ihe Maximum Maximum Conductor force 0.38-kPa (8-lb/ft2) The bcm-570 with conductor a 0.38-kPa angle low-point distance = 731.5 m (2400 ft) sum of adjacent spans = 792.5 m (2600 13 mm wind force wind values are simply (l/2 on iced in) are shown twice of radial conductor the = ft) ice = 37.676 22.816 N/m on figures values shown N/m (2.5816 (1.5634 lb/ft) 52 and 53. The on these figures force for lb/ft) values shown a 0.19-kPa above for wind. (9-78) Dead Load Force (W’) /3 mm Ica (W”)& OakPa Initial *-%,33%-.-Final .oc , Loadad,~~.50% Final I- 15.5~ ,COIIIPUW~ by No Ica. *Wind N 25 K -N (We”) I/. 408 ,.,,m j.3. ff9 N/m N o.ooo osw? Oats - *I977 Total O.O0/4Jo Modulus. (I3 Final k&&6- Area (AlC84md Temp. Coaff. of Linear -N K- Resultant. creep o.oooGG2LL Nh Wind Exp.: initial Fit?alAE per% NEtSC K:r/.374?2 Initial /1/ & 4//P GPa 2/ :! GPa &,/-‘I AE 3/ t (W) No Ice. Lk Wind (W’) Fire 52.-Conductor (metric). sag and tension calculation form for example problem on steel structure limitation chart TRANSMISSION 136 DC-K70 LINE DESIGN MANUAL (S-78) CONOUCTOR l&U km;/ ACSR 454 33ifem Code Name Rated Breaking Load Diameter Tension /U.&I Dead Weight -lb inch + hi”. L~m~tauonr: Initial.Final, - computed OF% OFA%- by - /. 4340 758 6 lb/f1 AL Lb Wind ..,,:, ‘F33fK LOrded .FiMl. *OF (W’) ICI (W”) Resultant: -lb Y - lb lb Area (A) /. TemD.‘Cooff. (W”‘) 3.6073 O.WO On per ‘?= Set 0.00 Creap o.oon~- lb/f1 Totai 0.001 O./O 4 lb/f1 in2 of Linear Exp.: s,g77 $4 -lb Date Permanent lb/f1 X=0,30 NEsc Modulus. (E) Final 9 35 Initial~x Final AE .a Initial AE ,7 159 x 1OS lb/it-$ 106 lb/id lb 276 lb No Ice. No Wind (W’) 0 Inch Ice No Ice. Mm Wind (w’) Figure 53.-Conductor customary). sag and tension calculation form for example problem on steel structure limitation chart (U.S. Metric Maximum Maximum Resultant vertical load = (731.52) (37.676) = 27 560.75 newtons per conductor wind load = (792.48/2) (22.816) = 9040.61 newtons per conductor load = [(27 560.75)2 + (9040.61)2]1/2 = 29 005.65 newtons per conductor = 58 011.30 newtons per phase = 145 028.25 newtons per phase with a safety factor of 2.5 Use 177 928-N insulator units for suspension strings. A sketch of a center phase V-string attachment for the 30s tower is shown on figure 54. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 137 For center phase V-string, b -=-a sin A 4 145 028 _ b sin 80° sin SO0 50” b ~(800) SillB a b = 145 028 (0.766 04) = 112 810.85 N 0.984 8 1 ‘“B’ Use 133 446-N insulator units. Figure S4.-Center phase V-string structure with no line angle. for type 30s steel U.S. Customary Maximum vertical Maximum Resultant wind load = (2600/2) load I = [(6195.84)2 + load = = Use 40 OOO-lb = (2400) 13 041.34 32 603.34 insulator (2.5816) pounds pounds units for = 6195.84 (1.5634) = (2032.42)2]r/2 per per phase phase suspension pounds per conductor 2032.42 pounds per conductor = 65’20.67 pounds per conductor with a safety factor strings. For center phase V-string (fig. 54), -=- a sinA 32= sin 80’ b sinB b sin SO0 b = 32 603 (o-766 04) = 25 360 57 I,, 0.984 81 Use 30 OOO-lb insulator units. Type 30X, 0 O line angle Maximum Maximum low-point distance = 975.5 m (3200 ft) sum of adjacent spans = 975.5 m (3200 ft) of 2.5 TRANSMISSION 138 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Metric Maximum vertical Maximum wind Resultant load Use 222 load load = = (975.5) (975.5/2) = [(36 = 76 800 = 192 000 410-N 752)a + = 36 752 newtons per conductor = 11 128 newtons per conductor (11 newtons insulator (37.676) (22.816) 128)a]1/2 per newtons = 38 400 newtons per conductor phase per phase with a safety factor of 2.5 units. U. S. Customary Maximum vertical Maximum wind Resultant load Use 50 OOO-lb load load = = = = = (3200) (3200/2) [(8261.12)2 17 263.06 43 157.65 insulator (2.5816) = 8261.12 (1.5634) (2501.44) = 2501.44 pounds per conductor 2 ] l/2 = 8631.53 pounds per conductor + pounds pounds per per phase phase with pounds a safety per factor conductor of 2.5 units. Type 30X, 5 o line angle Maximum low-point Maximum sum distance of adjacent = spans 792.5 = m (2600 792.5 ft) m (2600 ft) Metric Maximum vertical load Maximum wind load Angle load = 2 T(sin Resultant Use 177 load 928-N = = = = = (792.5) (37.676) = 29 858 (792.5/2) (22.816) = 9040 a/2) = 2(63 165) (0.043 62) [(29 858)a + (9040 + 5510)2]1/2 66 428 newtons per phase 166 070 newtons per phase with insulator newtons newtons = 5510 = per 33 214 a safety conductor per conductor newtons per conductor newtons factor per conductor of 2.5 units. U.S. Customary Maximum Maximum vertical load = (2600) (2.5816) = wind load = (2600/2) (1.5634) = = 2(14 200) (0.043 Angle load = 2 T ( sin a/2) Resultant load = [(6712.16)2 + (2032.42 + = 14 933.72 pounds per phase = 37 334.3 pounds per phase Use 40 OOO-lb insulator 6712.16 2032.42 62) = 1238.81)2]1/2 with a safety units. Type 3OA, 5 ’ line angle Maximum low-point Maximum sum distance of adjacent = spans 975.5 = m (3200 975.5 pounds pounds 1238.81 ft) m (3200 ft) per conductor per conductor pounds per = 7466.86 factor of 2.5 conductor pounds per conductor CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 139 Metric Maximum vertical Maximum Angle wind load Resultant Use load 222 = load = 2 T(sin load = (37.676) (975.5/2) a/2) = [(36 = 80 684 = 201 410-N (975.5) = 752)2 (22.816) 2(63 + (11 newtons 710 insulator newtons = 36 752 newtons = 11 128 newtons 165) (0.043 128 + per 62) = 5510)2]r/2 5510 = per conductor per conductor newtons 40 342 per conductor newtons per conductor phase per phase with a safety factor of 2.5 units. U. S. Customary Maximum vertical load = (3200) (2.5816) = 8261.12 Maximum wind load = (3200/2) (1.5634) = 2501.44 Angle load = 2 T (sin a/2) = 2(14 200) (0.043 62) = Resultant load Use 50 OOO-lb = = = [(8261.12)2 I8 136.76 45 341.9 insulator pounds per pounds 1238.81 per conductor pounds per + (2501.44 + 1238.81)2]1/2 pounds per phase pounds per phase with a safety = conductor 9068.38 factor conductor pounds per conductor of 2.5 units. Type 3OA, 15 ’ line angle Maximum Maximum low-point distance = 792.5 m (2600 ft) sum of adjacent spans = 792.5 m (2600 ft) Metric Maximum vertical load = (792.5) (37.676) = 29 858 newtons per conductor Maximum wind load = (792.5/2) (22.816) = 9040 newtons per conductor Angle load = 2 T (sin a/2) = 2(63 165) (0.130 53) = 16 489 newtons per conductor Resultant Use 222 load = = = 410-N [(29 858)2 + (9040 + 16 489)2]1/2 = 39 284 newtons 78 568 newtons per, phase 196 420 newtons per phase with a safety factor of 2.5 insulator per conductor units. U. S. Customary Maximum vertical load = (2600) (2.5816) = 6712.16 pounds per conductor Maximum wind load = (2600/2) (1.5634) = 2032.42 pounds per conductor Angle load = 2 T (sin a/2) = 2(14 200) (0.130 53) = 3707.05 pounds per conductor 3707.05) 2 ] 112 = 8831.46 pounds per conductor Resultant load = [(6712.16)2 + (2032.42 + = Use 50 OOO-lb 17 662.92 pounds = 44 157.3 pounds insulator units. per per phase phase with a safety factor of 2.5 TRANSMISSION 140 Type 30T and 300 tension LINE DESIGN MANUAL structures Metric Maximum tension= 63 165 = = Use double strings newtons 126 330 378 990 per newtons newtons of 222 ,410-N conductor per per insulator phase phase with a safety factor of 3.0 units. U.S. Clrstor?larv Maximum tension Use double strings Make the construction a. I4 200 pounds per conductor = = 28 400 85 200 pounds pourlds per per phase phase of SO OOO-lb following calculations of the steel structure Calculate tabulation. as follows: = The the conductor calculations insulator (paragraphs 3.a. limitation chart: tensions are with shown a safety factor of 3.0 through 3.g.) to obtain units. to be used for the on figures 52 and loading 53. conditions From data shown these figures, use in the in the the following tensions are Tension Loading condition N (lb) 63 165 (14 200) No ice, 0.19-kPa wind, 15.5 OC (60 OF) 29 289 (6 583) No ice, 0.48-kPa ( IO-lb/ft2 ) wind, 15.5 OC 34 791 (7 821) No ice, no wind, 15.5 OC 28 083 (6 314) 13-mm (l/2+) b. the for ice, 0.19-kPa (4-lb/ft2) wind, - 18 OC (0 OF) Assume a scale to be used for the distance between point of origin), and compute the scale factor: Metric Let 1 mm = 7.2 m of bare conductor vertical force. Vertical force of conductor = 20.928 N/m Then, 1 mm = (7.2) (20.928,) = 150.68 N, and 1 N = l/150.68 = 0.006 636 58 mm (scale factor). conductor low points (vertical scale below CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 141 I/. S. Customary Let 1 in = 600 ft of bare conductor weight, Weight of conductor = 1.4340 lb/ft Then, 1 in = (600) (1.434) = 860.4 lb, and 1 lb = l/860.4 = 0.001 162 25 in (scale factor). Compute the vertical force of the insulator C. phase factor: or one-fourth the insulator force string per conductor and convert to millimeters one-half (inches) the insulator using force the low-point per scale Metric Insulator string force = 1628 1628/4 = 407 newtons (407) (0.006 636 58) = N per conductor 2.70 mm U.S. Customary Insulator 366/4 (91.5) string weight = 366 lb = 91.5 pounds per conductor (0.001 162 25)= 0.106 in line deflection angle scale d. Compute calibration equal to the resultant tension at 15.5 pressure angle: in one conductor due to the line (horizontal axis to the o C (60 right ’ F) final of the origin) with with 0.48-kPa the degree (lo-lb/ft2) wind I;‘, = 2T(sin a/2) T = 34 791 N (7821 lb) 2 T = 69 582 N (15 642 lb) Assume be the line same angles as that and compute computed resultant in paragraph tensions e. Assume the point scale of origin): their scale 2T(sinU/2) N (lb) sina/2 40 50 60 and values. The scale must scale above SC& mm on) (682) 0.043 62 .087 16 3 035 6 065 (1363) 2) (0.79) (1.59) .173 53 .130 65 .216 44 .300 71 .258 82 129 083 15 060 18 009 20 924 (2042) (2716) (3385) (4704) (4048) ii: 100 139 120 :z; (3:95) - (4.72) .342 02 .422 62 .500 00 23 798 29 407 34 791 (5350) (6610) (7821) 158 195 231 to be used for the sum.of factor 3.b. adjacent spans portion of the chart E,’ (7:7 1) (9.12) (vertical TRANSMISSION 142 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Metric Let 1 mm Note: = 6 m of wind This scale sum of adjacent will spans span = one-half be doubled may the in marking be read directly sum the of adjacent chart; instead that spans. is, 1 mm of reading will one-half equal 12 m so that the sum of adjacent the spans. 0.48-kPa wind on conductor = 16.357 N/m (from force triangle, fig. 52) Then, 1 mm = (6) (16.357) = 98.142 N, and 1 N = l/98.142 = 0.010 189 318 mm (scale factor). U.S. Customary Let 1 in = 500 ft of wind span = one-half Note: This scale will be doubled the sum of adjacent spans may spans. the sum in marking the be read directly of adjacent spans. chart; that is, 1 inch will equal 1000 instead of reading one-half the sum feet so that of adjacent IO-lb/ft2 wind on the conductor = 1.12 1 lb/ft (from force triangle, fig. 53) Then, 1 in = (500) (1.121) = 560.5 lb, and 1 lb = l/560.5 = 0.001 784 12 in (scale factor). f. Calculate angle of bias lines to be drawn right bias lines are used to automatically add or subtract due to a line deflection angle. Because the scale the same as that used for the low-point tan 8= scale, and left of the deflection angle the wind pressure to or from factor used for the deflection the slope of the bias lines may calibrations. These the resultant angle scale tension must be be determined by sum of adjacent spans scale factor low-point scale factor where 8 is the angle formed by the vary depending upon the choice e = tan-l ’ = tan-’ g. Calculate wind with angle for 0.010 189 318 = tan-l 0.006 636 58 0.001 784 12 = tan-’ 0.001 162 25 the maximum each bias lines with of scale factors type maximum insulator permitted line of suspension angle, tower: the horizontal previously axis. The slope of the determined in paragraphs bias lines will 3.b. and 3.e. 1.5353 = 56O55’ (metric) 1.5351 = 56O55’ (U.S. customary) swing angles and maximum in each negative direction wind by using with maximum minimum permitted positive line CHAPTER Vertical plus load one-fourth IV-STRUCTURE due to conductor the insulator For one conductor, LIMITATION low-point force per distance equal to one-third CHARTS the sum of adjacent conductor: (20.928) (350:)(2) AND GUYING + y = 5297.2 N, or (’ ’ 50)(2) (1 434) + 366 = 1190 9 lb 3 4 * Calculate swing angles for suspension insulator strings: Metric For 0.48-kPa wind, 0’ line angle (30s tower with positive wind) Wind = 350.5 (16.357) = 5733.13 N e = tm-’ For -0.48-kPa 8 =tan-’ For 0.48-kPa 5733.13 = tan- l 1.0823 = 47O 15’ 5297.2 wind, O” line angle -5733.13 = tan-’ 5297.2 wind, 5’ line (30s and 30X towers with negative _ 1.0823 = -47015 angle (30X tower with positive wind) 2T(sin a/2) = 2 (34 791) (0.043 62) = 3035.17 N 8 = tan-1 3035’17 + 5733’13 = tan-1 1 6553 = 58051’ 5297.2 For -0.48-kPa 8 = tan’l For 0.48-kPa wind, 5O line angle (30A 3035.17 5733.13 = tm-’ 5297.2 wind, 15 O line angle (30A tower with negative -0.509 32 = - 261059’ tower with positive 2T(sin a/2) = 2 (34 791) (0.130 53) = 9082.28 N 8 =tan-’ wind) 9082.28 + 5733.13 = tan- l 2.7968 = 70°‘19’ 5297.2 wind) wind) 143 spans TRANSMISSION 144 LINE DESIGN MANUAL U.S. Customary For IO-lb/ftz wind, 0’ line angle (30s tower with positive wind) Wind = 1150 (1.121) = 1289.15 lb 1289.15 8 For =tan-' -lo-lb/ft2 8 = tan-’ For llgog lo-lb/ft2 wind, = tan-’ 0’ line 1.0825 = 47016’ angle (30s and 30X towers with negative wind) - 1289.15 llgo.g = tan-’ - 1.0825 = -47O16’ wind, 5’ line angle (30X tower with positive wind) 2T(sin a/2) = 2(7821) (0.043 62) = 682.30 lb (j = tan-’ 682’30 + 128g’15 = tan-l 1 6553 = 58051’ 1190.9 For -lO-lb/ft2 8 = tan-’ wind, 5’ 682.30- line angle 1289.15 (30A = tan-l tower -0 509 with lo-lb/ft2 wind, 15’ line angle (30A tower wind) = _ 27DoO’ 32 1190.9 For negative with positive wind) 2T(sin a/2) = 2 (7821) (0.130 53) = 2041.75 lb e=tan-' 2041.75+ 128g*15=tan-l 27970=7p19' 1190.9 the The permissible center phase. insulator swing angle It is desirable to keep the bottom of the V-string at all times would cause wearing of the metal-to-metal greater use in this respect. With a 50’ for the 30s approximately to prevent contacts insulator steel tower will 890 N (200 be limited by the V-string lb) of extra vertical force one leg of the V from becoming slack, which in the string. We use a 100 o V-string to permit swing: Metric tan0 = 1.191 76= on on 5733.13 N (0.48-kPa wind on 350.5 m of conductor) x (X = low point in newtons) CHAPTER Thus, a vertical when a 0.48-kPa required force of X = wind is blowing to provide 4810 - 407 4403 + this (extra = means insulator 252.9 the percent of the line angle, force vertical low sum LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 4810 N is required to hold the insulator on a sum of adjacent spans equal to vertical (one-fourth 890 5293/20.928 This IV-STRUCTURE plus the force) force = extra 890 4403 on V-string) 145 string at a SO0 angle 701 m. The conductor N is: N = 5293 N m of conductor point for the of adjacent V-string spans. must Therefore, 8 = tan- ’ (350s5) (*I c;;;;;o.g28) be at least for 252.9/(2)(350.5) a V-string with = a 0.48-kPa 0.36, or 36 wind and 0’ + 407 = tan- l 1.007 87 = 45 “13’. U. S. Customary tan0 = 1.191 76= Thus, a vertical when a lo-lb/ft2 to provide this 1082 1289.15 x weight wind weight - 91.5 of X = is blowing plus the (one-fourth (1 O-lb/ft2 wind on 1150 ft of conductor) (X = low point in pounds) 1082 lb is required on a sum of adjacent extra 200 lb is: Insulator weight) to hold spans = 990.5 equal the to 2300 (extra vertical weight on V-string) = 830.2 ft of conductor This percent the low point for the V-string must be at least sum of adjacent spans. Therefore, for a V-string line string ft. The at a 50’ conductor angle required lb 990.5 + 200 1190.5/1.434 means of the insulator = 1190.5 lb 830.2/(2)(1150) with a lo-lb/ft2 = 0.36, or 36 wind and a 0’ angle, 1289.15 8 = tan- l ( 1 150) (2) (o.36) ( 1.434) + g 1.5 = tan- l 1.008 05 = 4S” 13’. Paragraph To 4. construct the structure limitation chart a. Lay out the axes using the same vertical scale (see pars. 3.b. and 3.d.). provided b. the wind the Calibrate degree deflection angle the horizontal calibration equal pressure on one conductor bias right resultant to the of the tension line structures, proceed: for the horizontal scale and the lower part scale may be used for the sum of adjacent are adjusted axis to the due steel scale factor A different lines to the for of the spans accordingly. origin in degrees at 15.5 ’ C (60 deflection angle of line OF) (par.3.d.). with angle deflection 0.48-kPa (lo-lb/ft2) with TRANSMlSSlON 146 c. Calibrate calibrations on a bare d. should conductor Calibrate of the bare be displaced (pars. 3.b. e. lines the axis above the vertical and axis below due lay insulator swing g. angle) deflection h. Add i. List to the pertinent notes Conductor, l Conductor Conductor l Ruling Number Line in meters (feet) pressure spans for the of adjacent spans. at 0.48 kPa (par. 3.e.). (10 lb/ft2) distance the low points should string radial angles each type of insulator of structure swing draw in heavy boundary angle spans bias lines at the computed angle, dependent upon scale factors scale and the distance between low points scale (par. 3.f.). These add or subtract the wind (par. and for lines chart (sum showing on the size and span and 3.g.). pressure to or from the resultant tension of adjacent steel chart, tower spans, low-point distance, and line deflection data. including: type or heavy, and maximum design wind) size of insulators limitation problem structure Problem a 115-kV to be located charts for the example problem on steel structures follows that shows the limitation and guying (wood-pole transmission in an area construction) line with with a 0.77-kPa procedure charts. a 242-mm2 (16~lb/fts) for obtaining (477-kcmil), extreme the are shown on figures required to prepare ACSR, wind data 24/7 pressure. not be a factor because the resultant force per unit length of conductor of 18.746 for this condition is less than the 27.5345 N/m (1.8867 lb/ft) force for the NESC The following data is also assumed: Maximum Ruling between The 5. An example the wood-pole Example Assume the origin loading (NESC light, medium, maximum tension at full load The structure 55 and 56. Paragraph for the sum limits limitation of structure. a table l l (feet) angle. Draw in heavy for each type l out are used to automatically to a line in meters equal to the vertical force of the conductor. The zero point by a distance equal to one-half the vertical force of the insulator f. Lay out the .deflection used for the sum of adjacent bias lines origin 3.c.). a protractor, the the MANUAL be at a distance above the origin equal to the wind of length equal to one-half the sum of adjacent (no ice) conductor below the origin With for vertical LINE DESIGN initial span conductor tension (NESC heavy) single conductor. However, this will N/m (1.285 lb/ft) full-load condition. = 33 362 N (7500 = 213.36 m (700 lb) ft) STRL TURE DATA v lef I&ion V Angle. v 90 (dcp~l eo Tower Type Lme Angle Maximum Single Span (m) Minimum Lme Angle Mcxrmum Line Angle Mox. Sum of Adjacent Spans (m Minimum Line Angle Maximum Line Angle Mox. Low Point Distance (m) Conductor Minimum Line Angle Maximum Line Angle Overhead Ground Wire Minimum Line Angle Maximum Line Angle Maximum Uphft (N) Conductor Minimum Line Angle Maximum Line Angle Ovcrhcod Ground Mmimum Line Maximum Line 30s 7 3% 30x 65’ 30T a-3i 487.5 396 467.5 3% 975.5 792.5 975.5 792.5 731.5 731.5 975.5 792.5 975.5 792.5 653.5 653.5 1036.5 653.5 036.5 653.5 3% 792.5 792.5 540.5 407.5 640 1097 975.5 1260 1371.5 1524 1524 1463 305 213.5 305 3% 254 3% t Wire Angle Angle NOTES This chart is based on Conductor size Conductor loodmg Conductor tensions the Ruling span Insulators following: 644 mmf AC%. 4517 (bundle of two, 457-mm spacing) NESC Heavy. maximum wind at lS.S*C-0.46 kPo 63 165 N maximum per conductor, initiol conditions 34 790 N %r conductor with 0.46-kPa wind at IS.S*C 350.5 m 20 Units (146 ty 267 mm) 4 u ? I I i iAi i. i ““1 h I’/ -*0 ---- Id I - ----- I ----- I\ I\ $ +taox --I-+- -10 Insulator z : to S*ing”Angle Figure tdegZesl 55.-Example of a steel structure limitation chart (metric). 104-D-1078. 7 I x STRUCTURE Tower Type he Anale Moorimuk Siqle Span ( ft) Mimmum Line Angle Moximum Line Anqle Max Sum of Adjacent Spans (ft) Minimum Line Angle hbximum Line AnpIe Mar. Low point Dirtonce (ft) conductor Minimum Line Angle Morimum Line Angle Overhead Ground Wire Minimum Line Angle lo Morimum Line Angle Maximum Uplift (lb) Conductor Minimum Line Angle lo Moximum Line Angle Overhead Ground Wire Minimum Line Angle Maximum Line Anole IO \ 1 3osI 0. IATA 30X TT -lo lnrulotor 0 . ‘0 Swing Angle (degrees) Figure of a steel structure limitation 30D 535 lb00 I300 I600 I300 I600 1600 2100 2600 2606 3200 2600 3200 2600 3600 3200 4200 2400 2400 3200 2600 3200 2600 4200 4200 4500 2600 2600 3400 2600 3400 20 woo SW0 4600 1000 700 IO00 1300 633 l3DO NOTES This chart is based on the following: Conductor size 1272 hcmil. ACSR. 4517 (bundle of two. 16% spocimll NESC Heavy. maximum wind ot 6VF-IOlblft* Conductor loading 14 200 lb morimum per conductor, initiol conditions Conductor tensions lo 7620 lb. per ConductOr with IO- Iblft’ wind ot 6O.F Ruling spon I IS0 ft. lnsulotors 20 Units (5) by IO~ in.) 4 5 z r M 56.-Example 301 TF 1300 I300 ‘\ -co 30A Tiv chart (U.S. customary). 104-D-1079. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE units per mm (S-3/4 string by 10 in) Seven insulator 146 by 254 Length per Vertical LIMITATION AND GUYING string force (weight) per string 149 CHARTS = 1194 mm = 400 N (90 (47 in) lb) Wind Everyday Maximum Design for Wood-pole maximum = 0.19 kPa (4 lb/ft2) with = 0.38 kPa (8 lb/ft2) 13-mm a minimum structure (l/2-in) radial low-point distance designations and HS = tangent, HSB 3AC 3A = = = tangent, suspension, large small line angle, suspension large line angle, suspension 3AB = large 3TA = Paragraphs charts. a. to one-third the sum of adjacent are: line angle, vertical and load suspension tensions calculations dead end the procedure for the are shown loading on figures for making conditions 57 and the calculations shown in the following Assume a scale to be used for the distance between point of origin), and compute the scale factor: Metric Let 6 m of bare lmm= Vertical Then, conductor force of conductor 1 mm = (6)(8.968) 1 N = l/53.808 = 0.018 = = vertical 8.968 53.808 585 mm force. N/m. N, and (scale factor). U. S. Customary Let 1 in = 500 feet of bare conductor Weight of conductor = 0.6145 Then, 1 in = (500)(0.6145) = 1 lb = l/307.25 = 0.003 254 weight. lb/ft. 307.25 lb, 7 in (scale for the tabulation. Tension N (lb) 13-mm (l/2&) ice, 0.19~kPa (4-lb/ft2 ) wind, - 18 OC (0 OF) No ice, 0.19~kPa (4-lb/ft2) wind, 15.5 OC (60 OF) No ice, no wind, 15.5 OC (60 OF) the required 58. Loading condition b. spans. suspension the conductor data equal types tangent to 90’ line angle, 5.a. through 5.~. describe Calculate Conductor ice and factor). conductor low 33 362 (7500) 11 748 10 872 (2641) (2444) points (vertical scale below TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 150 DCm-570 (3.78) Linear Force Factw Rated Breaking Slrength ,?l Diameter.&* TO,9 N mm -& Teneton Lim~lations: O&L&Z Resultant: Final *-!,25K -N Ares (A)&?i%mmd Loaded,%.so% -N Temp. bell. N %- by o.oa Date - s ?*/06 . 7q.zyiJ kPa Wind -N Final.~‘, N/m mm Ice CW-,,2/.//xd htiat.%.33f% computed j/. 9. ?6fD Doad Load FQC* (W’) 8. (W”‘) 4 Permanent Set 0.00 02 Nhn creep 0.000 N/m Total 0.0002 N/m Modulus. (E) Final m x-R= of Litmar hp.: 4’90 v’.52y/ FiM, GPa *,,;itiaia~GP:, o&L&!-per% /?77 msc Initial n’= 4.3782 AE /sr27/ N 1 TENSION. N No Ice. No Wind (W’) - __ I kPa Wind (W”‘) No Ice#oWind 999 - 6 gs 0. flno I SPA# LEN /pf I (W’) 0-m D.O?574kPI wind (WV”)1 - / Permanent set a creep 1 No Ice. No Wind (W*) Figure 57.-Conductor (metric). c. force Compute the to millimeters Insulator One-half (200.17) ha&J I 432 15.5 32 4!4 sag and tension vertical (inches) I 6.000 I a33/ I 0. /959 lo , n.74 / I 1 / I I I I I I calculation s-253 621 I4kw. I ! I I I form for example problem force (weight) of the insulator string using the low-point scale factor: string force = 400.34 N (90 lb) insulator string force = 200.17 N (45 lb) (0.018 585) = 3.720 mm or, (45) (0.003 254 7) = on wood-structure and 0.1465 convert in one-half limitation the chart insulator CHAPTER DC-676 IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS (W’) -r?&/Js lblft Permamnt /. Wft 151 (6-76) Rated Breaking Load Diameter 8. -946 Tension Limitatiom: 1.7 doe +&in. Initial ,OF331Y- ICO (w”) Set O/XX& creep O.ooP~-- Total 0.00~ lb Final ,!F_2L~Laded Fiml. XF Dead Weight lb inch lb OF -5e - Modulus. (E) Fimlmx Am (A) fl&$ki?i2 in2 Temo. ~oeff. of Linear EXP.: * &=0.3~ 41 -lb K -lb Fiml Initial 3. AE Ijs 10s lb/i& //3 x lOS lb/i&? lb No ICO. No Wind (W’) SP4N LENGTH(S)--FEET Wlnd(w”’ Set L Creep lb/f? Pernunant / ’ 2 - 40 1 I n .na9 ff 6.92 4&O. /5 \ S43i? 7 I I Inch ~~ ICI. I SPANLENGTH(S)-?a FEET I I No Ice. No Wind (W’) 60 I Figure 58Ahductor cu6tomary). sag and tension calculation ml d. Compute deflection calibration equal to the pressure, in one conductor I I form for example problem angle scale (horizontal resultant tension at 15.5 due to the line angle: r;h I = I on wood-structure axis to the right ‘C (60 ’ F) final 2 T(sin 11 748 I I limitation of the origin) with 0.19-kPa chart (U.S. with the (4-lb/f?) degree wind a/2) N (2641 T = lb) 2 T = 23 496 N (5282 lb) Assume line angles and compute resultant be the same as that computed in paragraph tensions 5.b. and their scale values. The scale factor must TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 152 5 10 0.043 .087 .130 .173 .216 .258 342 .422 .500 ii 25 30 40 50 60 e. the Assume point 62 16 53 65 44 82 02 62 00 (230) 1025 2048 3 067 4 080 5085 6 081 8 036 9 930 11748 (0.75) :i (460) scale to be used for the sum of adjacent E (1143) (1367) 57 76 94 113 :;E; (2641) 184 149 218 spans portion ::z; (2:99) (3.72) (4.45) of the chart (vertical scale above of origin): Let 1 mm = 1 inch 6 m of wind = span 500 ft of wind = span one-half = the one-half sum the of adjacent sum Note: This scale will be doubled when marking the chart, that equal 1000 ft, so that the sum of adjacent spans may be read will the sum of adjacent spans, of adjacent or spans. is, 1 mm will equal 12 m, or 1 inch directly instead of reading one-half spans. Metric 0.19-kPa wind on conductor Then, 1 mm = 1 N = l/24.696 = (6)(4.116) = 0.040 4.116 = 24.696 492 mm N/m N, and (scale factor). U. S. Customary 4-lb/ft2 wind on conductor = 0.282 lb/ft Then, 1 in = (500)(0.282) = 141 lb, and 1 lb = l/141 = 0.007 092 in (scale factor). f. Calculate angle of bias lines to be drawn right bias lines are used to automatically add or subtract due to a line deflection angle. Because the scale the same as that used for the low-point scale, and left of the deflection angle the wind pressure to or from factor used for the deflection the slope of the bias lines may calibrations. These the resultant angle scale tension must be be determined by tane= sum of adjacent spans scale factor _ low-point scale factor where 8 is the angle formed by the will vary depending upon the choice 5.e. bias lines with of scale factors the horizontal previously axis. The slope of the determined in paragraphs bias lines 5.b. and CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION 0.040 492 = tan-’ 0.018 585 ’ = km-’ Compute maximum low-point 153 CHARTS 2.1787 = 65o20’ (metric) 0.007 092 = tan-l I9 = tan-1 0.003 255 g. AND GUYING distance 2.1788 = 65’20’ (U.S. customary) for the type HS structure shown on figure 59: Crossarm: 67 by 241 by 7620 mm (2-S/8 by 9-l/2 in by 25 ft) fbd’ Ultimate load = 6~ where: f = ultimate fiber stress of crossarm = 5 1 02 1 kPa (7400 lb/in2 ) for Douglas fir b = width of crossarm = 67 mm (2-S/8 in) d = depth of crossarm = 241 mm (9-l/2 in) L = length of crossarm projection = 1829 mm (72 in) fbd’ _ (51 021) (67) (24w 6L (6) (1829) (1000) = 18 OS1 N or = (7400) (2.625) (9-5)2 = 4058 lb (6) (72) Ultimate load for two crossarms = 36 104 N (8 116 lb) Ultimate load withsafety factor of 4 = 9026 N (2029 lb) Force of conductor with 13-mm (1/2-m) radial ice = 2 1.186 N/m (1.45 17 lb/ft) Allowable low-point distance: ==426m 21.186 2029 -= 1.4517 or 1397 ft At no load, force of conductor = 8.968 N/m (0.6145 lb/ft) factor of safety = h. Using Compute 18 905 maximum N (4250 8116 = 9.45 36 lo4 = 426 (8.968) (1397) (0.6145) low-point lb), b ased distance on test for data, type for HSB metal structure fittings shown on knee on figure braces 60: at 45’ slope: TRANSMISSION 154 LINE DESIGN MANUAL L -2 .. 2- .. a :n k “I / -- NvAngle \ \ ‘\ / or side guy For two X-braces., install bolts 457mm (I8 in) apart. II: For 22.9-m (75-ft) structure and under, install one X-brace. For 24.4-m (80 ft) structure and over, instal t two x-braces. TYPE Fiie 59,Type HS STRUCTURE HS wood-pole structure. 104-D-1080. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE -I LIMITATION PLAN AND GUYING CHARTS 155 L- /Angle or side guy For two x&braces, install bolts 457 mm (I8 in) apart. Structure ground wires4 “OKge* A For 22.9-m (75-f-t) structure and under, install one x-brace. For 24.4-m (80-ft) structure and over, install two x-braces. TYP E Metric L 2 HSB STRUCTURE 2490 7 620 3658 7 620 3658 2134 8 839 4267 69 II5 2490 138 I61 2439 IO 668 5182 Fiie 60.-Type HSB wood-pole structure. 104-D-1081. TRANSMISSION 156 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Metric US. Customary Crossarm load = 18 905 (0.707 1) = 13 367 N Allowable low-point distance: 4250 (0.7071) = 3005 lb 13 367 = 630.94 m 21.186 i. Compute maximum low-point 3005 = 2070 ft 1.4517 distance for type 3AC structure Metric (7400) (2.625) (9-5)2 = 4870 lb 6 (60) 1217 lb Ultimate load with a safety factor of 4 = 5414 N Allowable low-point distance for double crossarm: Compute insulator to prevent the effects m 21(;;;;) . of various sizes of hold string to increase the effective excessive insulator side swing. conductor The first downs Assume 18 288-mm example because different formula allowable sum on the structure: be attached to the bottom of the in adjacent spans, and also is the low-point scale factor. 1 lb = 0.003 254 7 in 50-lb weight = 0.163 in loo-lb weight = 0.325 in 150-lb weight = 0.488 in of adjacent (60-ft), class 2 western red this is the lowest strength classes of poles are a function for computing the wind force may = 1676 ft U.S. Customary 1 N=O.O18585mm 222.4-N force = 4.13 mm 444.8-N force = 8.27 mm 667.2-N force = 12.40 mm this that low-point distance value shown below Metric k. Compute the maximum determining the wind loading 61: 2-518 by 9-l/2 in (51 021.52) (67) (241)2 = 2l 662 N (1000) (6) (1524) j. on figure U.S. Customary Crossarm section = 67 by 241 mm fld= Ultimate load = 6~ 2(5415L511 21.186 shown cedar wood spans on a type poles (western permitted by of the pole circumference, on a pole may be derived HS structure (fig. 59) by red cedar data are used for USBR specifications). The see table B-3 in appendix using figure 62: B. The CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS -Structure ground wires--= TYPE 3, Metric, 69 115 STRUCTURE mm A 2 YT 1982 3658 1372 343 1982 4267 1524 610 Figure 61.-Type 3AC wood-pole U.S. Customary, ft-in A 6-6 6-6 structure. 2 Y 14-O 4-6 14-O 5-O 104-D-1082. T l-l& 2-O 157 TRANSMISSION 158 d2 0” LINE DESIGN H AX- d2- diameter of pole at top dl - diameter of pole a-t b&tom H - height of pole t dl 1 O Figure 62.~Single-line compute wind force. sketch For pole, of wood pole showing values needed to Y-Y1 x-x, =x2 - Xl Y2 - Yl General form of equation: Then MANUAL y-H x-4 =o - H d, - d, x = (Y - Hi , - d2 1 -H +d,=(y- Let the force of wind on dy l X be F in kilopascals moment of the wind force on a pole above ground is: H)k+d,,wherek=F (pounds per H c Fx dy*y, + Fx dy*y, + . . . 0 H =F yb-H)k+d,ldy / 0 =F H I WY2 - kHy + dzy)dy 0 square 4 foot). - d2 Then, the total CHAPTER Substituting (d Imeters (square dz)/-Hfor feet) IV-STRUCTURE k, the LIMITATION moment AND GUYING in newton-meters CHARTS (pound-feet) on an area is: - d,)fi’ =F (d, - d, )H2 d, H2 2 + 2 1 1 - d2)H2 - 3(d, - d2)H2 d2.H2 -6 + 2 1 d,H’ +2 =F I =F = H= d, +2.d, -y 3 I( 9 FH 2(d 1 + 2d, ) in lb*ft if diameters are in feet, or 6 = FH2W, + 26,) in Nom if diameters are in millimeters, or 6000 = FH2W, + 24 1.111lb* ft if diameters are in inches. 72 159 in square TRANSMISSION 160 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Metric Mp = FHZ’(d, + 26,) 6000 , where Mp = moment M =(0.383 04)(1000)(15.850)2 [404.34+2(202.18)] = 12970N.m 6000 P U.S. Customary Mp = The maximum IO-mm allowable (3/8-in) high SAS (sum strength of 21 418-N (4815~lb) on figures 63 and 64. DCm-I70 FH2(d, +2d,) 8(52)2 [ 15.92+2(7.96)1 72 = 72 initial steel, of adjacent 7-strand condition. spans) overhead Sag and L can now ground tension wires calculations = 9566 lb-ft be found with by statics. a maximum for the ground Assume full-load wire are shown (S-78) M coN0ucTom /o-mm. - .-=hJ .-/JJ+r Rotad Making Stmngth Dimeta .&mm Tmaim Limtatiana: Initial.FINI d--&--N 9c.33f* .o, .- -N 2s % -N LUdDdd.~~.Y)% Finsl cawutd NO I-. -N *-,--lS.Sg: w bv Date No Wind N - (W’) Figure 63Averhead chart (metric). ground wire sag and tension calculation form for example problem on wood-structure two tension limitation CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION km2 AND GUYING CHARTS $A6CKCUUTloM 161 0. #f&f 6=/5'+Q' LOAOIWGA&;'* 7-wire Ratad ErakIng Load -lb Dlamotu &d&L inch Tonslat &b oFA?L% Final. - LM Flml. ,-!A% aO?F WW- LOADING NO la. bad Weight (W')-d!d;73 + kin. ~a fw") .p.ld7 Limitation: Inithl.~ OFAL% - tb Wol@t Fntm: - (L -lb Dam lb Am lb Tamp. coan. IbItt (A) tw”‘) /*3/c of Llnu In2 Exp.: Q&Q o.oooonlPu~ [~[LllwnmlLEwlnJ lb/n Wind ,A Resultant: -lb Modulw. *x: &.q bt= &ac O.bO 0.00 (E) Flrl3j:x Initlal~. 0 100 IWid I l@ lb/Id Flnl AE ;zInitlaIAE /a SMfAcloR 1 SAG,R 7 I Total Iblft *:nn izIE. Fumsnont sol O.ooJn~ crap 0.00 lb/h lb lb 1 SN,Ib 1 TENSJON,lb No Wind (w’) F’iie 64.-Overhead ground chart (U.S. customary). wire sag and tension calculation Using base: the (2 OGW) sketch (wind shown force cond.) (wind force allowable moment force on pole) Figure 65.~Single-line sketch of one pole of a type HS wood-pole structure. form for example problem on figure on iced 65, and OGW) taking (moment on iced cond.) (moment on pole) (2 poles)/(safety (2 poles)] on wood-structure moments arm) arm) (l/2 factor (l/2 limitation about SAS) the + SAS) = [(max. of 2)] - [(wind (3. TRANSMISSION 162 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Metric (2) (13.222) (15.70) (L/2) + (3) (17.96) (13.87) (L/2) = (250 5255’ (2)- (2) (12 970) 415.1708 L/2 + 747.208 L/2 = 250 555 - 25 940 L12 = 224 615 = 193.24 1162.379 L = 386.48 m U. S. Customary (2) (0.9066) (5 1.5) (L/2) + (3) (1.23 1) (45.5) (L/2) = (184 8200) (2) _ (2) (9566) 93.380 L/2 + 168.031 L/2 = 184 800 - 19 132 L/2 = 165 668 = 633.74 261.411 L= 1267ft 1. (fig. Compute 59) for the allowable various line maximum sum of adjacent spans on a type HS structure with angles: Metric FH2(d, + 6000 w2) = (0.383 04) (1000) (3.51)2 i246.63 + 2(202.1-8)] = 512 Lo1 Nem 6000 U.S. Customary FH’(d, + 2d,) = (8) (1 1.5)2 19.71 + 2(7.96)1 = 376 .6 lbeft 72 72 X-brace CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE Using the LIMITATION sketch shown AND GUYING on figure 66, and CHARTS taking 163 moments about the base: (2 OGW)(2 Ga,. sin OGW) (mbment (l/2 (moment arm) SAS) factor = a/2) (moment arm) (l/2 + (3 cond.) [(max. of 2)] - [( wind allowable force arm) SAS) ( wind + (2 OGW) (wind force + (3 cond.) (2 T&,x. sin force on cond.) (moment moment on pole) on pole) on a/2) arm) (2 poles)/(safety (2 poles)] Figure 66.-Single-line sketch of top portion of a type HS woodpole structure with X-brace. Metric (2) (42 836) (sin a/2) (3.35) + (2) (13.222) (3.35) (L/2) + (3) (17.96)(1.52)(L/2) = (56 870) (2)/2 - (2) (512) 287 001 592 063 592 063 6936.88 Assume A line L/2 + 305 062 (sin L/2 = 55 849 L = 55 849 L = 654.35 (sin a/2) + 88.587 (sin a/2) (sin a/2) + + 170.700 85.35 (sin a/2) + values for L and solve for a/2) sin a/2 aI2 654.35 300 0 0 0.051 08 0.094 33 0 2’0’55’ 5O24’ these tabulated 82.113 L/2 = 56 870 - 1021 values should he drawn a 0 5050’ 10@48’ on the sum of adjacent U. S. Customary (2) (9630) (sin a/2) (11) + (3) (1.231) (5) (L/2) 22 747.2 (sin a/2) + (2) (0.9066) (11) (L/2) + (3) (15 = (41 945) (2)/2 - (2) (376.6) + L = 2144.86 (1.52) a: L, m representing + + (3) (66 724) (sin a/2) ’ 000) (sin a/2) (5) spans chart. TRANSMISSION 164 Assume values for L and solve for ft L, for a working western red cedar: stress, at 15.5 a 42 0 0.050 33 0.094 29 fiber MANUAL a: sin a/2 2144.86 1000 0 Assuming LINE DESIGN 0 2053’ 5O24’ ’ C (60 o F) with no wind load, $$) = 5.6 safety factor ultimate fiber stress = 38.612 MPa or ($ii working stress 6.895 MPa With (1844 (2 a 15.5 ‘C lb) on the OGW) (60 (2 Tsin moment OF) overhead a/2) on wood no wind tension of 10 872 ground wire, the moment (moment arm) + (3 cond.) (2 poles)/(safety factor pole) 0 5O46’ 1O”48’ N (2444 lb) equation on the would (2 Tsin a/2) of 6.895 MPa (1000 conductor, lb/ins) and 8205 N be: (moment arm) = (max. allowable of 5.6) Metric (2) (16 410) (sin a/2) (3.35) + (3) (21 744) ( sin Q /2) 109 947 (sin U/2) + 99 413.57 (sin a/2) = 20 310.71 (1.524) = (56 870) (2)/5.6 209 360.57 (sin a/2) = 20 310.71 sin a/2 = 0.097 01, a/2 = So 34 ’ a = 11’08’ U.S. Customary (2) (3688) (sin a/2) (11) sin a/2 = 0.096 99, a/2 a = 11’08’ If this angle had been + = less than be drawn on the sum of adjacent using the previously tabulated m. Compute 61) for various the two (3) (4888) 5’34 ’ (sin the angle spans angles. largest conductors Example : without (2 cond.) shear) (2T,,,. shear sin a/2) are guyed (5) = (41 computed 945) (2)/5.6 previously, then chart at 11 o 08 ’ from 0 to the intersection This means that the original line would the allowable sum of adjacent line angles. Assume conductor outside a/2) from spans due to bolt on inside of angle pole on outside a vertical line would with the line drawn be cut off at 11 o 08 : shear on a type 3AC structure is guyed to top of middle pole, (fig. and of angle. plates + (2. cond.) (wind force on iced cond.) (l/2 SAS) = (allowable bolt CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 165 Metric (2) (2) (33 362) (sin a/2) + (2) (17.959) (L/2) 133 448 (sin a/2) + 17.959 L = 8123.53 7430.70 (sin a/2) + L = 452.34 Assume values for L and solve for a: sin a/2 Lm 452.34 200 0 = (10 831.37) aI2 0 0.033 96 0.060 87 0 lO56’ 3 O29’ (0.75)* a 0 3O52’ 605 8’ U. S. Customary (2) (2) (7500) 24 378.35 (sin Assume Example values (sin a/2) a/2) for + L = 1507.92 L and solve for a: + (2) (1.2306) (L/2) = (2435) (0.75)* L, ft sin a/2 aI2 a 1507.92 1000 0 0 0.020 83 0.061 85 0 1011’ 3O32’ 0 2022’ 7004’ a/2 a : with shear plates Metric 633 448 7430.70 (sin a/2) (sin a/2) Assume values for + 17.959 + L = L and L = 26 689.2** 1486.12 solve for a: km sina/ 450 225 0 .0.139 44 .169 72 ,199 99 8OOl’ 9O46’ 1 lO32’ 16OO2’ 19032’ 23OO4’ * and l * Data from National Design Specifications for Stress-Grade Lumber and Its Fastenings, 1973 Edition, National Forest Products Association, Washington D.C. l Part VI Bolted Joints: Paragraph 600-K-3.-The tabulated loads (table 12 for double shear) shall be used for a main member which is twice the thickness of the thinnest side members (2-5/8 in x 2 = 5-l/4 in). Permissiile load = 2435 lb = 10 831.37 N. Paragraph 600.G-2.-When joints are to be exposed to weather, .75 percent of the tabulated loads apply. l * Part V Timber Connector Joints: Paragraph 500-B-2.-An assembly with two connector units of the same size used in contact faces with the connectors concentric with the same bolt axis, the total allowable connector load shall be the sum of the allowable connector loads given for each connector unit used (table 9). TRANSMISSION 166 LINE DESIGN MANUAL U.S. Customary 30 000 (sin a/2) + 24 378.35 (sin a/2) Assume for values for L, ft sin a/2 2000 1000 0 0.117 96 .158 98 .200 25 To be practical, assume type HS structure. n. Compute Full load Find strength a/2) 2Tsin A 60’ tension for angle a safety 35 585 N (8000 Let points = a 60’ on chart Then’ ’ N Using same line 6046’ 9009’ 1 l/033’ maximum sum of single insulator 33 362 N (7500 of adjacent (as computed spans string used (upper limit) on angle type 3AC as structures: under or par. due to the 5.d.) = 218 mm (8.6 in) 1 lb =+j=O.OOl (20 OOO-lb) = 21.186 line angle, insulator units N/m (1.4517 gives lb/ft). and conductor V be the a working Then, HZ + V2 = (35 585 N)2 or (8000 lb)2 H(N)=&35 for lb) 218 =-=O.O065446mm 33 362 force 131~32’ 18O18’ 23’OO6’ angle: factor of 2.5 on 88 964-N lb). F orce of iced conductor H be the horizontal in adjacent spans. a aI2 = 2(33 362) (0.5) = 33 362 N, = 2(7500) (0.5) = 7500 lb 30’ line the limitation conductor 2 T(sin L = 6000** 1.2306 + L = 4875.67 L and solve for a: 585)2 - Y2 or H(lb) = J(8000)2 - V2 force maximum between of low CHAPTER Solve for H by IV-STRUCTURE assuming low-point LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 167 distances: Metric Low point, m H, V2 v, N N 0 4 8 12 16 21 23t.2 414.4 711.4 948.8 186.0 233 231 226 218 205 187 35 585 35 332 34 561 33 237 31289 28 591 0 200 400 600 800 1000 17 953 864 71815 455 161584 175 287 261821 448846596 U. S. Customary Low point, ft 0 500 0 Since angle structures with 0 725.85 1451.70 2177.55 2903.40 3629.25 4355.10 1000 1500 2000 2500 suspension H, lb in 8000 7967 7867 7698 7455 7129 6711 9.17 9.14 9.02 8.83 8.55 8.17 7.70 V2 V, lb 2 4 8 13 18 insulators 526 858 107 433 741 124 429 732 171456 966 896 are limited preceding limitation will not have much bearing. To show the 66 723-N (15 OOO-lb) insulator units are to be considered. Then, have a working tension of 26 689 N (6000 lb) and, H(N) Solve for = &26 H by assuming - V2 689)2 low-point to a maximum effect with line of such calculations, a 2.5 safety factor, or H(lb) = J(6000)2 - V2 distances: Metric Low point, m 0 200 400 600 800 1000 v, N V2 423$2 8 47414 12 711.6 16 948.8 21 186.0 17 953 8640 71815 455 161584 775 287 261821 448 846 596 H, - N 26 689 26 25 23 20 16 350 308 467 617 231 angle mm 175 172 166 154 135 106 of 60 O, the assume we would TRANSMISSION 168 LINE DESIGN MANUAL U. S. Customary Low point, lb 0 6000 526858 2107433 4141 124 8429732 13171456 18966 896 5956 0 7250.85 1451.70 2171.55 2903.25 500 1000 1500 2000 2500 3000 o. Determine limitation angle of single 3629.25 4355.10 of bias lines insulator strings to be drawn under H, V2 17 ft on the various - 6.88 6.83 6.68 6.41 6.02 5.48 4.73 5822 5591 5251 4778 4127 sum of adjacent combinations in spans chart for reading of loadings: Metric Sm11 of adjacent For SAS = 600 spans scale, 1 mm = 6 m (from par. 5.e.) m, wind span = l/2 SAS = 300 m, 300/6 Conductor with 13-mm ice and 0.38-kPa The wind load on 300 m of iced conductor 1 N = 50/5387.7 = 0.009 280 4 mm wind, = wind (300) = force = (17.959) 50 mm on chart 17.959 N/m = 5387.7 N From figure 67, tan 0.008 280 4 6 (From = 0.006 o*oog2804=141802 544 6 ’ 8 = 54O48’ paro. fin.) Figure 67.-Force triangle showing angle of bias lines for wood-structure limitation chart (metric). U. S. Customa fy Sum of adjacent spans scale, 1 in = 500 ft (from par. 5.e.) = 1000 ft, 1000/500 For SAS = 2000 ft, wind span = l/2 S&I Conductor The wind 1 lb = with l/2-in ice and 8-lb wind, load on 1000 ft of iced conductor 2/1231 = 0.001 624 wind = force = 1.231 (1000) (1.231) = 2 in on chart lb/ft = 1231 lb 7 in From figure 68, ._ 0.001 624 7 = 1 416 85 km8 -0.001 1467 * 0.001 624 7 (From poro. 5.n.) 8 = 54O48’ Figure 68.-Force triangle showing angle of bias tines for wood-structure limitation chart (U.S. customary). the CHAPTER p. Compute IV-STRUCTURE conductor guying LIMITATION for H-frame type AND GUYING structures with CHARTS no guys 169 on the overhead ground wires: T When a transmission line which must be considered side of the angle structure, by the two a/2), legs of the see figure wind blowing both spans case that also on the could use more heavy and areas, instead NESC loading in all design the resultant work. force guying, conductor. happen. We assumption values loading of the values The This for value that usually pressure, and 0.57 called for in NESC and medium loading Where extreme wind the is highly areas areas loading kPa force a force wind blows add 250.B.: result of perpendicular to the safety NESC 0.19 worst factor. for light kPa and 0.43 kPa (9 lb/ft2) on the line (rule 250.C.) to it is the (8 lb/ft2) for is 2 T(sin is the but kPa (12 lb/ft2) rule force that improbable, 0.38 created is the same on each of the angle formed of the resultant consider will wind is a horizontal If the line tension will be on the split assume line. This practical line. there we also must transmission medium heavy areas. direction, transmission 69. For of the changes We NESC loading (4 lb/ft2) in NESC is greater for light than the combined ice and wind load (or wind load alone) prescribed in rule 250.B., then the proper values taken from the wind pressure map (fig. 250-2 of NESC) should be used for all structure and guy loading computations. Figure 69.-Force triangle showing resultant conductor force due to line angle. Example H = : 2 T (sin a/2) + (wind force) (L /2) Metric H = 2(33 362) (sin a/2) + (0.383 04) (1000) 1 L/2 = 66 724 (sin a/2) + 17.961 (L/2) = 66 724 (sin a/2) + 8.98 L U. S. Customary H = 2(7500) (sin a/2) + [(F) (8;l L/2 = 15 000 (sin a/2) + 0.6155 L Using 11-mm (14 500 lb), (7/16-in), a safety 7-wire, factor high-strength of 2.67, and steel guy wire set at an angle with of 45’ a breaking to the strength pole: of 64 500 N TRANSMISSION 170 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Metric 64 500 267 (0.707 1) = 17 080 N of horizontal pull per guy wire U. S. Customary 14 500 267 (0.7071) = 3840 lb of horizontal pull per guy wire . Then, guying structures (2 of the horizontal is determined 0-9 by farces the of the moment conductors and overhead ground wires on H-frame equation: %,a,. sin a/2) (moment arm) (2 (l/2 SAS) + (3 cond.) (2 T,,,. sin a/2) (moment arm) (l/2 SAS) = ( a 11owable + (2 OGW) ( wind (moment arm) + horizontal load force on OGW) (3 cond.) on guy) (moment (wind force (moment arm) - (wind poles) Metric (2) (2) + = 1 344 + 4 120 - For (21 one 418) guy: (sin (3) (2) (33 362) (17 080) (12.040) a/2) (15.697) + (2) (13.231) (15.697) (L/2) (13.868) + (3) (17.961) (13.868) ( sin a/2) L/2 + 2 775 985.30 793.38 ( sin a/2) + 415.48 L/2 = 179 703.69 + 1162.729 778.68 (sin a/2) L/2 = L = 179 4 120 778.68 (sin a/2) + 581.364 7088.12 (sin a/2) + L = 309.107 Assume values for L and solve for Lm 309.107 150 0 For two guys: 4 120 778.68 (sin 7088.12 (sin a/2) Assume values for Lm 662.83 300 0 a/2) + L (L/2) - 25 939.51 747.249 + 179 (sin a/2) 703.69 703.69 a: sin a/2 al2 a 0 0.022 45 .043 61 0 1417’ 2030’ 0 2O34’ 5000’ L = (2) 581.364 (17 080) (12.040) - 25 939.51 L = 662.832 and solve for a: sin a/2 0 0.046 96 .093 51 a/2 0 2Wl’ 5422’ a 0 5O22’ lOO44’ = 385 arm) on cond.) 346.89 on CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE U.S. Customary-For (sin (2) (2) (4815) one a/2) LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS guy: (51.5) + (2) (0.906) (51.5) (L/2) (45.5) + (3) (1.231) (45.5) (L/2) (3) (2) (7500) ( sin a/2) 3840 (39.5) - 19 132 + = 991 890 (sin a/2) + 93.318 L/2 + 2 047 500 ( sin a/2) + 168.032 L/2 a/2) + 261.35 L/2 = 132 548 L = 132 548 3 039 390 (sin a/2) + 130.67 23 260.044 (sin a/2) + L = 1014.372 Assume values for L and solve for a: 3 039 390 For two guys: 3 039 390 (sin 23 260.044 (sin values sin a/2 at2 0 0.022 11 .043 61 1 O16’ ft 1014.372 500 0 Assume Compute conductor conductor and on inside guyed from the outside overhead ground wires two conductors, 0 0 2032’ SO00 2”‘30’ at2 a 0 0.050 52 .093 51 0 2O53’ 5”22’ 0 5046’ 10044’ overhead of angle ground is guyed one wire to top pole. Two conductors will will be guyed off together. guying of center be guyed for pole, off a type and together, arm) horizontal + (2 cond.) load ( wind 656.86 656.86 7429.88 (sin (sin one conductor on guy) (moment arm) a/2) (13.868) + (2) (17.961) (13.868) (L/2) a/2) + 498.166 L/2 = 205 733.62 a/2) + 249.083 L = 205 733.62 a/2) + L = 825.964 (sin (fig. and on cond.) = (17 080) (13.564) - (2) (12 969.75) 1 850 structure outside force Metric (2) (2) (33 362) ( sin 3AC two conductors and guy: (moment (2 c0nd.j (2 Tmax. sin a/2) (l/2 SAS) = (2 guys) ( a 11owable 1 850 548 a sin a/2 ft 2175.159 1000 0 For 132 a/2) + 130.67 L = (2) (3840) (39.5) - 19 132 a/2) + L = 2175.159 for L and solve for a: L, q. = (sin L, Assume 171 (moment - (wind arm) on poles) 61). are two TRANSMISSION 172 Assume values for L and solve for LINE DESIGN MANUAL a: La sin a/2 ai2 600 300 0 0.030 4 1 .070 79 ,111 17 1044’ 4003’ 6O23’ a 3 O28’ 8006’ 112~46’ U.S. Customary a/2) (45.5) + (2) (1.231) + 112.021 L /2 = 170 1 365 000 (sin a/2) + 56.01 L = 151 748 24 370.648 (sin a/2) + L = 2709.302 Assume values for L and solve for Q: (2) (2) (7500) 1 365 000 (sin (sin a/2) L, ft two conductors, 0.029 10 .070 14 .lll 17 two (L/2) = (3840) (44.5) - (2) (9566) 880 - 19 132 sina/ 2000 1000 0 For (45.5) a/2 a 1040’ 4001’ 6’23’ 3O20’ 8002’ 12O46’ guys: Metric 1 850 Assume (sin a/2) + 249.083 L = (2) a/2) + L = 1756.068 values for L and solve for a: 656.86 7429.88 (17 080) (13.564) - (2) (12 969.75) (sin sin a/2 Lm 0.155 60 .195 97 .236 35 600 300 0 aI2 8O57’ 11°18’ 13O40’ a 17054’ 22O36’ 27 O20’ U. S. Customary 1 365 000 (sin a/2) + 56.01 24 370.648 L = Assume solve (sin a/2) + values for L and L = (2) (3840) (44.5) - (2) (9566) 5760.186 for a: L, ft sin a/2 2000 1000 0 0.154 29 .195 32 .236 36 aI2 8O52’ 11015’ 13O40’ a 17044’ 22O30’ 27 O20’ CHAPTER For one conductor and IV-STRUCTURE two overhead LIMITATION ground wires, AND GUYING one CHARTS guy: Metric (1) (2) (33 362) + (2) (2) = (17 080) 6860.892 Assume (sin (21 a/2) 418) (sin (14.326) a/2) (sin values (14.326) a/2) - (12 + (1) (14.326) (17.961) + (2) (14.326) (L /2) (13.2318) (14.326) (L/2) 969.75) + L = 728.186 L and solve for a: for sin, a 12 aI2 0.018 68 .062 41 .106 14 1004’ 3O34’ 6O05’ Lm 600 300 0 a 2OO8’ 7OO8’ 12010’ U.S. Customary (1) (2) (7500) (sin a/2) (47) + ( sin a/2) + (2) (‘4 (4815) (1) (47) (L/2) (0.906) (47) (1.231) (47) + (2) (L/2) = (3840) (47) - 9566 22 517.410 (sin a/2) + L = 2390.071 Assume values for L and solve for a: For one L, ft sin a/2 aI2 a 2000 1000 0 0.017 32 .061 73 .106 14 0°S9’ 3032’ 6Qo5’ lO58’ 7w4’ 12010’ conductor and two overhead a/2) + + L = 318.213 1497.131 ground wires, two guys: Metric 2 183 225.096 6860.882 (sin Assume (sin a/2) values for L and solve La for L = (2) (17 080) 0.130 76 .174 49 .218 21 42 7030’ lPO3’ 12036’ U. S. Customary 1 610 220 22 517.410 (sin a/2) (sin a/2) + L = (2) (3840) (47) - (9566) L = 4913.914 71.510 + .- (12 969.75) a: sina/ 600 300 0 (14.326) a 1SOOO’ 20° 06’ 2Pi 2’ 173 TRANSMISSION 174 Assume values L and solve for L, for 0 762 mm guy attachment (2.5 ft) two-conductor a total load for (three conductors two attachment between the two guy attachment guys and attachment The ground required points overhead with ground for the other guy attachment and two overhead points. two very little wires is separated two conductors and points, it is satisfactory wires) number 14O52’ 20000’ 25012’ guyed of guys load from an imaginary (as calculated) transferred the at each (2 cond.1 (2 T,,,. (1 cond.) attachment (moment on poles) sin a/2) (moment arm) + (2 cond.) ( wind force on cond.) arm) + (1 cond.) (wind force (2 T,,,. sin a/2) (moment arm) (l/2 SAS) (2) (2) (33 362) (sin a/2) = (2 guys) sin a/2) (moment arm) + (2 OGW) ( a 11owable horizontal load per guy) (2) (33 362) (sin (13.868) a/2) + (2) (14.326) (17.961) 4 033 881.960 Assmne be split between + (1) (17.961) (sin (sin a/2) values for Lm 600 300 0 (14.326) (14.326) (L/2) (L/2) a/2) + 567.296 L = 437 451.95 L = 771.118 L and solve for a: + sina/2 0.024 06 .060 63 .108 44 aI2 1022’ 3O28’ 6% 3’ arm) (l/2 (moment (wind force on OGW) (moment arm) - (wind (L/2) (13.868) + (2) (2) (21 418) (sin a/2) (14.326) + (2) (13.2318) = (2) (17 080) (13.945) - (3) (12 969.75) 7110.718 pole (moment on cond.) Metric (1) halfway then point): arm) (l/2 SAS) + (2 OGW) (2 T,,,. + only because the to consider point could through by points. (one SAS ) + conductor the guy attachment is located between the, two the Example For two 7O26’ 10°00’ 12”36’ f rom load between these one a al2 0.129 41 .173 82 .218 22 1000 MANUAL a: sin a/2 ft 2000 As the LINE DESIGN a 2O44’ 6O56’ 12O26’ CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS U. S. Customary (2) (2) (7500) (sin a/2) + (1) (2) (7500) (sin + (2) (2) (4815) ( sin = (2) (3840) (45.75) (45.5) a/2) a/2) - (3) + (2) (1.231) (45.5) (L/2) (47) + (1) (1.231) (47) (L/2) (47) + (2) (0.906) (47) (L /2) (9566) 2 975 220 (sin a/2) + 127.521 L = 322 662 23 331.216 (sin a/2) + L = 2530.266 Assume values for L and solve for a: L, ft 2000 1000 0 sin a/2 aI2 a 0.022 73 .065 59 .108 45 lO18’ 3045’ 6013’ 2036’ 7030’ 12O26’ For three guys (two at upper guy attachment and one at lower): Metric 4 033 881.960 (sin a/2) + 567.296 L = (3) (17 080) (13.945) 7110.718 (sin a/2) + L = 1190.970 Assume values for L and solve for a: - 38 909.25 L, m sin a/2 aI2 a 600 300 0 0.083 11 .125 30 .167 49 4p46’ 7012’ 938’ 9”32’ 14O24 19O16’ U. S. Customary 2 975 220 (sin a/2) + 127.521 L = (3) (3840) 23 331.216 (sin a/2) + L = 3907.921 Assume values for L and solve for a: L, ft 2000 1000 0 (45.75) - 28 698 sin a/2 42 0.081 78 .124 64 .167 50 4041’ 7OO9’ 938’ For four guys (two at each attachment a 9O22’ 14Ol8’ 19O16’ point): Metric + 4 033 881.960 (sin a/2) + L = 7110.718 (sin a/2) 567.296 1610.822 L.= (4) (17 080) (13.945) - 38 909.25 175 TRANSMISSION 176 Assrmle values L for and solve for LINE DESIGN a: sin a/2 Lm 600 300 0 MANUAL a aI2 0.142 15 .184 34 .226 53 8OlO’ 10O37’ 13005’ 16O20’ 21O14’ 26O 10’ U.S. C11st0maly 2 975 200 (sin a/2) + r. Compute For one guy L = (4) (3840) (45.75) - 28 698 L = 5285.576 127.521 23 331.216 (sin a/2) + Assume values for L and solve for a: L, ft sin a/2 2000 1000 0 0.140 82 .183 68 .226 54 conductor guying at each conductor: for a 42 structure 16OlO’ 21010’ 26O 10’ 8OO5’ 10035’ 13005’ types 3A (fig. 70) and 3AB (fig. 71). Metric 2 T(sin (2) (33 66 724 66 724 a/2) + 362) (sin (sin a/2) (sin a/2) 7430.041 Assume (sin a/2) values for L (wind force) (L /2) = 17 080 a/2) + [(47/1000) (0.383 04) + 17.9607 L /2 = 17 080 L = 17 080 + 8.9803 and sin a/2 m at2 0.175 23 .215 60 .256 00 lOOO5’ 12’27’ 14O50’ U. S. Customary (2) (7500) (sin a/2) 15 000 (sin a/2) + 15 000 (sin a/2) + + [(1.846/12) 1.231 L/2 0.6155 L = 24 370.43 + a/2) 17 080 1901.941 solve for a: 600 300 0 (sin = L = + L (lOOO)](L/2) (8)] = 3840 3840 L = 6238.83 (L/2) = 3840 a 2o” 10’ 24O54’ 29040’ CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 177 PLAN b ‘Minimum clearance between conductor and band or guy- 7 TYPE 1 230 Figure 70.-Type 3A Structure ground wires’ STRUCTURE 130481762011956 110-O 125-016-5 3A wood-pole structure. 104-D-1083. 178 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL PLAN /J c Minimum clearance between conductor and band or guy l-r TYPE Voltage, kV 1 69 Fii 3AB /J : / STRUCTURE Metric, mm “.‘. fCtus~~mory’ AIZIB AIZIB 130481442Oi 965 hO-Oh4-6 71-Type 3AB wood-pole structure. 1 3-2 1 104-D-1084. Assume values CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE for solve L and for sin a/2 2000 0.173 93 .214 97 .256 00 0 two guys at each AND GUYING CHARTS 179 a: L, ft 1000 For LIMITATION a aI2 20002 241O48’ 29O40’ 1OOOl’ 12O24’ 14050’ conductor: Metric 66 724 (sin 7430.041 Assume a/2) + (sin a/2) values for 8.9803 + L = L = L and (2) (17 080) 3803.882 solve for Lm a: sin a/2 0.431 21 .471 58 Sll 96 600 300 0 aI2 a 25O32’ 28OO8’ 30°47’ 5 I OO4’ 56’O16’ 6 l’O34’ aI2 a U. S. Customary 15 000 (sin a/2) + (sin a/2) 24 370.43 Assume values s. Compute for 0.6155 + L = L = L and (2) (3840). 12 477.66 solve for a: L, ft sin a/2 2000 1000 0 0.429 93 .470 97 .512 00 overhead ground wire guying 2S0’27’ 281OOS’ 3 0047’ for structure types on 2 OGW) = 3A, 50054’ 56010’ 6 1O’34’ 3AB, and 3TA (figs. 72, respectively). (2 OGV For one Metric (2 G,,,. sin a/2) + (wind load horizontal force to he guyed guy: (2) (2) (21 418) ( sin + 85 672 (sin a/2) + 85 672 (sin a/2) 6474.754 (sin a/2) a/2) + 26.4634 13.2317 + L = [ (34.544/1000) L /2 = 17 080 L = 1290:839 17 080 I (0.383 04) (lOOO)] (2) (L/2) = 17 080 70, 71, and 180 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL mm (14 ft) Withpost insulator 4877 mm (16 ft) With post insulator out Structure wires y ground TYPE I I Figure 72.-Type 3TA STRUCTURE POLE 3TA wood-pole SPACING structure. 104-D-1085. I CHAPTER Assume values L for IV-STRUCTURE and solve for Lm AND GUYING CHARTS a: sin a/2 600 300 0 U.S. LIMITATION a/2 0.106 70 .153 03 .199 36 6007’ 8O48’ 11030’ a 12O14’ 17O36’ 23OOO’ Customary (2) (2) (4815) (sin a/2) + [(1.36/12) (8)] 21 244.209 L = 3840 L = 4235.605 Assume solve 19 260 For two Metric (sin a/2) + (sin a/2) + values for L and for (2) (L/2) = 3840 a: L, ft sin a/2 2000 1000 0 0.105 23 ,152 30 .199 37 aI2 6OO2’ 8O45’ 11030’ a 12OO4’ 17030’ 23OOO’ guys: 85 672 (sin a/2) 6474.754 (sin a/2) Assume 0.9066 values + 13.2317 + L for L = (2)(17 080) L = and 2581.679 solve for a: La 600 300 0 sin a/2 a/2 a 0.306 06 .352 40 .398 73 17O49’ 20°38’ 23O30’ 35O38’ 41O16’ 47000’ a/2 a U. S. Customary 19 260 (sin a/2) + L = (2)(3840) 0.9066 21 244.209 (sin a/2) + Assume values for L and L = 8471.211 solve for a: L, ft sin a/2 2000 1000 0 0.304 61 .351 68 .398,75 17044’ 20°35’ 23O30’ 35O28’ 41010’ 47000’ 181 TRANSMISSION 182 For three LINE DESIGN MANUAL guys: Metric 85 672 (sin a/2) 6474.754 (sin a/2) Assume values + L for L = 13.2317 L = + and (3)(17 080) 3872.518 solve for a: sin a/2 Lm 0.505 43 .551 76 .598 10 600 300 0 a 42 30°21’ 33O29’ 36O44’ 60°42’ 66O58’ 73O28’ 42 a U.S. Customary 19 260 (sin 21 244.209 Assume a/2) + (sin a/2) vahtes 0.9066 + L L for and L = (3) (3840) = 12 706.817 solve for L, ft sin a/2 2000 0.503 99 .551 06 .598 13 1000 0 t. Prepare Assume guying structure data for has 18.3-m requirements with no angle (OGW) force on iced (wind (moment arm) force on pole) a: (l/2 SAS) structure (60-ft) type 30015’ 33O26’ 36O44’ 3TA western (fig. 60°30’ 66O52’ 73O28’ 72): red cedar poles without X-braces. = OGW) (moment [( max. allowable arm) (l/2 SAS) moment + ( cond.) on wood (wind pole)/(safetyLfactor Metric (13.232) (15.697) + 207.703 L/2 202.383 L = L = (L/2) + (17.959) L/2 = 197.064 112 307 554.923 m (maximum 125 (10.973) 277 SAS (L/2) = (250 555/Z) - 12 970 without side guys) U.S. Customary (0.9066) (51.5) (L/2) 46.690 L/2 + 44.316 45.503 L = 82 834 L = 1820.41 + Compute side guy guys: (36) (L/2) = = 92 400 - 9566 (1.231) L/2 ft (maximum SAS without (184 800/2) side guys) - 9566 12 970 force on iced cond.) of 2)] - (wind CHAPTER With At IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING 183 CHARTS X-braces: 5.9436 m (19.5 Circumference Diameter = on pole (wind 874 mm mm SAS) (34.4 in) in) on pole to wind on iced (l/2 of structure: (10.95 moment due force (moment arm) force on pole) top = 278 allowable Moment from of pole of pole Maximum (OGW) ft) = 81 603 OGW) (moment [( max. allowable = Nom (60 187 lb*ft) force: arm) (l/2 moment SAS) + on wood (cond.) (wind pole)/(safety force factor on iced cond.) of 2)] - (wind Metric FfI’(d, (13.232) 76.6291 +2d,) 6000 (5.7912) = [0.38304(1000)(5.9436)21 [278.13 +(2)(202.18)1 6000 (L/2) + L /2 + 19.1587 47.894 L = 39 262 m L = 819.7686 U. S. Customary (17.959) (1.0668) (L/2) 801 - 1539 = (81 603/2) - = 153g 176 Nem 1539 L /2 = 40 (maximum SAS without side guys) FH2 Cd, + 26,) _ K%19.5)21 f10.95 + (2) (7.9611 = 1135 25.,5 lbaft 72 72 (0.9066) 17.2254 10.767 The (19) (L/2) + (1.231) (3.5) (L/2) = (60 187/2) L /2 + 4.3085 L /2 = 30 093 - 1135 L = 28 958 L = 2689.51 ft (maximum SAS without side guys) National Electrical Safety Code does not require - 1135 angle guys structures; however, we use one single guy for each conductor up to 60 ‘. These angle guys will keep the structure from leaning for the u. 3TA overhead Determine single ground wires span were limits on structures The following paragraphs describe how between conductors and overhead ground and span permissible (30 length span with given for a given For loading conditions OF), determine the Conductor: 242 mm2 (477 Ruling span conductors structure of 13-mm conductor kcmil), computed in paragraph due to galloping to determine the spacing wires to prevent contact and overhead ground with given conductors (l/2-in) ice, O.lO-kPa and overhead ground ACSR, 24,/7, NESC if line guys at tension for line angles requirements 5.~. conductors: required between conductors and for a particular loading condition wires; or to determine and overhead ground (2-lb/ft2) wind pressure, wire sags for the given heavy are used on tension structures into the angle. Guying the maximum wires. and at minus span length: 1 ‘C loading = 213.36 m (700 ft) TRANSMISSION 184 Maximrun tension under full-load ice, 0.19-kPa (4-lb/ftz) Sag under a load of 13-mm at -l°C (30 LINE DESIGN MANUAL conditions of 13-mm (l/2-in) wind, at -18 o C: (0 o F) (l/2&1) ice, O.lO-kPa (2-lb/ftz) = 33 362N (7500 lb) = 5253 (17.23 = 2 13.36 = 21 118 N (4815 = 4353 wind, “F) mm ft) OG w: lo-mm (3/8-in) Ruling span Maximum high-strength tension under steel, full-load Sag under a load of 13-mm at -1 OC (30 “F) Sag and and tension calculation heavy loading conditions (l/2-in) forms NEST ice, O.lO-kPa for this (0) for example (2-lb/ft2) were m (700 ft) lb) wind, shown previously mm (14.28 on figures 57, ft) 58, 63, 64. Determine The the angle couductor (2-lb/ft2) wiud of sideswing has a force on the iced of 21.186 The overhead O.lO-kPa Therefore, ground (2-lb/ft2) wire wind has a force iced drawn at the ellipses: locations structures, sag valrles of attachment the conductors and below the attachment N/m of 11.773 N/m ground or points overhead points. length of the suspeusion hardware suspension insulator string for the overhead with (0.3077 = tan-’ overhead to scale to give an accurate configuration. respective angles of sideswing for the and lb/ft) 4.4898 or e = tan- 1 +f!$i$ Construct First, the conductors (I.4517 equals E on the the N/m conductor e = tan-’ the the 7-wire, for the (l/2-in) ice. Ib/ft). Therefore, with equals A O.lO-kPa 13-mm (l/2+1) ice. N/m (0.227 lb/ft). 3.3079 A 0.280 88 = 1SO42’. conductors and the are then drawn and overhead ground wires For suspension are located structures, for the overhead conductors. ground A line which will be the location of the major point at an angle of 28 f ram the line representing 13-mm lb/ft) wire Lines conductors wires: 0.211 92 = 1 lO58’. (0.807 = tan-’ ground overhead on these lines the sag points wires, gromld wires from the attachment ground wires. For and axis of an ellipse is then the conductor or overhead are points tension at their respective must be extended extended the drawn through ground wire length of each sag sideswing. The major axis of the ellipse is equal to the sag for full-sag ellipses, or one-half the sag for half-sag ellipses, plus 6 percent. The minor axis is equal to one-half of the major axis. The ends and center of the major axis are marked with one end being placed a distance below the sag point equal to 3 percent of the applicable sag or half-sag value. The minor axis is marked perpendicular to the major axis at its center point. The ellipses may then be drawn by any acceptable method. There is no definite length of span where galloping will change from full-sag ellipses to half-sag ellipses. However, our experience has shown that, for our line locations and conditions, we should use full-sag ellipses in spans up to 183 m (600 ft) in length. In longer spans, the conductors CHAPTER are likely to gallop IV-STRUCTURE in two or more percent of the sag, should be used. conductors or between conductors reduced (see sec. 15). for the longer must span be satisfied Full-sag limits Paragraph 6. To construct a. spans Lay the out the scale provided in one the and deflection b. Calibrate the the degree calibration pressure 5.b. chart 183-m type same scale A different bias horizontal axis to the equal to the resultant due to the (600-ft) of structure the for major spans axis and wire of these ellipses limitations limitation Ellipses chart are shown structures: the scale horizontal factor are adjusted deflection to 53 between is greatly configuration. scale may and be used the for lower the part sum of the of adjacent accordingly. right of the origin in degrees of line angle tension at 15.5 o C (60 ’ F) with 0.19-kPa line equal the half-sag and case. Each ground for the structure wood factor lines with 185 CHARTS the probability of contact as a result of galloping and overhead for 5.d.). angle conductor size ellipses, do not overlap, ground wires of the conductor limitation axes using the for each AND GUYING and cases to be considered structure (see pars. so one-half for the maximum be made by the dimensions for the different structure types on figures ‘73 through 87. vertical loops If these ellipses and overhead ellipses should LIMITATION angle (par. deflection (4-lb/ft2) with wind 5.d.). c. Calibrate the vertical axis above the origin in meters (feet) for the sum of adjacent spans. The calibrations should be at a distance above the origin equal to the wind pressure at 0.19 kPa (4 lb/ft2) on a bare d. conductor Calibrate of length the vertical equal to one-half axis below of the bare (no ice) conductor be displaced below the origin (pars. 5.b. and 5.c.). the origin Lay out the deflection angle bias g. Layout lines showing h. Draw lines to show in meters are offset the vertical adjacent (feet) for the distance spans (par. 5.e.). between low the maximum (pars. of the the conductor at the computed vertically from force of each swing, and draw in heavy (see table 21, par. l.c.). angle and the distance between add or subtract the wind permissible (dependent low point sum of adjacent limits the, insulator holddown by permissible upon low points scale, pressure to or from spans 5.k., 5.1., and S.m.), and maximum low structures (pars. 5.g., 5.h., and 5.i.). of holddowns to the bottom of the insulator strings holddown is drawn parallel to the insulator string swing These lines multiplying of the angles of insulator type of structure lines used for the sum of adjacent spans scale These bias lines are used to automatically tension due to a line deflection angle. types of suspension structures calculated from the strength sum points equal to the vertical force of the conductor. The zero point by a distance equal to one-half the vertical force of the insulator e. With a protractor, lay out the radial lines for the insulator swing limits for each f. the by the for class point addition should string boundary scale factors see par. 5.f.). the resultant 2 poles distance for all lines of various as sizes (par. 5.j.). A line for each size of insulator limit line for the type HS and HSB structures. string swing the low point limit line by values obtained scale factor (par. 5.j.). by TRANSMISSION 186 i. Plot the single 35 585 N (8000 j. spans The Add lb) insulator for the bias lines chart (par. structure string 88 965-N limit LINE DESIGN line (20 OOO-lb) for determining at the units resultant under the limitation MANUAL load on the maximum of single insulator loading insulator string conditions strings equal (par. to 5.n.). to the sum of adjacent 5.0.). limitation charts for wood structures are shown on figures 88 through 91. Paragraph 7. To construct a. Use b. Superimpose calibration C. under the the same (sum From angle guying line deflection the guying of adjacent conditions for angle chart horizontal using for the number (pars. suspension on the spans) the calculations full-load chart 5.p., wood axis deflection the structures: as used angle bias same scale used of angle guys required q., r., and s.), plot for lines, for lines the the structure limitation or repeat structure the vertical limitation for the various separating chart. the types zones axis chart.. of structures for different quantities of guys. Some of the limitations calculated may be unnecessary because some of the limit lines may be very close to each other if they are all plotted. Some of these limitations may be combined with others to keep the chart clean, but care must be taken to eliminate the right lines so that all guying requirements are satisfied. required by various guy guys required to satisfy indicated one angle Standard arrangements, the calculated guying drawings and the required guy requirements. quantities The be checked coordinated coordinated for the number with the quantities of guys number should of be on the structure guying chart. No guying is required for a line angle up to lo, but at least guy per suspension structure should be used for all line deflection angles greater than lo. A vertical line at the 1 o mark should be drawn and an angle guy is not required. Guying charts are shown arrangement must drawing for the type 3TA structure labeled to indicate the area on the chart on figures 92 and 93. A typical standard has been included as figure 94. where guying CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE Type HS Structure 289.5 -m (950-ft) Span Based on 213.4-m (700-ft) ruling span 3658-mm (12-ft) l%e spacing NESC Heavy Loading Conductor full-load tension = 33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW f ul I - load tension = 21 418 N (4815 lb) Half-sag ellipses LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS Conductor: 242 mm2 (477 kcmil~B~SR. 2417 9% Sag Half sag 290 (31.74) ( 15.87) ( 0.95) 5127 2563 (16.82) ( 8.41) 4837 +6% Major axis Minor axis 8 = I lo 58’ OGW: IO-mm ( i-in) So HaBf saa +6% ~-= Major axis Minor axis 8= 15’42’ H.S. Steel (tilt) mm 8016 (26.30) 4008 (I 3.15) ii0 ( 0.79) 4248 (I 3.94) 2124 ( 6.97) 4023 mm t= Fiie 73.~Half- and full-sag ellipses for type HS wood-pole (13.2 ft) structure (Sheet 1 of 2). 104-D-1086-1. 187 188 TRANSMISSION Type HS Structure 183-m (600-ft) Span Based on 213.4-m (700-ft) ruling span 3658-mm (12-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy Loading Conductor ful I- load tension = 33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension = 21 418 N (4815 lb) Full-sag ellipses LINE DESIGN MANUAL Conductor: 242 mm2 (477 kcmil) ACSR, 24/7 (if) m 3852 (12.64) Sag +6% Major axis Minor axis 231 4083 2042 ( 0.76) (13.40) ( 6.70) 0= IP58’ OGW: lo-mm ( i-in) Sag +6% Major axis Minor axis H.S. Steel mm (tit) 3 I97 (10.49) 192 3389 1695 ( 0.63) (I 1.12) ( 5.56) 8 = 15“ 42’ Figure 73.~Half- and full-sag ellipses for type HS wood-pole structure (Sheet 2 of 2). 104-D-1086-2. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE Based on 213.4-m (700-ft) ruling span 3658-mm (i2-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy Loading Conductor full-load tension Half-sag ellipses AND GUYING IO?7 5 359 321 5 680 2 840 Sag Half-sog +6% Major axis Minor axis 9 = I lo 58’ OGW: lo-mm ($-in) Saa Haif -sag +6% Major axis Minor axis 189 CHARTS Conductor: 242 mm2 (477 kcmil)f;XiR, Type HSB Structure 305.4-m (iooo-ft) Span = 33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension = 21 418 N (4815 lb) LIMITATION 24/7 (3576) (17.58) ( 1.05) ( 18.63) ( 9.32) H.S. Steel (fi) mm 8882 (29.14) 4441 ( 14.57) 266 ( 0.87) 4707 (15.44) 2353 ( 7.72) 6= 15”42’ F’iie 74.~Half- and full-sag ellipses for type HSB wood-pole structure (Sheet 1 of 2). 104-D-1087-1. TRANSMISSION 190 Type HS8 Structure Conductor: 183-m (600-ft) Span Based on 213.4-m (7oo-ft) ruling span 3658-mm (l2-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy Loading Conductor full- load tension = 33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension = 21 418 N (4815 lb) Full-sag ellipses Figure 74.-Half- and full-sag LINE DESIGN MANUAL 242 mm* (477 kcmil) ACSR, 2417 CY) 3852 (12.64) Sag +6% 231 ( 0.76) Major axis 4083 ( 13.40) Minor axis 2042 ( 6.70) 0 = I l”58’ OGW: IO-mm ($-in) H.S. Steel mm wt) 3197 (10.49) Sag +6% 192 ( 0.63) Major axis 3389 (11.12) Minor axis 1695 ( 5.56) 0 = 15’42’ ellipses for type HSB wood-pole structure (Sheet 2 of 2). 104-D-1087-2. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE Type 3AC Structure loo Line Angie 304.8-m (IOOO-ft) Span Based on 213.4-m (7oo-ft) ruling span 4267~ITIm (l4-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy Loading Conductor full-load tension = 33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension = 21 418 N (4815 lb) Half-sag ellipses LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS Conductor: 242 mm2 (477 kcmi~ft;LCSR. 24/7 IO?7 WI (35,16) Half -sag +6X Major axis Minor axis 8 = 11’58’ OGW: IO-mm (i-in) sag Half-sag +6% Major axis Minor axis 0 = 15’ 42’ 5 680 2 840 ( 18.63) ( 9.32) H.S. Steel mm 8882 4441 266 4707 2353 Kt) (29.14) (14.57) ( 0.87) (15.44) ( 1.72) 2(23 586) sin 5’+ Fii 75.~Half- and full-sag ellipses for type 3AC wood-pole structure (Sheet 1 of 2). 104-D-1088-1. 191 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 192 Type 3AC Structure IO0 Line Angle 183-m (600-ft) Span Based on 213.4-m (7oo-ft) ruling span 4267-mm (l4-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy Loading Conductor f uI I - load tension = 33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension Conductor: 242 mm2 (477 kcmil) ACSR, 2417 mm K?) 3852 (I 2.64) wl +6% 8 = ll”58’ OGW: IO-t?Im (i-in) +6% Full-sag ellipses 2 Fire 75.-Half- and full-sag Major axis Minor axis 8 = 15’ 42’ _ t- ( 0.76) (13.40) ( 6.70) H.S. Steel Hi) mm swl = 21 418 N (4815 lb) z 231 4083 2042 Major axis Minor axis 3 197 192 3389 ( 10.49) ( 0.63) (I 1.12) 1695 ( 5.56) 4251 mm (13.95 ft) ellipses for type 3AC wood-pole structure (Sheet 2 of 2). 104-D-1088-2. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE Type 3TA Structure Tangent, OGW in tension 213-m (700 -ft) Span 4267-mm (I4 - f t) Pole spacing NESC Heavy loading Conductor full-load tension -33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension -21 418 N (4815 lb) Full-sag ellipses LIMITATION AND GUYING 193 CHARTS Conductor : 242 mm2 (477 kcmil) ACSR, 24/7 5g 315 5568 2784 Sag +6 % Major axis Minor axis 0- ll”58’ OGW: ICFmm (&in) WI (17.23) (I .03) (18.26) (9.13) H.S. Steel Sag +6 % Major axis Minor axis 0= 15’42’ mm (B) 4353 261 4614 2307 (14.28) (0.86) (15.14) (7.5 7) 3534 mm (28 ft) Figure 76.-Full-sag 104-D-1089. ellipses for type 3TA wood-pole structure, tangent, 4267-mm (14.ft) pole spacing. TRANSMISSION 194 Conductor : 242 mm* (477 kcmil)ACSR, Sag Half sag +6 % Major axis Minor axis 8= 11’58’ OGW: IO-mm (i-in) Sag Half sag +6 % Major Minor 0= F@e. axis axis mm I2 966 6483 389 6872 3436 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Type 3TA Structure Tangent, OGW in tension 2417 (fa (42.54) (21.27) (1.27) (22.54) (I 1.27) 335-m (IIOO-ft) Span 4267-mm (l4- ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy loading Conductor ful l-load tension =33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension -21 418 N (4815 lb) Half-sag ellipses H.S. Steel IO 747 5374 (ti) (35.26) (I 7.63) 322 5696 2848 (1.06) (18.69) (9.35) 8534 mm (28 ft) lS“42’ 77.-Half-sag ellipses for type 3TA wood-pole structure, tangent, 4267-mm (14.ft) pole spacing. 104-D-1090. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 195 Type 3TA Structure 90” Line ongle, OGW in tension Conductor : 242 mm’ (477 kcmil) ACSR. 2417 Cf?) Without post insulator for jumper 4526 (14.86) Sag 198-m (650-ft) Span II 278-mm (37-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy loading +6% 272 4798 2399 Major axis Minor axis Conductor full -load tension 0 = Ilo 58’ -33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW: IO-mm ($-in) OGW full-load tension 121 418 N (4815 lb) sag Full-sag ellipses +6 % Only one OGW and two conductors Major axis are shown Minor axis 0s Fiie 78.-Full-sag ellipses for type 3TA wood-pole spacing. 104-D-1091. (0.89) (15.75) (7.88) H.S. Steel (ti) 3751 225 3976 1988 (12.31) (0.74) (13.05) (6.53) l5O42’ structure, 90” line angle, 11 278~mm (37.ft) pole TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 196 15 951 mm (52.33 ft) Conductor: 242 mm2( 477 kcmil). ACSR, 24/ 7 mm (ft) m Half-sag +6% Major ax/s Minor axis 0 e= 11058’ GW: IO-mm (i-in), m Half-sag +6% Major axis Minor axis II817 5 909 355 6 264 3 I32 (38.77) (19.39) ( 1.16) (20.55) (10.28) H.S. Steel !E3 4897 294 5191 2596 Type 3iA Structure 90“ Line Angle 320-m (1050-ftj Span II 278-mm (37-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy Loading Conductor full- load tension = 33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW ful I- load tension = 21 418 N (4815 lb) Half-sag ellipses O;to;;e OGW and two conductors (ft 1 (3Z) (I 6.07) ( 0.96) (17.03) ( 8.52) 0 = 15”42’ Figure 79.-Half-sag 104-D-1092. ellipses for type 3TA wood-pole structure, 90’ line angle, 11 278-mm (37-ft) pole spacing. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE Type 3TA Structure 60’ Line angle, OGWin tension 213-m (700-ft) Span 4267-mm(l4-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy loading Conductor full-load tension -33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension =21 418 N (4815 lb) Full-sag ellipses LIMITATION Conductor: AND GUYING 242mm' Sag +6 % Major axis Minor axis 8 = I lo 58’ OGW: IO-mm (i-in) %I +6 % Major axis Minor axis 8= 15’42’ \ Figure 80.-Full-sag ellipses for type 3TA wood-pole spacing. 104-D-1093. 197 CHARTS (477 kcmil)ACSR. 2417 (ft) 5% (17.23) 315 (I .03) 5568 (18.26) 2784 (9.13) H.S. Steel mm Ki) 4353 (14.28) 261 (0.86) 4614 (15.14) 2307 (7.57) 7366 mm (24.17f t) structure, 60’ line angle, 4267-mm (14-ft) pole 198 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Type 3TA Structure Conductor : 242 mm2 (477 kcmi I) ACSR, 2417 60’ Line angle, OGWin’ tension w 213-m (700- ft) Span 5z3 (17.23) sag 8230-mm (27-ft) Pole spacing +6 % 315 (I .03) NESC Heavy loading Major oxis 5568 (18.26) Conductor full-load tension Minor axis 2784 (9.13) =33 362 N (7500 lb) 0 = I lo 58’ OGW full-load tension OGW : IO-mm (i-in) H. S. Steel =2l 418 N (4815 lb) Cfi) mm Full-sag ellipses 4353 (14.28) Sag Only one OGW and two conductors +6 % 261 (0.86) are shown Major oxis 4614 (15.14) Minor axis 2307 (7.5 7) 8= ; _ 14 249 mm (46.75 ft) _ 7125 mm (23.38 ft) Figure 81.-Full-sag 104-D-1094. 15O42’ ellipses 7125 mm (23.38 ft) for type 3TA wood-pole structure, 60’ line angle, 8230-mm (27-ft) pole spacing. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS Type 3TA Structure 60” Line angje,OGWin tension 335-m (Iloo-ft) Span 4267-mm(14-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy loading Conductor full-load tension =33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension -21 418 N (4815 lb) Half-sag ellipses Conductor : 242 mm’ (477 kcmil) ACSR, 2417 snm (W 12966 (42.54) sag Half -sag 6483 (21.27) +6 % 389 (1.27) Major axis 6872 (22.54) Minor axis 3436 (I I. 27) 8 = I I“ 58’ OGW: IO-mm (&in) H.S. Steel mm Sag Half -sag +6 % Major axis Minor axis 8= 15”42’ Figure 82.-Half-sag 104-D-1095. ellipses for type 3TA woo&pole 199 structure, 60 ’ line angle, 4267-mm (14.ft) pole spacing. 200 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN Conductor: 242 mm2 (477 kcmi I) ACSR, 24/7 4< (ft) Sag Half -sag +6% Major axis Minor axis 0==11”58 OGW: IO-mm (i-in) Sag Half-sag +6% Major axis Minor axis I2%6 6483 389 6872 3436 (4224) (21.27) ( 1.27) (22.54) (I 1.27) H.S. Steel mm IO 747 5374 322 5696 2848 (f_t) (35.26) (17.63 ) ( 1.06) (18.69) ( 9.35) MANUAL 14 249 mm (46.75 f t) b Type 3TA Structure 60’ Line angle, OGW in tension 335-m (IIOO-ft) Span 8230-mm (27-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy loading Conductor full-load tension = 33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension = 21 418 N (4815 lb) Half-sag ellipses 0= 15’42’ Only one OGW and two conductors are shown Figure 83.-Half-sag 104-D-1096. ellipses for type 3TA wood-pole structure, 60’ line angle, 8230-mm (27.ft) pole spacing. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE Type ETA Structure LIMITATION full- Full-sag Sag +6% Major axis Minor axis load tension = 33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full- load tension = 21 418 N (4815 lb) CHARTS 201 Conductor: 242 mm2 (477 kcmil) ACSR. 2417 45’ Line angle, OGW in tension 213-m (700-ft) Span 6096-mm (20-ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy loading Conductor AND GUYING 8= Il”58’ OGW: IO-mm ( i-in) ellipses Sag +6% Major axis Minor axis 5E3 315 5568 2784 (ft) (17.23) ( 1.03) ( 18.26) ( 9.13) H.S. Steel mm 4353 261 4614 2307 CD) (14.28) ( 0.86) (15.14) ( 7.57) 8 =15’42’ II 278 mm Figure 84.-Full-sag ellipses for type 3TA spacing. 104-D-1097. wood-pole structure, 45’ line angle, 6096&n (20-ft) pole 202 TRANSMISSION Conductor: 242 mm2(477 Sag Half -sag +6% Major axis Minor axis 8= 11’58’ OGW: IO-mm (i-in) Sag Half-sag +6% Major axis Minor axis 8 = 15’42’ Figure (IL-Half-sag 104-D-1098. MANUAL kcmil ) ACSR, 24/7 mm I2 966 6483 389 6872 3436 (ti) (42.54) (21.27 ) ( 1.27) (22.54) (11.27) ~~~ Heavy loading Conductor full-load tension NESC H.S. Steel = 33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension = 21 418 N (4815 lb) (W I Om7:7 (35.26) 5374 (17.63) 322 ( 1.06 ) 5696 (18.69) 2848 ( 9.35) ellipses LINE DESIGN for type 3TA T E z ul Half-sag ellipses Only one OGW and two conductors are shown B d e J / L wood-pole structure, 45 ’ line angle, 6096-mm (20.ft) pole spacing. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE Type 3TA Structure 30° Line angle. OGW in tension 213-m (700-ft) Span 4572- mm (l5-ft) hle spacing NESC Heavy loading Conductor full- load tension =33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension =2l 418 N (4815 lb) Full-sag ellipses LIMITATION AND GUYING 203 Conductor : 242 mm2 (477 kcmil) ACSR. 24/7 sag +6% Major axis Minor axis 8- 11’58’ OGW: IO-mm (i-in) Sag +6% Major axis Minor axis 8= l5O 42’ Figure 86.-Full-sag ellipses for type 3TA spacing. 104-D-1099. CHARTS wood-pole structure, 30° mm 5253 315 5568 2784 (-ft) (17.23) ( 1.03) (18.26) (9.13) H.S. Steel 4% 261 4614 2307 (ftl (1428) ( 0.86) (15.14) ( 7.57) line angle, 4572=mm (IS-ft) pole TRANSMISSION 204 Conductor : 242 mm2 (477 kcmiI)ACSR. Sag Half -sag +6% Major axis Minor axis 8 = I I’-’58’ OGW: IO-mm (i-in) Sag Half -sag + 6 “/o Major Minor e= axis axis mm I2 966 6483 389 6872 3436 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Type 3TA Structure 30” Line angle, OGW in tension 335-m (Iloo- f t) Span 4572-mm (15 - ft) Pole spacing NESC Heavy loading Conductor ful l-load tension 24/7 (-ft) (42.54) (21.27) (1.27) (22.54) (II ,27) =33 362 N (7500 lb) OGW full-load tension =2l 418 N (4815 lb) H.S. Steel IO%7 5374 322 5696 2848 Half -sag ellipses (ft) (3F26) (17.63) (1.06) (18.69) (9.35) I 15” 42’ Figure 87.-Half-sag 104-D-1100. ellipses for type 3TA wood-pole structure, 30’ line angle, 4572-mm (15.ft) pole spacing. (4x1~) suodS -P\ CHAPTER +lMD! F IV-STRUCTURE 8 ? :t \ lp \ \y \ I’ LIMITATION 1 AND GUYING I CHARTS t f . , 4’ \ 205 5i 900 \ -60 -70 -60 -50 -40 with 88 965-N units -30 -20 -10 30 40 50 Angle’of InsuloGr Swing ~~egrees) Figure 89.-Example of a wood-structure limitation chart (metric). 104-D-1102. s e / I /I I4DG I \/ 3&3AB & 3TA OGW Gu 3 A & 3AB Co\nd. Gu !c I / I/ \‘. I \‘I . I \ / I IY.. \ blY\V /I \. \ \ I I / I I // \ \ \ / In n -10 Angle of"lnsulotor Figure 90.-Example king k&s) of a wood-structure limitation chart (U.S. customary). 104-D-1103. STRUCTURE NOTES DATA Voltage Looding -wet HS HSB 36 269 305 305 3A8 305 3AC 305 O-213 3TA’ 13% 2070 213 213-335 0- 213 213-335 0- 213 213-335 o- I96 196-320 lure 94 1 lension. 1 = tension ?i2E& ‘or (tensm) OGW mlmul) OGW (suspension) Angle guys Conductor OGW S ted 12 610 60 610 Itit 426 0 S S 3.6 5.5 S 5.2 I2 I6 I7 I4 I4 I4 I4 I4 Conductor Ultimate strength Maximum design tension 33 670 0 4.3 Overhead ground wire 426 4.3 60 Ultimate strength 670 60 4.3 Mokimum design tension -21 426 30 4.6 I5 Guy wire 670 4.6 30 I5 Conductor cteomnce 426 6.1 45 20 to pole ground wire or 670 45 6.1 20 to centerline of pok 1092 mm(43 in) 426 60 6.2 27 to crossarme69 mm(35 in) 670 60 6.2 27 to guy wire 1397 mm(55 in) 396 90 II.3 37 Lightning protective angle -30 degrees 90 II.3 - 37 Span length limits by holf sag elkpse method for suspemion structures Safety fuctws with l3-mm (i-in) ice, 0.36-kPo (&lb/ft) wind Poles 2.0 Cmssorms 4.0 One line double guy per conductor. Total for structure Insulators would be three line double guys each way (3-LDGEW). suspension 2.5 T mor.= 33 362 N (75oolb). I siflgle guy = 22 800 N (5125lb) tension 3.0 horizontal pull. Conductor 2.0 -.._ ^ . . . one line OouMe guy per OGW. TOtal for Structure would uverneoo grouno wire 2.0 be two line double guys each way (P-LDGEW). Guy wire Offset OGW line guys 30. from COnduCtOr t for e IV line line guys.o angles. 22 800 N (5125 lb) times cos 3Ov-19 745 N (4436lb.3 transverse 2.67 Omit OGW line guys for OGW in MpenSiOn (O*-60. line angles). Omit angle guys for 0*-I* and 60*- 90. line ongles. The oppropriateDnetric or U.S. customary) data from Use 3-150 for conductors on line angles up to 60. to keep the this figure should be placed on the structure structure from leaning into the angle. limitation chart to make o complete chart. For OGW in suspension (r- 60’ line angles) or tension ( lV-60v line angles). mad guying rquimments on suspemion guying chart. 1675 -335 O-213 iFi horl lMkn 3.6 -0.38 wind 1orrongl chu-t 213-335 O-213 near4 570 610 610 Design wind on structures Rles Ultunote fiber stress Crossarms Ultimate fiber stress Insulators II5 kv NESC Heavy: l3-mm(+in) ice. O.l9-kPo (rib/ft’) mum plus constant ot -l6Y(O*F) kPa (6 Ib/fte) Gloss 2 western red cedar 36.612 MPo(5600 lb/in’) Douglas fir 51.023 MR (7400 lb/in’) 146 by 254 mm (5{ by IO in). 66 964-N (2oOOo-lb) stwndord suspension units 242 mm’ (477 kcmil). ACSR. 2417. Flicker 76 509 N(l7 200 lb) 362 N (7500 lb) under full load conditions IO-mm (i-m) high strength steel, 7 wire 46 040 ND0 600 lb) 416 N (4615 lb) under full load conditions II-mm (fin) high strength steel, 7 wire Figure 91.-Additional S S or T S or T SorT Sor T T T T T T T T T data required 4.3 4.3 for the wood-structure limitation chart. 104-D-1104. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 209 NOTES The required number of guys noted on this chart should be coordinated with the number of guys required by the standard guying arrangement drawing for the structure type used. The coordinated number of guys should then be shown an the final guying chart. The line shown for b. may be omitted because of the small area defined. The H-frame (x-braced) limit and the I-ADG limit far conductors are about identical, so only one line is shown at f. The line shown far g. may be omitted because it falls outside the structure limit ; use structure limit far guy limit. Use the same maximum sum of adjacent spans limit for Type 3Ac as used for the type HS structures. ASG = Angle single guy ADG = Angle double guy 7\7 - I.x,i/ I/ i Y,/ I 74 /I . IV . I / I/ i ’ \, ‘i Figure 92.-Example guying chart ‘\/ Line for wood-pole I DeflectioFAngle structures (metric). / / r\ I \ (degreesr 104-D-1105. / / 210 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL NOTES The required number of guys noted on this chart should be coordinated with the number of guys required by the standard guymg arrangement drowmg for the structure type used. The coordinated number of guys should then be shown on the final guying chart. The line shown for b. may be omitted because of the small area defined. The H-frame (x-braced) limit and the I-ADG limit for conductors ore about identical. so only one line is shown ot f. The line shown for g.moy be omitted because it falls outside the structure limit; use structure limit for guy hmit. Use the same maximum sum ofadJacentspanslimlt forType 3AC as used for the Type HS structures. ASG = Angle single guy ADG '- Angle double guy 3000 \ c \ \ s r x v) v, 2000 \ \ / / / \ \ \ f!i .z Q \ / & / z \ \ 1000 \ / ‘c 0 / \ \ \. OO, 5 101 I5 20 h 2 30 50 Line Figure 93.-Example guying chart for wood-pole Deflectmn4c!Angle (degrees) structures \ \, \ s \ \ \ E . (U.S. customary). 104-D-1106. CHAPTER IV-STRUCTURE LIMITATION AND GUYING CHARTS 211 <<Chapter ADDITIONAL 25. Stresses H-frame type in Wood-Pole structure will DATA Structures.-There withstand when large V is a limit conductors to the and long amount spans of loading are used. This that the limitation becomes even more pronounced when strong winds and heavy ice loadings are also present. Sample analyses have been made to determine the pole strength in column loading for small deflections. Calculations of stresses have been made for the following H-frame structures: 29-m 29-m 29-m l l l The (95-ft) (95-ft) (95-ft) type type type HS 230-kV structure HSB 230-kV structure HSB 230-kV structure calculations assume: a The in a structure load Clockwise ,bending Poles are uniformly l a member moments tapered is positive with class 2 Douglas fir poles and one X-brace with class 2 Douglas fir poles and one X-brace with class 1 Douglas fir poles and two X-braces if it is in tension, are positive with minimum ANSI and negative (American if it is in compression National Standards Institute) dimensions a All The bolted effect joints of wind mass was neglected be made in tables and This by using B-l and B-4. on the structures and Example L M F U R I I, was taken on all structures. Similar the methods shown in the B-2, and pole circumferences Development figure Let are rigid the of the above I.-Stress = load formula tables for maximum (95.ft) = = bending extreme = = = axial reaction in pole horizontal reaction on pole account for only any single double prime sign indicates prime sign indicates V, Vg = = vertical vertical H, = horizontal conductor overhead conductor load ground, height and structure or voltage class may moment of resistance type HS 230-kV vertical load stress horizontal load stress wire is shown on figure B-4. B. moment fiber stress = on the HS structure, structure following examples. Pole resistance moments are shown for different classes of poles are shown in tables B-3 are in appendix analysis for a 29-m in member into analyses load load 213 structure with class 2 wood poles: TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 214 Hg = horizontal P, = pole LP = SAS = overhead resisting distance sum ground wire load moment between of adjacent low points in adjacent spans spans Metric Figure 95 shows the structure outline and -G I other data. - i L L 2 x 1 N --- Q - Conductor: 403 mm’, ACSR, 45/7 Diameter - 27 mm 0.38- kPo wind on iced (l3-mm radial) conductor = 20.07 N/m Vertical force with 13-mm radial ice = 27.26 N/m OGW: IO mm, H.S. Steel, ‘I-Wire Diameter = 9 mm 0.38 - kPa wind on iced (l3-mm radial 1 OGW= 13.23 N/m Vertical force with l3-mm radial ice = Ii.79 N/m Position 8 or D Ground K or M or P or R or dim5 Pole Circumference, mm 718 L N Q s Pr , N.m 801 59 778 82 996 983 1148 1326 244 634 376 534 I53 411 Douglas Fir Working Stress = 51.02 MPa 6.706 m Figure 95.-29-m Vertical loads, type HS 230-kV structure with class 2 Douglas fir poles (one X-brace). V, = (27.26)(LP) v- Hc = (20.07)(SAS/2) Hg = 3 V, + 2 Vg, are shared equally by two = (11.79)(LP) (13.23)(SAS/2) poles: UK’= U,’ = jyM’fl= UN’= Up’= UQ’= U,’ = U,’ = 1.5v, + vg 104-D-1107. CHAPTER For transverse H, loads and Hg , a plane Y vhf ) V-ADDITIONAL PQ exists. of inflection 215 DATA The location of the plane is found by: Y, = ‘rR vertical force due vu = Assuming 244-m The The The For + 2Hg(hg) + moment due to wind on poles pole spacing 0.383(16.464)2 [365.2 6 +(2)(202.2)] 037.60N force and in the overhead downward force and overhead force Pole 3H,(h,) 6.706 uplift conductor, is: (13.416)+2(13.23) V”= conductor, to uplift spans: 3(20.07) =49 +PrM = 12.649 - 3.662 = 8.987 m Yl The = (12.649) (153 411) = 3 662 m 376534+ 153411 * in the braces bending windward ground in the X-brace ground is installed at 45 moments are: pole is VU minus leeward the vertical force of structure, pole is one-half the vertical force of structure, VU plus wire. 0.5 Vu/sin 0 . O, 0.5 Vu 0.707 = 0.707 Vu. At K, MK = (1 SH,) (3.048) + H,(5.944) MK = 4.572(20.07)(243.84)+ + one-half wire. 0.383(6.096)2 + moment due to wind on pole 5.944(13.23)(243.84) [254.8 + (2) (202.2)l 6 At M, MIM = (1 SH, + H,)y, = 43 114 M,m + moment due to wind on pole MM = t(1.5) (20.07) + 13.231 (243.8) (3.662) + 0.383(12.802)2 1312.7 + (2) (202.2)1 = 46 291 Nam 6 TRANSMISSION 216 LINE DESIGN MANUAL At R, MR = (1 .5Hc + H,)y, + moment due to wind on pole MR = [(1.5) (20.07) + 13.231 (243.8) (8.987) + 0.383(25.451)2 Crossarm For [421.9 + (2) (202.2)1 = 12g 1 l4 Nmrn 6 strength:’ a 79- by 267-mm laminated arm, the ultimate fiber stress S = 13.79 MPa: where : W, = ultimate vertical load, N b = horizontal thickness of arm, mm d = vertical thickness of arm, mm L = length of arm to load (lever arm), mm w = 13.79(79) (267)2 = 3861 N or 7722 N for a double arm V 6(3352.8) For the given Allowable conductor, distance the between vertical low force points is 27.26 is 7722/27.26 N/m = (with 13-mm 283.272 m. radial ice). U. S. Customary Figure Vertical 96 shows loads, the 3 structure outline V, = H, = (1.3754)(SAS/2) V, + 2 and other data. (1.8682)(LP) V', are shared Vg = (0.8079)(LP) Hg = (0.9066)(SAS/2) equally ’ Standard Specifications for Structural Glued Laminated Association), table II, combination E, shows this ultimate (79- by 267-mm) laminated crossarm. by two poles: Douglas Fir (Coast Region) Timber (West Coast Lumbermen’s fiber stress is 2000 lb/ in2 (13.79 MPa) for a 3-l/8- by lo-l/2-in CHAPTER , V-ADDITIONAL DATA Conductor: 795 kcmil. ACSR, 45/7 Diameter = 1.063 in 8-lb/ft’ wind on iced (f-in radial) conductor - I. 3754 Ib/ft Vertical force with t-in radial ice = 1.8682 Ib/ft OGW: B - in H.S. steel, 7-wire Diameter = 0.360 in 8-Ib/ft* wind on iced (t-in radial) OGW = 0.9066 Ib/ft Vertical force with i-in radial ice = 0.8079 Ib/ft F - Ground h Figure 96.-95.ft 22ft For transverse type HS 230.kV loads H,and Hg, structure a plane Pole Circumference, in Posit ion 8 or cl K or L 28.26 31.52 44 100 6 I 059 M or N POT0 R or s 38.69 113244 45.20 180421 52.19 277 731 with class 2 Douglas of inflection fir poles (one X-brace). PQexists. The location by: Y (PM 1 (41.5) (113 244) y” =PrR +PrM = 277731+113244 yt The vertical force due vu = = 41.5 to the 3H,(h,) - 12.02 uplift = 29.48 Pr, Ibeft Douglas Fir Working stress = 7400 lb/in* ww- . 217 = 12 o2 ft ’ ft is: + 2Hg(hg) + moment due to wind on poles pole spacing 104-D-1108. of the plane is found TRANSMISSION 218 Assuming 800-ft LINE DESIGN spans: 3(1.3754) (F)( 44.02) +2(0.9066)(?)(53.52) vu = The uplift and overhead The At force in the braces bending windward pole is VU minus one-half the weight of structure, conductor, in the leeward pole is VU plus one-half the weight of structure, conductor, wire. X-brace is 0.5 VU/sin 8 . installed at 45 O, 0.5 VU/O.707 moments are: = 0.707 V, K,M, = (1 SH,) (10) + I&( 19.5) + moment due to wind on pole MK = 15 (1.3752) (800) + 19.5 (0.9066) (800) + = 31 799 At + 2(7’96)1) wire. ground force For in the ground downward Pole [;38 lb force overhead The + 2 ((8)(54’02)’ 22 = 11 026.87 and MANUAL 8(20)2 [ 10.03 + (2) (7.96)] 72 lb*ft M,MM = (1 .5HC + H,)y, + moment due to wind on pole MM = [( 1.5) (1.3752) + 0.90661, (800) (12.02) + 8t42)2 [ 12’y2+ (2) (7*96)1 = 34 087 lb*ft At R, MR = (1 .5Hc + H,)y, + moment due to wind on pole MR = [( 1.5) (1.3752) + 0.90661 (800) (12.02) + 8(83’5)2 [ ‘“‘;; + (2) (7’96)1 = 95 231 lb-ft Crossarm For strength: a 3-l/8- by 10-l/2- in laminated arm, the ultimate fiber stress S = 2000 where : W,,= ultimate vertical load, lb b = horizontal thickness of arm, in d = vertical thickness of arm, in L = length of arm to load (lever arm), in w = 2000(3.125) (10.5)2 = 870 lb or 1740 lb for a double arm V 6(132) lb/G. CHAPTER For the Allowable Example Metric Figure given conductor, distance Z.-Stress 97 shows the between analysis the vertical low force points for a 29-m structure V-ADDITIONAL outline (95-ft) and type other 1 L X 1 1 - is 1.8682 HSB data. 219 (with = 931 230-kV Using l/2-in ice). ft. structure the radial with nomenclature class 2 wood from example Vertical force with l3-mm ice - 11.79 N/m Pole Position Circumference, mm N (Ground or D or L or N or Q ’ Or ’ 718 801 983 II48 1326 radial Pr, N*m 59 82 I53 244 376 Douglas Fir Working Stress - 51.02 MPa tan QI =m sin cos Figure 97.-29-m 6.706 m L = 0.7727 u = 0.6114 a = 0.7913 u = 37O41’ type HSB 230-kV 1, OGW = 13.23 N/m 8 K M P , poles: Conductor: 403 mm,’ ASCR, 45/7 Diameter = 27 mm 0.38 - kPo wind on iced (l3-mm radial) E conductor = 20.07 N/m Vertical force with l3-mm radial ice = 27.26 N/m OGW: IO mm, H.S. Steel, 7-wire Diameter = 9 mm 0.38 - kPa wind on iced (B-mm radial) C ._- lb/ft is 1740/1.8682 F : DATA structure with class 2 Douglas fir poles (one X-brace). 104-D-1109. 778 946 41 I 634 534 220 TRANSMISSION Load in adjustable V, = H, = (20.07)(SAS/2) (27.26)(LP) braces load in nonadjustable braces EF: force in crossarm L,’ For transverse FC: = 0.5Vc/sin a = 0.8181/, = L,’ Band I- -L,,’ C and = - v,/tan D and between C: u = - 1.294& GF: in crosstie loads, 1.635V, ‘=-vc/tana=-1.294vc - LDE between L,, Vertical &/ha= ‘= L,‘= CC and L,,’ Load (11.79)(LP) Hg = (13.23)(SAS/2) I- Compressive = in crossarm: LAB Load MANUAL v- AC and LAG Compression LINE DESIGN 3 V, loads = LAG’ cos 2 Vg, are shared and a - L,,’ equally H, and Hg , a plane of inflection cos a = 0.647 V, by two poles: HJexists. The location by: x (p,B ) X0 =& +P,, Xl A plane of inflection PQalso 3.048W 778) =82946+59778 = 1 277 m * = 3.048 - 1.277 = 1.771 m =x-x, exists. Its Y (PrM 1 y” = PrR + PrM = location is found by: 12.649(153 411) 376534+153411=3*662m y1 = y - y. = 12.649 - 3.662 = 8.987 m ^ of this plane is found CHAPTER When position considered is known, wind points forces of zero on conductors the structure may be separated into parts and each part at J caused reaction dividing by the moment ‘?J UJ Taking and overhead ground wires are resisted equally by each pole moment. R, Axial 221 DATA separately. Horizontal at the of zero moment V-ADDITIONAL moments f) by arm -- R;’ = Rp” = Rd”= horizontal (pole wind - ISH, force is found - Hg by taking moments Hand about spacing). ,, _ (3H,) (1.277) + <=Q 6.706 (4.173) = 0.571H, + 1.244H, ” = - ufy B about in the pole above the plane of inflection (fig. 98), gives the Figure 98.-Free body diagram of pole above plane of inflection to the crosstie (metric example 2). force&“: and “c +“g 1.277(1.5H, FG 11-- The outside CF, carry braces, 90 percent. AC and Load L, ,, -0.9FG” --= cos a L, u --L,” - +H,)+ 2.591 EF, carry on the inner 2.896H, 10 percent braces of 1 =-0.739H, FG” and FHtr CFis: while - 1.611H, the inside CG and 0.9(-0.739H, - 1.611H,) = -0.841H, 0.7913 - 1.832H, braces, CG and TRANSMISSION 222 The load in the outer ,, _ -O.l&” The load =AG - L," = -LA; in the crossarm L,,” LB, The load AG braces = cos a -O.l(-0.739H, BC portions = l.l65H, + 1.448Hg =A, - 1.61 lH,) = O.O934H, + 0.2036H, 0.7913 cot?, a + 0.5& in the EFis: and = (-J&-G”) " =- LINE DESIGN MANUAL CD is: and - (- 0.841H, - 1.832H,) (0.79 13) + OSH,) = =CD” crossarm AB portions ” = -(LAG” and DE is: cos a + H,) = - (O.O934H, + 0.204H,) (0.79 13) - H, =- l.O74H, - O.l61H, LAB” = -L&V” The moment at MD B and D is given by: +Hg)= “=-xo(1.5Hc - 1.277(1.5H, +Hg) =- 1.915H, - 1.277Hg Nom MB 1)-MD" For the portion MK of the pole “=x1(1.5Hc between +Hg)= the planes of inflection, 1.771(1.5Hc+Hg)=2.657Hc the moment at K and L is: + 1.771H, N*m ML M-MK" The area of the pole at K and L , excluding the 23.8-mm-diameter hole for mounting the X-brace is: ??D2 - 23.80 =;(254.84)2 AK ~4 A, =A, - 23.8(254.84) = 5 1 006 - 6065 = 44 941 mm2 CHAPTER The section modulus L at K and V-ADDITIONAL is: 7TD3 23 Joe2 = $ (254.84)3 - y 32 6 ‘,= 223 DATA (254.84)2 = 1 624 810 - 257 609 = 1 367 201 mm3 The horizontal reaction in the poles P and at 1) - RP The axial reaction in the poles 3H, + 2Hg ‘Q” = up” The force “=-l.SH, -RQ Pand - Hg Q is: (12.139) + 0.571H, + 1.244H, = 6.002Hc + 4.864H, = - UQ” K at 6 . 706 at Q is: E i= b,’ L can be found -1.5 IH - K by taking moments about point M (fig. 99): H, + Hg F( E E (d Figure 99.-Free body diagram (metric example 2). E a 8 tii.- FK planes of inflection i;;--Fi’ P =- I.5 H, + Hg +Hg)+3.662WHc ” =- FK ” of pole between 6.706 FM” +Hg) 1 =- 2.715H, - 1.813H, 224 TRANSMISSION The force KN in X-braces 2.715H, + 1.813H, = -3.84OH, - 2.564H, sin 45O > 11 - - -L,,” L,, The net area A, =y A, =A, section of the LMis: and LKN” = - The pole (less the X-brace - 23.80 =%(312.80)’ modulus LINE DESIGN MANUAL at Mand mounting hole) - 23.8(312.80) at M and Nis: = 76 846 - 7445 = 69 401 mm2 N is: (312.80)3 - y (312.80)2 = 3 004 693 - 388 114 = 2 616 579 mm3 z, =z, Taking about point moments M(fig. 99): ” = -3.662(1.5H, Ml44 + Hg) = -5.493H, - 3.662H, MM 11--MN”’ By superposition, and horizontal by its respective Stress At in the point the loading total poles values of the forces and can he combined for total load factors and safety bending loading. tabulated. is: L : sL=--*-- UL ML AL ZL where : UL” = UJ” + 0.707L,,” kd U, = UL’+ULn moments The strength computed of each separately member for vertical can he divided CHAPTER ” = 0.571H,+ UL U,‘= V-ADDITIONAL 1.244H, + 0.707(3.84OH, + 2.564HJ 1.5v, + vg U, = U,’ + UL” = 1.5 V, + Vg + 3.286H, + 3.057H, A, = 44 941 mm2 ML” = 2.657H, + 1.771H, N-m Z, = 1367 201 mm3 s, + Vb + 3.286H, = 44 941 + 3.057H, mm2 + At point N: uN sN MN =A,% where : UN UN UN ” = ue” and UN = UN’ + UN” ‘= 1.5vc + v, ” = 6.002H, + 4.864H, UN = UN’+ UN ” = 1.5vc + vg + 6.002H, + 4.864H, AN = 69 401 mm2 MN ” = - 5.493H, - 3.662H, N-m zN = 2 616 579 mm3 1.5 V, + V8 + 6.002H, s, = 69 401 + 4.864H, + 225 DATA = 3.286H, + 3.057H, 226 TRANSMISSION Adjustable braces AG and EF: L AG’ = 1.635 Vc 183-m Spans, LP = 366 m LINE DESIGN MANUAL LAG" =0.0934Hc+0.2036Hg L AG=LAG'+L*G" 16 312 343.06+492.92=836 17 148 N 18 987 399.29 + 573.74 = 973 19 960 N 21750 457.38 + 657.22 = 1115 22865 N I',=9977 N 2 I ;g ; H; = 2421 N 213-m Spans, LP = 426 m V,=ll 613N V = 5 023N $= 4275N Hg= 2818N 244-m Spans, LP = 488 m V,=13303N $1 ii;;; H;= 3228N 274-m Spans, LP = 548 m 24424 513.61+ 738.05 = 1252 25 676N 27 188 571.70 + 821.53 = 1393 28 581 N 29 862 627.93 + 902.36 = 1530 31 392 N 32625 686.12 + 985.83 = 1672 34297N 35 300 742.34 + 1066.66 = 1809 37 109 N vc = 14 938 N v'= 6 461 N H,= 5 499N Hg= 3625N 305-m Spans, LP = 610 m vc = 16 629 N vg= 7192N H,= 6121N Hg= 4035 N 335-m Spans, LP = 670 m V,=18264N v-= 7 899N Hc= 6723N Hg= 4432N 366-m Spans, LP = 732 m vc = 19 954 N vg= 8630N H,= 7 346N f&= 4 842N 396-m Spans, LP = 792 m vc = 21 590 N vg= 9338N H,= 7948N f$.= 5 239N CHAPTER Adjustable braces AG and V-ADDITIONAL 227 DATA EF-Continued LaG”= 0.0934 L AG’= 1.635 Vc 427-m Spans, LP = 854 m 38 063 H, +0.2036 Hg 800.44 + 1150.14 = 1951 L &.=L/&+L*d 40 014 N v, = 23 280 N Vg=10069N ff, = 8 570N Hg = 5 649 N Nonadiustable braces Spans, m LP, m - 183 213 244 274 305 335 366 396 427 366 426 488 548 610 670 732 792 854 Crosstie GC and L& FC : = 0.818 vc, N Lee”= 0.841 8 9 10 12 13 14 16 17 19 3088.99 3595.27 4118.38 4624.66 5147.76+ 5654.04 6177.99+ 6684.27 7207.37 161 499 882 219 603 940 322 661 043 H, + 1.832 Hg, N + + + + 4 435.27 = 7 524 5 162.58 = 8 758 5 913.70 = 10 032 6 641.00 = 11 266 7392.12=12540 + 8 119.42 = 13 773 8 870.54 = 15 049 + 9 597.85 = 16 282 + 10 348.97 = 17 556 LGC = LGc) + LGc) N 15 18 20 23 26 28 31 33 36 685 257 914 485 143 713 371 943 599 GF : AB Crossarms and DE w, 366 426 488 548 610 670 732 792 854 = 0.647 Vc, LP, m N 183 213 244 274 305 335 366 396 427 366 426 488 548 610 670 732 792 854 6455 7 514 8 607 9 665 10 759 11 817 12 910 13 969 15 062 - (compressive): L &= -1.294 N m 183 213 244 274 305 335 366 396 427 L& Spans, m -12 -15 -17 -19 -21 -23 -25 -27 -30 910 027 214 330 518 634 820 937 124 vc, = -1.074 LABN -3944.80 -4591.35 -5259.38 -5905.93 -6573.95 -7220.50 -7889.60 -8536.15 -9204.18 - H, - 0.161 Hg, N 389.78 = 453.70 = 519.71 = 583.63 = 649.64 = 713.55 = 779.56.= 843.48 = 909.49 = -4 -5 -5 -6 -7 -7 -8 -9 -10 335 045 779 490 224 934 669 380 114 -17 -20 -22 -25 - -28 -31 -34 -37 -40 245 072 993 820 742 568 489 317 238 TRANSMISSION 228 BC and Crossarms spans, m - Poles LP, m LCD) = -1.294 366 426 488 548 610 670 732 792 854 -12 -15 -17 -19 -21 -23 -25 -27 -30 KN and X-braces (at point MANUAL CD (compressive): L ,,“=-l.l65H,- vc, N - 183 213 244 274 305 335 366 396 427 LINE DESIGN 1.448Hg, N 910 027 214 330 518 634 820 937 124 -4279.05 -4980.38 -5705.01-6406.34 -7130.97 -7832.30 -8558.09 -9259.42 -9984.05 - 3505.61 = -7 - 4080.46 = -9 4674.14 = -10 - 5249.00 = -11 - 5842.68 =-12 - 6417.54 = -14 - 7011.22 =-15 - 7586.07 = -16 - 8179.75 = -18 LCD = LCD’ + L&‘, N 785 061 379 655 974 250 569 845 163 -20 -24 -27 -30 -34 -37 -41 -44 -48 695 088 593 985 492 884 389 782 287 LM: Spans, m LP, m 183 213 244 274 305 335 366 396 421 366 426 488 548 610 670 732 792 854 L&l= - 3.840 H, - 2.564 Hg, N -14 104 - 6207=-20311 -164167 225 = -23 641 -18 735 - 8277r-27012 -211129295=-30407 -23505-10346=-33851 -25 816- 11364=-37180 -28209-12415=-40624 -30520-13433=-43953 -32909-14484=-47383 L ): 1.5 Vc t Vg + 3.286H, + 3.057H8 + s, = 44 941 mm* [ 183-m spans, 366-m LP s = L + 4315 + 3.286(3673) + 3.057(2421) 44 941 + 2.657(3673) + 1.771(2421) 1367.201 1 (1000) = 11 136 kPa 213-m spans, 426-m LP 613) + 5023 + 3.286(4275)+ 3.057(2818) + 2.657(4275) 44 941 + 1.771(2818) 1367.201 1 (1000) = 12 962 kPa 244-m spans, 488-m LP s L = 303) + 5754 + 3.286(4897) 44 941 + 3.057(3228) + 2.657(4897) + 1.771(3228) 1367.201 1 (1000) = 14 848 kPa CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 229 274-m spans, 548-m LP SL = c 1.5 (14 938) + 6461+ 3.286(5499) 44 941 + 3.057(3625) + 2.657(5499) + 1.771(3625) 1367.201 1 + 3.057(4035) + 2.657(6121) + 1.771(4035) 1367.201 1 + 3.057(4432) + 2.657(6723) + 1.771(4432) 1367.201 1 + 3.057(4842) + 2.657(7346) + 1.771(4842) 1367.201 1 + 3.057(5239) + 2.657(7948) + 1.771(5239) 1367.201 1 (1000) = 16 673 kPa 305-m spans, 610-m LP 629) + 7192 + 3.286(6121) 44 941 s, = (1000) = 18 559 kPa 335-m spans, 670-m LP 264) + 7899 + 3.286(6723) 44 941 (1000) = 20 385 kPa 366-m spans, 732-m LP s = (19 954) + 8630 + 3.286(7346) 44 941 L (1000) = 22 273 kPa 396-m spans, 792-m LP 590) + 9338 + 3.286(7948) 44 941 (1000) = 24 098 kPa 427-m spans, 854-m LP 280) + 10 069 + 3.286@570) 44 941 Poles (at point + 3.057(5649) + 2.657(8570) + 1.771(5649) 1367.201 1 (1000) = 25 984 kPa N): Vc + Vg' 6.002Hc+4.864Hg s,= + 69 401 183-m spans, 366-m LP s,= 1.5(9977) [ +4315 + 6.002(3673) + 4.864(2421) 69 401 + 5.493(3673) + 3.662(2421) 2616.579 1_ (1000) = 11864 kPa 2 13-m spans, 426-m LP 613) + 5023 + 6.002(4275) 69 401 + 4.864(2818) + 5.493(4275) + 3.662(2818) 2616.579 1 (1000) = 13 809 kPa TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 244-m spans, 488-m LP s _ (13 303) + 5754 + 6.002(4897) 69 401 N- + 4.864(3228) + 5.493(4897) + 3.662(3228) 2616.579 1 + 4.864(3625) + 5.493 (5499) + 3.662(3625) 2616.579 1 (1000) = 15 818 kPa 274-m spans, 548-m LP sN = 1.5 (14 938) + 6461+ 6.002(5499) 69 401 [ (1000) = 17 763 kPa 305-m spans, 610-m LP 1.5(16 629) + 7192 + 6.002(6121) 69 401 sN= + 4.864(4035) + 5.493(6121) + 3.662(4035) 2616.579 1 (1000) = 19 772 kPa 335-m spans, 670-m LP s = N 264) + 7899 f 6.002(6723) 69 401 + 4.864(4432) + 5.493(6723) + 3.662(4432) 2616.579 + 4.864(4842) + 5.493(7346) 1 (1000) = 21 716 kPa 366-m spans, 732-m LP sN= (19 954) + 8630 + 6.002(7346) + 3.662(4842) 2616.579 69 401 1 (1000) = 23 728 kPa 396-m spans, 792-m LP sN= 590) + 9338 + 6.002(7948) + 4.864(5239) + 5.493(7948) + 3.662(5239) 2616.579 69 401 1 (1000) = 25 673 kPa 427-m spans, 854-m LP sN= 280) + 10 069 + 6.002(8570) + 4.864(5649) +5.493(8570) 69 401 Table 24 shows a summary point distances. of loads in the structure + 3.662(5649) 2616.579 members 1 (1000) = 27 682 kPa for various span lengths and low CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 231 Table 24.-Summary of loads in structure members for various span lengths and low-point distances (metric example 2) SAS/Z, m 183 Member 213 244 274 305 335 366 396 421 Position LP, m Adjustable braces, N Nonadjustable braces, N Crosstie, N Crossarm (compressive), N Crossarm (compressive), N X-brace, N Pole, kPa Pole, kPa AC& CC & GF AB & BC & KN& L N EF FC DE CD LM 366 426 488 548 610 670 732 792 854 17 148 15 685 6455 17 245 20 695 20 311 11136 11864 19 960 18257 7514 20012 24088 23 641 12962 13809 22 865 20914 8607 22993 27593 27 012 14848 15818 25 676 23485 9665 25820 30985 30407 16673 11763 28 581 26143 10759 28742 34492 33 851 18559 19172 31 392 28713 11817 31568 31884 37 180 20385 21716 34 291 31371 12910 34489 41389 40 624 22213 23728 37 109 33943 13969 37317 44182 43 953 24098 25673 40 014 36599 15062 40238 48281 47 393 25984 27682 U. S. Customary Figure 100 shows the structure Load in adjustable outline and other data. V, = (1.8682)(LP) Vg = (0.8079)(LP) H, = (1.3754)(SAS/2) Hg = (0.9066)(SAS/2) braces AG and EF: )- LAG Compression ‘= V,/sina= - LEF load in crossarm: L AB’ = L,,’ Load in nonadjustable force in crossarm = LF,’ = 0.5 V,/sin a = 0.8 18 V, between )- LB, Load in crosstie = - V, /tan a = - 1.294 V, braces GC and FC : L,,’ Compressive 1.635T/, -LDC B and C and between D and C : ‘=-V,/tana=-1.294Vc GF: LGF ’ = LA,’ cos u - L,,’ cos a = 0.647Vc - 232 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Conductor: 795 kcmil, ACSR 45/ 7 Diameter = 1.063 in 8-lb/ft’ wind on iced ($-in radial) E conductor = I .3754 lb/f t Vertical force with $-in radial ice - 1.8682 I b/ft OGW: f - in, H.S. Steel, 7-wire Diameter = 0.360 in 8-lb/ft.’ wind on iced (t-in radial) OGW= 0.9066 Ib/ft Vertical force with $-in radial ice = 0.8079 lb/ft’ \ Position --- 8 or K or M or R or CCround w ton cn = y- 0 L N S Pole Circumference, in 28.26 3 1.52 Pr, lb* ft 44 100 61 059 38.69 52.19 II3 244 277 731 Douglas Fir Working stress = 7400 lb/in 2 0.7727 sin cy = 0.6114 cos a = 0.7913 a - 37041’ Figure Vertical lOO.-95-ft loads, 3 type HSB 230-kV V, and 2 Vg, structure are shared with class 2 Douglas equally by two fir poles (one X-brace). poles: 104-D-1110. CHAPTER For transverse H, loads Hg, and V-ADDITIONAL a plane of inflection DATA HJexists. 233 The location of this plane is found by: A plane PQ also of inflection exists. Its Y c&f location is found by: > 41.5 (113 244) y” =PrR +PrM= 277731+113244=12’02ft = 41.5 - 12.02 = 29.48 ft Yl =y-Yo When position of zero moment is known, considered separately. Horizontal wind forces on conductors at the points of zero moment. the and structure overhead R, N -- R;’ = &.,” = Axial dividing reaction by the at J caused moment arm by horizontal (pole spacing). may ground Rd’=- wind force be separated wires lSH, into are resisted parts equally and each part by each pole - Hg is found by taking moments about Hand u ,, _ (3H,) (4.19) + 2Hg (13.69) = O.S71H, + 1.244H, J22 Taking moments about B in the pole above the plane 4.19 (1.5H, + Hg) + 9.5H, 8.5 &“Z- of inflection 1 (fig. = -0.739H, lOl), gives the force Fen: - 1.61 lHg FF v -F,” The Ce outside carry AG braces, 90 percent. L,,” L, Load and EF, on the carry 10 percent inner braces CG Fc” and FH” and CF is: of while the inside 0.9FG u 0.9 (- 0.739H, - 1.611HJ = z= = - 0.841H, - 1.832H, 0.7913 11 - - - L,,” braces, CG and 234 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Figure lOl.-Free body diagram of pole above plane of inflection crosstie (U.S. customary example 2). The load in the outer braces ,, _ -O.l(F,“) LAG u -- L,, The load cos a in the AG = EFis: and -O.l(-0.739H, - 1.61 lHg) = O.O934H, + 0.2036H, 0.7913 - LAG” crossarm portions BC and CD is: L,c” = (-LCG”) cosa + OSH, = - (-0.841H, = l.l65H, load - 1.832H,) (0.7913) + OSH, + 1.448H, 11 - - - L,” L,, The and to the in the LAB crossarm portions AB and DE is: " = - (LAG" cos a + H,) = - (O.O934H, + 0.204H,) (0.7913) - H, = - l.O74H, - O.l61H, LAB” = - L,,” The moment at B and D is given by: MD” = - x0 (lSH, + Hg> = -6.285H, - 4.19H, lb*ft MB 1)--MD” For the portion of pole between the planes of inflection, MK ” =x1 (1.5H, +Hg) = 5.81 (1.5H, +i$) ML” = MK” the moment at K and L is: = 8.715H, + 5.81J$ lb*ft CHAPTER The area of the pole at Kand V-ADDITIONAL 235 DATA L , excluding the 15/16-inch-diameter hole for mounting the X-brace is: - 2 (10.03)= $I=;(10.03)' 79.06 - 9.40 = 69.66 in2 A, =A, The section modulus z, =g at K and L is: _ '~~y+-)03)3 - 0.15625(10.03)2 = 99.06 - 15.72 = 83.34 in3 z, = z, The horizontal reaction in the poles at Pand RP The axial reaction Qis: f’ -RQ ” = - 1.5H, - Hg in the poles at P and Q is: u Q (39.83) + 0571H,. + 1.244H, = 6.002Hc + 4.864H, ‘P” = - ‘Q ” The force at K can he found by taking Q”=- +H,)+ moments about point 12.02(1.5H, 22 +Hg) M (fig. 102): 1 = -2.715H, - 1.813H, Figure lOZ.-Free body diagram of pole between planes of inflection customary example 2). (U.S. TRANSMISSION 236 The force KN in X-braces L,” LM and LINE DESIGN MANUAL is: 2.715H, + 1.813H, =- sin 45’ _ - -3.84OH, - 2.564H, > L KN f! -- - LLM" The net area of the pole, less the AM =‘$ The section modulus at M X-brace - ED and mounting hole, at Mand N is: = 119.12 - 11.54= 107.58 in2 N is: 183.36 - 23.70 = 159.66 in3 Taking moments about MM point M(fig. 102): “=- 12.02(1.5H, +Hg)=- 18.11H, - 12.02H, MM )f -MN" By superposition, and horizontal by its respective Stress At in the point the loading total poles values of the forces and can be combined for total load factors and safety bending loading. tabulated. is: L: SL=-f- moments The UL ML AL ZL strength computed separately of each member for vertical can be divided CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA where : ” and U, = U,’ + UL” UL” = UJ” -I- 0.707L,, uL” = 0.571H, + 1.244H, + 0.707(3.84OH, U,’ = l.W, + 2.564H,) = 3.286H, + 3.057H, + vg U, = U,’ + UL” = 1.5 V, + Vg + 3.286H, I- 3.057H, A, = 69.66 in’ ML)) = 8.715H, + 5.81H, lbeft Z, = 83.34 in3 s, = 1.5& + V’ + 3.286H, f 3.057H, + 69.66 in2 N: At point where : u “=u N “adu Q N =u N ‘+u UN ’ = 1.5v, + vg UN ” = 6.002H, + 4.864H, N ” UN = UN’ + UN’) = 1.5 V, + V, + 6.002H, + 4.864H, AN = 107.58 in2 MN ” = - 18.1 lH, - 12.02H, ZN = 159.66 in3 s, = 1.5 V, + Vg + 6.002H, + 4.864H, 18.11H, + 12.02H, + 107.58 in2 159.66 in3 237 238 TRANSMISSION Adjustable braces AG and MANUAL EF: L ,& 600-ft Spans, LP = 1200 ft LINE DESIGN = 1.635 Vc L /& = O.O934H, + 0.2036Hg LAG = LllGl + LAG” 3666 77.06 + 110.76 = 188 3854 lb 4277 89.94 + 129.29 = 219 4496 lb 4887 102.74 + 147.61 = 250 5137 lb 5499 115.63 + 166.14 = 282 5781 lb 6110 128.43 + 184.67 = 313 6423 lb 6720 141.31+ 202.99 = 344 7064 lb 7331 154.11 + 221.52 = 376 7707 lb 7941 167.00 + 240.04 = 407 8348 lb 8553 179.89 + 258.37 = 438 8991 lb Vc = 2242 lb V = 9701b I$= Hg= 825 lb 544Ib 700-ft spans, LP = 1400 ft Vc = 2616 lb v =1131lb g= 9631b Hg= 6351b 800-ft Spans, LP = 1600 ft Vc = 2989 Ib V = 12931b 4 = 1100 lb 725 lb Hg= 900-ft spans, LP = 1800 ft V, = 3363 lb V = 1454 lb z$ = 1238 lb 8161b Hg= lOOO-ft Spans, LP = 2000 ft Vc = 3737 lb V =16161b 4 = 1375 lb Hg = 907 lb llOO-ft Spans, LP = 2200 ft V, = 4110 lb V = 1777 lb t( = 1513 lb Hg= 997 lb 1200-ft Spans, LP = 2400 ft Vc = 4484 lb 2: :;g; H; = 1088 lb 1300-ft Spans, LP = 2600 ft Vc = 4857 lb V = 2101 lb g = 1788 lb Hg = 1179 lb 1400-ft Spans, LP = 2800 ft Vc = 5231 lb V =2262 lb 4 = 1926 lb Hg = 1269 lb CHAPTER Nonadiustable spans, ft 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 Crosstie V-ADDITIONAL DATA 239 braces GC and FC : LP, ft L Gc’= 0.818V,, 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 1834 2140 2445 2751 3057 3362 3668 3973 4279 - LGC)) = 0.84111, + 1.832Hg, lb lb 694+ 996=1690 810+1163=1973 925 + 1328 = 2253 1041+1495=2536 1156+1661=2817 1272+1826=3098 1388+1993=3381 1504+2160=3664 1620 + 2324 = 3944 3524 4113 4698 5287 5874 6460 7049 7637 8223 GF : LP, Spans, ft 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 Crossarm =1bo.647 Vc, 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 1451 1693 1934 2176 2418 2659 2901 3142 3384 AB and DE (compressive): Spans, ft 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 Crossarm LG; ft LP, ft L&’ = -1.294yc lb 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 -2901 -3385 -3868 -4352 -4836 -5318 -5802 -6285 -6769 L/ ’ = -l.O74H, lb - ‘0.161Hg, -886 - 88 = -974 -1034-102=-1136 -1181-117 =-1298 -1330-131=-1461 -1477146=-1623 -1625-161=-1786 -1772 - 175 = -1947 -1920-190=-2110 -2069-204=-2273 LAB=kg’ +LAB: -3875 -4521 -5166 -5813 -6459 -7104 -7749 -8395 -9042 BC and CD (compressive): spans, ft LP, 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 12DO 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 ft L a’ = -1.294v,, lb -2901 -3385 -3868 -4352 -4836 -5318 -5802 -6285 -6769 L cD’ = -l.l65H, - 1.448H& lb -961788 = -1122 - 919 = -1282 - 1050 = -1442 - 1182 = -1602-1313=-2915 -1763-1444=-3207 -1922-1575=-3497 -2083-1707=-3790 -2244-1838=-4082 -1749 -2041 -2332 -2624 LCD = LC”’ ~4 -5 -6 -6 -7 -8 -9 -10 -10 + LCD: 650 426 200 976 751 525 299 075 851 240 TRANSMISSION KN X-braces LP, L &’ ft 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 (at point MANUAL LM : and Spans, ft Poles LINE DESIGN = -3.84OH, - 2.564Hg, lb 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 -3168-1395= -3698-1628= -4224-1859= -4754-2092= -5280 - 2326 = -5810-2556= -6336-2790= -6866-3023= -7396-3254=-10650 -4563 -5326 -6083 -6846 -7 606 -8366 -9126 -9889 L): 1.5 Vc + Vg + 3.286H, + 3.057Hg SL = + ~‘715;;;‘8’Hf)(!?) = lb/i,,2 69.66 600-ft spans, 1200-ft s, = LP 1.5 (2242) + 970 + 3.286(825) + 3.057 (544) + = 1615 lb/in2 69.66 700-ft spans, 1400-ft LP 1.5(2616)+ s, = 1131 + 3.286(963) + 3.057(635) 69.66 + = 1886 lb/in2 800-ft spans, 1600-ft LP SL = 1.5 (2989) + 1293 + 3.286(1100) + 3.057 (725). + 69.66 8.715(1100) + 83.34 900-ft spans, 1800-ft LP SL = 1.5(3363) + 1454 + 3.286(1238) + 3.057(816) 69.66 + = 2424 lb/in2 lOOO-ft spans, 2000-ft LP s, = 1.5(3737) + 1616 + 3.286(1375) + 3.057(907) 69.66 + = 2693 lb/in2 1 lOO-ft spans, 2200-ft LP s = 1.5(4110) L + 1777 + 3.286(1513) 69.66 + 3.057(997)+ 8.715(1513) +5.81(997) 83.34 12 >( -i > = 2961 lb/i2 CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 241 1200-ft spans, 2400-ft LP SL = 1.5(4484) + 1939 + 3.286(1650) + 3.057(1088) + = 3231 lb/in2 69.66 1300-ft spans, 2600-ft LP sL= 1.5 (4857) + 2101 + 3.286(1788) + 3.057(1179) +, 69.66 8.715 + 12 (1788) 5.81(1179) )( > = 3501 lb/i2 83.34 r 1400-ft spans, 2800-ft LP 1.5(5231) + 2262 + 3.286(1926) s, = Poles (at + 3.057(1269)+ 69.66 point 1.5 V;' N): Vg+ 6.002H, +4.865Hg sN= + 107.58 = lb/in’ 600-ft spans, 1200-ft LP sN= 1.5(2242)+ 970 + 6.002(825)+4.865(544)+ 18.11(825) + 12.02(544) 12 = 1725 lb/in2 159.66 x -i- > 107.58 700-ft spans, 1400-ft LP t$,,= 1.5(2616) + 1131 + 6.002(963) + 4.865(635) + = 2013 lb/in2 107.58 800-ft spans, 1600-ft LP s,= 1.5(2989) + 1293 + 6.002(1100) 107.58 + 4.865(725)+ 18.11(1100) + 12.02(725) 12 159.66 x T 1 = 2300 lb/in2 900-ft spans, 1800-ft LP s,= 1.5(3363) + 1454 + 6.002(1238) + 4.865 (816) 107.58 + 18.11(1238) + 12.02(816) 159.66 12 x> 1 = 2589 lb/i2 lOOO-ft spans, 2000-ft LP sN= 1.5(3737)+ 1616 + 6.002(1375)+4.865(907)+, 107.58 = 2876 lb/in’ 242 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 1 lOO-ft spans, 2200-ft LP s,= 1.5(4110)+ 1200-ft spans, lS(4484) sN= 1777 + 6.002(1513)+4.865(997) 107.58 18.11(1513) + + 12.02(997) 12 159.66 >( 1 > = 3163 lb/in* 2400-ft LP + 1939 + 6.002(1650) + 4.865(1088)+ = 345 1 lb/in* 107.58 1300-ft spans, 2600-ft LP 1.5 (4857) + 2101+ s,= 6.002 (1788) + 4.865 (1179) + 18.11(1788) 107.58 + 12 12.02(1179) >( > = 3739 lb/in* 159.66 r 1400-ft spans, 2800-ft LP lS(5231) sN= Table point + 2262 + 6.002(1926) 18.11(1926) + 4.865(1269)+ 107.58 25 shows a summary + 12.02(1269) 159.66 of loads in the structure members 12 )( r > for various = 4027 lb/in* span lengths and low distances. Table 25.~Summary of loads in structure members for various spans lengths and low-point distances (U.S. customary example 2) SAS/Z, ft Member Position 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 2 400 2 600 2 800 8 348 7 637 3 142 8 395 10 075 9 889 3 501 3 739 8 991 8 223 3 384 9 042 10 851 10 650 3 770 4 027 LP, ft 1200 AG&EF GC&FC GF AB&DE BC&CD KN&LM L N Adjustable braces, lb Nonadjustable braces, lb Crosstie, lb Crossann (compressive), lb Crossarm (compressive), lb X-brace, lb Pole, lb/in* Pole, lb/in* Example and double 3.-Stress analysis 1400 3854 3524 1451 3 875 4650 4 563 1 615 1725 4496 4113 1693 4521 5426 5 326 1 886 2013 for a 29-m (95-ft) 1600 1800 5137 4 698 1934 5166 6 200 6083 2 154 2300 type 5781 5 287 2 176 5813 6 976 6 846 2424 2589 HSB 2000 2 200 6423 5 874 2418 6459 7751 7 606 2 693 2876 7064 6 460 2659 7 104 8525 8 366 2961 3 163 230-kV structure -- 7 707 7 049 2 901 7 749 9 299 9 126 3 231 3451 with class 1 wood poles X-brace: Metric Figure 103 shows the structure outline and other data. Using the nomenclature from example 1, CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 243 Conductor: 403 mm : ACSR, 45/7 27 mm 0.38-kPo wind on iced (l3-mm radial) conductor - 20.07 N/m Vertical force with l3-mm radial ice 27.26 N/m OGW: IO mm, H.S. Steel, 7-wire Diometer - 9 mm 0.38- kPo wind on iced (l3-mm radial) OGW= 13.23 N/m Vertical force with l3-mm radial ice II.79 N/m DiOmeter: I--- 1 1 Pole Circumference, mm Position 8 or K or M or R or Pr, N*m 771 857 1247 1401 13 L N s 74 208 IO1 754 312 751 444 314 Douglas Fir Working Stress - 51.02 MPa 6,706m tan - +j& = 0.7727 sin a - 0.6114 cos a - 0.7913 a - 37O41’ Figure 103.-29-m type HSB 230.kV V, = H, = Load in adjustable braces structure (27.26)(LP) vg (20.07)(SAS/2) Hg = AC and load = fir poles (two X-braces). (11.79)(LP) (13.23)(SAS/2) EF: LAG’ = L,’ Compression with class 1 Douglas = V,/sin a = 1.635Vc in crossarm: )- LAB - L,’ = - Vc/tan a = - 1.294Vc 104-D-1 111. 244 TRANSMISSION Load in nonadjustable braces Compressive force in crossarm between I- - L, loads U,’ For 3 V, and = U,’ transverse B and C and ‘=-V,/tana ‘=L,, D between and C : =-1.294V, GF: in crosstie Vertical = 0.5 V,/sin a = 0.8 18 V, = L,’ LBC Load FC: CC and L,,’ LINE DESIGN MANUAL COS 2 Vg are shared = UK’ loads L,,’ H, = u, equally ’ = U,’ Hg , a and a - L,,’ = UN’ plane a = 0.647Y, COS by two = Up’ of inflection poles: = Ue’ = u, ’ = Us’ HJexists. The = 1.5 v, location + vg of this plane parts and is found by: X(PrB) 3.048(74 208) +P,B = 101 754+74208 xo =& Xl A plane exists. Its location Y C&M 1 considered moment Axial 444314+312751 is known, points wind forces of zero ’ the structure may be separated into each part on conductors reaction by the and overhead ground wires are resisted equally by each pole moment: RI;’ dividing = 2 266 m separately. Horizontal at the of zero by: = 5.486 - 2.266 = 3.220 m Yl =y-Yo position is found 5.486(312 751) y” =PpR +PrM= When ’ = 3.048 - 1.285 = 1.763 m =x-x, PQ also of inflection = 1 285 m at Jcaused moment ‘J UJ” arm by (pole CR, f) --R/z horizontal Rd’=-1.5H,-H, wind force is found by ,, _ (3H,) (1.285) + Cur,> (4.181) = 0.575H, 6.706 = q/ taking moments spacing): + 1.247H, about Hand CHAPTER Taking moments B about in the pole V-ADDITIONAL above the plane DATA 245 of inflection (fig. 104) gives force &“: Figure 104.-Free body diagram of pole above plane of inflection and to the crosstie (metric example 3). -F/ -1.5 Hc + Hg 1.285(1.5H, FG8)--- +I$)+ 1 2.896H, _ - -0.744H, 2.591 [ - 1.614H, FF” = FG” The outside ( fi’ . carry carry on the FGRand FH” CF is: 10 percent of braces CG and inner cos a L,, load EF, and Load ,, _ 0.9FG" 0.9(-0.744H, --= L, The AG braces, 90 percent. - 1.614H,) 0.7913 while the inside braces, =-0.846H, - 1.836H, --L," 8) - in the outer L*(y= braces -O.lF&’ cos a AG = and EFis: -O.l(-0.744H, - 1.614H,) = O.O94OH,+0.204H, 0.7913 L,, e --L,," The load in the crossarm LBc)) =(-L,") = l.l69H, LBC II - -- LCD” portions BC and CD is: cos.a + O.SH, =-(-0.846H, + 1.453H, - 1.836H,)(O.7913)+ O.SH, CG and 246 The load in the crossarm TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL portions DE AB and is: LAB " = -(LAG ” cos a + H,) = - (O.O94H, + 0.204H,) L, The (0.7913) -H, = - - O.l61H, l.O74H, rt -- -L& moment B at D is and given by: MD “=-xo(l.5Hc +Hg) = - 1.928H, - 1.285H, N-m MB” = MD” For the portion of pole between the MK ” =x1 (lSH, planes of inflection, the moment at K and L is: + Hg) = 2.645H, + 1.763H, Nom ML” = MK” The area of the pole at K and L, excluding the 23.8.mm-diameter hole for mounting the X-brace is: AK=x- nD2 23.80 =a (272.8)2 - 23.8(272.8) = 58 449 - 6493 = 51 956 mm2 A, =A, The section zK=x- modulus at K and L is: 71D3 23.8D2 = 5 (272.8)3 (j _ 23’8(;72’8)2 = 1993 118- 295 198= 1 697920mm3 z, =z, The horizontal reaction in the poles RP The axial reaction ‘Q” = UP in the poles at P and Q is: 11 - -RQ ” = - 1 .5Hc - Hg at P and Q is: 3H, + 2Hg (17.898) + 0.575H, + 1.247H, = 8.581H, + 6.585H, 6.706 ” = - UQ" The force at K can he found CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL by moments +H taking 247 DATA about point M (fig. 105): 9 F lgure 105.-Free body diagram of pole between (metric example 3). +H Q 15.632(1.5H, " =- FK planes of inflection +I$)+ 2.266(1.5& +Hg) 1 = - 4.003H, - 2.669H, 6.706 FK u --FM” Since the the division installation, VN, WM and of load assume L,, net area A,=4A, The all load X-braces KUand is taken by LTand one X-braces set of braces. The VNand force WMdepends in X-braces of the nD2 4.003H, + 2.669Hg Of- -- sin 45O M- - L,, pole (less M- L,” the X-brace = -5.662H, - 3.775H, ) = -L,,” mounting hole) 23.80 = 2 (396.80)2 - 23.8(396.80) at Mand N is: = 123 661- 9444 = 114 217 mm2 =A, section modulus nD3 ZM=F- at Mand N is: 23.8D2 6 = & (396.80)3 - ‘9 = 5 509 039 mm3 z, upon KU, LT, is: =KU The between that = z, (396.80)2 = 6 133 592 -- 624 553 TRANSMISSION 248 Taking about point moments u MA4 the By superposition, and horizontal loading by its respective Stress At in the point total poles M(fig. - - - 2.266 values LINE DESIGN 105): (1 .5Hc + HE) = - 3.399H, - 2.266H, of the forces and can be combined for total load factors and safety MANUAL bending moments loading. The strength computed of each separately member for tabulated. is: L : SL =- UL +- AL ML ZL where : UL” = UJ” + 0.707LL,” UL and UL = UL’ + UL” ” = 0.575H, + 1.247H, + 0.707 (5.662H, + 3.775H,) = 4.578H, + 3.9 16Hg U,’ = 1.5v, + vg u, = U,’ + UL” = 1.5V, + Vg + 4.578H, + 3.916H, A, =51 956mm’ ML” = 2.645H, + 1.763H, N-m Z, = 1 697 920 mm3 s lSV, L At point + Vg +4.578H, 51 956 mm* + 3.916H, + N: ‘N SN=ANfZN MN vertical can be divided CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 249 where : UN” = Ue” and UN = UN’ + UN” U,‘= 1.5vc + vg UN” = 8.58lH, + 6.585H, UN = UN) + UN)) = 1.5 v, + vg + 8.581H, + 6.585H, A, = 114217mm2 MN ” = - 3.399H, - 2.266H, zN = 5 509 039 + vg + 8.581H, + 6.585H, 114 217 mm2 s, = Adiustable mm3 braces AG and 1000,,,,,, + 3.399Hc+2.266Hg 5 509039 mm3 ) ()](lOO~zmm’) El;: L AG’ = 1.635V, 183-m Spans, LP = 366 m + 1000 = kPa LA/' O.O94OH,+0.204H, LAG=LAG'+LAGA 16 312 345.26+493.88= 839 17 151 N 18 987 401.85 + 574.87 = 977 19 964 N 21 750 460.32 + 658.51= 22869N 24424 516.91+ V,=9977N V =4315N 4~3673~ iTI"= N 213-m Spans, LP = 426 m V,= 11 613N V = 5023N d= 4275N Hg= 2818N 244-m Spans, LP = 488 m 1119 V,=13303N 2: ii;;; H;= 3228N 274-m Spans, LP = 548 m Vc= 14938N v- 6461 N f(= 5499N Hg= 3625N 739.50 = 1256 - 25680N 250 TRANSMISSION Adjustable braces AG and LINE DESIGN MANUAL IS-Continued LAG’ = 1.635 Vc 305-m Spans, LP = 610 m LAG))= O.O94OH,+0.204Hg LAG=L*Gt+L*G) 27 188 575.37 + 823.14 = 1399 28587N 29862 631.96 + 904.13 = 1536 31 398 N 32625 690.52 + 987.77 = 1678 34 303N 35 300 747.11+ 1068.76 = 1816 37 116 N 38063 805.58+ 1152.40 = 1958 40 021 N V,=16629N V = 7 192 N $= 6121N Hg= 4035N 335-m Spans, LP = 670 m V,=18264N V = 7899N l(= 6723N I+= 4432N 366-m Spans, LP = 732 m F= = 1gg54N 8630N l(= 7346N Hg= 4842N 396-m Spans, LP = 792 m V,=21590N V = 9338N ig= 7948N fig= 5239N 427-m Spans, LP = 854 m V,=23280N V = 10 069 N f(= 8570N Hg= 5649N Nonadjustable spans, m 183 213 244 274 305 335 366 396 427 braces LP, m 366 426 488 548 610 670 732 792 854 GC and FC : Lee' = O.S18V,, N N 8 161 9 10 12 13 14 16 17 19 L Gc"= 0.846H,+ 1.836Hg, 499 882 219 603 940 322 661 043 3107 + 4 445 = 7 552 3617+ 5174= 8791 4128+ 5927=10055 4652+ 6656=11308 5178+ 7408=12586 5688+ 8137=13825 6215 + 8 890 = 15 105 6724+ 9619=16343 7250+10372=17622 LGC = L& + L& 15 713 18 290 20937 23572 26 189 28765 31427 34004 36665 CHAPTER Crosstie V-ADDITIONAL DATA 251 GF : spans, m LP, m - 183 213 366 426 488 548 610 670 732 192 854 244 214 305 335 366 396 421 Crossarm 183 213 LP, m - 11 12 13 15 817 910 969 062 L m” = -l.O74H, - O.l61H& N -12 910 -3945-390= -4335 -15 021 -4591-454= -5045 -17 214 -5259-520= -5906-584= -6574-650= -1221-114= -1890-780= -8536-843= -5 719 -6490 -7224 -7935 -8670 -9319 -19 330 -21518 -23634 -25 820 -21937 -30124 -9204-909=-10113 LAB = LAB’ + LAB” -. N ’ -17245 -20012 -22993 -25 820 -28142 -31569 -34490 -31316 -40231 BC and CD (compressive): spans, m LP, m - 183 366 426 488 548 610 610 132 792 854 244 274 305 335 366 396 427 LAB’ = -1.294 vc, N 366 426 488 548 610 670 732 192 854 244 214 305 335 366 396 421 213 6455 1514 8607 9665 10 159 AB and DE (compressive): spans, m Crossarm L ,;=0.64lv,, N L& = -1.294 vc, N -12 910 -15 027 L &= -l.l69H, - 1.453Hg, N -4294-3518= -4991-40951 -1812 -9092 -5725-4690=-10415 -6428-5267=-11695 -7155-5863=-13018 -7859-6440=-14299 -8587-7035=-15622 -9291-7612=-16903 -10018-8208=-18226 -17 214 -19 330 -21518 -23634 -25 820 -21937 -30124 X-brace: spans, m 183 213 244 214 305 335 366 396 427 m, L,;=-5.662#- 366 426 488 548 610 670 132 192 854 -207969139=-29935 -24205-10638=-34843 -27721-12186=-39913 -31 135 - 13 684 = -44 819 -34 651- 15 232 = -49 889 -38066-16731=-54191 -41593-18219=-59812 3.175Hg, -m -45002-19171=-64779 -48523-21325=-69848 LCD = ‘SD’ + LCD: -20722 -24 119 -21629 -31025 -34536 -37933 -41442 -44 840 -48350 252 TRANSMISSION Poles (at point L): 1.5 Vc + Vg + 4.578H, s, LINE DESIGN MANUAL + 3.916Hg = + 51956 mm2 183-m spans, 366-m LP s = 1.5(9977) + 4315 + 4.578(3673) L + 3.916(2421)+ 2.645(3673) + 1.763(2421) (1000) = 9113 kPa 1697.92 51 956 I 2 13-m spans, 426-m LP SL = C 1.5(11 613) + 5023 + 4.578(4275) 51956 + 3.916(2818) + 2.645(4275) 1 + 1.763(2818) (1000) = 10 607 kPa 1697.92 244-m spans, 488-m LP s = L 1.5 (13 303) + 5754 + 4.578(4897) 51956 + 3.916(3228) + 2.645 (4897) + 1.763 (3228) 1697.92 1 (1000) = 12 150 kPa 274-m spans, 548-m LP s = L 1.5(14 938) + 6461 + 4.578(5499) 51956 + 3.916(3625)+2.645(5499) + 1.763(3625) 1697.92 1 (1000) = 13 644 kPa 305-m spans, 610-m LP s L 4.578(6121) = + 3.916(4035) 51956 + 2.645(6121) + 1.763(4035) 1697.92 1 (1000) = 15 187 kPa 335-m spans, 670-m LP s = 1.5(18 264) + 7899 + 4.578(6723) L + 3.916(4432) 51956 + 2.645 (6723) + 1.763(4432) 1697.92 1 + 2.645 (7346) + 1.763(4842) 1697.92 1 (1000) = 16 681 kPa 366-m spans, 732-m LP (19 954) + 8630 + 4.578(7346) 51956 + 3.916(4842) (1000) = 18 225 kPa 396-m spans, 792-m LP SL = 1.5 (21 590) + 9338 + 4.578(7948) 51’956 + 3.916(5239) + 2.645(7948) + 1.763(5239) 1697.92 1 (1000) = 19 719 kPa CHAPTER 427-m spans, 854-m l’oles .- (at point 253 + 3.916(5649) + 2.645 (8570) + 1.763(5649) 1697.92 1 (1000) = 21262 kPa N): I .5 V, + Vg + 8.581H, + 6.585Hg &TN= 3.399H, + 2.266Hg + [ DATA LP (23 280) + 10 069 + 4.578(8570) 51956 s, = V-ADDITIONAL 114 217 nun2 5 509 039 mm3 1ooo mm )(~](looo~~m2) +lOOO= kPa 183-m spans, 366-m LP S,= 1.5(9977) + 4315 + 8.581(3673) 114 217 + 6.585(2421) + 3.399(3673) + 2.266(2421) 5509.039 1 (1000) = 3846 kPa 213-m spans, 426-m LP S,= 1.5(11 613) + 5023 + 8.581(4275) 114 217 + 6.585(2818) + 3.399(4275) + 2.266(2818) 5509.039 1 (1000) = 4477 kPa 244-m spans, 488-m LP sN= 1.5 (13 303) + 5754 + 8.581(4897) + 6.585(3228) + 3.399(4897) + 2.266(3228) 1 (1000) = 5128 kPa 114 217 5509.039 274-m spans, 548-m LP shl= 1.5(14 938) + 6461 + 8.581(5499) 114 217 + 6.585(3625) + 3.399(5499) + 2.266(3625) 5509.039 1 (1000) = 5759 kPa 305-m spans, 610-m LP slv= 1.5 (16 629) + 7192 + 8.581(6121) 114 217 + 6.585 (4035) + 3.399(6121) + 2.266(4035) 1 (1000) = 6410 kPa 5509.039 335-m spans, 670-m LP s,= 1.5(18 264) + 7899 + 8.581(6723) 114 217 + 3.399(6723) + 2.266(4432) 5509.039 1 + 6.585 (4842) + 3.399(7346) + 2.266(4842) 5509.039 1 + 6.585(4432) (iOO0) = 7040 kPa 366-m spans, 732-m LP SN’ 1.5(19 954) + 8630 + 8.581(7346) 114 217 (1000) = 7693 kPa 254 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 396-m spans, 792-m LP (21 590) + 9338 + 8.581(7948) S,= + 6.585 (5239) + 3.399(7948) + 2.266(5239) 5509.039 114 217 1 (1000) = 8323 kPa 427-m spans, 854-m LP 1.5 (23 280) + 10 069 + 8.581(8570) 114 217 SN’ Table point 26 shows a summary of loads + 6.585 (5649) + 3.399(8570) + 2.266(5649) 5509.039 in the structure members for various 1 (1000) = 8974 kPa span lengths and low distances. 26.~Summary of loads in structure members for various span lengths and low-point distances (metric example 3) Table SAS/Z, m 213 183 Member 244 274 335 366 396 427 670 732 792 854 34303 31427 12910 34 490 41442 59872 18225 7 693 37116 34004 13969 37 316 44840 64779 19719 8 323 40021 36665 15062 40 237 48350 69848 21262 8 974 LP, m Position Adjustable braces, N Nonadjustable braces, N Crosstie, N Crossarm (compressive), N Crossarm (compressive), N X-brace, N Pole, kPa Pole, kPa 305 AG&EF GC&FC %&DE BC & CD KN&LM L N 366 426 488 548 610 17151 15 713 6 455 17 245 20722 29935 9113 3 846 19964 18 290 22869 20937 8 607 22 993 27629 39913 12150 5 128 25680 23572 9665 25 820 31025 44819 13644 5 759 28587 26 189 10759 28 742 34536 49889 15187 6 410 2: iii 24119 34843 10607 4 477 31398 28765 11817 31569 37933 54797 16681 7040 U. S. Customary Figure Load 106 shows in adjustable the structure outline and other data. V, = (1.8682)(LP) Vg = (0.8079)(LP) H, = (1.3754)(SAS/2) Hg = (0.9066)(SAS/2) braces AG and EF: LAG’ = LEF) = &/sin a = 1.635Vc Compression load in crossarm: tLAB Load in nonadjustable braces - LDE CC and L,.’ = L,’ ‘=- K/tana=-1.294V, FC: = 0.5 V, /sin a = 0.8 18 V, CHAPTER L V-ADDITIONAL Conductor: 759 kcmii, ACSR, 45/7 Diameter - 1.063 in 8- lb/f t ’ wind on iced (+-in radial) conductor - I.3754 lb/ft Vertical force with i-in radial ice - 1.8682 Ib/ft oGw:i-in, H.S. steel, 7-wire Diameter - 0.360 in 8-Ib/ft’ wind on iced (i-in radial) OGW- 0.9066 lb/f t Vertical force with t-in radial ice = 0.8079 Ib/ft I x X 1 255 DATA I Position Pole Circumference, in 8 or D KWL 30.37 33.74 M or 49.08 N ROTS Pr, Ib=ft 54 75 230 328 55. I5 730 047 976 655 Douglas Fir Working stress = 7400 lb/in* . tan a - v sin a - cos a = 0.7913 - 0.7727 37O 41’ 106.-95-ft Compressive I 0.6114 a Figure 22 ft type HSB 230.kV structure force in crossarm between LBC Load in crosstie ‘=L,, with class 1 Douglas B and ‘=- fir poles (two X-braces). C and between V,/tana=-1.294 D and C : V, GF: LcF) = LAG’ 00s a - L,,’ cos a = 0.647 V, 104-D-1112. 256 TRANSMISSION Vertical loads 3 &I ’ = For transverse V, u; and 2 Vg are = UK’ = u,’ H, loads shared equally by = (j-,’ = UN’ = (J,’ Hg, and LINE DESIGN a plane two MANUAL poles: = Ue’ of inflection = U,’ HJexists. = Us’ = 1.5 v, The location + vg of this plane parts and is found by: x (prB1 lO(54 xo =PrK +-Prs = Xl =x-x() A plane of inflection PQ also 75 047 = lo- exists. Its When position considered Horizontal at the of zero separately. wind forces points of zero - Y, moment Axial is known, on conductors J reaction at by the moment moments = 4*22 ft 655 - 7.43 by: 976) + 230 976 = 10.57 ft the structure and overhead may ground = 7’43 ft be separated wires into are resisted equally each part by each pole moment: caused arm about B &“=m Rd’=R$=-l.SH,- by horizontal (pole u ,, = (3H,) J Taking 328 = 18.0 Rt;‘=R;= dividing is found 18(230 Y(PrM) =Y + 54 730 4.22=5.78ft location y” =PrR +PrM = Yl 730) (4.22) + (*H,) is found (13.77) 22 pole (1 above the plane .5Hc + Hg) + 9.5H, 8.5 FF u -- FG” force by taking moments about 107) force Hand spacing): in the 4.22 wind Hg I = 0.575H, + 1.252H, of inflection (fig. = - 0.745H, - 1.614H, gives Fc”: CHAPTER -0 4 1 -In a6 The CF, HC+Hg AG and E& braces, Load 90 percent. LCG load in the load LB,” L, The load braces, of F, CG and ” and CF, FH” while the inside braces, is: - 1.6 14H,) = - 0.847H, - 1.836H, 0.7913 - LCG” outer - in the 10 percent 0.9 (- 0.745H, = AG braces ,, _- 0. I&” The inner cos a LAG L,y, carry on the 0.9FG” rr=- L CF 1)-The 257 Figure 107.-Free body diagram of pole above plane of inflection and to the crosstie (U.S. customary example 3). Fe” -I.5 outside carry DATA ;n#? 9 - -z dI V-ADDITIONAL -0.1 COSa and EF is: (-0.745H, = - 1.614H,) = 0.0941Hc 0.7913 0.204H, + M - - - LAG” crossarm BC portions and CD is: = (-a&“) cos a + 0.5H, = - (- 0.847H, - = l.l7OH, + 1.453H, 1.836H,) (0.79 13) + 0.204H,) (0.7913)- OSH, rt - - - L,” in the LAB crossarm portions ” =- (LAG” = - l.O74H, LABu -- L,,” cos AB and a + H,) = - - O.l61H, DE is: (O.O941H, + H, CG and TRANSMISSION 258 The moment B at D and is given For the portion of pole MANUAL by: MD ” = - x,, (1 SH, MB” LINE DESIGN + I$) = - 6.33H, - 4.22H, lb* ft = MD” hetween the planes of inflection, the moment at K and “=x,(1.5Hc+Hg)=5.78(1.5Hc+Hg)=8.67Hc+5.78Hg MK L is: lb.0 ML” = MK” The area of the pole L at Kand , excluding the 15/16-inch-diameter hole for mounting the X-brace is: .rrD2 A,=TAL The ‘K section = =t (10.74)2 - E (10.74) = 90.59 - 10.07 = 80.52 in2 =A, modulus TD3 -32 15 ED at K 15D2/16 6 L and is: = &(10.74)3 - 0.15625(10.74)2 = 121.62- 18.02 = 103.6in3 z, =z, The horizontal reaction in the poles P at and Q is: Rp” = Rp” = - 1.5Hc - Hg The axial reaction in the poles u*” = (34;2fJ at P and Q is: g ) (58.71) + 0.575H, + 1.252Hg = 8.581H, + 6.589Hg ‘P” = - ‘Q ” The force at FK FK K can be found ”=- by 51.28(1.5H, ” = - F,” taking moments about +Hg> + 7.43(1.5H, 22 point +Hg) M (fig. 1 108): = -4.003H, - 2.669H, CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 259 Figure 108.-Free body diagram of pole between (U.S. customary example 3). Since the division installation, assume of load that between all load X-braces is taken KUand LTand by one set of braces. X-braces The planes of inflection VNand force WMdepends in X-braces KU, upon LT, VN, WMis: and 4.003H, + 2.669H, II LKU -L KU ” = The net area of the pole The section > n -- - LWM” X-brace = $(1~62)~ = - 5.662H, - 3.775H, mounting - E (15.62) hole) at Mand = 191.62 - N is: 14.64 = 176.88 = 373.48 - 38.21 in2 =A, modulus nD3 at Mand 15D2 /16 6 ‘hf=x- Taking w -L, - LLT (less the ED A, sin 4S” ( moments about N is: - 0.15625(15.62)2 = 0.098(15.62)3 point MM“=- M (fig. 7.43(1.5H, MM n --MN” 108): +Hg)=- ll.l4H, - 7.43H, - = 335.36 in3 260 TRANSMISSION By superposition, and horizontal by its respective Stress At the loading total in the poles values of the LINE DESIGN MANUAL forces and can be combined for total load factors and safety bending moments loading. The strength computed of each separately member for vertic:tl can be divicl~~ll tabulated. is: L: point s, =- UL &-ML AL ZL where : UL )) = UJ” + 0.707L,," and UL = UL' + UL" UL" = O.S75H, + 1.252H, +0.707(5.662H, +3.775H,)= U,’ = l.SV, + vg U, = UL'+ UL" = 1.5Vc + Vg + 4.578H, + 3.921H, A, = 80.52 in2 ML" = 8.67H, + 5.78H, lb*ft ZL = 103.60 in3 s, = = Poles (at (%;LuL” +(~)(ni) 1.5Vc + VK + 4.578H, + 3.921H, + 80.52 in2 point N): ‘N SN=ANfZN where : UN “= UQ" and UN = UN'+ UN" MN 4.578H, + 3.921H, CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 261 UN’ = 1.5vc + vg UN” = 8.581H, + 6.589H, UN = UN’ + UNf’ = 1.5 V, + Vg + 8.58 lH, + 6.589H, AN = 176.98 in2 MN “=-1l.l4H, - 7.43H, ZN = 335.36 in3 s, = Adjustable 1.5V, + V’ + 8.581H, + 6.589H, braces 176.98 in2 AC and 600-ft Spans, LP = 1200 ft + 11.14Hc + 7.43Hg 335.36 in3 EF: L AG' = 1.635V, LAGn = O.O94OH,+ 0.204Hg LAG = LAG' + LA/ 3666 77.63 + 110.98 = 189 3855 lb 4277 90.62 + 129.54= 220 4497 lb 4881 103.51+ 147.90 = 251 5138 lb 5499 116.50 + 166.46 = 283 5782 lb 6110 129.39 + 185.03 = 315 6425 lb Vc = 2242 lb V = 9701b f( = 825 lb Hg= 544Ib 700-ft Spans, LP = 1400 ft V, = 2616 lb V = 11311b g= 9631b Hg= 635 lb 800-ft Spans, LP = 1600 ft V, = 2989 lb V = 12931b l$=llOOlb Hg = 725 lb 900-ft Spans, LP = 1800 ft Vc = 3363 lb v I( = 1454 lb = 1238 lb Hg= 8161b lOOO-ft Spans, LP = 2000 ft vc = 3737 lb v = 1616 lb g=1375lb Hg= 907 lb 262 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Adjustable braces AG and E&Continued ’ + LAG” L AG’ = 1.635 V, LAG” = O.O94OH, + 0.204Hg 6720 142.37 + 203.39 = 346 7066 lb 7331 155.27 + 221.95 = 377 7708 lb 1300-ft Spans, LP = 2600 ft 7924 168.25 + 240.43 = 409 8351 lb 1400-ft Spans, LP = 2800 ft 8553 181.20 + 258.92 = 440 8993 lb 1100-ft Spans, LP = 2200 ft LAG = LAG Vc = 4110 lb v = 1777lb 4=15131b Hg = 997 lb 1200-ft Spans, LP = 2400 ft Vc = 4484 lb 2 : ;g ; H; = 1088 lb Vc = 5231 lb V = 2262 lb I$ = 1926 lb Hg = 1269 lb Nonadiustable Spa% ft 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 Crosstie braces GC and FC : LP, ft L Gc’= 0.818V,, lb lb 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 1834 2140 2445 2751 3057 3362 3668 3973 4279 699 + 999 = 1698 816+ 1165 = 1981 932+1332=2264 1049 + 1498 = 2547 1165 + 1665 = 2830 1282+1831=3113 1398+1998=3396 1515+2164=3679 1631+2330=3961 - L cc” = 0.847H, + 1.836Hg, GF : Spans, ft LP, 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 ft L ‘$ = 0.647 Vc, lb 1451 1693 1934 2176 2418 2659 2901 3142 3384 3532 4121 4709 5298 5887 6475 7064 7652 8240 CHAPTER AB Crossarm and DE LP, ft L AB’ = -1.294Vc, lb 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 -2901 -3385 -3868 -4352 -4836 -5318 -5802 -6285 -6769 BC and 263 DATA (compressive): Spans, ft Crossarm V-ADDITIONAL L ABn = -l.O74H, lb - 0.161Hg, -88688= -974 -1034-102=-1136 -1181-117=-1298 -1330-131=-1461 -1477-146=-1623 -1625-161=-1786 -1772-175=-1947 -1920-190=-2110 -2069-204=-2273 -3875 -4521 -5166 -5813 -6459 -7104 -7749 -8395 -9042 CD (compressive): spans, ft LP, ft L cD’= -1.294Vc, lb 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 -2901 -3385 -3868 -4352 -4836 -5318 -5802 -6285 -6769 L &= -l.l7OH, lb - 1.453H 8. -966791=-1757 -1127922=-2049 -1287-1054=-2341 -1448 - 1186 = -2634 -1609-1317=-2926 -1770-1449=-3219 -1931-1581=-3512 -2092-1713=-3805 -2253-1844=-4097 L CD = “7” -4 -5 -6 -6 -7 -8 -9 -10 -10 + bD: 658 434 209 986 762 537 314 090 866 X-brace: Poles (at point spans, ft LP, 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 ft L KG = -5.662Hc lb - 3.775Hg, -4673-2054= -6727 -5451-2396= -7847 -6230-2738= -8968 -7009-3080=-10089 -7788-3422=-11210 -8566-3765=-12331 -9345-41Oi=-13452 -10124-4449=-14573 -10903-4791=-15694 L): 1.5 V, + Vg + 4.578Hc + 3.921Hg SL = 80.52 ina 600-ft spans, 1200-ft LP s, = 1.5(2242) + 970 + 4.578(825) 80.52 + 3.921(544) + = 1320 lb/in2 264 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 700-ft spans, 1400-ft LP 1.5(2616)+ S,= 1131+4.578(963) + 3.921(635) + = 1541 lb/in2 8052 800-ft spans, 1600-ft LP SL = 1.5(2989)+ 1293+4.578(1100) + 3.921(725) + 8.67(1100) 80.52 + 5.78(725) 103.60 12 >( T = 1760 lb/in2 > 900-ft spans, 1800-ft LP SL = 1.5(3363) + 1454 + 4.578(1238) + 3.921(816) + 8.67(1238) 80.52 + 5.78(816) 103.60 12 I( -7 > = 1980 lb/in2 lOOO-ft spans, 2000-ft LP s, = 1.5(3737) + 1616 + 4.578(1375) + 3.921(907) 80.52 8.67(1375) + ( + 5.78(907) 103.60 12 )O T = 2200 lb/in2 1 lOO-ft spans, 2200-ft LP s, = 1.5(4110)+ 1777 +4.578(1513)+ 3.921(997) + 8.67(1513)+ 80.52 5.78(997) 103.60 12 )O r = 2420 lb/i2 1200-ft spans, 2400-ft LP 1.5 (4484) + 1939 + 4.578(1650) s, = + 3.921(1088) 8.67 (1650) + 5.78(1088) + 80.52 103.60 -12 JO 1 = 2640 lb/in2 1300-ft spans, 2600-ft LP s = 1.5(4857)+ 2101 +4.578(1788) L + 3.921(1179) + = 2861 lb/in2 80.52 1400-ft spans, 2800-ft LP SL = Poles (at 1.5 (5231) + 2262 + 4.578(1926) 80.52 point N): l.5Vc+Hg+8.581Hc+6.589Hg s,= 176.98 in2 + 3.921(1269) + 8.67(1926) + 5.78(1269) 12 103.60 )O T = 3081 lb/in2 CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 265 600-ft spans, 1200-ft LP S,= 1.50242) + 970 + 8.581(825) + 6.589(544) + 11.14(825) 176.98 + 7.43(544) 335.36 ( )O 12 = 558 lb/in2 1 700-ft spans, 1400-ft LP S,-= 1.5(2616)+ 1131+ 8.581(963) + 6.589(635) + 176.98 800-ft spans, 1600-ft LP S,= 1.5(2989) + 1293 + 8.581(1100) + 6.589(725) + 176.98 11.14(1100) ( + 7.43(725) 335.36 12 )O r = 744 lb/in2 900-ft spans, 1800-ft LP S,= 1.5(3363)+ 1454 +8.581(1238) + 6.589(816)+ 176.98 lOOO-ft spans, 2000-ft LP s,= 1.5(3737) + 1616 + 8.581(1375) + 6.589(907) + 176.98 1 loo-ft spans, 2200-ft LP s,= 1.5(4110)+ 1777+8.581(1513)+6.589(997)+ ( 176.98 11.14(1513)+7.43(997) 335.36 12 )O - = 1023 lb/in2 1 1200-ft spans, 2400-ft LP s,= 1.5 (4484) + 1939 + 8.581(1650) + 6.589(1088) + 176.98 1300-ft spans, 2600-ft LP SN’ 1.5(4857) + 2101+ 8.581(1788)+ 6.589(1179) 176.98 )O 1400-ft spans, 2800-ft LP sN= 1.5 (5231) + 2262 + 8.581(1926) 176.98 + 6.589(1269) + 12 = 1209 lb/in’ 1 TRANSMISSION 266 Table point 27 shows a summary of loads LINE DESIGN MANUAL in the structure members for various span lengths and low distances. Table 27.-Summary of loads in structure members for various span lengths and low-point distances (U.S. customary example 3) SAS/Z, ft 600 Member 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1 300 1400 2000 2200 2400 2600 2800 6425 5881 2418 6459 7762 11 210 2200 930 7066 6475 2659 7104 8537 12 331 2420 1023 7708 7064 2 901 7749 9 314 13452 2640 1116 8351 7 652 3142 8 395 10090 14573 2861 1209 8993 8240 3 384 9042 10 866 15 694 3081 1 302 Position LP, ft Adjustable braces, lb Nonadjustable braces, lb Crosstie, lb Crossarm (compressive), lb Crossarm (compressive), lb X-brace, lb Pole, lb/in2 Pole, lb/in2 26. Structure location, wood-pole Data (a) l necessary 1800 3855 3532 1451 3875 4658 6727 1320 558 4497 4121 1693 4521 5434 7841 1541 651 5138 5782 4709 5298 1934 2176 5166 5813 6209 6986 8968 10089 1760 1980 744 837 spatting is a term line structures and bracing Required.-The following to the structure plan-profile limitation scales and for guying for the For and line: These the process equipment drawings are required are prepared specified conductor, and a conductor charts, by the field span, and ruling height table Process ofSpotting.-Figure Code 109 shows or the the details plan and profile drawing with the sag template spotting structures. Figure 110 also shows the applicable State for the various or clearances over ground, railroads, highways, communication circuits, and These clearances should be calculated in accordance with the latest edition Safety at the structure for Reqnired conductor other power lines. Electrical ground the the conductor National above of determining on the plan and profile drawings. is also determined for each location. template showing types and heights. of the height used data of structures on a transmission drawings of the transmission line. Plan l (b) and Equipment the locations and profile forces. A sag template made loading conditions. The 1600 type of transmission the amount of guying l l 1400 Structure Spotting.- height, and structures, determining AG&EF GCLFC GF AB & DE BC & CD KU&LT L N 1200 or municipal of the sag template, and figure structure code. 110 is a typical superimposed showing the method of using it for method of using the 15,5 OC (60 “F) curve of the template to determine the proper conductor and structure heights. The curve labeled “15.5 ‘C (60 o F) Final” represents the conductor position. The lower two curves, marked “8.2-m (27-ft) are exactly the same curves as the 15.5 ’ C final curve, but clearance” and “8.8-m (29-ft) clearance” displaced vertically the corresponding the 8.8-m clearance 8.2 and 8.8 m, respectively. Therefore, point on the 8,2-m clearance curve curve. Referring again to figure 110, any point on the final curve is 8.2 m above or 8.8 m above the corresponding point on the 8.8-m clearance curve just touches the CHAPTER ground the line 8.8-m of the profile. clearance line Therefore, touches the the V-ADDITIONAL conductor ground DATA 267 is 8.8 m above the ground at the point where line. Ccnductw: 201 md (387.5 kcmil), ACM, 2W7 Ruling Span =213.4 m (700 f t ) Max. Tension = 32 472 N (7300 lb), 45% Ult. NESC Heavy Loading: IS-mm (IL&in) ice with a 0.38-kPa (8-lb& wind at -18 OC (0 OFI cut out to prrmit drawing curve on the plan-profile / the I sheetr. TYPE low point span. Figure The process 109.-Typical of spotting usually 2083 + 50 on figure 110, and the position described above. in U.S. customary span to the right is selected, either the various types sag template (plastic) progresses the spans to the Please note that used for spotting from left the left to right structures. on the of it are spotted station numbering ter of ES the in each 21.3 IO.3 15.2 12.2 Ill m Ill Ill HS @Ott)@Oft& QofO{ &oft)- GROUND - 104-D-1113. profile. The structure at Sta. before the template is placed in referred to in this section are units. After the required position of the conductor has been determined for the of the structure at Sta. 2083+50, the location and height of the next structure by scaling or by use of a pole template. For convenience, the pole template for of structures is marked on the margin of the template. For the span under discussion, the structure location selected is at Sta. 2090 +20, the structure is a type HS with 18.3-m (60-ft) poles, and the span length is 204 m (670 ft). This information should be recorded on the drawing. The template is then moved to the right and the next span and structure located by repeating the process. TRANSMISSION Although the process the profile of spotting for several spans or railroad crossings, powerline which require will special structures ahead because ahead there to one of the fixed is a choice to determine that of structure of equal heights. The points at each of the as much as possible. transmission (c) may example, and high it is best to examine angle or low of the structure. points, points Such and work backward. be desirable desirable ruling profile to make layout In the highway in the profile conditions more is to have span, a smooth is a sign of good sections often than one of line layout spans of nearly conductor design. The where in order uniform profile, and length structures conductor structures should lie in a smooth flowing curve to equalize This is called grading the line and is an important part UplifLUplift, in a rough profile occur refer to the three conductor sag is drawn conductor will contract 60 o F), the conductor template. supports conductor crossings, as line attachment structure of the loading design of a line. Determining Uplift the left to right, such and it is usually a matter of determining the most these fixed locations. Sometimes it is desirable to it may most less than smooth line locations The from be conditions the location structure, between locations, to or slightly progresses may and affect structure the best arrangement. are equal usually there or communication consideration fix the location of a transmission line desirable arrangement of the structures move LINE DESIGN MANUAL Therefore, of alternate or upstrain, where the structures is a condition which conductor supports at Sta. 2105+35,2112+40, should be avoided, if possible. are at different elevations. For and 2121+70 on figure for a temperature of 15.5 ‘C (60 ’ F), but as the temperature and the sag will decrease. When the temperature reaches minus assumes the position indicated by the minus 51 ‘C cold curve minus 51 OC curve on the template between the conductor 2 105 + 35 and 2121+70), it can be determined whether the support of the intermediate structure (Sta. 2112+40) is above or below the cold curve. 21.3-m (70-ft) structure at Sta. 2112 +40, the conductor support is approximately on the conductor For the by placing structures lll.‘The decreases, the 51 ‘C (minus shown on the the (Sta. cold curve. Suppose, however, that the 21.3-m (70-ft) structure is replaced by a 19.8-m (65-ft) structure. The conductor support would then be below the cold curve and the conductor would exert an upward pull on the structure-this upward pull is the uplift or upstrain. Uplift at a structure will cause the conductor to pull the insulators cause the conductor to pull away from crossarm. Uplift may possibly be avoided up into the crossarm, and with pin-type insulators it might the insulator and possibly pull the insulator pin out of the by adjusting structure locations on the plan-profile drawing, to take advantage of terrain, by using a higher structure at the point of uplift or by attaching weights to the conductor. If these methods fail, then the conductor must be dead-ended. Structures should not be located at uplift points if it can be avoided because the only function of such a structure is to hold the conductors conductors during hot Insulator (d) that tends from to swing the swinging force of the to the distance of the adjacent wind pressure Sideswing.-Suspension pressure. Conductor to limit the sideswing on the conductor against weather. clearance in order an insulator spans suspended adjacent to the insulator between fall of the The rapidly away vertical conductor low the to sideswing by insulator insulation. is equal force structure, supported the caused length of the by horizontal wind sideswing, so it is necessary The horizontal wind pressure tends by the of the adjacent a short to one-half that supported of conductor points from to support are subject is reduced conductor The length conductor sometimes on a structure spans. force string. the insulators to the structure to maintain proper in the two is equal and the to keep insulator by the spans. conductor total string insulator On rough low wind pressure the insulator terrain points, plus string string one-half is equal where each as indicated CHAPTER by the conductor template, the low points from is still swinging. the Too structure. distance To the checked the point much insulator falls sideswing might (e) the instructions allowable, low-point distance, of structure could for extra proper angle be used In for by a broken conductor policy and of 230 kV and When strainextra clearance on both sides adjacent span or pin-type for broken is not the to a special maximum the be added the this If value area, Structure at the value chart. be used, outside the heights bottom lengths and structure heights used for pole lengths over. strength structure of 13.7 Class 1 poles of the are given is needed limitation number of guys, as shown major highways, major for any chart, on the m (45 ft) are used in or less; for extra reason. should guying be used charts, at a should adjacent to the crossing span. Other states broken (1977), d o not require required clearance for broken to maintain over the circuits, clearance edition lines communication sufficient latest NESC structures conductors. of a crossing, Whenever the under the outside The This railroads, conductor clearance major conditions and required are governed conductor highways, major on transmission lines above. the enough it is necessary be reduced structure. with communication or lake crossings one-half may falls is necessary. could m (50 ft) and additional railroads, of the spans in to provide major When sagged over which, River than correction the limitation type point or limits, be used. by the correct be provided in either rules powerlines, or where The the hardware, plan-profile. structure structure weights the allowable structures. should considerations. It is our of 15.2 as indicated all crossings NESC are normally line. some span 3 poles structures, on the between the insulator line. for lengths of structure, wood-pole powerlines the class in a transmission California, major tall type transmission used and insulators, suspension If distance to hold is within is measured limits. the vertically in the the specified prescribed However, insulators on the regarding each lines, are normally spans, The by the more spans. a failure spans spans 273 as acting of the area in which than type for On all wood-pole class 2 poles line be greater or another can cause adjacent General Instructions.-Instructions design long the be within adjacent sideswing of adjacent within to provide strings, the of the sum will will be adjusted insulator points the of the DATA to be considered distance whether low sideswing outside low-point against so defined of insulator fall of conductor determine between is then may the length V-ADDITIONAL ruling are used on both sides of a crossing, it is not necessary For lower voltages, when suspension-type structures increased involving span, decrease special to use spans ruling sag in the to seriously the crossing the structures longer than conductors or long spans approximately should tension due to a broken in most cases. are to be handled 1.7 times be dead-ended conductor as special the ruling span at both ends of the in an studies. or shorter span and span. terrain slopes across the right-of-way, conductor on the high side to meet approximately Other policies span clearance to allow are used in conductors and overhead 50 percent in the regarding substations 1. It is Bureau policy a substation or switchyard. sufficient clearance all requirements. ground span terminating and switchyards to install self-supporting In general, this means structures that the wires on are: under the should full load substation (no guys) within structure adjacent be maintained should normally or switchyard 183 m (600 ft) of to the substation 274 TRANSMISSION or switchyard conductor 2. will and When is not the reduced, should he a steel overhead may be varied and any special to meet The method that is designing of approach the tension requirements between span structures before angle in the transmission and design roads, should proceeding where with the and overhead ground final tension ground wires wire substation power tensions or switchyard or communication be discussed the in the conductor overhead of the and tensions yard. conductors structural as railroads, unbalanced the in a span the or switchyard steel the into of conductor of the such to the substation slack is reduced of reduction requirements of accepting to the clearance amount the crossing due wire midspan The capable wire ground sufficient be maintained. structure ground overhead LINE DESIGN MANUAL with design the of the lines. design group transmission line. 3. The be made deflection deflection as small as possible. angle reduces the or switchyard structure. On wood-pole lines all guyed structures 27. Right-of-Way transmission line strings require wide enough clearance Sufficient should sandy that imposes soil or other have a separate and Building design. Today’s soil with poor anchorplate Clearance higher this angle additional voltages, obstruction is essential that may to avoid for each .-Right-of-way wider phase adjacent to the right-of-way. are hanging in their no-wind It is legally possible for someone right-of-way, and occasionally this be at the flashover or switchyard characteristics guy clearance should is encountered, strand. is a very spacings, important consideration in and unrestrained insulator ever before. A right-of-way in a high-wind situation, edge of the right-of-way to trees, buildings, pole Some of these position. structure be less than loo because a larger transverse load on the substation bearing a wider right-of-way and greater clearances than to give adequate clearance between conductors from any clearance obstruction conductors where line at the substation It is preferred clearance and hazards on private lines, and are not obvious to erect a structure, such as a building, at the is done. The only way we can protect ourselves very and must be and also property. any other when the edge of our others is to make our right-of-way wide enough to provide a minimum electrical clearance between the outer conductor, at a maximum wind condition of 0.43 kPa (9 lb/ft2), and an imaginary building with a wall on the edge of the right-of-way. Tables 28 and 29 show the horizontal distance required as clearance between Tables 30 through ruling spans. a conductor and a building for various line voltages 35 show the required right-of-way for transmission Sometimes there is a tendency to reduce the right-of-way require shorter spans (to keep the conductors safely within would be more expensive than initially because of the and elevations above sea level. lines of different voltages and width to keep costs down, but this would the right-of-way) and the line probably additional structures required. CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 275 Table 28 .-Minimum horizontal clearance to buildings- USBR standard for NESC light, medium, and heavy loading (metric) kV Ruling span, m Conductor 69 84 mm2 ACSR 6/l 115 135 mm2 ACSR 26/7 138 242 mm2 ACSR 2417 161 242 mm2 ACSR 2417 230 483 mm2 ACSR 4517 345 483 mm2 ACSR 4517 duplex 213 305 213 305 213 305 213 305 305 366 427 305 366 427 Basic clearance, m 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 3.048 Increase for voltage,’ m 0.2003 .2003 .3420 .3420 .4836 .4836 .9086 .9086 .9086 1.6170 1.6170 1.6170 Increase for elevation, m Minimum horizontal clearance to buildings,2 m 3 percent of ‘increase for voltage” for each 305 m of elevation over 1006 m 3.048 3.048 3.249 3.249 3.389 3.389 3.532 3.532 3.956 3.956 3.956 4.666 4.666 4.666 r The increase for voltage is: ’ At 1006-m elevation and a Table 29.-Minimum horizontal clearance to buildings-USBR standard for NESC light, medium, and heavy loading (U.S. customary) kV Conductor 69 No. 4/O AWG ACSR 611 115 266.8 kcmil ACSR 2617 138 477 kcmil ACSR 2417 161 477 kcmil ACSR 2417 230 954 kcmil ACSR 4517 345 954 kcmil ACSR 4517 duplex Ruling spa ft Basic clearance, ft 700 1000 700 1000 700 1000 700 1000 1000 1200 1400 1000 1200 1400 10 10 10 10 10 10 :: 10 10 10 :8 10 l The increase for voltage is: 2 At 3300-ft elevation and at 60 “F with a 9-lb/ft’ wind. Increase for voltage,’ ft 0.66 0.66 1.12 1.12 1.59 1.59 2.98 2.98 2.98 5.31 5.31 5.31 Increase for elevation, ft 3 percent of ‘increase for voltage” for each 1000 ft of elevation over 3300 ft Minimum horizontal clearance to buildings,2 ft 10.00 10.00 10.66 10.66 11.12 11.12 11.59 11.59 12.98 12.98 12.98 15.31 15.31 15.31 Table 30.-Right-of-way Maximum kV’ 69 Conductor Ruling span, m conductor tension,2 newtons per conductor 84 mm2 ACSR 6/l 213 a12 900 115 138 135 mm2 ACSR 26/7 242 mm2 ACSR 2417 213 213 305 a24900 a16400 161 242 mm2 ACSR 24/l 213 230 483 mm2 ACSR 4517 305 305 a23 100 a24900 a23 100 a31100 366 427 305 366 a30200 a29 300 a31 100 a30200 427 a29 300 305 305 345 483 mm2 ACSR 4517 duplex b16 900 Insulator string length, mm Conductor swing 0.43kPa wind l/3 low point Degrees m 869 869 65O19’ 65O19’ 1219 1372 1219 3746 7 705 8 964 3745 7576 3460 73746 116 a12900 r 69 through 161 kV are H-frame wood-pole construction; 2 Maximum conductor tensions are limited by: Conductor sag at 15.5 oc, mm values-NESC Iigh t loading (metric) Right-of-way,4 m 2 % 63OO2' 57OO9’ 63OO2' 3.048 3.048 3.658 4.267 3.658 3.048 3.048 3.249 3.389 3.249 21 28 23 24 29 g 1372 1676 1676 2286 57OO9’ 57009’ 57OO9’ 50°38' 7.6255 4.5550 7.8809 8.6982 4.267 5.182 5.182 7.620 3.389 3.532 3.532 3.956 ;; 34 41 Iz m u 12851 17676 8 964 12851 2286 2286 3658 3658 50°38' 50°38' 50°38' 50°38' 11.7036 15.4341 9.7590 12.7644 7.620 7.620 9.144 9.144 3.956 3.956 4.666 4.666 47 55 48 54 17676 3658 5OO38' 16.4949 9.144 4.666 61 230 and 345 kV are steel tower construction. 3 At 1006-m elevation, and at 15.5 OC with a 0.43kPa wind. 4 At 1006-m elevation, and rounded off to next highest meter. Minimum horizontal clearance to buildings,3 m 7.6736 4.1705 4.2996 7.4292 7 705 a 18 percent ultimate strength at 15.5 oC fmal, no load. b 25 percent ultimate strength at -18 OC final, no load. 4.1925 Outside phase to structure centerline, m $ E n z 5 z ? Table 3 1.-Right-of-way kV’ 69 Conductor No. 4/O AWG ACSR 6/l 115 266.8 kcmil ACSR 2617 138 477 kcmil ACSR 24/l Ruling span, ft 411 kcmil ACSR 2417 230 954 kcmil ACSR 4517 345 954 kcmil ACSR 45/l duplex Conductor sag at 60 OF, ft Insulator string length, ft 12.28 24.86 11.34 23.27 12.28 25.25 12.28 25.25 29.31 42.09 57.89 29.37 42.09 57.89 2.5 2.5 4.0 4.0 4.5 4.5 5.5 5.5 7.5 7.5 7.5 12.0 12.0 12.0 700 a2900 a29oo 700 b3800 a3700 a5600 a5200 a5600 a5200 a7000 86800 a66oo a7000 86800 a66oo 700 1000 161 Maximum conductor tension,* pounds per conductor 1000 1000 700 1000 1000 1200 1400 1000 1200 1400 values-NESC light loading (US. customary) r 69 through 161 kV are H-frame wood-pole construction; * Maximum conductor tensions are limited by: Conductor swing 9-lb/ft* wind l/3 low point Degrees Et 65O19’ 65O19’ 63OO2' 63OO2' 57009’ 57OO9’ 57009’ 57009’ 50°38' 50°38' 50°38' 50°38' 50°38' 50'38' 230 and 345 kV are steel tower construction. a 18 percent ultimate strength at 60 OF fmal, no load. b 25 percent ultimate strength at 0 OF fmal, no load. ’ At 3300-ft elevation, and at 60 OF with a 9-lb/ft* wind. 4 At 3300-ft elevation. and rounded off to next highest 5 feet. Outside phase to structure centerline, ft Minimum horizontal clearance to buildings,3 ft Right-of-way,4 ft 10 10 10.00 10.00 70 24.86 13.67 24.31 14.10 24.99 90 s 12 12 14 14 10.66 10.66 75 95 80 !z 14.94 17 25.83 28.51 38.34 50.56 :5’ 25 25 13.43 31.99 41.82 54.04 i8 30 11.12 11.12 11.59 11.59 12.98 12.98 12.98 15.31 105 90 110 135 155 180 155 15.31 15.31 175 200 7 $ 0 =i 5 z : 2 Table 32.-Right-of-way kV’ Conductor 69 115 138 84 mm2 ACSR 6/l 213 135 mm2 ACSR 26/7 213 242 mm2 ACSR 24/l 161 242 mm2 ACSR 24/l 230 483 mm2 ACSR 45/l 345 Ruling span, m 483 mm2 ACSR 4517 duplex Maximum conductor tension,’ newtons per conductor Conductor sag at 15.5 oc, mm a15 500 values-NE,!%7 medium loading (metric) Insulator string length, mm Conductor swing 0.43-kPa wind l/3 low point Degrees m 305 bll300 a19 100 4033 7521 3111 305 b21300 a26700 6947 4 111 869 869 1219 1219 1372 305 305 305 366 427 305 366 b28500 a267OO b28500 b37400 b36900 b36400 b37400 b36900 1655 4 111 7655 8948 12 821 17525 8948 12 821 1372 1676 1676 2286 2286 2286 3658 3658 50038' 50°38' 50°38' 50°38' 50°38' 11.6850 15.3174 427 b36400 17525 3658 50°38' 16.3782 213 213 r 69 through 161 kV are H-frame wood-pole construction; 2 Maximum conductor tensions are limited by: 65O19’ 65O19’ 3 At 1006-m elevation, and at 15.5 OC with a 0.43-kPa wind. 4 At 1006-m elevation, and rounded off to next highest meter. 3.048 3.048 4.4531 7.6291 3.048 3.048 3.658 63OO2' 1.2185 4.6062 3.658 4.267 7.5835 4.8616 4.267 5.182 5.182 7.620 7.620 7.620 230 and 345 kV are steel tower construction. a 25 percent ultimate strength at -29 OC final, no load. b 18 percent ultimate strength at 15.5 OC fmal, no load. Minimum horizontal clearance to buildings,3 m 63OO2' 57009’ 57009’ 57009’ 57009’ 4.4542 Outside phase to structure centerline, m 7.8389 8.6859 9.7467 12.7458 9.144 9.144 9.144 3.249 3.249 3.389 3.389 Right-of-way ,4 m z % 22 28 g 5; ul i: 3.532 3532 3: P 1 z 3.956 3.956 3.956 41 41 0 E :48 5 4.666 4.666 54 4.666 61 m 5 z r Table 33.-Right-of-way kV’ Conductor 69 No. 4/O AWG ACSR 6/l 115 266.8 kcmil ACSR 2617 138 477 kcmil ACSR 2417 161 477 kcmil ACSR 2417 230 954 kcmil ACSR 4517 345 954 kcmil ACSR 4517 duplex Ruling span, ft 700 1000 700 1000 700 1000 700 1000 1000 1200 1400 1000 1200 1400 Maximum conductor tension,2 pounds per conductor Conductor sag at 60 OF, ft a3500 b3900 a4300 b4800 a6000 b6400 a6000 b6400 b8400 b8300 b8200 b8400 b8300 b8200 ’ 69 through 161 kV are H-frame wood-pole construction; ’ Maximum conductor tensions are limited by: values-NESCmedium 13.16 24.63 12.37 22.75 13.49 25.15 13.49 25.15 29.38 42.07 57.38 29.38 42.07 57.38 Insulator string length, ft 2.5 2.5 4.0 4.0 4.5 4.5 5.5 5.5 7.5 7.5 7.5 12.0 12.0 12.0 loading (U.S. customary) Conductor swing 9-lb/ft2 wind l/3 low point Degrees ft 6S019’ 65O19’ 63OO2’ 63OO2’ 57009’ 57009’ 57009’ 57OO9’ 50°38’ 50°38’ 50°38’ 50’38’ 50°38’ 50°38’ 230 and 345 kV are steel tower construction. a 25 percent ultimate strength at -20 OF final, no load. b 18 percent ultimate strength at 60 OF final, no load. ’ At 3300-ft elevation, and at 60 OF with a 9-lb/ft’ wind 4 At 3300-ft elevation, and rounded off to next highest 5’f&. 14.23 24.65 14.59 23.84 15.11 24.91 15.95 25.75 28.51 38.33 50.16 31.99 41.81 53.64 Outside phase to structure centerline, ft Minimum horizontal clearance to buildings,3 ft 10 10 12 12 14 14 17 17 25 25 25 30 30 30 10.00 10.00 10.66 10.66 11.12 11.12 11.59 11.59 12.98 12.98 12.98 15.31 15.31 15.31 Right-of-way,4 ft 70 90 ;: 85 100 1?8 135 155 180 155 175 200 II TJ -F ZJ a =I 5 z g 2 Table 34.-Right-of-way values-NESC heavy loading (metric) 84 mm2 ACSR 6/l 213 Maximum conductor tension,? newtons per conductor a18 200 115 135 mm2 ACSR 26/l 305 213 a182OO b24400 12530 4452 869 1219 65O19' 63OO2' 12.1751 5.0547 3.048 3.658 3.048 3.249 138 242 305 9524 4665 8 101 4 665 8 101 8 954 12 844 1219 1372 2286 2286 63OO2' 57009' 57009' 57009' 57009' 50°38' 50°38' 9.5755 5.0716 1.9582 5.3270 8.2186 8.6905 11.6982 3.658 4.267 4.267 5.182 5.182 7.620 7.620 3.249 3.389 3.389 3.532 3.532 3.956 3.956 34 41 41 Rulins span, Conductor kV’ 69 m 230 345 Insulator string length, mm Conductor swing 0.43kPa wind l/3 low point Degrees m 5194 869 65O19' Outside phase to structure centerline, m Minimum horizontal clearance to buildIngs,3 m 6.0544 3.048 3.048 25 is 31 24 f ;z $ 239” r z Rightof-way,4 m i 242 mm2 ACSR 24/l 213 483 mm2 ACSR 4517 305 305 366 a24900 b33300 a382OO b33 300 a38200 c51 100 c50700 421 c50 300 11515 2286 50°38' 15.3097 7.620 3.956 54 305 366 421 c51100 c50700 c50 300 128954 844 17515 3658 3658 50'38' 50°38' 50°38' 12.7590 9.7513 16.3705 9.144 9.144 4.666 4.666 54 48 61 mm2ACSR 24/l 213 305 161 Conductor sag at 15.5 oc, mm 483 mm2 ACSR 45/l duplex : 69 through Maximum 161 kV are H-frame wood-pole conductor construction; 1372 1676 1676 230 and 345 kV are steel tower construction. tensions are limited by: a 50 percent ultimate strength at -18 OC initial, full load. b 33-l/3 percent ultimate strength at -40 OC initial, RO load. c 18 percent ultimate strength at 15.5 OC final, no load. 3 At 1006-m elevation, and at 15.5 OC with a OA3kPa wind. 4 At 1006-m elevation, and rounded off to next highest meter. m 0 FJ s 5 f r Table Conductor kV’ 35 .-Right-of-way values-NESC heavy loading (U.S. customary) Ruhng spa% ft Maximum conductor tension,2 pounds per conductor Conductor sag at 60 OF, ft Insulator string length, ft a4 100 a4 100 18.95 41.00 2.5 2.5 65O19’ 65O19’ 19.49 39.53 10 10 10.00 10.00 80 120 12 12 14 14 17 10.66 10.66 11.12 11.12 11.59 11.59 12.98 80 110 85 105 95 115 135 12.98 12.98 155 180 : =i 6 z Conductor swing 9-lb/ft’ wind l/3 low point Degrees ft Outside phase to structure centerline, ft Minimum horizontal clearance to buildings,’ ft Rightof-way,4 ft 69 No. 4/O AWG ACSR 6/l 700 1000 115 266.8 kcmil ACSR 26/7 700 1000 700 1000 700 1000 1000 b5 a5 b7 a8 b7 a8 cl1 500 600 500 600 500 600 500 14.57 31.23 15.47 26.54 15.47 26.54 29.35 4.0 4.0 4.5 4.5 5.5 5.5 7.5 63OO2’ 63OO2’ 57009’ 57009’ 57OO9’ 57009’ 50°38’ 16.55 31.40 16.78 26.08 17.62 26.92 28.49 1200 1400 c11 400 cl1 300 42.13 57.51 7.5 7.5 50°38’ 50°38’ 38.37 50.26 1000 1200 c11 400 500 cl1 29.35 42.13 12.0 50°38’ 31.97 41.85 ii 30 15.31 155 175 57.51 12.0 50°38’ 1400 c11 300 t 69 through 161 kV are H-frame wood-pole construction; 230 and 345 kV are steel tower construction. 2 Maximum conductor tensions are limited by: 53.74 30 15.31 200 138’ 477 kcmil ACSR 2417 161 477 kcmfl ACSR 2417 230 954 kcmil ACSR 4517 345 954duplex kcmil ACSR 4517 a 50 percent ultimate strength at 0 OF initial, full load. b 33-l/3 percent ultimate strength at -40 OF initial, no load. ’ 18 percent ultimate strength at 60 OF final, no load. ’ At 3300-ft elevation, and at 60 OF with a g-lb/f? wind. 4 At 3300-ft elevation, and rounded off to next highest 5 feet. :: 25 ? D : Y 5 . : 2 282 TRANSMISSION 28. Armor Rods of vibrations may and produced well result by very turbulence steady on the leeward 1 to possibly millimeters aeolian the hertz, reinforced induces vibrations of an inch the aluminum on a clear, conductor cold the conductor support, which and The The a few light Therefore, dampers, effect on vibration value is through range and to 200 amplitudes nodes, of tension force per unit length. On short spans, by the humming sound produced-like and is usually this type or both. strung to fairly of conductor requires and reduce the amplitude from the reinforcing of the conductor some protection to the conductor due to flashovers. Armor rods for high special 10 to 20 percent; at the point of against vibration, the armor aluminum conductors are to a stranded cable of larger diameter-thereby region of maximum bending stress. A set of 7 to 13 rods, depending length of the rods vary with are eddy frequencies between and consist of a spiral layer of short, round rods surrounding conductor to its support is made in the middle of the armored equivalent is in the which varying millimeters frequencies distance and morning. is comparatively rods have some damping their greatest protective frequencies from types conductor periodically the excitation. length, and other in the natural It is the range or more. span to aeolian stresses of the and the conductor and is evident only Armor however, to offering from burns those produces velocity, so it is quite susceptible to vibration. by the use of armor rods, vibration maximum stress. In addition rods protect the conductor are subject bending normally inches), wind of the conductor, small amplitude lines that to several of the MANUAL (1 to 30 mi/h). amplitudes tensions, protection made of aluminum attachment of the are of 1 to 48 km/h and are functions singing of telephone Steel repeated Aeolian winds in the conductor, diameter the vibration is of extremely the conductors which side of the conductor 100 (a fraction vibrations Dampers.-All wind, in its failure. stimulated from Vibration by LINE DESIGN the conductor. length. This strengthening The makes it at the on conductor size, is required to armor a conductor. The size the size of the conductor. Generally, because of the ease of application, and for both and removal if necessary, preformed armor rods are used for all sizes of ACSR conductors steel and Alumoweld overhead ground wires. Formed rods are manufactured with a spiral shape the to fit diameter of the conductor on which they are to be used. The ends of each rod are discharge of armor or parrot-billed to reduce the chance of abraiding the conductor and the tendency for corona at these points. Clips or clamps are not required on this type of armor rod. Older types rods, now seldom used by the Bureau, include the straight rod and the tapered-rod types. Straight armor rounded rods, having a constant diameter sizes of 15 to 62 mm2 (No. 6 AWG to No. with long tapered ends and are used for straight at the and tapered types time of installation for their full length, of rods are furnished using special armor straight and the spiral rod wrenches. These on the conductor by the installation of armor rod clips or clamps been formed. Normally, armor rod clamps are used on transmission and higher, and armor mostly to the possibility Through experience, effective device against are used l/O AWG), inclusive. Tapered 79 mm2 (No. 2/O AWG) and has found and, when damper will greatly reduce vibration. We use both armor rods and vibration dampers the Stockbridge-type properly installed, for ACSR conductor rods are straight rods conductors. Both the is formed around the conductor types of rods are held in place at each end after the spiral has lines for voltages of 115 kilovolts rod clips are used for voltages of 69 kilovolts of corona loss off the sharper edges of the the Bureau vibration armor larger the on our transmission suspension points may be eliminated if sized clamps are used for the be an almost perfect fit, with extremely small tolerance, to provide strand breakage at this stress point. and clips. vibration latest lines. lower. This choice is due damper to be a very models of this type of Armor conductor. the desired rods at conductor These clamps must protection against Each construction application, contractor and transmission field office location in the to furnish DATA the dampers vibration middle of the of possible A damper the problem loop centerline could formed frequencies effective, however, absolutely from of the should be handled in the is almost are be located conductor to be furnished must be located in the middle suspension regardless of size, span simply. and the midpoint point A vibration problem third another of a loop would becomes of a loop for and are transmitted dampers. The so the problem at the the midpoint could be a node no effect (see fig. 112). recommendations conductor quite unlimited 283 manufacturer’s that or compression dead end. vibrated at the same frequency the to be most wind; have is required of the‘ vibration distance of a strain clamp If all conductors number V-ADDITIONAL line. The data are checked and, if found satisfactory, as the criteria to use for installation of the vibration at a prescribed velocity, CHAPTER created frequency, to be effective. for size, installed on the to the appropriate dampers are installed clamp or from length, tension, damper could he solved. more the and Studies and wind be placed However, complex. in the mouth conductor the the A damper, by the damper should would be made so that a damper installed at the chosen location will be effective on as many probable frequencies as possible. Numerous laboratory studies have been made by manufacturers of dampers over the years. The new, more sophisticated dampers have been developed through these laboratory studies and should be applied as recommended by the manufacturer. Formulas for computing the frequency and loop length and the basic theory of vibration can be found in most physics books. Two such formulas are: For frequency : Metric U.S. Customary Hz 51.4534 km/h Hz 3.26 mi/h mm in f&l d where f = frequency k= a constant (for air) V= velocity of wind d= outside diameter of conductor For loop length: where L = loop length f= frequency T= tension in conductor g = acceleration due to gravity W= force of conductor A standing but of opposite Reduction wave, such direction of span as the vibration loop, mm Hz N 9.8066 m/s* N/m is the result of two traveling of motion. length and tension reduces the severity of vibration. in Hz lb 32.2 ft/s* lb/ft waves equal in magnitude TRANSMISSION 284 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Midpoint of loop f (Vibration waves are exaggerated vertically for illustmtion) Figure Galloping or dancing 112.-Schematic conductors by strong gusty winds blowing of eliminating this phenomenon melt it off as quickly value. Corona are large-amplitude, after it forms loss on a transmission of conductors when the occurs when waves in a conductor. low-frequency vibrations. Galloping the potential and before damage occurs (see sec. line is the result of the ionization electric stress (or voltage gradient) of a conductor in air is raised conductors will result. There is always a power When and where will corona occur on a given be? What can be done to reduce or eliminate investigators have studied over the years. Three Rockwell Peterson [ 161, and Peterson formulas have been to such used for calculating of obtaining good the expected data is to take This true of the Recent available corona the data loss for these from the line extra-high-voltage lines, so care study based In fair conductor. up to a voltage near voltage is an indicator surface For the of a given same a smooth will increase size of the conductor diameter, conductor. approaches a stranded Any corona-and conductors distortion their the spacings line cylinder, is good to the surface the higher and a smooth conductor voltage, also the corona. country. region, The below Carroll-Rockwell 3.1 kilowatt higher voltages. Actually, the being studied after it has been a published is small disruptive that and per phase work has been directed toward corona loss in the information for this range should be explored and and the method of calculation from to that which you propose using. weather, corona The calculated a value tufts or streamers the odor of ozone. enough, corrosion transmission line ? How much power loss will there it? These are some of the questions that many methods of calculation by Peek [15], Carroll and [ 171 are in general use in this the most accurate in the low-loss kilometer (5 kilowatt per phase mile). extra-high-voltage range, and the latest is especially loss with 14). process which takes exceeds a certain dielectric strength of the surrounding air is exceeded. Corona is visible as bluish around the conductor; the visible discharge is accompanied by a hissing sound and In the presence of moisture, nitrous acid is produced and, if the corona is heavy of the is caused across irregularly ice-covered conductors. The only known methods are to either prevent the ice from forming on the conductor, or to as possible 29. Corona.-Corona place on the surface of vibration have the be exercised to select line the disruptive voltage of corona-performance. the for of the must on transmission higher about considerable the critical 80 to 85 percent conductor more (raised critical effect these best method constructed. strands, data test very data similar for a particular The closer the disruptive voltage. of the voltage burrs, scratches) of rough spots become. The on corona loss. Fair weather, CHAPTER rain, snow, hoarfrost, corona loss. rain produces the same loss is observed line to know In earlier When rates of rainfall behavior. Corona can and and dimension instead between text reduce overvoltage surge. for figures of the were illustrations, from we have are present, open-circuited loss to be expected an entire lines, transmission because become corona and in a be necessary line. of energy more can affect it will loss. important. system attenuate both corona reference chosen along studying The presence of voltage at which do so, it would has probably expected SI metric To when factor. of the was avoided-strictly of corona the be considered of corona simultaneously on long taken value switching) calculating preferred peak corona aspect (lightning, switching related and transmission, must to determine. exist 285 than any other single as low as 65 percent The could DATA temperature impossible, influence voltages is a procedure procedure weather. that radio high voltage Following the and loss more at voltages if not of high-voltage years, abnormally lightning fair difficult, years recent during is very all of the more pressure, Rain probably affects corona corona loss on a conductor transmission In atmospheric V-ADDITIONAL loss on a transmission line. is reference used centimeters Th [18]. dimension of millimeters. To to present the in centimeters: procedure ensure This as a compatibility Nomenclature: Pk = corona loss, kW/km P, = corona loss, kW/mi E = average surface critical visual Eo= = line to ground > = line frequency, 6 = air n = number r = conductor = spacing g = mean g,, = surface ;= density at 50 Hz at 60 Hz voltage corona (per phase) (per 3-phase) gradient gradient voltage, kV Hz factor of conductors radius, in bundle cm of conductors equivalent phase between spacing, average voltage m = conductor in bundle, cm and gradient surface cm factor maximum surface gradient, at which corona starts, (assumed 0.88, average kV/cm kV/cm weathered conductor) Assume: 345-kV transmission 483-mm2 457-mm 10.06-m The basic line (954-kcmil) (18~in) (33-ft) formula for at 1829-m ACSR,45/7 spacing on conductor flat phase spacing reading the corona (6000-ft) conductor elevation (duplex) e = 199.2 r 1.48 = cm s = 45.72 cm bundle D = loss from kV the curves shown on figures 1005.84 113 cm and 114 is: 286 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL pk g is analogous to E so, y22 g, = F A. 0go 0 For a duplex conductor, l+$ ( g= e ) (2r) log, A+For a single conductor, g= e r log, f g= (1 +~)WW (2) (1.48) log, Calculateg, Results from for air density the two-thirds a high-altitude test 205.65 == 14.45 kV/cm 14.23 (1 ;;;;k8p72, . fromg, project = 21.1 m 6% at Leadville, Colo. 0.301 1+ fi > ( [19] 8 varies as the one-half power in lieu of the first power power as indicated by Peterson’s investigations [17]. concluded that as suggested the = 20.72 kV/cm Calculate g/go and read corresponding value for 14.45 g -z-z go 20.72 From figure 113, -& curve Pk /n 2 r2 at 50 Hz from figure o 7. ’ A : = 0.04 Pk = 0.04(2)2 (1.48)2 = 0.2368 kW/km at 50 Hz (per phase) correction by Peek 113: [15] or CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL 287 DATA ‘k n2r2 0.4 0.6 Figure 113.-Corona As read test. from Because should multiplying 1.0 1.2 0.3 loss curves for (A) fair weather, figures 113 the corona be multiplied by the in kilowatts per for ~7 QS (B) rainfall,(C) for a 60-Hz factors, three phases The 0.3 OA Q5 Q6 Q7 0.9 09 1.0 I.1 1.2 13 and(D) value phases, should 60-Hz snow. 104-D-1116. From [18]. for each phase from a 50-Hz the value read from the chart kilometer for all three for --- per kilometer to frequency, system. the figure 1.1 hoarfrost, Pk is in kilowatts is in direct proportion if the loss is desired three mile ~5 114, 60/50 and Combining and loss factor by 1.6093, by three. value 0.9 may the be changed answer be multiplied should by 5.79 to mile by be multiplied to obtain a loss systems: Pk = 0.2368 kW/km at 50 Hz (per phase) PC = 5.79 (0.2368) = 1.371 kW/mi at 60 Hz (per 3-phase) When curve the rainfall two, three, 100 percent. give is to be considered, B. Similarly, the for hoarfrost or four Taking expected (whichever the assigned corona loss for the or snow, corona is applicable) percentages the line loss due losses are obtained values times ‘in question. for to rain must from corona the corresponding be read curves Cor loss must from figure ZI, respectively. be apportioned losses and summing 113 using Then, to make these will 288 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.1 0.08 0.06 0.01 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 I.1 Figure 114.-Average values of corona loss under fair weather with different conductor bundles. (1) single conductor (2) two-conductor bundle (3) three-conductor bundle (4) four-conductor bundle (5) average curve. 104-D-1117. From [18]. CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 289 Example: Assume that is fair, the line 5 percent previously of the used time is located it rains, and such that 10 percent 85 percent of the time of the time it snows-all the during weather a period of a year. pk - = 0.04 for fair weather (curve A, fig. 113) n2 Y2 Pk = 0.04(2)2 (1 .4Q2 = 0.2368 kW/km at 50 Hz (per phase) PC = 5.79(0.2368) ‘k - = 1.37 1 kW/mi at 60 Hz (per 3-phase) = 0.90 for rainfall (curve B, fig. 113) n2 r2 Pk = 0.90(2j2( = 7.885 kW/km at 50 Hz (per phase) 1 .48)2 PC = 5.79(7.885) = 45.654 kW/mi at 60 Hz (per 3-phase) pk n2 r2 for snow (curve D, fig. 113) = 0.15 Pk = 0.1 5(2)2 (1 .48)2 = 1.3 14 kW/km at 50 Hz (per phase) PC = 5.79(1.314) = 7.608 kW/mi at 60 Hz (Per 3-phase) Summation of losses times percentages: (0.85)(1.371) + (0.05)(45.654) + 0.10 (7.608) = 4.21 kW/mi at 60 Hz (per 3-phase) This is the average corona loss for the year. Although justified this method for practical due to weather conductor. decrease Factors conditions. New rapidly Fair weather lines with various for As indicated transmission rather for of calculation purposes. corona loss is only in the example, corona tend there loss depends to have higher an approximation, mostly losses; on the however, changes surface these conductors weather conditions conductor in fog, mist, Weathered conductor in fair weather Corona loss curves and computed by the for ACSR higher of the values will are: in rain Weathered elevations in the losses condition time. Range All it is apparently are substantial different conductor Carroll-Rockwell and voltages sizes-from method snow are shown which for fair 0.47 to 0.60 0.54 0.60 to 0.80 0.70 0.80 to 0.95 0.88 on figure may A verage value 115. Curves be determined the weather are shown estimated at 25 o C (77 o F). for corona different loss as TRANSMISSION 290 a 0 LINE DESIGN MANUAL CHAPTER V-ADDITIONAL DATA 291 TRANSMISSION 292 30. Stringing Sag furnished for stringing sag data the sag and studies, tension data determination electrical For field results installation for spans than sag table ruling conductor for to cover length a range increments, and from are not the without high become On free suspension from the tensions, and if the stringing sags and are usually loading a temperature form lengths in 5-m elevation, range Spans.-When conductors spans. If the if the terrain however, sag and loading is use and F in 10’ are increments, above -18 if conductor in field from tension conditions if the to 50 percent should at a lower the ruling to 49 ‘C in 5’ increments. Offset Data for Inclined low below tables unloaded 0 to 120’ span. Stringing for the preparation conditions from span. generally for convenience range the but on initial loading in table sag tables on the ruling required are the are based on final listed data to furnish of each lengths, basic spans values 50 percent strings span and of sag in that sheaves conductor hanging terrain is not is quite conductor supports in stringing sheaves very this steep, to hang put span to obtain dead intermediate ends to the conductor. the steep, the proper dead dead should tend problem sagging on adjacent to run downhill can be handled of the one to isolate be such as to minimize sag and offset dead end (the last structure clipped the steep conductor see figure is clipped a way that the amount the in, slack conductors of slack in a given span the sag while has been clipped dead ends, must be sagged the For either sagged structure from in one conductor purposes tension permanent ahead, during the the the suspension between the the clip-in comparatively the conductor the the distance it is necessary temporary clamp dead sections dead will end operation. level for since Where in one operation, where of is changed, in. Calculations operation. the be taken or temporary, of calculation, For components to change conductor 116. must horizontal it is necessary of line being to maintain be equal; the sagging ends. be at least is snubbed, ends, ends T2 must in such Whenever between to permit the span sag after dead in the section There conductor temporary great temporary be the last structure where between is too after upper correct of spans of conductor establish the is also changed-so the in a series between vertically into Tl and tensions HI and Hz are equal. tension length these suspension These units, insulator are made shall level about sheaves, the amount entire sags and based length span The from running the conductor offsets on exact line. metric concern; on line and lengths the individual For the the directly including it is necessary of span lengths into final right, If based complex. lower is in the upon are also based conductor. wires, range of span at the same spans much may ground based as to cover Sag and Insulator (b) for important. are not design he exactly increments. span extremely wires calculations will the entire is unstressed, an extent in lo-ft structures the sag values to such span cover approximately for the strengths, separately to be installed and complete calculations and overhead which to a substation span Stringing expanded line, used on the rest of the transmission of a stringing prestressed. ground he disastrous. spans values the of the are overhead of the sizes and None sag data and design of conductors spans that at the the are computed for approach Tables-Stringing conductors for may suspension Dead-ended tension used is wrong. far off-the prepared Sag the of structure clearances are too data Data.-(u) LINE DESIGN MANUAL be clipped and The to end the point selection of line, calculations. The insulator string ofthe in) must be held in a vertical position last previous temporary while the next section The tension in the conductor while after the suspension clamp is clipped in the stringing to the conductor, or lower than the tension insulator string clipped in may the line is brought swing to the towards proper or away of should of sag. from new section sheaves may be higher so the last suspension of line being brought to sag if the insulator is CHAPTER V-ADDITdONAL DATA 293 Figure 116.-Conductor tensions running stringing sheaves. not properly held sagging and clipping to sheave a reference string clamp for sag by mark in a vertical position. in of the conductor is equal to the and sag correction at any point in a conductor length of the ordinate data is given of uniform of the curve in the error in the is brought sag plus correction) of several spans, under the point where each insulator following cross section at the using free vertical, a serious After the conductor Clipping in is then started at any structure by placing offset distance and direction from the reference mark. offset Procedure The tension is not held could occur. checking the corrected sag (stringing chart should be placed on the conductor directly is supported. at the proper calculating If the insulator in the new section when given the center of the suspension An explanation of a method paragraphs. suspended point in the form times the unit of a catenary force conductor. At support A on figure 117: Directrix 2 +” 1 Figure 117.-Dimensions required for calculating stringing operations. 104-D-1 119. insulator offset and sag correction data during of the 294 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL T, = WYA in span 1 +Y, - Y,)inspan2 T, =W(YA T, - T, = W(Y, - Y,) where : W = force of conductor in newtons per meter (pounds per foot) T, and T, = conductor tensions in newtons (pounds) = difference in elevation between the directrices of the two cantenaries, which is also the difference in elevation between the low points of sag in the two spans, in meters (feet) y2 - Yl A table with the following column headings should be made: Column 1: Station number. This shows the survey station 2: Span length L, in meters (feet) 3: Yz- Yt in meters (feet). This value Column Column the low points at the stringing be essentially sheets. Column 4: of sags in spans adjacent temperature; however, the same at any W( yZ- Y,), given ( W) (col. shows the where each difference structure in elevation is located. Yz- Yl between to each structure. These sags should be the initial sags because the difference between sags in the two spans will Ys- Yr may be measured on the plan-profile temperature, 3), in newtons (pounds). This value shows the Tz-Tl, on the two sides of the structure. between the conductor tensions, Column 5: Assumed tension Hin newtons (pounds). This value shows an assumed component Hof the tension (called horizontal tension for convenience) in the conductor in the stringing at the stringing sheaves. For temperature this assumption, use the initial horizontal as shown on the sag-tension calculation difference horizontal as it hangs tension of the conductor form. Assume this tension to be in a certain span (generally, it is best to use one of the longer spans) and compute the tensions in other spans by adding or subtracting increments from column 4. (pounds). This value shows the difference between Column 6: H,H, (& -col. S), in newtons the horizontal H in each Column tension span with 7: Offset in the the Kin conductor conductor millimeters at the ruling K= lOOOW2 L3 mm/N 12H,,3 This value in tension. slack per Column in slack in this shows the change The sum of the column span corresponding is the overall or K=- change and w2 L3 in slack in a span corresponding values in this column gives the pound) change in the tension 8: Trial offset, (col. 6) (col. for each Ho span the assumed horizontal tension hanging in the stringing sheaves. per newton (inches per pound). for the complete 7), in millimeters to the of slack unbalanced Hl13 in/lb to a one-newton (one-pound) change total change in slack per newton (or section of line (inches). This tensions. for the complete The section being value considered. shows the algebraic of line, based sum of the change values on the assumed CHAPTER tensions. sum the This is a positive line. The sum must he zero value, If the sum should sum of column be applied that to the Ho-H 9: Column 10: Column 11: Modulus by Corrected offset, of column (col. 295 has been he subtracted sum he added to the 7 is the assumed in each from complete the complete total span. section section correction If the of the in tension of line. which of line. column correction must must section corrected, DATA tension amount the complete correct of slack that 8 divided Column if the amount is negative, V-ADDITIONAL 6 - (2 col. 7) (col. 8/X col. 7), in newtons 9), in millimeters in millimeters (pounds). (inches). (inches) 1OOOL (col. 9) mm or AE 12L (col. 9) in AE where : A = area of conductor in square millimeters (square inches) E = modulus of conductor in gigapascals (pounds per square inch) Column 12: Final correction in millimeters (inches). (Z col. 10 + x col. 11) (col. 7) z col. 7 Columns (col. 9, 10, 11, and 11) is the in columns corrections in length 13: Final amount Column the amount of the 11 should proportional Column the change 10 and 12 are used equal of offset (col. required 14: Sum of offsets, necessary to offset span. (running sum insulator change be made in column 13), in millimeters string from the vertical. in millimeters modulus The sum correction of the values in either of these 12 to offset these remainders. (inches). This value shows (inches). This value shows 12), in millimeters of col. spans. while in sheaves The in tension. is a remainder 11 + col. in each each of the offsets in the individual Column 15: Sag correction must col. in the offsets. with If there length 10 + corrections conductor zero. to the span offset, to make This offset columns, is the summation (feet) (3H, )(col. 10) (3H,,)(col. 10) (2W)(col. 2) mm Or (2W)(col. 2) (1/12) ft This column conductors shows are in the the amount stringing that sheaves will be necessary to obtain to correct the correct the sag in each sag after the span while conductor the is clipped in. The long rough and offset as the terrain accurate and sag correction individual where offset the offset computer data as computed for one span is not in any one span program should in such in excess in a section be used instead a table should of 381 mm of line of may this (15 in). be sufficiently For accurate installations exceed 381 mm, simplified method. a more It as on very detailed is usually TRANSMISSION 296 unnecessary in one to consider operation, the the offset and corrections LINE DESIGN MANUAL sag correction calculated data are within if, in a section all three of line of the following Line conductor mm w (1) Maximum summation of offsets at any structure (2) Maximum difference between summations of offsets at adjacent structures (3) Maximum sag correction in any span The same conductors procedure should A sample as described he used problem for to calculate has been worked out in both kcmil), ACSR, sagged limits: Overhead ground wire mm (id (6) 76 (3) 76 (3) 51 (2) 305 (12) 305 (12) the data is being 152 calculating similar that for offset the metric and overhead and U.S. sag correction ground customary data for line wires. units to illustrate this procedure: Example Conductor: Full load 644 mm2 conditions: Maximum Initial tension tension (1272 13-mm under at 15.5 (l/2-in) full ‘C load (60 45/7 radial conditions “F) (Bittern) ice with = is 26 040 a 0.19-kPa 53 378 N (5854 (4-lh/ft2) wind at -18 ’ C (0 ’ F) N (12 OOd lb) lb) widh a korresponding sag of 12 485 mm (40.96 ft). Area of conductor A = Initial modulus of conductor 689 mm2 AE = 32 162 542 N H,, = T- Ws = 26 040 - Initial E (1.068 = (7 230 46.678 Figures shows in the 118 and 119 the stationing, procedure is shown GPa (6.77~10~ lb/in2) = N 360 lb) (20.9277)(12.485) = 5854 - (1.434)(40.96) 120 in2) 25 778 = 5795 lb show the sag and tension calculations elevations, and span lengths for the in tables 36 and 37. for the given conductor, and figure sample problem. The table described CHAPTER OCm-678 V-ADDITIONAL DATA 297 (3-78) :":nT:"L' SAGCALCULATIONS Ml 2 CONDUCTORst'jmm R/7%7" //3Sf .4547 LOADING& Code Nams Linear Force Fnclor: @3 Rated Breaking Strength/q Diameter .A N Dead Load Force (W’) i?t&d! Permanenr set 0.00 Qa. CreepO.OOQ *s Tenston Llmlt*tions: Initial.- %.Ai-K- Final.!. ;;;“y+f$- N 25 8g9 N o.ow Exp.: jc A= Initial +!ZZt// Final AE OzL&perOC Dare ~ Initial */977 T~cp-/UNSTRESSEG LENGTN LOADING Ice HEX. ./ N/l? Modulus. (E) Final &.c&&- Temp. Coeff. of Linear %- Computed by yd, sqj Total O.CQd6? Area (A)amd -N Final .- 15.5% .- ,“; (W”‘) Resultant: % -N Loaded.~oC.5oW /dn?m N/m mm jb. GPa /,,79 44I//9 GPa 009 AE .& ,” x=d3782 SAG, mfn 1 SAGFACTOR / 3 '; I SPAN LENGTH(S 1 SW,N 1 TENSION, N NO Ice. No Wind (W’) Figure DC-578 118.Sag and tension calculation form for example problem on insulator offset and sag correction (metric). (3.73) !;,p CONDUCTOR&J 7 Code Nams Riftcrn Rated Breaking Diameter Tenston LOADING k'eavv 14, Load J!!.?+ Weight Factors: ,? , /ofi Dead Weight lb + ‘/Lin. inch Llmltatlons: o lb Final *OF*%- Compuled by - LOADING IbItt 3,gy 0 Wind Resultant: lb OFa%- (W’) ./, Ice (W”) &lb Initial ,OF&s. Loaded, Final. *OF- SAGCALCULATIONS jb Area (A) /,& in2 Temo. Coeff. of Linear Exp.: lb Total 0.000 0 a jc TEMP.. oF UNSTRESSED LFJGTH i! per “F 1 Modulus. (E) Final 51.36 Initial mx f=o.3/ x 103 lb/i&? 105 lb/in2 NE% lzl k=O.&7 SAGFACTOR 1 Y 0.00~~. :iIi: ?R/977 % -lb Date 7 Creep o.ooni2f- 78/T 3.‘0073 (W”‘) Permanent Set O.OOti? Ib/ft SAG.fl A”,’ +z?z?- 1 SW,Ib :,” 1 TENSION,Ib SPAN LENGTH(S) -FEET No Ice. No Wind (W) 120 Figure 119.~Sag customary). I/,nn3 and tension 922 IO. d/l/3 a & 7 lo. QQ&&@ calculation form / I / 1 for example I problem I on insulator i/hi/9. JL49. offset / I / I and sag correction (U.S. 298 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 365.76 (1200) 457.2 -I 335.28 (1500) 426.72 (1400) 396.24 (1300) (1100) g + E 03 \ fcr; .l”.J. j 7c I ” fImn\ \trvv, -. -.38 (1225) 304.8 (IqOO) *. 381 (1250) \x L 335.28 (D g I (1100) \ylooo~ A 2 243.84 ZOO) I Y-1 213.36 (700) 182.88 (600: 1 All values shown are in meters (feet) 152.4 (500) Figure 120.-Profile of spans for example problem on insulator offset and sag correction. 104-D-1120. Table 36.-Data from example problem on insulator offset and sag correction (metric) 1 Station 2 SP k@h L. 3 4 y, - y, . In m WY2 - Yt) W(3), N 5 Asrunltd H, N 6 7 Ho-H. H, - (5). N 20+72.64 365.760 24+38.40 28642 -50.597 27583 -41.148 -861 -45.110 -944 -1805 .08030 -944 (6) _ z (8) (7)(9), 2:0’N - 13 Fhul mnectlon lOOOL(9) [Z(lO) + Z(11#7) AE’ mm Z(7) 15 14 FiMl sum of ofr33t ofY3et3 (lo)+ (ll)+ (12). “E). ' mm .% cofr3ction whikln SiHwus 3Ho (10) 2wo’ mm mm 0 -299 -2445 -255 -28 0 -283 -43.5% -912 -52.121 -1091 358.140 -13% -145 -111 -14 0 -1288 -125 -612 .11091 -105 -525 -58 -6 0 -287 -64 -472 25778 365.760 38+93.82 0.104 26 -2864 (6) (7). Corrected Corrected Moduhu Ho-H offat correction 12 -408 26722 381.000 35+28.06 1000 3Ls 3 128s , mm/N Trill OffwA 11 -283 373.380 31+47.06 K 10 9 -1059 335.280 27+73.68 8 othet pr Newton 0 ,117 84 0 419 49 5 0 238 54 -418 24 866 912 .I0426 95 1331 139 15 0 154 2003 .09788 196 2422 237 27 0 264 702 -264 23775 42+51.% 1223 0 Tot& 0.615 45 -258 l1 - -1 Numbers in parentheses are column numbers. Table 37.-Data from example problem on insulator offset and sag correction (U.S. customary) 1 2 3 4 W(Y,-Y,) W(3). lb 5 A33llmd H, lh 6 7 8 Ho-H. 0ff33t po:d Ho - (5). K lb W2L3 Trial off3et (6);)~ 10 9 cofaected fim offmt Ho-H (6)-z, 11 Modulur 12 FillsI 13 FiMl 14 Sumof whikhl (7) (9h 3heavel la Ho3. lb in 3Ho 1200 8o+oo 91+00 103+25 1100 1225 1250 115+75 6439 -lag 2W(2) ft -194 -148 -212 -171 1175 -549.6 -10.04 .014 06 -5.725 -311.6 -4.38 -117.6 -2.28 26 -1.09 0 0.0017 -11.13 -0.57 .0013 -4.95 6201 -4% 6007 -212 .01942 -4.113 5795 0 .02064 0 -0.24 .0018 -2.52 55% 205 .01826 5345 450 .01714 94.4 1.95 0.20 .cm19 2.15 3.751 299.4 5.47 0.60 .0017 6.07 7.695 544.4 9.33 1.06 .0016 10.39 -205 1200 127+75 -11.785 0.018 -238 -135 -143 -644 -245 139+50 TOti Numbers in parentheses are column numbers. -0.107 -78 (10) - in in/lb 68+00 15 SW w ‘II -10.177 +a05 -0.04 -11.1 -16.1 -18.6 -16.4 -4.2 -2.0 -0.9 0.8 2.3 -10.4 0 4.0 -1 0 12 , 300 TRANSMISSION 31. Transmission Line Equations.-If and there are no later reroutes; in numerical notation and there start work on the equation will Assume crew the line, also that starts same result two from 4752 2370+66.4 while second this point is Sta. 2370+ 66.4Bk belongs to the part of the line that station in the two other crews (fig. 121). is surveyed from one end to the other, he one of a line ends meet or more after of a line station equations a survey and which at a common toward is the point crew designates it as Sta. 2374+31.2. in the has been work on the line, the The 200+364.8 If the station and the length If the length ahead line These is greater is shortened One length they will common equation of each point as to identify = Sta. 2374 + 31.2Ah. The Bk means backand indicates that station behind the common point. Similarly, Ah means ahead and indicates lengths may of the common point. will be 475 200-364.8 be in meters or feet, There is a difference of 364.8 = 474 835.2 if there are no depending = 475 564.8 if there are no other equations (fig. 122). back is greater than the station ahead, then there is an overlap of the line is increased by the amount of overlap (fig. 123). station of the An other. on the units Assume the crew which started at the beginning of the line determines that the meeting Sta. 2374+31:2, and the crew starting at the end of the line says the point is Sta. 2370+66.4. equation will then read Sta. 2374+ 31.2Bk = Sta. 2370+66.4Ah, and the line length will 475 line. completed. each approximate point, but the values will be different. at the beginning of the line designates belongs to the section of line ahead designations, and the length of line equations will at an assumed the two that common which started the there at opposite other line equally spaced stations will increase uniformly in the line. However, if two or more survey crews of a portion start the + 00. When have a station value for Assume that the crew Sta. and points, a reroute crews 0 +00 a transmission then all successive, will he no equations at different survey at Sta. say Sta. line LINE DESIGN MANUAL than by the the station value back, of the length then there of the of station is a gap in the gap (fig. 124). used. point is The then be designations stationing and the 2360+002360+00 - 2370+00 2370+00- on 2374+31.2Bk EQUATION on 2370+66.4Ah -1 :--I .J r ---I Station 2370+66.4Bk- EQUATION St&ion 2374+31.2Ah 1 I 1 I L ---me I 1--1 2380+00- 2380+00- TRANSMISSION 302 Figure 123.Station ahead Figure 124.-Station LINE DESIGN designations designations when station when station MANUAL back is greater than station ahead is greater than station back. << Bibliography [l] “Rules for Public [2] Overhead Utilities “National Electrical Electrical [3] and “National and Martin, Ehrenhurg, D. pp. 719-728, [6] “Copperweld [7] Rodee, H. [8] Bissiri, [9] Austin, Level of the A., Standards York, Stover, 1946. [ 1 l] “Wire Rope of print) [12] Rodee, [13] “A O., “Transmission July 1935. Alcoa the Line New [14] Clayton, Trans. H. Method Report, Use Landau, Catenary M., Steel Overhead Conductor Pa. 15219, 1961. CcBroken Conductor H., “S agging at the Fall Handbook,” American 230-kV,” Conductors in a Series General Trans. Engineering of print) of Steel of the Data on Sags AIEE, No. in Suspension Meeting, and Wire Oklahoma Co. of New Spans,” Co., vol. 54, 8, Aluminum Spans,” City, Okla. vol. 83, pp. 1102-1110, Phenomena Edition, 1929. December in High-Voltage Conference on Large Jersey, AIEE 73101, Lightning Performance of Transmission AIEE, vol. 69, pp. 1187-1196, 1950. Lightning Performance Young, F. S., “Estimating International 401, Trans. 1940. Conference October Lines,” (out Paper 23-27, AIEE 6, 1950. Committee of Transmission Lines,” 1964. Engineering,” McGraw-Hill, of Calculating Corona New Loss York, From High vol. 56, pp. 558-565, May 1937. Measurements of Corona Loss Above Electric Systems at High Tension (CIGRE), vol. Voltage Overhead Tension (CIGRE), Lines,” International Paper 413, vol. III, 1960. Robertson, Project,” L. M., and Dillard, J. K., Trans. of the AIEE, vol. Pedde, L. D., et al., “Metric Manual”, Denver, Colo. 80225, 1978. N.Y. Institute Edition. Co., Glassport, Pa. 15045, 1942. Calculations for ACSR and Other of Inclined III, 1950. Investigation on Extra-High Burgsdorf, V. V., “Corona Conference on Large Electric Systems at High Aluminum Inc., 1977 Copperweld for Estimating Trans. of the J. M., and of the AIEE, Paper York, of (out Steel Method Carroll, J. S., and Rockwell, M. M., “E mpirical Voltage Transmission Lines,” Electrical Engineering, Peterson, W. S., Cozzens, B., and Carroll, J. S., “Field “The Institute Edition. Institute, Tables,” Effect [16] [20] of California Inc., Sixth 10017, Calculations,” Peek, F. W., “Dielectric N.Y. 10017, Third [19] N.Y. of Martin’s [15] June State Institute, 10017, Standards York, Charts,” Copperweld Method for Sag-Tension Aluminum Pittsburgh, Engineering presented [ 181 95, AIEE, vol. 66, pp. 1181-1188, 1947. Insulator Effect on Tension and Sag for Short and Approximately T. M., ‘?Determine Spans,” Electrical World, p. 100, April 4, 1955. Insulator Effect in Substation Span Sags,” Electrical World, p. 62, July J. R., ” Strain [lo] [17] N.Y. National Inc., by No. 1931. of America, and New American Calculations 15045, National Inc., Engineers, Sag Calculating H., “Graphic Conductors,” Company American Code,” Order 1, 1960. Engineers, Safety Pa. [5] Code,” Electronics General Construction,” November Safety J. S., “Sag Glassport, Line Electronics Electrical Electrical [4] Electric Commission, Electrical 10017, First Conductor Edition, “Leadville High-Altitude 80, pp. 715-725, U.S. Department Handbook,” September The 1971. 303 Extra:High-Voltage December 1961. of the Interior, Bureau Aluminum Association, Test of Reclamation, 750 Third Ave., New TRANSMISSION 304 “Stress-Strain-Creep Curves Association, 750 “Amerstrand New Steel York, Edwards, vol. Pittsburg, Pa. Shielding,” on T. A., of the AIEE, vol. Systems,” L. M., 8, pp. “EHV 10016, “Lightning No. Steel 22, Tension, Book,” and Wire Paper 22-69 Electra No. Line Co., (WGOl), 12, April Conductors,” Westinghouse of Air Gap Line F., and Electric 87, Thompson, 1970. Trans. Corp., East No. R. L., IEEE of Transmission Line 1, pp. 270-281, ‘?Influence Trans., January of Air Power 196 Density Apparatus and 1967. for Transmission Line Design at the Higher Voltages,” Trans. 1954. Systems, Surge and Characteristics Reference Studies vol. Insulation,” August Apparatus and Analytical Systems, of Switching Power Withstand Systems, vol. Voltages 83, No. on Line-to-Ground vol. Book,” 86, No. Edison Switching 8, pp. Electric for 936-947, Surge August Institute, EHV 3, pp. 263-266, Insulation March 1964. Strength,” IEEE 1967. 90 Park Avenue, New Book 345-kV York, 1968. Performance Above, American of Transmission and and Line 1192-1197, Apparatus Transmission N.Y. pp. Trans., Power at High Spacing “Field A. 948-961, Determination L., “Influence Trans., R., Rohlfs, Clearances 73, IEEE Aluminum 1946. Apparatus of Transmission No. “The The Committee Reference E. Power Strength J. B., The 1950. Trans., 86, Study Systems October Conductors,” 1974. Handbook,” and Distribution Whitehead, P. L., ” Electrical Owens, 690-694, Robertson, vol. Electric Electrical 10017, CIGRE on Large and and IEEE Systems, Paris, of print) 65, pp. R., Electrical Bellashi, Construction of Insulation 15222, H. Phillips, and Galloping,” Transmission Armstrong, N.Y. (out “Co-ordination AIEE, “Electrical Overhead York, 1943. Conference W. W., Aluminum New Catalog 10001, ccConductor International of the for Ave., Strand N.Y. A. T., Lewis, Third LINE DESIGN MANUAL Electric of EHV-UHV Power Research Lines,” Institute, Transmission 3412 Hillview Line Avenue, Reference Palo Alto, Calif. and 94304, Ch. 12, 1975. “Optimized Transmission Schenectady, “Aeolian N.Y. Vibrations Tension vol. 185, pp. H-Frame Sarikas, Line,” February and Broadway, General Electric Co., 22-11, Pa. 15219, Reduce (out Aeolian Systems at High 1970. Conductor 1961. Electric Engineering Data No. 4., of print) Vibration,” Electrical World, 1976. Z. J., and Power Dimensions for Wood York, 10018, N.Y. Specification Association, Handbook: Products August New Design Products 1, Paper on Large Overhead Trotter, Apparatus Poles,” ANSI R. L., and Systems, “Sidney-Cayuga vol. 84, 345-kV No. 2, pp. Wood 93-106, American Laboratory, 1974. for As An Forest West Coast Stress-Grade Lumber D.C. 1973 Washington Wood National 20020, .Engineering Service, Standards Institute, Inc., 1430 05.1-1972. Grading Rules for West Coast Lumber,” 97208, No. 16, Rev. January 1, 1973. “National “Wood vol. Dampers Andracki, Trans., Seminars, 1965. “Specifications “Standard Oreg. IEEE 22, Pittshurg, 15, Engineering Conference Aluminum Line March R. H., No. Alcoa “Customized 108-109, G. P., Utility 1974. International Committee of America, L. A., Electric 21-23, Lines,” Vibration,” Company Kirkpatrick, Wilson, Study Conductor Aluminum Design,” October on Overhead (CIGRE), ccOverhead Line 12345, U.S. Material,” Dept. Lumber and Its Inspection Fastenings,” Bureau, National Portland, Forest Edition. Agriculture Handbook of Agriculture, Washington, No. 72, Forest D.C. 20250, Rev. BIBLIOGRAPHY ‘Standard Coast “Wood of the Specifications Lumbermen’s Pole for Structural Association, Maintenance,” Interior, Denver, Power Colo. Glued Laminated Portland, 0. 80225, and 305 Oreg. M. 1974. Bulletin Douglas 97208, No. 1962 Fir (Coast Edition; 30, Bureau Region) Rev. Timber,” West 1963. of Reclamation, U.S. Dept. <<Appendix A A METHOD FOR COMPUTING TRANSMISSION LINE SAGS AND TENSIONS IN SPANS ADJACENT TO A BROKEN CONDUCTOR A thesis by G. R. Wiszneauckas’ I-INTRODUCTION Description of the Problem.-The determination of sag and conductor or cable under various conditions of temperature the mechanical design of a transmission line. It is of equal of sag and tension from the simple cases of symmetrical nonsymmetrical to a broken and special spans, none conductor. The determination special case for the reason such as railroad, highway, national and/or Purpose of the local conductor thesis which methods now date, several methods or techniques have problem; however, in many of the methods Study of Initial in this case all such in of adjacent in this is to develop a technique been proposed rather severe for the solution limitations have assumed for any particular problem without making Another somewhat undesirable aspect common to procedures. These factors set forth the purpose or method by which the sags and while accounting in essence the tensions to some trial-and-error in a series degree for the aspects of in use. II-DEVELOPMENT OF A TECHNIQUE STRESSES DUE TO A BROKEN that is before the tensions, and span any of structure heights necessary at critical points or power line crossings in order to comply with of spans adjacent to a broken conductor can be computed asymmetries present in any particular case and eliminating the for codes. been imposed in that level, equal spans have been corrections to account for existing asymmetries. most methods is the time consuming trial-and-error of this tension least of which is the case of a series of spans of sags and corresponding tensions is important that it assures the designer waterway, telephone line, safety of Thesis.-To broken the corresponding and loading is of basic importance importance to extend this determination spans to the more complicated cases and Final Conditions .-In the broken conductor breaks, is one of static lengths known. The final condition quantities are unknown. The 307 This conductor equilibrium is likewise diagrams ’ Former Electrical Engineer with Bureau of Reclamation. Science from the University of Colorado in 1949. FOR ANALYZING CONDUCTOR shown method problem the initial condition, with all quantities such as sags, one of static equilibrium; however, in figures 1 and 2 have been given was his thesis for the degree of Master of 308 TRANSMISSION to illustrate in general these initial and final insulator strings and their deflections have other elements of the spans shown in order consideration. A study of figure 2 reveals the complexity in order to maintain static equilibrium after a method for treating this problem by not been made temporarily: (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) LINE DESIGN MANUAL conditions. In figures 1 and 2, as in those following, the been shown somewhat exaggerated as compared to the to present a more readable picture of the features under of the conditions which must be satisfied simultaneously the conductor breaks. To facilitate the development of complicating it further, the following assumptions have Level, equal spans exist before the conductor breaks. Conductor breaks at mid-span. No deflection of supporting structure as a result of the conductor breaking. No slipp in g o f conductor in its clamps as a result of the conductor breaking. The changes in elevation of the conductor after the conductor breaks are negligible. The insulator acts as a rigid body. After a procedure has been established for dealing with the problem under the above assumptions, criteria will be presented by which assumptions (a), (b), an d (c) can be removed entirely. For most cases the assumption made under assumption (d) is valid; however, conductor clamps are sometimes set to slip at a predetermined tension, in which case this assumption may not be in order. The assumptions made under assumptions (e) and (f) are reasonable for all but very special cases. Further study of figure 2 shows that the forces acting as a result of a conductor breaking can be resolved into two opposing horizontal forces. Herein lies the basis for the technique which has been developed. Study of the P Force.-Referring again to figure 2, the horizontal force designated P is the force which retards or damps the effects of the broken conductor and may be considered as the equal and opposite of the force required to deflect an insulator string by any angle 0 while a vertical load is acting. The relation between this force, P, and the vertical load can be developed from figure 3. Again, assuming that the insulator string acts as a rigid body and also that its gravity axis is midway between the conductor and the attachment hinge, the following relations can be written: For equilibrium at any angle 8, Wd = P ‘v or P ‘= Wd/v. Also, cos 8 = v/i and tan 8 =’ d/v = P/W from which P = Wd/v ; therefore, P = P : Also, P = Wd/i cos 8, which is a form more convenient for calculation. Insofar as the broken conductor problem is concerned, this relation should be interpreted as: P is the horizontal force which resists the movement of an insulator string of length i from the vertical to any angle 8 while a vertical load W is acting. Study of the H Force.-The horizontal force designated H in figure 2 is the horizontal component of tension acting in the conductor or cable. Insofar as the broken conductor problem is concerned, the relation between this force and a change in span length, such as might be caused by the deflection of an insulator string, is of primary importance and can be developed from figure 4 as follows: The length of conductor in the initial span is: I =*fJo 0- W WLO sinh - *HO APPENDIX The length of conductor in the span after a change 309 A of 4 is: I, =-24 sinh w(L, -#I W The change from Ho in conductor HI to length 24 due to the elastic properties of the conductor in changing the tension is: U-4,- H,) U,) AE Then, barring temperature conductor length length is increased By substituting and/or plus or minus or decreased, the values loading changes, the change in the II le, the elastic i.e. found above for and final conductor conductor length must depending equal on whether the the initial span 2Hl sinh W w(Lo _ @) or sinh 2H, = HI and solving for Cp: k. $=L, By way of interpretation, 4, the horizontal tension The forces Relations become of which will figure 11. Consider which also Between the aids from P in the a simple +, Hoi:J SinhO’ this means that when in the cable changes invaluable progress - ‘G sirthzi(l and H solution special a span from of length to Ho Forces.-The of the L e is HI. changed relations broken case as shown as developed conductor in figure first the case of a conductor breaking in a span adjacent outlines the conditions to be satisfied simultaneously in length problem, 5 to a general by an amount for the the P and H development case as shown in to a dead end as shown in figure in order to maintain equilibrium. 5, TRANSMISSION 310 Although these common presented: conditions are trial-and-error If the P and simple procedures H relations, and LINE DESIGN few, considerable to evaluate previously MANUAL them. developed, effort In could contrast, are plotted the with be expanded following a common in using solution system of coordinates as shown in figure 6, the resulting curves will intersect at some point which, upon examination, prove to be the only point in the system which could possibly satisfy simultaneously all necessary and sufficient to demonstrate lies, for this instance, conditions solution above which the point must compare The and value of d will be less than likewise, will be greater than there with are any Pand Hcurve. the number value of points H curve-which d which trial-and-error procedure Compute Knowing the to the value value this of 6 has been given Hcurve which of the be apparent of Hat to a value Figure any point should or conditions for which P= also the other necessary point, P which that note the the equals the solution value of 4 value of H H, there condition is only that one-the intersection d = $. of this more or less special case, consider next the case of a conductor dead end as shown in figure 7. In this case an additional set of commonly (1) Referring to figure which would be HI. Also, of P1. (2) (3) by studying Pcurve-it corresponds to maintain equilibrium. Pand Hcurves no longer case; however, these required conditions. procedures are as follows: solution. will of the the value of 4 for every point so selected above the intersection, do for every point below the intersection. Note then, that although must be satisfied in order the intersection of the basic as in the previous satisfy all of the the it is the satisfies As a step in the generalization breaking two spans away from conditions seen that with Corresponding of hence, can be substantiated intersection and of the lie on the for equilibrium; the has been of to figure 8, it can easily be all of the required conditions basic curves can be manipulated A method for this manipulation used in other 7, assume a value for based on the assumed Hz, compute Referring satisfies methods. essentials of such which from will the a trial-and-error d 1 and compute the corresponding new tension value for d 1, compute the corresponding value Hz by subtracting the The to obtain values can be derived corresponding PI from value HI. of 4s. (4) From this value of $2, the value of dz can be determined by the relation: dz = $2 + d 1. (5) Pz can now be evaluated since it is a function of dz. If this value for Pz is equal to the value computed for H 2, the initial assumption for the value of d 1 is correct and all other values computed are correct; however, if this is not the case, then a new value must be selected for dl and the entire procedure repeated. value of d 1 which can then be found for HI, Hz, and d 2 can be computed. Usually, by three interpolation, Based on this procedure, a straightforward graphical possible values for dl were assumed, then all possible from which all possible values of Hz could be found. or four trials and corresponding the will bracket the correct correct values analysis can be developed as follows: if all values for HI and PI could be determined This can be accomplished very easily by subtracting graphically, point by point, the abscissa values of the basic Pcurve from those of the basic Hcurve. The resulting curve then represents the locus of all possible values for Hz with respect to d 1. In similar manner, the graphical addition of the ordinates of the newly formed Hz curve, which represents represents all possible all possible also the locus of all possible all possible values of 42, will values values values of d 1 to the ordinates result in forming a new curve of d2 and also represents all possible for Hz with respect to corresponding values values of the basic H curve, which which represents the locus of of Hz with respect of dl and d2 have to dz. Now been defined, that all APPENDIX that remains to be done conditions. Referring is to determine again to figure which A 311 of the 8, it should possible be evident values that some will point satisfy the on the newly ds curve will satisfy the conditions required in the conductor. As in the previous case, at the insulator it will be found string immediately adjacent that there are any number this condition ds = curve which seen that which the can satisfy to the break. can will b, note The next step necessary simple Hz in the and for this required case that only in the previous for bon of the away from to the two the 4s equilibrium + dl. at the first Hcurve at the second would the only insulator string. be point adjacent point which In regard from point down H curve. basic be to add only string to be the vertically to intersect it can u) is the insulator formed to the break of points on inspection, (point it is determined-project problem By ds curve the basic horizontally generalization nature in which the is moved away from and for equilibrium in which thence that Pcurve point conditions make the dead end three spans interest to note the similarities and interrelated conductor breaks prove manner curve basic conditions will necessary the the necessary of the inspection all of the a to intersect the point all of the Further satisfy to point satisfy intersection required another span in the series to the break as shown in figure 9. In this case it will be of previous cases. Of special importance is the progressive requirements the dead end. for equilibrium By comparing occur as the span in which the these requirements, it will be seen one set of conditions is needed to maintain equilibrium in addition case in which the conductor breaks two spans away from the dead to those end. Also, though it may not be immediately apparent, the graphical analysis as developed for the previous case can be utilized in its entirety and requires only an additional step to account for the additional requirements for equilibrium in order to provide the complete solution. This additional step is one which of the is in continuation possible values values H3 with of of those graphically, point of the dz curve found respect for to taken d 2, the in the previous corresponding case, and possible dz can be determined. This consists value can and Based can be substantiated on these can be outlined special from which all all possible by subtracting from the corresponding all possible values of corresponding values of da can be determined by adding graphically, ordinates of the basic Hcurve-thus of the H3 curve to the corresponding which represents the locus of all possible values of H3 with respect case from be accomplished by point, the abscissa values of the basic Pcurve thus forming a new curve, Ha. Then, knowing manipulations have been shown in figure 10. Also indicated points a, 6, and c. These points were obtained in a manner of determining of Ps values the Hs, point by point, the ordinates forming a new curve, df, to da. The results of these is the solution which is represented by similar to that given for the previous likewise. cases, a procedure for solving a general case as represented by figure 11 as follows: (I) Compute and plot values for the basic P and H curves as shown in figure 12. (2) Subtract graphically, point by point, the abscissa values of the basic Pcurve from the abscissa values of the basic H curve to form a new curve, Hz. (3) Add graphically, point by point, the ordinate values of the new Hz curve to the ordinate of the basic H curve Subtract graphically, values (4) abscissa (5) values (6) values of the new to form a new point by point, dz curve curve, dt. the abscissa to form a new curve, values of the basic Pcurve from the HS. Add graphically, point by point, the ordinate values of the new H3 curve to the ordinate of the basic H curve to form a new curve, d 3. Continue this composition process of subtracting abscissa values of the basic Pcurve from those these new of each Hcurves succeeding d curve successively to the ordinate to form new values H curves, and of the basic add Hcurve the ordinate to form values new dcurves of TRANSMISSION 312 until the d,, and be represented H,, curves in which the indicates point (-) (7) The the d,,curve adjacent are established. symbolically H- p=H2 +H=d, point point to the conductor to the curve and to the dn-z across Each intersection insulator span insulator of each by point which . . .H, as described above can +H=d, of abscissa ordinate string which and values values of curves, and the (+) of curves. tension to the and of the converging by the above horizontal and curve across down corresponds is identified as described the H,, curve and the tension in each span and the corresponding procedure +H=d, subtraction of the break break, the procedure solution is then found graphically by stairstepping down from the intersection with the basic P curve, which defines the deflection of the insulator immediately conductor of the composition - P=H, addition to the is reached. The as: indicates by LINE DESIGN MANUAL to the H n-z stairstep to the same in the dn-l with down etc. until the a d curve of the Having immediately and curve, subscript subscript. span curve curve established defines of adjacent to the basic Hn+ Hcurve the deflection the tension and also the deflections in of each span from the conductor break to the dead end, the length sag can he computed by any standard method. The stairstep can be represented symbolically as: 0d,, in which vertical d,, X P indicates projection down horizontal projection, left the intersection from one curve to right, from of d,, and to another, one curve P curves, the vertical and the horizontal to another. The circles arrows arrows indicate indicate indicate a a intersection points of the stairstep with d curves, which points describe insulator deflections and conductor tensions. From the procedure as outlined to this point, a question as to the physical possibility of constructing all of the indicated number of curves for a case in which the nearest dead end is a very great number immediately of spans away from suggests trying to find the the conductor limiting break might logically be raised. Such locus of the d, and H, curves. Fortunately, be done with a fair degree of accuracy. By following the procedure six d and corresponding H curves have been constructed, a tendency regarding the space relations of the intersection points of the dcurves examining will very these space relations closely, it will be found that a geometric closely describe this tendency. Then, it is but a simple convergence point of the and find d,, curve. its sum which, The location a question this can as outlined above until five or of convergence can be noted with the basic Pcurve. Upon series matter can be arranged which to test the series for if existent, will describe the space relations of the intersection can be established by drawing a curve through this point and the Ho point such that it appears to be a member of the family of curves thus far established. many cases, this will be a straight line for practical purposes. From the d,, curve, the H, curve easily established by subtracting abscissa values of the basic Pcurve, point by point, from those the d,, curve. By stairstepping with the basic Pcurve to the on the d,, curve, the insulator down between Ho point, deflection these curves from the intersection and noting the intersection points and tension value for each span point of the of the converging progressing away In is of d,, curve stairstep from the conductor break will be defined. These points present an interesting relation in that regardless of the distance to the nearest dead, end, the effects of a conductor breaking will be damped out for practical purposes in a very few spans. This is in agreement with statements made by other authors on this subject. Figure 16 illustrates in detail a solution for a typical problem by this procedure. APPENDIX To substantiate Since the validity d, and the of stairstepping H,, curves represent curves, it should be evident that for practical purposes one could d n-1000 Hn-2, curve. Likewise, curve. be equally Therefore, number of curves in the family purposes, to operating between appear academic encountered from in practice the break in the Pcurve far and force to ensure scale. This be attained cross-section cases. Criteria adjusting as the since it can represent for the the case in which the H,, the H,, curves previously this aspect majority Hn-l, the end the to represent given of the such reduces, analysis of preliminary dead of together that d,,-2, or even the for may problems is beyond a few spans conductor. feature inspection that feature of this entire in a manner is approached and not some other the question of accuracy. As with the other curves drawn offer sufficient Assumptions .-The far to accommodate following problems spans, it should than the exception, and that any method which does not recognize this fact and the problem. be realized for dealing offers some that point on the horizontal methods, accuracy can on a standard llaccuracy for all but by 15-inch very special is an outline of procedures for with asymmetries, such as unequal and with other variables, such as deflections break which were initially assumed constant. nonsymmetrical the results can easily be shown in figures 4, 6, 8, the d, intersection point with the basic is, reversing the process of composition) Ho point the prompts spans, conductor procedure is that such as has been should be taken to check by resolving them (that for Removing Initial the method developed thus and for as follows: number close between d, and the reason of an unlimited to be so indescribably the d,, , the dn-l, solution any H, curves, positions to distinguish to any degree desired. With this method, sheet as shown in figures 16 or 17, should and nonsymmetrical the point of the unequal will have between d, and the that the stairstep formula the d, and H, curves. While it serves connection, care d,, and H, curves the enough limiting difficult actually Another interesting and useful checked either graphically or by 10 or 12. In this only the it is possible a great practical only, between in theory these curves not distinquish it would Hn-looo or the 313 A such in supporting In dealing a series of spans structures and with a series of is the rule rather with problems regarding such a series of spans means to account for it-is not doing justice to Two criteria can be used to adjust the method developed thus far to account for such asymmetries and variables. One offers an approximate correction at the expense of very little additional work and is suitable for use in making preliminary studies and estimates. The other offers a comparatively exact solution but requires much more a high degree of accuracy. The approximate correction any series of random-length symmetrical spans same distance problem, the in a conductor which will work and is suitable for use in connection is based on the Ruling Span Theory which symmetrical spans, there can be found have the as the random-length implications are then, and the nearest dead same horizontal tension, the same with problems requiring states, in effect, that a series of equal-length for total the slack, and cover series of spans. Applying this theory to the broken conductor that for any series of spans which might exist between a break end, there will exist one series of equal-length symmetrical spans which will best describe the characteristics of the existing series of spans. If such-an equivalent series of spans can be established, the method, as developed, can be applied. In order to establish the equivalent series of spans, a means for determining the equivalent level or symmetrical span for any inclined or nonsymmetrical and is given by a relation * Numbers in brackets span as: will be required. refer to items in the Bibliography, Such a means section VI. has been developed by Martin[8]* TRANSMISSION 314 Equivalent level 20 percent This and relation leaves spans. span = 2 (inclined span makes possible one can the condition be done conversion yet of any The ruling The the more - (horizontal span by using length solution a relation is then the of a typical exact correction series to be fulfilled-that span length). (Safe limit = by into a series of symmetrical an equivalent series spans of equal length of spans. Figure Still[6]. <E length problem of spans of finding given Ruling span length = 16 gives length) slope) only This length LINE DESIGN MANUAL of each by this is accomplished span in the approximate equivalent series method. by recognizing asymmetries as they actually exist and treating them as such without recourse to equivalent arrangements. Treatment of a problem on this basis requires a separate basic Pand H curve for each span involved, and while possible, undue difficulties would be experienced in computing the basic Hcurves for nonsymmetrical spans. In order to alleviate these difficulties, on the equivalent H curve relations previously outlined; but with little or no sacrifice level span of each nonsymmetrical as previously derived. The basic however, for nonsymmetrical in accuracy, H curves the insulator must be taken as equal to the weight of conductor from low point to low can be measured on the plan-profile sheets describing the series of spans under given to illustrate a typical to account only of the conductor conductor the basic break occurs at midspan of the insulator for the actual length of conductor from in the adjacent span. In this connection, curves into Represented steps involved above structure deflection and the horizontal deflecting curve similar in aspect to the basic Pcurve can the ordinates of this curve to the basic Pcurve effects of insulator and structure deflections will as the P incorporated are. By a similar the basic Pcurves. in figure in this procedure, 14 is a solution procedure can by this be outlined into a basic span. H Curve for each the span weight horizontal the basic to the low that if the were inclined so or uplift would position Pcurves which if the is relation force is known to the extent that a be drawn. By adding, point by point, of each span, new curves describing the combined be formed and can be used in the procedure exactly the criteria effects of “hinged” for the typical crossarms case shown may in figure also be 13. The as follows: (1) Compute a basic P curve for each insulator string conductor weights as determined from low-point distances such as structure deflections, hinged crossarms, etc. (2) Compute for each actual This distance Figure 13 is the assumed break point it is interesting to note string and if the adjacent of the span, a negative act on the insulator string which could cause it to deflect generally considered the limiting position. The effects of structure deflection can also be incorporated the point. study. can be generalized under this immediately adjacent to the P curve conductor is assumed to break next to an insulator that its low point would fall sufficiently far outside between descriptive be based problem. The initial assumption that the correction procedure by adjusting break point can span thereby making possible the use of the P curves required can be computed exactly as spans, the weight of conductor acting on each span involved, to be considered, based on actual and based on other considerations based on the equivalent level span APPENDIX (3) Plot (4) Manipulate these curves in the same these curves graphically coordinate H, - pl =H,‘+H, (5) The solution is given by 0d, The justification general case concerns the handling break. out for the of a problem practical depending purposes on the nature One the same reasoning as given could end is a great are all that =d, 0d, which the formula: formula: the effects so that problem, symbolic 4 Hz’-, question cases considered, of the 0d, the dead spans following stairstep follows 11. in which in a few the =d, - Pz +H3’+H3 symbolic solution in figure In this case, as in previous for the 315 system. by X P3 4 H,‘+ above as represented A previously be raised distance away of the broken from 6, 8, or 10 spans need be considered. will away the connection the conductor conductor first for in this be damped from the break, III-SUMMARY To summarize, catenary relations the discussion for determining presented insulator outlines a general and/or structure method or procedure deflections and based on special conductor tensions in spans adjacent to a broken conductor. Knowing these deflections and tensions, the corresponding conductor sags can be computed by the use of standard catenary relations. The method, while graphical in nature, is capable of a high degree of accuracy and is straightforward; that is, it does not involve conductor method the usual problem with those The Solution conductor to facilitate selected. tension By trial-and-error procedures. In appendix has been worked out and a comparison as obtained by another method. of a Typical Broken problem has been worked a comparison of results, The details of the problem in span A if the conductor A-l made IV-APPENDIX A-l Conductor Problem.-In which follows, a typical of the results as obtained the following, a typical out to illustrate the techniques the typical problem used by broken by this broken presented. For this purpose and Bissiri and Landau[4] has been are given in figure 15. The requirement breaks next to insulator No. 6. is to find the sag and the approximate method the procedure is as follows: (1) Using the nomograph given in figure 18, convert the series of given spans into a series of level spans. Since all equivalent level span lengths are less than 2 feet more than the horizontal span lengths (2) Using spans into series. (3) of 4. a series Using These shown, all spans the Ruling Span the values of level equal will be assumed level without correction. Computation Chart given in figure 18, convert spans. Take H force formula, assume are given in table A. (4) Using the P f orce formula; P. These values are given in table assume B. 970 feet as the values for HI values of d and span length and compute compute the series for the equal corresponding corresponding of level level span values values of TRANSMISSION 316 (5) Plot curves the computed according to the values Since the dead (6) by Bissiri the end he assumed, For dead will the the dead dead end 04 The By 16 and manipulate the resulting Pand - P=H, and . . .H,, +H=d, Landau) first, does a great not state distance away the location and, of the second, nearest at insulator end a great results distance away, XPJ-H,,+ at insulator No. 0d, XP+H,+ are tabulated in table the solution is given by the symbolic formula: @H/@...H,, d 1, the solution 0d, J-&-, is given by 0d, rH,+ the $Hp symbolic formula: 0d, E. the more exact method, the procedure is as follows: (1) Compute an Hcurve for each span. Assume that span E is dead ended at insulator No. 1 and that all spans are level spans without correction since the correction is less than 2 feet for each span. These (2) Compute values are given in table C. a P curve for each suspension table D. (3) Plot the according to the H HE-P, The The results Discussion between and symbolic P curves formula: as shown +HE)+HD =d3- P3 =HD’+Hc=d,- (4) the typical solution are tabulated by the in table of Results.-Considering problem, the is given methods the results check lies in the insulator in figure string. 1’7 and P., =Hc’+H,=d, following symbolic values manipulate are them -Ps =HB”HA given graphically =d6 -Ph =HA’ E. made by armor rods, vibration dampers, etc., were acting. Since several times that of a conductor, the effects of such relative magnitudes of the tension in formula: the inherent differences each other as well as could assumption These Bissiri between the methods used to solve he expected. The principal difference and Landau- that the conductor length in the span adjacent to a break is increased by the length of the insulator string immediately adjacent to the break. Theoretically, this would be true only if the weight distribution over the insulator string were the same as that over the conductor, and if no concentrated loads such as holddown weights, on the H E. 0d, For +H=d, (as given 1 in span in figure MANUAL formula: program end, No. as shown symbolic H- p=H2 LINE DESIGN in the system the unit weight a discontinuity to the total of an insulator string of weight distribution weight of conductor, is usually depend insulators, APPENDIX and concentrated has a varying low loads effect, comprising being more the system. correct for A Hence, long 317 the spans assumption with high made tensions by Bissiri than and for short Landau spans with tensions. V-APPENDIX To Chart facilitate and are given Figure conductor several certain a Sag and on the following 20 shows can specific computations Tension a typical be facilitated. ruling span such Computation pages lengths Chart as figures set of data The as made by by the in Appendix have 18 and span-tension A-2 which A-l, devised. a Ruling These Span Computation are self-explanatory and 19, respectively. preliminary curves approximate been have method studies been of the plotted as presented from effects data herein. of a broken computed for W E Table A.-H curve computation H,, = 4400 lb; L, = 970 ft; w = 1.57 lb/ft; 1 Hl 2 Ho&h- 3 WLO l-- Ho-H, 765.2528 765.2528 765.2528 765.2528 5 6 (4) (2) (3) AE WO 2300 2500 3000 4000 4 AE = 6,635,672 slnh-’ 7 (5) H, 0.999638 .999713 .999789 .999939 765.0106 765.0331 765.0913 765.2066 0.33261 .30601 .25500 .19130 0.3268 .3015 .2524 .1902 8 9 4 5 Wl -r (6) (7) 2929.936 3184.713 3821.650 5095.540 957.503 959.880 964.584 969.171 Lo - (8) 12.5 10.12 5.42 0.83 zi z E Z m Numbers in parenthesis are column numbers. Table B.-P curve computation Wd p=- ic0sll W = 1655 lb; i = 12.58 ft = 150.96 in d d A i case ii 0.1987 .3975 0.4803 .9178 0.2027 .4331 335.5 716.8 90 120 130 .5962 .7949 .8611 .8028 .6074 so90 .7426 1.3086 1.6910 1229.0 2165.7 2798.6 ic0se P Table C . -2 curve computations Ho = 4400 lb; w = 1.57 lb/ft; AB = 6,635,672 Lo = 880,910,980, and 1050 ft 1 880 2 3 4 5 (2) (3) H, (4) 6 7 slnh-’ (5) 8 16) (7) 9 Lo - (‘3) D 869.350 10.6 : s 0 z 2200 2500 3000 4000 693.6416 693.6416 693.6416 693.6416 0.999668 .999714 .999789 .999939 693.4116 693.4429 693.4951 693.5996 0.3152 .2774 .2309 .1734 0.3102 .2739 .2289 .1725 2802.548 3184.710 3821.660 5095.540 872.292 874.777 878.981 ;:‘2 910 2200 2500 3000 4000 717.4822 711.4822 717.4822 711.4822 .999668 .999714 .999789 .999939 717.2443 717.2768 717.3308 717.4384 .3260 .2869 .2389 .1794 .3205 .2831 .2366 .1783 2802.548 3184.710 3821.660 5095.540 898.216 901.591 904.205 908.980 11.8 8.4 5.8 1.02 980 2300 2500 3000 4000 773.2210 773.2210 773.2210 773.2210 .999683 .999714 .999789 .999939 772.9763 772.9996 773.0579 773.1744 .3361 .3092 .2574 .1933 .3300 .3044 .2547 .1921 2929.936 3184.710 3821.660 5095.540 996.879 969.426 973.377 978.853 13.12 10.6 6.62 1.15 1050 2500 3000 4000 829.0365 829.0365 829.0365 .999714 .999789 .999939 828.7991 828.8616 828.9865 .3315 .2760 .2072 .3258 .2727 .2058 3184.710 3821.660 5095.540 1037.597 1042.166 1048.662 12.4 7.83 1.34 ' Numbers in parenthesis are column numbers. 1.02 D Table D.-P Curve computations p=wd i cosd i = 12.58 ft = 150.96 in d i8 90 120 130 140 142 144 146 -d i me 0.1987 .3975 .5962 .7949 .8611 .9274 .9406 .9539 .9671 0.9803 .9178 .8028 .6074 .5090 .3740 .3394 .3002 .2542 d p2 p3 p4 ps i cost9 w = 1750 W = 1546 W = 1609 W = 1766 0.2027 0.4331 0.7426 1.3086 1.6910 2.4790 2.7710 3.1770 3.8050 354.7 757.9 1299.6 2290.1 2959.3 313.4 669.6 1148.1 2023.1 2614.3 326.1 696.9 1194.8 2105.5 2720.2 357.9 764.9 1311.4 2310.9 2986.3 Table E.-Tab& Approximate Dead end a great dist. from break Item Tension (lb)-A -B -C -D -E Insulator deflection 2920 3590 3930 4120 4230 (in)-6 -5 -2 2 Sag (ft)-A tion of results method Dead end at insuIat01 No. 1 2900 3550 3870 4050 4120 Exact method 2710 3620 3950 4120 4220 131.2 58.0 31.2 18.0 10.8 131.1 57.8 30.0 16.0 6.9 145.8 67.4 32.8 17.0 7.5 53.0 53.5 57.0 Bissiri and Landau ’ 2625 59.0 ’ For a final result, Bissiri and Landau give only an interpolated catenary parameter value for the span adjacent to the break. From this, Tension A = (1670)(1.57) = 2625 lb. 2 Sag values determined by use of Computing Chart given in figure 19. ‘6 w=730 174.9 316.2 542.1 955.3 1234.4 1809.7 2022.8 2319.2 2777.6 INITIAL 3 Lo = _ Lo CONDITIONS - Before _) “0 LO LO FIGURE c-c---------- G b-2 LO LO Conditions Break -- for equilibrium: - b-3 b-3 b-4 --lLO LO C.f Ln-4 b-3 h-2 dn-1 dn in conductor I CONDITIONS - After h-I LO LO = Horizontal tension = Span length FINAL Break ---LO 0= Change In span length. Pn = Hn ; Pn-1 + Hn = “n-1 ; Pn-2 + “n-1 = “n-2 ; Pn-3 + “n-2 = “n-3; On = dn- dn-1; an-1 = dn-1 -dn-2 ; (dn-2=dn-2 Ln = Lo-0n; Ln-2 = Lo -0n-2 Ln-1 =Lo -0n-1; FIGURE 2 104.D-1121 etc. -dn-4 -dn-3 ; On-3 =dn-3 , Ln-3 = Lo - 0n-3 ; etc. ; etc. TRANSMISSION 322 di v eWIW2- WPP’ - LINE DESIGN MANUAL Horizontal displacement of insulator string. Length of insulator string. Vertical displacement of insulator string. Angle of deflection of insulator string. Weight of insulator string. Weight of conductor acting on insulator string. Total vertical load = % + w2. Horizontal force caused by w when the insulator string is deflected by an angle 8, Horizontal force required to deflect the insulator string by an angle 8 when a load w is acting. FIGURE 3 Initial span length. Change in span length. Final span length. k ‘0 - Initial conductor length. ‘I - Conductor length after a change of 8 in span length. Initial horizontal tension in conductor. HOafter a change of 8 “,- Horizontal tension in conductor in span length. WUnit weight of conductor. Product of Modulus of elasticity and cross section area. AE- LO- 0- FIGURE 104-D-1122 4 APPENDIX Conductor Break 323 A in a Span Adjacent to a Dead End 4 // -ijoJ4 LI _ Conditions for equilibrium after P,=H,; 0, = d, ; L, = ~~-0, FIGURE 5 Force * c HO FIGURE 104-D-1123 conductor Relations Horizontal P, & H, c LO d P&H -w--e- 6 breaks: 324 TRANSMISSION Conductor LINE DESIGN MANUAL Break Two Spans Removed From Dead End ,, / ----L, L2 4 _ d2 LO LO Conditions for equilibrium after conductor breaks: P,=H,; P,+H,=H,; 0,=d,-d,; 0,=d,; L,= Lo-Q12; L,=L,-0, FIGURE 7 P & H Force Horizontal . Force p2 & H2 I H, . Relations -4 HO -I FIGURE 104-D-1124 8 c APPENDIX Conductor Conditions P3= Hg 8, =d,; Break for Three Spans conductor 0,=d3-d,; P,+Hz=H,; L,=L,-8,; FIGURE P&H _ Removed From Dead End equi Ii brium after P2+ H,=Hz; L,=L,-8,; f 325 A Horizontal breaks: 02=d2-d,; L, =~~-a, 9 Force Relations Force P,&H, _ p2 H2 PI HI HO FIGURE 104-D-1125 4 IO II P -A \to= APPENDIX A Conditions for equilibrium after conductor P3 = H;; P + H’,=H;; P, + H;= Hi; 0,=d,-d,; L$= L,-0,; L’,=L,-0, 8, = d,; Lf,=L,-03; FIGURE 13 104-D-1127 327 breaks: 0*=4-d,; 1030’ El. difrb;oq.80’ 900’ _ 940’ w: El. diffT7.89’ El. d~~o~l.50’ d-P- 1040’ _ El. diff=,l8.92’ 980 Normal horizontal tension ___________H, Conductor weight per ft ____________w AE= cond. area x modulus __________ Insulator length _-----___________ i Insulator weight----------------------For other details see Reference C4l FIGURE 15 104-D-1128 380’ El. dif8f=$.07’ = = = = = - 4400 lb 1.57 lb 6,635,672 12.58 ft 265 lb Bibliography 5m APPENDIX A 329 gkTT The determination of a geometric the space reloiiars of the ‘II’ curve intersections with the ‘P’curve : dtstance d2to dx-4e units I Avp mtio=0.277 Since mtio <I. the series, 46+Ii.5*~5... will converge and the sum will be approximately : 46 m-64 units This Sum -64 units - is then the distance from the i$ 6’~’ intersection t0 the . ‘4 6’P’ I t i i Requirements for I equihbrlum: “‘Y-Ho’% ‘k”C’% . . . . . . . . . +4-4 . . . . . . . . . Ld- La+, i I “cb+h #&-4 Y-Y’S ~4,-d, Hl’ps k4-4 L,+LO-& L&LO-b L;&-h Lg - 970’ 1 - I Horizontal FIGURE Force - Pounds 16 104-D-1 129 I TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Horizontol Force - Pounds FIGURE 104-D-1130 I7 APPENDIX A 331 VI-BIBLIOGRAPHY Technical [1] [2] [3] [4] Technical [5] [6] [7] [8] Journals Brown, R. S., “Stresses Produced in a Transmission Line by Breaking of a Conductor,” Electrical World, vol. 61, No. 13, pp. 673-676, March 29, 1913. September, Healy, E. S., and Wright, A. J., “Unbalanced Conductor Tensions,” Trans. of AIEE, pp. 1064-1070, 1926. Den Hartog, J. P., “Calculation of Sags in a Transmission Line With a Broken Conductor,” The Electric Journal, vol. XXV, pp. 24-26, January, 1928. Effect on Sags in Suspension Spans,” Trans. of AIEE, vol, 66, pp. Bissiri, A., and Landau, M., “Broken Conductor 1181-1188, 1947. Books Painton, E. T., “Mechanical Design of Overhead Electrical Transmission Lines,” D. Van Nostrand Co., New York, pp. 265-269, 1925. Third Edition, McGraw-Hill Book Co., New York, pp. 137-138, 1927. Still, A., “Electric Power Transmission,” Engineers Handbook-Electric Power,” Third Edition, Pender, H., Del Mar, W. A., and McIlwain, K., “Electrical Section 14, pp. 71-73, 1936. Martin, J. S., “Sag Calculations by the Use of Martin’s Tables,” Copperweld Steel Co., Glassport, Pa., pp. 39-40, 1942. 332 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL EOUIVALENT HORIZONTAL SPAN NOMOGRAPH NOTES These charts are designed to facilitate the computation of the ruling span length for any series of suspension spans. The procedure for computing the ruling span length is OS follows: I. Compute the Equivalent Horizontol Spon (He) for each span in the series being considered by using the nomograph which is based on J.S. Martin’s formula: He=ZI-H. (Use only for spans of 20% slope or less.) 2. The Ruling Span Length by using the relation: the solution of which is facilitated by using the Ruling Span Computation Chart. 900 600 5. no-c 8 20 600-- - 500-- z g 400-- G z 30 40 50 E :: = .u + k 5 t ki 100 k i3 = s 300-- 200 > 200 300 Z He- 2700: 400 i EXAMPLE: Horizontol span (H) Vertical span (V) Correction K) Equiv. horiz. span ZHe’ 0.27 x IO’ line. 4. Project vertlcolly down from this point to the Hrs scale ond read the ruling span length of 910 ft. 500 I = 1000’ -100’ = IO’ -1010’ FIGURE (Sheet ZH,‘-22.5~10’ 3. Enter the auxiliary bias lines at the value corresponding to ZHeL 22.5~ IO’ and read down the bias line to the intersection of the horizontal 300 200-- IOO- EXAMPLE Fmd the ruling span length for a SerieS of level spans of lengths, He=800, 900. 6 1000 ft. Solution: (Using the Ruling Span Chart), I. Enter the equivalent horizontal stole at the span lengths given and read the corresponding He3 values. 2. Add the Hd& He values: Problem: 18 2 of 2) 334 NMS s LINE DESIGN MANUAL NI H19N31 TRANSMISSION 133d EXPLANATION The purpose of this chart is to focilitote the computation of tronsmission line conductor sags and tensions when any three of the elements-span length, unit weight, sag, or tension ore known and when accuracy beyond the first decimal place is not required. This chart is based on the cotenory functions OS derived by J.S. Martin and given in the pamphlet “Sog Colculotions By The Use Of Mortin’s Tables” published by the Copperweld Steel Compony, Glossport. PO. The procedure for computing o sag value when the span length, unit weight, and tension ore known is OS follows: 3. Project horizontally from this point to the right or left to intersect the sag ratio curve. 4. From this potnt project vertically upward to intersect the Bose Spon Aux. Bios Line. 5. Thence, project horizontally -right or left- to intersect the bias line correspondtng to the span length used in step (I) obove. 6. from this point project vertically downward to intersect the sag scale ond read the corresponding sag value in feet. As on exomple, the followmg problem has been worked through: Find the sag for o conductor which weighs 1.1 lb. per ft when the span length is II00 ft. and the tension is 7000 lb. Answer by chart: 23.9 ft. Answer by more exact computation: 23.871 ft I. Enter the span length scale at o point corresponding to the equivalent level span length of the span under consideration ond project horizontally to the right to intersect the bias line which corresponds to the unit weight of the conductor. 2. Project vertically -up or down- from this point to intersect the bias line which corresponds to the tension in tne conductor: FIGURE I9 (Sheet 2 of 2) D : 1 0 Z D 336 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL 1000 RULING 1. P. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. I200 SPAN LENGTH - F 1. Dead-end in first span adjacent Deod- end in second won odjocrnt hod-end in third spon odjocmt Dood-end in fourth spon odjocent Dead-end in fifth spon odjocrnt Dead-•d o great distoncr from Tonsion brforr brook. FIGURE 20 2) (Sheet I of 104-D-1133 to brook. to brook. to brook. to brook. to brook. break. 1400 APPENDIX Theso curves ot crossings ore bosed ore to be use’?1 which worront on the following: Conductor Looding Insulators A NOTES in moking preliminary determinations compliance with titionol o&/or 337 of conductor h6ights Loco/ sofety codes ond - 195,000 C. M. MS. R. 6617 stronding. 130°F. tinol no load with mox. lood = 7500 Ibs. Q 25% ond #*wind. - lb, &“x lOWsuspension units. The following l xomple is given to illustrate the use of the curves shown to the left. PROBLEM: Determine conductor heights ot crossing shown below, moking provisions for required cleoronce under broken conductor conditions. PROCEDURE: FIRSTFrom pertinent SECOND - Determine safety cod6s determine required cleoronce over crossing. the ruling spon from crossing spon to neorest deod-end by: level spons, where the l quivolent Note: L,, Le, etc. ore l quivolent l?S=jy:*. level spon = 2 (Inclined spon) - octuol spon. THIRD - ;nter?he curves ot the value of the ruling spon OS determined obove ond using the curve which best describes the location of the neorest deod-end reod For deod-ends more thon 5 spons the corresponding value of horizontol tension. from breok use curve No.6. FOURTH - Determine brok6n conductor sog and/or profile OS required. In applying conductor pro file to transmission line profil6, the shift in the spon due to the conductor breoC need be consider6d only for vrry short spans. FIFTH - For o I6vel crossing spon, conductor height = required clr. + broken cond. $09. For on inclined spon, us6 height osindicohd by intercepts of the broken cond. prOfil6 on the StruCtur6 center lines. FIGURE 20 (Sheet 2 of 2) <<Appendix USEFUL FIGURES 339 AND TABLES B TRANSMISSION 340 t= II 36 I --- LINE DESIGN MANUAL 6 Miles I I line 3’ l I 32 j I 5 I 35 33 3 4 1 2 36 j 31 ----- I E --.-- 6 _-- 7 8 9 IO II 12 i I2 cr--- 7 --- XL I3 I8 I6 I7 I5 I4 I3 I8 _-- 3L 3r 24 19 20 23 22 21 u a .2 u I9 24 ---7 --25 30 29 28 27 26 25 31 32 33 34 35 36 --36 2 30 = Q, F --cz 31 _---- I 6 1 5 I ! 4 3 f j 2 j Townshi; I ine J Figure B-l.-Typical township showing section numbering. 104-D-1134. I /6 APPENDIX B 341 I Mile /FN \ $ car. --- ‘NW car. Sec.15 /t/6\’ co, ‘% senter NW$ 9\’ VEcar:Sec.15’ (Center NE { i 0 -; ai J r w t Center SE i SECOT. Set 15. --- Typical Section of Land Showing Corner Designations --- - ---l---NW ) of NW; NE ; of NW; SW $ of NW) SE 4’ of NW $ . 15---I I I Typical $ Section Figure B-2.-Typical land section showing corner and l/16 designations. 104-D-1135. tmnsmission line olwoys runs from left to right on o key mop or on o plon-profile drawing. The direction (beoring) of o line, OS indicated on the plan-profile drawing, is related to the directions given on on azimuth chart. Examples ore: N8803O’OO”E S 62” 36’47” E +l E a Indicates the angle .. turned, and the arrow In head indicates the 5 direction of the new segment of the line i in relation to the segment just before the angle point. S 71“15’00” W / S48’09’OO”W & The letters PI (point of intersection) are += 5 8 used OS a prefix to CD’D a station to denote eP on angle and to q indicate the exact ;a location of the angle point. Figure B-3.-Azimuth chart. 104-D-1136. APPENDIX B 343 Consider pole as a simple beam where f = M= S= J = Y= r = C = stress in outer fiber maximum moment section modulus moment of inertia distance from center of gravity to outer fiber radius of pole cross section circumference of pole cross section N/mm* N-mm mm3 mm4 mm mm mm (Ib/in* ) (lb-in) (in3) (in4) (in) iin) (in) axis of moments through center then b = 4 7 r rrd _ rr 4 J =w-7 ;Ay3 S = $a$. =f ! M = fS=f (y3) C = 27r r CL 27T r3= c3 87r3 M = f ($)($) =fL-$=0.003 166fc3 If f is in N/mm* and c is in mm, M is in N.mm. Dividing by 1000, M iS in N-m. M =3.166 x 10+fC3 N-m. If f is in lb/in* and c is in inches, M is in lb-in. Dividing by 12, M is in lb-ft. M=2.638 xIOe4fc3 lb-ft. Figure B-4.-Development of formula for maximum moment of resistance on wood poles. 104-D-1137. 344 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL APPENDIX Table B-l .-Maximum Metric: 345 moment of resistance for pole circumferences at ground line- USBR standard M,. = 3.166 x 10s6fc3 (c in mm) Pole Circumference B U.S. customary: Western Red Cedar Pole Diameter f= 38.610 88 MPa M,. = 2.638 x 10w4fc3 (c in inches) Douglas Fir and Southern Yellow Pine f= 5600 lb/in2 fz51.021 52 MPa f= 7400 lb/in2 C mm in mm in N-m lb.ft N.m lb-ft 508 521 533 546 559 20.0 20.5 21.0 21.5 22.0 162 166 170 114 178 6.37 6.53 6.68 6.84 7.00 16025 17 287 18509 19 891 21 352 11 12 13 14 15 818 726 681 681 730 21176 22 844 24459 26293 28 216 15 616 16817 18 078 19 400 20186 512 584 597 610 622 22.5 23.0 23.5 24.0 24.5 182 186 190 194 198 7.16 7.32 7.48 1.64 7.80 22871 24 341 26 010 27 746 29416 16 821 17 914 19 171 20421 21125 30230 32173 34 370 36665 38 871 22235 23 751 25 334 26986 28708 635 648 660 673 686 25.0 25.5 26.0 26.5 27.0 202 206 210 214 218 7.96 8.12 8.28 8.44 8.59 31299 33261 35 144 37261 39463 23082 24495 25 964 21491 29 071 41360 43953 46440 49239 52147 30501 32368 34 310 36328 38423 699 711 124 737 749 27.5 28.0 28.5 29.0 29.5 222 226 230 235 238 8.75 8.91 9.07 9.23 9.39 41149 43936 46 391 48935 51364 30122 32429 34 191 36029 37925 55 169 58059 61302 64 664 67 874 40597 42852 45 189 41610 50115 162 115 787 800 813 30.0 30.5 31.0 31.5 32.0 242 247 250 255 259 9.55 9.71 9.87 10.03 10.19 54086 56 901 59586 62587 65 688 39886 41914 44009 46173 48407 71470 15 191 78738 82705 86803 52707 55 386 58155 61015 63967 826 838 851 864 876 32.5 33.0 33.5 34.0 34.5 263 267 271 275 219 10.35 10.50 10.66 10.82 10.98 68890 71937 75 337 78842 82017 50712 53089 55538 58063 60662 91034 95059 99552 104185 108586 67012 70153 73 390 76726 80161 889 902 914 921 940 35.0 35.5 36.0 36.5 37.0 283 287 291 295 299 llJ4 11.30 11.46 11.62 11.78 85 89 93 97 101 886 709 338 377 532 63338 66 091 68923 71835 74 828 113493 118545 123 339 128677 134 167 83691 87 335 91078 94925 98880 953 965 978 991 1003 31.5 38.0 38.5 39.0 39.5 303 307 311 315 319 11.94 12.10 12.25 12.41 13.57 105 109 114 118 123 803 850 350 971 345 17903 81 061 84 303 87 630 91044 139 811 145 159 151105 157 211 162992 102943 107 116 111400 115 797 120 308 1016 1029 1041 1054 1067 40.0 40.5 41.0 41.5 42.0 323 328 331 336 340 12.73 12.89 13.05 13.21 13.37 128 133 137 143 148 204 188 902 133 495 94545 98135 101 815 105 586 109 448 169412 175 999 182228 189141 196226 124 129 134 139 144 935 679 542 524 628 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-l .-Maximum moment of resistance for pole circumferences at ground line-USBR standard-Continued Pole Circumference Western Red Cedar Pole Diameter f= 38.610 88 MPa C N.m Douglas Fir and Southern Yellow Pine f=5600 lb/in2 f= 51.02152 MPa f = 7400 lb/in2 mm in mm in 1080 1092 1105 1118 1130 42.5 43.0 43.5 44.0 44.5 344 348 352 356 360 13.53 13.69 13.85 14.01 14.16 153 159 164 170 176 989 180 932 822 382 113 117 121 125 130 404 454 599 840 179 203 210 217 225 233 486 345 947 730 077 149 155 160 166 172 855 207 684 289 023 1143 1156 1168 1181 1194 45.0 45.5 46.0 46.5 47.0 364 368 372 376 380 14.32 14.48 14.64 14.80 14.96 182 188 194 201 208 540 840 782 358 081 134 139 143 148 153 617 154 792 532 375 241 249 257 266 274 214 538 390 081 964 177 183 190 196 202 886 882 011 275 674 1207 1219 1232 1245 1257 47.5 48.0 48.5 49.0 49.5 384 388 392 396 400 15.12 15.28 15.44 15.60 15.76 214 952 221427 228 587 235 900 242 787 158 163 168 173 179 322 375 534 800 175 284 292 302 311 320 044 600 062 725 826 209 215 222 229 236 212 888 705 664 767 1270 1283 1295 1308 1321 50.0 50.5 51.0 51.5 52.0 404 408 412 416 420 15.92 16.07 16.23 16.39 16.55 250 258 265 273 281 398 166 478 554 792 184 190 195 201 207 660 255 962 782 717 330 883 341 149 350 811 361482 372 368 244 015 251408 258 950 266 641 274 483 1334 1346 1359 1372 1384 52.5 53.0 53.5 54.0 54.5 425 428 433 437 440 16.71 16.87 17.03 17.19 17.35 290 298 306 315 324 193 095 816 706 062 213 219 226 232 239 767 933 216 618 140 383 393 405 417 428 470 912 436 183 225 282 290 298 307 316 477 625 928 388 006 1397 1410 1422 1435 1448 55.0 55.5 56.0 56.5 57.0 445 449 453 457 461 17.51 17.67 17.83 17.98 18.14 333 280 342 671 351495 361 223 371 130 245 252 259 266 273 782 546 434 445 581 440 452 464 477 490 406 815 475 331 422 324 333 342 352 361 783 722 823 088 518 1461 1473 1486 1499 1511 57.5 58.0 58.5 59.0 59.5 465 469 473 477 481 18.30 18.46 18.62 18.78 18.94 381 390 401 411 421 216 686 122 742 710 280 288 295 303 311 844 235 753 402 181 503 516 530 544 557 749 264 054 088 259 371 380 390 400 411 116 882 817 924 204 1524 1537 1549 1562 1575 60.0 60.5 61.0 61.5 62.0 485 489 493 497 501 19.10 19.26 19.42 19.58 19.74 432 443 454 465 477 688 856 333 868 597 319 327 335 343 352 092 136 314 627 077 571 586 600 615 631 767 524 369 612 111 421 432 443 454 465 657 287 094 079 244 1588 1600 1613 1626 1638 62.5 63.0 63.5 64.0 64.5 506 509 513 518 521 19.89 20.05 20.21 20.37 20.53 489 500 513 525 537 521 703 007 511 232 360 369 378 387 396 664 389 254 260 407 646 661 677 694 709 868 643 902 425 914 476 488 499 511 523 591 121 836 736 824 lb-ft N-m lb*ft APPENDIX 347 B Table B-l .-Maximum moment of resistance for pole circumferences at ground line-USBR standard-Continued Pole Circumference Douglas Fir and Southern Yellow Pine Western Red Cedar Pole Diameter f= 38.610 88 MPa f= 5600 lb/in2 f=5’1.02152 MPa f = 7400 lb/in2 C mm N.m lb-ft N-m lb-ft in mm in 1651 1664 1676 1689 1702 65.0 65.5 66.0 66.5 67.0 526 530 534 538 542 20.69 20.85 21.01 21.17 21.33 550 563 575 588 602 125 223 496 992 697 405 415 424 434 444 698 132 712 437 311 726 744 760 778 796 951 259 477 311 421 536 548 561 574 587 100 567 226 078 125 1715 1727 1740 1753 1765 67.5 68.0 68.5 69.0 69.5 546 550 554 558 562 21.49 21.65 21.80 21.96 22.12 6i6 629 643 658 672 613 647 974 516 132 454 464 474 485 495 332 504 826 299 926 814 832 850 870 888 810 034 965 181 174 600 613 627 641 655 368 808 448 288 331 1778 1791 1803 1816 1829 70.0 70.5 71.0 71.5 72.0 566 570 574 578 582 22.28 22.44 22.60 22.76 22.92 687 702 716 732 747 093 275 486 096 931 506 517 528 539 551 707 642 734 984 391 907 928 946 967 988 945 006 785 412 337 669 684 698 713 728 577 027 685 550 624 1842 1854 1867 1880 1892 72.5 73.0 73.5 74.0 74.5 586 590 594 598 602 23.08 23.24 23.40 23.55 23.71 763 779 795 812 827 993 022 524 258 911 562 574 586 598 610 959 687 576 629 845 1009 1 029 1051 1073 1094 562 422 228 341 026 743 759 775 791 807 910 407 119 045 189 1905 1918 1930 1943 1956 75.0 75.5 76.0 76.5 77.0 606 610 614 618 623 23.87 24.03 24.19 24.35 24.51 845 862 878 896 914 095 514 805 683 802 623 635 648 661 674 227 775 490 374 427 1 116 1139 1 161 1184 1 208 732 751 278 902 845 823 840 856 873 891 550 131 933 958 207 TRANSMISSION 348 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-2.-Maximum moment of resistance for pole circumferences at ground line-ANSI standard Mr=2.64x 10-4fc3 Western Larch Pole diameter, 20.0 20.5 21.0 21.5 22.0 6.37 6.53 6.68 6.84 7.00 12612 13646 14669 15142 16866 16896 18 195 19 559 20990 22488 17 741 19 105 20537 22039 23613 22.5 23.0 23.5 24.0 24.5 7.16 7.32 7.48 7.64 7.80 18042 19 212 20566 21 897 23294 24057 25 696 21409 29 196 31 059 25 259 26 981 28779 30656 32612 25.0 25.5 26.0 26.5 27.0 7.96 8.12 8.28 8.44 8.59 24750 26264 21840 29477 31177 33000 35 019 37 120 39303 41570 34 650 36170 38976 41268 43649 21.5 28.0 28.5 29.0 29.5 8.75 8.91 9.07 9.23 9.39 32942 34 771 36668 38632 40665 43923 46 362 48890 51509 54220 46 119 48680 51335 54085 56 931 30.0 30.5 31.0 31.5 32.0 9.55 9.71 9.87 10.03 10.19 42768 44942 47188 49 509 51904 57 024 59 922 62 918 66012 69 206 59875 62 919 66064 69313 72666 32.5 33.0 33.5 34.0 34.5 10.35 10.50 10.66 10.82 10.98 54 315 56924 59551 62251 65044 72501 75 898 79401 83 010 86726 76126 79 693 83 371 87160 91 062 35.0 35.5 36.0 36.5 37.0 11.14 11.30 11.46 11.62 11.78 67 914 70866 73903 77025 80234 90552 94488 98531 102700 106979 95 079 99212 103464 107 835 112328 37.5 38.0 38.5 39.0 39.5 11.94 12.10 12.26 12 41 12.57 83531 86 917 90 393 93 961 97 621 111315 115 889 120 524 125 281 130 162 116943 121684 126550 131545 136670 40.0 40.5 41.0 41.5 42.0 12.73 12.89 13.05 13.21 13.37 135 168 140300 145 561 150 951 156 413 141926 147 315 152 839 158 499 164 297 in f Western Red Cedar = 6000 lb/in2, lb*ft Southern Yellow Pine f = 8000 lb/in2, lb*ft Pole circumference c, in 101 105 109 113 117 376 225 170 213 355 f= 8400 Ib/in2, lb-ft APPENDIX 6 Table B-2.-Maximum moment of resistance for pole circumferences at ground line-ANSIstandard-Continued Pole Circumference c, in Pole Diameter, 42.5 43.0 43.5 44.0 44.5 13.53 13.69 13.85 14.01 14.17 121 125 130 134 139 596 939 383 931 583 162 167 173 179 186 129 918 844 908 111 170 176 182 188 195 235 314 537 904 417 45.0 45.5 46.0 46.5 47.0 14.32 14.48 14.64 14.80 14.96 144 149 154 159 164 342 201 180 262 455 192 198 205 212 219 456 942 573 350 274 202 208 215 222 230 078 889 852 961 237 47.5 48.0 48.5 49.0 49.5 15.12 15.28 15.44 15.60 15.76 169 175 180 186 192 760 177 709 356 119 226 233 240 248 256 347 570 945 474 158 237 245 252 260 268 664 248 992 898 966 50.0 50.5 51.0 51.5 52.0 15.92 16.08 16.23 16.39 16.55 198 203 210 216 222 000 999 119 359 723 264 271 280 288 296 000 999 158 479 964 277 200 285 599 294 166 302 903 311812 52.5 53.0 53.5 54.0 54.5 16.71 16.87 17.03 17.19 17.35 229 235 242 249 256 209 821 558 422 415 305 314 323 332 341 613 428 411 563 887 320 330 339 349 358 893 149 581 192 982 55.0 55.5 56.0 56.5 57.0 17.51 17.67 17.83 17.99 18.14 263 270 278 285 293 538 790 175 693 345 351 361 370 380 391 384 054 900 924 127 368 379 389 399 310 953 107 466 971 683 57.5 58.0 58.5 59.0 59.5 18.30 18.46 18.62 18.78 18.94 301 309 317 325 333 133 057 119 320 661 401511 412 076 422 825 433 760 444 881 421 432 443 455 467 586 680 967 448 126 60.0 60.5 61.0 61.5 62.0 19.10 19.26 19.42 19.58 19.74 342 350 359 368 377 144 769 537 451 511 456 467 479 491 503 192 692 383 268 348 479 491 503 515 528 001 076 353 832 516 62.5 63.0 63.5 64.0 64.5 19.90 20.05 20.21 20.37 20.53 386 396 405 415 425 718 074 579 236 044 515 528 540 553 566 625 099 713 648 725 541 554 567 581 595 506 504 811 330 062 in f Western Red Cedar = 6000 lb/in2 lb*ft f Southern Yellow Pine = 8000 lb/in2 lb*ft Western Larch = 8400 lb/in2 f lb-ft TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-2.-Maximum moment of resistance for pole circumferences at ground line-ANSI standard-continued Western Larch Pole Diameter, 65.0 65.5 66.0 66.5 67.0 20.69 20.84 21.00 21.16 21.32 435 445 455 465 476 006 122 393 822 408 580 008 593 496 607 191 621096 635 211 609 623 637 652 666 008 170 551 150 972 67.5 68.0 68.5 69.0 69.5 21.48 21.64 21.80 21.96 22.12 487 498 509 520 531 154 060 127 358 752 649 664 678 693 709 539 080 837 811 003 682 697 712 728 744 015 284 779 501 453 70.0 70.5 71.0 71.5 72.0 22.28 22.44 22.60 22.75 22.91 543 555 566 578 591 312 037 931 992 224 724 740 755 771 788 416 050 908 990 299 760 777 793 810 827 636 052 703 590 714 72.5 73.0 73.5 74.0 74.5 23.07 23.23 23.39 23.55 23.71 603 616 628 641 654 627 202 95 1 874 973 804 821 838 855 873 837 603 602 833 298 845 862 880 898 916 078 684 532 624 963 75.0 75.5 76.0 76.5 77.0 23.87 24.03 24.19 24.35 24.50 668 681 695 709 723 250 704 337 152 148 891 908 927 945 964 000 939 117 536 197 935 954 973 992 1012 550 386 473 813 407 77.5 78.0 78.5 79.0 79.5 24.66 24.82 24.98 25.14 25.30 737 751 766 780 795 327 690 238 973 896 983 1002 1021 1041 1061 103 253 651 298 195 1032 1052 1072 1 093 1114 258 366 734 363 255 80.0 80.5 81.0 81.5 82.0 25.46 25.62 25.78 25.94 26.10 811 826 841 857 873 008 309 802 487 366 1081 1 101 1 122 1 143 1 164 344 746 403 317 489 1 1 1 1 1 135 156 178 200 222 411 833 523 483 713 82.5 83.0 83.5 84.0 84.5 26.26 26.41 26.57 26.73 26.89 889 905 922 938 955 440 710 177 843 708 1185 1 207 1 229 1 251 1 274 921 614 570 790 277 1245 1 267 1 291 1 314 1337 217 994 048 380 991 85.0 85.5 27.05 27.21 972 774 990 041 in f Western Red Cedar = 6000 lb/in2 lb*ft Southern Yellow Pine = 8000 lb/in2 lb-ft Pole Circumference c, in f 1 297 032 1 320 055 f = 8400 lb/in2 lb-ft 1 361 883 1 386 058 APPENDIX Table B-3.-Pole SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE AND DOUGLAS FIR DISTANCE CLASS I FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 30 CLASS CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 3 CLASS CIRC. INCHES TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 27.00 27.40 27.79 20.19 28.58 28.98 29.38 29.77 30.17 30.56 30.96 25.00 25.38 25.75 26.13 26.50 26.68 27.25 27.63 28.00 28.38 28.75 23.00 23.38 23.75 24.13 24.50 24.89 25.25 25.63 26.00 26.38 26.75 21 .oo 21.33 21 .67 22.00 22.33 22.67 23.00 23.33 23.67 24.00 24.33 I 1 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 31.35 31.75 32.15 32.54 32.94 33.33 33.73 34.12 34.52 34.92 29.13 29.50 29.00 30.25 30.63 31 .oo 31.38 31.75 32.13 32.50 27.13 27.50 27.68 28.25 28.63 29.00 29.36 29.75 30.13 30.50 24.67 25.00 25.33 25.67 26.00 26.33 26.67 27.00 27.33 27.61 25 26 27 28 29 30 TOP 351 circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine 21 22 23 24 SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 6 35.31 35.71 36.10 36.50 GROUND 36.90 37.29 37.69 38.08 38.48 38.87 L.INE PINE AND DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-2 CLASS H-l CIRC. CIRC. INCHES INCHES 31 .oo 31.43 31.86 32.29 32.72 33.16 33.59 34.02 34.45 34.88 35.31 29.00 29.43 29.86 30.29 30.72 31.16 31.59 32.02 32.45 32.88 33.31 32.88 33.25 33.63 34.00 (5 FEE1 34.38 34.75 35.13 35.50 35.88 36.25 30.88 31 .25 31 .63 32.00 6 INCHESl------32.38 32.75 33.13 33.50 33.68 34.25 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 27 27 27 28 28 29 29 29 30 30 31 00 41 83 24 66 07 48 90 31 72 14 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 25.00 25.40 25.79 26.19 26.59 26.98 27.38 27.78 28.17 28.57 28.97 2 FOOT POLE 4 28.00 28.33 28.67 29.00 29.33 29.67 30.00 30.33 30.67 31 .oo CLASS CIRC. INCHES 23.00 23.38 23.76 24.14 24.52 24.90 25.28 25.66 26.03 26.41 26.79 35 FOOT CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 3 _ 21 .oo 21 .36 21 .72 22.09 22.45 22.81 23.17 23.53 23.90 24.26 24.62 POLE TRANSMISSION 352 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET I I 12 13 14 CLASS CIRC. 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES INCHES 5 FOOT POLE-COII. CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 17 18 19 20 33.74 34.17 34.60 35 03 35 47 35 90 36 33 36 76 37 19 37 62 31.55 31.97 32.38 32 79 33 21 33 62 34 03 34 45 34 86 35 28 29.36 29.76 30.16 30.55 30.95 31.34 31.74 32.14 32.53 32.93 27.17 27.55 27.93 28.31 28.69 29.07 29.45 29.83 30.21 30.59 24.98 25.34 25.71 26.07 26.43 26.79 27.16 27.52 27.88 28.24 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 40.05 40.48 40.91 41.34 41 .78 42.21 42.64 43.07 43.50 38 38 38 39 39 40 40 41 41 35 36 36 36 37 37 38 38 39 69 10 52 93 34 76 17 59 00 33.33 33.72 34.12 34.52 34.91 35.31 35.71 36.10 36.50 30.97 31.34 31 .72 32.10 32.48 32.86 33.24 33.62 34.00 --------------34.38 28.60 28.97 29.33 29.69 30.05 30.41 30.78 31.14 31.50 34.76 35.14 35.52 35.90 36.28 32.22 32.59 32.95 33.31 33.67 -----------------GROUND 05 48 91 34 78 21 64 07 50 LINE (6 FEET 30 43.93 41.93 39.4 31 32 33 34 35 44.36 44.79 45.22 45.66 46.09 42.36 42.79 43.22 43.66 44.09 39 40 40 41 41 YELLOW CLASS PINE H-3 CIRC. INCHES AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 0 INCHES)36.90 83 24 66 07 48 37.29 37.69 38.09 38.48 38.88 FIR CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. 1 NCHES 33.00 33.46 33.91 34.37 34.82 35.28 35.74 36.19 36.65 37.10 37.56 31 00 31 44 31 88 32 32 32 76 33.21 33.65 34 09 34 53 34 97 35 41 29 29 29 30 30 31 31 31 32 32 33 00 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 43 85 28 71 13 56 99 41 84 26 27 27 27 28 28 29 29 29 30 30 31 82 24 65 06 47 88 29 71 12 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 38.01 38.47 38.93 39.38 39.84 40.29 40.75 41.21 41.66 42.12 35 36 36 37 37 38 38 38 39 39 33 34 34 34 35 35 36 36 37 37 69 12 54 97 40 82 25 68 10 53 31 31 32 32 33 33 34 34 34 35 53 94 35 76 18 59 00 41 82 24 TOP 2 35.74 36.17 36.60 37.03 37.47 37.90 38.33 38.76 39.19 39.62 15 16 SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 35 PINE AND DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-2 CLASS H-l CIRC. CIRC. INCHES INCHES 85 29 74 18 62 06 50 94 38 82 00 41 1 CLASS 2 CLASS 31.86 40 FOOT POLE 3 CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES CIRC. INCHES CIRC. INCHES 25.00 25.40 25.79 26.19 26.59 26.99 27.38 27.78 28.18 28.57 28.97 23.00 23.38 23.76 24.15 24.53 24.91 25.29 25.68 26.06 26.44 26.82 21.37 21.74 22.10 22.47 22.84 23.21 23.57 23.94 24.31 24.68 29.37 29.76 27.21 27.59 27.97 28.35 28.74 29.12 29.50 29.88 30.26 30.65 25.04 25.41 25.78 26.15 26.51 26.88 27.25 27.62 27.99 28.35 30.16 30.56 30.96 31.35 31.75 32.15 32.54 32.94 21 .oo APPENDIX 353 6 Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 --------34 35 36 31 38 39 40 SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 42.57 43.03 43.49 43.94 44.40 44.85 45.31 45.76 46.22 46.68 40 40 41 41 42 42 42 43 43 44 47.13 47.59 48.04 ---------------GROUND 48.50 48.96 49.41 49.87 50.32 50.78 51 .24 YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES FIR 26 71 15 59 03 47 91 35 79 24 46.00 46.44 46.88 41.32 47.76 48.21 48.65 37.96 38.38 38.81 39.24 39.66 40.09 40.51 40.94 41.37 41.79 35.65 36.06 36.47 36.88 37.29 37.71 38.12 38.53 38.94 39.35 33 33 34 34 34 35 35 36 36 36 34 74 13 53 93 32 72 12 51 91 31.03 31.41 31.79 32.18 32.56 32.94 33.32 33.71 34.09 34.47 28 72 29 09 29 46 29.82 30.19 30 56 30 93 31 29 31 66 32 03 39.76 40.18 40.59 0 INCHES)--41 .oo 41.41 41 .82 42.24 42.65 43.06 43.47 37 37 38 31 71 10 34.85 35.24 35.62 32 32 33 40 76 13 38 38 39 39 40 40 40 50 90 29 69 09 49 88 36.00 36.38 36.76 37.15 37.53 37.91 38.29 33 33 34 34 34 35 35 50 87 24 60 97 34 71 AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES FEET CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 POLE-con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 42.22 42.65 43.07 LINE (6 43.50 43.93 44.35 44.78 45.21 45.63 46.06 44.68 45.12 45.56 1 40 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 45 FOOT POLE 3 CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33.00 33.46 33.92 34.38 34.85 35.31 35.71 36.23 36.69 37.15 37.62 31 .oo 31.45 31.90 32.35 32.79 33.24 33.69 34.14 34.59 35.04 35.49 29.00 29.42 29.85 30.27 30.69 31.12 31.54 31 .96 32.38 32.81 33.23 27.00 27.41 27.82 28.23 28.64 29.05 29.46 29.87 30.28 30.69 31.10 25 25 25 26 26 26 21 27 28 28 28 00 40 19 19 59 99 38 78 18 58 97 23.00 23.37 23.14 24. 12 24.49 24.86 25.23 25.60 25.97 26.35 26.72 21 21 21 22 22 22 23 23 23 24 24 00 36 72 08 44 79 15 51 87 23 59 I I 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 38.08 38.54 39.00 39.46 39.92 40.38 40.85 41.31 41.77 42.23 35 36 36 37 37 38 38 39 39 39 33.65 34.08 34.50 34.92 35.35 35.77 36.19 36.62 37.04 37.46 31.51 31.92 32.33 32.74 33.15 33.56 33.97 34.38 34.79 35.21 29 29 30 30 30 31 31 32 32 32 37 77 17 56 96 36 76 15 55 95 27.09 27.46 27.83 28.21 28.58 28.95 29.32 29.69 3Q. 06 30.44 24 25 25 26 26 26 27 27 27 28 95 31 67 03 38 74 10 46 82 18 TOP 2 94 38 83 28 73 18 63 08 53 97 4 354 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 42.69 43.15 43.62 44.08 44.54 45.00 45.46 45.92 46.38 46.85 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 --------------. 47.31 47.77 48.23 48.69 49.15 49.62 50.08 50.54 39 40 51 .oo 51 .46 41 42 43 44 45 51.92 52.38 52.85 53.31 53.77 SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 40 40 41 41 42 42 43 43 44 44 FIR 42 a7 32 77 22 67 12 56 01 46 44.91 45.36 45.81 46.26 46.71 47.15 47.60 48.05 ---GROUND 48.50 48.95 49.40 49.85 50.29 50.74 51.19 AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 2 45 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES POLE-con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 37.88 38.31 38.73 39.15 39.58 40.00 40.42 40.85 41 .27 41 .69 35.62 36.03 36.44 36.85 37.26 37.67 38.08 38.49 38.90 39.31 33 33 34 34 34 35 35 36 36 36 35 74 14 54 94 33 73 13 53 92 30.81 31.18 31.55 31.92 32.29 32.67 33.04 33.41 33.78 34.15 28.54 28.90 29.26 29.62 29.97 30.33 30.69 31.05 31.41 31 .I7 39.72 40.13 40.54 40.95 41 .36 41 .I7 42.18 42.59 6 INCHES)--43.00 43.41 37 37 38 38 38 39 39 40 32 72 12 51 91 31 71 10 34.53 34.90 35.27 35.. 64 36.01 36.38 36.76 37.13 32.13 32.49 32.85 33.21 33.56 33.92 34.28 34.64 40 40 50 90 37.50 37.87 35.00 35.36 46.35 46.77 47.19 47.62 48.04 43.82 44.23 44.64 45.05 45.46 41.29 41 .69 42.09 42.49 42.88 38.24 38.62 38.99 39.36 39.73 35.72 36.08 36.44 36.79 37.15 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 42.12 42.54 42.96 43.38 43.81 44.23 44.65 45.08 LINE (6 45.50 45.92 FEET, 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES FIR 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 50 3 4 FOOT POLE CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 a 9 10 33.00 33.45 33.91 34.36 34.82 35.27 35.73 36.18 36.64 37.09 37.55 31 .oo 31.44 31 .a9 32.33 32.77 33.22 33.66 34.10 34.55 34.99 35.43 29.00 29.42 29.84 30.26 30.68 31.10 31 .52 31.94 32.36 32.78 33.20 27.00 27.41 27.82 28.23 28.64 29.05 29.45 29.86 30.27 30.68 31.09 25.00 25.39 25.77 26.16 26.55 26.93 27.32 27.70 28.09 28.48 28.86 23.00 23.36 23.73 24.09 24.45 24.82 25.18 25.55 25.91 26.27 26.64 21 .oo 21.35 21.70 22.06 22.41 22.76 23.11 23.47 23.82 24.17 24.52 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 38.00 38.45 38.91 39.36 39.82 40.27 40.73 41.18 41 .64 42.09 35.88 36.32 36.76 37.20 37.65 38.09 38.53 38.98 39.42 39.86 33.63 34.05 34.47 34.89 35.31 35.73 36.15 36.57 36.99 37.41 31.50 31.91 32.32 32.73 33.14 33.55 33.95 34.36 34.77 35.18 29.25 29.64 30.02 30.41 30.80 31.18 31.57 31.95 32.34 32.73 27.00 27.36 27.73 28.09 28.45 28.82 29.18 29.55 29.91 30.27 24.87 25.23 25.58 25.93 26.28 26.64 26.99 27.34 27.69 28.05 APPENDIX 355 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. FIR CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 50 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES POLE-con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES 42.55 43.00 43.45 43.91 44.36 44.82 45.27 45.73 46.18 46.64 40.31 40.75 41.19 41 .64 42.08 42.52 42.97 43.41 43.85 44.30 37.83 38.25 38.67 39.09 39.51 39.93 40.35 40.77 41.19 41 .61 35.59 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 36.00 36.41 36.82 37.23 37.64 38.05 38.45 38.86 39.27 33.11 33.50 33.89 34.27 34.66 35.05 35.43 35.82 36.20 36.59 30.64 31 .oo 31 .36 31.73 32.09 32.45 32.82 33.18 33.55 33.91 28.40 28.75 29.10 29.45 29.81 30.16 30.51 30.86 31.22 31.57 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 47.09 47.55 48.00 48.45 48.91 49.36 49.82 50.27 50.73 51.18 44.74 45.18 45.62 46.07 46.51 46.95 47.40 47.84 48.28 48.73 42.03 42.45 42.87 43.30 43.72 44.14 44.56 44.98 45.40 45.82 39.68 40.09 40.50 40.91 41 .32 41.73 42.14 42.55 42.95 43.36 36.98 37.36 37.75 38.14 38.52 38.91 39.30 39.68 40.07 40.45 34.27 34.64 35.00 35.36 35.73 36.09 36.45 36.82 37.18 37.55 31.92 32.27 32.62 32.98 33.33 33.68 34.03 34.39 34.74 35.09 41 42 51 .64 52.09 49.17 49.61 46.24 46.66 43.77 44.18 40.84 41 .23 35.44 35.80 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 52.55 53.00 53.45 53.91 54.36 54.82 55.27 55.73 37.91 38.27 --------------38.64 39.00 39.36 39.73 40.09 40.45 40.82 41.18 21 ---GROUND SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.45 33.90 34.35 34.80 35.24 35.69 36. 14 36.59 37.04 37.49 LINE 50.06 50.50 50.94 51.39 51 .83 52.27 52.72 53.16 AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 31 .oo 31.43 31.86 32.29 32.71 33.14 33.57 34.00 34.43 34.86 35.29 (7 FEET 47.08 47.50 47.92 48.34 48.76 49.18 49.60 50.02 0 INCHES)------44.59 41 .61 45.00 45.41 45.82 46.23 46.64 47.05 47.45 42.00 42.39 42.77 43.16 43.55 43.93 44.32 FIR CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. 1 NCHES 29.00 29.42 29.84 27.00 27.40 27.80 28.19 28.59 28.99 29.39 29.79 30.18 30.58 30.98 30.26 30.67 31.09 31.51 31.93 32.35 32.77 33.18 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 25 25 25 26 26 26 27 27 28 28 28 00 38 76 13 51 89 27 64 02 40 78 2 4 36.15 36.50 36.85 37.20 37.56 37.91 38.26 38.61 55 FOOT POLE 3 CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 1 NCHES CLASS CIRC. 23.00 23.36 23.71 24.07 24.43 24.79 25.14 25.50 25.86 26,21 26.57 21 00 21 35 21 69 22 04 22 39 22 73 23 08 23 43 23 78 24 12 24 47 356 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES I I 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37.94 38.39 38.84 39.29 39.13 40.18 40.63 41 .08 41.53 41 .98 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES . FIR CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES I CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 55 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES POLE-con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES 35.71 36. 14 36.57 37.00 37.43 37.86 38.29 38.71 39.14 39.57 33 34 34 34 35 35 36 36 36 37 60 02 44 86 28 69 11 53 95 37 31 .38 31 .78 32.17 32.57 32.97 33.37 33.77 34.16 34.56 34.96 29.15 29.53 29.91 30.29 30.66 31.04 31 .42 31 .80 32.17 32.55 26.93 27.29 27.64 28.00 28.36 28.71 29.07 29.43 29.79 30.14 24.82 25.16 25.51 25.86 26.20 26.55 26.90 27.24 27.59 27.94 42.43 42.88 43.33 43.78 44.22 44.67 45.12 45.57 46.02 46.47 40.00 40.43 40.86 41 .29 41.71 42.14 42.57 43.00 43.43 43.86 37 38 38 39 39 39 40 40 41 41 79 20 62 04 46 88 30 71 13 55 35.36 35.76 36.15 36.55 36.95 37.35 37.74 38. 14 38.54 38.94 32.93 33.31 33.68 34.06 34.44 34.82 35.19 35.51 35.95 36.33 30.50 30.86 31.21 31.57 31.93 32.29 32.64 33.00 33.36 33.71 28.29 28.63 28.98 29.33 29.67 30.02 30.37 30.71 31 .06 31.41 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 46.92 47.37 47.82 48.27 48.71 49.16 49.61 50.06 50.51 50.96 44.29 44.71 45.14 45.57 46.00 46.43 46.86 47.29 47.71 48.14 41 42 42 43 43 44 44 44 45 45 97 39 81 22 64 06 48 90 32 73 39.34 39.73 40.13 40.53 40.93 41.33 41 .72 42.12 42.52 42.92 36.70 37.08 37.46 37.84 38.21 38.59 38.97 39.35 39.72 40.10 34.07 34.43 34.79 35.14 35.50 35.86 36.21 36.57 36.93 37.29 31 .76 32.10 32.45 32.80 33.14 33.49 33.84 34.18 34.53 34.88 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 51.41 51.86 52.31 52.76 53.20 53.65 54.10 48.57 49.00 49.43 49.86 50.29 50.71 51.14 46 46 46 47 47 48 48 37.64 38.00 38.36 38.71 39.07 39.43 39.79 35.22 35.57 35.92 36.27 36.61 36.96 37.31 ------ 54.55 55.00 55.45 51.57 52.00 52.43 49 49.50 49.92 43.32 43.71 44.11 44.51 44.91 45.31 45.70 6 INCHES)------46.10 46.50 46.90 40.48 40.86 41 .23 41 .61 41.99 42.37 42.74 48 49 50 15 57 99 41 83 24 66 7 FEET, 08 43.12 43.50 43.88 40.14 40.50 40.86 37.65 38.00 38.35 51 52 53 54 55 55.90 56.35 56.80 57.24 57.69 52.86 53.29 53.71 54.14 54.57 50 50 51 51 52 34 76 17 59 01 47.30 47.69 48.09 48.49 48.89 44.26 44.63 45.01 45.39 45.77 41.21 41.57 41.93 42.29 42.64 38.69 39.04 39.39 39.13 40.08 -----------------------GROUND LINE 4 APPENDIX 357 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 60 3 FOOT POLE CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.44 33.89 34.33 34.78 35.22 35.61 36.11 36.56 37.00 37.44 31 .oo 31.43 31.85 32.28 32.70 33.13 33.56 33.98 34.41 34.83 35.26 29.00 29.41 29.81 30.22 30.63 31.04 31.44 31 .85 32.26 32.67 33.07 27.00 27.39 27.78 28.17 28.56 28.94 29.33 29.72 30.11 30.50 30.89 25.00 25.37 25.74 26.11 26.48 26.85 27.22 27.59 27.96 28.33 28.70 23.00 23.35 23.70 24.06 24.41 24.76 25.11 25.46 25.81 26.17 26.52 21 .oo 21.33 21 .67 22.00 22.33 22.67 23.00 23.33 23.67 24.00 24.33 11 12 13 14 I5 16 17 18 19 20 37.89 38.33 38.78 39.22 39.67 40.11 40.56 41 .oo 41.44 41 .89 35.69 36.11 36.54 36.96 37.39 37.81 38.24 38.61 39.09 39.52 33.48 33.89 34.30 34.70 35.11 35.52 35.93 36.33 36.74 31.15 31 .28 31 .67 32.06 32.44 32.83 33.22 33.61 34.00 34.39 34.78 29.07 29.44 29.81 30.19 30.56 30.93 31.30 31 .67 32.04 32.41 26.87 27.22 27.57 27.93 28.28 28.63 28.98 29.33 29.69 30.04 24.67 25.00 25.33 25.67 26.00 26.33 26.67 27.00 27.33 27.67 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 42.33 42.78 43.22 43.67 44.11 44.56 45.00 45.44 45.89 46.33 39.94 40.37 40.80 41.22 41 .65 42.07 42.50 42.93 43.35 43.78 37.56 37.96 38.37 38.78 39.19 39.59 40.00 40.41 40.81 41.22 35.17 35.56 35.94 36.33 36.72 31.11 37.50 37.89 38.28 38.67 32.78 33.15 33.52 33.89 34.26 34.63 35.00 35.37 35.74 36.11 30.39 30.74 31.09 31.44 31 .80 32.15 32.50 32.85 33.20 33.56 28.00 28.33 28.67 29.00 29.33 29.67 30.00 30.33 30.67 31 .oo 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 46.78 47.22 47.67 48.11 48.56 49.00 49.44 49.89 50.33 50.78 44.20 44.63 45.06 45.48 45.91 46.33 46.76 47.19 47.61 48.04 41 .63 42.04 42.44 42.85 43.26 43.67 44.07 44.48 44.89 45.30 39.06 39.44 39.83 40.22 40.61 41 .oo 41.39 41 .78 42.17 42.56 36.48 36.85 37.22 37.59 37.96 38.33 38.70 39.07 39.44 39.81 33.91 34.26 34.61 34.96 35.31 35.67 36.02 36.37 36.72 37.07 31.33 31 .67 32.00 32.33 32.67 33.00 33.33 33.67 34.00 34.33 Ltl 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51.22 51 .67 52.11 52.56 53.00 53.44 53.89 54.33 54.78 55.22 48.46 48.89 49.31 49.74 50.17 50.59 51.02 51.44 51 .87 52.30 45.70 46.11 46.52 46.93 47.33 47.74 48.15 48.56 48.96 49.37 42.94 43.33 43.72 44.11 44.50 44.89 45.28 45.67 46.06 46.44 40.19 40.56 40.93 41.30 41 .67 42.04 42.41 42.78 43.15 43.52 37.43 37.78 38.13 38.48 38.83 39.19 39.54 39.89 40.24 40.59 34.67 35.00 35.33 35.67 36.00 36.33 36.67 37.00 37.33 37.67 TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 I 8 9 10 TRANSMISSION 358 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 55.67 56.11 56.56 57.00 57.44 57.89 58.33 58.78 59.22 59.67 YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 52.72 ---GROUND 53.15 53.57 54.00 54.43 54.85 55.28 55.70 56.13 56.56 AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-l CIRC. 1 NCHES 49.78 Ll INE (8 FEET, 50.19 50.59 51 .oo 51.41 51.81 52.22 52.63 53.04 53.44 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 46 0 47 47 48 48 48 49 49 49 50 1 83 NCHES 22 61 00 39 78 17 56 94 33 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 60 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES 43.89 40.94 44.26 44.63 45.00 45.37 45.74 46.11 46.48 46.85 47.22 91 41 42 42 42 43 43 43 44 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 38.00 30 65 00 35 70 06 41 76 11 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 38.33 36.67 39.00 39.33 39.67 40.00 40.33 40.67 41 .oo 65 FOOT POLE 3 CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.43 33.86 34.30 34.73 35.16 35.59 36.03 36.46 36.89 37.32 31 31 31 32 32 33 33 33 34 34 35 00 42 83 25 66 08 49 91 32 74 15 29.00 29.40 29.80 30.19 30.59 30.99 31.39 31 .I9 32.19 32.58 32.98 27.00 27.38 27.76 28.14 28.53 28.91 29.29 29.67 30.05 30.43 30.81 25.00 25.36 25.73 26.09 26.46 26.82 27.19 27.55 27.92 28.28 20.64 23.00 23.35 23.69 24.04 24.39 24.74 25.08 25.43 25.78 26.13 26.47 21 .oo 21.33 21.66 21.99 22.32 22.65 22.98 23.31 23.64 23.97 24.31 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37.75 38.19 38.62 39.05 39.48 39.92 40.35 40.78 41.21 41 .64 35 35 36 36 37 37 38 38 30 39 57 98 40 81 23 64 06 47 89 31 33.38 33.78 34.18 34.58 34.97 35.37 35.77 36.17 36.57 36.97 31.19 31.58 31 .96 32.34 32.72 33.10 33.48 33.86 34.25 34.63 29.0 1 29.37 29.74 30.10 30.47 30.83 31.19 31 .56 31.92 32.29 26.82 27.17 27.52 27.86 28.21 28.56 28.91 29.25 29.60 29.95 24.64 24.97 25.30 25.63 25.96 26.29 26.62 26.95 27.28 27.61 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 42.08 42.51 42.94 43.37 43.81 44.24 44.67 45.10 45.53 45.97 39 40 40 40 41 41 42 42 43 43 72 14 55 97 38 80 21 63 04 46 37.36 37.76 30.16 30.56 30.96 39.36 39.75 40.15 40.55 40.95 35.01 35.39 35.77 36.15 36.53 36.92 37.30 37.68 38.06 38.44 32.65 33.02 33.38 33.75 34.11 34.47 34.84 35.20 35.57 35.93 30.30 30.64 30.99 31.34 31 .69 32.03 32.38 32.73 33.08 33.42 27.94 28.27 28.60 28.93 29.26 29.59 29.92 30.25 30.58 30.92 TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 4 1 FIR CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES POLE-con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES APPENDIX 359 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS 2 CIRC. 1 NCHES 65 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES POLE-Con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES 31 32 33 34 35 36 31 38 39 40 46.40 46.83 47.26 47.69 48.13 40.56 48.99 49.42 49.86 50.29 43.87 44.29 44.70 45.12 45.53 45.95 46.36 46.78 47.19 47.61 41.35 41.75 42.14 42.54 42.94 43.34 43.74 44.14 44.53 44.93 38.82 39.20 39.50 39.97 40.35 40.73 41.11 41.49 41.87 42.25 36.30 36.66 37.03 37.39 37.75 38.12 38.48 38.85 39.21 39.58 33.77 34.12 34.47 34.81 35.16 35.51 35.86 36.20 36.55 36.90 31.25 31.58 31.91 32.24 32.57 32.90 33.23 33.56 33.89 34.22 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 50.72 51.15 51.58 52.02 52.45 52.88 53.31 53.75 54.16 54.61 48.03 48.44 48.86 49.27 49.69 50.10 50.52 50.93 51.35 51 .76 45.33 45.73 46.13 46.53 46.92 47.32 47.72 48.12 48.52 48.92 42.64 43.02 43.40 43.78 44.16 44.54 44.92 45.31 45.69 46.07 39.94 40.31 40.67 41.03 41.40 41 .76 42.13 42.49 42.86 43.22 37.25 37.59 37.94 38.29 38.64 38.98 39.33 39.68 40.03 40.37 34.55 34.88 35.21 35.54 35.87 36.20 36.53 36.86 37.19 37.53 51 52 53 54 55 56 -- 55.04 55.41 55.91 56.34 56.77 57.20 40.72 41.07 41 .42 41 .76 42.11 42.46 37.86 38.19 38.52 38.85 39.18 39.51 57.64 58.07 58.50 58.93 46.45 46.83 47.21 47.59 47.97 48.36 6 INCHES)------48.74 49.12 49.50 49.88 43.58 43.95 44.31 44.68 45.04 45.41 57 58 59 60 52.18 52.59 53.01 53.42 53.84 54.25 ---GROUND 54.67 55.08 55.50 55.92 45.77 46.14 46.50 46.86 42.81 43.15 43.50 43.85 39.84 40.17 40.50 40.83 61 62 63 64 65 59.36 59.80 60.23 60.66 61 .09 53.30 53.69 54.09 54.49 54.89 50.26 50.64 51.03 51.41 51.79 47.23 47.59 47.96 48.32 48.69 44.19 44.54 44.89 45.24 45.58 41.16 41.49 41.82 42.15 42.48 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 29.00 29.39 29.78 30.17 30.56 30.95 31.34 31.73 32.13 32.52 32.91 27.00 27.38 27.75 28.13 28.50 28.88 29.25 29.63 30.00 30.38 30.75 SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 33 33 33 34 34 35 35 36 36 36 37 00 43 86 29 72 15 58 01 44 87 30 49.31 49.71 50.11 50.51 50.91 51.31 LINE (6 51.70 52.10 52.50 52.90 56.33 56.75 57.16 57.58 57.99 AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 31 .oo 31.41 31 .I31 32.22 32.63 33.03 33.44 33.84 34.25 34.66 35.06 FEET FIR 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 25 25 25 26 26 26 27 27 27 28 28 00 36 72 08 44 80 16 52 88 23 59 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 70 3 23.00 23.34 23.69 24.03 24: 38 24.72 25.06 25.41 25.75 26.09 26.44 4 FOOT POLE CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 21 21 21 21 22 22 22 23 23 23 24 00 32 64 96 28 60 92 24 56 88 20 360 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow @e-Continued SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES I CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 70 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES POLE-con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES I I 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37.73 38.16 38.59 39.02 39.45 39.88 40.30 40.73 41.16 41.59 35.47 35.88 36.28 36.69 37.09 37.50 37.91 38.31 38.72 39.13 33.30 33.69 34.08 34.47 34.86 35.25 35.64 36.03 36.42 36.81 31.13 31.50 31 .aa 32.25 32.63 33.00 33.38 33.75 34.13 34.50 28.95 29.31 29.67 30.03 30.39 30.75 31.11 31.47 31 .a3 32.19 26.78 27.13 27.47 27.81 28.16 28.50 28.84 29.19 29.53 29.88 24.52 24.84 25.16 25.48 25.80 26.13 26.45 26.71 27.09 27.41 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 42.02 42.45 42.88 43.31 43.74 44.17 44.60 45.03 45.46 45.89 39.53 39.94 40.34 40.75 41.16 41 .56 41.97 42.38 42.78 43.19 37.20 37.59 37.98 38.38 38.77 39.16 39.55 39.94 40.33 40.72 34.88 35.25 35.63 36.00 36.38 36.75 37.13 37.50 37.88 38.25 32.55 32.91 33.27 33.63 33.98 34.34 34.70 35.06 35.42 35.78 30.22 30.56 30.91 31 .25 31.59 31.94 32.28 32.63 32.97 33.31 27.73 28.05 28.37 28.69 29.01 29.33 29.65 29.97 30.29 30.61 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 46.32 46.75 47.18 47.61 48.04 48.47 48.90 49.33 49.76 50.19 43.59 44.00 44.41 44.81 45.22 45.63 46.03 46.44 46.84 47.25 41.11 41.50 41 .a9 42.28 42.67 43.06 43.45 43.84 44.23 44.63 38.63 39.00 39.38 39.75 40.13 40.50 40.88 41 .25 41 .63 42.00 36. 14 36.50 36.86 37.22 37.58 37.94 38.30 38.66 39.02 39.38 33.66 34.00 34.34 34.69 35.03 35.38 35.72 36.06 36.41 36.75 30.93 31.25 31.57 31 .a9 32.21 32.53 32.85 33.17 33.49 33.81 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 50.62 51.05 51.48 51.91 52.34 52.77 53.20 53.63 54.05 54.48 47.66 48.06 48.47 48.88 49.28 49.69 50.09 50.50 50.91 51.31 45.02 45.41 45.80 46.19 46.58 46.97 47.36 47.75 48.14 48.53 42.38 42.15 43.13 43.50 43.88 44.25 44.63 45.00 45.38 45.75 39.73 40.09 40.45 40.81 41.17 41.53 41 .a9 42.25 42.61 42.97 37.09 37.44 37.78 38.13 38.47 38.81 39.16 39.50 39.84 40.19 34.13 34.45 34.77 35.09 35.41 35.73 36.05 36.38 36.70 37.02 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 54.91 55.34 55.77 56.20 56.63 57.06 57.49 57.92 58.35 58.78 51 .72 52.13 52.53 52.94 53.34 53.75 54.16 54.56 54.97 55.38 48.92 49.31 49.70 50.09 50.48 50.88 51 .27 51.66 52.05 52.44 46.13 46.50 46.88 47.25 47.63 48.00 48.38 48.75 49.13 49.50 43.33 43.69 44.05 44.41 44.77 45.13 45.48 45.84 46.20 46.56 40.53 40.88 41.22 41 .56 41.91 42.25 42.59 42.94 43.28 43.63 37.34 37.66 37.98 38.30 38.62 38.94 39.26 39.58 39.90 40.22 + APPENDIX B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET YELLOW PINE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES -----------------------GROUND 51 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES LINE 59.21 59.64 60.07 60.50 60.93 61 .36 61 .79 62.22 62.65 63.08 SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 70 FIR 55.78 56.19 56.59 57.00 57.41 57.81 58.22 58.63 59.03 59.44 PINE AND CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES (9 CLASS CIRC. INCHES FEET. 52.83 53.22 53.61 54.00 54.39 54.76 55.17 55.56 55.95 56.34 DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 0 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 FOOT CLASS CIRC. INCHES POLE-Con. 3 CLASS CIRC. INCHES INCHES)-------------------------- 49.88 50.25 50.63 51 .oo 51.38 51 .I5 52.13 52.50 52.88 53.25 46.92 47.26 47.64 48.00 48.36 48.12 49.08 49.44 49.80 50.16 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES I 43.97 44.31 44.66 45.00 45.34 45.69 46.03 46.38 46.72 47.06 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 40.54 40.86 41.18 41.50 41 .82 42.14 42.46 42.78 43.10 43.42 75 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES 8 9 10 33 33 33 34 34 35 35 35 36 36 37 00 42 84 26 68 10 52 94 36 78 20 31 .oo 31.41 31 .81 32.22 32.62 33.03 33.43 33.84 34.25 34.65 35.06 29.00 29.38 29.77 30.15 30.54 30.92 31.30 31 .69 32.07 32.46 32.84 27.00 27.37 27.74 28.11 28.48 28.85 29.22 29.59 29.96 30.33 30.70 25.00 25.35 25.70 26.04 26.39 26.74 27.09 27.43 27.78 28.13 28.48 23.00 23.33 23.67 24.00 24.33 24.67 25.00 25.33 25.67 26.00 26.33 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37 38 38 38 39 39 40 40 40 41 62 04 46 88 30 72 14 57 99 41 35.46 35.67 36.28 36.68 37.09 37.49 37.90 38.30 38.71 39.12 33.22 33.61 33.99 34.36 34.76 35.14 35.53 35.91 36.30 36.68 31.07 31.43 31.80 32.17 32.54 32.91 33.28 33.65 34.02 34.39 28.63 29.17 29.52 29.87 30.22 30.57 30.91 31 .26 31 .61 31 .96 26.67 27.00 27.33 27.67 28.00 28.33 28.67 29.00 29.33 29.67 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 41 42 42 43 43 43 44 44 45 45 83 25 67 09 51 93 35 77 19 61 39.52 39.93 40.33 40.74 41. I4 41.55 41 .96 42.36 42.77 43.17 37.07 37.45 37.83 38.22 38.60 38.99 39.37 39.75 40.14 40.52 34.76 35.13 35.50 35.87 36.24 36.61 36.98 37.35 37.12 38.09 32.30 32.65 33.00 33.35 33.70 34.04 34.39 34.14 35.09 35.43 30.00 30.33 30.67 31 .oo 31.33 31 .67 32.00 32.33 32.67 33.00 POLE 4 362 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET PINE AND CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 75 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES POLE-con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 46.03 46.45 46.87 47.29 47.71 48.13 48.55 48.97 49.39 49.81 43.58 43.99 44.39 44.80 45.20 45.61 46.01 46.42 46.83 47.23 40.91 41.29 41 .67 42.06 42.44 42.83 43.21 43.59 43.98 44.36 38.46 38.83 39.20 39.57 39.93 40.30 40.67 41.04 41.41 41 .78 35.78 36.13 36.48 36.83 37.17 37.52 37.87 38.22 38.57 38.91 33.33 33.67 34.00 34.33 34.67 35.00 35.33 35.67 36.00 36.33 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 50.23 50.65 51.07 51.49 51.91 52.33 52.75 53.17 53.59 54.01 47.64 48.04 48.45 48.86 49.26 49.67 50.07 50.48 50.88 51.29 44.75 45.13 45.51 45.90 46.28 46.67 47.05 47.43 47.82 48.20 42.15 42.52 42.89 43.26 43.63 44.00 44.37 44.74 45.11 45.48 39.26 39.61 39.96 40.30 40.65 41 .oo 41.35 41.70 42.04 42.39 36.67 37.00 37.33 37.67 38.00 38.33 38.67 39.00 39.33 39.67 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 54.43 54.86 55.28 55.70 56.12 56.54 56.96 57.38 57.80 58.22 51.70 52.10 52.51 52.91 53.32 53.72 54.13 54.54 54.94 55.35 48.59 48.97 49.36 49.74 50.12 50.51 50.89 51 .28 51.66 52.04 45.85 46.22 46.59 46.96 47.33 47.70 48.07 48.43 48.80 49.17 42.74 43.09 43.43 43.78 44.13 44.48 44.83 45.17 45.52 45.87 40.00 40.33 40.67 41 .oo 41.33 41 .67 42.00 42.33 42.67 43.00 61 62 63 64 65 --------------- 58.64 59.06 59.48 59.90 60.32 43.33 43.67 44.00 44.33 44.67 ----- 60.74 61.16 61 .58 62.00 62.42 49.54 49.91 50.28 50.65 51.02 INCHES) 51.39 51 .76 52.13 52.50 52.87 46.22 46.57 46.91 47.26 47.61 66 67 68 69 70 55.75 56.16 56.57 56.97 57.38 GROUND 57.78 58.19 58.59 59.00 59.41 47.96 48.30 48.65 49.00 49.35 45.00 45.33 45.67 46.00 46.33 71 72 73 74 75 62.84 63.26 63.68 64.10 64.52 53.24 53.61 53.98 54.35 54.72 49.70 50.04 50.39 50.74 51.09 46.67 47.00 47.33 47.67 48.00 59.81 60.22 60.62 61 .03 61 .43 LINE 52.43 52.81 53.20 53.58 53.96 9 FEET, 54.35 54.73 55.12 55.50 55.88 56.27 56.65 57.04 57.42 57.80 6 3 APPENDIX 363 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET PINE AND DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-2 CLASS H-3 CIRC. CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES 33.00 33.41 33.82 34.24 34.65 35.06 35.47 35.89 36.30 36.71 37.12 31 .oo 31.39 31.70 32.18 32.57 32.96 33.35 33.74 34.14 34.53 34.92 29.00 29.38 29.76 16 17 18 19 20 37.53 37.95 38.36 38.77 39.18 39.59 40.01 40.42 40.83 41 .24 21 22 23 24 25 26 21 28 29 30 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 80 FOOT POLE CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES 30.14 30.51 30.89 31 .27 31 .65 32.03 32.41 32.78 27.00 27.36 27.73 28.09 28.46 28.82 29.19 29.55 29.92 30.28 30.65 25.00 25.34 25.69 26.03 26.38 26.72 27.07 27.41 27.76 28. IO 28.45 23.00 23.32 23.65 23.97 24.30 24.62 24.95 25.27 25.59 25.92 26.24 35.31 35.70 36.09 36.49 36.88 37.27 37.66 38.05 38.45 38.84 33.16 33.54 33.92 34.30 34.68 35.05 35.43 35.81 36.19 36.57 31 .Ol 31 .38 31.74 32.11 32.47 32.84 33.20 33.57 33.93 34.30 28.79 29.14 29.48 29.82 30.17 30.51 30.86 31.20 31.55 31 .89 26.57 26.89 27.22 27.54 27.86 28.19 28.51 28.84 29.16 29.49 41.66 42.07 42.48 42.89 43.30 43.72 44.13 44.54 44.95 45.36 39.23 39.62 40.01 40.41 40.80 41.19 41.50 41.97 42.36 42.76 36.95 37.32 37.70 38.08 38.46 38.84 39.22 39.59 39.97 40.35 34.66 35.03 35.39 35.76 36.12 36.49 36.85 37.22 37.58 37.95 32.24 32.58 32.93 33.27 33.61 33.96 34.30 34.65 34.99 35.34 29.81 30.14 30.46 30.78 32.08 32.41 32.73 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 45.78 46.19 46.60 47.01 47.43 47.84 48.25 48.66 49.07 49.49 43.15 43.54 43.93 44.32 44.72 45.11 45.50 45.89 46.28 46.68 40.73 42.24 42.62 43.00 43.38 43.76 44.14 38.31 38.68 39.04 39.41 39.77 40.14 40.50 40.86 41 .23 41.59 35.68 36.03 36.37 36.72 37.06 37.41 37.75 38.09 38.44 38.78 33.05 33.38 33.70 34.03 34.35 34.68 35.00 35.32 35.65 35.97 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 49.90 50.31 50.72 51.14 51.55 51.96 52.37 52.78 53.20 53.61 47.07 47.46 47.85 48.24 48.64 49.03 49.42 49.81 50.20 50.59 44.51 44.89 45.27 45.65 46.03 46.41 46.78 47.16 47.54 47.92 41 .96 42.32 42.69 43.05 43.42 43.78 44.15 44.51 44.88 45.24 39.13 39.47 39.82 40.16 40.51 40.85 41.20 41.54 41 .89 42.23 36.30 36.62 36.95 37.27 37.59 37.92 38.24 38.57 38.89 39.22 TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 El 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 41.11 41.49 41.86 31.11 31.43 31 .76 TRANSMISSION 364 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET PINE AND DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-2 CLASS H-3 CIRC. CIRC. INCHES INCHES 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 54.02 54.43 54.84 55.26 55.67 56.08 56.49 56.91 57.32 57.73 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 58.14 58.55 58.91 59.38 59.79 60.20 60.61 61 .03 61 .44 70 61 .85 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 62.26 62.68 63.09 63.50 63.91 64.32 64.74 65.15 65.56 65.9-l SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 PINE AND CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.41 33.81 34.22 34.62 35.03 35.43 35.84 36.24 36.65 37.05 50 99 51 38 51 77 52 16 52 55 52 95 53 34 53.73 54.12 54.51 54.91 55.30 55.69 56.08 56.47 56.86 57.26 57.65 58.04 -GROUND 58.43 LINE 58.82 59.22 59.61 60.00 60.39 60.78 61.18 61 .51 61 .96 62.35 DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 31 31 31 32 32 32 33 33 34 34 34 00 39 77 16 54 93 32 70 09 47 86 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 48.30 48.68 49.05 49.43 49.81 50.19 50.57 50.95 51 .32 51.70 45.61 45.97 46.34 46.70 47.07 47.43 47.80 48.16 48.53 48.89 42.57 42.92 43.26 43.61 43.95 44.30 44.64 44.99 45.33 45.68 39.54 39.86 40.19 40.51 40.84 41.16 41.49 41.81 42.14 42.46 49.26 49.62 49.99 50.35 50.72 51 .08 51.45 51 .81 52.18 INCHES) 52.54 46.02 46.36 46.71 47.05 47.40 47.74 48.09 48.43 48.78 42.78 43.11 43.43 43.76 44.08 44.41 44.73 45.05 45.38 49.12 45.70 55.86 56.24 56.62 57.00 57.38 57.16 58.14 58.51 58.89 59.27 52.91 53.21 53.64 54.00 54.36 54.73 55.09 55.46 55.82 56.19 49.47 49.81 50.16 50.50 50.84 51.19 51.53 51.88 52.22 52.57 46.03 46.35 46.68 47.00 47.32 41.65 47.97 48.30 48.62 48.95 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 29.00 29.37 29.75 30.12 30.49 30.87 31 .24 31 .61 31.99 32.36 32.73 27.00 27.35 27.71 28.06 28.42 28.77 29.13 29.48 29.84 30.19 30.54 52.08 52.46 52.84 53.22 53.59 53.91 54.35 54.73 55.11 (10 FEET 55.49 0 1 80 FOOT POLE-Con. CLASS 2 CLASS 3 CIRC. CIRC. INCHES INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 25.00 25.34 25.67 26.01 26.34 26.68 27.01 27.35 21.68 28.02 28.35 2 85 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES 23.00 23.32 23.63 23.95 24.27 24.58 24.90 25.22 25.53 25.85 26.16 POLE APPENDIX 365 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET PINE AND DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-3 CLASS H-2 CIRC. CIRC. INCHES INCHES 85 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 FOOT POLE-Con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37.46 37.86 38.27 38.67 39.08 39.48 39.89 40.29 40.70 41.10 35.25 35.63 36.02 36.41 36.79 37.16 37.56 37.95 38.34 38.72 33.11 33.46 33.85 34.23 34.60 34.91 35.35 35.72 36.09 36.47 30.90 31.25 31.61 31.96 32.32 32.67 33.03 33.38 33.73 34.09 28.69 29.03 29.36 29.70 30.03 30.37 30.70 31.04 31.37 31.71 26.48 26.80 27.11 27.43 27.75 28.06 28.38 28.70 29.01 29.33 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 41.51 41.91 42.32 42.72 43.13 43.53 43.94 44.34 44.75 45.15 39.11 39.49 39.88 40.27 40.65 41.04 41.42 41.81 42.20 42.58 36.84 37.22 37.59 37.96 38.34 38.71 39.08 39.46 39.83 40.20 34.44 34.80 35.15 35.51 35.86 36.22 36.57 36.92 37.28 37.63 32.04 32.38 32.72 33.05 33.39 33.72 34.06 34.39 34.73 35.06 29.65 29.96 30.28 30.59 30.91 31.23 31.54 31.86 32.18 32.49 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 45.56 45.96 46.37 46.77 47.16 47.58 47.99 48.39 48.80 49.20 42.97 43.35 43.74 44.13 44.51 44.90 45.28 45.67 46.06 46.44 40.58 40.95 41.32 41.70 42.07 42.44 42.82 43.19 43.56 43.94 37.99 36.34 38.70 39.05 39.41 39.16 40.11 40.47 40.82 41.18 35.40 35.73 36.07 36.41 36.74 37.08 37.41 37.75 38.08 38.42 32.81 33.13 33.44 33.76 34.08 34.39 34.71 35.03 35.34 35.66 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 49.61 50.01 50.42 50.82 51.23 51.63 52.04 52.44 52.85 53.25 46.83 47.22 47.60 47.99 48.37 48.76 49.15 49.53 49.92 50.30 44.31 44.68 45.06 45.43 45.80 46.18 46.55 46.92 47.30 47.67 41.53 41.89 42.24 42.59 42.95 43.30 43.66 44.01 44.37 44.72 38.75 39.09 39.42 39.76 40.09 40.43 40.77 41.10 41.44 41.77 35.97 36.29 36.61 36.92 37.24 37.56 37.87 38.19 38.51 38.82 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 56 59 60 53.66 54.06 54.47 54.87 55.28 55.68 56.09 56.49 56.90 57.30 50.69 51.08 51.46 51.85 52.23 52.62 53.01 53.39 53.78 54.16 48.04 48.42 48.79 49.16 49.54 49.91 50.28 50.66 51.03 51.41 45.08 45.43 45.76 46.14 46.49 46.85 47.20 47.56 47.91 48.27 42.11 42.44 42.78 43.11 43.45 43.78 44.12 44.46 44.79 45.13 39.14 39.46 39.77 40.09 40.41 40.72 41.04 41.35 41.67 41.99 3 TRANSMISSION 366 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET PINE AND CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 57.71 58.11 58.52 58.92 59.33 59.73 60.14 60.54 60.95 61.35 71 72 73 74 61 .76 62.16 62.57 62.97 75 76 77 78 79 80 63.38 63.78 64.19 64.59 65.00 65.41 81 82 83 84 85 65.81 66.22 66.62 67.03 67.43 SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET PINE AND CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 85 FOOT POLE-con. CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 54 54 55 55 56 56 56 57 57 58 51 .78 52.15 52.53 52.90 53.27 53.65 54.02 54.39 54.77 55.14 48.62 48.97 49.33 49.68 50.04 50.39 50.75 51.10 51 .46 51 .81 45.46 45.80 46.13 46.47 46.80 47.14 47.47 47.81 48.15 48.48 42.30 42.62 42.94 43.25 43.57 43.89 44.20 44.52 44.84 45.15 55.51 55.89 56.26 56.63 (10 FEET, 57.01 57.38 57.75 58.13 58.50 58.87 52.16 52.52 52.87 53.23 INCHESl---53.58 53.94 54.29 54.65 55.00 55.35 48.82 49.15 49.49 49.82 45.47 45.78 46.10 46.42 50.16 50.49 50.83 51.16 51.50 51 .84 46.73 47.05 47.37 47.68 48.00 48.32 52 52 52 53 53 48.63 48.95 49.27 49.58 49.90 55 94 32 71 09 48 87 25 64 03 58 41 58 80 59 18 59 57 -GROUND LINE 59.96 60.34 60.73 61.11 61 .50 61 .89 62.27 62.66 63.04 63.43 63.82 DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 59.25 59.62 59.99 60.37 60.74 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 6 1 55.71 56.06 56.42 56.77 57.13 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS?-CIRC. INCHES 17 51 84 18 51 CLASS CIRC. INCHES TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33.00 33.40 33.80 34.20 34.60 34.99 35.39 35.79 36.19 36.59 36.99 31 .oo 31 .38 31 .76 32.14 32.52 32.90 33.29 33.67 34.05 34.43 34.81 29.00 29.36 29.73 30.09 30.45 30.82 31.18 31.54 31.90 32.27 32.63 27.00 27.35 27.69 28.04 28.38 28.73 29.07 29.42 29.76 30.11 30.45 25.00 25.33 25.67 26.00 26.33 26.67 27.00 27.33 27.67 28.00 28.33 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37.39 37.79 38.18 38.58 38.98 39.38 39.78 40.18 40.58 40.98 35.19 35.57 35.95 36.33 36.71 37.10 37.48 37.86 38.24 38.62 32.99 33.36 33.72 34.08 34.45 34.81 35.17 35.54 35.90 36.26 30.80 31.14 31.49 31 .83 32.18 32.52 32.87 33.21 33.56 33.90 28 29 29 29 30 30 30 31 31 31 2 90 FOOT POLE CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES 23.00 23.31 23.62 23.93 24.24 24.55 24.86 25.17 25.48 25.79 26.10 67 00 33 67 00 33 67 00 33 67 26.40 26.71 27.02 27.33 27.64 27.95 28.26 28.57 28.88 29.19 APPENDIX 367 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET PINE AND DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-3 CLASS H-2 CIRC. CIRC. INCHES INCHES 21 22 23 24 25 26 21 28 29 30 41.37 41.77 42.17 42.57 42.97 43.37 43.77 44.17 44.57 44.96 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 INCHES FOOT POLE-Con. CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. 90 2 42.05 42.43 36.62 36.99 37.35 37.71 38.08 38.44 38.80 39.17 39.53 39.89 34.25 34.60 34.94 35.29 35.63 35.98 36.32 36.67 37.01 37.36 32.00 32.33 32.67 33.00 33.33 33.67 34.00 34.33 34.67 35.00 29.81 30.12 30.43 30.74 31.05 31 .36 31 .67 31 .98 32.29 45.36 45.16 46.16 46.56 46.96 47.36 47.76 48.15 48.55 48.95 42.81 43.19 43.57 43.95 44.33 44.71 45.10 45.48 45.86 46.24 40.26 40.62 40.98 41.35 41.71 42.07 42.43 42.80 43.16 43.52 37.70 38.74 39.08 39.43 39.77 40.12 40.46 40.81 35.33 35.67 36.00 36.33 36.67 37.00 37.33 37.67 38.00 38.33 32.60 32.90 33.21 33.52 33.83 34.14 34.45 34.76 35.07 35.38 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 49.35 49.75 50.15 50.55 50.95 51.35 51.74 52. 14 52.54 52.94 46.62 47.00 47.38 47.76 48.14 48.52 48.90 49.29 49.67 50.05 43.89 44.25 44.61 44.98 45.34 45.70 46.07 46.43 46.79 47.15 41.15 41.50 41 .85 42.19 42.54 42.88 43.23 43.57 43.92 44.26 38.67 39.00 39.33 39.67 40.00 40.33 40.67 41 .oo 41.33 41 .67 35.69 36.00 36.31 36.62 36.93 37.24 37.55 37.86 38.17 38.48 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 53.34 53.74 54.14 54.54 54.93 55.33 55.13 56.13 56.53 56.93 50.43 50.81 51.19 51.57 52.33 52.71 53.10 53.48 53.06 47.52 47.88 48.24 48.61 48.97 49.33 49.70 50.06 50.42 50.79 44.61 44.95 45.30 45.64 45.99 46.33 46.68 47.02 47.37 47.71 42.00 42.33 42.67 43.00 43.33 43.67 44.00 44.33 44.67 45.00 38.79 39.10 39.40 39.71 40.02 40.33 40.64 40.95 41 .26 41.57 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 57.33 57.73 58.12 50.52 58.92 59.32 59.72 60.12 60.52 60.92 54.24 54.62 55.00 55.30 55.76 56.14 56.52 56.90 57.29 57.67 51.15 51.51 51 .87 52.24 52.60 52.96 53.33 53.69 54.05 54.42 48.06 48.40 48.75 49.10 49.44 49.79 50.13 50.48 50.82 51.17 45.33 45.67 46.00 46.33 46.67 47.00 47.33 47.67 48.00 48.33 41.88 42.19 42.50 42.81 43.12 43.43 43.74 44.05 44.36 44.67 39.00 39.38 39.76 40.14 40.52 40.90 41.29 Ltl .67 51.95 38.05 38.39 29.50 368 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET SOUTHERN PINE AND CLASS H-3 CIRC. 1 NCHES 71 61 .32 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 61 .71 62. I I 62.51 62.91 63.31 63.71 64.11 79 80 64.51 64.90 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 65.30 65.70 66.10 66.50 66.90 67.30 67.70 68.10 68.49 68.89 YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 DOUGLAS FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. 90 CLASS CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES 58.05 58.43 58.81 59.19 59.57 59.95 60.33 60.71 51.51 51 .86 52.20 52.55 52.89 53.24 53.58 53.93 61 .48 54.78 55.14 55.51 55.87 56.23 56.60 56.96 57.32 (11 FEET, 57.68 58.05 61 .86 62.24 62.62 63.00 63.38 63.76 64.14 64.52 64.90 65.29 58.41 58.77 59.14 59.50 59.86 60.23 60.59 60.95 61 .32 61 .68 -GROUND 61.10 AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES LINE FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 0 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 54.27 54.62 45.60 45.90 46.21 46.52 46.83 47.14 ----47.45 47.76 54.96 55.31 55.65 56.00 56.35 56.69 57.04 57.38 57.13 58.07 52.00 52.33 52.61 53.00 53.33 53.67 54.00 54.33 54.67 55.00 48.07 48.38 48.69 49.00 49.31 49.62 49.93 50.24 50.55 50.86 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 44.98 45.29 CLASS 95 2 CIRC. INCHES 31 .oo 31.38 31.75 32.13 32.51 32.88 33.26 33.63 34.0 1 34.39 34.76 29.00 29.36 29.72 30.08 30.44 30.80 31.16 31 .52 31.88 32.24 32.60 27.00 27.34 27.67 28.01 2’3.35 28.69 29.02 29.36 29.70 30.03 30.37 25.00 25.33 25.65 25.98 26.30 26.63 26.96 27.28 27.61 27.93 28.26 37.26 37.65 38.04 38.43 38.81 39.20 39.59 39.98 40.37 40.75 35.14 35.52 35.89 36.27 36.65 37.02 37.40 37.78 38.15 38.53 32 33 33 34 34 34 35 35 35 36 30 31 31 31 32 32 32 33 33 33 28.58 28.91 29.24 29.56 29.89 30.21 30.54 30.87 31.19 31 .52 31 67 03 39 75 11 47 83 19 71 04 38 72 06 39 73 07 40 74 3 INCHES 33.00 33.39 33.78 34.16 34.55 34.94 35.33 35.71 36.10 36.49 36.88 96 POLE-Con. CLASS CIRC. 48.67 49.00 49.33 49.67 50.00 50.33 50.67 51 .oo _-----51.33 51 .67 INCHES1 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES FOOT 2 FOOT POLE APPENDIX 369 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 95 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 26 29 30 41.14 41.53 41.92 42.30 42.69 43.08 43.47 43.85 44.24 44.63 38.90 39.28 39.66 40.03 40.41 40.79 41.16 41.54 41.92 42.29 36.55 36.91 37.27 37.63 37.99 38.35 38.71 39.07 39.43 39.79 34.08 34.42 34.75 35.09 35.43 35.76 36.10 36.44 36.76 37.1 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 45.02 45.40 45.79 46. I8 46.57 46.96 47.34 47.73 48.12 48.51 42.67 43.04 43.42 43.80 44.17 44.55 44.93 45.30 45.68 46.06 40.15 40.51 40.67 41.22 41.58 41.94 42.30 42.66 43.02 43.38 37.45 37.79 38.12 38.46 38.80 39.13 39.47 39.81 40.15 40.48 35. IO 35.43 35.75 36 ~08 36.40 36.73 37.06 37.36 37.71 38.03 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 48.89 49.28 49.67 50.06 50.44 50.83 51.22 51 .61 51.99 52.38 46.43 46.81 47.19 47.56 47.94 48.31 48.69 49.07 49.44 49.82 43.74 44. IO 44.46 44.82 45.18 45.54 45.90 46.26 46.62 46.98 40.82 41.16 41.49 41 .83 42.17 42.51 42.84 43.18 43.52 43.85 38.36 38.69 39.01 39.34 39.66 39.99 40.31 40.64 40.97 41.29 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 52.77 53.16 53.54 53.93 54.32 54.71 55.10 55.48 55.87 56.26 50.20 50.57 50.95 51.33 51.70 52.08 52.46 52.83 53.21 53.56 47.34 47.70 48.06 48.42 46.78 49.13 49.49 49.85 50.21 50.57 44.19 44.53 44.87 45.20 45.54 45.88 46.21 46.55 46.89 47.22 41 .62 41.94 42.27 42.60 42.92 43.25 43.57 43.90 44.22 44.55 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 56.65 57.03 57.42 57.81 58.20 58.58 58.97 59.36 59.75 60.13 53.96 54.34 54.71 55.09 55.47 55.84 56.22 56.60 56.97 57.35 50.93 51.29 51 .65 52.01 52.37 52.73 53.09 53.45 53.81 54.17 47.56 47.90 46.24 48.57 48.91 49.25 49.58 49.92 50.26 50.60 44.88 45.20 45.53 45.65 46.18 46.51 46.83 47.16 47.48 47.61 I 31.84 32.17 32.49 32.82 33.15 33.47 33.80 34.12 34.45 34.78 POLE-Con. TRANSMISSION 370 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. 1NCHES FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES 61 .69 62.07 62.46 62.85 63.24 63.62 64.01 57.72 58.10 58.48 58.85 59.23 59.61 59.98 60.36 60.74 61.11 54.53 54.89 55.25 55.61 55.97 56.33 56.69 57.04 57.40 57.76 50.93 51 .27 51 .61 51.94 52.28 52.62 52.96 53.29 53.63 53.97 64.40 64.79 65.17 61 .49 61 .87 62.24 58.12 58.48 58.84 54.30 54.64 54.98 60.52 60.91 61 .30 1 95 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 85 86 87 88 89 90 65.56 65.95 66.34 66.72 67.11 67.50 67.89 62.62 62.99 63.37 63.75 64.12 64.50 64.88 59.20 59.56 59.92 60.28 60.64 61 .OO 61 .36 55.31 55.65 55.99 56.33 56.66 57.00 57.34 91 92 93 94 95 68.28 68.66 69.05 69.44 69.83 65.25 65.63 66.01 66.38 66.76 61 .72 62.08 62.44 62.80 63.16 57.67 58.01 58.35 58.69 59.02 54.65 54.98 55.30 55.63 55.96 FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. CLASS CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES INCHES INCHES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33.00 33.38 33.77 34.15 34.53 34.91 35.30 35.68 36.06 36.45 36.83 31 .oo 31.37 31.73 32.10 32.47 32.84 33.20 33.57 33.94 34.30 34.67 29.00 29.35 29.70 30.05 30.40 30.76 31.11 31 .46 31 .81 32.16 32.51 27.00 27.34 27.67 28.01 28.34 28.68 29.01 29.35 29.68 30.02 30.35 25.00 25.32 25.64 25.96 26.28 26.60 26.91 27.23 27.55 27.87 28.19 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37.21 37.60 37.98 38.36 38.74 39.13 39.51 39.89 40.28 40.66 35.04 35.40 35.77 36.14 36.51 36.87 37.24 37.61 37.97 38.34 32.86 33.21 33.56 33.91 34.27 34.62 34.97 35.32 35.67 36.02 30.69 31.02 31 .36 31.69 32.03 32.36 32.70 33.03 33.37 33.70 28.51 28.83 29.15 29.47 29.79 30.11 30.43 30.74 31 .06 31 .38 -----GROUND YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. LINE (11 FEET, 0 POLE-con. 48.13 48.46 48.79 49.11 49.44 49.76 50.09 50.42 50.74 51.07 51.39 51 .72 52.04 -----52.37 52.70 53.02 53.35 53.67 54.00 54.33 84 SOUTHERN CLASS CIRC. INCHES)----- 100 1 CLASS CIRC. 2 FOOT POLE APPENDIX 371 6 Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. 100 INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. 1NCHES CLASS CIRC. 1 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES INCHES 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 41.04 41.43 41 .81 42.19 42.57 42.96 43.34 43.72 44.11 44.49 38.71 39.07 39.44 39.81 40.18 40.54 40.91 41 .28 41 .64 42.01 36.37 36.72 37.07 37.43 37.78 38.13 38.48 38.83 39.18 39.53 34.04 34.37 34.71 35.04 35.38 35.71 36.05 36.38 36.72 37.05 31.70 32.02 32.34 32.66 32.98 33.30 33.62 33.94 34.26 34.57 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 44.87 45.26 45.64 46.02 46.40 46.79 47.17 47.55 47.94 48.32 42.38 42.74 43.11 43.48 43.85 44.21 44.58 44.95 45.31 45.68 39.88 40.23 40.59 40.94 41.29 41 .64 41.99 42.34 42.69 43.04 37.39 37.72 38.06 38.39 38.73 39.06 39.40 39.73 40.07 40.40 34.89 35.21 35.53 35.05 36.17 36.49 36.81 37.13 37.45 37.77 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 48.70 49.09 49.47 49.85 50.23 50.62 51 .oo 51 .38 51.77 52.15 46.05 46.41 46.78 47.15 47.52 47.88 48.25 48.62 48.98 49.35 43.39 43.74 44.10 44.45 44.80 45.15 45.50 45.85 46.20 46.55 40.74 41.07 41.41 41.74 42.08 42.41 42.75 43.09 43.42 43.76 38.09 38.40 38.72 39.04 39.36 39.68 40.00 40.32 40.64 40.96 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 52.53 52.91 53.30 53.68 54.06 54.45 54.83 55.21 55.60 55.98 49.72 50.09 50.45 50.82 51.19 51.55 51.92 52.29 52.65 53.02 46.90 47.26 47.61 47.96 48.31 48.66 49.01 49.36 49.71 50.06 44.09 44.43 44.76 45.10 45.43 45.77 46.10 46.44 46.77 47.11 41 .28 41 .60 41.91 42.23 42.55 42.87 43.19 43.51 43.83 44.15 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 56.36 56.74 57.13 57.51 57.89 58.28 58.66 59.04 59.43 59.81 53.39 53.76 54.12 54.49 54.86 55.22 55.59 55.96 56.32 56.69 50.41 50.77 51.12 51.47 51 .82 52.17 52.52 52.87 53.22 53.57 47.44 47.78 48.11 48.45 48.78 49.12 49.45 49.79 50.12 50.46 44.47 44.79 45.11 45.43 45.74 46.06 46.38 46.70 47; 02 47.34 21 POLE-Con. 372 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 70 79 80 60.19 60.57 60.96 61 .34 61 .72 62.11 62.49 62.87 63.26 63.64 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 64.02 64.40 64.79 65.17 65.55 65.94 66.32 66.70 .-----GROUND 67.09 67.47 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 SOUTHERN AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 67.85 68.23 68.62 69.00 69.38 69.77 70.15 70.53 70.91 71.30 AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.38 33.76 34.14 34.52 34.89 35.27 35.65 36.03 36.41 36.79 FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 57.06 57.43 57.79 58.16 58.53 58.89 59.26 59.63 59.99 60.36 60.73 61.10 61 .46 61 .83 62.20 62.56 62.93 63.30 L INE (11 ‘63.66 64.03 64 64 65 65 65 66 66 66 67 67 40 77 13 50 87 23 60 97 34 70 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. 1 NCHES 1 100 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 53.93 54.28 54.63 54.98 55.33 55.68 56.03 56.38 56.73 57.09 50 51 51 51 52 52 52 53 53 53 79 13 46 80 13 47 80 14 47 81 47.66 47.98 48.30 48.62 48.94 49.26 49.57 49.89 50.21 50.53 57.44 57.79 58.14 58.49 58.84 59.19 59.54 59.89 FEET, 0 60.24 60.60 54 54 54 55 55 55 56 56 14 48 81 15 48 82 15 49 50.85 51.17 51.49 51 .81 52.13 52.45 52.77 53.09 56 57 82 16 53.40 53.72 POLE-Con. INCHES)-- 60.95 61 .30 61 .65 62.00 62.35 62.70 63.05 63.40 63.76 64.11 57.49 57.83 58.16 58.50 58.84 59.17 59.51 59.84 60.18 60.51 FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 31 .oo 31 .36 31.73 32.09 32.45 32.82 33.18 33.55 33.91 34.27 34.64 29.00 29.34 29.69 30.03 30.37 30.72 31 .06 31.40 31.75 32.09 32.43 27.00 27.33 27.66 27.98 28.31 28.64 28.97 29.30 29.63 29.95 30.28 54.04 54.36 54.68 55.00 55.32 55.64 55.96 56.28 56.60 56.91 1 105 CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 25.00 25.31 25.63 25.94 26.25 26.57 26.88 27.19 27.51 27.82 28.13 FOOT POLE APPENDIX 373 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES I 105 FOOT POLE CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES I I 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37.17 37.55 37.92 38.30 38.68 39.06 39.44 39.02 40.20 40.58 35.00 35.36 35.73 36.09 36.45 36.82 37.18 31.55 37.91 38.27 32.78 33.12 33.46 33.81 34.15 34.49 34.84 35.18 35.53 35.87 30.61 30.94 31 .27 31 .60 31.92 32.25 32.58 32.91 33.24 33.57 28.44 28.76 29.07 29.38 29.70 30.01 30.32 30.64 30.95 31 .26 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 40.95 41.33 41.71 42.09 42.47 42.85 43.23 43.61 43.98 44.36 38.64 39.00 39.36 39.73 40.09 40.45 40.82 41.18 41.55 41.91 36.21 36.56 36.90 37.24 37.59 37.93 38.27 38.62 38.96 39.30 33.89 34.22 34.55 34.88 35.21 35.54 35.86 36. 19 36.52 36.85 31 .58 31 .89 32.20 32.52 32.83 33.14 33.45 33.77 34.08 34.39 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 44.74 45.12 45.50 45.88 46.26 46.64 47.02 47.39 41.71 48.15 42.27 42.64 43.00 43.36 43.73 44.09 44.45 44.82 45.18 45.55 39.65 39.99 40.33 40.68 41.02 41 .36 41.71 42.05 42.39 42.74 37.18 37.51 37.83 38.16 38.49 38.82 39.15 39.47 39.80 40.13 34.71 35.02 35.33 35.65 35.96 36.27 36.59 36.90 37.21 37.53 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 48.53 48.91 49.29 49.67 50.05 50.42 50.80 51.18 51 .56 51.94 45.91 46.27 46.64 47.00 47.36 47.73 48.09 48.45 48.82 49.18 43.08 43.42 43.77 44. I I 44.45 44.80 45.14 45.48 45.83 46.17 40.46 40.79 41.12 41.44 41.77 42.10 42.43 42.76 43.09 43.41 37.84 38.15 38.46 38.78 39.09 39.40 39.72 40.03 40.34 40.66 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 52.32 52.70 53.08 53.45 53.83 54.21 54.59 54.97 55.35 55.73 49.55 49.91 50.27 50.64 51 .oo 51 .36 51.73 52.09 52.45 52.82 46.52 46.86 47.20 47.55 47.89 48.23 48.58 48.92 49.26 49.61 43.74 44.07 44.40 44.73 45.06 45.38 45.71 46.04 46.37 46.70 40.97 41 .28 41 .60 41.91 42.22 42.54 42.85 43.16 43.. 47 43.79 -Con. 374 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. 1 NCHES FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 105 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 56.11 56.46 56.86 57.24 57.62 58.00 58.38 58.76 59.14 59.52 53.18 53.55 53.91 54.27 54.64 55.00 55.36 55.73 56.09 56.45 49.95 50.29 50.64 50.98 51 .32 51 .67 52.01 52.35 52.70 53.04 47.03 47.35 47.68 48.01 48.34 48.67 48.99 49.32 49.65 49.98 44.10 44.41 44.73 45.04 45.35 45.67 45.98 46.29 46.61 46.92 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 59.89 60.27 60.65 61 .03 61 .41 61 .79 62.17 62.55 62.92 63.30 56.82 57.18 57.55 57.91 56.27 56.64 59.00 59.36 59.73 60.09 53.38 53.73 54.07 54.41 54.76 55.10 55.44 55.79 56.13 56.47 50.31 50.64 50.96 51 .29 51 .62 51.95 52.28 52.61 52.93 53.26 47.23 47.55 47.86 48: 17 48.48 48.60 49.11 49.42 49.74 50.05 81 82 83 84 85 86 07 88 69 90 63.68 64.06 64.44 64.82 65.20 65.58 65.95 66.33 66.71 67.09 60.45 60.82 61.18 61 .55 61 .91 62.27 62.64 63.00 63.36 63.73 56.82 57.16 57.51 57.85 58.19 56.54 58.88 59.22 59.57 59.91 53.59 53.92 54.25 54.58 54.90 55.23 55.56 55.89 56.22 56.55 50.36 50.68 50.99 51.30 51 .62 51.93 52.24 52.56 52.87 53.18 67.47 91 92 67.85 -------------GROUND 93 68.23 94 68.61 95 68.98 96 69.36 97 69.74 98 70.12 99 70.50 100 70.88 101 102 103 104 105 71 .26 71 .64 72.02 72.39 72.77 64.09 64.45 LINE 64.62 65.18 65.55 65.91 66.27 66.64 67.00 67.36 67.73 68.09 68.45 68.82 69.18 (12 60.25 56.87 60.60 57.20 FEET, 0 INCHES)----60.94 57.53 61 .28 57.86 61 .63 58.19 61 .97 58.52 62.31 58.84 62.66 59.17 63.00 59.50 63.34 59.83 63.69 64.03 64.37 64.72 65.06 60.16 60.48 60.81 61.14 61 .47 53.49 53.81 54.12 54.43 54.75 55.06 55.37 55.69 56.00 56.31 56.63 56.94 57.25 57.57 57.88 POLE-Con. APPENDIX 375 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 110 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33.00 33.37 33.74 34.11 34.48 34.85 35.22 35.59 35.96 36.33 36.70 31.00 31.36 31.71 32.07 32.42 32.78 33.13 33.49 33.85 34.20 34.56 29.00 29.34 29.68 30.02 30.37 30.71 31.05 31.39 31.73 32.07 32.41 27.00 27.32 27.64 27.97 28.29 28.61 28.93 29.25 29.58 29.90 30.22 25.00 25.31 25.62 25.92 26.23 26.54 26.85 27.15 27.46 27.77 28.08 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37.07 37.44 37.81 38.18 38.55 38.92 39.29 39.66 40.03 40.40 34.91 35.27 35.62 35.98 36.34 36.69 37.05 37.40 37.76 38.12 32.75 33.10 33.44 33.78 34.12 34.46 34.80 35.14 35.49 35.83 30.54 30.87 31.19 31.51 31.83 32.15 32.48 32.80 33.12 33.44 28.38 28.69 29.00 29.31 29.62 29.92 30.23 30.54 30.85 31.15 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 40.77 41.14 41.51 41.88 42.25 42.62 43.00 43.37 43.74 44.11 38.47 38.83 39.18 39.54 39.89 40.25 40.61 40.96 41.32 41.67 36.17 36.51 36.85 37.19 37.53 37.87 38.22 38.56 38.90 39.24 33.76 34.09 34.41 34.73 35.05 35.37 35.70 36.02 36.34 36.66 31.46 31.77 32.08 32.38 32.69 33.00 33.31 33.62 33.92 34.23 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 44.48 44.85 45.22 45.59 45.96 46.33 46.70 47.07 47.44 47.81 42.03 42.38 42.74 43.10 43.45 43.81 44.16 44.52 44.87 45.23 39.58 39.92 40.26 40.61 40.95 41.29 41.63 41.97 42.31 42.65 36.99 37.31 37.63 37.95 38.27 38.60 38.92 39.24 39.56 39.88 34.54 34.65 35.15 35.46 35.77 36.08 36.38 36.69 37.00 37.31 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 48.18 48.55 48.92 49.29 49.66 50.03 50.40 50.77 51.14 51.51 45.59 45.94 46.30 46.65 47.01 47.37 47.72 48.08 48.43 48.79 43.00 43.34 43.68 44.02 44.36 44.70 45.04 45.38 45.73 46.07 40.21 40.53 40.85 41.17 41.50 41.82 42.14 42.46 42.78 43.11 37.62 37.92 38.23 38.54 38.85 39.15 39.46 39.77 40.08 40.38 POLE TRANSMISSION 376 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES I 110 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 51.88 52.25 52.62 52.99 53.36 53.73 54.10 54.47 54.84 55.21 49.14 49.50 49.86 50.21 50.57 50.92 51.28 51.63 51.99 52.35 46.41 46.75 47.09 47.43 47.77 48.12 48.46 48.80 49.14 49.48 43.43 43.75 44.07 44.39 44.72 45.04 45.36 45.68 46.00 46.33 40.69 41.00 41.31 41.62 41.92 42.23 42.54 42.85 43.15 43.46 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 55.56 55.95 56.32 56.69 57.06 57.43 57.80 58.17 58.54 58.91 52.70 53.06 53.41 53.77 54.12 54.48 54.84 55.19 55.55 55.90 49.82 50.16 50.50 50.85 51.19 51.53 51.87 52.21 52.55 52.89 46.65 46.97 47.29 47.62 47.94 48.26 48.58 48.90 49.23 49.55 43.77 44.08 44.38 44.69 45.00 45.31 45.62 45.92 46.23 46.54 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 59.28 59.65 60.02 60.39 60.76 61.13 61.50 61.87 62.25 62.62 56.26 56.62 56.97 57.33 57.60 58.04 58.39 50.75 59.11 59.46 53.24 53.58 53.92 54.26 54.60 54.94 55.28 55.62 55.97 56.31 49.87 50.19 50.51 50.84 51.16 51.48 51.80 52.12 52.45 52.77 46.85 47.15 47.46 47.77 48.08 48.38 48.69 49.00 49.31 49.62 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 62.99 63.36 63.73 64.10 64.47 64.84 65.21 65.58 65.95 66.32 59.82 60.17 60.53 60.88 61.24 61.60 61.95 62.31 62.66 63.02 56.65 56.99 57.33 57.67 58.01 58.36 58.70 59.04 59.38 59.72 53.09 53.41 53.74 54.06 54.38 54.70 55.02 55.35 55.67 55.99 49.92 50.23 50.54 50.05 51.15 51.46 51.77 52.08 52.38 52.69 91 66.69 67.06 92 67.43 93 67.80 94 68.17 95 68.54 96 68.91 97 -------------GROUND 98 69.28 99 69.65 100 70.02 63.37 63.73 64.09 64.44 64.80 65.15 65.51 LINE 65.67 66.22 66.58 60.06 60.40 60.75 61.09 61.43 61.77 62.11 FEET, 0 62.45 62.79 63.13 56.31 56.63 56.96 57.28 57.60 57.92 58.25 53.00 53.31 53.62 53.92 54.23 54.54 54.85 58.57 58.89 59.21 55.15 55.46 55.77 (12 INCHES)------ POLE-con. APPENDIX 377 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SGUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 1 IO ;OUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. 1 NCHES 70.39 70.76 71.13 71.50 71.87 72.24 72.61 72.98 73.35 73.72 66.93 67.29 67.64 68.00 60.36 68.71 69.07 69.42 69.70 70.13 CLASS H-i CIRC. INCHES 63 63 64 64 64 65 65 65 66 66 48 82 16 50 84 18 52 07 21 55 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES 31 .oo 31.35 31.70 32.05 32.39 32.74 33.09 33.44 33.79 34.14 34.49 29.00 9 10 33.00 33.36 33.72 34.09 34.45 34.81 35.17 35.54 35.90 36.26 36.62 11 12 13 14 15 16 36.99 37.35 37.71 38.07 38.44 38.80 17 39.16 18 19 20 39.52 39.09 40.25 34.83 35.18 35.53 35.88 36.23 36.50 36.93 37.28 37.62 37.97 32.60 33.02 33.35 33.69 34.02 34.36 34.69 35.03 35.36 35.70 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 40.61 40.97 41.33 41.70 42.06 42.42 42.78 43.15 38.32 30.67 39.02 39.37 39.72 40.06 40.41 40.76 41.11 41 .46 36.03 36.37 36.70 37.04 37.37 37.71 38.04 38.38 38.71 39.05 2 3 5 6 8 43.51 43.87 CLASS CIRC. 1 INCHES 59 59 60 60 60 61 61 61 62 62 110 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. 53 86 18 50 82 14 47 79 11 43 29.33 29.67 30.00 30.34 30.67 31 .Ol 31.34 31 .68 32.01 32.35 CLASS CIRC. 56.08 56.38 56.69 57.00 57.31 57.62 57.92 58.23 58.54 58.05 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES INCHES 27.00 27.32 27.63 27.95 25.00 25.30 25.61 25.91 26.21 26.51 26.82 27.12 27.42 27.72 28.03 28.27 28.5’3 28.90 29.22 29.53 29.85 30.17 30.48 30.80 32.06 32.38 32.70 33.01 33.33 28.33 28.63 28.94 29.24 29.54 29.84 30.15 30.45 30.75 31 .06 33.65 33.96 34.28 34.60 34.91 35.23 35.55 35.06 36.18 36.50 31 .36 31.66 31 .96 32.27 32.57 32.07 33.17 33.48 33.78 34.08 31.11 31.43 31.75 POLE-con. INCHES 115 FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. TOP AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 2 FOOT POLE 378 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 1 15 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 44.23 44.60 44.96 45.32 45.68 46.05 46.41 46.77 47.13 47.50 41.81 42.16 42.50 42.85 43.20 43.55 43.90 44.25 44.60 44.94 39.38 39.72 40.05 40.39 40.72 41 .06 41.39 41 .72 42.06 42.39 36.81 37.13 37.44 37.76 38.08 38.39 38.71 39.03 39.34 39.66 34.39 34.69 34.99 35.29 35.60 35.90 36.20 36.50 36.81 37.11 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 47.96 48.22 48.58 48.94 49.31 49.67 50.03 50.39 50.76 51.12 45.29 45.64 45.99 46.34 46.69 47.04 47.39 47.73 48.08 48.43 42.73 43.06 43.40 43.73 44.07 44.40 44.74 45.07 45.41 45.74 39.98 40.29 40.61 40.93 41 .24 41 .56 41.88 42.19 42.51 42.83 37.41 37.72 38.02 38.32 30.62 38.93 39.23 39.53 39.83 40.14 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 51.48 51.84 52.21 52.57 52.93 53.29 53.66 54.02 54.38 54.74 48.78 49.13 49.48 49.83 50.17 50.52 50.87 51.22 51.57 51.92 46.08 46.41 46.15 47.08 47.42 47.75 48.09 48.42 48.76 49.09 43.14 43.46 43.78 44.09 44.41 44.72 45.04 45.36 45.67 45.99 40.44 40.74 41.05 41.35 41 .65 41.95 42.26 42.56 42.86 43.17 61 62 63 64 65 66 61 68 69 70 55.11 55.47 55.83 56.19 56.56 56.92 57.28 57.64 58.00 58.37 52.27 52.61 52.96 53.31 53.66 54.01 54.36 54.71 55.06 55.40 49.43 49.76 50.10 50.43 50.77 51.10 51.44 51.77 52.11 52.44 46.31 46.62 46.94 47.26 47.57 47.89 48.21 48.52 48.84 49.16 43.47 43.77 44.07 44.38 44.68 44.98 45.28 45.59 45.89 46.19 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 59.73 59.09 59.45 59.82 60.18 60.54 60.90 61 .27 61 .63 61 .99 55.75 56.10 56.45 56.80 57.15 57.50 57.84 58.19 58.54 58.89 52.78 53.11 53.44 53.78 54.11 54.45 54.79 55.12 55.45 55.19 49.47 49.79 50.11 50.42 50.74 51 .06 51.37 51 .69 52.00 52.32 46.50 46.80 47.10 47.40 47.71 48.01 48.31 48.61 48.92 49.22 POLE-con. APPENDIX 379 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 56.12 56.46 56.79 57.13 57.46 57.80 58.13 58.47 58.80 59.14 52.64 52.95 53.27 53.59 53.90 54.22 54.54 54.85 55.17 55.49 49.52 49.63 50.13 50.43 50.73 51.04 51.34 51.64 51.94 52.25 62.35 62.72 63.08 63.44 63.80 64.17 64.53 64.89 65.25 65.61 59 59 59 60 60 60 61 61 62 62 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 65.98 66.34 66.70 67.06 67.43 67.19 68.15 68.51 68.88 69.24 62.72 63.07 63.42 63.77 64.12 64.41 64.82 65.17 65.51 65.86 59.47 59.81 60.14 60.48 60.81 61.15 61.48 61.82 62.15 62.49 55.80 56.12 56.44 56.75 57.07 57.39 57.70 58.02 58.33 58.65 52.55 52.85 53.16 53.46 53.76 54.06 54.37 54.67 54.97 55.28 66.21 66.56 LINE 66.91 67.26 67.61 67.95 68.30 68.65 69.00 69.35 62.82 63.16 0 FEE T. 63.49 63.83 64.16 64.50 64.63 65.17 65.50 65.83 58.97 59.28 INCHES)--------------- 55.58 55.88 59.60 59.92 60.23 60.55 60.87 61.18 61.50 61.82 56.18 56.49 56.79 57.09 57.39 57.70 58.00 58.30 66.17 66.50 66.84 67.17 67.51 62.13 62.45 62.77 63.06 63.40 58.61 58.91 59.21 59.51 59.82 .- 103 109 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 69.60 69.96 -----GROUND 70.33 70.69 71.05 71.41 71.78 72.14 72.50 72.86 73.22 73.59 73.95 74.31 74.67 ( 12 69.70 70.05 70.39 70.74 71.09 AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 33 33 33 34 34 34 35 35 35 36 36 24 59 94 28 63 98 33 60 03 38 1 1 15 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 81 82 83 84 85 06 87 88 89 90 101 102 --- SOUTHERN AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. 1 NCHES 00 36 72 08 44 80 16 52 88 24 60 FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 31.00 31.34 31.60 32.03 32.37 32.71 33.05 33.39 33.74 34.08 34.42 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 29.00 29.33 29.66 29.99 30.32 30.64 30.97 31.30 31.63 31.96 32.29 27.00 27.31 27.62 27.93 28.25 28.56 28.87 29.18 29.49 29.80 30.11 1 120 CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 25 25 25 25 26 26 26 27 27 27 27 00 30 60 89 19 49 79 09 39 68 98 POLE-con. FOOT POLE 380 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 120 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES I 1 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 36.96 37.32 37.68 38.04 38.39 38.75 39.11 39.47 39.83 40.19 34.76 35.11 35.45 35.79 36.13 36.47 36.82 37.16 37.50 37.84 32.62 32.95 33.28 33.61 33.93 34.26 34.59 34.92 35.25 35.58 30.43 30.74 31.05 31.36 31.67 31.98 32.29 32.61 32.92 33.23 28.28 28.58 28.88 29.18 29.47 29.77 30.07 30.37 30.67 30.96 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 40.55 40.91 41.27 41.63 41.99 42.35 42.71 43.07 43.43 43.19 38.18 38.53 38.87 39.21 39.55 39.89 40.24 40.58 40.92 41.26 35.91 36.24 36.57 36.89 37.22 37.55 37.88 38.21 38.54 38.87 33.54 33.85 34.16 34.47 34.79 35.10 35.41 35.72 36.03 36.34 31.26 31.56 31.86 32.16 32.46 32.75 33.05 33.35 33.65 33.95 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 44.15 44.51 44.87 45.23 45.59 45.95 46.31 46.67 47.03 47.39 41.61 41.95 42.29 42.63 42.97 43.32 43.66 44.00 44.34 44.68 39.20 39.53 39.86 40.18 40.51 40.84 41.17 41.50 41.83 42.16 36.65 36.96 37.28 37.59 37.90 38.21 38.52 38.83 39.14 39.46 34.25 34.54 34.84 35.14 35.44 35.74 36.04 36.33 36.63 36.93 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 47.75 48.11 48.46 48.82 49.18 49.54 49.90 50.26 50.62 50.98 45.03 45.37 45.71 46.05 46.39 46.74 47.08 47.42 47.76 48.11 42.49 42.82 43.14 43.47 43.60 44.13 44.46 44.79 45.12 45.45 39.77 40.08 40.39 40.70 41.01 41.32 41.64 41.95 42.26 42.57 37.23 37.53 37.82 38.12 38.42 38.72 39.02 39.32 39.61 39.91 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 51.34 51.70 52.06 52.42 52.78 53.14 53.50 53.86 54.22 54.58 48.45 48.79 49.13 49.47 49.82 50.16 50.50 50.84 51.18 51.53 45.78 46.11 46.43 46.76 47.09 47.42 47.75 48.08 48.41 48.74 42.88 43.19 43.50 43.82 44.13 44.44 44.75 45.06 45.37 45.68 40.21 40.51 40.81 41.11 41.40 41.70 42.00 42.30 42.60 42.89 POLE-con. ____._ APPENDIX !3 Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued ,UUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 120 FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 FOOT CLASS CIRC. INCHES 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 54.94 55.30 55.66 56.02 56.38 56.74 57.10 57.46 57.82 58.18 51 .87 52.21 52.55 52.89 53.24 53.58 53.92 54.26 54.61 54.95 49.07 49.39 49.72 50.05 50.38 50.71 51.04 51.37 51.70 52.03 46.00 46.31 46.62 46.93 47.24 47.55 47.86 48.18 48.49 48.80 43.19 43.49 43.79 44.09 44.39 44.68 44.98 45.28 45.58 45.88 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 18 79 80 58.54 50.89 59.25 59.61 59.97 60.33 60.69 61 .05 61 .41 61 .77 55.29 55.63 55.97 56.32 56.66 57.00 57.34 57.60 58.03 58.37 52.36 52.68 53.01 53.34 53.67 54.00 54.33 54.66 54.99 55.32 49.11 49.42 49.73 50.04 50.36 50.67 50.98 51 .29 51 .60 51.91 46.18 46.47 46.77 47.07 47.37 47.67 47.96 48.26 48.56 48.86 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 62.13 62.49 62.85 63.21 63.57 63.93 64.29 64.65 65.01 65.37 58.71 59.05 59.39 59.74 60.08 60.42 60.76 61.11 61 .45 61 .79 55.64 55.97 56.30 56.63 56.96 57.29 57.62 57.95 58.28 58.61 52.22 52.54 52.05 53.16 53.47 53.78 54.09 54.40 54.71 55.03 49. 16 49.46 49.75 50.05 50.35 50.65 50.95 51 .25 51.54 51 .84 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 65.73 66.09 66.45 66.81 67.17 67.53 67.89 68.25 68.61 68.96 62.13 62.47 62.82 63.16 63.50 63.84 64.18 64.53 64.87 65.21 58.93 59.26 59.59 59.92 60.25 60.58 60.91 61 .24 61 .57 61 .89 55.34 55.65 55.96 56.27 56.58 56.09 57.21 57.52 57.83 58.14 52. 14 52.44 52.74 53.04 53.33 53.63 53.93 54.23 54.53 54.82 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 69.32 69.68 70.04 70.40 70.76 71.12 71.48 ----GROUND 71 .a4 72.20 72.56 58.45 50.76 59.07 59.39 59.70 60.01 60.32 55.12 55.42 55.72 56.02 56.32 56.61 56.91 ----- 60.63 60.94 61 .25 57.21 57.51 57.81 108 109 110 65.55 65.09 66.24 66.58 66.92 67.26 67.61 LINE 67.95 68.29 68.63 (12 62.22 62.55 62.88 63.21 63.54 63.87 64.20 FEET. 0 64.53 64.86 65.18 INCHES)------ 2 POLE-Con. TRANSMISSION 382 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. 1 NCHES 72.92 73.28 73.64 74.00 74.36 74.72 75.08 75.44 75.80 76.16 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 68.97 69.32 69.66 70.00 70.34 70.68 71.03 71.37 71.71 72.05 65.51 65.84 66.17 66.50 66.83 67.16 67.49 67.82 68.14 68.47 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 FOOT CLASS CIRC. INCHES 61 .57 61 .88 62.19 62.50 62.81 63.12 63.43 63.75 64.06 64.37 58.11 58.40 58.70 59.00 59.30 59.60 59.89 60.19 60.49 60.79 125 2 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES INCHES INCHES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33.00 33.35 33.71 34.06 34.41 34.76 35.12 35.47 35.82 36.18 36.53 31 .oo 31.34 31 .67 32.01 32.34 32.68 33.02 33.35 33.69 34.03 34.36 29.00 29.32 29.65 29.97 30.29 27.00 27.31 27.61 27.92 28.23 28.53 28.84 29.15 29.45 29.76 30.07 25.00 25.29 25.58 25.87 26.16 26.45 26.74 27.03 27.32 27.61 27.90 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 36.88 37.24 37.59 37.94 38.29 38.65 39.00 39.35 39.71 40.06 34.70 35.03 35.37 35.71 36.04 36.38 36.71 37.05 37.39 37.72 32.56 32.88 33.53 33.85 34.18 34.50 34.82 35.15 35.47 30.37 30.68 30.99 31.29 31 .60 31.91 32.21 32.52 32.83 33.13 28.19 28.48 28.77 29.06 29.35 29.64 29.93 30.22 30.51 30.80 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 40.41 40.76 41.12 41.47 41 .82 42.18 42.53 42.88 43.24 43.59 38.06 38.39 38.73 39.07 35.79 36.12 36.44 36.76 37.09 37.41 37.74 38.06 38.38 38.71 33.44 33.75 34.05 34.36 34.67 34.97 35.28 35.59 35.89 36.20 31.09 31 .38 31 .67 31 .96 32.25 32.54 32.83 33.12 33.41 33.70 39.40 39.74 40.08 40.41 40.75 41 .08 30.62 30.94 31 .26 31.59 31.91 32.24 33.21 CLASS CIRC. POLE-Con. 2 FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. TOP AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. 120 FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. FOOT POLE APPENDIX 383 B Table B-3.-Pole circumferences for Douglas fir and southern yellow pine-Continued SOUTHERN YELLOW PINE DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET AND DOUGLAS CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES FIR CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 125 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 43.94 44.29 44.65 45.00 45.35 45.71 46.06 46.41 46.76 47.12 41 .42 41 .76 42.09 42.43 42.76 43. IO 43.44 43.77 44.11 44.45 39.03 39.35 39.68 40.00 40.32 40.65 40.97 41.29 41 .62 41.94 36.51 36.82 37.12 37.43 37.74 38.04 38.35 38.66 38.96 39.27 33.99 34.28 34.57 34.86 35.15 35.44 35.73 36.02 36.31 36.60 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 47.47 47.82 48.18 48.53 48.88 49.24 49.59 49.94 50.29 50.65 44.78 45.12 45.45 45.79 46.13 46.46 46.80 47.13 47.47 47.81 42.26 42.59 42.91 43.24 43.56 43.88 44.21 44.53 44.85 45.18 39.58 39.88 40.19 40.50 40.80 41.11 41 .42 41 .72 42.03 42.34 36.89 37.18 37.47 37.16 38.05 38.34 38.63 38.92 39.21 39.50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 51 .oo 51.35 51.71 52.06 52.41 52.76 53.12 53.47 53.82 54.18 48.14 48 ‘48 48.82 49.15 49.49 49.82 50.16 50.50 50.83 51.17 45.50 45.82 46.15 46.47 46.79 47.12 47.44 47.76 48.09 48.41 42.64 42.95 43.26 43.56 43.87 44.18 44.48 44.79 45.10 45.40 39.79 40.08 40.37 40.66 40.95 41 .24 41.53 41.82 42.11 42.39 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 54.53 54.88 55.24 55.59 55.94 56.29 56.65 57.00 57.35 57.71 51.50 51.84 52.18 52.51 52.85 53.18 53.52 53.86 54.19 54.53 48.74 49.06 49.38 49.71 50.03 50.35 50.68 51 .oo 51 .32 51 .65 45.71 46.02 46.32 46.63 46.94 47.24 47.55 47.86 48.16 48.47 42.68 42.97 43.26 43.55 43.84 44.13 44.42 44.71 45.00 45.29 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 58.06 58.41 58.76 59.12 59.47 59.82 60.18 60.53 60.88 61 .24 54.87 55.20 55.54 55.87 56.21 56.55 56.88 57.22 57.55 57.89 51.97 52.29 52.62 52.94 53.26 53.59 53.91 54.24 54.56 54.88 48.78 49.08 49.39 49.70 50.00 50.31 50.62 50.92 51 .23 51.54 45.58 45.87 46.16 46.45 46.74 47.03 47.32 47.61 47.90 48.19 POLE-con. APPENDIX 385 B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar rlESTERN RED 30 CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS CIRC. INCHES TOP WESTERN 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 3 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 3 4 5 6 I 8 9 10 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 31 32 00 54 08 63 17 71 25 79 33 88 42 25.00 25.52 26.04 26.56 27.08 27.60 28.13 28.65 29.17 29.69 30.21 23.00 23.50 24.00 24.50 25.00 25.50 26.00 26.50 21.00 27.50 28.00 21 .oo 21 .48 21 .96 22.44 22.92 23.40 23.88 24.35 24.83 25.31 25.79 I I 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 32 33 34 34 35 35 36 36 37 31 96 50 04 58 12 67 21 75 29 83 30.73 31 .25 31 .-II 32.29 32.81 33.33 33.85 34.37 34.90 35.42 28.50 29.00 29.50 30.00 30.50 31 .oo 31.50 32.00 32.50 33.00 26.27 26.75 27.23 27.71 28.19 28.61 29.15 29.63 30.10 30.58 21 22 23 24 ------GROUND 25 26 27 28 29 30 38 38 39 40 37 92 46 00 35.94 36.46 36.98 37.50 (5 FEET, 38.02 38.54 39.06 39.58 40.10 40.62 RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-2 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES TOP 1 31 .oo 31.59 32.17 32.76 33.34 33.93 34.52 35.10 35.69 36.28 36.86 LINE 40.54 41 .08 41 .62 42.17 42.71 43.25 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 29.00 29.57 30.14 30.71 31 .28 31 .84 32.41 32.98 33.55 34.12 34.69 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 27.00 27.53 28.07 28.60 29.14 29.67 30.21 30.74 31 .28 31 .81 32.34 33.50 34.00 34.50 35.00 6 INCHE!S------35.50 36.00 36.50 37.00 37.50 38.00 I CLASS CIRC. INCHES 25 25 26 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 00 52 03 55 07 59 10 62 14 66 17 2 FOOT POLE 35 FOOT CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES POLE 4 31 .06 31.54 32.02 32.50 32.98 33.46 33.94 34.42 34.90 35.37 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 23.00 23.50 24.00 24.50 25.00 25.50 26.00 26.50 27.00 27.50 28.00 3 - 21 .oo 21.47 21.93 22.40 22.86 23.33 23.79 24.26 24.72 25.19 25.66 386 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-2 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES 11 12 13 I4 15 16 17 19 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 --30 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 33 33 34 34 35 36 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 40 41 42 42 43 43 44 45 30.69 31.21 31 .72 32.24 32.76 33.28 33.79 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 37 37 43.31 43.90 44.4E 45.07 45.66 46.24 46.83 47.41 48.00 40 41 42 42 43 43 44 44 45 95 38.22 38.76 39.29 39.83 40.36 40.90 41.43 41.97 42.50 LINE (6 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 88 26 83 40 97 53 IO 67 24 81 30 52 09 66 22 79 36 93 50 1 41 95 48 02 55 09 62 16 69 35 35 36 36 37 30 30 39 39 40 FEET. CLASS CIRC. INCHES FOOT POLE-con. CLASS 4 CIRC. 1 NCHES 34.83 35.34 26.12 26.59 27.05 27.52 27.98 28.45 28.91 29.38 29.84 30.31 35.86 36.38 36.90 37.41 37.93 39.45 38.97 39.48 40.00 33.50 34.00 34.50 35.00 35.50 36.00 36.50 37.00 37.50 30.78 31 .24 31.71 32.17 32.64 33.10 33.57 34.03 34.50 34.31 0 35 3 28.50 29.00 29.50 30.00 30.50 31 .oo 31.50 32.00 32.50 33.00 INCHES)- 46 07 43.03 40.52 38.00 34.97 49.17 49.76 46 47 47 48 48 43 57 44 10 44 64 45 17 45 71 41.03 41.55 42.07 42.59 43.10 38.50 39.00 39.50 40.00 40.50 35.43 35.90 36.36 36.03 37.29 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 64 21 70 34 91 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 60 21 81 41 01 62 22 82 43 03 31 .oo 31.59 32.18 32.76 33.35 33.94 34.53 35.12 35.71 36.29 36.88 30.12 30.68 31 .24 31.79 32.35 32.91 33.47 34.03 34.59 27.00 27.53 28.06 28.59 29.12 29.65 30.18 30.71 31 .24 31 .76 32.29 63 24 84 44 04 65 25 85 46 06 37.47 38.06 38.65 39.24 39.82 40.41 41 .oo 41.59 42.18 42.76 35.15 35.71 36.26 36.82 37.38 37.94 38.50 39.06 39.62 40.18 32.92 33.35 33.88 34.41 34.94 35.47 36.00 36.53 37.06 37.59 00 2 40.59 50.34 50.93 51.52 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 37.45 38.03 38.62 39.21 39.79 40.38 40.97 41.55 42.14 42.72 .-GROUND 31 32 33 34 35 TOP CLASS H-l CIRC. 1 NCHES 29.00 29.56 1 CLASS CIRC. 2 40 FOOT POLE 3 CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 25.00 25.51 26.03 26.54 27.06 27.57 28.09 28.60 29.12 29.63 30.15 23.00 23.49 23.97 24.46 24.94 25.43 25.91 26.40 26.88 27.37 27.85 21 .oo 21 .46 21.91 22.37 22.82 23.28 23.74 24.19 24.65 25.10 25.56 30.66 31.18 31 .69 32.21 32.72 33.24 33.75 34.26 34.78 35.29 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 31 32 32 26.01 26.47 26.93 27.38 27.84 28.29 28.75 29.21 29.66 30.12 34 82 31 79 28 76 25 74 22 71 INCHES APPENDIX 387 B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 45.66 46.26 46.87 47.47 48.07 48.68 49.28 49.88 50.49 51.09 51 .69 52.29 52.90 ____--------_ 53.50 54.10 54.71 55.31 55.91 56.51 57.12 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 40 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 43 43 44 45 45 46 46 47 48 48 35 94 53 12 71 29 88 47 06 65 49.24 49.82 50.41 .--GROUND 51 .oo 51.59 52.18 52.76 53.35 53.94 54.53 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 40.74 41.29 41.85 42.41 42.97 43.53 44.09 44.65 45.21 45.76 46.32 46.88 47.44 LINE (6 48.00 48.56 49.12 49.68 50.24 50.79 51.35 FEET, CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 38.12 38.65 39.18 39.71 40.24 40.76 41.29 41 .82 42.35 42.88 35 36 36 37 37 38 38 39 39 40 43.41 43.94 44.47 0 INCHES)------45.00 45.53 46.06 46.59 47.12 47.65 48.18 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 2 81 32 84 35 87 38 90 41 93 44 FOOT CLASS CIRC. INCHES 3 POLE-con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES 33.19 33.68 34.16 34.65 35.13 35.62 36.10 36.59 37.07 37.56 30 31 31 31 32 32 33 33 34 34 57 03 49 94 40 85 31 76 22 68 40.96 41.47 41.99 38.04 38.53 39.01 35 35 36 13 59 04 42.50 43.01 43.53 44.04 44.56 45.07 45.59 39.50 39.99 40.47 40.96 41.44 41.93 42.41 36 36 37 37 38 38 39 50 96 41 87 32 78 24 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.59 34.18 34.77 35.36 35.95 36.54 37.13 37.72 38.31 38.90 31 31 32 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 00 58 15 73 31 88 46 04 62 19 77 29.00 29.55 30.10 30.65 31.21 31 .76 32.31 32.86 33.41 33.96 34.51 27.00 27.53 28.05 28.58 29.10 29.63 30.15 30.68 31.21 31.73 32.26 25 25 26 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 00 50 00 50 00 50 00 50 00 50 00 39.49 40.08 40.67 41 .26 41 .85 42.44 43.03 43.62 44.21 44.79 37 37 38 39 39 40 40 41 41 42 35 92 50 08 65 23 81 38 96 54 35.06 35.62 36.17 36.72 37.27 37.82 38.37 38.92 39.47 40.03 32.78 33.31 33.83 34.36 34.88 35.41 35.94 36.46 36.99 37.51 30.50 31 .oo 31.50 32.00 32.50 33.00 33.50 34.00 34.50 35.00 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 4 45 FOOT POLE 3 CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 23.00 23.47 23.95 24.42 24.90 25.37 25.85 26.32 26.79 27.27 27.74 21 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 25 25 28.22 28.69 29.17 29.64 30.12 30.59 31 .06 31.54 32.01 32.49 25.94 26.38 26.83 27.28 27.73 28.18 28.63 29.08 29.53 29.97 00 45 90 35 79 24 69 14 59 04 49 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 45.38 45.91 46 56 47 15 47 74 48 33 48 92 49 51 50.10 50.69 43.12 43.69 44.27 44.85 45.42 46.00 46.58 47.15 47.73 48.31 31 51.28 32 51.87 33 52.46 34 53.05 35 53.64 36 54.23 37 54.82 38 55.41 -----------------------GROUND 39 56.00 40 56.59 48.66 49.46 50.04 50.62 51.19 51.77 52.35 52.92 41 42 43 44 45 54.65 55.23 55.81 56.38 56.96 57.18 57.77 58.36 58.95 59.54 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES 53.50 54.08 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 40.58 41.13 41.68 42.23 42.70 43.33 43.88 44.44 44.99 45.54 38.04 30.56 39.09 39.62 40.14 40.67 41.19 41.72 42.24 42.77 35.50 36.00 36.50 37.00 37.50 38.00 38.50 39.00 39.50 40.00 43.29 43.82 44.35 44.87 45.40 45.92 46.45 46.97 6 INCHES)--47.50 48.03 40 41 41 42 42 43 43 44 48.55 49.08 49.60 50.13 50.65 46.09 46.64 47.19 47.74 48.29 48.85 49.40 49.95 LINE (6 50.50 51.05 FEET, 51.60 52.15 52.71 53.26 53.81 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 45 FOOT POLE-Con. CLASS CLASS 3~ CIRC. CIRC. INCHES INCHES 32.96 33.44 33.91 34.36 34.86 35.33 35.81 36.28 36.76 37.23 30.42 30.87 31.32 31.77 32.22 32.67 33.12 33.56 34.01 34.46 50 00 50 00 50 00 50 00 -- 37.71 38.18 38.65 39.13 39.60 40.08 40.55 41.03 ---_--- 34.91 35.36 35.81 36.26 36.71 37.15 37.60 38.05 44 45 50 00 41.50 41.97 38.50 38.95 45 46 46 47 47 50 00 50 00 50 42.45 42.92 43.40 43.87 44.35 39.40 39.05 40.29 40.74 41.19 CLASS CIRC. INCHES .oo 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 50 3 FOOT POLE CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES ; 6 7 8 9 IO 35 36 37 37 38 38 00 58 16 74 32 90 48 06 64 22 80 31.00 31.56 32.11 32.67 33.23 33.78 34.34 34.90 35.45 36.01 36.57 29.00 29.53 30.07 30.60 31.14 31.67 32.20 32.74 33.27 33.81 34.34 27.00 27.51 28.02 28.53 29.05 29.56 30.07 30.58 31.09 31.60 32.11 25 25 25 26 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 .49 .98 .47 .95 44 :93 .42 .91 40 :89 23.00 23.47 23.93 24.40 24.86 25.33 25.80 26.26 26.73 27.19 27.66 21.00 21.43 21.86 22.30 22.73 23.16 23.59 24.02 24.45 24.89 25.32 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 39.37 39.95 40.53 41 11 41 69 42 27 42.85 43.43 44 01 44 59 37.12 37.68 38.24 38.80 39.35 39.91 40.47 41.02 41.58 42.14 34.87 35.41 35.94 36.48 37.01 37.55 38.08 38.61 39.15 39.68 32.63 33.14 33.65 34.16 34.67 35.18 35.69 36.20 36.72 37.23 30.37 30.86 31.35 31.84 32.33 32.82 33.31 33.80 34 28 34 77 26.12 28.59 29.06 29.52 29.99 30.45 30.92 31.39 31.65 32.32 25.75 26.18 26.61 27.05 27.48 27.91 28.34 28.77 29.20 29.64 TOP 1 2 3 33 33 34 34 4 APPENDIX B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued HESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 f-ROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 50 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES Pot-E-con. CIASS CIRC. INCHES 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 45.17 45.15 46.33 46.91 47.49 48.07 48.65 49.23 49.81 50.39 42.69 43.25 43.81 44.36 44.92 45.48 46.03 46.59 47.15 47.70 40.22 40.75 41 .28 41.62 42.35 42.89 43.42 43.95 44.49 45.02 37.74 38.25 38.76 39.27 39.78 40.30 40.81 41 .32 41 .83 42.34 35.26 35.75 36.24 36.73 37.22 37.70 38.19 36.68 39.17 39.66 32.78 33.25 33.72 34.18 34.65 35.11 35.58 36.05 36.51 36.98 30.07 30.50 30.93 31 .36 31 .80 32.23 32.66 33.09 33.52 33.95 31 32 33 34 35 36 31 38 39 40 50.97 51.55 52.12 52.70 53.28 53.86 54.44 55.02 55.60 56.18 48.26 48.82 49.37 49.93 50.49 51.05 51 .60 52.16 52.72 53.27 45.56 46.09 46.62 47.16 47.69 48.23 48.76 49.30 49.83 50.36 42.85 43.36 43.87 44.39 44.90 45.41 45.92 46.43 46.94 47.45 40.15 40.64 41.12 41 .61 42.10 42.59 43.08 43.57 44.06 44.55 37.44 37.91 38.37 36’. 84 39.31 39.77 40.24 40.70 41.17 41 .64 34.39 34.82 35.25 35.68 36.11 36.55 36.98 37.41 37.84 38.27 41 42 56.76 57.34 42.10 42.57 38.70 39.14 51.92 58.50 59.08 59.66 60.24 60.82 61 .40 61 .98 47.97 48.48 0 INCHES)------48.99 45.50 50.01 50.52 51.03 51.55 52.06 52.57 45.03 45.52 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 53.83 54.39 ---GROUND 54.94 55.50 56.06 56.61 57.17 57.13 58.28 58.84 46.01 46.50 46.99 47.48 47.97 48.45 48.94 49.43 43.03 43.50 43.97 44.43 44.90 45.36 45.83 46.30 39.57 40.00 40.43 40.86 41.30 41.73 42.16 42.59 IHESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES TOP 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33 33 34 34 35 35 36 37 37 38 38 00 57 14 71 29 86 43 00 57 14 71 50.90 51.43 LINE (7 51.97 52.50 53.03 53.57 54.10 54.64 55.17 55.70 FEET CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 31 .oo 31.54 32.08 32.62 33.16 33.70 34.24 34.79 35.33 35.87 36.41 29.00 29.52 30.04 30.56 31 .08 31 .60 32.12 32.64 33.16 33.68 34.20 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 27.00 27.50 28.00 28.50 29.00 29.50 30.00 30.50 31 .oo 31.50 32.00 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 25 25 25 26 26 27 27 28 26 29 29 00 48 96 44 92 40 88 36 84 32 80 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 23.00 23.45 23.90 24.35 24.80 25.24 25.69 26.14 26.59 27.04 27.49 4 55 FOOT POLE 3 CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 21 .oo 21.43 21.86 22.29 22.71 23.14 23.57 24.00 24.43 24.86 25.29 390 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. i NCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES I CLASS 2 CIRC. 1 NCHES 55 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES POLE-Con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES 11 12 13 14 15 I6 17 18 19 20 39.29 39.86 40.43 41 .oo 41.57 42.14 42.71 43.29 43.86 44.43 36.95 37.49 38.03 38.57 39.11 39.65 40.19 40.73 41.28 41 .82 34.72 35.24 35.77 36.29 36.81 37.33 37.85 38.37 38.89 39.41 32.50 33.00 33.50 34.00 34.50 35.00 35.50 36.00 36.50 37.00 30.28 30.76 31 .23 31.71 32.19 32.67 33.15 33.63 34.1 I 34.59 27.94 28.39 28.84 29.29 29.73 30.18 30.63 31 .oa 31.53 31.98 25.71 26.14 26.57 27.00 27.43 27.86 28.29 28.71 29.14 29.57 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 45.00 45.57 46.14 46.71 47.29 47.86 48.43 49.00 49.57 50.14 42.36 42.90 43.44 43.98 44.52 45.06 45.60 46.14 46.68 47.22 39.93 40.45 40.97 41.49 42.01 42.53 43.05 43.57 44.09 44.61 37.50 38.00 38.50 39.00 39.50 40.00 40.50 41 .oo 41.50 42.00 35.07 35.55 36.03 36.51 36.99 37.47 37.95 38.43 38.91 39.39 32.43 32.88 33.33 33.78 34.22 34.67 35.12 35.57 36.02 36.47 30.00 30.43 30.86 31.29 31.71 32.14 32.57 33.00 33.43 33.86 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 50.71 51.29 51 .86 52.43 53.00 53.57 54.14 54.71 55.29 55.86 47.77 48.31 48.85 49.39 49.93 50.47 51 .Ol 51.55 52.09 52.63 45.13 45.65 46.17 46.69 47.21 47.73 48.26 48.78 49.30 49.82 42.50 43.00 43.50 44.00 44.50 45.00 45.50 46.00 46.50 47.00 39.07 40.35 40.83 41.31 41.79 42.27 42.74 43.22 43.70 44.18 36.92 37.37 37.82 38.27 38.71 39.16 39.61 40.06 40.51 40.96 34.29 34.71 35.14 35.57 36.00 36.43 36.86 37.29 37.71 38.14 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 --- 56.43 57.00 57.57 58.14 58.71 59.29 59.86 ----- 44.66 45.14 45.62 46.10 46.58 47.06 47.54 41.41 41 .86 42.31 42.76 43.20 43.65 44.10 ----- 38.57 39.00 39.43 39.86 40.29 40.71 41.14 48 49 50 60.43 61 .OO 61 .57 47.50 48.00 48.50 49.00 49.50 50.00 50.50 6 INCHES)------51 .oo 51.50 52.00 48.02 48.50 48.98 44.55 45.00 45.45 41.57 42.00 42.43 51 52 53 54 55 62.14 62.71 63.29 63.86 64.43 52.50 53.00 53.50 54.00 54.50 49.46 49.94 50.42 50.90 51.38 45.90 46.35 46.80 47.24 47.69 42.86 43.29 43.71 44.14 44.57 53.17 53.71 54.26 54.80 55.34 55.88 56.42 ---GROUND 56.96 57.50 58.04 58.58 59.12 59.66 60.20 60.74 50.34 50.86 51.38 51.90 52.42 52.94 53.46 LINE (7 53.98 54.50 55.02 55.54 56.06 56.58 57.10 57.62 FEET, Lt APPENDIX 391 6 Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES FOOT POLE CLASS Lt CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.56 34.11 34.67 35.22 35.76 36.33 36.89 37.44 38.00 38.56 31 .oo 31.53 32.06 32.58 33.11 33.64 34.17 34.69 35.22 35.75 36.28 29.00 29.51 30.02 30.53 31.04 31.55 32.06 32.56 33.07 33.58 34.09 27.00 27.49 27.98 28.47 28.96 29.45 29.94 30.44 30.93 31 .42 31.91 25.00 25.47 25.94 26.42 26.89 27.36 27.83 28.31 28.78 29.25 29.72 23.00 23.44 23.87 24.31 24.74 25.18 25.61 26.05 26.48 26.92 27.35 21 .oo 21.42 21 .83 22.25 22.67 23.08 23.50 23.92 24.33 24.75 25.17 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 39.11 39.67 40.22 40.78 41.33 41 .89 42.44 43.00 43.56 44.11 36.81 37.33 37.86 38.39 38.92 39.44 39.97 40.50 41.03 41 .56 34.60 35.11 35.62 36.13 36.64 37.15 37.66 38.17 38.68 39.19 32.40 32.89 33.38 33.87 34.36 34.85 35.34 35.63 36.32 36.81 30.19 30.67 31.14 31 .61 32.08 32.56 33.03 33.50 33.97 34.44 27.79 28.22 28.66 29.09 29.53 29.96 30.40 30.83 31 .27 31.70 25.56 26.00 26.42 26.83 27.25 27.67 28.08 28.50 28.92 29.33 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 44.67 45.22 45.78 46.33 46.89 47.44 48.00 48.56 49.11 49.67 42.08 42.61 43.14 43.67 44.19 44.72 45.25 45.78 46.31 46.83 39.69 40.20 40.71 41.22 41.73 42.24 42.75 43.26 43.77 44.28 37.31 37.80 38.29 30.78 39.27 39.76 40.25 40.74 41 .23 41 .72 34.92 35.39 35.86 36.33 36.81 37.28 37.75 38.22 38.69 39.17 32.14 32.57 33.01 33.44 33.08 34.31 34.75 35.19 35.62 36.06 29.75 30.17 30.58 31 .oo 31.42 31 .83 32.25 32.67 33.08 33.50 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 50.22 50.78 51.33 51 .89 52.44 53.00 53.56 54. I1 54.61 55.22 47.36 47.89 48.42 48.94 49.47 50.00 50.53 51 .06 51 .58 52.1 I 44.79 45.30 45.81 46.31 46.82 47.33 47.84 48.35 48.86 49.37 42.21 42.70 43.19 43.69 44.18 44.67 45.16 45.65 46.14 46.63 39.64 40.11 40.58 41 .06 41.53 42.00 42.47 42.94 43.92 43.89 36.49 36.93 37.36 37.80 38.23 38.67 39.10 39.54 39.97 40.41 33.92 34.33 34.75 35.17 35.58 36.00 36.42 36.83 37.25 37.67 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 55.18 56.33 56.89 57.44 58.00 58.56 59.11 59.67 60.22 60.78 52.64 53.17 53.69 54.22 54.75 55.28 55.81 56.33 56.86 57.39 49.88 50.39 50.90 51.41 51.92 52.43 52.94 53.44 53.95 54.46 47.12 47.61 48.10 48.59 49.08 49.57 50.06 50.56 51.05 51.54 44.36 44.83 45.31 45.78 46.25 46.72 47.19 47.67 48.14 48.61 40.84 41 .28 41.71 42.15 42.58 43.02 43.45 43.89 44.32 44.76 38.08 38.50 38.92 39.33 39.75 40.17 40.58 41 .oo 41 .42 41 .83 TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 60 3 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 51 61.33 -----------------------GROUND 57.92 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 58.44 58.97 59.50 60.03 60.56 61 .08 61 .61 62.14 62.67 61 .89 62.44 63.00 63.56 64.1 I 64.67 65.22 65.78 66.33 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES TOP CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 60 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. 1 NCHES 52.03 49.08 0 INCHES)------- 45.19 55.48 55.99 56.50 57.01 57.52 58.03 58.54 59.05 59.56 52.52 53.01 53.50 53.99 54.48 54.97 55.46 55.95 56.44 45.63 46.06 46.50 46.94 47.37 47.81 48.24 48.68 49.11 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES LINE 54.97 CLASS CIRC. INCHES (8 FEET, 49.56 50.03 50.50 50.97 51.44 51 .92 52.39 52.86 53.33 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES POLE-Con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES -------- 4 42.25 42.67 43.08 43.50 43.92 44.33 44.75 45.17 45.58 46.00 65 3 FOOT POLE CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33.00 33.54 34.08 34.63 35.17 35.71 36.25 36.80 37.34 37.88 38.42 31 .oo 31 .52 32.03 32.55 33.07 33.58 34.10 34.62 35.14 35.65 36.17 29.00 29.50 30.00 30.50 31 .oo 31.50 32.00 32.50 33.00 33.50 34.00 27.00 27.47 27.95 28.42 28.90 29.37 29.85 30.32 30.80 31 .27 31.75 25.00 25.45 25.90 26.35 26.80 27.25 27.69 28.14 28.59 29.04 29.49 23.00 23.42 23.85 24.27 24.69 25.12 25.54 25.97 26.39 26.81 27.24 21 .oo 21.41 21 .81 22.22 22.63 23.03 23.44 23.85 24.25 24.66 25.07 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 38.97 39.51 40.05 40.59 41.14 41.68 42.22 42.76 43.31 43.85 36.69 37.20 37.72 38.24 38.75 39.27 39.79 40.31 40.82 41.34 34.50 35.00 35.50 36.00 36.50 37.00 37.50 38.00 38.50 39.00 32.22 32.69 33.17 33.64 34.12 34.59 35.07 35.54 36.02 36.49 29.94 30.39 30.84 31 .29 31.74 32.19 32.64 33.08 33.53 33.98 27.66 28.08 28.51 28.93 29.36 29.78 30.20 30.63 31.05 31.47 25.47 25.88 26.29 26.69 27.10 27.51 27.92 28.32 28.73 29.14 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 44.39 44.93 45.47 46.02 46.56 47.10 47.64 48.19 48.73 49.27 41.86 42.37 42.89 43.41 43.92 44.44 44.96 45.47 45.99 46.51 39.50 40.00 40.50 41 .oo 41.50 42.00 42.50 43.00 43.50 44.00 36.97 37.44 37.92 38.39 38.86 39.34 39.81 40.29 40.76 41 .24 34.43 34.88 35.33 35.78 36.23 36.68 37.13 37.58 38.03 38.47 31.90 32.32 32.75 33.17 33.59 34.02 34.44 34.86 35.29 35.71 29.54 29.95 30.36 30.76 31.17 31 .58 31 .98 32.39 32.80 33.20 APPENDIX 393 B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. 1 NCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. 1 NCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 65 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES POLE--Con. CLASS CIRC. INCHES 31 32 33 34 35 36 3-I 38 39 40 49.81 50.36 50.90 51.44 51.98 52.53 53.07 53.61 54.15 54.69 47.03 47.54 48.06 48.58 49.09 49.61 50.13 50.64 51.16 51 .68 44.50 45.00 45.50 46.00 46.50 47.00 47.50 48.00 48.50 49.00 41.71 42.19 42.66 43.14 43.61 44.08 44.56 45.03 45.51 45.98 38.92 39.37 39.82 40.27 40.72 41.17 41 .62 42.07 42.52 42.97 36. 14 36.56 36.98 37.41 37.83 38.25 38.68 39.10 39.53 39.95 33.61 34.02 34.42 34.83 35.24 35.64 36.05 36.46 36.86 37.27 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 4a 49 50 55.24 55.78 56.32 56.06 57.41 57.95 58.49 59.03 59.58 60.12 52.19 52.71 53.23 53.75 54.26 54.78 55.30 55.81 56.33 56.85 49.50 50.00 50.50 51 .oo 51.50 52.00 52.50 53.00 53.50 54.00 46.46 46.93 47.41 47.88 48.36 48.83 49.31 49.78 50.25 50.73 43.42 43.86 44.31 44.76 45.21 45.66 46.11 46.56 47.01 47.46 40.37 40.80 41.22 41 .64 42.07 42.49 42.92 43.34 43.76 44.19 37.68 30.08 38.49 38.90 39.31 39.71 40.12 40.53 40.93 41.34 51 52 53 54 55 56 60.66 61 .20 61 .75 62.29 62.03 63.37 ------ 47.91 48.36 48.81 49.25 49.70 50.15 44.61 45.03 45.46 45.88 46.31 46.73 ----- 41.75 42.15 42.56 42.97 43.37 43.78 57 58 59 60 63.92 64.46 65.00 65.54 51.20 51.68 52.15 52.63 53.10 53.58 6 INCHES)------54.05 54.53 55.00 55.47 50.60 51.05 51.50 51.95 47.15 47.58 48.00 48.42 44.19 44.59 45.00 45.41 61 62 63 64 65 66.08 66.63 67.17 67.71 68.25 55.95 56.42 56.90 57.37 57.85 52.40 52.85 53.30 53.75 54.19 48.85 49.27 49.69 50.12 50.54 45.81 46.22 46.63 47.03 47.44 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. INCHES FEET TOP 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33.00 33.53 34.06 34.59 35.13 35.66 36.19 36.72 37.25 37.70 38.31 57.36 57.88 58.40 58.92 59.43 59.95 ---GROUND 60.47 60.98 61 .50 62.02 62.53 63.05 63.57 64.08 64.60 54.50 55.00 55.50 56.00 56.50 57.00 LINE (a 57.50 58.00 58.50 59.00 FEE1 59.50 60.00 60.50 61 .OO 61 .50 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 31 .oo 31.51 32.02 32.52 33.03 33.54 34.05 34.55 35.06 35.57 36.08 29.00 29.48 29.97 30.45 30.94 31 .42 31.91 32.39 32.88 33.36 33.84 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 27 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 31 00 46 92 38 a4 30 77 23 69 15 61 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 25.00 25.44 25.88 26.31 26.75 27.19 27.63 28.06 28.50 28.94 29.38 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 23 23 23 24 24 25 25 25 26 26 27 70 3 00 41 a3 24 66 07 48 90 31 73 14 4 FOOT POLE CLASS 4 CIRC. INCHES 21 .oo 21.39 21.78 22.17 22.56 22.95 23.34 23.73 24.13 24.52 24.91 394 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES 70 18 19 20 38.84 39.38 39.91 40.44 40.97 41.50 42.03 42.56 43.09 43.63 36.59 37.09 37.60 38.11 38.62 39.13 39.63 40.14 40.65 41.16 34.33 34.81 35.30 35.78 36.27 36.75 37.23 37.72 38.20 38.69 32.07 32.53 32.99 33.45 33.91 34.38 34.84 35.30 35.76 36.22 29.81 30.25 30.69 31.13 31 .56 32.00 32.44 32.88 33.31 33.75 27.55 27.97 28.38 28.80 29.21 29.63 30.04 30.45 30.87 31 .28 25.30 25.69 26.08 26.47 26.86 27.25 27.64 28.03 28.42 28.81 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 44.16 44.69 45.22 45.75 46.28 46.81 47.34 47.88 48.41 48.94 41.66 42.17 42.68 43.19 43.70 44.20 44.71 45.22 45.73 46.23 39.17 39.66 40.14 40.63 42.08 42.56 43.05 43.53 36.68 37.14 37.60 38.06 38.52 38.98 39.45 39.91 40.37 40.83 34.19 34.63 35.06 35.50 35.94 36.38 36.81 37.25 37.69 38.13 31.70 32.11 32.52 32: 94 33.35 33.77 34.18 34.59 35.01 35.42 29.20 29.59 29.98 30.38 30.77 31.16 31.55 31.94 32.33 32.72 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 49.47 50.00 50.53 51 .06 51.59 52.13 52.66 53.19 53.72 54.25 46.74 47.25 47.76 48.27 48.77 49.28 49.79 50.30 50.80 51.31 44.02 44.50 44.98 45.47 45.95 46.44 46.92 47.41 47.89 48.38 41.29 41.75 42.21 42.67 43.13 43.59 44.05 44.52 44.98 45.44 38.56 39.00 39.44 39.88 40.31 40.75 41.19 41 .63 42.06 42.50 35.84 36.25 36.66 37.08 37.49 37.91 38.32 38.73 39.15 39.56 33.11 33.50 33.89 34.28 34.67 35.06 35.45 35.84 36.23 36.63 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 54.78 55.31 55.84 56.38 56.91 57.44 57.97 58.50 59.03 59.56 51 .82 52.33 52.84 53.34 53.85 54.36 54.87 55.38 55.88 56.39 48.86 49.34 49.83 50.31 50.80 51 .28 51.77 52.25 52.73 53.22 45.90 46.36 46.82 47.28 47.74 48.20 48.66 49.13 49.59 50.05 42.94 43.38 43.81 44.25 44.69 45.13 45.56 46.00 46.44 46.88 39.98 40.39 40.80 41.22 41 .63 42.05 42.46 42.88 43.29 43.70 37.02 37.41 37.80 38.19 38.58 38.97 39.36 39.75 40.14 40.53 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 60.09 60.63 61.16 61 .69 62.22 62.75 63.28 63.81 64.34 64.88 56.90 57.41 57.91 56.42 58.93 59.44 59.95 60.45 60.96 61.47 53.70 54.19 54.67 55.16 55.64 56.13 56.61 57.09 57.58 58.06 50.51 50.97 51.43 51.89 52.35 52.81 53.27 53.73 54.20 54.66 47.31 47.75 48. 19 48.63 49.06 49.50 49.94 50.38 50.81 51 .25 44.12 44.53 44.95 45.36 45.77 46.19 46.60 47.02 47.43 47.84 40.92 41.31 41.70 42.09 42.48 42.88 43.27 43.66 44.05 44.44 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 41.11 41.59 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 3 POLE-con. CLASS H-l ClRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES FOOT CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 4 APPENDIX 395 I3 Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES 70 CLASS H-2 CIRC. -----------------------GROUND 51 65.41 62 65.94 63 66.41 64 67.00 65 67.53 66 68.06 67 68.59 68 69.13 69 69.66 70 70.19 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES LINE (9 CLASS ClRC. INCHES FEET, 58.55 59.03 59.52 60.00 60.48 60.97 61 .45 61 .9’t 62.42 62.91 61 .98 62.48 62.99 63.50 64.01 64.52 65.02 65.53 66.04 66.55 0 1 INCHES) 55.12 55.58 56.04 56.50 56.96 57.42 57.88 58.34 58.80 59.27 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES POLE--con. 3 CLASS CIRC. INCHES --------- 1 48.26 48.67 49.09 49.50 49.91 50.33 50.74 51.16 51.57 51.98 CLASS CIRC. 2 44.83 45.22 45.61 46.00 46.39 46.78 47.17 47.56 47.95 48.34 75 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES INCHES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33.00 33.51 34.03 34.54 35.06 35.57 36.09 36.60 37.12 37.63 38.14 31 .oo 31.49 31.99 32.48 32.97 33.46 33.96 34.45 34.94 35.43 35.93 29.00 29.47 29.94 30.41 30.88 31 .36 31 .83 32.30 32.77 33.24 33.71 27.00 27.45 27.90 28.35 28.80 29.25 29.70 30.14 30.59 31.04 31.49 25.00 25.43 25.86 26.28 26.71 27.14 27.57 27.99 28.42 28.85 29.28 23.00 23.41 23.81 24.22 24.62 25.03 25.43 25.84 26.25 26.65 27.06 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 38.66 39.17 39.69 40.20 40.72 41.23 41.75 42.26 42.78 43.29 36.42 36.91 37.41 37.90 38.39 38.88 39.38 39.87 40.36 40.86 34.18 34.65 35.12 35.59 36.07 36.54 37.01 37.48 37.95 38.42 31.94 32.39 32.84 33.29 33.74 34.19 34.64 35.09 35.54 35.99 29.70 30.13 30.56 30.99 31.41 31 .84 32.27 32.70 33.12 33.55 27.46 27.87 28.28 28.68 29.09 29.49 29.90 30.30 30.71 31.12 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 43.80 44.32 44.83 45.35 45.86 46.38 46.89 47.41 47.92 48.43 41.35 41 .84 42.33 42.83 43.32 43.81 44.30 44.80 45.29 45.78 38.89 39.36 39.83 40.30 40.78 41 .25 41 .72 42.19 42.66 43.13 36.43 36.88 37.33 37.78 38.23 38.68 39.13 39.58 40.03 40.48 33.98 34.41 34.83 35.26 35.69 36.12 36.54 36.97 37.40 37.83 31 .52 31.93 32.33 32.74 33.14 33.55 33.96 34.36 34.77 35.17 TOP ‘-t .----- 51.69 52.13 52.56 53.00 53.44 53.88 54.31 54.75 55.19 55.63 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES FOOT CLASS CIRC. INCHES POLE TRANSMISSION 396 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l ClRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS ClRC. INCHES 75 2 FOOT POLE-con. CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 48.95 49.46 49.98 50.49 51.01 51.52 52.04 52.55 53.07 53.50 46 46 47 47 48 48 49 49 50 50 28 77 26 75 25 74 23 72 22 71 43.60 44.07 44.54 45.01 45.49 45.96 46.43 46.90 47.37 47.84 40.93 41.38 41.83 42.28 42.72 43.17 43.62 44.07 44.52 44.97 38.25 30.60 39.11 39.54 39.96 40.39 40.82 41.25 41.67 42.10 35.50 35.99 36.39 36.80 37.20 37.61 38.01 38.42 38.83 39.23 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 54.09 54.61 55.12 55.64 56.15 56.67 57.18 57.70 58.21 50.72 51 51 52 52 53 53 54 54 55 55 20 70 19 68 17 67 16 65 14 64 48.31 48.78 49.25 49.72 50.20 50.67 51.14 51.61 52.08 52.55 45.42 45.87 46.32 46.77 47.22 47.67 48.12 48.57 49.01 49.46 42.53 42.96 43.38 43.81 44.24 44.67 45.09 45.52 45.95 46.38 39.64 40.04 40.45 40.86 41.26 41.67 42.07 42.48 42.88 43.29 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 59.24 59.75 60.27 60.78 61.30 61.81 62.33 62.84 63.36 63.87 56 56 57 57 58 58 59 59 60 60 13 62 12 61 10 59 09 58 07 57 53.02 53.49 53.96 54.43 54.91 55.38 55.85 56.32 56.79 57.26 49.91 50.36 50.81 51.26 51.71 52.16 52.61 53.06 53.51 53.96 46.80 47.23 47.66 48.09 48.51 48.94 49.37 49.80 50.22 50.65 43.70 44.10 44.51 44.91 45.32 45.72 46.13 46.54 46.94 47.35 61 62 63 64 65 --- 64.38 64.90 65.41 65.93 66.44 _------__- 51.08 51.51 51.93 52.36 52.79 47.75 48.16 48.57 48.97 49.38 66 67 68 69 70 66.96 67.47 67.99 68.50 69.01 56.65 57.10 57.55 58.00 58.45 53.22 53.64 54.07 54.50 54.93 49.78 50.19 50.59 51.00 51.41 71 72 73 74 75 69.53 70.04 70.56 71.07 71.59 58.90 59.35 59.80 60.25 60.70 55.36 55.78 56.21 56.64 57.07 51.81 52.22 52.62 53.03 53.43 ____ 61 06 61 55 62 04 62 54 63 03 GROUND LINE 63.52 64.01 64.51 65.00 65.49 65.99 66.48 66.97 67.46 67.96 ( 57.73 58.20 58.67 59.14 59.62 9 FEET, 60.09 60.56 61.03 61.50 61.97 62.44 62.91 63.38 63.06 64.33 6 54.41 54.86 55.30 55.75 56.20 *NCHES)---------. APPENDIX B 397 Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES TOP I 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. 1 CLASS CIRC. 2 80 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES 25.00 25.42 25.84 26.26 26.68 27.09 27.51 27.93 28.35 28.77 29.19 23.00 23.39 23.78 24.18 24.57 24.96 25.35 25.74 26.14 26.53 26.92 33.00 33.51 34.01 34.52 35.03 35.53 36.04 36.55 37.05 37.56 38.07 31 .oo 31.49 31.97 32.46 32.95 33.43 33.92 34.41 34.89 35.38 35.86 29.00 29.46 29.92 30.38 30.84 31.30 31 .76 32.22 32.68 33.14 33.59 27.00 27.44 27.88 20.32 28.76 29.20 29.64 30.07 30.51 30.95 31.39 38.57 39.08 39.59 40.09 40.60 34.05 34.51 34.97 35.43 35.89 36.35 36.81 37.27 37.73 38.19 31 .83 32.27 32.71 33.15 33.59 34.03 34.47 34.91 35.34 35.78 29.61 30.03 30.45 30.86 31.28 31.70 32.12 32.54 32.96 33.38 27.31 27.70 28.09 28.49 28.88 29.27 29.66 30.05 30.45 30.84 15 16 17 41.11 41 .61 18 19 20 42.12 42.63 43.14 36.35 36.84 37.32 37.81 38.30 38.78 39.27 39.76 40.24 40.73 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 43.64 44.15 44.66 45.16 45.67 46.18 46.68 47.19 47.70 48.20 41.22 41.70 42.19 42.68 43.16 43.65 44.14 44.62 45.11 45.59 38.65 39.11 39.57 40.03 40.49 40.95 41.41 41.86 42.32 42.78 36.22 36.66 37.10 37.54 37.98 38.42 38.86 39.30 39.74 40.18 33.80 34.22 34.64 35.05 35.47 35.89 36.31 36.73 37.15 37.57 31 .23 31 .62 32.01 32.41 32.80 33.19 33.58 33.97 34.36 34.76 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 48.71 49.22 49.72 50.23 50.74 51 .24 51.75 52.26 52.76 53.27 46.08 46.57 47.05 47.54 48.03 48.51 49.00 49.49 49.97 50.46 43.24 43.70 44.16 44.62 45.08 45.54 46.00 46.46 46.92 47.38 40.61 41.05 41.49 41.93 42.37 42.81 43.25 43.69 44.13 44.57 37.99 38.41 38.82 39.24 39.66 40.08 40.50 40.92 41.34 41 .76 35.15 35.54 35.93 36.32 36.72 37.11 37.50 37.89 38.28 38.68 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 53.78 54.28 54.79 55.30 55.80 56.31 56.02 57.32 57.83 58.34 50.95 51.43 51.92 52.41 52.89 53.38 53.86 54.35 54.84 55.32 47.84 48.30 48.76 49.22 49.68 50.14 50.59 51.05 51.51 51.97 45.01 45.45 45.89 46.32 46.76 47.20 47.64 48.08 48.52 48.96 42.18 42.59 43.01 43.43 43.85 44.27 44.69 45.11 45.53 45.95 39.07 39.46 39.85 40.24 40.64 41.03 41 .42 41 .81 42.20 42.59 11 12 13 14 POLE 398 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 58.84 59.35 59.86 60.36 60.87 61.38 61 .89 62.39 62.90 63.41 61 :: 64 65 66 67 68 69 __------ 63.91 64.42 64.93 65.43 65.94 66.45 66.95 67.46 67.97 ----------- 70 68.47 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 68.98 69.49 69.99 70.50 71 .Ol 71.51 72.02 72.53 73.03 73.54 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. INCHES FEET TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33.00 33.49 33.99 34.46 34.97 35.47 35.96 36.46 36.95 37.44 37.94 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. 52.43 52.89 53.35 53.81 54.27 54.73 55.19 55.65 56.11 56.57 49.40 49.84 50.28 50.72 51.16 51.59 52.03 52.47 1 INCHES 80 2 CLASS CIRC. INCHES FOOT POLE-Con. CLASS 3 CIRC. 1NCHES 53.35 46.36 46.78 47.20 47.62 48.04 48.46 48.86 49.30 49.72 50.14 53.79 54.23 54.67 55.11 55.55 55.99 56.43 56.86 57.30 50.55 50.97 51 .39 51.81 52.23 52.65 53.07 53.49 53.91 57.74 54.32 50.43 61 .62 62.08 62.54 63.00 63.46 63.92 64.38 64.84 65.30 65.76 58.18 58.62 59.06 59.50 59.94 60.38 60.82 61 .26 61 .70 62.14 54.74 55.16 55.58 56.00 56.42 56.84 57.26 57.68 58.09 58.51 50.82 51.22 51 .61 52.00 52.39 52.78 53.18 53.57 53.96 54.35 CLASS CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. 1 NCHES 31 .oo 31.47 31.95 32.42 32.90 33.37 33.85 34.32 34.80 35.27 35.75 29.00 29.45 29.90 30.35 30.80 31 .25 31.70 32.15 32.59 33.04 33.49 27.00 27.43 27.86 28.29 28.72 29.15 29.58 30.01 30.44 30.87 31.30 55.81 56.30 56.78 57.27 57.76 58.24 58.73 59.22 59.70 60.19 60.68 61.16 61.65 62.14 62.62 63.11 63.59 64.08 64.57 -GROUND 65.05 L INE 65.54 66.03 66.51 67.00 67.49 67.97 68.46 68.95 69.43 69.92 CLASS H-2 CIRC. 57.03 57.49 57.95 58.41 58.86 59.32 59.78 60.24 60.70 ( 10 FEET 61.16 52.91 0 INCHES )------------ INCHES 1 42.99 43.38 43.77 44.16 44.55 44.95 45.34 45.73 46.12 46.51 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 25 25 25 26 26 27 27 27 28 28 29 00 41 81 22 62 03 43 84 24 65 05 46.91 47.30 47.69 48.08 48.47 48.86 49.26 49.65 50.04 ----_-- 2 85 FOOT POLE CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES 23.00 23.39 23.77 24.16 24.54 24.93 25.32 25.70 26.09 26.47 26.86 APPENDIX 399 B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 85 2 FOOT POLE-Con. CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES 11 12 13 I4 15 16 17 18 19 20 38.43 30.92 39.42 39.91 40.41 40.90 41.39 41.69 42.36 42.87 36.22 36.70 37.17 37.65 39.12 38.59 39.07 39.54 40.02 40.49 33.94 34.39 34.84 35.29 35.74 36.19 36.64 37.09 37.54 37.99 31.73 32.16 32.59 33.03 33.46 33.89 34.32 34.75 35.18 35.61 29.46 29.86 30.27 30.67 31.08 31.48 31.89 32.29 32.70 33.10 27.25 27.63 28.02 28.41 28.79 29.18 29.56 29.95 30.34 30.72 21 22 23 24 25 26 :i 29 30 43.37 43.06 44.35 44.85 45.34 45.84 46.33 46.82 47.32 47.81 40.97 41.44 41.92 42.39 42.87 43.34 43.82 44.29 44.77 45.24 38.44 38.89 39.34 39.78 40.23 40.68 41.13 41.58 42.03 42.48 36.04 36.47 36.90 37.33 37.76 38.19 38.62 39.05 39.48 39.91 33.51 33.91 34.32 34.72 35.13 35.53 35.94 36.34 36.75 37.15 31.11 31.49 31.88 32.27 32.65 33.04 33.42 33.81 34.20 34.58 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 48.30 48.80 49.29 49.78 50.28 50.77 51.27 51.76 52.25 52.75 45.72 46.19 46.66 47.14 47.61 48.09 48.56 49.04 49.51 49.99 42.93 43.38 43.83 44.28 44.73 45.18 45.63 46.08 46.53 46.97 40.34 40.77 41.20 41.63 42.06 42.49 42.92 43.35 43.78 44.22 37.56 37.96 38.37 38.77 39.18 39.58 39.99 40.39 40.80 41.20 34.97 35.35 35.74 36.13 36.51 36.90 37.28 37.67 38.06 38.44 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 40 49 50 53.24 53.73 54.23 54.72 55.22 55.71 56.20 56.70 57.19 51.68 50.46 50.94 51.41 51.89 52.36 52.84 53.31 53.78 54.26 54.73 47.42 47.87 48.32 48.77 49.22 49.67 50.12 50.57 51.02 51.37 44.65 45.08 45.51 45.94 46.37 46.80 47.23 47.66 48.09 48.52 41.61 42.01 42.42 42.82 43.23 43.63 44.04 44.44 44.85 45.25 38.83 39.22 39.60 39.99 40.37 40.76 41.15 41.53 41.92 42.30 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 58.18 58.61 59.16 59.66 60.15 60.65 61.14 61.63 62.13 62.62 55.21 55.68 56.16 56.63 51.11 51.58 58.06 58.53 59.01 59.48 51.92 52.37 52.82 53.27 53.72 54.16 54.61 55.06 55.51 55.96 48.95 49.38 49.81 50.24 50.67 51.10 51.53 51.96 52.39 52.82 45.66 46.06 46.47 46.87 47.28 47.68 48.09 48.49 48.90 49.30 42.69 43.08 43.46 43.85 't4.23 44.62 45.01 45.39 45.78 46.16 TRANSMISSION 400 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES 61 62 63 64 65 66 61 68 69 70 71 72 13 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 63.11 63.61 64. IO 64.59 65.09 65.58 66.08 66.51 67.06 67.56 68.05 68.54 69.04 69.53 ----------_ 70.03 70.52 71 .Ol 71.51 72.00 72.49 72.99 73.48 73.97 74.47 74.96 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES TOP 1 2 33.00 33.48 33.96 34.45 34.93 35.41 35.89 36.37 36.86 37.34 37.82 11 38.30 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 38.79 20 39.27 39.75 40.23 40.71 41.20 41.68 42.16 42.64 CLASS H-2 CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES 59.96 60.43 60.91 61 .38 61 .a5 62.33 56.41 56.86 57.31 63.28 63.75 64.23 57.76 58.21 58.66 59.11 59.56 60.01 60.46 64.70 65.18 65.65 66.13 60.91 61 .35 61 .80 62.25 62.80 -GROUND L INE 66.60 67.08 61.55 68.03 68.50 68.97 69.45 69.92 70.40 ( 10 FEET 62.70 63.15 63.60 64.05 64.50 64.95 CLASS CIRC. 1 INCHES 53.25 53.68 54.11 54.54 54.97 55.41 85 CLASS 2 CIRC. 1 NCHES FOOT POLE-Con. CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES 49.71 50.11 50.52 50.92 51.33 51.73 52.14 52.54 52.95 53.35 46.55 46.94 47.32 47.71 53.76 54.16 54.57 58.85 54.97 6 INCHES I---------59.28 55.38 55.78 59.71 56.19 60.14 56.59 60.57 57.00 61 .OO 61 .43 57.41 50.41 50.80 51.18 51.51 ----51.96 52.34 52.73 53.11 53.50 55.84 56.27 56.70 57.13 48.09 48.48 48.87 49.25 49.64 50.03 57.56 57.99 58.42 61 .86 62.29 62.72 63.15 63.58 53.89 57.81 58.22 54.27 54.66 55.04 55.43 70.87 71.35 65.40 65.85 66.30 66.75 67.20 CLASS H-2 CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES INCHES 31 .oo 31 .46 31.93 29.00 29.44 29.88 30.32 30.76 31.20 31 .64 27.00 21.42 25.00 25.40 23.00 27.85 28.27 28.69 29.11 25.80 23.75 24.13 24.50 24.88 25.25 25.63 26.00 32.39 32.86 33.32 33.79 34.25 34.71 35.18 35.64 36.11 36.57 37.04 37.50 37.96 38.43 38.89 39.36 39.82 40.29 CLASS CIRC. 58.62 59.03 59.43 1 CLASS CIRC. 32.08 29.54 29.96 26.20 26.60 26.99 21.39 27.79 32.52 32.96 33.40 30.38 30.80 31 .23 28.19 28.59 28.99 31 .65 29.39 29.79 30.18 33.85 34.29 34.73 35.17 35.61 36.05 36.49 36.93 37.31 37.81 32.07 32.49 32.92 33.34 33.76 34.18 34.61 35.03 35.45 30.58 30.98 31.38 31.78 32. la 32.58 32.98 55.82 2 90 FOOT CLASS 3 CIRC. 1 NCHES 23.38 26.38 26.75 27.13 27.50 27.88 28.25 28.63 29.00 29.38 29.75 30.13 30.50 POLE APPENDIX 401 B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. 1NCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 SO FOOT POLE-Con. 2 CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES INCHES CLASS CIRC. 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 43.12 43.61 44.09 44.57 45.05 45.54 46.02 46.50 46.98 47.46 40.75 41.21 41 .68 42.14 42.61 43.07 43.54 44.00 44.46 44.93 38.25 30.69 39.13 39.57 40.01 40.45 40.89 41.33 41.77 42.21 35.88 36.30 36.72 37.14 37.57 37.99 38.41 38.83 39.26 39.68 33.38 33.77 34.17 34.57 34.97 35.37 35.77 36.17 36.57 36.96 30.88 31.25 31 .63 32.00 32.38 32.75 33.13 33.50 33.88 34.25 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41.95 48.43 48.91 49.39 49.87 50.36 50.84 51 .32 51 .80 52.29 45.39 45.86 46.32 46.79 47.25 47.71 48.18 48.64 49.11 49.57 42.65 43.10 43.54 43.98 44.42 44.86 45.30 45.74 46.18 46.62 40.10 40.52 40.95 41.37 41 .I9 42.21 42.64 43.06 43.48 43.90 31.36 37.76 38.16 38.56 38.96 39.36 39.76 40.15 40.55 40.95 34.63 35.00 35.38 35.75 36.13 36.50 36.88 37.25 37.63 38.00 41 52.77 53.25 53.73 54.21 54.70 55.18 55.66 56.14 56.62 57.11 50.04 50.50 50.96 51.43 51 .89 52.36 52.82 53.29 53.75 54.21 47.06 47.50 47.94 48.38 48.82 49.26 49.70 50.14 50.58 51.02 44.33 44.75 45.17 45.60 46.02 46.44 46.86 47.29 47.71 48.13 41.35 41.75 42.15 42.55 42.95 43.35 43.74 44.14 44.54 44.94 38.38 38.75 39.13 39.50 39.88 40.25 40.63 41 .oo 41 .38 41.75 57 58 59 60 57.59 58.07 50.55 59.04 59.52 60.00 60.48 60.96 61 .45 61 .93 54.68 55.14 55.61 56.07 56.54 57.00 57.46 57.93 58.39 58.06 51 .46 51.90 52.35 52.79 53.23 53.67 54.11 54.55 54.99 55.43 48.55 48.98 49.40 49.82 50.24 50.67 51.09 51.51 51.93 52.36 45.34 45.74 46.14 46.54 46.93 47.33 47.73 48.13 48.53 40.93 42.13 42.50 42.88 43.25 43.63 44.00 44.38 44.75 45.13 45.50 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 62.41 62.89 63.37 63.66 64.34 64.82 65.30 65.79 66.27 66.75 59.32 59.79 60.25 60.71 61.18 61 .64 62.11 62.57 63.04 63.50 55.87 56.31 56.75 57.19 57.63 58.07 58.51 58.95 59.39 59.83 52.78 53.20 53.62 54.05 54.47 54.89 55.32 55.74 56.16 56.58 49.33 49.73 50.12 50.52 50.92 51 .32 51 .72 52.12 52.52 52.92 45.88 46.25 46.63 47.00 47.38 47.75 48.13 48.50 48.88 49.25 21 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 TRANSMISSION 402 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE CLASS H-3 FROM TOP CIRC. FEET INCHES WESTERN CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. 63.96 64.43 64.89 65.36 65.82 66.29 66.75 67.21 INCHES 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 ----79 80 67.23 67.71 68.20 68.68 69.16 69.64 70.12 70.61 71.09 71.57 67.68 68.14 60.27 60.71 61.15 61 .60 62.04 62.48 62.92 63.36 ( 1 1 FEET 63.80 64.24 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 so 72.05 72.54 73.02 73.50 73.98 74.46 74.95 75.43 75.91 76.39 68.61 69.07 69.54 70.00 70.46 70.93 71.39 71.86 72.32 72.79 64.68 65.12 65.56 66.00 66.44 66.88 67.32 67.76 68.20 68.64 .-GROUND RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET L INE CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 TOP CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 57.01 57.43 57.85 58.27 58.70 59.12 59.54 59.96 0 SO FOOT POLE -Con. 2 CLASS 3 CIRC. INCHES I TiCHiS CLASS CIRC. 53.32 53.71 54.11 54.51 54.91 55.31 55.71 56.11 49.63 50.00 50.38 50.75 51.13 51.50 51.88 60.39 60.81 56.51 56.90 52.25 -----52.63 53.00 61 .23 61 .65 62.08 62.50 62.92 63.35 63.77 64.19 64.61 65.04 57.30 57.70 58.10 58.50 58.90 59.30 59.70 60.10 60.49 60.89 53.38 53.75 54.13 54.50 54.88 55.25 55.63 56.00 56.38 56.75 INCHESl--- INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. 1 NCHES 33.00 33.47 33.94 34.42 34.89 35.36 35.83 36.30 36.78 37.25 37.72 31 .oo 31 .46 31.91 32.37 32.82 33.28 33.73 34.19 34.64 35.10 35.55 29.00 29.43 29.87 30.30 30.73 31.16 31 .60 32.03 32.46 32.89 33.33 27.00 27.41 27.82 28.23 28.64 29.05 29.46 29.87 30.28 30.69 31.10 25.00 25.39 25.78 26.16 26.55 26.94 27.33 27.71 28.10 28.49 28.88 38.19 38.66 39.13 39.61 40.08 40.55 41.02 41.49 41.97 42.44 36 36 36 37 37 38 38 39 39 40 33.76 34.19 34.62 35.06 35.49 35.92 36.35 36.79 37.22 37.65 31.51 31 .92 32.33 32.74 33.15 33.56 33.97 34.38 34.79 35.20 29.26 29.65 30.04 30.43 30.81 31.20 31.59 31 .98 32.37 32.75 01 46 92 37 83 28 74 19 65 10 I CLASS CIRC. 95 2 INCHES FOOT POLE APPENDIX 403 B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS H-3 CIRC. CLASS H-2 CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. 1 NCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES 21 42.91 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 43.38 43.85 44.33 44.80 45.27 45.74 46.21 46.69 47.16 40.56 41 .Ol 41.47 41.92 42.38 42.83 43.29 43.74 44.20 44.65 38.08 38.52 38.95 39.38 39.81 40.25 40.68 35.61 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 47.63 48.10 48.57 49.04 49.52 49.99 50.46 50.93 51.40 51.88 45.11 45.56 46.02 46.47 46.93 47.38 47.84 48.29 48.75 49.20 42.41 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 52.35 52.82 53.29 53.76 54.24 54.71 55.18 55.65 56.12 56.60 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 1 95 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 36.02 36.43 36.84 37.25 37.66 38.07 38.48 38.89 39.30 33.14 33.53 33.92 34.30 34.69 35.08 35.47 35.85 36.24 36.63 42.84 43.28 43.71 44.14 44.57 45.01 45.44 45.87 46.30 39.71 40.12 40.53 40.94 41.35 41 .76 42.17 42.58 42.99 43.40 37.02 37.40 37.79 38.18 38.57 38.96 39.34 39.73 40.12 40.51 49.66 50.11 50.57 51.02 51.48 51.93 52.39 52.84 53.30 53.75 46.74 47.17 47.60 48.03 48.47 48.90 49.33 49.76 50.20 50.63 43.81 44.22 44.63 45.04 45.46 45.87 46.28 46.69 47.10 47.51 40.89 41 .28 41 .67 42.06 42.44 42.83 43.22 43.61 43.99 44.38 57.07 57.54 58.01 58.48 58.96 59.43 59.90 60.37 60.84 61 .31 54.21 54.66 55.12 55.57 56.03 56.48 56.94 57.39 57.85 58.30 51 .06 51.49 51.93 52.36 52.79 53.22 53.66 54.09 54.52 54.96 47.92 48.33 48.74 49.15 49.56 49.97 50.38 50.79 51.20 51.61 44.77 45.16 45.54 45.93 46.32 46.71 47.10 47.48 47.87 48.26 61 .79 62.26 62.73 63.20 63.67 64.15 64.62 65.09 65.56 66.03 58.76 59.21 59.67 60.12 60.58 61.03 61 .49 61.94 62.40 62.65 55.39 55.82 56.25 56.69 57.12 57.55 57.98 58.42 58.85 59.28 52.02 52.43 52.84 53.25 53.66 54.07 54.48 54.89 55.30 55.71 48.65 49.03 49.42 49.81 50.20 50.58 50.97 51 .36 51.75 5‘2.13 41.11 41.54 41.98 POLE-Cot-I. TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 95 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. 66.51 63.31 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 66.98 67.45 67.92 68.39 68.87 69.34 69.81 70.28 70.75 63.76 64.22 64.67 65.13 65.50 66.04 66.49 66.95 67.40 59 71 60 15 60 58 61 01 61 44 61 98 62 31 62.74 63.17 63.61 56 12 56 53 56 94 57 35 57 76 59 17 58 58 58 99 59 40 59 81 52.52 52.91 53.30 53.69 54.07 54.46 54.85 55.24 55.62 56.01 81 82 83 71.22 71.70 72.17 67.86 68.31 68.77 64.04 64.47 64.90 60 60 61 22 63 04 56.40 56.79 57.17 LINE (11 FEET. 0 INCHES)-- 84 85 06 87 08 89 90 72.64 73.11 73.58 74.06 74.53 75.00 75.47 69.22 69.60 70.13 70.59 71.04 71.50 71 .96 65.34 65.77 66 20 66 63 67 07 67.50 67.93 61 61 62 62 63 63 63 45 86 27 68 09 50 91 57.56 57.95 58.34 58.72 59.11 59.50 59.89 91 92 93 94 95 75.94 76.42 76.89 77.36 77.83 72.41 72.87 73.32 73.78 74.23 68 68 69 69 70 37 80 23 66 10 64 64 65 65 65 32 73 14 55 96 60.28 60.66 61 .05 61 .44 61 .83 RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP 2 3 4 5 6 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 ia 19 20 100 CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.46 33.93 34.39 34.85 35.31 35.78 36.24 36.70 37.16 37.63 38.09 38.55 39.02 39.48 39.94 40.40 40.87 41.33 41.79 42.26 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 31 .oo POLE-Con. INCHES 71 -------------GROUND WESTERN CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 29 00 29 43 29.85 31.44 31.88 32.32 32.77 33.21 33.65 34.09 34.53 34.97 35.41 30.28 30 70 31 13 31 55 31.98 32.40 32.83 33.26 35.96 36.30 36.74 37.18 37.62 38.06 38.51 38.95 39.39 39.83 33 34 34 34 35 35 36 36 37 37 68 11 53 96 38 81 23 66 09 51 CLASS CIRC. 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES INCHES 27.00 27.40 27.81 29.21 28.62 29.02 29.43 30.23 30.64 31.04 25.00 25.39 25.77 26.15 26.53 26.91 27.30 27.68 28.06 20.45 28.83 31.45 31 .85 32.26 32.66 33.06 33.47 33.97 34.28 34.68 35.09 29.21 29.60 29.98 30.36 30.74 31.13 31.51 31 .89 32.28 32.66 29.83 2 FOOT POLE APPENDIX 405 B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 100 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 42.72 43.18 43.64 44.11 44.57 45.03 45.49 45.96 46.42 46.88 40.27 40.71 41.15 41 .60 42.04 42.48 42.92 43.36 43.80 44.24 37.94 38.36 38.79 39.21 39.64 40.06 40.49 40.91 41.34 41.77 35.49 35.89 36.30 36.70 37.11 37.51 37.91 38.32 38.72 39.13 33.04 33.43 33.81 34.19 34.57 34.96 35.34 35.72 36.11 36.49 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 47.35 47.81 48.27 48.73 49.20 49.66 50.12 50.59 51.05 51.51 44.69 45.13 45.57 46.01 46.45 46.89 47.34 47.78 48.22 48.66 42.19 42.62 43.04 43.47 43.89 44.32 44.74 45.17 45.60 46.02 39.53 39.94 40.34 40.74 41.15 41.55 41 .96 42.36 42.77 43.17 36.87 37.26 37.64 38.02 38.40 38.79 39.17 39.55 39.94 40.32 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51.97 52.44 52.90 53.36 53.82 54.29 54.75 55.21 55.68 56. 14 49.10 49.54 43.57 43.98 44.38 44.79 45.19 45.60 46.00 46.40 46.81 47.21 40.70 41.09 50.43 50.87 51.31 51.75 52.19 52.63 53.07 46.45 46.87 47.30 47.72 48.15 48.57 49.00 49.43 49.85 50.28 42.23 42.62 43.00 43.38 43.77 44.15 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 56.60 57.06 57.53 57.99 58.45 58.91 59.38 59.84 60.30 60.77 53.52 53.96 54.40 54.84 55.28 55.72 56.16 56.61 57.05 57.49 50.70 51.13 51.55 51 .98 52.40 52.83 53.26 53.68 54.11 54.53 47.62 48.02 48.43 48.83 49.23 49.64 50.04 50.45 50.85 51 .26 44.53 44.91 45.30 45.68 46.06 46.45 46.83 47.21 47.60 47.98 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 61 .23 61 .69 62.15 62.62 63.08 63.54 64.01 64.47 64.93 65.39 57.93 58.37 58.81 59.26 59.70 60.14 60.58 61 .02 61 .46 61.90 54.96 55.38 55.81 56.23 56.66 57.09 57.51 57.94 58.36 58.79 51.66 52.06 52.47 52.87 53.28 53.68 54.09 54.49 54.89 55.30 48.36 48.74 49.13 49.51 21 49.98 1 INCHES 41.47 41.85 49.89 50.28 50.66 51.04 5 l_. 43 51 .a1 POLE-Con. 406 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 04 05 86 87 88 ------89 so 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 100 CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 65.06 66.32 66.78 67.24 67.71 68.17 68.63 69.10 69.56 70.02 62.35 62.79 63.23 63.67 64.11 64.55 64.99 65.44 65.88 66.32 59 21 59 64 60 06 60 49 60 91 61 34 61 77 62 19 62 62 63 04 55.70 56.11 56.51 56.91 57.32 57.72 58.13 58.53 58.94 59.34 70.48 70.95 71.41 71.87 72.34 72.80 73.26 73.72 66.76 67.20 67.64 68.09 68.53 60.97 69.41 69.85 63 63 64 64 65 65 66 66 59.74 60.15 60.55 60.96 61 .36 61 .77 62.17 62.57 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 1 INCHES FOOT CLASS CIRC. INCHES 74.19 74.65 70.29 70.73 66.87 67.30 62.98 63.38 75.11 75.57 76.04 76.50 76.96 77.43 77.89 78.35 78.81 79.28 71.18 71 .62 72.06 72.50 72.94 73.38 73.82 74.27 74.71 75.15 67.72 68.15 68.51 69.00 69.43 69.85 70.28 70.70 71.13 71.55 63.79 64.19 64.60 65.00 65.40 65.81 66.21 66.62 67.02 67.43 59.85 60.23 60.62 61 .OO 61 .38 61 .77 62.15 62.53 62.91 63.30 CLASS H-3 CIRC. CLASS H-2 CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES CIRC. INCHES CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.45 33.91 34.36 34.82 35.27 35.73 36.18 36.64 37.09 37.55 31 .oo 31.43 31 .87 32.30 32.74 33.17 33.61 34.04 34.47 34.91 35.34 29.00 29.41 29.83 30.24 30.66 31.07 31.48 31.90 32.31 32.73 33.14 27.00 27.39 27.79 28.18 28.58 28.97 29.36 29.76 30.15 30.55 30.94 25.00 25.37 25.75 26.12 26.49 26.87 27.24 27.62 27.99 20.36 28.74 LINE (11 FEET, 0 INCHES) ------ CLASS POLE-Con. 2 52.19 52.57 52.96 53.34 53.72 54.11 54.49 54.87 55.26 55.64 56.02 56.40 56.79 5-l. 17 57.55 57.94 58.32 58.70 -----59.09 59.47 -----GROUND 47 89 32 74 17 60 02 45 CLASS CIRC. 1 CLASS 105 2 FOOT POLE APPENDIX 407 B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 35.78 36.21 36.65 37.08 37.52 37.95 38.38 38.82 39.25 39.69 33.56 33.97 34.38 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 38.00 38.45 38.91 39.36 39.82 40.27 40.73 41.18 41 .64 42.09 31.33 31.73 32.12 32.52 32.91 33.30 33.70 34.09 34.48 34.88 29.11 29.48 29.86 30.23 30.61 30.98 31.35 31.73 32.10 32.47 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 42.55 43.00 43.45 43.91 44.36 44.82 45.27 45.73 46.18 46.64 40.12 40.56 40.99 41 .42 41.86 42.29 42.73 43.16 43.60 44.03 37.70 38.11 40. la 40.60 41 .Ol 41 .42 35.27 35.67 36.06 36.45 36.85 37.24 37.64 38.03 38.42 38.82 32.85 33.22 33.60 33.97 34.34 34.72 35.09 35.46 35.84 36.21 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 47.09 47.55 48.00 48.45 48.91 49.36 49.82 50.27 50.73 51.18 44.46 44.90 45.33 45.77 46.20 46.64 47.07 47.51 47.94 48.37 41 .84 42.25 42.67 43.08 43.49. 43.91 44.32 44.74 45.15 45.57 39.21 39.61 40.00 40.39 40.79 41.18 41.58 41.97 42.36 42.76 36.59 36.96 37.33 37.71 38.08 38.45 38.83 39.20 39.58 39.95 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 .64 52.09 52.55 53.00 53.45 53.91 54.36 54.82 55.27 55.73 48.81 49.24 49.68 50.11 50.55 50.98 51.41 51 .a5 52.28 52.72 45.98 46.39 46.81 47.22 47.64 48.05 48.46 48.88 49.29 49.71 43.15 43.55 43.94 44.33 44.73 45.12 45.52 45.91 46.30 46.70 40.32 40.70 41.07 41.44 41 .82 42.19 42.57 42.94 43.31 43.69 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 56.18 56.64 57.09 57.55 58.00 58.45 58.91 59.36 59.82 60.27 53.15 53.59 54.02 54.45 54.89 55.32 55.76 56.19 56.63 57.06 50.12 50.54 50.95 51 .36 51 .78 52.19 52.61 53.02 53.43 53.85 47.09 47.48 47.88 48.27 48.67 49.06 49.45 49.85 50.24 50.64 44.06 44.43 44.81 45. la 45.56 45.93 46.30 46.68 47.05 47.42 34.80 35.21 35.63 36.04 36.45 36.87 37.28 38.53 38.94 39.35 39.77 1 105 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES I I 12 13 CLASS H-3 CIRC. POLE-Con. 408 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES I 105 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 60.73 61.18 61 .64 62.09 62.55 63.00 63.45 63.91 64.36 64.82 57 57 58 58 59 59 60 60 60 61 49 93 36 80 23 67 10 54 97 40 54.26 54.68 55.09 55.51 55.92 56.33 56.75 57.16 57.58 57.99 51.03 51.42 51 .82 52.21 52.61 53.00 53.39 53.79 54.18 54.58 47.80 48.17 48.55 48.92 49.29 49.67 50.04 50.41 50.79 51.16 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 65.27 65.73 66.18 66.64 67.09 67.55 68.00 68.45 68.91 69.36 61 62 62 63 63 64 64 64 65 65 84 27 71 14 58 01 44 88 31 75 58.40 58.82 59.23 59.65 60.06 60.47 60.89 61 .30 61 .72 62.13 54.97 55.36 55.76 56.15 56.55 56.94 57.33 57.73 58.12 58.52 51.54 51.91 52.28 52.66 53.03 53.40 53.78 54.15 54.53 54.90 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 69.82 70.27 70.73 71.18 71 .64 72.09 72.55 73.00 73.45 73.91 66 66 67 67 67 68 68 69 69 70 18 62 05 48 92 35 79 22 66 09 62.55 62.96 63.37 63.79 64.20 64.62 65.03 65.44 65.86 66.27 58.91 59.30 59.70 60.09 60.48 60.88 61 .27 61 .67 62.06 62.45 55.27 55.65 56.02 56.39 56.77 57.14 57.52 57.89 58.26 58.64 91 92 -------93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 74.36 74.82 -----GROUND 75.27 75.73 76.18 76.64 77.09 77.55 78.00 78.45 78.91 79.36 79.82 80.27 80.73 70 53 70.96 LINE (12 71.39 71 .83 72.26 72.70 73.13 73.57 74.00 74.43 74 75 75 76 76 87 30 74 17 61 66.69 62.85 67. IO 63.24 FEET, 0 INCHES)----67.52 63.64 67.93 64.03 68.34 64.42 68.76 64.82 69.17 65.21 69.59 65.61 70.00 66.00 70.41 66.39 70.83 71 .24 71.66 72.07 72.48 66.79 67.18 67.58 67.97 68.36 59.01 59.38 59.76 60.13 60.51 60.88 61 .25 61 .63 62.00 62.37 62.75 63.12 63.49 63.87 64.24 POLE-Con. APPENDIX 409 B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.45 33.09 34.34 34.79 35.24 35.68 36.13 36.58 37.02 31.47 31 .oo 31.43 31 .86 29.00 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 CLASS CIRC. 110 2 INCHES 32.28 32.71 33.14 33.57 34.00 34.42 34.65 35.20 29.41 29.82 30.23 30.63 31.04 31.45 31.86 32.27 32.68 33.09 27.00 27.39 27.70 26.17 28.56 28.95 29.34 29.73 30.12 30.50 30.89 25.00 25.37 25.73 26.10 26.46 26.93 27.19 27.56 27.92 28.29 28.65 16 19 20 37.92 38.37 38.81 39.26 39.71 40.15 40.60 41.05 41.50 41.94 35.71 36.13 36.56 36.99 37.42 37.95 36.27 38.70 39.13 39.56 33.50 33.90 34.31 34.72 35.13 35.54 35.95 36.36 36.76 37.17 31 .28 31 .67 32.06 32.45 32.04 33.23 33.62 34.01 34.40 34.79 29.02 29.38 29.75 30.12 30.48 30.65 31.21 31.58 31.94 32.31 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 29 29 30 42.39 42.04 43.26 43.73 44.18 44.62 45.07 45.52 45.97 46.41 39.99 40.41 40.94 41 .27 41.70 42.12 42.55 42.98 43.41 43.84 37.58 37.99 38.40 38.81 39.22 39.63 40.03 40.44 40.85 41 .26 35.18 35.57 35.96 36.35 36.74 37.12 37.51 37.90 38.29 38.66 32.67 33.04 33.40 33.77 34.13 34.50 34.87 35.23 35.60 35.96 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 46.06 47.31 47.75 48.20 40.65 49.10 49.54 49.99 50.44 50.88 44.26 44.69 45.12 45.55 45.98 46.40 46.83 47.26 47.69 48.12 41.67 42.08 42.49 42.09 43.30 43.71 44.12 44.53 44.94 45.35 39.07 39.46 39.85 40.24 40.63 41.02 41.41 41.80 42.19 42.58 36.33 36.69 37.06 37.42 37.79 36.15 39.52 38.88 39.25 39.62 91 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51.33 51.78 52.23 52.67 53.12 53.57 54.01 54.46 54.91 55.36 49.54 48.97 49.40 49.83 50.25 50.68 45.75 46.16 46.57 46.98 47.39 47.80 48.21 46.62 49.02 49.43 42.97 43.36 43.75 44.13 44.52 44.91 45.30 45.69 46.08 46.47 39.98 40.35 40.71 41.08 41.44 41 .81 42.17 42.54 42.90 43.27 TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 51.11 51.54 51.97 52.39 FOOT POLE 410 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 110 FOOT CLASS H-3 CIRC. 1 NCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 55.80 56.25 56.70 57.14 57.59 58.04 58.49 58.93 59.38 59.83 52.82 53.25 53.68 54.11 54.53 54.96 55.39 55.82 56.25 56.67 49.84 50.25 50.66 51.07 51.48 51.88 52.29 52.70 53.1 I 53.52 46.86 47.25 47.64 48.03 48.42 48.81 49.20 49.59 49.98 50.37 43.63 44.00 44.37 44.73 45.10 45.46 45.83 46.19 46.56 46.92 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 60.27 60.72 61.17 61 .62 62.06 62.51 62.96 63.40 63.85 64.30 57.10 57.53 57.96 58.38 58.81 59.24 59.67 60.10 60.52 60.95 53.93 54.34 54.75 55.15 55.56 55.97 56.38 56.79 57.20 57.61 50.75 51.14 51.53 51.92 52.31 52.70 53.09 53.48 53.87 54.26 47.29 47.65 48.02 48.38 48.75 49.12 49.48 49.85 50.21 50.58 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 64.75 65.19 65.64 66.09 66.53 66.98 67.43 67.87 68.32 68.77 61.38 61.81 62.24 62.66 63.09 63.52 63.95 64.37 64.80 65.23 58.01 58.42 58.83 59.24 59.65 60.06 60.47 60.87 61 .28 61 .69 54.65 55.04 55.43 55.82 56.21 56.60 56.99 57.37 57.76 58.15 50.94 51.31 51 .67 52.04 52.40 52.77 53.13 53.50 53.87 54.23 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 69.22 69.66 70.11 70.56 71 .oo 71.45 71.90 72.35 72.79 73.24 65.66 66.09 66.51 66.94 67.37 67.80 68.23 68.65 69.08 69.51 62.10 62.51 62.92 63.33 63.74 64.14 64.55 64.96 65.37 65.78 58.54 58.93 59.32 59.71 60.10 60.49 60.88 61 .27 61 .66 62.05 54.60 54.96 55.33 55.69 56.06 56.42 56.79 57.15 57.52 57.88 73.69 74.13 74.58 75.03 75.48 75.92 76.37 69.94 70.37 70.79 71.22 71 .65 72.08 72.50 66.19 66.60 67.00 67.41 67.82 68.23 68.64 62.44 62.83 63.22 63.61 64.00 64.38 64.77 58.25 58.62 58.98 59.35 59.71 60.08 60.44 ----60.81 61.17 61 .54 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 --98 99 100 ----GROUND 76.82 77.26 77.71 LINE 72.93 73.36 73.79 (12 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES FEET, 0 69.05 69.46 69.87 CLASS CIRC. INCHES INCHES)------ 65.16 65.55 65.94 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 2 POLE-Con. APPENDIX 411 6 Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 110 CLASS H-3 CIRC. CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 78.16 78.61 79.05 79.50 79.95 80.39 80.84 81.29 81.74 82.18 74.22 74.64 75.07 75.50 75.93 76.36 76.78 77.21 77.64 78.07 70.27 70.68 71.09 71.50 71.91 72.32 72.73 73.13 73.54 73.95 CLASS H-3 CIRC. CLASS H-2 CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 33.00 33.44 33.87 34.31 34.74 35.18 35.61 36.05 36.49 36.92 37.36 31 .oo 31.42 31.83 32.25 32.67 33.09 33.50 33.92 34.34 34.76 35.17 29.00 29.40 29.80 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37.79 38.23 38.67 39.10 39.54 39.97 40.41 40.84 41.28 41.72 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 42.15 42.59 43.02 43.46 43.89 44.33 44.77 45.20 45.64 46.07 TOP CLASS 1 CIRC. INCHES POLE-Con. INCHES 66.33 66.72 67.11 67.50 67.09 68.28 68.67 69.06 69.45 69.84 CLASS CIRC. FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. 61.90 62.27 62.63 63.00 63.37 63.73 64.10 64.46 64.83 65.19 1 CLASS CIRC. 115 2 INCHES INCHES 30.20 30.60 31 .oo 31.39 31.79 32.19 32.59 32.99 27.00 27.38 27.76 28.14 28.52 28.90 29.28 29.67 30.05 30.43 30.81 25.00 25.36 25.72 26.07 26.43 26.79 27.15 27.50 27.86 28.22 28.58 35.59 36.01 36.43 36.84 37.26 37.68 38.10 38.51 38.93 39.35 33.39 33.79 34.19 34.59 34.99 35.39 35.76 36.18 36.58 36.98 31.19 31.57 31.95 32.33 32.71 33.09 33.47 33.85 34.23 34.61 28.94 29.29 29.65 30.01 30.37 30.72 31.08 31.44 31.80 32.16 39.77 40.18 40.60 41.02 41.44 41.85 42.27 42.69 43.1 I 43.52 37.38 37.78 38.18 38.58 38.98 39.38 39.78 40.17 40.57 40.97 35.00 35.38 35.76 36.14 36.52 36.90 37.28 37.66 38.04 38.42 32.51 32.87 33.23 33.59 33.94 34 * 30 34.66 35.02 35.38 35.73 FOOT POLE TRANSMISSION 412 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 115 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 46.51 46.94 47.38 47.82 48.25 48.69 49.12 49.56 50.00 50.43 43.94 44.36 44.78 45.19 45.61 46.03 46.44 46.86 47.28 47.70 41.37 41.77 42.17 42.57 42.97 43.37 43.77 44.17 44.56 44.96 38.80 39.18 39.56 39.94 40.33 40.71 41.09 41.47 41 .85 42.23 36.09 36.45 36.81 37.17 37.52 37.88 38.24 38.60 38.95 39.31 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 50.87 51.30 51.74 52.17 52.61 53.05 53.48 53.92 54.35 54.79 48.11 48.53 48.95 49.37 49.78 50.20 50.62 51.04 51.45 51 .81 45.36 45.16 46.16 46.56 46.96 47.36 47.76 48.16 48.56 48.95 42.61 42.99 43.37 43.75 44.13 44.51 44.89 45.28 45.66 46.04 39.67 40.03 40.39 40.74 41.10 41 .46 41 .82 42.17 42.53 42.89 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 55.22 55.66 56.10 56.53 56.97 57.40 57.84 58.28 58.71 59.15 52.29 52.71 53.12 53.54 53.96 54.38 54.79 55.21 55.63 56.05 49.35 49.75 50.15 50.55 50.95 51.35 51.75 52.15 52.55 52.94 46.42 46.80 47.18 47.56 47.94 48.32 48.70 49.08 49.46 49.84 43.25 43.61 43.96 44.32 44.68 45.04 45.39 45.75 46.11 46.47 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 59.58 60.02 60.45 60.89 61 .33 61 .76 62.20 62.63 63.07 63.50 56.46 56.88 57.30 57.72 58.13 58.55 58.97 59.39 59.80 60.22 53.34 53.74 54.14 54.54 54.94 55.34 55.74 56.14 56.54 56.94 50.22 50.61 50.99 51.37 51.75 52.13 52.51 52.89 53.27 53.65 46.83 47.18 47.54 47.90 48.26 48.61 48.97 49.33 49.69 50.05 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 63.94 64.38 64.81 65.25 65.68 66.12 66.56 66.99 67.43 67.86 60.64 61 .06 61 .47 61 .89 62.31 62.72 63.14 63.56 63.98 64.39 57.33 57.73 58.13 58.53 58.93 59.33 59.73 60.13 60.53 60.93 54.03 54.41 54.79 55.17 55.56 55.94 56.32 56.70 57.08 57.46 50.40 50.76 51.12 51 .48 51 .83 52.19 52.55 52.91 53.27 53.62 POLE-Con. APPENDIX 6 413 Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cechr-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 1 115 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 81 62 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 68.30 68.73 69.17 69.61 70.04 70.48 70.91 71.35 71.78 72.22 64 81 65 23 65 65 66.06 66.48 66 90 67 32 67 73 15 68 68 57 61 33 61 72 12 62 62.52 62.92 63 32 63 72 64 12 64 52 64 92 57 84 58 22 58 60 58.98 59.36 59 74 60 12 60 50 60 89 61 27 53.98 54.34 54.70 55.06 55.41 55.77 56.13 56.49 56.84 57.20 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 72.66 73.09 73.53 73.96 74.40 74.83 75.27 75.71 76.14 76.58 68 99 69 40 69 82 70.24 70.66 71 07 71 49 71 91 72 33 72 74 65 32 65 72 66 11 66.51 66.91 67.31 67.71 68.11 68.51 68.91 61 65 62 03 62 41 62.79 63.17 63 55 63 93 64 31 64 69 65 07 57.56 57.92 58.28 58.63 58.99 59.35 59.71 60.06 60.42 60.78 65.45 65.83 61.14 61.50 66 22 66 60 66 98 67 36 67 74 68.12 68.50 68 88 61.85 62.21 62.57 62.93 63.28 63.64 64.00 64.36 26 64 02 40 78 64.72 65.07 65.43 65.19 66.15 101 102 -103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 WESTERN CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET TOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 77.01 77.45 -----GROUND 77.89 78.32 78.76 79.19 79.63 80.06 80.50 80.94 81.37 81.81 82.24 82.68 83.11 CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.43 33.86 34.29 34.72 35.15 35.58 36.01 36.44 36.81 37.30 73.16 73.58 LINE (12 74.00 74.41 74.83 75.25 75.67 76.08 76.50 76 92 77 77 78 78 79 33 75 17 59 00 69.31 69.71 FEET, 0 INCHES)-70.11 70.50 70.90 71.30 71.70 72.10 72.50 72 90 73 73 74 74 74 30 70 10 50 89 .-- 69 69 70 70 70 CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 31 00 31 41 31 82 32 24 32 65 33.06 33.47 33 89 34 30 34 71 35 12 29.00 29.39 29.79 30.18 30.58 30.97 31.37 31.76 32.16 32.55 32.95 27.00 27.37 27.75 28.12 28.49 28.86 29.24 29.61 29.98 30.36 30.73 1 120 CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 25.00 25.35 25.70 26.05 26.40 26.75 27.11 27.46 27.81 28.16 28.51 POLE-con. FOOT POLE 414 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 18 19 20 37.73 38.16 38.59 39.02 39.45 39.88 40.31 40.74 41.17 41.60 35.54 35.95 36.36 36.77 37.18 37.60 38.01 38.42 38.83 39.25 33.34 33.74 34.13 34.53 34.92 35.32 35.71 36.1 I 36.50 36.89 31.47 31 .85 32.22 32.59 32.96 33.34 33.71 34.08 34.46 28.86 29.21 29.56 29.91 30.26 30.61 30.96 31.32 31.67 32.02 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 42.03 42.46 42.89 43.32 43.75 44.18 44.61 45.04 45.46 45.89 39.66 40.07 40.48 40.89 41.31 41 .72 42.13 42.54 42.96 43.37 37.29 37.68 38.08 38.47 38.87 39.26 39.66 40.05 40.45 40.84 34.83 35.20 35.57 35.95 36.32 36.69 37.07 37.44 37.81 38.18 32.37 32.72 33.07 33.. 42 33.77 34.12 34.47 34.82 35.18 35.53 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 46.32 46.75 47.18 47.61 48.04 48.47 48.90 49.33 49.76 50.19 43.78 44.19 44.61 45.02 45.43 45.84 46.25 46.67 47.08 47.49 41.24 41 .63 42.03 42.42 42.82 43.21 43.61 44.00 44.39 44.79 38.56 38.93 39.30 39.68 40.05 40.42 40.79 41.17 41.54 41.91 35.88 36.23 36.58 36.93 37.28 37.63 37.98 38.33 38.68 39.04 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 50.62 51.05 51.48 51.91 52.34 52.77 53.20 53.63 54.06 54.49 47.90 48.32 48.73 49.14 49.55 49.96 50.38 50.79 51.20 51.61 45.18 45.58 45.97 46.37 46.76 47.16 47.55 47.95 48.34 48.74 42.29 42.66 43.03 43.40 43.78 44.15 44.52 44.89 45.27 45.64 39.39 39.74 40.09 40.44 40.79 41.14 41.49 41 .84 42.19 42.54 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 54.92 55.35 55.78 56.21 56.64 57.07 57.50 57.93 58.36 58.79 52.03 52.44 52.85 53.26 53.68 54.09 54.50 54.91 55.32 55.74 49.13 49.53 49.92 50.32 50.71 46.01 46.39 46.76 47.13 47.50 47.88 48.25 48.62 49.00 49.37 42.89 43.25 43.60 43.95 44.30 44.65 45.00 45.35 45.70 46.05 11 12 13 I4 15 16 17 CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 51.11 51.50 51.89 52.29 52.68 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 31.10 1 120 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. CLASS H-3 CIRC. 1 NCHES INCHES POLE-Con. APPENDIX 415 B Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES 60.08 60.51 60.94 61.37 61.80 62.23 62.66 63.09 56.15 56.56 56.97 57.39 57.80 58.21 50.62 59.04 59.45 59.06 53.08 53.47 53.87 54.26 54.66 55.05 55.45 55.04 56.24 56.63 50.11 50.49 50.86 51 .23 51 .61 51.98 52.35 52.72 53.10 46.40 46.75 Lt7.11 47.46 47.81 48.16 48.51 48.06 49.21 49.56 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 63.52 63.95 64.30 64.81 65.24 65.67 66.10 66.53 66.96 67.39 60.27 60.68 61.10 61.51 61.92 62.33 62.75 63.16 63.57 63.90 57.03 57.42 57.02 58.21 58.61 59.00 59.39 59.79 60.18 60.50 53.47 53.04 54.21 54.59 54.96 55.33 55.71 56.08 56.45 56.02 49.91 50.26 50.61 50.96 51 .32 51 .67 52.02 52.37 52.72 53.07 81 02 83 84 85 86 87 80 89 90 67.02 60.25 60.60 69.11 69.54 69.96 70.39 70.82 71 .25 71.60 64.39 64.81 65.22 65.63 66.04 66.46 66.07 67.20 67.69 68.11 60.97 61 .37 61 .76 62.16 62.55 62.95 63.34 63.74 64.13 64.53 57.20 57.57 57.94 50.32 50.69 59.06 59.43 59.81 60.18 60.55 53.42 53.77 54.12 54.47 54.02 55.18 55.53 55.80 56.23 56.50 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 72.11 72.54 72.97 73.40 73.03 74.26 74.69 75.12 75.55 75.90 60.52 68.93 69.34 69.75 70.17 70.58 70.99 71.40 71.02 72.23 64.92 65.32 65.71 66.11 66.50 66.09 67.29 67.60 68.08 68.47 60.93 61.30 61 .67 62.04 62.42 62.79 63.16 63.54 63.91 64.28 56.93 57.20 57.63 57.90 50.33 50.60 59.04 59.39 59.74 60.09 76.41 76.04 77.27 77.70 70.13 70.56 70.99 72.64 73.05 73.46 73.80 74.29 74 .‘70 75.11 68.87 69.26 69.66 70.05 70.45 70.84 71 .24 64.65 65.03 65.40 65.77 66.14 66.52 60.44 60.79 61.14 61 .49 61 .84 62.19 62.54 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 59.22 59.65 -------------GROUND 108 109 110 79.42 79.85 80.28 LINE 75.53 75.94 76.35 (12 FEET, 0 71.63 72.03 72.42 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 49.74 66.09 INCHES)--------------- 67.26 67.64 68.01 1 120 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 61 CLASS H-3 CIRC. INCHES 62.89 63.25 63.60 POLE-con. 416 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red Cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS H-3 CIRC. 1 NCHES 80.71 81.14 81.57 82.00 82.43 82.86 83.29 83.72 84.15 84.58 CLASS H-2 CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES 76 77 77 78 78 78 79 79 80 80 72.82 73.21 73.61 74.00 74.39 74.79 75.18 75.58 75.97 76.37 1 12_p FOOT POLE CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES CLASS H-2 CIRC. INCHES 33.00 33.42 33.84 34.26 34.68 35.10 35.52 35.94 36.36 36.78 37.20 31 31 31 32 32 33 33 33 34 34 35 1I 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 37.62 38.04 38.46 38.88 39.30 39.72 40.14 40.56 40.98 41.40 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 41.82 42.24 42.66 43.08 43.50 43.92 44.34 44.76 45.18 45.61 00 40 81 21 61 02 42 82 23 63 03 CLASS H-l CIRC. 68 38 68 75 69 13 69 50 69 87 70 25 70 62 70 99 71 36 71 74 INCHES CLASS CIRC. INCHES 63.95 64.30 64.65 65.00 65.35 65.70 66.05 66.40 66.75 67.11 1 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 30.16 30.55 30.93 31 .32 31.71 32.09 32.48 32.87 27.00 27.37 27.73 28.10 28.46 28.83 29.19 29.56 29.92 30.29 30.66 25.00 25.34 25.69 26.03 26.38 26.72 27.07 27.41 27.76 28.10 28.45 35.44 35.84 36.24 36.65 37.05 37.45 37.86 38.26 38.66 39.07 33.25 33.64 34.03 34.41 34.80 35.18 35.57 35.96 36.34 36.73 31.02 31.39 31.75 32.12 32.48 32.85 33.21 33.58 33.95 34.31 28.79 29.13 29.48 29.82 30.17 30.51 30.86 31.20 31.55 31 .89 39.47 39.87 40.28 40.68 41 .08 41.49 41 .89 42.29 42.70 43.10 37.12 37.50 34.68 35.04 35.41 35.77 36.14 36.50 36.87 37.24 37.60 37.97 32.24 32.58 32.92 33.27 33.61 33.96 34.30 34.65 34.99 35.34 29.00 29.39 29.77 37.89 38.28 38.66 39.05 39.44 39.82 40.21 40.60 -Con. INCHES 125 CLASS H-3 CIRC. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 TOP 76 18 59 00 41 82 24 65 06 47 CLASS CIRC. 1 NCHES FOOT POLE APPENDIX B 417 Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET CLASS H-3 CIRC. CLASS H-2 CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 46.03 46.45 46.87 47.29 47.71 48.13 48.55 48.97 49.39 49.81 43.50 43.91 44.31 44.71 45.12 45.52 45.92 46.33 46.73 47.13 40.98 41.37 41 .I6 41 42 43 44 45 46 41 48 49 50 50.23 50.65 51.07 51.49 51.91 52.33 52.75 53.17 53.59 54.01 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 CLASS CIRC. INCHES I 125 FOOT CLASS 2 CIRC. INCHES 42.14 42.53 42.92 43.30 43.69 44.08 44.46 38.33 38.70 39.06 39.43 39.79 40.16 40.53 40.89 41 .26 41 .62 35.68 36.03 36.37 36.71 37.06 37.40 37.75 38.09 38.44 38.78 47.54 47.94 48.34 48.75 49.15 49.55 49.96 50.36 50.76 51.17 44.85 45.24 45.62 46.01 46.39 46.78 47.17 47.55 47.94 48.33 41.99 42.35 42.72 43.08 43.45 43.82 44.18 44.55 44.91 45.28 39.13 39.47 39.82 40.16 40.50 40.85 41.19 41.54 41.88 42.23 54.43 54.85 55.27 55.69 56.11 56.53 56.95 57.37 57.79 58.21 51.57 51.97 52.38 52.78 53.18 53.59 53.99 54.39 54.80 55.20 48.71 49.10 49.49 49.87 50.26 50.65 51.03 51 .42 51 .81 52.19 45.64 46.01 46.37 46.74 47.1 I 47.47 47.84 48.20 48.57 48.93 42.57 42.92 43.26 43.61 43.95 44.29 44.64 44.98 45.33 45.67 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 58.63 59.05 59.47 59.89 60.31 60.73 61.15 61 .57 61 .99 62.41 55.61 56.01 56.41 56.82 57.22 57.62 58.03 58.43 58.83 59.24 52.58 52.97 53.35 53.74 54.13 54.51 54.90 55.29 55.67 56.06 49.30 49.66 50.03 50.39 50.76 51.13 51.49 51.86 52.22 52.59 46.02 46.36 46.71 47.05 47.39 47.74 48.08 48.43 48.77 49.12 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 62.83 63.25 63.67 64.09 64.51 64.93 65.35 65.77 66.19 66.61 59.64 60.04 60.45 60.85 61 .25 61.66 62.06 62.46 62.87 63.27 56.45 56.83 57.22 57.61 57.99 58.38 58.76 59.15 59.>4 59.92 52.95 53.32 53.68 54.05 54.42 54.78 55.15 55.51 55.88 56.24 49.46 49.81 50.15 50.50 50.84 51.18 51.53 51 .87 52.22 52.56 POLE-con. 418 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-4.-Pole circumferences for western red Cedar-Continued WESTERN RED CEDAR DISTANCE FROM TOP FEET 125 CLASS H-2 CIRC. CLASS H-l CIRC. INCHES INCHES INCHES 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 67.03 67.45 67.87 68.29 68.71 69.13 69.55 69.97 70.39 70.82 63.67 64.08 64.48 64.88 65.29 65.69 66.09 66.50 66.90 67.30 60 60 61 61 61 62 62 63 63 63 31 70 08 47 86 24 63 02 40 79 56 56 57 57 58 58 58 59 59 59 61 97 34 71 07 44 80 17 53 90 52.91 53.25 53.60 53.94 54.29 54.63 54.97 55.32 55.66 56.01 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 71.24 71.66 72.08 72.50 72.92 73.34 73.76 74.18 74.60 75.02 67.71 68.11 68.51 68.92 69.32 69.72 70.13 70.53 70.93 71.34 64 64 64 65 65 66 66 66 67 67 18 56 95 34 72 11 50 88 27 66 60 60 61 61 61 62 62 62 63 63 26 63 00 36 73 09 46 82 19 55 56.35 56.70 57.04 5%. 39 57.73 58.08 58.42 58.76 59.11 59.45 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 75.44 75.86 76.28 76.70 77.12 77.54 77.96 78.38 78.80 79.22 71.74 72.14 72.55 72.95 73.35 73.76 74.16 74.56 74.97 75.37 68 68 68 69 69 69 70 70 71 71 04 43 82 20 59 97 36 75 13 52 63 64 64 65 65 65 66 66 66 67 92 29 65 02 38 75 11 48 84 21 59.80 60.14 60.49 60.83 61.18 61.52 61.87 62.21 62.55 62.90 111 112 -------113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 79.64 80.06 75.77 76.18 71.91 72.29 121 122 123 124 125 -----GROUND LINE I12 FEET, 0 CLASS CIRC. INCHES 67.58 67.94 INCHES)----- 80.48 80.90 81 .32 81.74 82.16 82.58 83.00 83.42 76.58 76.98 77.39 77.79 78.19 78.60 79.00 79.40 72.68 73.07 73.45 73.84 74.23 74.61 75.00 75.39 68.31 68.67 69.04 69.40 69.77 70.13 70.50 70.87 83.84 84.26 84.68 85.10 85.52 79.81 80.21 80.61 81.02 81 .42 75 77 76 16 76 55 76 93 77.32 71 23 71 60 71 96 72 33 72.69 1 FOOT CLASS H-3 CIRC. CLASS CIRC. INCHES 63.24 63.59 -. _------_63.93 64.28 64.62 64.97 65.31 65.66 66.00 66.34 66.69 67.03 67.38 67.72 68.07 2 POLE-Con. APPENDIX Table B-S.-Permanent Maximum conductor tension Percent of rated strength 419 B set values for Alumoweld strand Permanent set mm/mm or in/in Maximum conductor tension Percent of rated strength Permanent set mm/mm 01 in/in 096 104 112 120 129 40 41 42 43 44 15 16 17 18 19 .ooo 138 .OOO 148 .ooo 159 .ooo 171 .OOO183 45 46 47 48 49 .OOO600 .OOO622 .OOO645 .ooo 668 .OOO691 :i .OOO206 .ooo 195 22 23 24 .OOO217 .OOO228 .OOO240 50 51 52 53 54 .ooo 714 .ooo 737 .OOO760 .OOO783 .OOO807 25 26 27 .OOO253 .OOO267 .OOO282 ii .ooo 298 .OOO 314 55 56 57 58 59 .OOO832 .OOO858 .OOO885 .ooo 912 .ooo 940 30 .ooo 330 :Y 62 63 64 .OOO968 .ooo 997 .001027 .001057 .001087 10 11 12 13 14 0.000 .ooo .ooo .ooo .ooo i: 33 34 .ooo 347 .OOO 364 .OOO381 .OOO398 ii .OOO415 .ooo 432 2 39 .ooo 449 .OOO 466 .OOO484 65 Initial modulus: Final modulus: 148.238 GPa (21.5 x 10” lb/in2) 158.580 GPa (23 x 10” lb/in2) 0.000 .ooo .ooo .ooo .ooo 502 521 540 559 5 79 zt .OOl .OOl .OOl .OOl .OOl 118 149 181 214 248 70 .OOl 283 420 TRANSMISSION Table B-6.-Permanent Tension LINE DESIGN MANUAL set values for steel strand 10 mm (3/8 in) 13 mm (l/2 in) 11 mm (7/16 in) HS’ EHS2 lb HS’ EHS’ 8 896 9 341 9 786 10 231 10 657 2 000 2 100 2 200 2 300 2 400 0.000 136 .OOO142 .ooo 147 .ooo 154 .OOO162 0.000 036 .ooo 037 .OOO038 .ooo 039 .ooo 040 0.000 091 .OOO096 .ooo 100 .ooo 105 .ooo 110 0.000 019 .ooo 020 .ooo 021 .ooo 022 .OOO023 0.000 060 .OOO063 .ooo 066 .ooo 070 .ooo 074 0.000 012 .ooo 013 .ooo 014 .ooo 015 .OOO016 11 11 12 12 12 121 565 010 455 900 2 500 2 600 2 700 2 800 2 900 .ooo 170 .ooo 179 .ooo 188 .OOO198 .OOO208 .ooo 041 .OOO042 .ooo 043 .ooo 045 .ooo 047 .ooo 115 .ooo 120 .OOO125 .ooo 130 .ooo 135 .OOO024 .OOO025 .OOO026 .OOO027 .OOO028 .OOO078 .OOO082 .ooo 086 .ooo 090 .ooo 094 .ooo 017 .OOO018 xl00 019 .ooo 020 .ooo 021 13 13 14 14 15 345 789 234 679 124 3 000 3 100 3 200 3 300 3 400 .ooo 219 .OOO230 .OOO242 .OOO253 .OOO264 .ooo 049 .OOO052 .ooo 055 .OOO058 .OOO061 .ooo 140 .ooo 145 .ooo 150 .ooo 155 .OOO 160 .ooo 029 .ooo 030 .ooo 031 .OOO032 .ooo 033 .OOO098 .ooo 102 .OOO 106 .ooo 111 .ooo 115 .ooo 022 .OOO023 .OOO024 .OOO025 .OOO026 15 16 16 16 17 569 014 458 903 348 3 500 3 600 3 700 3 800 3 900 .OOO275 .OOO287 .ooo 299 .ooo 311 .OOO323 ,000 064 .ooo 068 .OOO072 .OOO076 .OOO081 .OOO165 .ooo 170 .ooo 175 .OOO180 .OOO 185 .ooo 034 .ooo 035 .OOO036 .ooo 037 .OOO038 .ooo 119 .OOO123 .OOO127 .ooo 131 .ooo 135 .OOO027 ,000 028 .ooo 029 .ooo 030 .ooo 031 17 18 18 19 19 793 238 682 127 572 4 000 4 100 4,200 4 300 4 400 .OOO336 .ooo 350 .OOO365 .OOO381 .OOO398 .ooo 086 .ooo 092 .OOO098 .ooo 104 .ooo 110 .ooo 190 .ooo 195 .ooo 202 .OOO208 .OOO214 .ooo .ooo .ooo .ooo .ooo 040 04 1 043 045 047 .ooo 139 .ooo 143 .OOO148 .OOO152 .OOO156 .OOO032 .ooo 033 .ooo 034 .ooo 035 .OOO036 20 20 20 21 21 017 462 907 351 796 4 4 4 4 4 500 600 700 800 900 .OOO416 .ooo 435 .ooo 455 .ooo 475 .OOO496 .ooo 117 .OOO124 .ooo 131 .OOO138 .OOO146 .ooo 220 .OOO227 .OOO234 .OOO242 .OOO250 .ooo 049 .ooo 05 1 .ooo 053 .OOO056 .OOO05 8 .OOO160 .OOO164 .ooo 168 .OOO172 .OOO176 .ooo 037 .OOO038 .ooo 039 .ooo 040 .ooo 041 22 22 23 23 24 241 686 131 575 020 5 000 5 100 5 200 5 300 5 400 .ooo 519 .ooo 544 .ooo 571 .OOO600 .OOO631 .ooo 154 .OOO162 .ooo 171 .OOO180 ‘:OOO189 .ooo 259 .OOO268 .OOO277 .OOO286 ,000 295 .OOO062 .OOO065 .ooo 068 .ooo 07 1 .ooo 074 .OOO180 .OOO185 .ooo 190 .ooo 195 .ooo 200 .OOO042 .ooo 043 .ooo 044 .ooo 045 .OOO046 24 24 25 25 26 465 910 355 800 244 5 5 5 5 5 500 600 700 800 900 .ooo 199 .ooo 209 .ooo 219 .OOO230 .OOO241 .ooo 305 .ooo 315 .OOO325 .ooo 335 .ooo 347 .ooo 077 .OOO080 .OOO083 .ooo 086 .OOO089 .OOO205 .ooo 210 .OOO215 .ooo 220 .OOO225 .ooo 047 .OOO048 .ooo 049 .ooo 050 .ooo 05 1 26 27 27 28 28 689 134 576 024 468 6 000 6 100 6 200 6 300 6 400 .OOO252 .OOO263 .OOO275 .OOO287 .ooo 299 .ooo .ooo ,000 .ooo .ooo .ooo .ooo .ooo .ooo .ooo 092 095 099 103 107 .OOO230 .OOO236 .OOO243 .OOO250 .OOO257 .OOO052 .ooo 053 .ooo 054 .OOO056 .OOO058 28 29 29 30 30 913 358 803 248 693 6 500 6 600 6 700 6 800 6 900 .ooo 311 .OOO324 .ooo 337 .ooo 351 .OOO365 .ooo 417 .ooo 429 .ooo 441 .ooo 453 .OOO465 .ooo 111 .ooo 115 .ooo 119 .OOO123 .OOO128 .OOO264 .OOO271 .OOO278 .OOO285 .ooo 292 .OOO060 .OOO062 .OOO064 .OOO067 .ooo 070 359 371 382 393 405 EHS2 HS’ N APPENDIX Table B-6.-Permanent Tension 421 6 set values for steel strand-continued 10 mm (3/8 in) EHS2 HS' N lb 31 137 31 582 32 027 32 472 32 917 7 000 7 100 7 200 7 300 7 400 0.000 380 .OOO396 .ooo 413 .ooo 431 .ooo 45 1 33 362 33 806 34 251 34 696 35 141 7 500 7 600 7 700 7 800 7 900 .OOO472 .ooo 493 .ooo 515 35 586 36 030 36 475 36 920 37 365 11 mm (7/16 in) HS' EHS2 0.000 477 .OOO489 .ooo 501 .ooo 513 13 mm (l/2 in) HS' EHS2 0.000 133 ,000 139 ,000 146 .OOO152 .ooo 159 0.000 299 .OOO306 .ooo 313 .OOO320 .OOO327 0.000073 .ooo075 .OOO 078 .OOO 081 .OOO 083 .OOO165 .OOO172 .OOO178 .OOO185 .ooo 191 .ooo 334 .ooo 341 .OOO348 .ooo 355 .OOO363 .OOO085 .OOO087 .ooo 090 .ooo 093 .OOO096 8 000 8 100 8 200 8 300 8 400 .OOO198 .OOO204 .ooo 211 .OOO217 ,000 224 .ooo 371 .OOO378 .OOO387 .OOO396 .ooo 405 .ooo 099 .ooo 102 .ooo 105 .OOO108 .ooo 111 37 810 38 255 38 699 39 144 39 589 8 500 8 600 8 700 8 800 8 900 .OOO230 .OOO237 .OOO243 .ooo 249 .OOO256 .ooo 414 .OOO424 .ooo 434 .ooo 444 .ooo 454 .ooo 114 .OOO118 .ooo 122 .OOO126 .ooo 130 40 034 40 479 40 923 41 368 41 813 9 000 9 100 9 200 9 300 9 400 .OOO262 .OOO268 .OOO274 .OOO280 .OOO287 .OOO464 ,000 474 .OOO484 .ooo 495 .OOO506 .ooo 135 .ooo 139 .ooo 143 .ooo 147 .ooo 151 42 258 42 703 43 148 43 592 44 037 9 500 9 600 9 700 9 800 9 900 .ooo 295 .OOO306 .OOO318 ,000 329 .ooo 341 .ooo 155 .ooo 159 .OOO164 .ooo 168 .ooo 173 44 482 44 927 45 372 45 816 46 261 10 000 10 100 10 200 10 300 10 400 .OOO352 .OOO364 .ooo 375 .OOO387 .ooo 403 .OOO178 .OOO183 .ooo 188 .ooo 192 .ooo 197 46 706 47 151 47 596 48 041 48 485 10 500 10 600 10 700 10 800 10 900 .ooo 201 .OOO205 .ooo 209 .OOO213 .OOO218 48 930 49 375 49 820 50 265 50 709 11000 11 100 11 200 11300 11400 .OOO223 .OOO228 .OOO233 .OOO238 ,000 243 51 154 51599 52 044 52 489 52 934 11500 11 600 11700 11 800 11900 .OOO255 .OOO261 .OOO267 .OOO273 .ooo 249 422 TRANSMISSION Table B-6.-Permanent Tension 10 N lb HS’ mm (3/8 LINE DESIGN MANUAL set values for steel strand-Continued in) EHS’ 11 HS’ mm (7/16 in) F2-d 13 mm (l/2 in) HS’ EHS2 53 53 54 54 55 378 823 268 713 158 12 12 12 12 12 000 100 200 300 400 0.000 280 .OOO287 .ooo 295 .OOO302 .ooo 309 55 56 56 56 57 603 047 492 937 382 12 12 12 12 12 500 600 700 800 900 .ooo 317 .OOO325 .ooo 333 .ooo 341 .ooo 350 57 58 58 59 59 827 271 716 161 606 13 13 13 13 13 000 100 200 300 400 .ooo 359 .OOO368 .ooo 377 .OOO386 .OOO396 Ultimate strength 48 040 N (10 800 lb) 68 500 N (15 400 lb) 64 500 N (14 500 lb) 92 520 N (20 800 lb) 83 625 N (18 800 lb) 119 655 N (26 900 lb) t High strength. Initial modulus = 158.580 GPa (23 x lo6 lb/in2). Final modulus = 177.885 GPa (25.8 x lo6 lb/in2). ’ Extra-high strength. Initial modulus = 162.028 GPa (23.5 x lo6 lb/in2). Final modulus = 177.885 GPa (25.8 x 10 6 lb/in2). APPENDIX 423 B Table B- 7.-Flashover characteristics of suspension insulator strings and air gaps Impulse air gap, in mm 8 Impulse flashover (positive critical), kV Number of insulator units’ Wet 6082 flashover, Wet 60-Hz air gap, kV mm in 130 170 215 254 305 406 508 660 10 12 16 20 26 762 889 991 1118 1245 ;t 39 44 49 203 356 533 660 813 150 255 355 440 525 965 1092 1245 1397 1524 610 695 780 860 945 5 9 10 255 295 335 375 415 1025 1105 1185 1265 1345 11 12 13 14 15 455 490 525 565 600 1346 1473 1575 1676 1778 53 58 I; 88 1676 1803 1956 2083 2235 ;3 104 110 115 2362 2515 2642 2794 2921 1425 1505 1585 1665 1745 16 17 18 630 660 690 720 750 1880 1981 2083 2184 2286 74 78 82 86 90 121 126 132 137 143 3073 3200 3353 3480 3632 1825 1905 1985 2065 2145 21 22 23 780 810 840 870 900 2388 2464 2565 2692 2794 94 97 101 106 110 148 154 159 165 171 3759 3912 4039 4191 4343 2225 2305 2385 2465 2550 26 27 930 960 990 1020 1050 2921 3023 3124 3251 3353 115 119 123 128 132 14 21 26 32 38 43 49 z; 66 71 6 :Fl z ii 30 ifi 70 1 Insulator units are 146 by 254 mm (5-3/4 by 10 in) or 146 by 267 mm (5-3/4 by 10-l/2 in). 424 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN Table B-8.-Flashover _ Ahgap mm in Flashover 60-Hz wet, Pos. critical kV impulse, kV MANUAL values of air gaps AirgaP mm in Flashover 60-Hz wet, Pos. critical kV impulse, kV 25 51 76 102 127 1 2 3 4 5 38 60 75 91-95 106-114 1295 1321 1346 1372 1397 51 52 53 54 55 438 447 455 464 472 814 829 843 858 872 152 178 203 229 254 6 7 8 9 10 80 128-141 141-15’5 159-166 175-178 190 1422 1448 1473 1499 1524 56 57 58 59 60 481 489 498 506 515 887 901 916 930 945 279 305 330 356 381 11 12 13 14 15 89 98 107 116 125 207 224 241 258 275 1549 1575 1600 1626 1651 :: 63 64 65 523 532 540 549 557 960 975 990 1005 1020 406 432 457 483 508 16 17 18 19 20 134 143 152 161 170 290 305 320 335 350 1676 1702 1727 1753 1778 66 z’8 69 70 566 574 583 591 600 1035 1050 1065 1080 1095 533 559 584 610 635 21 22 23 24 25 178 187 195 204 212 365 381 396 412 427 1803 1829 1854 1880 1905 71 72 73 74 75 607 615 622 630 637 1109 1124 1138 1153 1167 660 686 711 737 762 26 27 28 29 30 221 229 238 246 255 443 458 474 489 505 1930 1956 1981 2007 2032 76 77 78 79 80 645 652 660 667 675 1182 1196 1211 1225 1240 787 813 838 864 889 31 32 33 34 35 264 273 282 291 300 519 534 548 563 577 2057 2083 2108 2134 2159 81 82 83 84 85 683 691 699 707 715 1254 1269 1283 1298 1312 914 940 965 991 1016 36 ;;: 39 40 309 318 327 336 345 592 606 621 635 650 2184 2210 2235 2261 2286 86 87 88 89 90 723 731 739 747 755 1327 1341 1356 1370 1385 1041 1067 1092 1118 1143 41 42 43 44 45 353 362 370 379 387 665 680 695 710 725 2311 2337 2362 2388 2413 91 92 93 ;: 763 771 779 787 795 1399 1414 1428 1443 1457 1168 1194 1219 1245 1270 46 47 48 49 50 396 404 413 421 430 740 755 770 785 800 2438 2464 2489 2515 2540 ;4 98 99 100 803 811 819 827 835 1472 1486 1501 1515 1530 APPENDIX Table B-8.-Flashover bc gap Flashover 60-Hz wet, Pos. critical kV imuulse. kV mm in 2565 2591 2616 2642 2667 101 102 103 104 105 842 848 855 862 869 2692 2718 2743 2769 2794 106 107 108 109 110 2819 2845 2870 2896 2921 425 B values of air gaps-Continued Air gap Flashover 60-Hz wet, Pos. critical kV impulse, kV mm in 1544 1559 1573 1588 1602 3835 3861 3886 3912 3937 15: 152 153 154 155 1176 1182 1188 1194 1200 2269 2284 2298 2313 2327 875 882 889 896 902 1617 1631 1646 1660 1675 3962 3988 4013 4039 4064 156 157 158 159 160 1206 1212 1218 1224 1230 2342 2356 2371 2385 2400 111 112 113 114 115 909 916 923 929 936 1689 1704 1718 1733 1747 4089 4115 4140 4166 4191 161 162 163 164 165 1236 1242 1248 1254 1260 2414 2429 2443 2458 2472 2946 2972 2997 3023 3048 116 117 118 119 120 943 950 956 963 970 1762 1776 1791 1805 1820 4216 4242 4267 4293 4318 166 167 168 169 170 1266 1272 1278 1284 1290 2487 2501 2516 2530 2545 3073 3099 3124 3150 3175 121 122 123 124 125 977 984 991 998 1005 1834 1849 1863 1878 1892 4343 4369 4394 4420 4445 171 172 173 174 175 1296 1302 1308 1314 1320 2559 2574 2588 2603 2617 3200 3226 3251 3277 3302 126 127 128 129 130 1012 1019 1026 1033 1040 1907 1921 1936 1950 1965 4470 4496 4521 4547 4572 176 177 178 179 180 1326 1332 1338 1344 1350 2632 2646 2661 2675 2690 3327 3353 3378 3404 3429 131 132 133 134 135 1047 1054 1061 1068 1075 1979 1994 2008 2023 2037 4597 4623 4648 4674 4699 181 182 183 184 185 1355 1361 1366 1372 1377 2704 2719 2733 2748 2762 3454 3480 3505 3531 3556 136 137 138 139 140 1082 1089 1096 1103 1110 2052 2066 2081 2095 2110 4724 4750 4775 4801 4826 186 187 188 189 190 1383 1388 1394 1399 1405 2777 2791 2806 2820 2835 3581 3607 3632 3658 3683 141 142 143 144 145 1116 1122 1128 1134 1140 2124 2139 2153 2168 2182 4851 4877 4902 4928 4953 191 192 193 194 195 1410 1416 1421 1427 1432 2849 2864 2878 2893 2907 3708 3734 3759 3785 3810 146 147 148 149 150 1146 1152 1158 1164 1170 2197 2211 2226 2240 2255 4978 5004 5029 5055 5080 196 197 198 199 200 1438 1443 1449 1454 1460 2922 2936 2951 2965 2980 426 TRANSMISSION Table B-9.-Relative Elevation m LINE DESIGN air density and barometric pressure Barometric mm ft pressure in Relative air density at 25 OC at II OF 0 328.08 656.17 984.25 1312.34 1 2 3 4 0 000 000 000 000 760 733 107 681 656 29.92 28.86 21.82 26.81 25.84 1 .oo 0.96 .93 .90 .86 1.00 0.96 .93 .90 .86 1640.42 1968.>0 2296.59 2624.67 2952.16 5 6 I 8 9 000 000 000 000 000 632 609 581 564 544 24.89 23.98 23.10 22.22 21.40 .83 .80 .77 .I4 .I2 .83 .80 .I1 .I4 .I2 3280.84 3608.92 3937.01 4265.09 4593.18 10 000 11000 12 000 13 000 14 000 523 503 484 465 447 20.58 19.81 19.05 18.31 17.58 .69 .66 .64 .61 .59 .69 .66 .64 .61 .59 4921.26 5249.34 15 000 16 000 429 412 16.88 16.21 .56 .54 .56 .54 Table B- 1O.-Barometric Nonstandard air factor MANUAL Barometric mm of mercury pressure inches of mercury r Elevation m ft pressure versus elevation Nonstandard air factor Barometric mm of mercury pressure inchesof mercury 1 m Elevation ft 1 .oo 1.01 1.02 1.03 1.04 760 152 145 131 730 29.92 29.62 29.32 29.02 28.12 8: 171 256 343 0 280 561 841 1126 1.23 1.24 1.25 1.26 1.27 585 578 570 562 555 23.04 22.74 22.44 22.14 21.84 2154 2258 2362 2468 2580 1.05 1.06 1.07 1.08 1.09 722 114 101 699 692 28.42 28.12 27.83 27.53 21.23 432 521 609 691 788 1417 1709 1999 2287 2584 1.28 1.29 1.30 1.31 1.32 547 540 532 524 517 21.54 21.24 20.94 20.64 20.35 2691 2803 2914 3026 3139 8 9 9 9 10 1.10 1.11 1.12 1.13 1.14 684 676 669 661 654 26.93 26.63 26.33 26.03 25.13 878 971 1065 1159 1253 2881 3186 3495 3804 4112 1.33 1.34 1.35 1.36 1.37 509 502 494 486 419 20.05 19.75 19.45 19.15 18.85 3258 3317 3491 3617 3740 10 688 11079 11414 11 868 12 270 1.15 1.16 1.17 1.18 1.19 646 638 631 623 616 25.43 25.13 24.83 24.53 24.24 1347 1440 1534 1638 1739 4418 4724 5034 5375 5705 1.38 1.39 1.40 1.41 1.42 471 464 456 448 441 18.55 18.25 17.95 17.65 17.35 3864 3987 4113 4238 4369 12 13 13 13 14 1.20 1.21 1.22 608 600 593 23.94 23.64 23.34 1843 1946 2050 6045 6386 6727 1.43 1.44 1.45 433 426 418 17.05 16.76 16.46 4501 4630 4765 14 768 15 191 15 632 r Barometric pressure = (29.92) (2 minus nonstandard air factor). 7 068 7 409 I 750 8 098 8 463 829 195 561 921 299 676 082 493 904 333 APPENDIX 427 B Table B-l 1.-Mass per unit volume and relative mass density of wood species used for poles 1 Green Air-dry (15 percent moisture content) Species k/m3 Bald cypress lb/ft3 kg/m3 lb/ft3 Relative mass density 2 512 32 0.42 801 Douglas-fn Coast type Rocky Mountain 625 657 39 41 545 480 34 30 .45 .40 Hemlock, western 657 41 464 29 .38 Larch, western 801 50 609 38 .51 Pine Jack Loblolly 3 Lodgepole Longleaf’ Ponderosa Red Shortleaf 641 849 625 881 721 785 833 40 53 39 55 45 49 52 480 577 464 657 448 496 561 30 ;; 41 28 31 35 .40 .47 .38 .54 .38 .41 .46 Red cedar Eastern Western 593 432 37 27 529 368 33 23 .44 .31 Redwood 801 50 400 25 .38 Spruce (red, sitka, and white) 545 34 448 28 .37 White cedar Atlantic Northern 400 432 25 27 368 352 23 22 .31 .29 type r From “Wood Handbook,” Agriculture. Forest Products Laboratory, U.S. Forest Service, Department of 2 Based on volume when green, and mass when oven dry. 3 Part of southern yellow pine group. Volume of pole Metric V= 2.616 x lo-‘h(d,’ + d,d2)m3 where, h = length of pole, m dr = diameter of pole at top, mm di = diameter of pole at bottom, mm U.S. Customary V= 1.818 x lo-’ h(d12 +d,d2)ft3 where, h = length of pole, ft dr = diameter of pole at top,-in d2 = diameter of pole at bottom, in 428 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B- 12 .-Conductor temperature coefficients of expansion for normal sag-tension computations Temperature coefficient of expansion Conductor Stranding InitialJOF x 1o-6 Final/OF x 1o-6 Initial/OC x lo+ Final/OC x 1o-6 EC aluminum Steel ACSR 1 ACSR ACSR ACSR ACSR ACSR ACSR ACSR ACSR ACSR all all 12.8 12.8 6.4 23.0 11.5 18.3 23.0 6/l l/l 18/l 24/i' 26/l 30/l 45/l 54/l 54119 84119 6.4 10.2 9.5 11.6 10.5 9.9 9.5 11.2 10.2 10.4 11.2 10.5 9.8 11.1 10.8 10.5 9.9 11.5 10.1 10.8 11.5 11.1 20.8 18.9 11.8 11.0 20.2 18.3 18.8 20.1 11.5 18.9 11.1 21.1 19.5 18.9 11.8 20.7 19.3 19.5 20.6 ’ For ACSR conductors, the values shown apply only when the stress is borne by both the steel and aluminum strands. APPENDIX 429 6 Table B-l 3.-Pressure on a projected area due to wind velocity Indicated velocity Actual velocity Cylindrical m/s 0.894 1.788 2.682 3.576 4.470 mi/h : 6 8 10 12 14 16 m/s mi/h kPa Pressure on projected area surface Flat surface lblft= kPa lb/ft2 0.894 1.743 2.593 3.442 4.291 2.0 3.9 5.8 7.7 9.6 0.000 48 .OOl 82 .004 03 .007 10 .01103 0.01 .c4 .08 .15 .23 0.0008 .0031 .0068 .0119 .0185 0.02 .06 .14 .25 .39 11.2 12.9 14.5 16.2 17.8 .015 01 .019 91 .025 17 .03141 .037 92 .31 .42 .53 .66 .79 .0252 .0335 .0423 .0528 .0637 .53 .70 .88 1.10 1.33 5.364 6.258 7.152 8.046 8.940 to8 5.006 5.766 6.482 7.241 7.951 11.175 13.410 15.645 17.880 20.115 25 30 35 40 45 9.745 11.488 13.231 14.930 16.584 21.8 25.7 29.6 33.4 37.1 .056 .079 .104 .133 .164 88 05 86 51 73 1.19 1.65 2.19 2.79 3.44 .0956 .1328 .1762 .2243 .2768 2.00 2.77 3.68 4.68 5.78 22.350 24.585 26.820 29.055 31.290 50 55 60 65 70 18.238 19.892 21.500 23.065 24.630 40.8 44.5 48.1 51.6 55.1 .199 ,237 .276 .318 .363 23 01 87 65 36 4.16 4.95 5.78 6.66 7.59 .3347 .3982 .4652 .5353 .6104 6.99 8.32 9.72 11.18 12.75 33.525 35.760 37.995 40.230 42.465 75 8”: 90 95 26.194 27.893 29.368 30.971 32.542 58.6 62.4 65.7 69.3 72.8 .410 .466 .516 .574 .634 97 01 60 76 30 8.58 9.73 10.79 12.01 13.25 .6904 .7829 .8679 .9656 1.0656 14.42 16.25 18.13 20.17 22.26 44.700 46.935 49.170 51.405 53.640 100 105 110 115 120 34.061 35.626 37.190 38.755 40.319 76.2 79.7 83.2 86.7 90.2 .694 .760 .828 .899 .973 90 22 43 62 70 14.52 15.88 17.31 18.79 20.34 1.1674 1.2772 1.3918 1.5114 1.6358 24.39 26.68 29.07 31.57 34.17 55.875 58.110 60.345 62.580 64.815 125 130 135 140 145 41.884 43.448 45.013 46.622 48.187 93.7 97.2 100.7 104.3 107.8 1.050 1.130 1.213 1.301 1.390 75 69 62 93 80 21.95 23.62 25.35 27.20 29.05 1.7653 1.8996 2.0389 2.1872 2.3365 36.87 39.68 42.59 45.69 48.81 67.050 71.520 75.990 80.460 84.930 150 160 170 180 190 49.751 52.835 55.964 59.093 62.178 111.3 118.2 125.2 132.2 139.1 1.482 1.672 1.875 2.091 2.315 55 05 96 59 68 30.97 34.93 39.19 43.69 48.37 2.4907 2.8090 3.1516 3.5139 3.8903 52.03 58.68 65.84 73.40 81.26 430 TRANSMISSION Table B-14.-Equivalent LINE DESIGN MANUAL metric data for standard electrical conductors U.S. customary Code word Stranding Turkey swan sparrow Robin Raven 6/l 611 6/l 6/l 6/l Quail Pigeon Penguin Partridge Ostrich 6/l 6/l 6/l z;:: Size of conductor Thousand AWG circular No. mlls @mill 6 4 2 Diameter, in 0.198 Metric Area, in2 Aluminum Total 13.29 21.16 33.61 42.39 10.11 53.48 15.48 24.11 39.23 49.48 62.39 0.1219 0.1538 0.1939 11.35 0.2436 0.2140 16.31 11.21 61.42 85.03 101.23 135.16 152.00 18.65 99.23 125.10 151.16 116.17 0.2642 0.3122 0.3122 0.3146 0.3146 0.3012 0.3630 0.3850 0.4232 0.4356 18.31 20.41 198.19 234.19 248.39 21.19 110.45 201.42 201.42 241.68 241.68 213.03 281.03 0.4938 0.5083 0.5368 0.5526 0.5643 23.22 23.55 24.21 24.54 24.82 282.00 282.00 306.58 306.58 322.26 318.58 321.93 346.32 356.52 364.06 322.26 331.14 402.84 402.84 483.42 314.11 381.55 468.45 430.11 516.84 546.06 559.81 0.0206 0.0328 0.0521 0.0651 0.0829 0.0240 0.0383 0.0608 0.0161 0.0961 266.8 300.0 0.441 0.502 0.563 0.642 0.680 0.1045 0.1318 0.1662 0.2095 0.2356 0.721 0.183 0.806 0.846 0.858 0.914 210 3/o 4/o Area, mm2 Aluminum Total 5.03 6.35 8.03 9.02 0.250 0.316 0.355 0.398 If0 Diameter, mm 12.15 14.30 Linnet Ibis Lark Flicker Hawk 2617 26/l 30/l WI 26/l 336.4 391.5 397.5 411.0 411.0 Parakeet Dove Peacock Squab Rook 24/l 26/l 24/l 26/l 24/l 556.5 556.5 605.0 605.0 636.0 0.911 0.4311 0.4311 0.4152 0.4152 0.4955 Grosbeak Flamingo Drake Tern Rail 26/l 24/l 26/l 45/l 45/l 636.0 666.0 195.0 195.0 954.0 0.990 1.000 1.108 1.063 1.165 0.4995 0.5235 0.6244 0.6244 0.1493 0.5809 0.1261 0.6676 0.8011 25.15 25.40 28.14 21.00 29.59 C~dilld Ortolan Curlew Bluejay Finch 54/l 954.0 1033.5 30.38 30.81 1033.5 1113.0 1113.0 0.1493 0.8111 0.8117 0.8141 0.8141 0.8464 0.8618 2;: 45/l 54119 1.196 1.213 1.246 1.259 1.293 0.9169 0.9346 0.9849 31.65 31.98 32.84 483.42 523.68 523.68 563.93 563.93 45/l 1212.0 1212.0 1.345 1.382 1431.0 1431.0 1590.0 1.421 1.465 1.502 0.9990 0.9990 1.124 1.124 1.068 1.126 1.202 1.266 1.335 34.16 35.10 36.25 31.21 38.15 644.51 644.51 125.16 125.16 805.80 689.03 126.45 115.48 816.17 1590.0 1.545 1.602 1.762 1.131 1.401 1.512 1.831 1.116 39.24 40.69 44.15 44.12 805.80 901.93 1092.26 1098.06 901.74 915.48 Bittern Pheasant Bobolink Plover Lapwing Falcon ChUkiU Bluebird Kiwi 54119 45/l 54119 45/l 54119 84119 84119 1217 1180.0 2156.0 2161.0 0.921 0.953 0.966 1.249 1.249 1.398 1.693 1.102 0.5914 19.89 21.49 591.55 602.91 635.42 861.29 1181.29 1145.80 APPENDIX Table B-15.-Selected B 431 U-metric conversions. From /20/ Area To convert from To acre (U.S. survey1 are barn circular mil (cmil) hectare (ha) section [U.S. survey] square centimeter (cm’ ) square chain square foot [International (ft2 1 square foot [U.S. survey] ut* 1 square inch (in* ) square kilometer (km* ) square mile [International (mi*) square mile [U.S. survey] (mi* ) square rod [U.S. survey] hd* 1 square yard (yd*) township l Exact square square square square square square square square square meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter ______ Multiply (m*) (m*) (m* ) (m*) (m* ) (m* (m* (m* (m* f 4.046 * 1 .ooo l 1 .ooo 5.067 “I .ooo 2.589 *I .ooo * 1.562 “9.290 by 873 500 304 E+03 E+02 E- 28 E-10 E+04 E+06 E- 04 E- 04 E-02 341 E- 02 “6.451 600 1 .ooo 2.589 988 E- 04 E+OG E+06 075 998 square meter (m* square meter square meter square meter (m* (m* (m2 square meter (m* 2.589 998 E+06 square meter (m* 2.529 295 E+Ol square meter square meter (m* (m* 8.361 9.323 274 993 -- E-01 E+07 9.290 l conversion. Force To convert from --- To --- crinal dyne (dyn) kilogram force (kgf) kilopond kip ounce force pound force (Ibf) poundal (pdl) ton force Exact l I newton newton newton newton newton newton newton newton newton Multiply (N) (N) (N) (N) (N) (N) (N) (N) (N) *1 .ooo “I ,000 “9.806 “9.806 4.448 2.780 4.448 1.382 8.896 by E-01 E- 05 650 650 222 139 222 550 444 E+03 E-01 E-01 E+03 conversion. Force per length To convert from dyne per centimeter (dyn/cm) kilogram force per meter (W/m) pound per foot (Ib/ft) pound per inch (lb/in) l Exact conversion. To Multiolv newton per meter (N/m) * 1 .ooo newton per meter (N/m) “9.806 newton newton per meter per meter (N/m) (N/m) 1.459 1.751 bv E- 03 650 390 268 E+Ol E+O2 TRANSMISSION 432 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B-15. -Selected X-metric conversions-Continued Density-Mass To convert from gram per cubic centimeter (g/cm3 1 gram per liter (g/L) megagram per cubic meter &b/m3 1 metric ton per cubic meter (t/m3 1 milligram per liter (mg/L) ounce per cubic inch (oz/in3 ) ounce per gallon (oz/gal) ounce per pint (oz/pt) pound per (Ib/in3) pound per (Ib/ft3) pound per (I b/yd3 1 pound per cubic inch cubic foot cubic yard gallon (lb/gall slug per cubic foot (slug/ft3 ) ton [short] per cubic yard (ton/yd3 1 l Exact capacity To kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter per cubic (kg/m3 1 per cubic (kg/m3 1 per cubic (kg/m3 1 per cubic (kg/m3 l per cubic (kg/m3 1 per cubic (kg/m3 1 per cubic (kg/m3 1 per cubic (kg/m3 1 per cubic (kg/m3 l per cubic (kg/m’ 1 per cubic (kg/m3 1 per cubic (kg/m31 per cubic (kg/m3 1 per cubic (kg/m3 1 Multiply by “1 .ooo E+03 *I .ooo *I .ooo E+03 *I a00 E+03 *I .ooo E-03 1.729 994 E+03 7.489 152 9.361 440 E-01 2.767 990 E+04 1.601 846 E+OI 5.932 764 E-01 1.198 264 E+02 5.153 788 E+02 1.186 553 E+03 conversion. Time To convert from day [mean solar1 (dl day [sidereal] hour [mean solar] (hr) hour [sidereal] minute [mean solar] (min) minute [sidereal] month [mean calendar] (mol second [sidereal] week 17 days1 (wkl year [calendar] (al year [sidereal] l Exact conversion. Multiply To second second second second second second second second second second second (s) (sl (s) (s) (s) (sl (sl (sl (sl (s) (sl “8.640 8.616 “3.600 3.590 l 6.000 5.983 l 2.628 9.972 “6.048 l 3. I53 3.155 409 170 617 696 600 815 by E+O4 E+O4 E+03 E+03 E+Ol E+OI E+O6 E-01 E+05 E+07 E+07 APPENDIX B 433 Table B- 15 .-Selected SI-metric conversions-Continued Length -To convert from To angstrom unit (A) astronomical unit (AU) caliber centimeter (cm) chain, surveyor’s chain, engineer’s chain, nautical fathom fermi [obsolete replaced by femtometer] femtometer (fm) foot [U.S. survey] (ft) foot [International] (ft) furlong (fur) inch (in) kilometer (km) league link, surveyor’s light year (Iv) microinch (pin) micrometer @m) micron [obsolete, replaced by micrometer] mil (mil) mile [International] (mi mile [Statute] (mi) mile [U.S. survey] (mi) nautical mile (nmi) parsec pica, printer’s point, printer’s rod spat vard (vd) meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) l 1 .ooo * 1 .ooo 3.048 “3.048 2.011 l 2.540 l 1 .ooo 4.828 2.011 9.460 “2.540 meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) (m) “1.000 “2.540 * 1.609 1.609 1.609 l 1 .852 3.085 4.217 3.514 5.029 * 1.000 Exact conversion. l Linear ~ l Exact conversion. Multiply density l 1 .ooo 1.495979 “2.540 l 1 .ooo 2.011 680 “3.048 4.572 l 1.828 800 006 680 032 680 900 l 1.ooo l 9.144 344 300 347 678 518 598 210 by E-10 E+l 1 E- 02 E-02 E+Ol E+Ol E-15 E-15 E-01 E-01 E+02 E-02 E+03 E- 03 E-01 E+l5 E-08 E- 06 E-06 E- 05 E+03 E+03 E+03 E+03 E+16 E- 03 E- 04 E+12 E-01 TRANSMISSION 434 Table B-15.-Selected LINE DESIGN MANUAL N-metric conversions-Continued Load concentration To convert from To gram per square centimeter (s/cm2 1 megagram per square metet (Mg/m2 ] metric ton per square mete1 (t/m2 ] ounce per square inch (ozlin2) ounce per square foot (oz/ft2 ) ounce per square yard (o&d2 ] pound per square inch (I b/in2 ] pound per square foot (Ib/ft2) pound per square yard (I b&d2 ] ton per square foot (ton/ft2 ) Exact l kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter kilogram meter Multiply per square (kg/m’ ) per square (kg/m2 ) per square (kg/m’) per square (kg/m’ ] per square (kg/m21 per square (kg/m’ ) per square (kg/m2 ) per square (kg/m2 ) per square ( kg/m2 ) per square (kg/m2 ) by *I .ooo E+Ol *I .ooo E+03 *I .ooo E+03 2.119 109 E-03 3.051 517 E-01 3.390 575 E- 02 7.030 696 E+02 4.882 428 5.424 920 E-01 9.071 a47 E+02 conversion. Power To convert British thermal (Btu,,/h ] British thermal (Btu,,/h ] British thermal (Btul,/min) British thermal unit [IT] per hour unit per hour [rc] unit [tc] per minute unit per second [tcl (Btu& calorie [tc] per minute (cal,,/min) calorie [tcl per second (calt,/s) erg per second (erg/s] foot-pound per hour (ftlb/h) foot-pound per minute (ftlb/min) foot-pound per second (ft*lb/s) horsepower (hp) horsepower [boiler] horsepower [electric] horsepower [metric] (hpM) horsepower [water] ton [refrigeration] l Exact conversion. To from Multiolv bv watt (W] 2.930 711 E-01 watt (WI 2.928 751 E-01 watt (WI 1.757 250 E+Ol watt watt watt watt watt watt watt watt watt watt watt watt watt (WI (WI (WI (W] (W] (W] (WI (WI (WI (WI (WI (WI (WI 1.054 6.973 l 4.lB4 350 333 E+03 E-02 l 1 .ooo 3.766 161 2.259 697 1.355 ala 7.456 999 9.809 500 “7.460 7.354 990 7.460 430 3.516 BOO E-07 E- 04 E-02 E+02 E+03 E+02 E+O2 E+02 E+03 APPENDIX B 435 Table B- 15 .-Selected S&metric conversions-Continued Mass To convert barrel of cement carat [metric] carat (kt) cental centner centner [metric] grain from [376 To lb] gram (9) hundredweight [gross or long] (cwt) hundredweight [net or short] (cwt) kilogram force-second squared per meter (kgfx* /m) kilotonne (kt) ounce [avoirdupois] (oz) ounce [troy/apothecary] (oz) megagram (Mg) metric grain metric ton (t) milligram (mg) pennyweight pound [avoirdupois] (lb) pound [troy/apothecary] quintal sack of cement 194 Ibs] slug ton [assay] ton [long] ton [ short] tonne (t) Exact l kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) 1.705 “2.000 2.591 4.535 4.535 1 .ooo 6.479 * 1 .ooo 5.080 4.535 kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram kilogram (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) “9.806 * 1 .ooo 2.834 3.110 * 1 .ooo “5.000 * 1 .ooo * 1 .ooo 1.555 4.535 3.732 “1.000 4.263 1.459 2.916 1 .016 9.071 “1.000 507 956 924 924 891 235 924 by E+02 E- 04 E-04 E+Ol E+Ol E+02a E- 05 E- 03 E+Ol E+Ol 650 952 348 174 924 417 767 390 667 047 847 E+06 E-02 E- 02 E+03 E-05 E+03 E- 06 E-03 E-01 E-01 E+02 E+Ol E+Ol E-02 E+03 E+02 E+03 conversion. a European applies Multiply metric centner to the centner is 50 percent of this value; conversion factor presented as used in the U.S.S.R Frequency I To convert from To Multiply by hertz (Hz) 2.777 778 f- 04 cycle per minute (c/min) hertz (Hz) 1.666 667 E-02 cycle per second (c/s) hertz (Hz) * 1 .ooo hertz (Hz) “1.000 cycle per hour (c/h) fresnel l Exact conversion. E+12 436 TRANSMISSION Table B-15.4elected LINE DESIGN MANUAL S-metric conversions-Continued Pressure-Stress To convert from atmosphere [standard] (atm) bar barye dyne per square centimeter (dyn/crr?) foot of water 14 “Cl gram force per square centimeter (gf/cm’ ) inch of mercury [O “Cl inch of mercury [ I6 “Cl inch of water [4 “C] inch of water [ I6 “C] kilogram force per square meter (kgf/m2 ) kilogram force per square centimeter (kgf/cm’) To Multiply by Pascal (Pa) Pascal (Pa) Pascal (Pa) 1.013 250 “1.000 *I .ooo E+05 E+05 E-01 Pascal (Pa) Pascal (Pa) “I .ooo 2.988 980 E-01 E+03 Pascal Pascal Pascal Pascal Pascal (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) “9.806 3.386 3.376 2.490 2.488 650 380 850 817 400 E+Ol E+03 E+03 E+02 E+02 Pascal (Pa) l 9.806 650 Pascal (Pa) “9.806 650 E+04 kip per square inch (kip/in2) kip per square foot (kip/ft2 ) megapascal (MPa) meter-head [meter of water, 4 “C] millibar (mbar) millimeter of mercury [0 “C] Pascal Pascal Pascal Pascal Pascal Pascal 6.894 757 4.788 026 *I .ooo 9.806 365 “1.000 I .333 220 E+06 E+04 E+06 E+03 E+02 E+02 (mm(W) millimeter Pascal (Pa) of water [4 “C] (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) 9.806 365 hm(H20)) newton per square meter (N/m2 ) pound per square foot (Ib/ft2 ) pound per square inch (lb/in2 ) poundal per square foot (pdl/ft2 ) tor torr (mm(Hg)) l Exact conversion. Pascal Pascal Pascal Pascal Pascal Pascal (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) (Pa) “I .ooo 4.788 026 6.894 757 I .488 164 * 1 .ooo I .333 220 E+OI E+03 E+02 APPENDIX 437 B Table B-15. -Selected SI-metric conversions--Continued Tempera we Scale values Degrees Celsius “C Degrees Fahrenheit OF - x “c= X OF= $(x- X K= x- x “R= ; (x- X Or= x + 273.15 :x+32 - 32) 273.15 fx- 491.67) fx + 491.67 459.67 %x+32 Degrees Reaumur Or %X x + 459.67 t (x + 459.67) $(x- ;(x ;X x - 459.67 $X Degrees Rankine “R Kelvins K - fX $x + 273.15 $x $(x- K OF OR Or l”C=l K= 1 9 5 4 5 IoF= “R= 5 9 1 4 s 5 4 9 4 1 Or= - 273.15) 491.67) - +491.67 Intervals: “C 32) 1 TRANSMISSION 438 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table B- 15 .-Selected S-metric conversions-Continued Velocity-Speed To convert Angular from revolution (r/min) revolution (r/s) per minute per second by radian per second (rad/s) radian per second (rad/s) radian per second (rad/s) 1.745 329 E-02 1.047 198 E-01 6.283 185 (L/T): foot per second (ft/s) foot per minute (ft/min) foot per hour (ft/h) foot per day (ft/d) foot per year (ft/a) inch per second (in/s) inch per hour (in/h) kilometer per hour (km/h knot [nautical miles per hour1 (kn) mile per hour (mi/h) meter per hour (m/h) meter per year (m/a) millimeter per second (mm/s) speed of light (c) l Multiply (e/r): degree per second Linear To Exact meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter per per per per per per per per second second second second second second second second (m/s) (m/s) (m/s) (m/s) (m/s) (m/s) (m/s) (m/s) “3.048 “5.080 8.466 3.527 9.695 “2.540 7.055 2.777 meter meter meter meter per per per per second second second second (m/s) (m/s) (m/s) (m/s) 5.144 4.470 2.777 3.170 meter meter per second per second (m/s) (m/s) *I .ooo 2.997 556 778 E-01 E- 03 E-05 E- 06 E- 09 E-02 E-06 E-01 444 400 778 979 E-01 E-01 E- 04 E-08 925 E-03 E+08 667 778 890 conversion. Torque-Bending To convert from dyne centimeter (dyncm) kilogram force meter (kgfem) kip-foot (kip.ft) ounce inch (oz.in)aS b pound-foot (Ib*ft) aSb pound-inch (Ib*in)aS b moment Multiply To newton meter (N-m) l 1.ooo newton newton newton newton newton meter meter meter meter meter (N.m) (N*m) (N*m) (N-m) (N-m) “9.806 650 1.355 818 7.061 552 1.355 818 1.129848 l Exact conversion. iThe addition of the force designator Most USBR engipeers reverse the equivalent terminology. may be desirable, torque units, for e.g., Ibf-ft. example, foot-pound; by E- 07 E+02 E- 03 E-01 this is APPENDIX B 439 Table B- 15 .-Selected S&metric conversions-Continued Volume-Capacity To convert from To Multiply acre-foot [U.S. survey1 (acre-ft) barrel [oil] (bbl) barrel [water] (bbl) board foot [l ft x 1 ft x 1 in] cubic cubic cubic meter meter meter (m3) (m3) (m3 1 (fbm) bushel [U.S., dry] (bu) cord cubic centimeter (cm3) cubic decimeter (dm3) cubic dekameter (dam3 ) cubic foot (ft3) cubic inch (in3 ) cubic kilometer (km3) cubic mile (mi3) cubic millimeter (mm3) cubic yard (yd3 ) cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter meter (m3) (m3 (m3) (m3 (m3) (m3) (m3) (m3 (m3) (m3 (m3) (m3 (m3 (m3 (m3 (m3 (m3 (m3) (m3 (m3 (m3) (m3 (m3 (m3 (m3) (m3) (m3 (m3) (m3) (m3 (m3 (m3 cubic cubic cubic cubic cubic cup firkin fluid dram fluid ounce [U.S.] (fl.oz.) gallon Ilmperiall gallon [U.S., dry1 gallon [U.S., liquid] (gal) gill [U.S.] kiloliter (kL) liter (L) megaliter (ML) milliliter (mL) peck [U.S.] pint [U.S., dry1 pint [U.S., liquid] quart [U.S., dry1 quart [U.S., liquid] stere [timber] tablespoon teaspoon ton [sea freight or shipping capacity] ton [internal cap. of ships or register ton] ton [vol. of oil] ton [timber] tun [U.S., liquid] l Exact conversion. 1 1 1.233 1.589 1.192 489 873 405 E+O3 E-01 E-01 2.359 737 3.523 907 3.624 556 * 1 .ooo E-03 E- 02 549 737 871 691 353 060 884 412 941 E- 06 E-03 E+03 E-02 E- 05 E+09 E+09 E-09 E-01 E- 03 E-02 E- 06 E- 05 E-03 E- 03 E- 03 E-04 l 1.ooo ) ) ) ) ) 1 ) ) 1 ) by *1 .ooo 2.831 1.638 *1 .ooo 4.168 l 1 .ooo 7.645 2.359 3.406 3.696 2.957 4.546 4.404 3.785 1.182 “1.000 “1 .ooo 685 706 182 768 105 765 221 529 ) ) ) *1 .ooo 8.809 5.506 4.731 1.101 9.463 *1 .ooo 1.478 4.928 E-03 E+03 E-06 E- 03 E-04 E-04 E-03 E-04 676 922 E-05 E-06 meter (m3 1 1.132 674 meter meter meter meter (m3) (m3 1 (m3) (m3 1 2.831 6.700 1.415 9.539 685 179 842 238 1 ) ) ) l 1.ooo E-O! <<Appendix C CONDUCTORANDOVERHEADGROUNDWIREDATATABLES The tables in this and stress-strain and based on information and Wire Initial loading Co. (U.S. appendix creep from Steel) have catalog modulus values shown curve between the point at 50 percent of the ultimate been prepared for ACSR curves prepared by the Aluminum Copperweld Steel Co., and the conductor based upon conductor data Association. The Alumoweld data are steel data are based on American Steel information. in the where tables were determined the entire conductor from starts the average the to share slope load of the initial the point and strength. Permanent set values were determined at 50 percent of the conductor ultimate strength as it represents the maximum stress permitted under full load conditions. Creep values were determined at 18 percent of the ultimate strength of the conductor because ma no-load tension on a conductor. this would be about equal to the 15.5 ‘C (60 OF) f 1 441 442 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table C-l .-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (metric) 103.42 110.32 117.21 124.11 131 .oo 137.90 144.79 151.69 158.58 165.48 172.37 179.26 186.16 193.05 199.95 206.84 .00070146 .00123350 ’ Calculated at 18 percent of ultimate strength. APPENDIX 443 C Table C-l .-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (metric&Continued DS AND Code word Size, mm2 WANATE PARATE 21.13 33.64 1 STFFI 1O-year creep’ S Tension’ , N I 1 1.00048932 .00047536 1 1889.6 AND Final modulus, GPa 87.012 87.012 L Stress, MPa 6.89 13.79 20.68 27.58 34.47 41.37 48.26 55.16 62.05 68.95 75.84 82.74 89.63 96.53 103.42 110.32 117.21 124.11 131 .oo 137.90 144.79 151.69 158.58 165.48 172.37 i79.26 186.16 193.05 199.95 206.84 213.74 220.63 227.53 234.42 Permanent set .00002236 .00003009 .00003766 .00004518 .00005282 .00006070 .00006896 .00007776 .00008723 .00009751 .00010874 .00012106 .00013462 .00014955 .00016600 .00018410 .00020401 to0022585 .00024977 .00027591 .00030442 .00033543 .00036908 .00040552 .00044488 .00048731 .00053295 .00058194 .00063441 .00069052 .00075040 .00081419 .00088204 .00095408 Calculatedat 18 percentof ultimate strength. Initial modulus, GPa 79.271 79.351 79.389 79.383 79.335 79.244 79.112 78.939 78.726 78.474 78.186 77.862 77.505 77.115 76.696 76.249 75.776 75.280 74.761 74.223 73.666 73.094 72.507 71.909 71.299 70.680 70.054 69.421 68.784 68.143 67.500 66.856 66.211 444 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table C-l .-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (metric&Continued r STRANDS Code word Size, mm2 135.19 170.45 201.41 241.70 ‘AXW I NG IERL IN HICKADEE ‘ELICAN SPREY INGBIRD 287.05 322.26 Stress, MPa 6.89 13.79 20.68 27.58 34.47 41.37 48.26 55.16 62.05 68.95 75.84 82.74 89.63 96.53 103.42 110.32 117.21 124.11 131 .oo 137.90 144.79 151.69 158.58 165.48 ’ Calculated at 18 &ent AN 1O-year creep’ Tension’, N .00058691 .00058702 .00056698 .00056019 .00055702 .00055886 5508.7 6949.9 7958.7 9448.0 10969.3 12570.6 Permanent set .00007997 .00011682 .00015029 .00018134 .00021094 .00024002 .00026954 .00030046 .00033374 .00037032 .00041116 .00045722 .00050944 .00056879 .00063621 .00071266 .00079909 .00089647 .00100573 .00112784 .00126375 .00141442 .00158079 .00176383 of ultimate 1 1 STE!=l S strength. Final modulus, GPa 68.031 68.031 68.031 68.031 68.031 68.031 Initial modulus, GPa 49.893 50.516 51.036 51.441 51.725 51.885 51.919 51.831 51.627 51.313 50.900 50.400 49.824 49.183 48.489 47.754 46.985 46.194 45.387 44.570 43.751 42.933 42.120 APPENDIX C 445 Table C-l .-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (metric&Continued r 7 STFFI Code word Size, mm2 7ANT I CKER ~RAKEET IACOCK IOK -AM I NGO JCKOO 201.41 241.70 281 .98 306.81 322.26 337.46 402.83 1O-year creep’ Tension’, N 11689.9 13771.6 15853.4 17294.6 17614.9 18976.0 22338.9 .00050955 .00049932 .00049191 .00049382 .00047682 .00049160 .0004845a S’ LBANDS Final modulus, GPa 72.602 72.602 72.602 72.602 72.602 72.602 72.602 L Stress, MPa 6.89 13.79 20.68 27.58 34.47 41.37 48.26 55.16 62.05 68.95 75.84 82.74 89.63 96.53 103.42 110.32 117.21 124.11 131 .oo 137.90 144.79 151.69 158.58 165.48 172.37 i79.26 186.16 193.05 199.95 ’ Calculated at 18 percent Permanent set .0000444 I .00007736 ,000 I 0696 .00013378 .OOOI 5840 .00018138 .000203 30 .00022474 .00024627 .00026846 .00029 I 89 .00031713 .00034475 .00037532 .00040943 .ooO44764 .00049053 .00053867 .00059263 .00065299 ,00072033 .0007952 I .0008782 i .00096990 . 00 I 07086 .OOl 18166 .00130287 .00143507 .00157883 of ultimate strength. Initial modulus, GPa 53 .900 54.625 55.288 55.880 56.395 56.827 57.170 57.422 57.581 57 646 57.620 57.506 57.307 57 .029 56.678 56 .262 55.787 55.259 54.687 54.077 53.435 52.767 52.079 51.375 50.660 49.939 49.213 48.487 TRANSMISSION 446 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table C-l .-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (metric&Continued r STRANDSAM2 Code word 4RTR I DGE STR I CH I NNET 31s 4WK IJVE IJUAB ?OSBEAK TARL I NG ?AKE Size, mm2 135.19 152.01 170.45 201.41 241.70 281.98 306.55 322.26 362.54 402.83 1O-year creep’ 10168.6 11289.5 13051 .o 15613.2 18095.3 19456.4 20177.0 22739.2 25221.3 -1 L 6.89 13.79 .00007464 .00010656 206.84 .00013679 .00016568 .00019357 .00022078 .00024767 .00027456 .00030180 .00032973 .00035868 .00038900 .00042101 .00045507 .00049150 .00053065 .00057285 .00061844 .00066777 .00072116 .00077897 .00084152 .00090915 .00098221 .00106103 .00114595 .00123731 .00133544 .00144069 .00155340 ’ Calculated at 18 Ijercent of ultimate 74.188 74.188 74.188 74.188 74.188 74.188 74.188 74.188 74.188 74.188 9047.6 .00050213 .00050168 .00049623 .00048422 .00048255 .00047888 .00047298 .00046581 .00046675 .00046583 Permanent set 137.90 144.79 151.69 158.58 165.48 172.37 i79.26 186.16 193.05 199.95 Final modulus, GPa Tension’ N Stress, MPa 20.68 27.58 34.47 41.37 48.26 55.16 62.05 68.95 75.84 82.74 89.63 96.53 103.42 110.32 117.21 124.11 131 .oo ANDS strength. L Initial modulus, GPa 55.223 55.600 55.932 56.215 56.449 56.631 56.761 56.837 56.860 56.831 56.750 56.619 56.440 56.216 55.948 55.640 55.295 54.915 54.505 54.067 53.604 53.119 52.615 52.096 51.562 51.018 50.465 49.905 49.340 1 APPENDIX C 447 Table C-l .-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final inodulus values (metric&-Continued 30 AI MUJ.M Size, mm* Code word RIOLE ARK EN AGLE 170.45 201.41 241.70 281.98 Stress, MPa 6.89 13.79 20.68 27.58 34.47 41.37 48.26 55.16 62.05 68.95 75.84 82.74 89.63 96.53 103.42 110.32 117.21 124.11 131 .oo 137.90 144.79 151.69 158.58 165.48 172.37 i79.26 186.16 193.05 199.95 206.84 213.74 STRANDS AND 1O-year creep’ 7 STFFL SIjXANDS Tension’ , N .00041719 .00041419 .00040398 .00040442 Permanent set .00004619 .00006826 .00008940 .00010977 .00012958 .00014901 .00016823 .00018745 .00020683 .00022657 .00024684 .00026785 .00028976 .00031276 .00033705 .00036280 .00039020 .00041943 .00045068 .00048413 .00051997 .00055839 .00059956 .00064367 .00069091 .00074147 .00079552 .00085325 .00091485 .00098050 .00105038 ’ Calculated at 18 percent of ultimate strength. 13851.7 16253.7 19056.1 22258.8 Final modulus, GPa 78.187 78.187 78.187 78.187 Initial modulus, GPa 62.536 62.804 63.040 63.241 63.407 63.538 63.633 63.691 63.713 63.698 63.648 63.563 63.444 63.291 63.106 62.890 62.645 62.372 62.072 61.748 61.401 61.033 60.645 60.240 59.818 59.382 58.933 58.472 58.001 57.522 448 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table C-l .-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (metric&Continued IlWNDs AND 4 Code word T ERN RUDDY RAIL 0 RTOLAN B LUEJAY B UNT I NG B I TTERN D I PPER BOBOL I NK NNUTHATCH L APWI NG 1O-year creep’ Size, mm2 402.83 456.03 483.39 523.67 563.96 604.24 644.52 684.81 725.09 765.37 805.65 00057764 00056147 00056215 00055394 00055325 00055490 00055412 00055343 00055282 00054804 00054776 Tension’ N L Stress, MPa Permanent set 6.89 .00007248 .00012961 .00017972 ,00022409 .00026402 .00030081 .00033576 .00037017 .00040532 .00044251 .00048305 .00052822 .00057932 .00063765 .00070450 .00078118 .00086897 .00096917 .00108308 .00121199 .00135721 .00152002 .00170172 17694.9 19536.5 20737.5 22178.7 23860.1 25621.6 27303.1 28984.5 30665.9 32107.1 33788.5 - - - Final modulus, GPa 64.466 64.466 64.466 64.466 64.466 64.466 64.466 64.466 64.466 64.466 64.466 Initial modulus, GPa - 13.79 20.68 27.58 34.47 41.37 48.26 55.16 62.05 68.95 75.84 82.74 89.63 96.53 103.42 110.32 117.21 124.11 131 .oo 137.90 144.79 151.69 158.58 Calculated at 18percentofultimate strength. 42.020 42.961 43.828 44.606 45.278 45.830 46.251 46.534 46.679 46.686 46.562 46.317 45.963 45.513 44.982 44.384 43.731 43.036 42.309 41.561 40.799 40.030 APPENDIX C 449 Table C-l .-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (metric&Continued Code word Size, mm* 402.83 456.03 483.39 523.67 ONDOR ANARY ARD I NAL URLEW I;_; I 1O-year creep’ 00046434 00046390 00046369 00046347 Tension’ , N 22579.1 25541.6 27062.8 29304.7 67.114 67.114 67.114 67.114 - Stress, MPa 6.89 13.79 20.68 27.58 34.47 41.37 48.26 55.16 62.05 68.95 75.84 82.74 89.63 96.53 103.42 110.32 117.21 124.11 131 .oo 137.90 144.79 151.69 158.58 165.48 172.37 179.26 Permanent set 00005753 00010350 00014543 00018402 00021994 00025388 00028652 00031856 00035066 00038352 00041782 00045425 00049348 00053621 00058311 00063487 00069218 00075571 00082615 00090420 00099052 00108580 00119074 00130600 00143228 00157026 Calculated at 18 percent of ultimate strength. Final modulus, GPa 1 Initial modulus, GPa 46.368 47.014 47.606 48.136 48.598 48.987 49.297 49.527 49.674 49.738 49.721 49.624 49.453 49.212 48.907 48.543 48.126 47.665 47.163 46.629 46.066 45.482 44.879 44.264 43.639 450 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table C-l .-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (metric)-Continued r 9 STFFl Code word Size, mm2 563.96 604.24 644.52 684.81 725.09 765.37 805.65 I NCH RACKLE HEASANT ARTIN LOVER ARROT ALCON 1O-year creep’ 00050022 00050043 0004877 1 00048760 00048851 00048704 00048789 S Tension’ , N 31306.4 33548.3 34909.5 37071.3 39313.2 41394.9 43636.8 Final modulus, GPa 69.706 69.706 69.706 69.706 69.706 69.706 69.706 Stress, MPa 6.89 13.79 20.68 27.58 34.47 41.37 48.26 55.16 62.05 68.95 75.84 82.74 89.63 96.53 103.42 110.32 117.21 124.11 131 .oo 137.90 144.79 151.69 158.58 165.48 172.37 179.26 186.16 Permanent set Initial modulus, GPa .00002892 .00006013 .00008941 .00011729 .00014431 .00017099 .00019788 .00022551 .00025441 .00028512 .00031817 .00035409 .00039342 .00043669 .00048444 .00053719 .00059549 .00065987 .00073086 .00080900 .00089482 .00098885 .00109163 .00120369 .00132557 .00145779 .00160090 ’ Calculated at 18 percent of ultimate strength. 52.987 53.386 53.717 53.976 54.159 54.267 54.299 54.254 54.136 53.948 53.692 53.374 52.999 52.571 52.097 51.582 51.031 50.451 49.845 49.219 48.577 47.923 47.260 46.592 45.922 45.251 APPENDIX 451 C Table C-l .-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (metric&-Continued 9 STFFL S Size, mm2 Code word 901.93 092.45 552.53 HUCKAR LUEBIRD 1O-year creep’ Tension’, N 00071310 00069677 00069663 40834.5 48280.8 68617.9 LANDS Final modulus, GPa 66.811 66.811 66.811 L Stress, MPa 6.89 13.79 20.68 27.58 34.47 41.37 48.26 55.16 62.05 68.95 75.84 82.74 89.63 96.53 103.42 110.32 117.21 124.11 131.00 137.90 144.79 151.69 158.58 165.48 Initial modulus, GPa Permanent set 0.00000000 .00003350 .00006531 .00009538 .00012455 .00015366 .00018356 .00021507 .00024904 .00028631 .00032772 .00037411 .00042632 .00048519 .00055156 .00062627 .00071016 .00080407 .00090885 .00102532 .00115433 .00129672 .00145333 .00162500 50.111 50.590 50.972 51.251 51.423 51.487 51.443 51.296 51.050 50.713 50.293 49.799 49.241 48.628 47.970 47.275 46.551 45.807 45.048 44.280 43.509 42.737 41.970 1t Calculated at 18 percent of .ultimate strength. TRANSMISSION 452 LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table C-2.-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (U.S. customary) r 1 1 STFFL S L Code word TURKEY SWAN SPARROW ROBIN RAVEN QUAIL PI GEON PENGU I N Size, AWG 01 kcmil 6 4 2 1 l/O 2/o 3/o 4/o 1O-year creep’ 214. 335. 513. 639. 788. 956. 1192. 1503. .00046458 .00045465 .00043810 .00043228 .00042251 .00040529 .00040014 .00040034 L Stress, lb/in’ Final modulus, lb/in2 Tension’ , lb Permanent set 11460000. 11460000. 11460000. 11460000. 11460000. 11460000. 11460000. 11460000. - 1 Initial modulus, lb/in2 1000. 2000. 3000. 4000. 5000. 6000. 7000. 8000. 9000. 10000. 11000. 12000. 13000. 14000. 15000. 16000. 17000. 18000. 19000. 20000. 21000. 22000. 23000. 24000. 25000. 26000. 27000. 28000. 29000. 30000. .00005034 .00006347 .00007589 .00008791 .00009981 .00011190 .00012448 .00013784 .00015228 .00016810 .00018560 .00020507 .00022682 .00025114 .00027834 .00030870 .00034253 .00038012 .00042178 .00046780 .00051848 .00057412 .00063501 .00070146 .00077376 .00085221 .00093712 .00102877 .00112746 .00123350 L ’ Calculated at 18 percent of ultimate strength. 9960963. 9996316. 10021891. 10037502. 10043072. 10038633. 10024321. 10000376. 9967127. 9924989. 9874445. 9816035. 9750342. 9677978. 9599568. 9515745. 9427132. 9334340. 9237955. 9138534. 9036604. 8932655. 8827140. 8720474. 8613037. 8505170. 8397179. 8289339. 8181890. APPENDIX 453 C Table C-2.-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (U.S. customary&Continued .00007776 .00009751 .00010874 .00014955 .00016600 .00020401 .00036908 .00044488 t Calculated at 18 percent of ultimate strength. 11497226. 11508882. 11514317. 11513518. 11506512. 11493358. 11474154. 11449026. 11418134. 11381666. 11339833. 11292869. 11241027. 11184574. 11123789. 11058958. 10990372. 10918326. 10843111. 10765016. 10684325. 10601313. 10516247. 10429384. 454 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table C-2.-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (U.S. customary)-Continued 1 1 STFFL S Code word Size, AWG or kcmil WAXWI NG MERL IN CHICKADEE PEL I CAN OSPREY KINGBIRD 266.8 336.4 397.5 477.0 566.5 636.0 Stress, lb/in2 1000. 2000. 3000. 4000. 5000. 6000. 7000. 8000. 9000. 10000. 11000. 12000. 13000. 14000. 15000. 16000. 17000. 18000. 19000. 20000. 21000. 22000. 23000. 24000. 1O-year creep’ .00058691 .00058702 .00056698 .00056019 .00055702 .00055886 Permanent set .00007997 .00011682 .00015029 .00018134 .00021094 .00024002 .00026954 .00030046 .00033374 .00037032 .00041116 .00045722 .00050944 .00056879 .00063621 .00071266 .00079909 .00089647 .00100573 .00112784 .00126375 .00141442 .00158079 .00176383 Calculated at 18 percent of ultimate lb Final modulus, lb/in2 1238. 1562. 1789. 2124. 2466. 2826. 9867000. 9867000. 9867000. 9867000. 9867000. 9867000. Tension’, strength. Initial modulus, lb/in2 7236257, 7326749. 7402066. 7460835. 7502070. 7525224. 7530226. 7517466. 7487760. 7442273. 7382441. 7309875. 7226273. 7133343. 7032742. 6926027. 6814624. 6699814. 6582724. 6464328. 6345457. 6226811. 6108966. APPENDIX C 455 Table C-2.-Permanent set, creep, and initial and .final modulus values (U.S. customary)-Continued TRANDS Size AWG or kcmil Code word AJYR 7 1O-year creep’ STFFL S‘ ANDS Final modulus, lb/in* Tension’, lb ~~ IRANT L I CKER IARAKEET ‘EACOCK !OOK LAM I NGO :UCKOO 397.5 477.0 556.5 605.5 636.0 666.0 795.0 .00050955 .00049932 .00049191 .00049302 .00047682 .00049160 .00048458 1 Stress, lb/in2 Permanent set 1000. .0000444 .00007736 .00010696 .00013378 .00015840 .00018138 .00020330 .00022474 2000. 3000. 4000. 5000. 6000. 7000. 8000. 9000. 10000. 11000. 12000. 13000. 14000. 15000. 16000. 17000. 18000. 19000. 20000. 21000. 22000. 23000. 24000. 25000. 26000. 27000. 28000. 29000. L Initial modulus, lb/in2 I .00024627 .00026846 .00029 I89 .00031713 00034475 : 00037532 .00040943 .00044764 .00049053 00053867 : 00059263 .00065299 .00072033 .0007952 I .0008782 I .00096990 .00107086 .OOll8166 . 00 I 30287 . 00 I43507 .00157883 Calculated at 18 percent qf ultimate 10530000. 10530000. 10530000. 10530000. 10530000. 10530000. 10530000. 2628. 3096. 3564. 3888. 3960. 4266. 5022. strength. 7817435 7922641 8018775. 8 I 04704 8179403. . . 824 I 996 829 I796 8328327. 8351347 8360853 8357070. 8340441 a31 1590. 827 I299 8220464. 8 I60059 8091 IO3 . 8014626 793 I642 7843128. 7750010. 7653 I47 7553330. 745 I274 73476 I 9 7242933 7137716. 7032400. . . . . . . . . . . . . 456 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table C-2.-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (U.S. customary)-Continued 1000. 2000. 3000. 4000. 5000. 6000. 7000. 8000. 9000. 10000. 11000. 12000. 13000. 14000. 15000. 16000. 17000. 18000. 19000. 20000. 21000. 22000. 23000. 24000. 25000. 26000. 27000. 28000. 29000. 30000. at 18 percentofultimate .00007464 .00010656 .00013679 .00016568 .00019357 .00022078 .00024767 .00027456 .00030180 .00032973 .00035868 .00038900 .00042101 .00045507 .00049150 .00053065 .00057285 .00061844 .00066777 .00072116 .00077897 .00084152 .00090915 .00098221 .00106103 .00114595 .00123731 .00133544 .00144069 .00155340 strength. 8009304. 8064029. 8112144. 8153295. 8187189. 8213600. 8232378. 8243448. 8246813. 8242554. 8230825. 8211848. 8185905. 8153331. 8114503. 8069834. 8019760. 7964731. 7905206. 7841642. 7774488. 7704182. 7631143. 7555770. 7478440. 7399503. 7319286. 7238088. 7156184. APPENDIX 457 C Table C-2.-Permament set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (U.S. customary)-Continued 1000. 2000. 3000. 4000. 5000. 6000. 7000. 8000. 9000. 10000. 11000. 12000. 13000. 14000. 15000. 16000. 17000. 18000. 19000. 20000. 21000. 22000. 23000. 24000. 25000. 26000. 27000. 28000. 29000. 30000. 31000. .00004619 .00006826 .00008940 .00010977 .00012958 .00014901 .00016823 .00018745 .00020683 .00022657 .00024684 .00026785 .00028976 .00031276 .00033705 .00036280 .00039020 .00041943 .00045068 .00048413 .00051997 .00055839 .00059956 .00064367 .00069091 .00074147 .00079552 .00085325 .00091485 .00098050 .00105038 Calculated at 18 percent o$ ultimate strength. 9069999. 9108929. 9143072.. 9172274. 9196403. 9215362. 9229082. 9237528. 9240698. 9238620. 9231356. 9218997. 9201662. 9179498. 9152671. 9121373. 9085809. 9046200. 9002779. 8955785. 8905464. 8852064. 8795831. 8737012. 8675847. 8612572. 8547413. 8480591. 8412314. 8342782. 458 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table C-2.-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (U.S. customary&-Continued r AND Code word TERN RUCDY RAIL ORTOLAN BLUE JAY BUNT I NG B I TTERN D I PPER BOBOL I NK NUTHATCH LAPW I NG Size, AWG 01 kcmil 795.0 900.0 954.0 1,033.5 1,113.0 1,192.5 1,272.0 1,351.5 1,431.0 1,510.5 1.590.0 1O-year creel.9 7 STFF’ Tension’, lb .00057764 .00056147 .00056215 .00055394 .00055325 .00055490 .00055412 .00055343 .00055282 .00054804 eOOO54776 Stress, lb/in2 Permanent set 1000. 2000. 3000. 4000. 5000. 6000. 7000. 8000. 9000. 10000. 11000. 12000. 13000. 14000. 15000. 16000. 17000. 18000. 19000. 20000. 21000. 22000. 23000. .00007248 .00012961 .00017972 .00022409 .00026402 .00030081 .00033576 .00037017 .00040532 .00044251 .00048305 .00052822 .00057932 .00063765 .00070450 .00078118 .00086897 .00096917 .00108308 .00121199 .00135721 .00152002 .00170172 1 Calculated at 18’percent of ultimate strength. S 3978. 4392. 4662. 4986. 5364. 5760. 6138. 6516. 6894. 7218. 7598. - Final modulus, lb/in2 9350000. 9350000. 9350000. 9350000. 9350000. 9350000. 9350000. 9350000. 9350000. 9350000. 9350000. Initial modulus, lb/in2 6094514. 6230875. 6356725. 6469544. 6566978. 6647001. 6708064. 6749205. 6770117. 6771136. 6753185. 6717665. 6666327. 6601128. 6524109. 6437290. 6342586. 6241760. 6136388. 6027851. 5917333. 5805834. APPENDIX 459 C Table C-2.-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (US. customary&-Continued Size, AWG or kcmil Code word CONDOR CANARY CARDINAL CURLEW 795.0 900.0 954.0 1.033.5 1O-year creep’ .00046434 .00046390 .00046369 .00046347 5076. 5742. 6084. 6588. 9734000. 9734000. 9734000. 9734000. Stress, lb/in’ Permanent set 1000. 2000. 3000. 4000. 5000. 6000. 7000. 8000. 9000. 10000. 11000. 12000. 13000. .00005753 .00010350 .00014543 .00018402 .00021994 .00025388 .00028652 .00031856 .00035066 .00038352 .00041782 .00045425 .00049348 .00053621 .00058311 .00063487 .00069218 .00075571 .00082615 .00090420 .00099052 .00108580 .00119074 .00130600 .00143228 .00157026 14000. 15000. 16000. 17000. 18000. 19000. 20000. 21000. 22000. 23000. 24000. 25000. 26000. Calculatedat percentofultimate strength. Final modulus, lb/in2 Tension’, lb 1 Initial modulus, lb/in2 6725040. 6818757. 6904585. 6981488. 7048526. 7104893. 7149946. 7183242. 7204543. 7213835. 7211311. 7197364. 7172554. 7137584. 7093261. 7040465. 6980111. 6913128. 6840425. 6762878. 6681315. 6596501. 6509140. 6419866. 6329243. , 460 TRANSMISSION LINE DESIGN MANUAL Table C-2.-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (U.S. customary&Continued 1000. 2000. 3000. 4000. 5000. 6000. 7000. 8000. 9000. 10000. 11000. 12000. 13000. 14000. 15000. 16000. 17000. 18000. 19000. 20000. 21000. 22000. 23000. 24000. 25000. 26000. 27000. .00002892 .00006013 .0000894 1 .00011729 .00014431 .00017099 .00019788 .00022551 .00025441 .00028512 .00031817 .00035409 .00039342 .00043669 .00048444 .00053719 .00059549 .00065987 .00073086 .00080900 .00089482 .00098885 .00109163 .00120369 .00132557 .00145779 .00160090 ’ Calculated at 18 percent of ultimate strength. 7685036. 7742948. 7790922. 7828437. 7855119. 7870755. 7875301. 7868880. 7851773. 7824407. 7787332. 7741200. 7686737. 7624723. 7555962. 7481264. 7401427. 7317221. 7229375. 7138573. 7045445. 6950565. 6854451. 6757566. 6660319. 6563070. APPENDIX 461 C Table C-2.-Permanent set, creep, and initial and final modulus values (U.S. customary&Continued 1000. 2000. 3000. 4000. 5000. 6000. 7000. 8000. 9000. 10000. 11000. 12000. 13000. 14000. 15000. 16000. 17000. 18000. 19000. 20000. 21000. 22000. 23000. 24000. 0.00000000 .00003350 .00006531 .00009538 .00012455 .00015366 .00018356 .00021507 .00024904 .00028631 .00032772 .00037411 .00042632 .00048519 .00055156 .00062627 .00071016 .00080407 .00090885 .00102532 .00115433 .00129672 .00145333 .00162500 Calculated at 18 percent of ultimate strength. 7267970. 7337414. 7392798. 7433244. 7458197. 7467449. 7461150. 7439784. 7404137. 7355238. 7294302. 7222659. 7141699. 7052811. 6957345. 6856575. 6751677. 6643716. 6533641. 6422281. 6310355. 6198473. 6087152. Table C-3.-Conductor Code word TURKEY SWAN SWANATE SPARROW SPARATE ROBIN RAVEN QUAIL PIGEON PENGU I N GROUSE PETREL M I NORCA LEGHORN GUINEA DOTTEREL DORK I NG COCH I N OWL WAXWI NG PARTR I DGE OSTR I CH MERLIN LINNET ORIOLE CH I CKADEE BRANT IBIS Size, mm2 13.28 21.13 21..13 33 864 33.64 42.41 53.46 67.44 85.02 107.22 40.54 51.58 56.14 68.20 80.57 89.64 96.68 107.07 135.19 135.19 135.19 152.01 170.45 170.45 170.45 201.41 201.41 201.41 ’ Does not include NEW constant. Stranding! Xameter, hminum, mm steel 6/ 6/ 7/ 6/ 7/ 6/ 6/ 6/ 6/ 6/ 8/ 12/ 12/ 12/ 12/ 12/ 12/ 12/ 6/ 18/ 26/ 26/ 18/ 26/ 30/ 18/ 24/ 26/ 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 1 7 7 1 7 7 1 7 7 5.03 6.35 6.53 8.03 8.26 9.02 10.11 11.35 12.75 14.30 9.32 11.71 12.22 13.46 14.63 15.42 16.03 16.84 16.08 15.47 16.31 17.27 17.37 18.31 18.82 18.87 19.61 19.89 and overhead ground wire data (metric) Area, mm2 15.5 24.7 26.5 39.2 42.1 49.5 62.4 78.6 99.2 125.1 54.6 81.7 88.9 108.0 127.5 141.9 153.1 169.5 152.8 142.6 157.2 176.8 179.9 198.2 210.3 212.6 227.5 234.2 Ultimate strength, N 5293 4715 10497 12677 16191 15791 19483 23619 29447 37142 23130 46261 50264 60495 71171 76953 83181 126328 43058 30603 50264 56492 38610 62719 76953 44215 64943 72505 Coeff. of linear expansion, per “C .0000189 .0000189 .0000176 .0000189 .0000176 .0000189 .0000189 .0000189 .0000189 .0000189 .0000153 .0000153 .0000153 .0000153 .0000153 .0000153 .0000153 .0000153 .0000194 .0000211 .0000189 .0000189 .0000211 .0000189 .0000178 .0000211 .0000194 .0000189 Force, N/m .5268 .8377 .9778 1.3324 1.5572 1.6812 2.1190 2.6721 3.3697 4.2483 2.1745 3.7083 4.0367 4.9036 5.7909 6.4417 6.9511 7.6983 4.9970 4.2235 5.3603 6.0229 5.3312 6.7570 7.6924 6.2987 7.4735 7.9814 I. 192-kPa Resultant, force’ , wind, N/m N/m .963 1.216 1.250 1.537 1.581 1.727 1.936 2.174 2.442 2.739 1.785 2.243 2.340 2.578 2.802 2.953 3.070 3.225 3.079 2.963 3.123 3.308 3.327 3.507 3.605 3.614 3.755 3.809 1.0979 1.4767 1.5872 2.0343 2.2191 2.4102 2.8703 3.4451 4.1616 5.0546 2.8135 4.3337 4.6658 5.5401 6.4332 7.0863 7.5987 8.3466 5.8696 5.1589 6.2038 6.8715 6.2843 7.6131 8.4951 7.2621 8.3641 8.8437 Table C-3 .-Conductor Code word LARK PEL I CAN FLICKER HAWK HEN OSPREY PARAKEET DO.VE EAGLE PEACOCK SQUAB TEAL KINGBIRD ROOK GROSBEAK EGRET SWIFT FLAMINGO STARLING REDW I NG CUCKOO DRAKE MALLARD COOT TERN CONDOR RUDDY Size, mm2 201.41 241.70 241.70 241.70 241.70 281.98 281.98 281.98 281.98 306.55 306.55 306.55 322.26 322.26 322.26 322.26 322.26 331.33 337.46 362.54 362.54 402.83 402.83 402.83 402.83 402.83 402.83 456.03 l Does not include NESC constant. Stranding! luminum, steel Diameter, mm 30/ 7 18/ 1 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/ 7 18/ 1 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/ 7 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/19 18/ 1 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/19 36/ 1 18/ 3 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/19 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/19 36/ 1 45/ 7 54/ 7 45/ 7 20.47 20.68 21.49 21.79 22.43 22.33 23.22 23.55 24.21 24.21 24.54 25.25 23.88 24.82 25.15 25.88 23.62 24.21 25.40 26.70 27.46 27.74 28.14 28.96 26.42 27.00 27.76 28.73 and .overhead ground wire data (metric&Continued Area, mm2 248.4 255.1 273.0 281.0 298.1 297.7 318.6 327.9 347.8 346.3 356.5 376.5 340.1 364.1 374.8 395.7 331.2 343.3 381.5 421.6 445.2 455.0 468.5 494.7 413.9 430.7 455.0 487.4 Ultimate strength, N 90298 52488 76509 86739 105867 60940 88074 100529 123659 96081 108091 133446 69836 97860 112094 140118 61385 65833 105422 126328 153907 124104 14011.8 170810 74729 98305 125439 108536 Coeff. of linear expansion, per “C .0000178 .0000211 .0000194 .0000189 .0000178 .0000211 .0000194 .0000189 .0000178 .0000194 .0000189 .0000207 .0000211 .0000194 .0000189 .0000207 .0000220 .0000218 .0000194 .0000189 .0000207 .0000194 .0000189 .0000207 .0000220 .0000207 .0000193 .0000207 Force, N/m 9.0891 7.5596 8.9680 9.5882 10.9016 8.8147 10.4638 11.1789 12.7259 11.3832 12.1567 13.7183 10.0844 11.9524 12.7697 14.4188 9.3941 9.8684 12.5362 14.3750 16.2138 14.9442 15.9657 18.0235 11.7437 13.0761 14.9442 14.8128 3.192-kPa wind, N/m 3.921 3.960 4.115 4.174 4.295 4.276 4.446 4.510 4.636 4.636 4.699 4.835 4.573 4.753 4.816 4.957 4.524 4.636 4.865 5.113 5.259 5.312 5.390 5.546 5.059 5.171 5.317 5.502 Resultant force’ , N/m 9.8987 8.5339 9.8672 10.4573 11.7174 9.7971 11.3693 12.0542 13.5440 12.2911 13.0334 14.5455 11.0727 12.8627 13.6476 15.2471 10.4267 10.9031 13.4469 15.2571 17.0453 15.8602 16.8510 18.8574 12.7871 14.0615 15.8619 15.8016 Table C-3.-Conductor Code word CANARY CATB I RD RAIL CARDINAL ORTOLAN CURLEW BLUEJAY FINCH BUNT I NG GRACKLE BITTERN PHEASANT D I PPER MART I N BOBOLINK PLOVER NUTHATCH PARROT LAPW I NG FALCON CHUKAR BLUEBIRD KIWI THRASHER JOREE Size, mm* 456.03 483.39 483.39 483.39 523.67 523.67 563.96 563.96 604.24 604.24 644.52 644.52 684.81 684.81 725.09 725.09 765.37 765.37 805.65 805.65 901.93 .030.63 .092.45 .098.02 .165.41 .171.49 274.35 552.53 ’ Does not include NESC constant. Stranding ’ 1Xameter, Juminum I mm steel 541 7 361 1 451 7 541 7 451 7 541 7 451 7 54/19 451 7 54/19 451 7 54/19 451 7 54/19 451 7 54/19 451 7 54/19 451 7 54/19 84/19 72/ 7 84/19 721 7 96/19 76/19 76/19 84/19 29.51 28.96 29.59 30.38 30.81 31.65 31.98 32.84 33.07 33.99 34.16 35.10 35.20 36.17 36.25 37.21 37.24 38.25 38.15 39.24 40.69 42.70 44.75 44.12 47.17 45.77 47.75 53.37 and overhead ground wire data (metric&Continued Area, mm* 515.2 496.9 516.8 546.1 559.9 591.5 603.0 635.4 645.8 680.6 689.0 726.5 732.3 771.6 775.5 816.8 818.1 862.6 861.3 907.7 975.5 1075.4 1181.3 1145.8 1313.5 1235.1 1343.6 1679.2 Ultimate strength, N 141897 88074 115208 150349 123215 162804 132556 173924 142342 186379 151683 193941 161024 20595 1 170366 218406 178372 229971 187714 242426 226858 208175 268226 221520 355856 252212 274453 381210 Coeff. of linear expansion, per “C .0000193 .0000220 .0000207 .0000193 .0000207 .0000193 .0000207 .0000194 .0000207 .0000194 .0000207 .0000194 .0000207 .0000194 .0000207 .0000194 .0000207 .0000194 .0000207 .0000194 .0000207 .0000216 .0000207 .0000216 .0000194 .0000211 .0000211 .0000207 Force, N/m 16.9143 14.0977 15.6884 17.9359 17.0019 19.4245 18.3153 20.8839 19.6142 22.3724 20.9277 23.8610 22.2119 25.3496 23.5400 26.8528 24.8388 28.3414 26.1523 29.8299 30.2677 31.5520 36.6453 33.6098 43.3147 36.8642 40.1186 52.1002 0.192-kPa wind, N/m Resultant force’ , 5.653 5.546 5.667 5.818 5.901 6.061 6.125 6.290 6.334 6.509 6.543 6.723 6.742 6.927 6.942 7.127 7.132 7.326 7.307 7.516 7.793 8.177 8.571 8.450 9.034 8.766 9.146 10.221 17.8339 15.1493 16.6807 18.8560 17.9968 20.3482 19.3122 21.8105 20.6115 23.3000 21.9266 24.7900 23.2127 26.2791 24.5422 27.7824 25.8423 29.2729 27.1538 30.7622 31.2549 32.5945 37.6344 34.6557 44.2467 37.8921 41.1478 53.0933 N/m Table C-3.-Conductor and overhead ground wire data (metric)-Continued Diameter, mm Wire type and size STEEL 3.525 3.525 II.113 II.113 12.7 12.7 HIGH EXTRA HIGH HIGH EXTRA HIGH HIGH EXTRA HIGH mm mm mm mm mm mm STRENGTH STRENGTH STRENGTH STRENGTH STRENGTH STRENGTH 9.14 9.14 11.05 11.05 12.57 12.57 Area, mm2 Ultimate strength, N Coeff. of linear expansion, per “C Force, N/m 0.192~kpa wind, N/m Resultant force’ , N/m STRAND OVERHEAD GROUND WIRE (7-WIRE) 51.1 51.1 74.6 74.6 96.6 96.6 48040 68502 64498 92522 83626 119656 .0000115 .0000115 .0000115 .0000115 .0000115 .0000115 3.9841 3.9841 5.8230 5.8230 7.5450 7.5450 ALUMOWELD STRAND OVERHEAD GROUND WIRE 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 8M 10M 12.5M 14M 16M 18M 20M 25M NO. 12 NO. 11 NO. 10 NO. 9 NO. 8 NO. 7 NO. 6 NO. 5 AWG AWG AWG AWG AWG AWG AWG AWG ’ Does not include NESC constant. 6.91 7.77 8.71 9.22 9.80 10.59 11.28 13.18 6.15 6.91 7.77 8.71 9.78 11 .oo 12.34 13.87 29.4 36.9 46.1 51.9 58.1 68.5 77.7 106.1 23.2 29.2 36.8 46.5 58.6 73.9 93.1 117.4 35585 44482 55602 62274 71171 80067 88964 111205 28028 35340 44570 56180 70859 84782 101107 120234 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 .0000130 1.9118 2.4080 3.0355 3.3858 3.8236 4.4657 5.0641 6.9321 1.5119 1.9060 2.4036 3.0297 3.8207 4.8160 6.0754 7.6603 1.323 1.489 1.669 1.766 1.878 2.029 2.160 2.525 1.177 1.323 1.489 1.669 1.873 2.106 2.364 2.656 2.3250 2.8310 3.4639 3.8186 4.2598 4.9049 5.5055 7.3776 1.9162 2.3202 2.8272 3.4588 4.2550 5.2565 6.5192 8.1077 Table C-4.-Conductor Code word ‘URKEY iWAN ;WANATE iPARROW ;PARATE lOBIN !AVEN !UAlL ’ I GEON ‘ENGU I N iROUSE ‘ETREL I I NORCA .EGHORN iU I NEA IOTTEREL lORK I NG :OCHI N IWL ‘AXW I NG ‘ARTR I DGE lSTR I CH IERLIN I NNET #RlOLE HICKADEE RANT BIS Size, AWG or kcmil 6 4 4 2 2 1 l/O 2/o 3/o 4/o 80.0 101.8 110.8 134.6 159.0 176.9 190.8 211.3 266.8 266.8 266.8 300.0 336.4 336.4 336.4 397.5 397.5 397.5 Does not include NESC constant. Stranding duminum steel 6/ 6/ 7/ 6/ 7/ 6/ 6/ 6/ 6/ 6/ 8/ 12/ 12/ 12/ 12/ 12/ 12/ 12/ 6/ 18/ 26/ 26/ 18/ 26/ 30/ 18/ 24/ 26/ 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 1 7 7 1 7 7 1 7 7 Diameter: in 198 : 250 .257 .316 .325 .355 .398 .447 .502 .563 .367 .461 .481 .530 .576 .607 .631 .663 .633 .609 .642 .680 .684 .721 .741 .743 .772 .783 and overhead ground wire data (U.S. customary) Area, in2 .0240 .0383 .0411 .0608 .0653 .0767 .0967 .1219 .1538 .1939 .0847 .1266 .1378 .1674 1977 : 2200 .2373 .2628 .2368 .2211 .2436 .2740 .2789 .3072 .3259 .3295 .3527 .3630 Ultimate strength, lb Coeff. of linear expansion, per OF Weight, lb/ft 4-lb/ft2 wind, lb/ft Resultant weight,’ lb/ft 1,190 1,860 2,360 2,850 3,640 3,550 4,380 5,310 6,620 8,350 5,200 10,400 11,300 13,600 16,000 17,300 18,700 28,400 9,680 6,880 11,300 12,700 8,680 14,100 17,300 9,940 14,600 16,300 .0000105 .0000105 .0000098 .0000105 .0000098 .0000105 .0000105 .0000105 .0000105 .0000105 .0000085 .0000085 .0000085 .0000085 .0000085 .0000085 .0000085 .0000085 .0000108 .0000117 .0000105 .0000105 .0000117 .0000105 .0000099 .0000117 .0000108 .0000105 .03610 .05740 .06700 .09130 10670 : 11520 .14520 18310 : 23090 .29110 14900 : 25410 .27660 .33600 .39680 .44140 .47630 .52750 .34240 .28940 .36730 .41270 .36530 .46300 .52710 .43160 .51210 .54690 .06600 .08333 .08567 .10533 .10833 .11833 .13267 .14900 .16733 18767 : 12233 .15367 .16033 .17667 19200 : 20233 .21033 .22100 .21100 .20300 21400 : 22667 .22800 .24033 .24700 .24767 .25733 .26100 .07523 .10119 .10876 .13939 .15206 .16515 19668 : 23606 .28516 .34635 19279 : 29695 .31971 .37961 .44081 .48556 .52067 .57192 .40219 .35350 .42509 .47085 .43061 .52166 .58210 .49761 .57312 .60599 Table C-4.-Conductor Code word LARK PEL I CAN FLICKER HAWK HEN OSPREY PARAKEET DOVE EAGLE PEACOCK SQUAB TEAL KINGBIRD ROOK GROSBEAK EGRET SWIFT FLAMINGO STARLING REDW I NG CUCKOO DRAKE MALLARD COOT TERN CONDOR RUDDY Size, AWG or kcmil 397.5 477.0 477.0 477.0 477.0 556.5 556.5 556.5 556.5 605.0 605.0 605.0 636.0 636.0 636.0 636.0 636.0 653.9 666.0 715.5 715.5 795.0 795.0 795.0 795.0 795.0 795.0 900.0 ’ Does not include NESC constant. Stranding .luminum steel 30/ 7 18/ 1 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/ 7 18/ 1 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/ 7 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/19 18/ 1 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/19 36/ 1 18/ 3 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/19 24/ 7 26/ 7 30/19 36/ 1 45/ 7 54/ 7 45/ 7 and overhead ground wire data (U.S. customary&Continued Diameter , in Area, in2 .806 .3850 .3954 .4232 .4356 .4620 .814 .846 .858 .883 .879 .914 .927 .953 .953 .966 .994 .940 .977 .990 1.019 .930 .953 1 .ooo 1.051 1.081 1.092 1.108 1.140 1.040 1.063 1.093 1.131 .4614 .4938 .5083 .5391 .5368 .5526 .5835 .5272 .5643 .5809 .6134 .5133 .5321 .5914 .6535 .6901 .7053 7261 : 7668 .6416 .6676 .7053 .7555 Ultimate strength, lb 20,300 11,800 17,200 19,500 23,800 13,700 19,800 22,600 27,800 21,600 24,300 30,000 15,700 22 ) 000 25,200 31,500 13,800 14,800 23,700 28,400 34,600 27,900 31,500 38,400 16,800 22) 100 28,200 24,400 Coeff. of linear expansion, per OF .0000099 .0000117 .0000108 .0000105 .0000099 .0000117 .0000108 .0000105 .0000099 .0000108 .0000105 .0000115 .0000117 .0000108 .0000105 .0000115 .0000122 .0000121 .0000108 .0000105 .0000115 .0000108 .0000105 .0000115 .0000122 .0000115 .0000107 .0000115 Weight, lb/ft .62280 .51800 .61450 .65700 74700 : 60400 .71700 76600 : 87200 .78000 .83300 .94000 .69100 .81900 .87500 .98800 .64370 .67620 .85900 .98500 1.11100 1.02400 1.09400 1.23500 .80470 .89600 1.02400 1.01500 4-lb/ft2 wind, Ib/ft Resultant weight,’ Ib/ft .26867 .27133 .28200 .28600 .29433 .29300 .30467 .30900 .31767 .31767 .32200 .33133 .31333 .32567 .33000 .33967 .31000 .31767 .33333 .35033 .36033 .36400 .36933 .38000 .34667 .35433 .36433 .37700 .67828 .58476 .67612 .71655 .80290 .67132 .77904 .82598 .92806 .84221 .89307 .99669 .75872 .88137 .93516 1.04476 71446 : 74710 .92141 1.04545 1.16797 1.08677 1.15466 1.29214 .87620 .96352 1.08688 1.08275 Table @I.-Conductor Code word CANARY CATB I RD RAIL CARDINAL ORTOLAN CURLEW BLUE JAY FINCH BUNT I NG GRACKLE B I TTERN PHEASANT D I PPER MART I N BOBOLINK PLOVER NUTHATCH PARROT LAPW I NG FALCON CHUKAR BLUEBIRD KIWI THRASHER JOREE Size, AWG or kcmil 900.0 954.0 954.0 954.0 1,033.5 1,033.5 1,113.0 1,113.0 1,192.5 1,192.5 1,272.0 1,272.0 1,351.5 1,351.5 1,431.0 1,431.0 1,510.5 1,510.5 1,590.o 1,590.o 1,780.O 2,034.o 2,156.0 2,167.O 2,300.O 2,312.0 2,515.0 3,064.O ’ Does not include NESC constant. Stranding .luminum, steel 54/ 7 36/ 1 45/ 7 54/ 7 45/ 7 54/ 7 45/ 7 54/19 45/ 7 54/19 45/ 7 54/19 45/ 7 54/19 45/ 7 54/19 45/ 7 54119 45/ 7 54/19 84/19 721 7 84/19 72/ 7 96/19 76119 76/19 84/19 and overhead ground wire data (U.S. customary&Continued Diameter. in 1.162 1.140 1.165 1.196 1.213 1.246 1.259 1.293 1.302 1.338 1.345 1.382 1.386 1.424 1.427 1.465 1.466 1.506 1.502 1.545 1.602 1.681 1.762 1.737 1.857 1.802 1.880 2.101 Area, in2 7985 : 7702 .8011 .8464 .8678 .9169 .9346 .9849 1 .OOlO 1.0550 1.0680 1.1260 1.1350 1.1960 1.2020 1.2660 1.2680 1.3370 1.3350 1.4070 1.5120 1.6669 1.8310 1.7760 2.0359 1.9144 2.0826 2.6028 Ultimate strength, lb Coeff. of linear expansion, per OF 31,900 19,800 25,900 33,800 27,700 36,600 29,800 39,100 32,000 41,900 34,100 43,600 36,200 46,300 38,300 49,100 40,100 51,700 42,200 54,500 51,000 46,800 60,300 49,800 80,000 56,700 61,700 85,700 .0000107 .0000122 .0000115 .0000107 .0000115 .0000107 .0000115 .0000108 .0000115 .0000108 .0000115 .0000108 .0000115 .0000108 .0000115 .0000108 .0000115 .0000108 .0000115 .0000108 .0000115 .0000120 .0000115 .0000120 .0000108 .0000117 .0000117 .0000115 Weight, lb/ft 4-lb/ft2 wind, lb/ft Resultant weight,’ lb/ft 1.15900 .96600 1.07500 1.22900 1.16500 1.33100 1.25500 1.43100 1.34400 1.53300 1.43400 1.63500 1.52200 1.73700 1.61300 1.84000 1.70200 1.94200 1.79200 2.04400 2.07400 2.16200 2.51100 2.30300 2.96800 2.52600 2.74900 3.57000 .38733 .38000 .38833 .39867 .40433 .41533 .41967 .43100 .43400 .44600 .44833 .46067 .46200 .47467 .47567 148833 .48867 .50200 .50067 .51500 .53400 .56033 .58733 .57900 .61900 .60067 .62667 .70033 1.22201 1.03805 1.14299 1.29204 1.23317 1.39430 1.32331 1.49450 1.41234 1.59656 1.50245 1.69866 1.59057 1.80069 1.68167 1.90370 1.77076 2.00583 1.86063 2.10788 2.14164 2.23343 2.57878 2.37467 3.03186 2.59644 2.81952 3.63804 Table C-4.-Conductor Wire type and size and overhead ground wire data (U.S. customary&Continued Diameter, in Area, in2 Ultimate strength, lb Coeff. of linear expansion, per OF I Weight, lb/ft 4-lb/ft2 wind, lb/ft Resultant weight ,l lb/ft STEEL STRAND OVERHEAD GROUND WIRE (7 WIRE) 3/8 3/8 7/16 7/16 l/2 i/2 HIGH STRENGTH INCH INCH EXTRA HIGH STRENGTH INCH HIGH STRENGTH INCH EXTRA HIGH STRENGTH INCH HIGH STRENGTH INCH EXTRA HIGH STRENGTH .360 .360 .435 .435 .495 .495 .0792 .0792 .1156 .1156 1497 :1497 10,800 15,400 14,500 20,800 18,800 26.900 .0000064 .0000064 .0000064 .0000064 .0000064 .0000064 ALUMOWELD STRAND OVERHEAD GROUND WIRE 8M 10M 12.5M 14M 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 16M 18M 20M 25M NO. 12 NO. 11 NO. 10 NO. 9 NO. 8 NO. 7 NO. 6 NO. 5 AWG AWG AWG AWG AWG AWG AWG AWG * Does not include NESC constant. .272 .306 .343 .363 .386 .417 .444 .519 .242 .272 .306 .343 .385 .433 .486 .546 .0455 .0572 .0714 .oco5 .0901 .1062 .1204 1645 : 0359 .0453 .0571 .0720 .0908 .1145 .1443 .1820 8,000 10,000 12,500 14,000 16,000 18,000 20,000 25,000 6,301 7,945 10,020 12,630 15,930 19,060 22,730 27.030 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .0000072 .27300 .27300 .39900 .39900 .51700 .51700 .12000 .12000 .14500 .14500 .16500 .16500 .29821 .29821 .42453 .42453 .54269 .54269 .13100 16500 :20800 .23200 .26200 .30600 .34700 .47500 .10360 .13060 16470 :20760 .26180 .33000 .41630 .52490 .09067 .10200 .11433 .12100 .12867 .13900 .14800 .17300 .08067 .09067 .10200 .11433 .12833 .14433 .16200 .18200 .15932 19398 :23735 .26166 .29189 .33609 .37724 .50552 .13130 .15899 19373 :23700 .29156 .36018 .44671 .55556 Table C-5.-Conductor and overhead ground wire values for NESC light, medium, and heavy loading (metric) Code word TURKEY SWAN SWANATE SPARROW SPARATE ROBIN RAVEN QUAIL PIGEON PENGU I N GROUSE PETREL M I NORCA LEGHORN GUINEA DOTTEREL DORK I NG COCH I N OWL WAXW I NG PARTR I DGE OSTR I CH MERLIN L I NNET ORIOLE CH I CKADEE BRANT IBIS F NATIONAL LIGHT Force with no ice .5268 .8377 .9778 1.3324 1.5572 1.6812 2.1190 2.6721 3.3697 4.2483 2.1745 3.7083 4.0367 4.9036 5.7909 6.4417 6.9511 7.6983 4.9970 4.2235 5.3603 6.0229 5.3312 6.7570 7.6924 6.2987 7.4735 7.9814 ’ Includes 0.7297 NESC constant. * Includes 2.9188 NESC constant. 3 Includes 4.3782 NESC constant. ELECTRICAL SAFETY T LOADING MEDIUM 0.43 1-kPa Resultant wind force’ 7orce with 6.35-mm ice 2.1672 2.7364 2.8130 3.4588 3.5573 3.8856 4.3563 4.8926 5.4946 6.1623 4.0170 5.0458 5.2647 5.8011 6.3046 6.6439 6.9066 7.2568 6.9285 6.6658 7.0270 7.4429 7.4867 7.8917 8.1106 8.1325 8.4499 8.5703 2.5602 3.1070 3.2789 3.9013 4.1669 4.4271 5.0601 5.8356 6.7828 7.9382 4.9749 6.9353 7.3545 8.4437 9.5398 10.3314 10.9497 11.8421 9.0046 8.1222 9.4089 10.2439 9.5703 2.9600 3.5914 3.7078 4.4362 4.6129 4.9634 5.5740 6.3045 7.1753 8.2144 5.2975 6.9916 7.3639 8.3256 9.2902 9.9837 10.5286 11.3092 9.2721 8.6208 9.5678 10.3042 9.9205 11.1189 11.9080 11.0161 12.0104 12.4409 11.1641 12.1903 10.8057 12.1121 12.6699 CODE T LOADING 0.192-kPa wind 3.3955 3.6485 3.6825 3.9695 4.0133 4.1593 4.3684 4.6068 4.8744 5.1711 4.2176 4.6749 4.7722 5.0106 5.2343 5.3851 5.5019 5.6576 5.5116 5.3949 5.5554 5.7403 5.7597 5.9397 ‘6.0370 6.0467 6.1878 6.2413 1977 Resultant force2 7.1713 7.7110 7.8495 8.4845 8.7041 8.9932 9.6037 10.3536 11.2714 12.3928 9.4409 11.2826 11.6859 12.7373 13.8003 14.5694 15.1730 16.0430 13.4763 12.6694 13.8453 14.6614 14.0886 15.5646 16.5220 15.3012 16.5199 17.0425 ALL VALUES 1 EDITION HEAVY Force witk 12.7-mm ice 6.8629 7.6457 7.8494 8.7396 9.0460 9.4424 10.2705 11.2684 12.4653 13.8976 10.0446 12.4317 12.9416 14.2533 15.5581 16.4904 17.2176 18.2553 15.2817 14.2903 15.7267 16.7342 16.0788 17.8405 18.9575 17.5819 19.0200 19.6277 LOADING 0.192~kPa wind 5.8278 6.0808 6.1148 6.4019 6.4456 6.5916 6.8008 7.0391 7.3067 7.6034 6.6500 7.1072 7.2045 7.4429 7.6667 7.8175 7.9342 8.0899 7.9439 7.8272 7.9877 8.1726 8.1920 8.3720 8.4693 8.4791 8.6201 8.6736 Resultant force3 13.3816 14.1472 14.3283 15.2116 15.4857 15.8937 16.6962 17.6645 18.8271 20.2197 16.4246 18.6981 19.1900 20.4577 21.7227 22.6278 23.3360 24.3457 21.6013 20.6717 22.0172 23.0014 22.4236 24.0854 25.1415 23.8979 25.2604 25.8370 ARE IN NEWTONS PER METER. Table C-S.-Conductor and overhead ground wire values for NESC light, medium, and heavy loading (metric&Continued NATIONAL Code word -LARK PEL I CAN FLICKER HAWK HEN OSPREY PARAKEET DOVE EAGLE PEACOCK SQUAB TEAL KINGBIRD ROOK GROSBEAK EGRET SWIFT FLAM I NGO STARLING REDWING CUCKOO DRAKE MALLARD COOT TERN CONDOR RUDDY L I GHT ELECTRICAL SAFETY T LOADING MEDIUM T LOADING 9.0891 7.5596 8.9680 9.5882 10.9016 8.8147 10.4638 11.1789 12.7259 11.3832 12.1567 13.7183 10.0844 11.9524 12.7697 14.4188 9.3941 9.8684 12.5362 14.3750 16.2138 14.9442 15.9657 18.0235 11.7437 13.0761 14.9442 14.8128 1 Includes 0.7297 NESC constant. ’ Includes 2.9188 NESC constant. 3 Includes 4.3782 NESC constant. 0.43 1-kPa wind 8.8220 8.9096 9.2598 9.3912 9.6648 9.6210 10.0041 10.1464 10.4310 10.4310 LO. 5733 LO.8798 LO.2887 LO.6937 10.8360 11.1534 LO. 1792 10.4310 10.9454 11.5036 11.8320 11.9524 12.1275 12.4778 11.3832 11.6350 11.9633 12.3793 Resultant force’ 13.3962 12.4142 13.6203 14.1509 15.2986 13.7782 15.2064 15.8266 17.1843 16.1694 16.8412 18.2385 15.1364 16.7676 17.4773 18.9588 14.5813 15.0890 17.3717 19.1409 20.8017 19.8657 20.7792 22.6509 17.0849 18.2328 19.8726 20.0342 1by; . ;Nll - ice 13.8820 12.3888 13.9424 14.6171 16.0440 13.9389 15.7469 16.5210 18.1859 16.8433 17.6758 19.3644 15.4854 17.5214 18.3977 20.1784 14.7498 15.3285 18.2095 20.2798 22.2548 21.0351 22.1293 24.3323 17.5986 19.0355 21.0396 21.0808 0.192-kPa wind Resultant force2 6.3532 6.3921 6.5478 6.6062 6.7278 6.7083 6.8786 6.9418 7.0683 7.0683 7.1316 7.2678 .7.0051 7.1851 7.2483 7.3894 6.9564 7.0683 7.2970 7.5450 7.6910 7.7445 7.8223 7.9780 7.4915 7.6034 7.7494 7.9342 18.185516.8594 18.3221 18.9594 20.3163 18.3879 20.1025 20.8389 22.4300 21.1851 21.9790 23.6021 19.9150 21.8562 22.6928 24.4076 19.2267 19.7984 22.5359 24.5567 26.4651 25.3342 26.3899 28.5256 22.0456 23.4166 25.3402 25.4432 ALLVALUES EDITION HEAVY L L Force with no ice 1977 CODE I Torte LOADING with 12.7-mm ice 0.192~kPa Resultant force3 wind 20.9442 19.4874 21.1861 21.9153 23.4557 21.3325 23.2993 24.1324 25.9154 24.5727 25.4642 27.2799 23.1558 25.3597 26.2950 28.2074 22.3748 23.0579 26.1523 28.4540 30.5652 29.3954 30.5622 32.9104 25.7229 27.2641 29.4045 29.6181 8.7855 8.8244 8.9801 9.0385 9.1601 9.1406 9.3109 9.3741 9.5006 9.5006 9.5639 9.7001 9.4374 9.6174 9.6806 9.8217 9.3887 9.5006 9.7293 9.9774 10.1233 10.1768 10.2546 10.4103 9.9239 10.0357 10.1817 10.3665 ARE IN 27.0904 25.7704 27.3889 28.0842 29.5591 27.5865 29.4690 30.2673 31.9801 30.7236 31.5791 33.3313 29.3833 31.5003 32.3985 34.2466 28.6429 29.3166 32.2816 34.5308 36.5762 35.4853 36.6149 38.8958 31.9490 33.4307 35.4955 35.7580 D : 2 0 x 0 E7NTONS PER METER. 2 Table C-5.-Conductor and overhead ground wire values for NESC light, medium, and heavy loading (met&)-Continued NATIONAL Code word CANARY CATB I RD RAIL CARDINAL ORTOLAN CURLEW BLUEJAY FINCH BUNT I NG GRACKLE B I TTERN PHEASANT D I PPER MART I N BOBOL I NK PLOVER NUTHATCH PARROT LAPW I NG FALCON CHUKAR BLUEBIRD KIWI THRASHER JOREE LIGHT Force with no ice 16.9143 14.0977 15.6884 17.9359 17.9019 19.4245 18.3153 20.8839 19.6142 22.3724 20.9277 23.8610 22.2119 25.3496 23.5400 26.8528 24.8388 28.3414 26.1523 29.8299 30.2677 31.5520 36.6453 33.6098 13.3147 36.8642 10.1186 52.1002 ’ Includes 0.7297 NESC constant. ’ Includes 2.9188 NESC constant. 3 Includes 4.3782 NESC constant. SAFETY ELECTRICAL T LOADING MEDIUM CODE LOADING 0.43 1-kPa Resultant wind force’ Force with 6.35-mm ice 0.192-kPa wind 12.7186 12.4778 12.7514 13.0907 13.2768 13.6380 13.7803 14.1524 14.2509 14.6450 14.7216 15.1266 15.1704 15.5863 15.6191 16.0350 16.0460 16.4838 16.4400 16.9107 17.5346 18.3993 19.2858 19.0122 20.3257 19.7237 20.5774 22.9963 23.3230 20.4065 22.1107 24.4989 23.6420 26.2144 25.1642 27.8871 26.6583 29.5799 28.1669 31.2682 29.6372 32.9474 31.1514 34.6367 32.6272 36.3113 34.1041 37.9769 38.6734 40.3162 45.7772 42.6282 52.8777 46.1776 49.7861 62.7707 8.0850 7.9780 8.0996 8.2504 8.3331 8.4936 8.5569 8.7223 8.7661 8.9412 8.9752 9.1552 9.1747 9.3596 9.3741 9.5590 9.5639 9.7585 9.7390 9.9482 10.2255 10.6098 11.0038 10.8822 11.4659 11.1984 11.5778 12.6529 21.8923 19.5563 20.9467 22.9347 22.3014 24.4638 23.6502 25.9572 24.9744 27.4692 26.3166 28.9815 27.6278 30.4876 28.9801 32.0058 30.3006 33.5161 31.6201 35.0196 35.7097 37.2545 42.1401 39.3442 48.5763 42.5387 45.8178 57.6794 1 1977 T 1 EDITION HEAVY LOADING Resultant force2 Force with 12.7-mm ice 0.192-kPa wind Resultant force3 27.6034 24.8294 26.4663 28.7696 27.9864 30.4748 29.4981 32.1381 30.9813 33.8205 32.4811 35.4997 33.9436 37.1698 35.4500 38.8503 36.9188 40.5185 38.3862 42.1770 42.9212 44.6077 49.9999 46.9140 57.0254 50.4348 54.0333 66.9520 32.0010 28.9847 30.8023 33.3312 32.5515 35.2736 34.2825 37.1597 35.9717 39.0567 37.6755 40.9447 39.3319 42.8145 41.0321 44.6899 42.6850 46.5506 44.3252 48.3932 49.3485 51.3498 57.1784 53.9159 64.7101 57.7604 61.7229 75.7106 10.5173 10.4103 10.5319 10.6827 10.7654 10.9260 10.9892 11.1546 11.1984 11.3735 11.4076 11.5876 11.6070 11.7919 11.8065 11.9913 11.9962 12.1908 12.1713 12.3805 12.6578 13.0421 13.4361 13.3145 13.8983 13.6307 14.0101 15.0852 38.0631 35.1756 36.9313 39.3794 38.6636 41.3052 40.3789 43.1759 42.0526 45.0572 43.7428 46.9310 45.3870 48.7869 47.0751 50.6489 48.7168 52.4986 50.3441 54.3300 55.3241 57.3584 63.1140 59.9138 70.5640 63.7251 67.6711 81.5770 ALL VALUES ARE IN NEWTONS PER METER. Table C-5.-Conductor and overhead ground wire values for NESC light, medium, and heavy loading (metric)-Continued NATIONAL Wire type and size 0.43 l-kPa wind 3.9841 3.9841 mm HS mm EHS mm HS mm EHS mm HS mm EHS 5.8230 5.8230 7.5450 7.5450 3.9404 3.9404 4.7613 4.7613 5.4180 5.4180 Resultant force’ 1.9118 8M 12.5M 14M 16M 18M 20M 25M 7 NO. 7 NO. 7 NO. 7N0. 7N0. 7N0. 7N0. 7N0. 2.4080 3.0355 3.3858 3.8236 4.4657 5.0641 6.9321 1.5119 1.9060 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 / 2.4036 3.0297 3.8207 4.8160 6.0754 7.6603 1 Includes 0.7297 NESC constant. ’ Includes 2.9188 NESC constant. 3 Includes 4.3782 NESC constant. 2.9772 3.3493 3.7543 3.9732 4.2249 4.5642 4.8598 5.6807 2.6488 2.9772 3.3493 3.7543 4.2140 4.7394 5.3195 5.9762 FtT<zgh * ice STRAND 4.2678 4.8548 5.5576 5.9498 6.4279 7.1152 7.7484 9.6921 3.7796 4.2647 4.8522 5.5540 6.4179 7.4866 8.8048 .0.4454 GROUND OVERHEAD 4.2810 4.. 9315 5.7270 6.1680 6.7102 7.4930 8.2139 10.4224 3.7450 4.2752 4.9271 5.7211 6.7028 7.9159 9.4159 11.2731 EDITION HEAVY 0.192-kPa wind WIRE 4.3101 4.4609 4.5922 4.9571 3.6096 ~~.~~~” ice LOADING 0.192-kPa wind Resultant force3 (7-WIRE) 11.7907 11.7907 14.3103 14.3103 16.5771 16.5771 6.6159 6.6159 6.9807 6.9807 8.6136 9.2190 9.9626 10.3799 10.8940 11.6392 12.3293 14.4599 8.9196 9.7244 10.6878 11.2196 11.8662 12.7897 13.6332 16.1820 6.1878 6.3532 6.5332 6.6305 6.7424 6.8932 7.0245 7.3894 8.1201 8.6092 8.2474 GROUND 3.7555 3.9209 4.1009 4.1982 3.7555 3.9209 4.1009 4.3052 4.5387 4.7965 5.0884 Resultant force2 10.8625 10.8625 12.9422 12.9422 14.8693 14.8693 4.1836 4.1836 4.5484 4.5484 4.8403 4.8403 STRAND 1977 LOADING OVERHEAD 6.3332 6.3332 8.2514 8.2514 10.0185 10.0185 ALUMOWELD 10M CODE MEDIUM STEEL I.525 I.525 I.11 I.11 12.7 12.7 SAFETY LOADING LIGHT Force with no ice ELECTRICAL 7.2726 7.2726 17.8982 17.8982 20.3004 20.3004 22.4804 22.4804 WIRE 9.2156 9.9579 10.8851 12.0436 13.4860 15.2871 8.9137 9.7200 10.6819 11.8542 13.2852 15.0258 17.1553 6.0419 6.1878 6.3532 6.5332 6.7375 6.9710 7.2288 7.5207 15.2339 15.9940 16.9046 17.4105 18.0261 18.9072 19.7146 22.1675 14.6018 15.2291 15.9903 16.8996 18.0133 19.3812 21.0524 23.1096 ALL VALUES ARE IN NEWTONS PER METER. Table C-&-Conductor and overhead ground wire values for NESC light, medium, and heavy loading (U.S. customary) Code word TURKEY SWAN SWANATE SPARROW SPARATE ROBIN RAVEN QUAIL PIGEON PENGU I N GROUSE PETREL M I NORCA LEGHORN GUINEA OOTTEREL DORK I NG COW I N OWL WAXWI NG PARTR I DGE OSTR I CH MERLIN L I NNET ORIOLE CH I CKADEE BRANT IBIS F NAT LIGHT IONAL ELECTRICAL r LOADING SAFETY MEDIUM Weight with no ice 9-lb/ft2 wind Resultant weight’ Weight with l/4-in ice .0361 .0574 .0670 .0913 .1067 .1152 .1452 1831 : 2309 .2911 1490 : 2541 .2766 .3360 .3968 .4414 .4763 .5275 .3424 .2894 .3673 .4127 .3653 .4630 .5271 .4316 .5121 15469 .1485 .1875 1928 : 2370 .2438 .2663 .2985 .3353 .3765 .4223 .2753 .3458 .3608 .3975 .4320 .4553 .4733 .4973 .4748 .4568 .4815 .5100 .5130 .5408 .5558 .5573 .5790 .5873 .2028 .2461 .2541 .3040 .3161 .3401 .3819 14320 .4917 .5629 .3630 .4791 .5046 .5705 .6366 .6841 .7214 .7749 .6353 .5907 .6556 .7061 .6798 .7619 .8160 17548 .8230 .8525 1754 : 2129 .2247 .2673 .2855 .3034 .3467 .3999 .4648 .5439 .3409 .4752 .5039 .5786 .6537 .7079 .7503 .8114 .6170 .5565 .6447 .7019 .6558 .7650 .8353 .7404 .8299 .8682 1 Includes 0.05 NESC constant. ’ Includes 0.20 NESC constant. 3 Includes 0.30 NEW constant. 1977 CODE EDITION T- LOADING 4-lb/ft2 wind Resultant weight’ .2327 .2500 .2523 .2720 .2750 .2850 .2993 .3157 .3340 .3543 .2890 .3203 .3270 .3433 .3587 .3690 .3770 .3877 .3777 .3697 .3807 .3933 .3947 .4070 .4137 .4143 .4240 .4277 .4914 .5284 .5379 .5814 .5964 .6162 .6581 .7094 .7723 .8492 .6469 .7731 .8007 .8728 .9456 .9983 1.0397 1.0993 .9234 .8681 .9487 1.0046 .9654 1.0665 1.1321 1.0485 1.1320 1.1678 HEAVY Weight with l/2-in ice .4703 .5239 .5379 .5989 .6199 .6470 .7038 .7721 .8541 .9523 .6883 .8518 .8868 .9767 1.0661 1.1300 1.1798 1.2509 1.0471 .9792 1.0776 1.1467 1.1017 1.2225 1.2990 1.2047 1.3033 I 1.3449 ALL VALUES LOADING 4-lb/ft2 wind .3993 .4167 .4190 .4387 .4417 .4517 .4660 .4823 .5007 .5210 .4557 .4870 .4937 .5100 .5253 .5357 .5437 .5543 .5443 .5363 .5473 .5600 .5613 .5737 .5803 .5810 .5907 .5943 ARE IB POUNDS Resultant weight3 .9169 .9694 .9818 1.0423 1.0611 1.0891 1.1441 1.2104 1.2901 1.3855 1.1254 1.2812 1.3149 1.4018 1.4885 1.5505 1.5990 1.6682 1.4802 1.4165 1.5087 1.5761 1.5365 1.6504 1.7227 1.6375 1.7309 1.7704 ER FOOT Table C-k-Conductor and overhead ground wire values for NESC light, medium, and heavy loading (U.S. customary)-Continued Code word LARK PEL I CAN FLICKER HAWK HEN OSPREY PARAKEET DOVE EAGLE PEACOCK SQUAB TEAL KINGBIRD ROOK GROSBEAK EGRET SWIFT FLAMINGO STARLING REDWI NG CUCKOO DRAKE MALLARD COOT TERN CONDOR RUDDY F NATIONAL LIGHT Weight with no ice .6228 .5180 .6145 .6570 .7470 .6040 .7170 .7660 .8720 .7800 .8330 .9400 .6910 .8190 .8750 .9880 .6437 .6762 .8590 .9850 1.1110 1.0240 1.0940 1.2350 .8047 .8960 1.0240 1.0150 ’ Includes 0.05 NESC constant. * Includes 0.20 NESC constant. 3 Includes 0.30 NESC constant. ELECTRICAL T LOADING 9-lb/ft* wind Resultant weight’ .6045 .6105 .6345 .6435 .6623 .6593 .6855 .6953 .7148 .7148 .7245 .7455 .7050 .7328 .7425 .7643 .6975 .7148 .7500 .7883 .8108 .8190 .8310 .8550 .7800 .7973 .8198 .8483 .9179 .8506 .9333 .9696 1.0483 .9441 1.0420 1.0845 1.1775 1.1080 1.1540 1.2497 1.0372 1.1489 1.1976 1.2991 .9991 1.0339 1.1903 1.3116 1.4254 1.3612 1.4238 1.5521 1.1707 1.2493 1.3617 1.3728 SAFETY MEDIUM Weight with l/4-in ice .9512 .8489 .9554 1.0016 1.0994 .9551 1.0790 1.1320 1.2461 1.1541 1.2112 1.3269 1.0611 1.2006 1.2606 1.3827 1.0107 1.0503 1.2478 1.3896 1.5249 1.4414 1.5163 1.6673 1.2059 1.3043 1.4417 1.4445 CODE LOADING 4-lb/ft* wind .4353 .4380 .4487 .4527 .4610 .4597 .4713 .4757 .4843 .4843 .4887 .4980 .4800 .4923 .4967 .5063 .4767 .4843 .5000 .5170 .5270 .5307 .5360 .5467 .5133 .5210 .5310 .5437 1977 HEAVY Resultant weight* 1.2461 1.1552 1.2555 1.2991 1.3921 1.2600 1.3775 1.4279 1.5369 1.4516 1.5060 1.6173 1.3646 1.4976 1.5550 1.6725 1.3174 1.3566 1.5442 1.6827 1.8134 1.7359 1.8083 1.9546 1.5106 1.6045 1.7364 1.7434 ALL VALUES 1 EDITION Weight with l/2-in ice 1.4351 1.3353 1.4517 1.5017 1.6072 1.4617 1.5965 1.6536 1.7758 1.6838 1.7449 1.8693 1.5867 1.7377 1.8018 1.9328 1.5332 1.5800 1.7920 1.9497 2.0944 2.0142 2.0942 2.2551 1.7626 1.8682 2.0148 2.0295 LOADING 4-lb/ft* wind .6020 .6047 .6153 .6193 .6277 .6263 .6380 .6423 .6510 .6510 .6553 .6647 .6467 .6590 .6633 .6730 .6433 .6510 .6667 .6837 .6937 .6973 .7027 .7133 .6800 .6877 .6977 .7103 Resultant weight3 1.8563 1.7658 1.8767 1.9244 2.0254 1.8903 2.0193 2.0740 2.1913 2.1052 2.1639 2.2839 2.0134 2.1585 2.2200 2.3466 1.9627 2.0088 2.2120 2.3661 2.5063 2.4315 2.5089 2.6652 2.1892 2.2907 2.4322 2.4502 ARE IN POUNDS PER FOOT. Table C-&-Conductor and overhead ground wire values for NESC light, medium, and heavy loading (U.S. customary)-Continued Code word CANARY CATB I RD RAIL CARDINAL ORTOLAN CURLEW BLUEJAY FINCH BUNT I NG GRACKLE B I TTERN PHEASANT D I PPER MART I N BOBOLINK PLOVER NUTHATCH PARROT LAPW I NG FALCON CHUKAR BLUEBIRD KIWI THRASHER JOREE F NATIONAL LIGHT Weight with no ice 1.1590 .9660 1.0750 1.2290 1.1650 1.3310 1.2550 1.4310 1.3440 1.5330 1.4340 1.6350 1.5220 1.7370 1.6130 1.8400 1.7020 1.9420 1.7920 2.0440 2.0740 2.1620 2.5110 2.3030 2.9680 2.5260 2.7490 3.5700 ’ Includes 0.05 NESC constant. 2 Includes 0.20 NESC constant. 3 Includes 0.30 NESC constant. l- LOADING 9-lb/ft2 wind .8715 .8550 .8738 .8970 .9098 .9345 .9443 .9698 .9765 1.0035 1.0088 1.0365 1.0395 1.0680 1.0703 1.0988 1.0995 1.1295 1.1265 1.1588 1.2015 1.2608 1.3215 1.3028 1.3928 1.3515 1.4100 1.5758 SAFETY ELECTRICAL Resultant weight l 1.5001 1.3400 1.4353 1.5715 1.5281 1.6763 1.6206 1.7786 1.7113 1.8822 1.8033 1.9859 1.8931 2.0891 1.9858 2.1931 2.0763 2.2966 2.1667 2.3996 2.4469 2.5527 2.8875 2.6959 3.3285 2.9148 3.1395 3.9523 MEDIUM Weight with l/4-in ice 1.5981 1.3983 1.5151 1.6787 1.6200 1.7963 1.7243 1.9109 1.8267 2.0269 1.9300 2.1426 2.0308 2.2576. 2.1345 2.3734 2.2357 2.4881 2.3369 2.6022 2.6500 2.7625 3.1367 2.9210 3.6233 3.1642 3.4114 4.3012 1977 CODE l- LOADING 4-lb/ft2 wind .5540 .5467 .5550 .5653 .5710 .5820 .5863. .5977 .6007 .6127 .6150 .6273 .6287 .6413 .6423 .6550 .6553 .6687 .6673 .6817 .7007 .7270 .7540 .7457 .7857 .7673 .7933 .8670 Resultant weight2 1.8914 1.7014 1.8135 1.9713 1.9177 2.0882 2.0213 2.2022 2.1229 2.3174 2.2257 2.4325 2.3259 2.5469 2.4291 2.6621 2.5297 2.7764 2.6303 2.8900 2.9410 3.0566 3.4261 3.2146 3.9075 3.4559 3.7025 4.5877 ALL VALUES 1 EDITION HEAVY LOADING Weight with l/2-in ice 4-lb/ft2 wind Resultatlt weight’ 2.1928 1.9861 2.1106 2.2839 2.2305 2.4170 2.3491 2.5462 2.4648 2.6762 2.5816 2.8056 2.6951 2.9337 2.8116 3.0622 2.9249 3.1897 3.0372 3.3160 3.3814 3.5186 3.9180 3.6944 4.4341 3.9578 4.2294 5.1878 .7207 .7133 97217 .7320 .7377 .7487 .7530 .7643 .7673 .7793 .7817 .7940 .7953 .8080 .8090 .8217 .8220 .8353 .8340 -8483 .8673 .8937 .9207 .9123 .9523 .9340 .9600 1.0337 2.6082 2.4103 2.5306 2.6983 2.6493 2.8303 2.7668 2.9585 2.8815 3.0874 2.9973 3.2158 3.1100 3.3430 3.2257 3.4706 3.3382 3.5973 3.4497 3.7228 3.7909 3.9303 4.3247 4.1054 4.8352 4.3666 4.6369 5.5898 ARE IN POUNDS PER FOOT. Table Cd.-Conductor and overhead ground wire values for NESC light, medium, and heavy loading f U.S. customary&Continued I Wire type and size NATIONAL I. I GHT Weight with no ice ELECTRICAL MEDIUM LOADING 9-lb/ft2 wind Resultant weight l STEEL 3/8 3/8 ‘/I6 ‘46 l/2 y/2 INCH INCH INCH INCH INCH INCH HS EHS HS EHS HS EHS .2730 .2730 .3990 .3990 .5170 .5170 .2700 .2700 .3263 .3263 .3713 .3713 .1310 8M 16M 18M 20M 25M 7 NO. 7 NO. 7 NO. 7N0. 7N0. 7N0. 7N0. 7N0. 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 1650 : 2080 .2320 .2620 .3060 .3470 .4750 .1036 .1306 1647 : 2076 .2618 .3300 .4163 .5249 ’ Includes 0.05 NESC constant. 2 Includes 0.20 NESC constant. 3 Includes 0.30 NESC constant. .2040 .2295 .2573 .2723 .2895 .3128 .3330 .3893 1815 : 2040 .2295 .2573 .2888 .3248 .3645 .4095 Weight with l/4-in ice STRAND .2924 .3327 .3808 .4077 .4405 .4875 .5309 .6641 .2590 .2922 .3325 .3806 .4398 .5130 .6033 .7157 1977 CODE LOADING 4-lb/ft2 wind OVERHEAD .4340 .4340 .5654 .5654 .6865 .6865 ALUMOWELD 10M 12.5M 14M SAFETY GROUND HEAVY Resultant weight’ WIRE .3117 .3117 .3317 .3317 OVERHEAD .2933 .3379 .3924 .4226 .4598 .5134 .5628 .7142 .2566 .2929 .3376 .3920 .4593 .5424 .6452 .7725 .2573 .2687 .2810 .2877 .2953 .3057 .3147 .3397 .2473 .2573 .2687 .2810 .2950 .3110 .3287 .3487 Weight with l/2-in ice 4-lb/ft2 wind Resultant weight” .8079 .8079 99806 .9806 .4533 .4533 .4783 .4783 .4983 .4983 1.2264 1.2264 1.3910 1.3910 1.5404 1.5404 .4240 .4353 .4477 .4543 .4620 .4723 1.0439 1.0959 1.1583 1.1930 1.2352 1 h2956 1.3509 1.5190 1.0005 1.0435 1.0957 1.1580 1.2343 1.3280 1.4425 1.5835 1.1359 1.1359 GROUND LOADING (7-WIRE) .2867 .2867 STRAND EDITION WIRE .5902 .6317 .6827 .7113 .7465 .7975 .8448 .9908 .5564 .5899 .6315 .6823 .7459 .8252 .9241 1.0475 ALL VALUES .6112 .6663 .7323 .7688 .8131 .8764 .9342 1.1088 .5651 .6108 .6660 .7319 .8123 .9103 1.0296 1.1755 .4813 .5063 .4140 .4240 .4353 .4477 .4617 .4777 .4953 .5153 ARE IN POUNDS PER FOOT. <<Index ACSR conductors creep, 9, 13, 26. 442, 452 data tables, 462, 466 ice and wind load, 27, 470, 474 initial and final modulus, 13, 15, 26, 442, 452 loading conditions, 2, 26, 128 loading constants, 27 loading tables, 470, 474 permanent set, 14, 26, 442, 45? sags and tensions (see Sags and tensions) stress-strain curves, 10 Adjacent spans distance between low points of, 128 maximum sum of, 128 Air gap, 103. 112 flashover values, 423, 424 Aluminum conductor tables, 462 Alumoweld strand data tables, 465. 469 ice and wind load, 27, 473, 477 initial and final modulus, 13, 26, 419 loading conditions, 2, 26 loading constants, 27 loading tables, 473, 477 permanent set, 419 sags and tensions (see Sags and tensions) stress-strain curves, 14 Angle insulator swing, 105, 112, 123, 129, 133, 142 maximum line deflection, 128 of bias lines for single insulator string limit, 168 of bias lines on structure limitation chart, 152 of line deflection scale, 141 (wood), 151 (steel) of protection, 108 of sideswing, 51, 127 ANSI. 2, 213 moment of resistance for wood poles, 348 Armor rods, 282 Aaiiutb chart, 342 Barometric pressure, 426 Basic impulse insulation level, Broken conductor, 56 sags and tensions, 29 thesis, 307 unbalanced condition, 67 Building clearances, 274 104 California safety code (see Safety codes) Carroll, J. S., 284 catenary curve. 14, 17, 22, 25, 28 charts azimuth, 342 pyiw. 127 structure limitation, 127 Circumference tables for wood Class of poles, 156 by pole lengths, 273 Clayton, J. M.. 111 Clearance patterns. 103, 111 construction of, 121 poles, 351 Clearances air-gap, 103, 109, 112 at conductor transposition, 7 between conductors, 51 climbing, 2 conductor to building, 274 conductor to ground, 34, 38, 266 conductor to guy, 130, 131 (Calif.) conductor to steel structure, 112 conductor to wood structure, 129, 131 (Calif.) crossings, 273 curves for spotting, 266 midspan, 110 models for, 6 NESC, 34 patterns, 103, 111 right-of-way, 274 Codes (see Safety codes) Concentrated loads, 29, 99 Conductor broken, 29, 56, 307 clearance patterns, 103, 111 clearances (see Clearances) creep, 9, 13, 26, 442, 452 data tables, 430, 442, 452, 462, 466, 470, 474 effect of temperature change, 30 elastic limit, 13 electrical conductivity, 9 elongation, 10 galloping, 50, 284 ice and wind load, 27, 470, 474 lightning protection, 103 loading conditions (see Loading conditions) loading constants, 27 mechanical strength, 9 modulus of elasticity, 13 proportional limit, 13 sags and tensions (see Sags and tensions) sag template, 32 selection of, 9 stress-strain curves, 10 ultimate tensile strength, 13 uplift, 268 vibration, 282 working limit, 13 yield strength, 13 Cone of protection, 108 Construction single wood-pole, 4 type of, 4, 128 Copperweld sag charts, 29 Corona, 284 loss, 9 with armor rods, 282 Cost estimates, 2 Creep, 9, 442, 452 defdtion, 13 in final loading condition, 26 Crossings, 273 Dancing conductors (see Galloping Data summary form. 23 Davison, A. E., 50 479 conductors) 480 TRANSMISSION Den Hat-tog, J. P., 50 Density, 426, 427 Department of Energy, iii Design instructions, 21 Design tensions (conductor), 128 Distance between low points, 128 Double-circuit steel structures. 6 Douglas fir pole circumferences, 351 Drawings guying chart, 209 plan and profile, 32, 266 project, 4 sag template, 32, 266 standard, 4 steel structure limitation chart, 147 wood structure limitation chart, 205 clearance to conductor, 130, in poor hearing soil, 274 Factor of safety California, 13 1 insulation withstand, 105 steel construction, 127 wood construction, 129 Farr. Holland H., iii Field data, 1 Final loading condition, 26 Final modulus of elasticity, 13, 26, 442, 452 Flashover, 103 characteristics of insulators and air gaps, 423 critical impulse, 120 lightning, 107 60-He wet, 120 surge, 104 switching values of air gaps, 424 Flattop construction, 4 Footing resistance, 103, 111 surge resistance, 111 Fortescue, C. L., 106 GUYS calculations for, 169 131 (Calif.) H-frame wood-pole structures, 4 guying, 169 maximum design tensions, 128 maximum low-point distance. 153 maximum sum of adjacent spans, 156, stresses, 213 Effective span, 8 Ehrenburg, D. O., 40 Elastic limit, 13 Electrical conductivity, 9 Ellipses, 130, 184 Elongation, 10, 26 Engineers cost estimate, 2 Equations (survey), 300 Galloping conductors, 50 half- and full-sag ellipses, 130 vibrations, 284 Grading the transmission line, 268 Graphic method for sag-tension calculations, Ground clearances, 34, 38 on side slopes, 273 Ground resistivity. 111, 344 Guying chart. 127 eonstrnction of. 186 LINE DESIGN MANUAL 30 162 Ice loading, 27, 470, 474 Impulse insulation level (value), 104, 112, 423 Inclined spans, 38 sags and tensions, 28 stringing, 292 Initial loading condition, 26 Initial modulus of elasticity, 13, 26, 442, 452 Insulation, 103 air-gap, 103, 112, 423 basic impulse level, 104 safety factors, 106 selection tables, 107 withstand, 105 Insulator effect, 77 extra units, 106 factor of safety, 128 flashover characteristics, 423 impulse insulation value, 104, 112. 423 offset, 292 sideswing, 51, 268 strength requirement for steel structures, 135 swing angle, 105. 112, 129, 131, 133, 142 vertical force, 141 Isoceraunic level. 103 Kientz, H. J., iii Land sections, 340, 341 Level spans sags and tensions, 28 Lightning direct-stroke theory, 106 impulse voltages, 103 protection, 103, 106 Line deflection angle, 128 near a substation, 274 resultant force, 169 Loading conditions, 2, 128 ACSR, 27 California, 3, 27, 130 final, 26 for galloping, 50 full load, 132 initial. 26 NESC. 9.26 overhead ground wire, 28 Loading constants, 27 INDEX Locating structures (see Structure Long-span construction, 7 Losses corona, 284 Martin, J. S., 29 Martin’s Sag Calculating Tables, Mass per volume (wood species), Metric conversions, 431 Midspan clearances, 110 Models for clearances, 6 Modulus of elasticity, 13, 26 Mohr, R. D., iii Moment of resistance ANSI standard, 348 formula, 343 USBR standard, 345 spotting) 29 427 NESC, 2.93 clearances, 34, 273 loading conditions, 27, 132 Nomenclature steel structures, 5, 133 wood-pole structures, 4, 149 Normal span, 7 Oscillations (see Galloping conductors) Outages lightning, 111 Overhead ground wires, 108 data tables, 462, 466, 470, 474 loading conditions, 3, 27 midspan clearances, 110 Overvoltage6 causes, 105 liihtuing, 103 power frequency, 103 switching surges, 103 Parabola. 14, 25, 28 Peek, F. W., 284 Permanent set, 10, 26 definition, 13 values for ACSR, 442, 452 values for Alumoweld strand, 419 values for steel strand, 420 Peterson, W. S., 284 Pole circumferences Douglas fir, 351 southern yellow pine, 351 western red cedar, 385 Pole ground wire. 128 Power frequency operating voltages, 103 causes of overvoltages, 105 Power loss. 284 Pressure due to wind, 429 Priest, F. F.. iii, 99 Proportional limit, 13 Protection lightning, 103 Proximity effect, 104 Relative air density, 426 Relative mass density (wood), 427 Resistance maximum moment of, 343 Resistivity, 111, 344 Restriking, 104 Right-of-way, 274 Rockwell, M. M., 284 Ruling span definition, 8 for stringing, 292 Safety codes, 2, 28 California, 2, 26, 35, 130, 273 NESC, 2,26, 132, 273, 275 Safety factor (see Factor of safety) Sags and tensions, 25, 29 calculation form, 33 calculations for, 30, 38 catenary versus parabola, 14, 25, 28 Copperweld charts, 30 Ehrenburg’s method. 40 inclined spans, 28, 38, 292 initial and final loading conditions, 26 insulator effect on, 29, 77 level spans, 28 loading conditions, 2, 27 loading constants, 27 Martin’s tables, 29 maximum tensions, 3, 27 spans adjacent to a broken conductor, 29, 56 spans with concentrated loads, 29, 99 stringing, 292 temperature for loading conditions, 3, 27 Sag template, 32 broken conductor, 67 for structure spotting, 266 inclined span, 38 Scale factors for structure limitation charts line deflection angle, 141 (steel), 151 (wood) low point, 140 (steel), 149 (wood) sum of adjacent spans, 141 (steel), 152 (wood) Section numbering, 340 Selection of conductor, 9 ruling span, 8 type of construction, 4 Sheaves for stringing, 292 Shield angle, 103, 108 Sideswing, 51, 268 angle, 105, 112, 129, 131, 133, 142 SI metric, 431 Single-circuit steel structure, 5, 133 Single span limits on structures, 183 Single wood-pole structure, 4 Southern yellow pine pole circumferences, 351 481 482 TRANSMISSION Spacing between conductors, 51 SpaDS adjacent to broken conductor, 29, 56 effective, 8 inclined, 28, 38 level, 28 maximum permissable, 51 normal, 7 ~lins, 8 substation approach, 273 with concentrated loads, 29, 99 with unbalanced loads, 29, 67 Standards for preparing structure limitation chart, 127 Station equations, 300 Steel strand, 7-wire data tables, 465. 469 ice and wind load. 27,473,477 initial and foal modulus, 13, 26, 422 loading conditions, 2, 26 loading constants, 27 loading tables, 473, 477 permanent set, 420 sags and tensions (see Sags and tensions) stress-strain mtrves, 14 Steel structures (see Structures) Strength basis for calculation, 128 determining low-point distance, 153 determining span length, 183 determiniq sum of adjacent spans, 156, 162 limitation of single insulator string, 166 requirements of insulator string, 135 (steel) Stresses conductor, 10 voltage, 103, 112 wood-pole structures, 213 Stress-strain curves, 10, 15 Stringing, 25 sag data, 292 Stroke current, 103 Structure limitation chart, 127 angle of bias lines, 142 (steel), 152 (wood) angle of bias lines for insulators, 168 basis for strength calculations, 128 clearance patterns, 111 conductor calcuhxtions, 135 (steel), 150 (wood) conductor clearances, 129, 131 (Cahf.) construction of, 145 (steel), 185 (wood) data required for construction of, 132 (steel), 146 (wood) effect of hold downs, 156 full-load conditions, 132 guying, 169, 176, 179, 182 insulator swing angles, 142 (steel) insulator swing limits, 129, 131 insulator vertical force, 141 (steel), 150 (wood) line deflection angle scale, 141 (steel), 151 (wood) loading conditions, 3, 128 low-point distance, 153 low-point scale, 140 (steel), 149 (wood) maximum design tensions, 128 safety factors, 128, 131 single span limits, 183 standards to follow, 127 LINE DESIGN MANUAL strength of insulators, 105 (wood), 135 (steel) structure design, 130 (Cahf.) sum of adjacent spans, 156, 162, 164 sum of adjacent spans scale, 141 (steel), 152 (wood) wind force on pole, 156 Structures adjacent to substation. 273 basic types of, 4 double-circuit steel, 6 for special conditions, 4, 6 functional classes of. 4 gr0”miing of, 111 H-frame wood-pole, 4, 149 insulation for, 103 liihtning protection, 103 single-circuit steel, 5. 133 single wood-pole, 4 spotting, 266 stresses in wood-pole, 213 Structure spotting, 29, 266 sag template, 32 uplift, 268 Substations, 29, 273 Summary form, 23 Sum of adjacent spans, 128 (steel), 156, 162 (wood) Survey equations, 300 Suspension clamp, 292 Suspension insulator string flashover characteristics, 423 switching surges, 103 Switchyards (see Substations) Taps, 29, 99 Temperature coefficients of expansion, 428 for loading conditions, 3, 27 Template (see Sag template) Tensile testing, 10 Tension (see also Sags and tensions) calculation of, 29 conductor, 3, 25 maximum design. 128, 130 overhead ground wire, 28 Tie-downs, 29, 99 Township, 340 Transmission lie data summary form, 23 equations, 300 grading the line, 268 Transpositions, 6 Triangular construction, 4 Types of construction double-circuit steel, 6 H-frame wood-pole, 4 selection of, 4 single-circuit steel, 5 single wood-pole, 4 ultimate tensile strength, defhtion, 13 Uplift (upstrain). 268 422, 462, 466 INDEX USBR standards augle of protection, 110 clearance patterns, 111 conductor and overhead ground wire design criteria, 3 conductor clearance to buildiugs, 275 conductor clearance to guy wire, 130, 131 (Calif.) conductor clearance to structure, 129, 131 (Calif.) wowings, 273 ellipses, 50 factors of safety for wood construction, 129, 131 (Calif.) full-load conditions. 132 insulation coordination, 105 insulator swing limitations, 129 (wood) maximum moment of resistance for wood poles, 345 structure limitation chart, 127 structures and spans near substations, 273 Vibration dampers, 282 Voltagc stress, 112 lightning impulse, 103, 105 power frequency, 103, 105 switching surge. 103 Wave shape, 103 Western Area Power Administration, iii Western red cedar pole circumferences, 385 Wind force on ~004 pole, i56 loadiug on conductor, 3 pressure on projected area, 429 Wiieauckas, G. R., 29, 56, 307 Wood-pole structures basis for strcugth calculation, 128 classes of poles, 156, 273 483 climbii clearance, 2 conductor calculations, 149 conductor clearance to guy wire, 130, 131 (Calif.) conductor clearance to structure, 129, 131 (Calif.) designations and types, 149 effect of hold downs, 156 full-load conditions, 133 guying, 169;171, 176, 179, 182 H-frame, 4, 128, 149 insulator string strength, 166 insulator swing limits, 129, 131 insulator vertical force, 150 loading conditions, 3, 128 low-point distance, 153 mass per volume of wood, 427 moment of resistance, 343 pole circumferences, 351, 385 relative mass density of wood, 427 safety factors, 129, 131 (Calif.) single, 4 single span limits, 183 stresses in, 213 structure limitation chart, 146, 185 sum of adjacent spans, 156, 162, 164 tensions (design), 128 type of construction, 128 wind force on pole, 156 Wood species mass and density of, 427 Working limit, 13 X-braces, 4 Yield strength, 13 Young, F. S., 111